Use these links to rapidly review the document
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on August 29, 2014

Registration No. 333-            


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549



FORM S-1

REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933



Veritex Holdings, Inc.

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)



Texas
(State or Other Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or Organization)
  6022
(Primary Standard Industrial
Classification No.)
  27-0973566
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 400
Dallas, Texas 75225
(972) 349 - 6200

(Address, Including Zip Code, of Registrant's Principal Executive Offices)

C. Malcolm Holland, III
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
Veritex Holdings, Inc.
8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 400
Dallas, Texas 75225
(972) 349 - 6200
(Name, Address and Telephone Number, Including Area Code, of Agent For Service)



Copies to:

William S. Anderson
Jason M. Jean
Bracewell & Giuliani LLP
711 Louisiana, Suite 2300
Houston, Texas 77002
(713) 223-2300
(713) 437-5370 (facsimile)

 

Sanford M. Brown
Justin M. Long
Bracewell & Giuliani LLP
1445 Ross Avenue, Suite 3800
Dallas, Texas 75202
(214) 468-3800
(214) 758-8300 (facsimile)

 

Chet A. Fenimore
Geoffrey S. Kay
Fenimore, Kay, Harrison & Ford, LLP
812 San Antonio Street, Suite 600
Austin, Texas 78701
(512) 583-5900
(512) 583-5940 (facsimile)



Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:
As soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration Statement.

          If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933, check the following box.    o

          If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.    o

          If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.    o

          If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.    o

          Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer" and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 under the Exchange Act. (check one)

Large accelerated filer o   Accelerated filer o   Non-accelerated filer ý
(Do not check if a
smaller reporting company)
  Smaller reporting company o

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

       
 
Title of Each Class of Securities
to be Registered

  Proposed Maximum
Aggregate Offering
Price (1)

  Amount of
Registration Fee

 

Common Stock, $0.01 par value per share

  $40,000,000   $5,152

 

(1)
Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933. Includes offering price of shares that the underwriters have the option to purchase.

          The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file an amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 or until this Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.

   


Table of Contents

The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state where the offer or sale is not permitted.

Subject to Completion, Dated August 29, 2014

PROSPECTUS

            Shares

LOGO

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

Common Stock



        This is the initial public offering of shares of common stock of Veritex Holdings, Inc., the holding company for Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state chartered bank headquartered in Dallas, Texas.

        We are offering            shares of our common stock. No public market currently exists for our common stock. We intend to apply to list our common stock on the NASDAQ Global Market under the symbol "VBTX."

        We anticipate that the initial public offering price per share of our common stock will be between $            and $            .

        We are an "emerging growth company" as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, and are subject to reduced public company disclosure standards.

        Investing in our common stock involves risks. See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 12 of this prospectus to read about factors you should consider before investing in our common stock.

 
  Per share
  Total

Initial public offering price of our common stock

  $           $        

Underwriting discounts and commissions

       

Proceeds, before expenses, to us(1)

       

(1)
See "Underwriting" for additional information regarding the underwriting discounts and commissions and certain expenses payable to the underwriters by us.

        We have granted the underwriters the option to purchase up to an additional                        shares of our common stock from us within 30 days of the date of this prospectus on the same terms and conditions set forth above, to cover over allotments, if any.

        Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission, any state securities commission, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, the Texas Department of Banking nor any other regulatory authority has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

        These securities are not deposits, savings accounts or other obligations of any bank or savings association and are not insured or guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any other governmental agency and are subject to investment risks, including the possible loss of the entire amount you invest.

        The underwriters expect to deliver the shares to purchasers on or about                , 2014, subject to customary closing conditions.

Sandler O'Neill + Partners, L.P.   Stephens Inc.

Sterne Agee



   

The date of this prospectus is                , 2014


Table of Contents

GRAPHIC


Table of Contents


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
  Page  

Forward-Looking Statements

    iii  

Summary

    1  

Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data

    9  

Risk Factors

    12  

Use of Proceeds

    35  

Capitalization

    36  

Dilution

    38  

Dividend Policy

    40  

Business

    41  

Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

    57  

Regulation and Supervision

    96  

Management

    110  

Executive Compensation

    117  

Principal Shareholders

    122  

Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions

    124  

Description of Capital Stock

    127  

Shares Eligible for Future Sale

    132  

Material U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences for Non-U.S. Holders

    134  

Underwriting

    137  

Legal Matters

    142  

Experts

    142  

Where You Can Find More Information

    142  

Index to Financial Statements

    F-1  

Table of Contents


About this Prospectus

        You should rely only on the information contained in this prospectus and any free writing prospectus prepared by us or on our behalf that we have referred you to. We and the underwriters have not authorized anyone to provide you with additional or different information. If anyone provides you with additional, different or inconsistent information, you should not rely on it. We and the underwriters take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. This prospectus is an offer to sell only the shares offered hereby, and only under circumstances and in jurisdictions where it is lawful to do so. We are not making an offer of these securities in any state, country or other jurisdiction where the offer is not permitted. You should not assume that the information in this prospectus or any free writing prospectus is accurate as of any date other than the date of the applicable document regardless of its time of delivery or the time of any sales of our common stock. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows may have changed since the date of the applicable document.


Market Data

        This prospectus includes industry and trade association data, forecasts and information that we have prepared based, in part, upon data, forecasts and information obtained from independent trade associations, industry publications and surveys, government agencies and other information available to us, which information may be specific to particular markets or geographic locations. Some data is also based on our good faith estimates, which are derived from management's knowledge of the industry and independent sources. Industry publications and surveys and forecasts generally state that the information contained therein has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable. Although we believe these sources are reliable, we have not independently verified the information. Statements as to our market position are based on market data currently available to us. While we are not aware of any misstatements regarding our industry data presented herein, our estimates involve risks and uncertainties and are subject to change based on various factors, including those discussed under the heading "Risk Factors" in this prospectus. Similarly, we believe our internal research is reliable, even though such research has not been verified by any independent sources.


Implications of Being an Emerging Growth Company

        As a company with less than $1.0 billion in revenue during our last fiscal year, we qualify as an "emerging growth company" as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012, or the JOBS Act. We will continue to be an emerging growth company until the earliest to occur of: (1) the last day of the fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of this offering; (2) the last day of the fiscal year in which we have more than $1.0 billion in annual revenues; (3) the date on which we are deemed to be a "large accelerated filer" under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or the Exchange Act; or (4) the date on which we have, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1.0 billion in non-convertible debt securities. Until we cease to be an emerging growth company, we may take advantage of specified reduced reporting and other regulatory requirements generally unavailable to other public companies. Those provisions allow us to present only two years of audited financial statements, discuss only our results of operations for two years in related Management's Discussions and Analyses and provide less than five years of selected financial data in an initial public offering registration statement; not to provide an auditor attestation of our internal control over financial reporting; to choose not to comply with any new requirements adopted by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, or the PCAOB, requiring mandatory audit firm rotation or a supplement to the auditor's report providing additional information about the audit and our audited financial statements; to provide reduced disclosure regarding our executive compensation arrangements pursuant to the rules applicable to smaller reporting companies, which means we do not have to include a compensation discussion and analysis and certain other disclosure regarding our executive

i


Table of Contents

compensation; and not to seek a non-binding advisory vote on executive compensation or golden parachute arrangements. We may choose to take advantage of some or all of these reduced reporting and other regulatory requirements. We have elected in this prospectus to take advantage of the reduced disclosure requirements relating to executive compensation arrangements.

        The JOBS Act also permits an "emerging growth company" to take advantage of an extended transition period to comply with new or revised accounting standards applicable to public companies. However, we have "opted out" of this provision. As a result, we will comply with new or revised accounting standards to the same extent that compliance is required for non-emerging growth companies. This decision to opt out of the extended transition period under the JOBS Act is irrevocable.

ii


Table of Contents


FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

        Forward-looking statements included in this prospectus are based on various facts and derived utilizing numerous important assumptions and are subject to known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause our actual results, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, performance or achievements expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements include the information concerning our future financial performance, business and growth strategy, projected plans and objectives, as well as projections of macroeconomic and industry trends, which are inherently unreliable due to the multiple factors that impact economic trends, and any such variations may be material. Statements preceded by, followed by or that otherwise include the words "believes," "expects," "anticipates," "intends," "projects," "estimates," "plans" and similar expressions or future or conditional verbs such as "will," "should," "would," "may" and "could" are generally forward-looking in nature and not historical facts, although not all forward-looking statements include the foregoing. You should understand that the following important factors could affect our future results and cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in the forward-looking statements:

iii


Table of Contents

        Other factors not identified above, including those described under the headings "Risk Factors" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations," may also cause actual results to differ materially from those described in our forward-looking statements. Most of these factors are difficult to anticipate and are generally beyond our control. You should consider these factors in connection with considering any forward-looking statements that may be made by us. We undertake no obligation to release publicly any revisions to any forward-looking statements, to report events or to report the occurrence of unanticipated events unless we are required to do so by law.

iv


Table of Contents

 


SUMMARY

        This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. This summary does not contain all of the information that you should consider in making your investment decision. You should read the following summary together with the entire prospectus, including the more detailed information regarding us, the common stock being sold in this offering and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. You should carefully consider, among other things, the matters discussed in the sections entitled "Risk Factors" and "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" in this prospectus before deciding to invest in our common stock. Some of the statements in this prospectus constitute forward-looking statements. See "Forward-Looking Statements."

        Except where the context otherwise requires or where otherwise indicated, in this prospectus the terms "we," "us," "our," "our company" and "our business" refer to Veritex Holdings, Inc. and our wholly-owned banking subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state chartered bank, and the term "Bank" refers to Veritex Community Bank.

Our Company

        We are a bank holding company headquartered in Dallas, Texas. Through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state chartered bank, we provide relationship-driven commercial banking products and services tailored to meet the needs of small to medium-sized businesses and professionals. Since our inception, we have targeted customers and focused our acquisitions primarily in the Dallas metropolitan area, which we consider to be Dallas and the adjacent communities in North Dallas. As we continue to grow, we expect to expand our primary market to include the broader Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area, which would include Fort Worth and Arlington, as well as the communities adjacent to those cities. We currently operate eight branches and one mortgage office, all of which are located in the Dallas metropolitan area. We have experienced significant organic growth since commencing banking operations in 2010 and have successfully acquired and integrated three banks. As of June 30, 2014, we had total assets of $710.4 million, total loans of $541.0 million, total deposits of $611.2 million and total stockholders' equity of $74.2 million.

        Our primary customers are small and medium-sized businesses, generally with annual revenues of under $30 million, and professionals. We believe that these businesses and professionals highly value the local decision-making and relationship-driven, quality service we provide and our deep, long-term understanding of the Dallas community and Texas banking. As a result of consolidation, we believe that there are few locally-based banks that are dedicated to providing this level of service to small and medium-sized businesses. Our management team's long-standing presence and experience in the Dallas metropolitan area gives us unique insight into our local market and the needs of our customers. This enables us to respond quickly to customers, provide high quality personal service and develop comprehensive, long-term banking relationships by providing products and services tailored to meet the individual needs of our customers. This focus and approach enhances our ability to continue to grow organically, successfully recruit talented bankers and strategically source potential acquisitions in our target market.

Our History and Growth

        Our management team is led by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, C. Malcolm Holland, III, who has overseen and managed our organic growth and acquisition activity since we commenced banking operations in 2010. We have completed three whole-bank acquisitions that have increased our market presence within the Dallas metropolitan area. We have also grown organically by

 

1


Table of Contents

opening two branches and a mortgage office in the Dallas metropolitan area. The following table summarizes our three acquisitions:

Bank Acquired
  Date Completed   Acquired
Assets
  Acquired
Loans
  Number of
Branches
  Dallas Area
Locations
 
  (Dollars in millions)

Professional Bank, N.A. through Professional Capital, Inc. 

  September 2010   $ 181.8   $ 91.7     3   Park Cities,
Lakewood and
Garland

Fidelity Bank through Fidelity Resources Company

 

March 2011

   
166.3
   
108.1
   
3
 

Preston Center,
SMU and Plano

Bank of Las Colinas

 

October 2011

   
53.8
   
40.4
   
1
 

Las Colinas

        We have established a record of steady growth and profitable operations since commencing banking operations in 2010, as demonstrated below (total loans and deposits as of period-end and three year compound annual growth rate, or CAGR, through December 31, 2013), while preserving our strong credit culture. Our initial growth in 2010 and 2011 was primarily the result of our acquisitions. During 2012, 2013 and the first six months of 2014, we grew our total loans and deposits organically by increasing our commercial lending relationships and more deeply penetrating the Dallas metropolitan area.

GRAPHIC

 

2


Table of Contents

Our Strategy

        Our business strategy is comprised of the following components:

    Organic Growth in Thriving Dallas Metropolitan Area.  Our organic growth strategy has focused on more deeply penetrating the Dallas metropolitan area through our community-focused, relationship-driven approach to banking. We believe that our current market area provides abundant opportunities to continue to grow our customer base, increase loans and deposits and expand our overall market share. Our team of seasoned bankers has been an important driver of our organic growth by further developing banking relationships with current and potential customers, many of which span more than 20 years. Our market presidents and relationship managers are incentivized to increase the size of their loan and deposit portfolios and generate fee income while maintaining strong credit quality. We intend to add to our team of experienced bankers in order to grow our current footprint and expand further into markets throughout the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area. Preserving sound credit underwriting standards as we grow our loan portfolio will continue to be the foundation of our organic growth strategy.

    Acquisitions.  We intend to continue to grow through acquisitions, and we believe having publicly traded common stock will improve our ability to compete for acquisitions. Many small to medium-sized banking organizations in the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area face significant scale and operational challenges, regulatory pressure, management succession issues and shareholder liquidity needs. There are 60 banks headquartered in this area with less than $500 million of assets, which collectively held approximately $11.0 billion in assets, as of March 31, 2014, according to the FDIC. As a result, we believe that there will continue to be attractive acquisition opportunities in the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area as well as in other attractive markets in Texas. Although we have no current plans, arrangements or understandings to make any material acquisitions, this market dynamic will afford us opportunities to identify and execute acquisitions designed to strengthen our franchise and increase shareholder value.

    Improve Operational Efficiency and Increase Profitability.  We are committed to maintaining and enhancing profitability. Our net income increased from $109,000 in 2011 to $3.4 million in 2013 and our efficiency ratio improved from 92.2% in 2011 to 69.8% in 2013. For the six months ended June 30, 2014, our net income was $2.2 million compared to $1.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2013. We employ a systematic and calculated approach to improving our operational efficiency, which in turn we believe increases our profitability. We have upgraded our operating capabilities and created a platform for continued efficiencies in the areas of technology, data processing, regulatory compliance and human resources. We believe that our scalable infrastructure and efficient operating platform will allow us to achieve continued growth without incurring significant incremental noninterest expenses and will enhance our returns.

    Continue to Build Our Community Ties.  Our officers and employees are heavily involved in civic and community organizations, and we sponsor numerous activities that benefit our community. Our business development strategy, which focuses on building market share through personal relationships, as opposed to formal advertising, is consistent with our customer-centric culture and is a cost-effective approach to developing new relationships and enhancing existing ones.

Our Competitive Strengths

        We believe our competitive strengths include the following:

    Experienced Senior Management Team.  Our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, C. Malcolm Holland, III, and our Vice Chairman, William C. Murphy, have more than 75 years of combined experience acquiring, growing and selling banks in the Dallas metropolitan area. Messrs. Holland

 

3


Table of Contents

      and Murphy have worked together in three different banking institutions during seven of the past 17 years.

      Mr. Holland began his banking career in 1982, and in 1986 was an organizer and leader of EastPark National Bank, Dallas, until it was acquired by Fidelity Bank of Dallas in 1995, which, at that time, was led by Mr. Murphy. Mr. Holland then assumed the primary lending and business development role at Fidelity Bank of Dallas until it was acquired by Compass Bank in 1998. In 2000, Mr. Holland became President of First Mercantile Bank, where, through a combination of an acquisition and organic growth, the bank grew from $125.0 million to $325.0 million in total assets over a two-year period. When Colonial Bank acquired First Mercantile Bank in 2002, Mr. Holland assumed the role of Chief Executive Officer for the Texas Region of Colonial Bank, overseeing the management and organic growth of the region from $625.0 million in assets in 2002 to over $1.6 billion in assets in 2009.

      Mr. Murphy began his banking career in 1971 and has been Chairman or Chief Executive Officer of several community banks in the Dallas metropolitan area, including Parkway National Bank, Mercantile Bank & Trust and Fidelity Bank of Dallas, and was instrumental in the growth and leadership of these institutions. Mr. Murphy has led financial institutions in over 25 transactions involving the acquisition, formation or sale of banks, bank holding companies or individual branches.

      In addition to Messrs. Holland and Murphy, we believe we have significant depth in management throughout each function of our organization, including lending, credit administration, treasury services, finance, operations, information technology, regulatory compliance and risk management. Our bankers also have significant experience, with nine of our market presidents and relationship managers having more than 20 years of banking experience in the Dallas metropolitan area. Our team has a demonstrated track record of achieving profitable growth, successfully executing acquisitions, maintaining a strong credit culture, and implementing a community-focused, relationship-driven approach to banking. The depth of our team's market knowledge and long-term relationships in the Dallas metropolitan area are the keys to our strong successful referral business.

    Strong Brand and Reputation in Our Market.  The name "Veritex" is derived from a combination of the Latin root word "veritas," meaning truth, and "Texas," and we strive to provide truth in Texas banking every day. We have developed a reputation as an active lender in our community. The members of our management team have spent the majority of their careers as bankers in the Dallas metropolitan area. We believe that our strong brand and market reputation have become and will remain a competitive advantage within our market. By capitalizing on the business and personal relationships of our senior management team, market presidents and relationship managers, we believe that we are positioned for continued growth and increased profitability.

    Loyal and Growing Core Deposit Franchise.  Developing significant deposit relationships with our borrowers is a key component of our growth strategy. Our core deposits, which include all demand deposits, money market and savings accounts and time deposits under $250,000, but exclude all brokered deposits, represented approximately 90.7% of our deposits as of June 30, 2014, 93.5% of our deposits as of December 31, 2013 and 95.0% of our deposits as of December 31, 2012. Our customers maintain significant noninterest-bearing deposits with us, which contributes to our lower cost of funds. Noninterest-bearing deposits represented 38.7%, 38.2% and 38.1% of our total deposits as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively. Our cost of funds was 48 basis points for the first six months of 2014, 44 basis points for 2013, and 56 basis points for 2012. Our strong, low-cost deposit base

 

4


Table of Contents

      serves as a major driver of our operating results, as we utilize our core deposit base primarily to fund our loan growth. Our total deposits grew by 28.1% in 2013 and 22.8% in 2012, while our noninterest-bearing deposits grew by 28.4% in 2013 and 51.3% in 2012. Total deposits grew by 13.0% and non-interest bearing deposits grew by 15.7% during the first six months of 2014 on an annualized basis. We believe that our ability to grow strong core deposits is a unique and valuable competitive advantage.

    Proven Ability and Demonstrated Success in Acquisitions and Integration.  We have completed three whole-bank acquisitions since the beginning of 2010 and only two other Texas-based banking institutions have completed more acquisitions in Texas during that period, according to SNL Financial. As a result, we believe we have developed an experienced and disciplined acquisition and integration approach capable of identifying candidates, conducting thorough due diligence, determining financial attractiveness, and integrating the acquired institution. Utilizing the prior experience of our management team at larger financial institutions, we believe that we have built a corporate infrastructure capable of supporting additional acquisitions and continued organic growth. We believe our acquisition experience and our reputation as a successful acquirer position us to capitalize on additional opportunities in the future.

    Strong Credit Culture.  Our disciplined implementation of comprehensive policies and procedures for credit underwriting and administration has enabled us to maintain strong asset quality during our growth. We manage the risk in the portfolio with prudent underwriting and proactive credit administration. Mr. Murphy, our Vice Chairman, who leads the Bank directors' loan committee, has more than 40 years of banking experience. Our nonperforming assets to total assets ratio was 0.42% as of June 30, 2014, 0.44% as of December 31, 2013 and 0.71% as of December 31, 2012, while our net charge-offs to average loans outstanding was 0.04% during the first six months of 2014, 0.02% during 2013 and 0.21% during 2012. As much of the growth in our loan portfolio is attributed to new loans with which we have limited experience and payment history, a portion of our loan portfolio is considered to be relatively unseasoned.

    Scalable Platform.  Throughout our operating history, we have built and maintained a strong and scalable banking platform to support our dynamic growth. Utilizing the significant prior experience of our management team and employees, we believe that we have built a scalable corporate infrastructure, including technology and banking processes, capable of supporting future organic growth and acquisitions while improving our operational efficiencies. We believe that our strong capital and asset quality position will allow us to grow and our scalable operating platform will allow us to manage that growth effectively, resulting in greater efficiency and improved profitability. This increased efficiency has been demonstrated by the improvement in our efficiency ratio from 92.2% in 2011 to 69.8% in 2013.

Our Market Area

        We currently operate in the Dallas metropolitan area, which is part of the broader Dallas-Fort Worth-Arlington metropolitan statistical area, which we refer to as the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area. The Dallas economy is fueled by the real estate, technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing, health care and energy sectors. This market is among the most vibrant in the United States with a rapidly growing population, a high level of job growth, an affordable cost of living and a pro-growth business climate. More broadly, Texas is also experiencing significant population and employment growth on a statewide basis.

    A Leading Population Growth Center.  The Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area is the fourth largest metropolitan area in the nation by population, behind only New York City, Los Angeles and Chicago, based on data from the United States Census Bureau. Population in this area is projected to grow by 7.2% from 2014 to 2019, compared to 3.5% for the nation as a whole,

 

5


Table of Contents

      according to SNL Financial. Texas is the second most populous state in the United States and its population is projected to grow by 7.6% from 2014 to 2019, according to SNL Financial.

    Robust Employment Growth.  The Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area had the highest percentage of employment growth of the 12 most populous metropolitan areas in the United States during the 12 months ended April 30, 2014, according to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics. The area's unemployment rate was 5.0% in May 2014, according to the U.S. Bureau of Labor Statistics. Texas led the nation in job growth for the period from 2000 to 2013, according to the Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas.

    Fortune 500 Companies.  The Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area serves as the corporate headquarters for numerous Fortune 500 companies across many varied industries, including ExxonMobil, AT&T, American Airlines, Fluor, Kimberly-Clark, HollyFrontier, Southwest Airlines, Texas Instruments, Neiman-Marcus, Tenent Healthcare, JCPenney, Dean Foods, GameStop, Energy Transfer Equity, Commercial Metals, Celanese, D.R. Horton, Dr Pepper Snapple Group and Energy Future Holdings. Other major companies have recently announced significant relocations or expansions in the area, such as Toyota, which announced the relocation of its North American headquarters, and State Farm, which announced a major expansion of its regional hub. On a statewide basis, Texas is home to the corporate headquarters of 52 Fortune 500 companies.

    Numerous Small and Medium-Sized Businesses.  Our primary customers are small and medium-sized businesses and professionals. Small and medium-size businesses are a vital part of the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area. With more than 140,000 businesses that employ less than 100 people, representing approximately 97.0% of total businesses, the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area ranks fifth in the United States in number of businesses employing less than 100 people, according to United States Census Bureau data for 2012 released in May 2014.

    World Class Hospitals and Universities.  The Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area contains several world-class hospitals and medical research facilities, major universities, and professional sports franchises.

Our Corporate Information

        Our principal executive offices are located at 8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 400, Dallas, Texas 75225, and our telephone number is (972) 349-6200. Our website is www.veritexbank.com. The information contained on or accessible from our website does not constitute a part of this prospectus and is not incorporated by reference herein.

 

6


Table of Contents

 


The Offering

Common stock we are offering

                 shares (               shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full).

Common stock to be outstanding after this offering

 

               shares (               shares if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full).

Use of proceeds

 

We estimate that our net proceeds from the sale of the shares of common stock by us will be approximately $           million, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, based on an assumed initial public offering price of $              per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full, the net proceeds to us will be approximately $               million. We intend to use the net proceeds to us from this offering to support our continued growth, including organic growth and potential future acquisitions, and for general corporate purposes. See "Use of Proceeds."

Dividend policy

 

We have not declared or paid any dividends on our common stock. We currently intend to retain all of our future earnings, if any, for use in our business and do not anticipate paying any cash dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. See "Dividend Policy."

Directed share program

 

At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to           shares of our common stock offered by this prospectus, for sale, at the initial public offering price, to our directors, executive officers and employees who have expressed an interest in purchasing our common stock in this offering. The number of shares available for sale to the general public in the offering will be reduced to the extent these persons purchase the reserved shares. Any reserved shares not so purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same terms as the other shares.

Registration and Board Rights

 

Prior to the completion of this offering, we will enter into a registration rights agreement with SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P., or SunTx, and WCM Parkway, Ltd., two of our largest shareholders, pursuant to which such shareholders will have the ability to cause us to register the resale of their shares. Such shareholders have agreed with the underwriters not to exercise such rights for a period of at least 180 days from the date of this prospectus. SunTx also has the right to nominate one representative to serve on our board of directors for so long as they hold at least 4.9% of our common stock. See "Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Registration Rights Agreement" and "—Agreements with SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P."

 

7


Table of Contents

Management and Principal Shareholders

 

As of August 29, 2014, our executive officers and directors, together with SunTx, beneficially owned 42.0% of our common stock. Following the completion of this offering, we anticipate that our executive officers and directors, together with SunTx, will beneficially own approximately      % of our common stock (or      % if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full). See "Principal Shareholders".

Stock exchange symbol

 

We intend to apply to have our common stock listed on the NASDAQ Global Market under the symbol "VBTX."

Risk factors

 

Investing in our common stock involves risks. See "Risk Factors" beginning on page 13 for a discussion of factors you should carefully consider before deciding to invest in our common stock.


Except as otherwise indicated, all of the information in this prospectus:

    assumes no exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase up to            additional shares of common stock from us;

    excludes 357,500 shares of common stock issuable upon the exercise of outstanding time-based options at a weighted average exercise price of $10.15 per share (181,200 shares of which were exercisable), as of June 30, 2014;

    excludes 472,500 shares of common stock issuable upon the exercise of performance-based options at a weighted average exercise price of $10.15 per share (none of which were exercisable), as of June 30, 2014, which we intend to cancel prior to the completion of this offering as described in "Executive Compensation—2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan";

    excludes restricted stock units that we intend to grant prior to the completion of this offering in connection with the cancelation of our performance-based options, as described in "Executive Compensation—2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan";

    excludes 63,250 shares of common stock underlying outstanding restricted stock units that were not fully vested as of June 30, 2014;

    excludes 25,000 shares of our common stock issuable upon exercise of warrants at an exercise price of $11.00 per share as of June 30;

    does not attribute to any director, executive officer or principal shareholder any purchase of shares of our common stock in the offering, including through the directed share program described in "Underwriting—Directed Share Program;" and

    assumes an initial offering price of $      per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

 

8


Table of Contents


SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

        The following selected historical consolidated financial data as of and for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements appearing elsewhere in this prospectus, and the selected historical consolidated financial data as of and for the year ended December 31, 2010 have been derived from our audited consolidated financial statements not appearing in this prospectus.

        The selected historical consolidated financial data for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 and the selected historical consolidated financial data as of June 30, 2014 have been derived from our unaudited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this prospectus.

        You should read the selected historical consolidated financial data set forth below in conjunction with the sections entitled "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of
June 30,
2014
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Selected Period-end Balance Sheet Data:

                               

Total assets

  $ 710,382   $ 664,971   $ 524,127   $ 437,820   $ 197,949  

Cash and cash equivalents

    66,550     76,646     53,160     62,790     11,446  

Securities available for sale

    50,547     45,604     29,538     42,688     69,502  

Total loans(1)

    540,990     495,270     397,736     298,017     100,922  

Allowance for loan losses

    5,516     5,018     3,238     1,012     166  

Goodwill

    19,148     19,148     19,148     19,148     10,409  

Intangibles

    1,413     1,567     1,875     2,183     838  

Noninterest-bearing deposits

    236,198     218,990     170,497     112,698     37,919  

Interest-bearing deposits

    374,976     354,948     277,405     252,060     116,523  

Total deposits

    611,174     573,938     447,902     364,758     154,442  

Advances from FHLB

    15,000     15,000     10,000     10,000     10,000  

Other borrowings

    8,073     8,072     3,093     3,093      

Total stockholders' equity

    74,244     66,239     61,860     58,676     33,019  

 

9


Table of Contents

 

 
  As of and for the
Six Months Ended
June 30,
  As of and for the
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
  2014   2013   2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)
 

Selected Income Statement Data:

                                     

Net interest income

  $ 11,806   $ 10,043   $ 21,041   $ 19,093   $ 12,567   $ 2,000  

Provision for loan losses

    677     1,008     1,883     2,953     960     166  
                           

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    11,129     9,035     19,158     16,140     11,607     1,834  

Noninterest income

    1,211     1,306     2,391     1,647     1,277     195  

Noninterest expense

    8,994     8,108     16,364     16,172     12,762     3,708  
                           

Income (loss) before income tax

    3,346     2,233     5,185     1,615     122     (1,679 )

Income tax expense

    1,190     774     1,777     136     13      
                           

Net income (loss)

    2,156     1,459     3,408     1,479     109     (1,679 )

Preferred dividends

    40     40     60     100     76      
                           

Net income (loss) available to common stockholders

  $ 2,116   $ 1,419   $ 3,348   $ 1,379   $ 33   $ (1,679 )
                           
                           

Per Share Data:

                                     

Earnings (loss) per common share, basic

  $ 0.34   $ 0.25   $ 0.58   $ 0.24   $ 0.01   $ (1.68 )

Earnings (loss) per common share, diluted

    0.33     0.24     0.57     0.24     0.01     (1.68 )

Book value per common share(2)

    10.42     9.69     10.03     9.46     9.12     9.29  

Tangible book value per common share(3)

    7.18     6.09     6.46     5.77     5.28     6.13  

Weighted average common shares outstanding, basic

    6,231,031     5,771,841     5,787,810     5,640,801     5,041,454     998,477  

Weighted average common shares outstanding, diluted

    6,359,031     5,835,841     5,848,810     5,677,801     5,068,454     998,477  

 

 
   
  As of and for the
Years Ended December 31,
 
 
  As of and for the
Six Months Ended
June 30, 2014
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010(4)  

Summary Performance Ratios:

                               

Return on average assets(5)

    0.65 %   0.58 %   0.31 %   0.03 %   n/m  

Return on average equity(5)

    5.96     5.27     2.47     0.23     n/m  

Net interest margin(6)

    3.86     3.96     4.50     4.12     n/m  

Efficiency ratio(7)

    69.09     69.84     77.97     92.18     168.93  

Loans to deposits ratio

    88.52     86.29     88.80     81.70     65.35  

Noninterest expense to average assets(5)

    2.70     2.80     3.42     3.67     n/m  

Summary Credit Quality Ratios:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Nonperforming assets to total assets

    0.42 %   0.44 %   0.71 %   0.20 %   0.35  

Nonperforming loans to total loans

    0.09     0.23     0.33     0.05     0.36  

Allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans

    1,109.86     445.65     248.31     661.44     0.46  

Allowance for loan losses to total loans

    1.02     1.01     0.81     0.34     0.16  

Net charge-offs to average loans outstanding

    0.04     0.02     0.21     0.05     n/m  

 

10


Table of Contents

 

 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of
June 30,
2014
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010(4)  

Capital Ratios:

                               

Total stockholders' equity to total assets

    10.45 %   9.96 %   11.80 %   13.40 %   16.68 %

Tangible common equity to tangible assets(8)

    6.70     5.90     6.63     7.18     12.06  

Tier 1 capital to average assets(5)

    8.66     8.06     8.81     9.80     8.30  

Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets

    10.44     9.75     11.34     14.00     13.30  

Total capital to risk-weighted assets

    12.35     11.74     12.17     13.70     13.40  

(1)
Total loans does not include loans held for sale of $6.3 million as of June 30, 2014, $2.1 million as of December 31, 2013 and $2.8 million as of December 31, 2012. There were no loans held for sale as of December 31, 2011 or 2010.

(2)
We calculate book value per common share as stockholders' equity less preferred stock at the end of the relevant period divided by the outstanding number of shares of our common stock at the end of the relevant period.

(3)
We calculate tangible book value per common share as total stockholders' equity less preferred stock, goodwill, core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization at the end of the relevant period, divided by the outstanding number of shares of our common stock at the end of the relevant period. Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP financial measure, and, as we calculate tangible book value per common share, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure is total stockholders' equity per common share. See our reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures under the caption "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measures."

(4)
We commenced banking operations in 2010. Accordingly, certain ratios are not meaningful.

(5)
Except as otherwise indicated in this footnote, we calculate our average assets and average equity for a period by dividing the sum of our total assets or total stockholders' equity, as the case may be, as of the close of business on each day in the relevant period, by the number of days in the period. We have calculated our return on average assets and return on average equity for a period by dividing net income for that period by our average assets and average equity, as the case may be, for that period. As a result of system conversions and integrations associated with acquisitions, we are unable to calculate daily average balances for 2010, 2011 or 2012. For these periods, return on average assets and return on average equity are calculated using period-end balances divided by the number of months in the period.

(6)
Net interest margin represents net interest income, annualized on a fully tax equivalent basis, divided by average interest-earning assets.

(7)
Efficiency ratio represents noninterest expense divided by the sum of net interest income and noninterest income.

(8)
We calculate tangible common equity as total stockholders' equity less preferred stock, goodwill, core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization, and we calculate tangible assets as total assets less preferred stock, goodwill and core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization. Tangible common equity to tangible assets is a non-GAAP financial measure, and, as we calculate tangible common equity to tangible assets, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure is total stockholders' equity to total assets. See our reconciliation of non-GAAP financial measures to their most directly comparable GAAP financial measures under the caption "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measures."

 

11


Table of Contents


RISK FACTORS

        Investing in our common stock involves a high degree of risk. Before you decide to invest in our common stock, you should carefully consider the risks described below, together with all other information included in this prospectus, including our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. We believe the risks described below are the risks that are material to us as of the date of this prospectus. If any of the following risks actually occur, our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects could be materially and adversely affected. In that case, you could experience a partial or complete loss of your investment.

Risks Related to Our Business

Our business concentration in the Dallas metropolitan area imposes risks and may magnify the consequences of any regional or local economic downturn affecting the Dallas metropolitan area, including any downturn in the real estate sector.

        We conduct our operations exclusively in the Dallas metropolitan area. As of June 30, 2014, the substantial majority of the loans in our loan portfolio were made to borrowers who live and/or conduct business in the Dallas metropolitan area and the substantial majority of our secured loans were secured by collateral located in the Dallas metropolitan area. Accordingly, we are significantly exposed to risks associated with a lack of geographic diversification. The economic conditions in the Dallas metropolitan area are highly dependent on the real estate sector as well as the technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing and energy sectors. Any downturn or adverse development in these sectors, particularly the real estate sector, or a decline in the value of single family homes in the Dallas metropolitan area could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations, and future prospects. Any adverse economic developments, among other things, could negatively affect the volume of loan originations, increase the level of nonperforming assets, increase the rate of foreclosure losses on loans and reduce the value of our loans. Any regional or local economic downturn that affects the Dallas metropolitan area or Texas, our existing or prospective borrowers or property values in our market area may affect us and our profitability more significantly and more adversely than our competitors whose operations are less geographically focused.

We may not be able to implement aspects of our growth strategy, which may affect our ability to maintain our historical earnings trends.

        Our business has grown rapidly. Financial institutions that grow rapidly can experience significant difficulties as a result of rapid growth. Furthermore, our strategy focuses on organic growth, supplemented by acquisitions. We may not be able to execute on aspects of our growth strategy to sustain our historical rate of growth or may not be able to grow at all. More specifically, we may not be able to generate sufficient new loans and deposits within acceptable risk and expense tolerances, obtain the personnel or funding necessary for additional growth or find suitable acquisition candidates. Various factors, such as economic conditions and competition, may impede or prohibit the growth of our operations, the opening of new branches and the consummation of acquisitions. Further, we may be unable to attract and retain experienced bankers, which could adversely affect our growth. The success of our strategy also depends on our ability to effectively manage growth, which is dependent upon a number of factors, including our ability to adapt our existing credit, operational, technology and governance infrastructure to accommodate expanded operations. If we fail to build infrastructure sufficient to support rapid growth or fail to implement one or more aspects of our strategy, we may be unable to maintain our historical earnings trends, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

12


Table of Contents

Our strategy of pursuing acquisitions exposes us to financial, execution and operational risks that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.

        We intend to continue pursuing a strategy that includes acquisitions. An acquisition strategy involves significant risks, including the following:

        The market for acquisition targets is highly competitive, which may adversely affect our ability to find acquisition candidates that fit our strategy and standards. We face significant competition in pursuing acquisition targets from other banks and financial institutions, many of which possess greater financial, human, technical and other resources than we do. Our ability to compete in acquiring target institutions will depend on our available financial resources to fund the acquisitions, including the amount of cash and cash equivalents we have and the liquidity and market price of our common stock. In addition, increased competition may also drive up the acquisition consideration that we will be required to pay in order to successfully capitalize on attractive acquisition opportunities. To the extent that we are unable to find suitable acquisition targets, an important component of our growth strategy may not be realized.

        Acquisitions of financial institutions also involve operational risks and uncertainties, such as unknown or contingent liabilities with no available manner of recourse, exposure to unexpected problems such as asset quality, the retention of key employees and customers, and other issues that could negatively affect our business. We may not be able to complete future acquisitions or, if completed, we may not be able to successfully integrate the operations, technology platforms, management, products and services of the entities that we acquire or to realize our attempts to eliminate redundancies. The integration process may also require significant time and attention from our management that would otherwise be directed toward servicing existing business and developing new business. Failure to successfully integrate the entities we acquire into our existing operations in a timely manner may increase our operating costs significantly and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. Further, acquisitions typically involve the payment of a premium over book and market values and, therefore, some dilution of our tangible book value and net income per common share may occur in connection with any future acquisition, and the carrying amount of any goodwill that we currently maintain or may acquire may be subject to impairment in future periods.

Our ability to retain bankers and recruit additional successful bankers is critical to the success of our business strategy, and any failure to do so could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects.

        Our ability to retain and grow our loans, deposits and fee income depends upon the business generation capabilities, reputation and relationship management skills of our bankers. If we were to lose the services of any of our bankers, including successful bankers employed by banks that we may acquire, to a new or existing competitor or otherwise, we may not be able to retain valuable

13


Table of Contents

relationships and some of our customers could choose to use the services of a competitor instead of our services.

        Our growth strategy also relies on our ability to attract and retain additional profitable bankers. We may face difficulties in recruiting and retaining bankers of our desired caliber, including as a result of competition from other financial institutions. In particular, many of our competitors are significantly larger with greater financial resources, and may be able to offer more attractive compensation packages and broader career opportunities. Additionally, we may incur significant expenses and expend significant time and resources on training, integration and business development before we are able to determine whether a new banker will be profitable or effective. If we are unable to attract and retain successful bankers, or if our bankers fail to meet our expectations in terms of customer relationships and profitability, we may be unable to execute our business strategy and our business, financial condition, results of operations and growth prospects may be adversely affected.

Loss of our executive officers or other key employees could impair our relationships with our customers and adversely affect our business.

        Our success is dependent upon the continued service and skills of our executive management team. Our goals, strategies and marketing efforts are closely tied to the banking philosophy and strengths of our executive management, including our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, C. Malcolm Holland, III, and our Vice Chairman, William C. Murphy. Our success is also dependent in part on the continued service of our market presidents and relationship managers. The loss of services of any of these key personnel could adversely affect our business because of their skills, years of industry experience, relationships with customers and the difficulty of promptly finding qualified replacement personnel. We cannot guarantee that these executive officers or key employees will continue to be employed with us in the future.

We have limited operating history and, accordingly, investors will have little basis on which to evaluate our ability to achieve our business objectives.

        We were formed as a bank holding company in 2009 and commenced banking operations in 2010. Accordingly, we have a limited operating history upon which to evaluate our business and future prospects. As a result, it is difficult, if not impossible, to predict future operating results and to assess the likelihood of the success of our business. As a relatively young financial institution, the Bank is also subject to risks and levels of risk that are often greater than those encountered by financial institutions with longer established operations and relationships. New financial institutions often require significant capital from sources other than operations. Since we are a relatively young financial institution, our management team and employees will shoulder the burdens of the business operations and a workload associated with business growth and capitalization that is disproportionately greater than a more mature, established financial institution

The relatively unseasoned nature of a significant portion of our loan portfolio may expose us to increased credit risks.

        The business of lending is inherently risky, including risks that the principal of or interest on any loan will not be repaid timely or at all or that the value of any collateral supporting the loan will be insufficient to cover our outstanding exposure. Our loan portfolio has grown to $541.0 million as of June 30, 2014, from $100.9 million as of December 31, 2010. A portion of this growth is related to a combination of organic growth and loans acquired in connection with our acquisitions. The organic portion of this increase is due to our increased loan production in a strong market. It is difficult to assess the future performance of acquired or recently originated loans because our relatively limited experience with such loans does not provide us with a significant payment history from which to judge future collectability. These loans may experience higher delinquency or charge-off levels than our

14


Table of Contents

historical loan portfolio experience, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Difficult market conditions and economic trends have adversely affected the banking industry and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        We are operating in a challenging and uncertain economic environment, including generally uncertain conditions nationally and locally in our industry and market. Although economic conditions have improved in recent years, financial institutions continue to be affected by volatility in the real estate market in some parts of the country and uncertain regulatory and interest rate conditions. We retain direct exposure to the residential and commercial real estate market in Texas, particularly in the Dallas metropolitan area, and are affected by these events.

        Our ability to assess the creditworthiness of customers and to estimate the losses inherent in our loan portfolio is made more complex by uncertain market and economic conditions. Our risk management practices, such as monitoring the concentration of our loans within specific industries and our credit approval practices, may not adequately reduce credit risk, and our credit administration personnel, policies and procedures may not adequately adapt to changes in economic or any other conditions affecting customers and the quality of the loan portfolio. Another national economic recession or deterioration of conditions in our market could drive losses beyond that which is provided for in our allowance for loan losses and result in the following consequences:

        While economic conditions in Texas and the U.S. continue to show signs of recovery, there can be no assurance that these conditions will continue to improve. Although real estate markets have stabilized in portions of the U.S., a resumption of declines in real estate values, volume of home sales and financial stress on borrowers as a result of the uncertain economic environment, including job losses, could have an adverse effect on our borrowers and/or their customers, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The small to medium-sized businesses that we lend to may have fewer resources to weather adverse business developments, which may impair a borrower's ability to repay a loan, and such impairment could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.

        We focus our business development and marketing strategy primarily on small to medium-sized businesses. Small to medium-sized businesses frequently have smaller market shares than their competition, may be more vulnerable to economic downturns, often need substantial additional capital to expand or compete and may experience substantial volatility in operating results, any of which may impair a borrower's ability to repay a loan. In addition, the success of a small and medium-sized business often depends on the management skills, talents and efforts of one or two people or a small group of people, and the death, disability or resignation of one or more of these people could have a material adverse impact on the business and its ability to repay its loan. If general economic conditions negatively impact the Dallas metropolitan area or Texas and small to medium-sized businesses are adversely affected or our borrowers are otherwise affected by adverse business developments, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

15


Table of Contents

Our allowance for loan losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb potential losses in our loan portfolio, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        We establish our allowance for loan losses and maintain it at a level considered adequate by management to absorb probable loan losses based on our analysis of our loan portfolio and market environment. The allowance for loan losses represents our estimate of probable losses in the portfolio at each balance sheet date and is based upon relevant information available to us. Our allowance for loan losses consists of a general component based upon probable but unidentified losses inherent in the portfolio and a specific component based on individual loans that are considered impaired. The general component is based on various factors including our historical loss experience, historical loss experience for peer banks, growth trends, loan concentrations, migration trends between internal loan risk ratings, current economic conditions and other qualitative factors. The specific component of the allowance for loan losses is calculated based on a review of individual loans considered impaired. The analysis of impaired losses may be based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the effective loan rate, an observable market price or the fair value of the underlying collateral on collateral dependent loans. In determining the collectability of certain loans, management also considers the fair value of any underlying collateral. The amount ultimately realized may differ from the carrying value of these assets because of economic, operating or other conditions beyond our control, and any such differences may be material.

        As of June 30, 2014, our allowance for loan losses was 1.02% of our total loans. Loans acquired are initially recorded at fair value, which includes an estimate of credit losses expected to be realized over the remaining lives of the loans, and therefore no corresponding allowance for loan losses is recorded for these loans at acquisition. Additional loan losses will likely occur in the future and may occur at a rate greater than we have previously experienced. We may be required to take additional provisions for loan losses in the future to further supplement the allowance for loan losses, either due to management's decision to do so or requirements by our banking regulators. In addition, bank regulatory agencies will periodically review our allowance for loan losses and the value attributed to non-accrual loans or to real estate acquired through foreclosure. Such regulatory agencies may require us to recognize future charge-offs. These adjustments could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

A large portion of our loan portfolio is comprised of commercial loans secured by receivables, promissory notes, inventory, equipment or other commercial collateral, the deterioration in value of which could increase the potential for future losses.

        As of June 30, 2014, $174.1 million, or 32.2% of our total loans, was comprised of commercial loans to businesses. In general, these loans are collateralized by general business assets including, among other things, accounts receivable, promissory notes, inventory and equipment and most are backed by a personal guaranty of the borrower or principal. These commercial loans are typically larger in amount than loans to individuals and, therefore, have the potential for larger losses on a single loan basis. Additionally, the repayment of commercial loans is subject to the ongoing business operations of the borrower. The collateral securing such loans generally includes moveable property such as equipment and inventory, which may decline in value more rapidly than we anticipate exposing us to increased credit risk. A significant portion of our commercial loans are secured by promissory notes that evidence loans made by us to borrowers that in turn make loans to others that are secured by real estate. Accordingly, negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity could impair the value of the collateral securing these loans. Significant adverse changes in the economy or local market conditions in which our commercial lending customers operate could cause rapid declines in loan collectability and the values associated with general business assets resulting in inadequate collateral coverage that may expose us to credit losses and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

16


Table of Contents

Our nonfarm nonresidential and construction and land loan portfolios expose us to credit risks that could be greater than the risks related to other types of loans.

        As of June 30, 2014, $180.9 million, or 33.5% of our total loans, was comprised of nonfarm nonresidential real estate loans (including owner occupied commercial real estate loans) and $56.8 million, or 10.5% of our total loans, was comprised of construction and land loans. These loans typically involve repayment dependent upon income generated, or expected to be generated, by the property securing the loan in amounts sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service. The availability of such income for repayment may be adversely affected by changes in the economy or local market conditions. These loans expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by other types of collateral because the collateral securing these loans is typically more difficult to liquidate due to the fluctuation of real estate values. Additionally, non-owner occupied commercial real estate loans generally involve relatively large balances to single borrowers or related groups of borrowers. Unexpected deterioration in the credit quality of our non-owner occupied commercial real estate loan portfolio could require us to increase our allowance for loan losses, which would reduce our profitability and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        Construction and land loans also involve risks attributable to the fact that loan funds are secured by a project under construction, and the project is of uncertain value prior to its completion. It can be difficult to accurately evaluate the total funds required to complete a project, and construction lending often involves the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the ultimate project rather than the ability of a borrower or guarantor to repay the loan. If we are forced to foreclose on a project prior to completion, we may be unable to recover the entire unpaid portion of the loan. In addition, we may be required to fund additional amounts to complete a project and may have to hold the property for an indeterminate period of time, any of which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Because a significant portion of our loan portfolio is comprised of real estate loans, negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity could impair the value of collateral securing our real estate loans and result in loan and other losses.

        As of June 30, 2014, $362.6 million, or 67.0% of our total loans, was comprised of loans with real estate as a primary or secondary component of collateral. As a result, adverse developments affecting real estate values in the Dallas metropolitan area or Texas generally could increase the credit risk associated with our real estate loan portfolio. Real estate values in many Texas markets have experienced periods of fluctuation over the last five years. The market value of real estate can fluctuate significantly in a short period of time. Adverse changes affecting real estate values and the liquidity of real estate in one or more of our markets could increase the credit risk associated with our loan portfolio, and could result in losses that adversely affect credit quality, financial condition, and results of operation. Negative changes in the economy affecting real estate values and liquidity in our market areas could significantly impair the value of property pledged as collateral on loans and affect our ability to sell the collateral upon foreclosure without a loss or additional losses. Collateral may have to be sold for less than the outstanding balance of the loan, which could result in losses on such loans. Such declines and losses could have a material adverse impact on our business, results of operations and growth prospects. If real estate values decline, it is also more likely that we would be required to increase our allowance for loan losses, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may be subject to additional credit risk with respect to loans that we make to other lenders.

        As a part of our commercial lending activities, we make loans to customers that, in turn, make commercial and residential real estate loans to other borrowers. As of June 30, 2014, $62.8 million, or

17


Table of Contents

36.1%, of our commercial loan portfolio was comprised of these types of loans. When we make a loan of this nature, we take as collateral the promissory notes issued by the end borrowers to our customer, which are themselves secured by the underlying real estate. Although the loans to our customers are subject to the risks inherent in commercial lending generally, we are also exposed to additional risks, including those related to commercial and residential real estate lending, as the ability of our customer to repay the loan from us can be affected by the risks associated with the value and liquidity of the real estate underlying our customer's loans to the end borrowers. Moreover, because we are not lending directly to the end borrower, and because our collateral is a promissory note rather than the underlying real estate, we may be subject to risks that are different from those we are exposed to when we make a loan directly that is secured by commercial or residential real estate. Because the ability of the end borrower to repay its loan from our customer could affect the ability of our customer to repay its loan from us, our inability to exercise control over the relationship with the end borrower and the collateral, except under limited circumstances, could expose us to credit losses that adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We have a concentration of loans outstanding to a limited number of borrowers, which may increase our risk of loss.

        We have extended significant amounts of credit to a limited number of borrowers, and as of June 30, 2014, the aggregate amount of loans to our 10 and 25 largest borrowers (including related entities) amounted to $73.7 million, or 13.6% of total loans, and $142.1 million, or 26.3% of total loans, respectively. As of such date, none of these loans were nonperforming loans. Concentration of a significant amount of credit extended to a limited number of borrowers increases the risk in our loan portfolio. In the event that one or more of these borrowers is not able to make payments of interest and principal in respect of such loans, the potential loss to us is more likely to have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

A lack of liquidity could impair our ability to fund operations and adversely affect our operations and jeopardize our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

        Liquidity is essential to our business. We rely on our ability to generate deposits and effectively manage the repayment and maturity schedules of our loans and investment securities, respectively, to ensure that we have adequate liquidity to fund our operations. An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of our investment securities, the sale of loans, and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity. Our most important source of funds is deposits. Deposit balances can decrease when customers perceive alternative investments as providing a better risk/return tradeoff. If customers move money out of bank deposits and into other investments such as money market funds, we would lose a relatively low-cost source of funds, increasing our funding costs and reducing our net interest income and net income.

        Other primary sources of funds consist of cash flows from operations, maturities and sales of investment securities, and proceeds from the issuance and sale of our equity and debt securities to investors. Additional liquidity is provided by the ability to borrow from the Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas, or the FHLB. We also may borrow funds from third-party lenders, such as other financial institutions. Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance or capitalize our activities, or on terms that are acceptable to us, could be impaired by factors that affect us directly or the financial services industry or economy in general, such as disruptions in the financial markets or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry. Our access to funding sources could also be affected by a decrease in the level of our business activity as a result of a downturn in the Dallas metropolitan area or by one or more adverse regulatory actions against us.

18


Table of Contents

        Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to originate loans, invest in securities, meet our expenses, or to fulfill obligations such as repaying our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity and could, in turn, adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We may need to raise additional capital in the future, and if we fail to maintain sufficient capital, whether due to losses, an inability to raise additional capital or otherwise, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, as well as our ability to maintain regulatory compliance, could be adversely affected.

        We face significant capital and other regulatory requirements as a financial institution. We may need to raise additional capital in the future to provide us with sufficient capital resources and liquidity to meet our commitments and business needs, which could include the possibility of financing acquisitions. In addition, we, on a consolidated basis, and the Bank, on a stand-alone basis, must meet certain regulatory capital requirements and maintain sufficient liquidity. Importantly, regulatory capital requirements could increase from current levels, which could require us to raise additional capital or reduce our operations. Our ability to raise additional capital depends on conditions in the capital markets, economic conditions and a number of other factors, including investor perceptions regarding the banking industry, market conditions and governmental activities, and on our financial condition and performance. Accordingly, we cannot assure you that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us. If we fail to maintain capital to meet regulatory requirements, our liquidity, business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

Interest rate shifts could reduce net interest income and otherwise negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.

        The majority of our banking assets are monetary in nature and subject to risk from changes in interest rates. Like most financial institutions, our earnings and cash flows depend to a great extent upon the level of our net interest income, or the difference between the interest income we earn on loans, investments and other interest-earning assets, and the interest we pay on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Changes in interest rates can increase or decrease our net interest income, because different types of assets and liabilities may react differently, and at different times, to market interest rate changes. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-earning assets in a period, an increase in interest rates could reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature or reprice more quickly, or to a greater degree than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates could reduce net interest income. As of June 30, 2014, 45.0% of our interest-earning assets and 62.3% of our interest-bearing liabilities are variable rate. Our interest sensitivity profile was asset sensitive as of June 30, 2014, meaning that we estimate our net interest income would increase more from rising interest rates than from falling interest rates.

        Additionally, an increase in interest rates may, among other things, reduce the demand for loans and our ability to originate loans and decrease loan repayment rates. A decrease in the general level of interest rates may affect us through, among other things, increased prepayments on our loan portfolio and increased competition for deposits. Accordingly, changes in the level of market interest rates affect our net yield on interest-earning assets, loan origination volume, loan portfolio and our overall results. Although our asset-liability management strategy is designed to control and mitigate exposure to the risks related to changes in market interest rates, those rates are affected by many factors outside of our control, including governmental monetary policies, inflation, deflation, recession, changes in unemployment, the money supply, international disorder and instability in domestic and foreign financial markets.

19


Table of Contents

We could recognize losses on investment securities held in our securities portfolio, particularly if interest rates increase or economic and market conditions deteriorate.

        While we attempt to invest a significant percentage of our assets in loans (our loan to deposit ratio was 88.5% as of June 30, 2014), we invest a percentage of our total assets (7.1% as of June 30, 2014) in investment securities with the primary objectives of providing a source of liquidity, providing an appropriate return on funds invested, managing interest rate risk, meeting pledging requirements and meeting regulatory capital requirements. As of June 30, 2014, the fair value of our securities portfolio was $50.5 million, which included a net unrealized gain of $294,731. Factors beyond our control can significantly influence the fair value of securities in our portfolio and can cause potential adverse changes to the fair value of these securities. For example, fixed-rate securities are generally subject to decreases in market value when interest rates rise. Additional factors include, but are not limited to, rating agency downgrades of the securities, defaults by the issuer or individual borrowers with respect to the underlying securities, and continued instability in the credit markets. Any of the foregoing factors could cause other-than-temporary impairment in future periods and result in realized losses. The process for determining whether impairment is other-than-temporary usually requires difficult, subjective judgments about the future financial performance of the issuer and any collateral underlying the security in order to assess the probability of receiving all contractual principal and interest payments on the security. Because of changing economic and market conditions affecting interest rates, the financial condition of issuers of the securities and the performance of the underlying collateral, we may recognize realized and/or unrealized losses in future periods, which could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

        We conduct our operations almost exclusively in Texas and particularly in the Dallas metropolitan area. Many of our competitors offer the same, or a wider variety of, banking services within our market area. These competitors include banks with nationwide operations, regional banks and other community banks. We also face competition from many other types of financial institutions, including savings banks, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, insurance companies, brokerage and investment banking firms, asset-based non-bank lenders and certain other non-financial entities, such as retail stores which may maintain their own credit programs and certain governmental organizations which may offer more favorable financing or deposit terms than we can. In addition, a number of out-of-state financial intermediaries have opened production offices, or otherwise solicit deposits, in our market area. Increased competition in our market may result in reduced loans and deposits, as well as reduced net interest margin, fee income and profitability. Ultimately, we may not be able to compete successfully against current and future competitors. If we are unable to attract and retain banking customers, we may be unable to continue to grow our loan and deposit portfolios, and our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

        Our ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including, among other things:

20


Table of Contents

        Failure to perform in any of these areas could significantly weaken our competitive position, which could adversely affect our growth and profitability, which, in turn, could adversely affect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Negative public opinion regarding our company or failure to maintain our reputation in the community we serve could adversely affect our business and prevent us from growing our business.

        As a community bank, our reputation within the community we serve is critical to our success. We have set ourselves apart from our competitors by building strong personal and professional relationships with our customers and being active members of the communities we serve. As such, we strive to enhance our reputation by recruiting, hiring and retaining employees who share our core values of being an integral part of the communities we serve and delivering superior service to our customers. If our reputation is negatively affected by the actions of our employees or otherwise, we may be less successful in attracting new customers, and our business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects could be materially and adversely affected. Further, negative public opinion can expose us to litigation and regulatory action as we seek to implement our growth strategy.

The dividend rate on our Series C preferred stock will increase in the future if not redeemed, which would reduce net income available to our common shareholders.

        We have issued $8.0 million in Series C preferred stock to the U.S. Treasury in connection with our participation in the SBLF program. The annual dividend rate is currently 1.0%. The dividend rate increases to 9.0% per annum in February 2016. If we do not redeem our Series C preferred stock on or before such date, the increase in the dividend rate on our Series C preferred stock will reduce net income available to our common shareholders.

If we fail to maintain an effective system of disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results or prevent fraud.

        Ensuring that we have adequate disclosure controls and procedures, including internal control over financial reporting, in place so that we can produce accurate financial statements on a timely basis is costly and time-consuming and needs to be reevaluated frequently. We are in the process of documenting, reviewing and, if appropriate, improving our internal controls and procedures in anticipation of being a public company and being subject to the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, or the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, which will require annual management assessments of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting and, when we cease to be an emerging growth company under the JOBS Act, a report by our independent auditors addressing these assessments. Our management may conclude that our internal control over financial reporting are not effective due to our failure to cure any identified material weakness or otherwise. Moreover, even if our management concludes that our internal control over financial reporting are effective, our independent registered public accounting firm may not conclude that our internal control over financial reporting are effective. In the future, our independent registered public accounting firm may not be satisfied with our internal control over financial reporting or the level at which our controls are documented, designed, operated or reviewed, or it may interpret the relevant requirements differently from us. In addition, during the course of the evaluation, documentation and testing of our internal control over financial reporting, we may identify deficiencies that we may not be able to remediate in time to meet the deadline imposed by the Securities and Exchange Commission, or the SEC, for compliance with the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Any such deficiencies may also subject us to adverse regulatory consequences. If we fail to achieve and maintain the adequacy of our internal control over financial reporting, as these standards are modified, supplemented or amended from time to time, we may be unable to report our financial information on a timely basis, we

21


Table of Contents

may not be able to conclude on an ongoing basis that we have effective internal control over financial reporting in accordance with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, and we may suffer adverse regulatory consequences or violations of listing standards. There could also be a negative reaction in the financial markets due to a loss of investor confidence in the reliability of our financial statements.

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer or employee fraud and data processing system failures and errors.

        Employee errors and employee or customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation. Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information. It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases. Employee errors could also subject us to financial claims for negligence.

        We maintain a system of internal controls to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud, as well as insurance coverage designed to protect us from material losses associated with these risks including losses resulting from any associated business interruption. If our internal controls fail to prevent or detect an occurrence, or if any resulting loss is not insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits, it could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        In addition, we rely heavily upon information supplied by third parties, including the information contained in credit applications, property appraisals, title information, equipment pricing and valuation and employment and income documentation, in deciding which loans we will originate, as well as the terms of those loans. If any of the information upon which we rely is misrepresented, either fraudulently or inadvertently, and the misrepresentation is not detected prior to loan funding, the value of the loan may be significantly lower than expected, or we may fund a loan that we would not have funded or on terms we would not have extended. Whether a misrepresentation is made by the applicant or another third party, we generally bear the risk of loss associated with the misrepresentation. A loan subject to a material misrepresentation is typically unsellable or subject to repurchase if it is sold prior to detection of the misrepresentation. The sources of the misrepresentations are often difficult to locate, and it is often difficult to recover any of the resulting monetary losses we may suffer.

We have a continuing need for technological change, and we may not have the resources to effectively implement new technology, or we may experience operational challenges when implementing new technology.

        The financial services industry is undergoing rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services. In addition to better serving customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and enables financial institutions to reduce costs. Our future success will depend, at least in part, upon our ability to address the needs of our customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands for convenience as well as to create additional efficiencies in our operations as we continue to grow and expand our products and service offerings. We may experience operational challenges as we implement these new technology enhancements or products, which could result in us not fully realizing the anticipated benefits from such new technology or require us to incur significant costs to remedy any such challenges in a timely manner.

        Many of our larger competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements. As a result, they may be able to offer additional or superior products compared to those that we will be able to provide, which would put us at a competitive disadvantage. Accordingly, we may

22


Table of Contents

lose customers seeking new technology-driven products and services to the extent we are unable to provide such products and services.

Our operations could be interrupted if our third-party service providers experience difficulty, terminate their services or fail to comply with banking regulations.

        We depend on a number of relationships with third-party service providers. Specifically, we receive certain third-party services including, but not limited to, core systems processing, essential web hosting and other Internet systems, our online banking services, deposit processing and other processing services. If these third-party service providers experience difficulties, or terminate their services, and we are unable to replace them with other service providers, particularly on a timely basis, our operations could be interrupted. If an interruption were to continue for a significant period of time, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected, perhaps materially. Even if we are able to replace third-party service providers, it may be at a higher cost to us, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

System failure or breaches of our network security could subject us to increased operating costs as well as litigation and other liabilities.

        The computer systems and network infrastructure we use, including the systems and infrastructure of our third-party service providers, could be vulnerable to unforeseen problems. Our operations are dependent upon our ability to protect our computer equipment, and the information stored therein, against damage from physical theft, fire, power loss, telecommunications failure or a similar catastrophic event, as well as from security breaches, denial of service attacks, viruses, worms and other disruptive problems caused by hackers. Any damage or failure that causes breakdowns or disruptions in our general ledger, deposit, loan and other systems could damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny, including enforcement action that could restrict our operations, or expose us to civil litigation and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on us. Computer break-ins, phishing and other disruptions could also jeopardize the security of information stored in and transmitted through our computer systems and network infrastructure, which may result in significant liability to us and may cause existing and potential customers to refrain from doing business with us. In addition, advances in computer capabilities could result in a compromise or breach of the systems we and our third-party service providers use to encrypt and protect customer transaction data. A failure of such security measures could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

If the goodwill that we have recorded or may record in connection with a business acquisition becomes impaired, it could require charges to earnings, which would adversely affect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        Goodwill represents the amount by which the cost of an acquisition exceeded the fair value of net assets we acquired in connection with the purchase of another financial institution. We review goodwill for impairment at least annually, or more frequently if a triggering event occurs which indicates that the carrying value of the asset might be impaired.

        Our goodwill impairment test involves a two-step process. Under the first step, the estimation of fair value of the reporting unit is compared to its carrying value including goodwill. If step one indicates a potential impairment, the second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment, if any. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. Any such adjustments are reflected in our results of operations in the periods in which they become known. As of June 30, 2014, our goodwill totaled $19.1 million. While we have not recorded any impairment charges since we initially recorded the goodwill, there can be no assurance that our future evaluations of our existing goodwill or goodwill we may acquire in the future will not result in findings of impairment and related write-downs, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

23


Table of Contents

We may be subject to environmental liabilities in connection with the foreclosure on real estate assets securing our loan portfolio.

        Hazardous or toxic substances or other environmental hazards may be located on the properties that secure our loans. If we acquire such properties as a result of foreclosure or otherwise, we could become subject to various environmental liabilities. For example, we could be held liable for the cost of cleaning up or otherwise addressing contamination at or from these properties. We could also be held liable to a governmental entity or third party for property damage, personal injury or other claims relating to any environmental contamination at or from these properties. In addition, we own and operate certain properties that may be subject to similar environmental liability risks. Although we have policies and procedures that are designed to mitigate against certain environmental risks, we may not detect all environmental hazards associated with these properties. In the event we ever became subject to significant environmental liabilities, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

Risks Related to Our Industry and Regulation

The ongoing implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act could adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

        On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law, and the process of implementation is ongoing. The Dodd-Frank Act imposes significant regulatory and compliance changes on many industries, including ours. There remains significant uncertainty surrounding the manner in which the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will ultimately be implemented by the various regulatory agencies and the full extent of the impact of the requirements on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, require the development of new compliance infrastructure, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements or with any future changes in laws or regulations could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We operate in a highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in them, or our failure to comply with them, could adversely affect us.

        We are subject to extensive regulation, supervision and legal requirements that govern almost all aspects of our operations. These laws and regulations are not intended to protect our shareholders. Rather, these laws and regulations are intended to protect customers, depositors, the Deposit Insurance Fund, and the overall financial stability of the United States, these laws and regulations, among other matters, prescribe minimum capital requirements, impose limitations on the business activities in which we can engage, limit the dividend or distributions that the Bank can pay to us, restrict the ability of institutions to guarantee our debt, and impose certain specific accounting requirements on us that may be more restrictive and may result in greater or earlier charges to earnings or reductions in our capital than generally accepted accounting principles would require. Compliance with laws and regulations can be difficult and costly, and changes to laws and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. Our failure to comply with these laws and regulations, even if the failure follows good faith effort or reflects a difference in interpretation, could subject us to restrictions on our business activities, fines and other penalties, any of which could adversely affect our results of operations, capital base and the price of our securities. Further, any new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance more difficult or expensive or otherwise adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

24


Table of Contents

State and federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including compliance with laws and regulations, and our failure to comply with any supervisory actions to which we are or become subject as a result of such examinations could adversely affect us.

        Texas and federal banking agencies, including the Texas Department of Banking and the Federal Reserve, periodically conduct examinations of our business, including compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a Texas or federal banking agency were to determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that our company, the Bank or their respective management were in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin "unsafe or unsound" practices, to require affirmative actions to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital levels, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against us, the Bank or their respective officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate the Bank's deposit insurance. If we become subject to such regulatory actions, our business, financial condition, results of operations and reputation could be adversely affected.

Many of our new activities and expansion plans require regulatory approvals, and failure to obtain them may restrict our growth.

        We intend to complement and expand our business by pursuing strategic acquisitions of financial institutions and other complementary businesses. Generally, we must receive state and federal regulatory approval before we can acquire an FDIC-insured depository institution or related business. In determining whether to approve a proposed acquisition, federal banking regulators will consider, among other factors, the effect of the acquisition on competition, our financial condition, our future prospects, and the impact of the proposal on U.S. financial stability. The regulators also review current and projected capital ratios and levels, the competence, experience and integrity of management and its record of compliance with laws and regulations, the convenience and needs of the communities to be served (including the acquiring institution's record of compliance under the Community Reinvestment Act, or the CRA) and the effectiveness of the acquiring institution in combating money laundering activities. Such regulatory approvals may not be granted on terms that are acceptable to us, or at all. We may also be required to sell branches as a condition to receiving regulatory approval, which condition may not be acceptable to us or, if acceptable to us, may reduce the benefit of any acquisition.

        In addition to the acquisition of existing financial institutions, as opportunities arise, we plan to continue de novo branching as a part of our organic growth strategy. De novo branching and any acquisitions carry with them numerous risks, including the inability to obtain all required regulatory approvals. The failure to obtain these regulatory approvals for potential future strategic acquisitions and de novo branches could impact our business plans and restrict our growth.

Financial institutions, such as the Bank, face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes and regulations.

        The Bank Secrecy Act, the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001, or the USA PATRIOT Act, and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among other duties, to institute and maintain an effective anti-money laundering program and file suspicious activity and currency transaction reports as appropriate. The Financial Crimes Enforcement Network, established by the U.S. Department of the Treasury, or the Treasury Department, to administer the Bank Secrecy Act, is authorized to impose significant civil money penalties for violations of those requirements, and has recently engaged in coordinated enforcement efforts with the individual federal banking regulators, as well as the U.S.

25


Table of Contents

Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration, and Internal Revenue Service. There is also increased scrutiny of compliance with the sanctions programs and rules administered and enforced by the Treasury Department's Office of Foreign Assets Control.

        In order to comply with regulations, guidelines and examination procedures in this area, we have dedicated significant resources to our anti-money laundering program. If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient, we could be subject to liability, including fines and regulatory actions such as restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals to proceed with certain aspects of our business plans, including acquisitions and de novo branching.

We are subject to the CRA and fair lending laws, and failure to comply with these laws could lead to material penalties.

        The CRA, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act and other fair lending laws and regulations impose nondiscriminatory lending requirements on financial institutions. The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, or the CFPB, the Justice Department and other federal agencies are responsible for enforcing these laws and regulations. A successful challenge to an institution's performance under the CRA or fair lending laws and regulations could result in a wide variety of sanctions, including the required payment of damages and civil money penalties, injunctive relief, imposition of restrictions on mergers and acquisitions activity, and restrictions on expansion activity. Private parties may also have the ability to challenge an institution's performance under fair lending laws in private class action litigation.

The FDIC's restoration plan and the related increased assessment rate could adversely affect our earnings and results of operations.

        As a result of economic conditions and the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC has increased deposit insurance assessment rates, which in turn raised deposit premiums for many insured depository institutions. If these increases are insufficient for the Deposit Insurance Fund to meet its funding requirements, further special assessments or increases in deposit insurance premiums may be required. We are generally unable to control the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC insurance. If there are additional financial institution failures that affect the Deposit Insurance Fund, we may be required to pay FDIC premiums higher than current levels. Our FDIC insurance related costs were $378,000 for the year ended December 31, 2013, compared to $234,000 for the year ended December 31, 2012, and $383,000 for the year ended December 31, 2011. Any future additional assessments, increases or required prepayments in FDIC insurance premiums could adversely affect our earnings and results of operations.

We will become subject to more stringent capital requirements, which may adversely impact our return on equity or constrain us from paying dividends or repurchasing shares.

        The Dodd-Frank Act requires the federal banking agencies to establish stricter risk-based capital requirements and leverage limits to apply to banks and bank and savings and loan holding companies. In July 2013, the federal banking agencies published the final Basel III Capital Rules (as defined in "Regulation and Supervision—Regulatory Capital Requirements and Capital Adequacy") that revised their risk-based and leverage capital requirements and their method for calculating risk-weighted assets. The Basel III Capital Rules will apply to all bank holding companies with $500 million or more in consolidated assets and all banks regardless of size.

        As a result of the enactment of the Basel III Capital Rules, we will become subject to increased required capital levels. The Basel III Capital Rules become effective as applied to us on January 1, 2015, with a phase-in period that generally extends from January 1, 2015 through January 1, 2019. The application of more stringent capital requirements on us could, among other things, result in lower

26


Table of Contents

returns on equity, require the raising of additional capital, and result in regulatory actions such as the inability to pay dividends or repurchase shares if we were to be unable to comply with such requirements.

The Federal Reserve may require us to commit capital resources to support the Bank.

        The Federal Reserve requires a bank holding company to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary banks and to commit resources to support its subsidiary banks. Under the "source of strength" doctrine, the Federal Reserve may require a bank holding company to make capital injections into a troubled subsidiary bank at times when the bank holding company may not be inclined to do so and may charge the bank holding company with engaging in unsafe and unsound practices for failure to commit resources to such a subsidiary bank. Accordingly, we could be required to provide financial assistance to the Bank if it experiences financial distress.

        Such a capital injection may be required at a time when our resources are limited and we may be required to borrow the funds to make the required capital injection. In the event of a bank holding company's bankruptcy, the bankruptcy trustee will assume any commitment by the holding company to a federal bank regulatory agency to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank. Moreover, bankruptcy law provides that claims based on any such commitment will be entitled to a priority of payment over the claims of the holding company's general unsecured creditors, including the holders of any note obligations.

We could be adversely affected by the soundness of other financial institutions.

        Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including commercial banks, brokers and dealers, investment banks and other institutional clients. Many of these transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of a default by a counterparty or client. In addition, our credit risk may be exacerbated when our collateral cannot be foreclosed upon or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the credit or derivative exposure due. Any such losses could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

        In addition to being affected by general economic conditions, our earnings and growth are affected by the policies of the Federal Reserve. An important function of the Federal Reserve is to regulate the U.S. money supply and credit conditions. Among the instruments used by the Federal Reserve to implement these objectives are open market operations in U.S. government securities, adjustments of both the discount rate and the federal funds rate and changes in reserve requirements against bank deposits. These instruments are used in varying combinations to influence overall economic growth and the distribution of credit, bank loans, investments and deposits. Their use also affects interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

        The monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve have had a significant effect on the operating results of commercial banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future. Although we cannot determine the effects of such policies on us at this time, such policies could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

27


Table of Contents

Risks Related to this Offering and an Investment in our Common Stock

An active trading market for our common stock may not develop, and you may not be able to sell your common stock at or above the initial public offering price.

        Prior to this offering there has been no public market for our common stock. An active trading market for shares of our common stock may never develop or be sustained following this offering. If an active trading market does not develop, you may have difficulty selling your shares of common stock at an attractive price, or at all. The initial public offering price for our common stock will be determined by negotiations between us and the representative of the underwriters and may not be indicative of prices that will prevail in the open market following this offering. Consequently, you may not be able to sell your common stock at or above the initial public offering price or at any other price or at the time that you would like to sell. An inactive market may also impair our ability to raise capital by selling our common stock and may impair our ability to expand our business by using our common stock as consideration in an acquisition.

The market price of our common stock may fluctuate significantly.

        The market price of our common stock could fluctuate significantly due to a number of factors, including, but not limited to:

        In particular, the realization of any of the risks described in this "Risk Factors" section could have a material adverse effect on the market price of our common stock and cause the value of your investment to decline. In addition, the stock market in general has experienced extreme volatility that has often been unrelated to the operating performance of particular companies. These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the trading price of our common stock over the short, medium or long term, regardless of our actual performance. If the market price of our common stock reaches an

28


Table of Contents

elevated level following this offering, it may materially and rapidly decline. In the past, following periods of volatility in the market price of a company's securities, shareholders have often instituted securities class action litigation. If we were to be involved in a class action lawsuit, it could divert the attention of senior management and could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The obligations associated with being a public company will require significant resources and management attention.

        As a public company, we will face increased legal, accounting, administrative and other costs and expenses that we have not incurred as a private company, particularly after we are no longer an emerging growth company. We expect to incur incremental costs related to operating as a public company of approximately $700,000 annually, although these costs could be higher, particularly when we no longer qualify as an emerging growth company. After the completion of this offering, we will be subject to the reporting requirements of the Exchange Act, which requires that we file annual, quarterly and current reports with respect to our business and financial condition and proxy and other information statements, and the rules and regulations implemented by the SEC, the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, the Dodd-Frank Act, the PCAOB and the Nasdaq Stock Market, each of which imposes additional reporting and other obligations on public companies. As a public company, we will be required to:

        We expect these rules and regulations and changes in laws, regulations and standards relating to corporate governance and public disclosure, which have created uncertainty for public companies, to increase legal and financial compliance costs and make some activities more time consuming and costly. These laws, regulations and standards are subject to varying interpretations, in many cases due to their lack of specificity, and, as a result, their application in practice may evolve over time as new guidance is provided by regulatory and governing bodies. This could result in continuing uncertainty regarding compliance matters and higher costs necessitated by ongoing revisions to disclosure and governance practices. Our investment in compliance with existing and evolving regulatory requirements will result in increased administrative expenses and a diversion of management's time and attention from revenue-generating activities to compliance activities, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. These increased costs could require us to divert a significant amount of money that we could otherwise use to expand our business and achieve our strategic objectives.

29


Table of Contents

You will incur immediate dilution as a result of this offering.

        If you purchase our common stock in this offering, you will pay more for your shares than the net tangible book value per share immediately prior to consummation of this offering. As a result, you will incur immediate dilution of $            per share representing the difference between the offering price of $            , the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and our net tangible book value per share as of June 30, 2014 of $7.18. Accordingly, if we are liquidated at our book value, you would not receive the full amount of your investment.

If securities or industry analysts change their recommendations regarding our stock or if our operating results do not meet their expectations, our stock price could decline.

        The trading market for our common stock could be influenced by the research and reports that industry or securities analysts may publish about us or our business. If one or more of these analysts cease coverage of us or fail to publish reports on us regularly, we could lose visibility in the financial markets, which in turn could cause our stock price or trading volume to decline. Moreover, if one or more of the analysts who cover us downgrade our stock or if our operating results do not meet their expectations, either absolutely or relative to our competitors, our stock price could decline significantly.

Future sales or the possibility of future sales of a substantial amount of our common stock may depress the price of shares of our common stock.

        Future sales or the availability for sale of substantial amounts of our common stock in the public market could adversely affect the prevailing market price of our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through future sales of equity securities.

        At the time of this offering, we expect that our certificate of formation will authorize us to issue up to 75,000,000 shares of common stock,            of which will be outstanding upon consummation of this offering (assuming the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full). This number includes            shares that we are selling in this offering, which will be freely transferable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or the Securities Act. Holders of approximately        % of the shares of our common stock outstanding prior to this offering, including all of our executive officers and directors, have agreed not to sell any shares of our common stock for a period of at least 180 days from the date of this prospectus, subject to certain exceptions. See "Underwriting." Following the expiration of the applicable lock-up period, all of these shares will be eligible for resale under Rule 144 of the Securities Act, subject to any remaining holding period requirements and, if applicable, volume limitations. The remaining shares of common stock outstanding prior to this offering are not subject to lock-up agreements and substantially all of such shares have been held by our non-affiliates for at least one year and therefor may be freely sold by such persons upon the completion of this offering. See "Shares Eligible for Future Sale" for a discussion of the shares of our common stock that may be sold into the public market in the future.

        We may issue shares of our common stock or other securities from time to time as consideration for future acquisitions and investments and pursuant to compensation and incentive plans. If any such acquisition or investment is significant, the number of shares of our common stock, or the number or aggregate principal amount, as the case may be, of other securities that we may issue may in turn be substantial. We may also grant registration rights covering those shares of our common stock or other securities in connection with any such acquisitions and investments.

        We cannot predict the size of future issuances of our common stock or the effect, if any, that future issuances and sales of our common stock will have on the market price of our common stock. Sales of substantial amounts of our common stock (including shares of our common stock issued in connection with an acquisition or under a compensation or incentive plan), or the perception that such

30


Table of Contents

sales could occur, may adversely affect prevailing market prices for our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through future sales of our securities.

We may issue shares of preferred stock in the future, which could make it difficult for another company to acquire us or could otherwise materially adversely affect holders of our common stock, which could depress the price of our common stock.

        At the time of this offering, we expect that our certificate of formation will authorize us to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of one or more series of preferred stock. Our board of directors will have the authority to determine the preferences, limitations and relative rights of shares of preferred stock and to fix the number of shares constituting any series and the designation of such series, without any further vote or action by our shareholders. Our preferred stock could be issued with voting, liquidation, dividend and other rights superior to the rights of our common stock. The potential issuance of preferred stock may delay or prevent a change in control of us, discouraging bids for our common stock at a premium over the market price, and materially adversely affect the market price and the voting and other rights of the holders of our common stock.

The holders of our debt obligations and shares of our preferred stock will have priority over our common stock with respect to payment in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up and with respect to the payment of interest and preferred dividends.

        As of June 30, 2014, we had outstanding $5.0 million in aggregate principal amount of subordinated promissory notes held by investors, and $3.1 million of junior subordinated debentures issued to a statutory trust that, in turn, issued $3.0 million of trust preferred securities. In the future we may incur additional indebtedness. Upon our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, holders of our common stock will not be entitled to receive any payment or other distribution of assets until after all of our obligations to our debt holders have been satisfied and holders of trust preferred securities have received any payment or distribution due to them. In addition, we are required to pay interest on our outstanding indebtedness before we pay any dividends on our common stock.

        As of June 30, 2014, we had outstanding 8,000 shares of our Series C preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury in connection with our participation in the SBLF program. These shares have rights that are senior to our common stock. As a result, we must make dividend payments on the Series C preferred stock before any dividends can be paid on our common stock and, in the event of our bankruptcy, dissolution or liquidation, the holders of the Series C preferred stock must be satisfied in full before any distributions can be made to the holders of our common stock. Furthermore, our board of directors, in its sole discretion, has the authority to designate and issue one or more series of preferred stock from our authorized and unissued preferred stock, which may have preferences with respect to common stock in dissolution, dividends, liquidation or otherwise.

        Because our decision to issue debt or equity securities or incur other borrowings in the future will depend on market conditions and other factors beyond our control, the amount, timing, nature or success of our future capital raising efforts is uncertain. Thus, common shareholders bear the risk that our future issuances of debt or equity securities or our incurrence of other borrowings will negatively affect the market price of our common stock.

We currently have no plans to pay dividends on our common stock, so you may not receive funds without selling your common stock.

        We do not anticipate paying any dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. Our ability to pay dividends on our common stock is dependent on the Bank's ability to pay dividends to us, which is limited by applicable laws and banking regulations, and may in the future be restricted by the terms of any debt or preferred securities we may incur or issue. Payments of future dividends, if any,

31


Table of Contents

will be at the discretion of our board of directors after taking into account various factors, including our business, operating results and financial condition, current and anticipated cash needs, plans for expansion and any legal or contractual limitations on our ability to pay dividends. Accordingly, shares of common stock should not be purchased by persons who need or desire dividend income from their investment.

We are an "emerging growth company," and we cannot be certain if the reduced disclosure requirements applicable to emerging growth companies will make our common stock less attractive to investors.

        We are an "emerging growth company," as defined in the JOBS Act, and we may take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not emerging growth companies. These exemptions allow us, among other things, to present only two years of audited financial statements and discuss our results of operations for only two years in related Management's Discussions and Analyses; not to provide an auditor attestation of our internal control over financial reporting; to choose not to comply with any new requirements adopted by the PCAOB requiring mandatory audit firm rotation or a supplement to the auditor's report providing additional information about the audit and our audited financial statements; to provide reduced disclosure regarding our executive compensation arrangements pursuant to the rules applicable to smaller reporting companies, which means we do not have to include a compensation discussion and analysis and certain other disclosure regarding our executive compensation; and not to seek a non-binding advisory vote on executive compensation or golden parachute arrangements. In addition, even if we comply with the greater disclosure obligations of public companies that are not emerging growth companies immediately after this offering, we may avail ourselves of these reduced requirements applicable to emerging growth companies from time to time in the future, so long as we are an emerging growth company. We will remain an emerging growth company for up to five years, though we may cease to be an emerging growth company earlier under certain circumstances, including if, before the end of such five years, we are deemed to be a large accelerated filer under the rules of the SEC (which depends on, among other things, having a market value of common stock held by non-affiliates in excess of $700.0 million). Investors and securities analysts may find it more difficult to evaluate our common stock because we may rely on one or more of these exemptions, and, as a result, investor confidence and the market price of our common stock may be materially and adversely affected.

We are dependent upon the Bank for cash flow, and the Bank's ability to make cash distributions is restricted which could impact our ability to satisfy our obligations.

        Our primary asset is the Bank. As such, we depend upon the Bank for cash distributions through dividends on the Bank's stock to pay our operating expenses and satisfy our obligations, including debt obligations. There are numerous laws and banking regulations that limit the Bank's ability to pay dividends to us. If the Bank is unable to pay dividends to us, we will not be able to satisfy our obligations. Federal and state statutes and regulations restrict the Bank's ability to make cash distributions to us. These statutes and regulations require, among other things, that the Bank maintain certain levels of capital in order to pay a dividend. Further, federal and state banking authorities have the ability to restrict the Bank's payment of dividends through supervisory action. In addition, in connection with our participation in the SBLF program, we are subject to restrictions on the payment of dividends.

We have broad discretion in the use of the net proceeds from this offering, and our use of those proceeds may not yield a favorable return on your investment.

        We expect to use the net proceeds of this offering to support our continued growth, including organic growth and potential future acquisitions, and for general corporate purposes. From time to

32


Table of Contents

time, we evaluate and conduct due diligence with respect to potential acquisition candidates and may enter into letters of intent, although we do not have any current arrangements or understandings to make a material acquisition. There can be no assurance that we will enter into any definitive agreements in respect of any such transaction. Our management has broad discretion over how these proceeds are used and could spend the proceeds in ways with which you may not agree. In addition, we may not use the proceeds of this offering effectively or in a manner that increases our market value or enhances our profitability. We have not established a timetable for the effective deployment of the proceeds, and we cannot predict how long it will take to deploy the proceeds. Investing the offering proceeds in securities until we are able to deploy the proceeds will provide lower margins that we generally earn on loans, potentially adversely affecting shareholder returns, including earnings per share, return on assets and return on equity.

We have a significant investor whose individual interests may differ from yours.

        Our largest shareholder is SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P., or SunTx. SunTx currently owns 24.7% of our outstanding common stock, and is expected to own, following the completion of this offering,        % of our outstanding common stock (or        % if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full). We have granted SunTx certain rights, such as board representation rights, that may give SunTx greater influence over our company than you or other shareholders. As a result of its significant ownership, SunTx could have greater ability to influence matters such as the election of directors and other matters submitted to a vote of our shareholders, such as mergers, a sale of all or substantially all of our assets and other extraordinary corporate transactions. SunTx's interests could conflict with the interests of our other shareholders, including you, and any future transfer by SunTx of its shares of common stock to other investors who have different business objectives could adversely affect the market value of our common stock.

Our corporate organizational documents and provisions of federal and state law to which we are subject contain certain provisions that could have an anti-takeover effect and may delay, make more difficult or prevent an attempted acquisition that you may favor.

        Certain provisions may have an anti-takeover effect and may delay, discourage or prevent an attempted acquisition or change of control. These provisions may include:

        Our amended and restated certificate of formation does not provide for cumulative voting for directors and authorizes the board of directors to issue shares of its preferred stock without shareholder approval and upon such terms as the board of directors may determine. The issuance of our preferred stock, while providing desirable flexibility in connection with possible acquisitions, financings and other corporate purposes, could have the effect of making it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or of discouraging a third-party from acquiring, a controlling interest in us. In addition, certain provisions of Texas law, including a provision which restricts certain business combinations between a Texas corporation and certain affiliated shareholders, may delay, discourage or prevent an attempted acquisition or change in control.

        Furthermore, banking laws impose notice, approval, and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other party that seeks to acquire direct or indirect "control" of an FDIC-insured depository institution. These laws include the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, or the BHC Act, and the Change in Bank Control Act. These laws could delay or prevent an acquisition.

33


Table of Contents

Shareholders may be deemed to be acting in concert or otherwise in control of us, which could impose notice, approval and ongoing regulatory requirements and result in adverse regulatory consequences for such holders.

        We are a bank holding company regulated by the Federal Reserve. Banking laws impose notice, approval, and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other party that seeks to acquire direct or indirect "control" of an FDIC-insured depository institution or a company that controls an FDIC-insured depository institution, such as a bank holding company. These laws include the BHC Act and the Change in Bank Control Act. The determination whether an investor "controls" a depository institution or holding company is based on all of the facts and circumstances surrounding the investment.

        As a general matter, a party is deemed to control a depository institution or other company if the party (1) owns or controls 25.0% or more of any class of voting stock of the bank or other company, (2) controls the election of a majority of the directors of the bank or other company, or (3) has the power to exercise a controlling influence over the management or policies of the bank or other company. In addition, subject to rebuttal, a party may be presumed to control a depository institution or other company if the investor owns or controls 10.0% or more of any class of voting stock. Ownership by affiliated parties, or parties acting in concert, is typically aggregated for these purposes. "Acting in concert" generally means knowing participation in a joint activity or parallel action towards the common goal of acquiring control of a bank or a parent company, whether or not pursuant to an express agreement. The manner in which this definition is applied in individual circumstances can vary and cannot always be predicted with certainty.

        Any shareholder that is deemed to "control" us for regulatory purposes would become subject to notice, approval, and ongoing regulatory requirements and may be subject to adverse regulatory consequences. Potential investors are advised to consult with their legal counsel regarding the applicable regulations and requirements.

An investment in our common stock is not an insured deposit and is not guaranteed by the FDIC, so you could lose some or all of your investment.

        An investment in our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss or guaranteed by the FDIC, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity. An investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described herein. As a result, if you acquire our common stock, you could lose some or all of your investment.

34


Table of Contents


USE OF PROCEEDS

        We intend to initially retain the net proceeds from this offering at our holding company and to use such proceeds to support our continued growth, including organic growth and potential future acquisitions, and for general corporate purposes. From time to time, we evaluate and conduct due diligence with respect to potential acquisition candidates and may enter into letters of intent, although we do not have any current plans, arrangements or understandings to make a material acquisition. There can be no assurance that we will enter into any definitive agreements in respect of any such transaction. Our management will retain broad discretion to allocate the net proceeds of this offering. Although we intend to initially retain the net proceeds of this offering at our holding company, we may elect to contribute a portion of the net proceeds to the Bank as regulatory capital. The precise amounts and timing of our use of the proceeds will depend upon market conditions and other factors.

        We estimate that the net proceeds from the sale of the shares of our common stock in this offering will be approximately $             million, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, based on an assumed initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus. If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full, the net proceeds to us will be approximately $             million.

        A $1.00 increase (or decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, would increase (or decrease) the net proceeds from the sale of the shares of common stock by us by approximately $            , assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

        A 1,000,000 share increase (or decrease) in the number of shares of common stock offered by us, would increase (or decrease) the net proceeds from the sale of the shares of common stock by us by approximately $            , assuming an initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

35


Table of Contents


CAPITALIZATION

        The following table sets forth our capitalization as of June 30, 2014:

        This table should be read in conjunction with "Use of Proceeds," "Selected Consolidated Financial Data," "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
  As of June 30, 2014  
 
  Actual   As Adjusted  
 
  (Dollars in thousands,
except per share data)

 

Other borrowings:

             

Junior subordinated debentures due 2036

  $ 3,093   $ 3,093  

Subordinated notes due 2023

    4,979     4,979  

Stockholders' equity:

             

Preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 500,000 shares authorized; 8,000 shares Series C, issued and outstanding with a $1,000 liquidation value(1)

  $ 8,000   $ 8,000  

Common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 10,000,000 shares authorized; issued and outstanding—6,358,832 shares actual, shares as adjusted (excluding 10,000 shares held in treasury)(1)

    64        

Additional paid-in capital

    61,419        

Retained earnings

    5,038     5,038  

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

    194     194  

Unearned ESOP shares

    (401 )   (401 )

Treasury shares, 10,000 at $7.00 per share

    (70 )   (70 )
           

Total stockholders' equity

  $ 74,244   $               
           

Total capitalization

  $ 82,316   $               
           
           

Per Share Data:

             

Book value per common share(2)

  $ 10.42   $               

Tangible book value per common share(3)

    7.18        

Capital Ratios:

   
 
   
 
 

Tier 1 capital to average assets

    8.66 %                %

Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets

    10.44        

Total capital to risk-weighted assets

    12.35        

Tangible common equity to tangible assets(4)

    6.70        

(1)
We expect that our certificate of formation at the time of this offering will authorize us to issue up to 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock and up to 75,000,000 shares of common stock.

36


Table of Contents

(2)
We calculate book value per common share as stockholders' equity less preferred stock at the end of the relevant period divided by the outstanding number of shares of our common stock at the end of the relevant period.

(3)
Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate tangible book value per common share as total stockholders' equity less preferred stock, goodwill, core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization at the end of the relevant period, divided by the outstanding number of shares of our common stock at the end of the relevant period. We believe that the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure is total stockholders' equity per common share. For a reconciliation of the non-GAAP financial measure to its most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, see "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measures."

(4)
Tangible common equity to tangible assets is a non-GAAP financial measure. We calculate tangible common equity as total stockholders' equity less preferred stock, goodwill, core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization, and we calculate tangible assets as total assets less preferred stock, goodwill and core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization. We believe that the most directly comparable GAAP financial measure is total stockholders' equity to total assets. For a reconciliation of the non-GAAP financial measure to its most directly comparable GAAP financial measure, see "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Non-GAAP Financial Measures."

        A $1.00 increase (or decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, would increase (or decrease) the net proceeds from the sale of the shares of common stock by us by approximately $            , assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

        A 1,000,000 share increase (or decrease) in the number of shares of common stock offered by us, would increase (or decrease) the net proceeds from the sale of the shares of common stock by us by approximately $            , assuming an initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us.

        The "as adjusted" amounts discussed above are illustrative only and subject to the actual initial public offering price and the actual number of shares sold by us in this offering.

37


Table of Contents


DILUTION

        If you invest in our common stock, your ownership interest will be diluted to the extent that the initial public offering price per share of our common stock in this offering exceeds the net tangible book value per share of common stock upon completion of this offering.

        Net tangible book value per common share represents the amount of our total tangible assets less total liabilities, divided by the number of shares of common stock outstanding. Our net tangible book value as of June 30, 2014 was $45.7 million, or $7.18 per share of common stock.

        Investors participating in this offering will incur immediate, substantial dilution. After giving effect to the sale of             shares of our common stock by us at the initial public offering price of $            per share, the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us, our net tangible book value as of June 30, 2014 would have been approximately $            , or approximately $            per share of common stock. This represents an immediate increase in net tangible book value of $            per share to existing common shareholders, and an immediate dilution of $            per share to investors participating in this offering. If the initial public offering price is higher or lower, the dilution to new shareholders will be greater or less, respectively.

        The following table illustrates the calculation of the amount of dilution per share that a purchaser of our common stock in this offering will incur given the assumptions above:

Assumed initial public offering price per share of common stock

        $               

Net tangible book value per common share as of June 30, 2014

  $ 7.18        

Increase in tangible book value per common share attributable to this offering

             
             

As adjusted net tangible book value per common share after this offering

             
             

Dilution in net tangible book value per common share to new investors(1)

        $    
             
             

(1)
Dilution is determined by subtracting net tangible book value per share after giving effect to this offering from the initial public offering price paid by a new investor.

        A $1.00 increase (or decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, would increase (or decrease) the as adjusted net tangible book value per share after this offering by approximately $            , and dilution in net tangible book value per share to new investors by approximately $            , assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us. If the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of our common stock in this offering, the as adjusted net tangible book value after this offering would be $            per share, the increase in net tangible book value to existing shareholders would be $            per share and the dilution to new investors would be $            per share, in each case assuming an initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus.

        The following table summarizes, as of June 30, 2014, the differences between our existing shareholders and new investors with respect to the number of shares of our common stock purchased from us, the total consideration paid to us and the average price per share paid by existing

38


Table of Contents

shareholders and investors purchasing common stock in the offering. The calculations with respect to shares purchased by new investors in this offering reflect the initial public offering price of $            per share, which is the midpoint of the estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, before deducting estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and estimated offering expenses payable by us:

 
  Shares Purchased   Total Consideration    
 
 
  Average Price
Per Share
 
 
  Number   Percentage   Amount   Percentage  

Existing shareholders

    6,358,832                  % $ 63,544,177                  % $ 10.07  

New investors

                               
                         

Total

          100 % $                  100 % $               
                         
                         

        The discussion and tables above assume no exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares, and no exercise of any outstanding options. In addition, if the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares is exercised in full, the number of shares of common stock held by existing shareholders will be further reduced to        % of the total number of shares of common stock to be outstanding upon the completion of this offering, and the number of shares of common stock held by investors participating in this offering will be further increased to             shares or        % of the total number of shares of common stock to be outstanding upon the completion of this offering.

        The discussion and tables above exclude 855,000 shares of our common stock issuable upon the exercise of outstanding options and warrants and 63,250 shares of common stock underlying outstanding restricted stock units that are not fully vested. As of June 30, 2014, we had outstanding options to purchase 830,000 shares of common stock at a weighted average exercise price of $10.15 per share, of which 357,500 shares were issuable upon the exercise of time-based options (181,200 shares of which were exercisable) and 472,500 shares were issuable upon the exercise of performance-based options (none of which were exercisable). We intend to cancel all of our performance-based options prior to the completion of this offering and to grant additional restricted stock units as described in "Executive Compensation—2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan." As of June 30, 2014, we had outstanding warrants to purchase 25,000 shares of common stock at an exercise price of $11.00 per share. To the extent any of these options or warrants are exercised or shares are issued upon vesting of restricted stock units, investors purchasing common stock in this offering will experience further dilution.

39


Table of Contents


DIVIDEND POLICY

        We have not declared or paid any dividends on our common stock. We currently intend to retain all of our future earnings, if any, for use in our business and do not anticipate paying cash dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future. Payments of future dividends, if any, will be at the discretion of our board of directors after taking into account various factors, including our business, operating results and financial condition, current and anticipated cash needs, plans for expansion and any legal or contractual limitations on our ability to pay dividends.

        As a bank holding company, our ability to pay dividends is affected by the policies and enforcement powers of the Federal Reserve. In addition, because we are a holding company, we are dependent upon the payment of dividends by the Bank to us as our principal source of funds to pay dividends in the future, if any, and to make other payments. The Bank is also subject to various legal, regulatory and other restrictions on its ability to pay dividends and make other distributions and payments to us. See "Regulation and Supervision—Regulatory Limits on Dividends and Distributions." In addition, in the future we may enter into borrowing or other contractual arrangements that restrict our ability to pay dividends.

        As a result of our participation in the SBLF program, we are obligated to pay quarterly non-cumulative dividends on our Series C preferred stock held by the U.S. Treasury. Payments are due each January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1. The dividend rate on our Series C preferred stock is 1.0% per annum as of June 30, 2014 and will increase to 9.0% beginning February 2016. Failure to pay quarterly dividends on the Series C preferred stock may limit our ability to pay dividends on our common stock in the future.

40


Table of Contents


BUSINESS

Our Company

        We are a bank holding company headquartered in Dallas, Texas. Through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state chartered bank, we provide relationship-driven commercial banking products and services tailored to meet the needs of small to medium-sized businesses and professionals. Since our inception, we have targeted customers and focused our acquisitions primarily in the Dallas metropolitan area, which we consider to be Dallas and the adjacent communities in North Dallas. As we continue to grow, we expect to expand our primary market to include the broader Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area, which would include Fort Worth and Arlington, as well as the communities adjacent to those cities. We currently operate eight branches and one mortgage office, all of which are located in the Dallas metropolitan area. We have experienced significant organic growth since commencing banking operations in 2010 and have successfully acquired and integrated three banks. As of June 30, 2014, we had total assets of $710.4 million, total loans of $541.0 million, total deposits of $611.2 million and total stockholders' equity of $74.2 million.

        Our primary customers are small and medium-sized businesses, generally with annual revenues of under $30 million, and professionals. We believe that these businesses and professionals highly value the local decision-making and relationship-driven, quality service we provide and our deep, long-term understanding of the Dallas community and Texas banking. As a result of consolidation, we believe that there are few locally-based banks that are dedicated to providing this level of service to small and medium-sized businesses. Our management team's long-standing presence and experience in the Dallas metropolitan area gives us unique insight into our local market and the needs of our customers. This enables us to respond quickly to customers, provide high quality personal service and develop comprehensive, long-term banking relationships by providing products and services tailored to meet the individual needs of our customers. This focus and approach enhances our ability to continue to grow organically, successfully recruit talented bankers and strategically source potential acquisitions in our target market.

Our History and Growth

        Our management team is led by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, C. Malcolm Holland, III, who has overseen and managed our organic growth and acquisition activity since we commenced banking operations in 2010. We have completed three whole-bank acquisitions that have increased our market presence within the Dallas metropolitan area. We have also grown organically by opening two branches and a mortgage office in the Dallas metropolitan area. The following table summarizes our three acquisitions:

Bank Acquired
  Date Completed   Acquired
Assets
  Acquired
Loans
  Number of
Branches
  Dallas Area
Locations
 
  (Dollars in millions)

Professional Bank, N.A. through Professional Capital, Inc. 

  September 2010   $ 181.8   $ 91.7     3   Park Cities, Lakewood and Garland

Fidelity Bank through Fidelity Resources Company

  March 2011     166.3     108.1     3   Preston Center, SMU and Plano

Bank of Las Colinas

  October 2011     53.8     40.4     1   Las Colinas

        We have established a record of steady growth and profitable operations since commencing banking operations in 2010, as demonstrated below (total loans and deposits as of period-end and three year compound annual growth rate, or CAGR, through December 31, 2013), while preserving our strong credit culture. Our initial growth in 2010 and 2011 was primarily the result of our acquisitions. During 2012, 2013 and the first six months of 2014, we grew our total loans and deposits organically by

41


Table of Contents

increasing our commercial lending relationships and more deeply penetrating the Dallas metropolitan area.

GRAPHIC

Our Strategy

        Our business strategy is comprised of the following components:

42


Table of Contents

Our Competitive Strengths

        We believe our competitive strengths include the following:

43


Table of Contents

44


Table of Contents

Our Banking Services

        We are focused on delivering a wide variety of relationship-driven commercial banking products and services tailored to meet the needs of small to medium-sized businesses and professionals in the Dallas metropolitan area. A general discussion of the range of commercial banking products and other services we offer follows.

        We offer a variety of loans, including commercial lines of credit, working capital loans, commercial real estate-backed loans (including loans secured by owner occupied commercial properties), term loans, equipment financing, acquisition, expansion and development loans, borrowing base loans, real estate construction loans, homebuilder loans, letters of credit and other loan products to small and medium-sized businesses, real estate developers, mortgage lenders, manufacturing and industrial companies and other businesses. We also offer various consumer loans to individuals and professionals including residential real estate loans, home equity loans, installment loans, unsecured and secured personal lines of credit, and standby letters of credit. Lending activities originate from the efforts of our bankers, with an emphasis on lending to individuals, professionals, small to medium-sized businesses and commercial companies located in the Dallas metropolitan area. Although all lending involves a degree of risk, we believe that commercial business loans and commercial real estate loans present greater risks than other types of loans in our portfolio.

45


Table of Contents

        As of June 30, 2014, we had total loans of $541.0 million, representing 76.2% of our total assets. Our loan portfolio consisted of the following loan categories as of June 30, 2014:

 
  Amount of Loans   Percentage  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)

 

Real estate:

             

Construction and land

  $ 56,818     10.5 %

Farmland

    11,982     2.2  

1 - 4 family residential

    98,030     18.1  

Multi-family residential

    14,866     2.7  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    180,921     33.5  
           

Total real estate loans

    362,617     67.0  

Commercial

    174,094     32.2  

Consumer

    4,279     0.8  
           

Total loans

  $ 540,990     100.00 %
           
           

        Loan Types.    A description of the types of loans we offer to our customers follows below.

        Real Estate Loans.    A significant portion of our loan portfolio consists of various types of real estate loans, including, commercial, construction, farmland, multi-family residential and owner occupied residential loans. Our real estate loans can be broken out into the following categories:

46


Table of Contents

47


Table of Contents

        Commercial Loans.    We make general commercial loans, including commercial lines of credit, working capital loans, term loans, equipment financing, asset acquisition, expansion and development loans, borrowing base loans, letters of credit and other loan products, primarily in our target markets that are underwritten on the basis of the borrower's ability to service the debt from income. Generally, we take as collateral, a lien on general business assets including, among other things, available real estate, accounts receivable, promissory notes, inventory and equipment and generally obtain a personal guaranty of the borrower or principal. A significant portion of our commercial loans are secured by promissory notes that evidence loans made by us to borrowers that in turn make loans to others that are secured by real estate. Our commercial loans generally have variable interest rates and terms that typically range from one to five years depending on factors such as the type and size of the loan, the financial strength of the borrower/guarantor and the age, type and value of the collateral. Fixed rate commercial loan maturities are generally short-term, with three to five year maturities, or include periodic interest rate resets.

        In general, commercial loans may involve increased credit risk and, therefore, typically yield a higher return. The increased risk in commercial loans derives from the expectation that such loans generally are serviced principally from the operations of the business, and those operations may not be successful. Any interruption or discontinuance of operating cash flows from the business, which may be influenced by events not under the control of the borrower such as economic events and changes in governmental regulations, could materially affect the ability of the borrower to repay the loan. In addition, the collateral securing commercial loans generally includes moveable property such as equipment and inventory, which may decline in value more rapidly than we anticipated, exposing us to increased credit risk. As a result of these additional complexities, variables and risks, commercial loans require extensive underwriting and servicing.

48


Table of Contents

        Consumer Loans.    We also make a variety of loans to individuals for personal and household purposes, including secured and unsecured term loans and home improvement loans. Consumer loans are underwritten based on the individual borrower's income, current debt level, past credit history and the value of any available collateral. The terms of consumer loans vary considerably based upon the loan type, nature of collateral and size of the loan. Consumer loans entail greater risk than residential real estate loans because they may be unsecured, or if secured, the value of the collateral, such as an automobile or boat, may be more difficult to assess and more likely to decrease in value than real estate. In such cases, any repossessed collateral for a defaulted consumer loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment for the outstanding loan balance. The remaining deficiency often will not warrant further substantial collection efforts against the borrower beyond obtaining a deficiency judgment. In addition, consumer loan collections are dependent on the borrower's continuing financial stability, and thus are more likely to be adversely affected by job loss, divorce, illness or personal bankruptcy. Furthermore, the application of various federal and state laws may limit the amount which can be recovered on such loans.

        Concentrations of Credit Risk.    Most of our lending activity is conducted with businesses and individuals in north central Texas. Our loan portfolio consists primarily of real estate loans, which were $362.6 million and constituted 67.0% of our total loans as of June 30, 2014, and commercial loans, which were $174.1 million and constituted 32.2% of our total loans as of June 30, 2014. Of the commercial loans outstanding as of June 30, 2014, $62.8 million were secured by promissory notes that evidence loans made by us to borrowers that in turn make loans to others that are secured by real estate. The remaining commercial loans are secured by general business assets, accounts receivable and/or the personal guaranty of the borrower. The geographic concentration subjects the loan portfolio to the general economic conditions within this area. The risks created by such concentrations have been considered by management in the determination of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. Management believes the allowance for loan losses is adequate to cover estimated losses on loans as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

        The majority of our loan portfolio consists of commercial loans and commercial real estate loans. As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, commercial real estate loans represented approximately 33.5%, 34.6% and 33.8%, respectively, of our total loans. In addition, commercial loans represented approximately 32.2%, 32.5% and 31.1% as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        Sound risk management practices and appropriate levels of capital are essential elements of a sound commercial real estate lending program. Concentrations of commercial real estate exposures add a dimension of risk that compounds the risk inherent in individual loans. Interagency guidance on commercial real estate concentrations describe sound risk management practices which include board and management oversight, portfolio management, management information systems, market analysis, portfolio stress testing and sensitivity analysis, credit underwriting standards, and credit risk review functions. Management believes it has implemented these practices in order to monitor concentrations in commercial real estate in our loan portfolio.

        Large Credit Relationships.    As of June 30, 2014, the aggregate amount of loans to our 10 and 25 largest borrowers (including related entities) amounted to approximately $73.7 million, or 13.6% of total loans, and $142.1 million, or 26.3% of total loans, respectively. See "Risk Factors—Risk Related to Our Business—We have a significant amount of loans outstanding to a limited number of borrowers, which may increase our risk of loss."

        Loan Underwriting and Approval.    Our underwriting philosophy seeks to balance our desire to make sound, high quality loans while recognizing that lending money involves a degree of business risk. We have loan policies designed to assist us in managing this business risk. These policies provide a general framework for our loan origination, monitoring and funding activities, while recognizing that

49


Table of Contents

not all risks can be anticipated. Our board of directors delegates loan authority up to board-approved limits collectively to our Director's Loan Committee, comprised of two outside directors, and the members of the Executive Loan Committee, which is comprised of the Bank's Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, the Vice Chairman and the Chief Lending Officer (or other designee of executive management). Responsibility is then delegated to the Bank's loan officers and lending support staff, who are charged with executing this responsibility in a judicious manner. When the total relationship exceeds an individual's loan authority, approval of the Executive Loan Committee is required. Additionally, loans to individuals that would exceed $8.0 million in total relationship debt must also be approved by the Director's Loan Committee. Further, loans that exceed $12.5 million in total relationship debt must be approved by the full board of directors. The Director's Loan Committee also reviews all loans approved by the Executive Loan Committee which exceed $3.0 million in total relationship debt on a monthly basis. The objective of the Bank's approval process is to provide a disciplined, collaborative approach to larger credits while maintaining responsiveness to client needs.

        Loan decisions are documented as to the borrower's business, purpose of the loan, evaluation of the repayment source and the associated risks, evaluation of collateral, covenants and monitoring requirements, and the risk rating rationale. Our strategy for approving or disapproving loans is to follow conservative loan policies and consistent underwriting practices which include:

        Managing credit risk is a company-wide process. Our strategy for credit risk management includes well-defined, centralized credit policies, uniform underwriting criteria by loan type and ongoing risk monitoring and review processes for all types of credit exposures. Our processes emphasize early-stage review of loans, regular credit evaluations and management reviews of loans, which supplement the ongoing and proactive credit monitoring and loan servicing provided by our loan officers and lending support staff. Our Director's Loan Committee, Executive Loan Committee and our Chief Lending Officer provide company-wide credit oversight and periodically review all credit risk portfolios to ensure that the risk identification processes are functioning properly and that our credit standards are followed. In addition, a third-party loan review is performed at least annually to identify problem assets and confirm our internal risk rating of loans. We attempt to identify potential problem loans early in an effort to aggressively seek resolution of these situations before the loans become a loss, record any necessary charge-offs promptly and maintain adequate allowance levels for probable loan losses inherent in the loan portfolio.

        Our loan policies generally include other underwriting guidelines for loans collateralized by real estate. These underwriting standards are designed to determine the maximum loan amount that a borrower has the capacity to repay based upon the type of collateral securing the loan, borrower liquidity and historical and current market conditions relevant to the borrower's business and the type of real estate. Such loan policies include loan-to-value limits and loan terms tailored to the category of loans collateralized by liens on real estate.

50


Table of Contents

        In addition, our loan policies provide guidelines for personal guarantees, an environmental policy review, loans to employees, executive officers and directors, problem loan identification, maintenance of an adequate allowance for loan losses and other matters relating to lending practices.

        Lending Limits.    Our lending activities are subject to a variety of lending limits imposed by federal and state law. In general, the Bank is subject to a legal lending limit on loans to a single borrower based on the Bank's capital level. The dollar amounts of the Bank's lending limit increases or decreases as the Bank's capital increases or decreases. The Bank is able to sell participations in its larger loans to other financial institutions, which allows it to manage the risk involved in these loans and to meet the lending needs of its customers requiring extensions of credit in excess of these limits.

        The Bank's current legal lending limit on loans to a single borrower is approximately $15.0 million, which we expect to increase to $25.0 million following the consummation of this offering. Currently, we maintain an in-house limit of $12.5 million for loans to a single borrower. Exceptions to this limit may be made in the case of particularly strong credit. We currently have no relationships with an aggregate principal balance of more than $12.5 million. We require approval by two of three designated executive officers for new loans exceeding $1.5 million or renewals of existing loans exceeding $2.5 million. Further, all loan relationships over $5.0 million but less than $8.0 million to a single borrower must be approved by the Chief Executive Officer and Vice Chairman. The Director's Loan Committee must approve loan relationships over $8.0 million to $12.5 million. All loan relationships over $12.5 million must be approved by the board of directors. We have strict policies and procedures in place for the establishment of hold limits with respect to specific products and businesses and evaluating exceptions to the hold limits for individual relationships.

        Our loan policies provide general guidelines for loan-to-value ratios that restrict the size of loans to a maximum percentage of the value of the collateral securing the loans, which percentage varies by the type of collateral. Our internal loan-to-value limitations follow limits established by applicable law.

        Deposits are our principal source of funds for our interest earning assets. We believe that a critical component of our success is the importance we place on our deposit services. Market presidents and other key personnel are trained and incentivized to fully develop each relationship including asking our customers to bring their full relationship to the bank. We ensure our branches are staffed with skilled personnel to handle the needs of our customers. Delivering a "private bank" experience is an important component of our value proposition to our customers.

        Our services include the usual deposit functions of commercial banks, safe deposit facilities, commercial and personal banking services in addition to our loan offerings. We offer a variety of deposit products and services consistent with the goal of attracting a wide variety of customers, including high net worth individuals and small to medium-sized businesses. The types of deposit accounts we offer consist of demand, savings, money market and time accounts. We actively pursue business checking accounts by offering competitive rates, telephone banking, online banking and other convenient services to our customers. We also pursue commercial deposit accounts that will benefit from the utilization of our treasury management services. Through our marketing focus on relationship banking, more than 84.0% of our commercial loan customers have deposit relationships with us as of June 30, 2014.

        We believe core deposit relationships are critical to building franchise value. As of June 30, 2014, we held $236.2 million in noninterest-bearing deposits and $554.5 million in core deposits. As of December 31, 2013, we have grown our total deposits and our noninterest-bearing deposits organically at a compound annual growth rate of 25.4% and 39.4%, respectively, since December 31, 2011.

51


Table of Contents

        We offer banking products and services that are attractively priced and easily understood by the customer, with a focus on convenience and accessibility. We offer a full suite of online banking solutions including access to account balances, online transfers, online bill payment and electronic delivery of customer statements, as well as ATMs, and banking by telephone, mail and personal appointment. We also offer debit cards, night depository, direct deposit, cashier's checks, and letters of credit, as well as treasury management services including wire transfer services and automated clearinghouse services.

        We are currently focused on expanding noninterest income though increased income from our treasury management service. We offer a full array of commercial treasury management services designed to be competitive with banks of all sizes. Treasury Management Services include balance reporting (including current day and previous day activity), transfers between accounts, wire transfer initiation, automated clearinghouse origination and stop payments. Cash management deposit products consist of lockbox, remote deposit capture, positive pay, reverse positive pay, account reconciliation services, zero balance accounts, and sweep accounts including loan sweep.

Investments

        The primary objectives of our investment policy are to provide a source of liquidity, to provide an appropriate return on funds invested, to manage interest rate risk, to meet pledging requirements and to meet regulatory capital requirements.

        As of June 30, 2014, the book value of our investment portfolio totaled $50.5 million, with an average yield of 1.73% and an estimated duration of approximately 2.17 years.

        Our board of directors and Asset-Liability Committee are responsible for the regular review of our investment activities and the review and approval of our investment policy. Day-to-day transactions affecting our investment securities portfolio are managed by our Chief Financial Officer in accordance with the guidelines set forth in our investment policy. These investment activities are reviewed regularly by our board of directors and Asset-Liability Committee.

        Our investment policy outlines investment type limitations, security mix parameters, authorization guidelines and risk management guidelines. The policy authorizes us to invest in a variety of investment securities, subject to various limitations. Our current investment portfolio consists of obligations of the U.S. Treasury and other U.S. government agencies or sponsored entities, including mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations.

Our Market Area

        We currently operate in the Dallas metropolitan area, which is part of the broader Dallas-Fort Worth-Arlington metropolitan statistical area, which we refer to as the Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area. The Dallas economy is fueled by the real estate, technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing, health care and energy sectors. This market is among the most vibrant in the United States with a rapidly growing population, a high level of job growth, an affordable cost of living and a pro-growth business climate. More broadly, Texas is also experiencing significant population and employment growth on a statewide basis.

52


Table of Contents

Information Technology Systems

        We continue to make significant investments in our information technology systems for our banking and lending operations and treasury management activities. We believe this is a necessary investment in order to enhance our capabilities to offer new products and overall customer experience, to provide scale for future growth and acquisitions, and to increase controls and efficiencies in our back office operations. We outsource our core data processing services to a nationally recognized bank software vendor providing us with capabilities to support the continued growth of the Bank. Our internal network and e-mail systems are maintained in-house. We leverage the capabilities of a third party service provider to provide the technical expertise around network design and architecture that is required for us to operate as an effective and efficient organization. We actively manage our business continuity plan. We follow all recommendations outlined by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council to ensure that we have effectively identified our risks and documented contingency plans for key functions and systems including providing for back up sites for all critical applications. We perform tests to ensure the adequacy of these contingency plans.

        The majority of our other systems, including our electronic funds transfer, transaction processing and online banking services, are hosted by third-party service providers. The scalability of this infrastructure is designed to support our growth strategy. These critical business applications and processes are included in the business continuity plans referenced above.

Competition

        The banking business is highly competitive, and our profitability will depend principally upon our ability to compete with other banks and non-bank financial institutions located in the Dallas

53


Table of Contents

metropolitan area for lending opportunities, deposit funds, bankers and acquisition candidates. Our banking competitors in our target markets include Chase Bank, Wells Fargo, Bank of America, BBVA Compass, Amegy Bank, Comerica Bank, Regions Bank, Prosperity Bank, Independent Bank, Texas Capital Bank and various community banks.

        We are subject to vigorous competition in all aspects of our business from banks, savings banks, savings and loan associations, finance companies, credit unions and other providers of financial services, such as money market mutual funds, brokerage firms, consumer finance companies, asset-based non-bank lenders, insurance companies and certain other non-financial entities, including retail stores which may maintain their own credit programs and certain governmental organizations which may offer more favorable financing than we can.

        Many of the banks and other financial institutions with which we compete have significantly greater financial strength, marketing capability and name recognition than us and operate on a statewide, regional or nationwide basis. These institutions are also likely to have legal loan limits substantially in excess of those that we maintain. Such institutions can perform certain functions for their customers, including trust, securities brokerage and international banking services, which we presently do not offer directly. Although we may offer these services through correspondent banks, the inability to provide such services directly may be a competitive disadvantage and this may affect our ability to generate business, attract experienced bankers and capitalize on acquisition opportunities.

        In addition, recent developments in technology and mass marketing have permitted larger companies to market loans and other products and services more aggressively to our small business customers. Such advantages may enable our competitors to realize greater economies of scale and operating efficiencies than we can. Further, some of the non-bank competitors are not subject to the same extensive regulations that govern the Company and the Bank. Various legislative acts in recent years have led to increased competition among financial institutions and competition from both financial and non-financial institutions is expected to continue. See "Risk Factors—We face strong competition from financial services companies and other companies that offer banking services, which could impact our business."

        We have been able to compete effectively with other financial institutions by providing a high level of personalized banking service to professionals and owner-operated businesses and by emphasizing quick and flexible responses to customer demands, establishing long-term customer relationships and building customer loyalty, and by offering products and services designed to address the specific needs of our customers. We rely heavily on the continued business generation of our bankers and the efforts of our officers and directors for the solicitation and referral of potential customers and we expect this to continue for the foreseeable future.

Employees

        As of June 30, 2014, we had 120 full-time employees and six part-time employees. None of our employees are represented by a union. Management believes that our relationship with employees is good.

Properties

        Our principal offices are located at 8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 400, Dallas, Texas 75225. All of our branches are located in Texas. We own two of our branch locations and lease the remaining seven locations. The terms of our leases range from five to 10 years and generally give us the option to renew for subsequent terms of equal duration or otherwise extend the lease term subject to price adjustment

54


Table of Contents

based on market conditions at the time of renewal. The following table sets forth a list of our locations as of the date of this prospectus.

Branch Locations  
Location
  Own or Lease   Sq. Ft.  

Park Branch

  Own     8,500  

5049 W. Park Boulevard
Plano, Texas 75093

           

Royal Branch

 

Own

   
3,938
 

10703 Preston Road
Dallas, Texas 75230

           

Westchester Branch

 

Lease

   
14,396
 

8214 Westchester Drive
Suite 100
Dallas, Texas 75225

           

SMU Branch

 

Lease

   
3,714
 

6116 N. Central Expressway
Suite 100
Dallas, Texas 75206

           

Lakewood Branch

 

Lease

   
4,473
 

2101 Abrams Road
Dallas, Texas 75214

           

Garland Branch

 

Lease

   
5,195
 

622 Clara Barton Boulevard
Garland, Texas 75042

           

Alexis Branch

 

Lease

   
3,200
 

14885 Preston Road
Dallas, Texas 75254

           

Las Colinas Branch

 

Lease

   
7,630
 

300 E. John Carpenter Freeway
Suite 100, Wingren and 114
Irving, Texas 75062

           

 

Other Non-Banking Locations  
Location
  Own or Lease   Sq. Ft.  

Veritex Mortgage

  Lease     2,462  

7001 Preston Road
Suite 100
Dallas, Texas 75205

           

        Our operational support functions are located at our Lakewood and Park Branch facilities. Our Westchester location houses management and staff totaling approximately 40 people with the capacity to significantly increase staffing within the existing space. In addition, certain mortgage functions are performed out of the Veritex Mortgage location. In June 2014, we acquired two parcels located at 2700 and 2706 Oak Lawn that we expect to serve as the new location of our existing Las Colinas Branch.

55


Table of Contents

Legal Proceedings

        We are not currently subject to any material legal proceedings. We are from time to time subject to claims and litigation arising in the ordinary course of business. These claims and litigation may include, among other things, allegations of violation of banking and other applicable regulations, competition law, labor laws and consumer protection laws, as well as claims or litigation relating to intellectual property, securities, breach of contract and tort. We intend to defend ourselves vigorously against any pending or future claims and litigation.

        At this time, in the opinion of management, the likelihood is remote that the impact of such proceedings, either individually or in the aggregate, would have a material adverse effect on our combined results of operations, financial condition or cash flows. However, one or more unfavorable outcomes in any claim or litigation against us could have a material adverse effect for the period in which they are resolved. In addition, regardless of their merits or their ultimate outcomes, such matters are costly, divert management's attention and may materially adversely affect our reputation, even if resolved in our favor.

56


Table of Contents


MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

        The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with "Selected Consolidated Financial Data" and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that are subject to certain risks and uncertainties and are based on certain assumptions that we believe are reasonable but may prove to be inaccurate. Certain risks, uncertainties and other factors, including those set forth under "Forward-Looking Statements," "Risk Factors" and elsewhere in this prospectus, may cause actual results to differ materially from those projected results discussed in the forward-looking statements appearing in this discussion and analysis. We assume no obligation to update any of these forward-looking statements.

Overview

        We are a bank holding company headquartered in Dallas, Texas. Through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state chartered bank, we provide relationship-driven commercial banking products and services tailored to meet the needs of small to medium-sized businesses and professionals. Since our inception, we have targeted customers and focused our acquisitions primarily in the Dallas metropolitan area, which we consider to be Dallas and the adjacent communities in North Dallas. As we continue to grow, we expect to expand our primary market to include the broader Dallas-Fort Worth metropolitan area, which would include Fort Worth and Arlington, as well as the communities adjacent to those cities. We currently operate eight branches and one mortgage office, all of which are located in the Dallas metropolitan area. We have experienced significant organic growth since commencing banking operations in 2010 and have successfully acquired and integrated three banks. As of June 30, 2014, we had total assets of $710.4 million, total loans of $541.0 million, total deposits of $611.2 million and total stockholders' equity of $74.2 million.

        The comparability of our consolidated results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 is affected by the two acquisitions that we completed in 2011. We acquired Fidelity Resources Company and its wholly-owned subsidiary, Fidelity Bank, on March 23, 2011, and Bank of Las Colinas on October 26, 2011. Therefore, the results of the acquired operations of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas were included in our results of operations for only a portion of 2011, compared to the full year in 2012 and 2013.

        As a bank holding company operating through one segment, community banking, we generate most of our revenues from interest income on loans, customer service and loan fees, gains on sale of mortgage loans, and interest income from securities. We incur interest expense on deposits and other borrowed funds and noninterest expense, such as salaries and employee benefits and occupancy expenses. We analyze our ability to maximize income generated from interest earning assets and expense of our liabilities through our net interest margin. Net interest margin is a ratio calculated as net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets. Net interest income is the difference between interest income on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings, which are used to fund those assets.

        Changes in the market interest rates and interest rates we earn on interest-earning assets or pay on interest-bearing liabilities, as well as the volume and types of interest-earning assets, interest-bearing and noninterest-bearing liabilities and stockholders' equity, are usually the largest drivers of periodic changes in net interest spread, net interest margin and net interest income. Fluctuations in market interest rates are driven by many factors, including governmental monetary policies, inflation, deflation, macroeconomic developments, changes in unemployment, the money supply, political and international conditions and conditions in domestic and foreign financial markets. Periodic changes in the volume and types of loans in our loan portfolio are affected by, among other factors, economic and competitive

57


Table of Contents

conditions in Texas and specifically in the Dallas metropolitan area, as well as developments affecting the real estate, technology, financial services, insurance, transportation, manufacturing and energy sectors within our target market and throughout the state of Texas.

Results of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

Net Interest Income

        Our operating results depend primarily on our net interest income, calculated as the difference between interest income on interest-earning assets, such as loans and securities, and interest expense on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Fluctuations in market interest rates impact the yield and rates paid on interest sensitive assets and liabilities. Changes in the amount and type of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities also impact net interest income. The variance driven by the changes in the amount and mix of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities is referred to as a "volume change." Changes in yields earned on interest-earning assets and rates paid on interest-bearing deposits and other borrowed funds are referred to as a "rate change."

        To evaluate net interest income, we measure and monitor (1) yields on our loans and other interest-earning assets, (2) the costs of our deposits and other funding sources, (3) our net interest spread and (4) our net interest margin. Net interest spread is the difference between rates earned on interest-earning assets and rates paid on interest-bearing liabilities. Net interest margin is a ratio calculated as net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets. Because noninterest-bearing sources of funds, such as noninterest-bearing deposits and stockholders' equity also fund interest-earning assets, net interest margin includes the benefit of these noninterest-bearing sources.

        For the six months ended June 30, 2014, net interest income totaled $11.8 million, and net interest margin and net interest spread were 3.86% and 3.57%, respectively. For the six months ended June 30, 2013, net interest income totaled $10.0 million and net interest margin and net interest spread were 4.02% and 3.87%, respectively. The decreases in net interest margin and net interest spread were primarily attributable to the decrease in the average yield on the loan portfolio due to the low interest rate environment and its impact on competitive loan pricing. While we have experienced significant growth in average loan balances, market yields on new loan originations are below the average yield of amortizing or paid-off loans. Due to the continued impact of new loan growth and the runoff of higher yielding loan balances, we anticipate continued pressure on our net interest margin and net interest spread. Changes in rates paid on interest-bearing deposits for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and June 30, 2013 had a minimal impact on the net interest margin.

        The following table presents, for the periods indicated, an analysis of net interest income by each major category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, the average amounts outstanding and the interest earned or paid on such amounts. The table also sets forth the average rate earned on interest-earning assets, the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities, and the net interest margin on average total interest-earning assets for the same periods. Interest earned on loans that are classified as non-accrual is not recognized in income, however the balances are reflected in average outstanding balances for the period. For the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, interest

58


Table of Contents

income not recognized on non-accrual loans was not material. Any non-accrual loans have been included in the table as loans carrying a zero yield.

 
  For the Six Months Ended June 30,  
 
  2014   2013  
 
  Average
Outstanding
Balance
  Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
  Average
Yield/
Rate
  Average
Outstanding
Balance
  Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
  Average
Yield/
Rate
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands) (Unaudited)
 

Assets

                                     

Interest-earning assets:

                                     

Total loans(1)

  $ 508,836   $ 12,718     5.04 % $ 409,217   $ 10,918     5.38 %

Securities available for sale

    50,186     422     1.70     33,295     280     1.70  

Investment in subsidiary

    93     1     2.17     93     1     2.17  

Interest-bearing deposits in other banks

    57,948     77     0.27     61,532     60     0.20  
                           

Total interest-earning assets

    617,063     13,218     4.32     504,137     11,259     4.50 %

Allowance for loan losses

    (5,205 )               (3,602 )            

Noninterest-earning assets

    59,668                 55,381              
                                   

Total assets

  $ 671,526               $ 555,916              
                                   
                                   

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

                                     

Interest-bearing liabilities:

                                     

Interest-bearing deposits

  $ 357,320   $ 1,161     0.66 % $ 294,172   $ 1,060     0.73 %

Advances from FHLB

    15,000     59     0.79     14,861     125     1.70  

Other borrowings

    8,072     192     4.80     3,093     31     2.02  
                           

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    380,392     1,412     0.75     312,126     1,216     0.79  
                           

Noninterest-bearing liabilities:

                                     

Noninterest-bearing deposits

    216,721                 178,186              

Other liabilities

    1,494                 1,877              
                                   

Total noninterest-bearing liabilities

    218,215                 180,063              

Stockholders' equity

    72,919                 63,727              
                                   

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 671,526               $ 555,916              
                                   
                                   

Net interest rate spread(2)

                3.57 %               3.72 %

Net interest income

        $ 11,806               $ 10,043        
                                   
                                   

Net interest margin(3)

                3.86 %               4.02 %

(1)
Includes average outstanding balances of loans held for sale of $2,855 and $2,802 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

(2)
Net interest spread is the average yield on interest-earning assets minus the average rate on interest-bearing liabilities.

(3)
Net interest margin is equal to net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.

        The following table presents information regarding the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for the periods indicated for each major component of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and distinguishes between the changes attributable to changes in

59


Table of Contents

volume and changes attributable to changes in interest rates. For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume that cannot be segregated have been allocated to rate.

 
  For the Six Months
Ended June 30, 2014
compared to 2013
 
 
  Increase (Decrease)
due to
   
 
 
  Volume   Rate   Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)

 

Interest-earning assets:

                   

Total loans

  $ 2,658   $ (858 ) $ 1,800  

Securities available for sale

    142         142  

Interest-earning deposits in other banks

    (3 )   20     17  
               

Total increase (decrease) in interest income

    2,797     (838 )   1,959  
               
               

Interest-bearing liabilities:

                   

Interest-bearing deposits

    228     (127 )   101  

Advances from FHLB

    1     (67 )   (66 )

Other borrowings

    50     111     161  
               

Total increase (decrease) in interest expense

    279     (83 )   196  
               

Increase (decrease) in net interest income

  $ 2,518   $ (755 ) $ 1,763  
               
               

Provision for Loan Losses

        Our provision for loan losses is a charge to income in order to bring our allowance for loan losses to a level deemed appropriate by management. For a description of the factors taken into account by management in determining the allowance for loan losses see "—Financial Condition—Allowance for Loan Losses." The provision for loan losses was $677,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared to $1.0 million for the same period in 2013, a decrease of $323,000 or 32.3%. The decrease in provision expense was due to a reduction in the level of specific reserves needed to cover classified loans and a lower amount of expense required to replenish the reserve from the net charge-off to loans. This reduction was partially offset by general reserves needed to cover the amount of growth in the loan portfolio.

Noninterest Income

        Our primary sources of recurring noninterest income are service charges on deposit accounts, gains on the sale of loans and other real estate owned and income from bank-owned life insurance. Noninterest income does not include loan origination fees to the extent they exceed the direct loan origination costs, which are generally recognized over the life of the related loan as an adjustment to yield using the interest method.

60


Table of Contents

        The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the major categories of noninterest income:

 
  For the Six
Months Ended
June 30,
   
 
 
  Increase
(Decrease)
 
 
  2014   2013  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)

 

Noninterest income:

                   

Service charges on deposit accounts

  $ 396   $ 369   $ 27  

Gain on sales of loans held for sale

    245     424     (179 )

Gain on sales of other real estate owned

    37     17     20  

Bank-owned life insurance income

    212     166     46  

Gain on sales of investment securities

    34         34  

Other

    287     330     (43 )
               

Total noninterest income

  $ 1,211   $ 1,306   $ (95 )
               
               

        Noninterest income for the six months ended June 30, 2014 decreased $95,000 or 7.3% to $1.2 million compared to noninterest income of $1.3 million for the same period in 2013. The primary components of the decrease were as follows:

        Service charges on deposit accounts.    We earn fees from our customers for deposit-related services, and these fees constitute a significant and predictable component of our noninterest income. Service charges on deposit accounts were $396,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014, an increase of $27,000 over the same period in 2013. This increase was primarily attributable to an increase in merchant and debit card fees of $11,000, an increase in stop payment fees of $10,000 and the growth in the number of deposit accounts, fees and related balances.

        Gain on sales of loans.    We originate long-term fixed-rate mortgage loans for resale into the secondary market. Our mortgage originations were $18.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 compared to $23.7 million for the six months ended June 30, 2013. Income from the sales of loans was $245,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 compared to $424,000 for the same period of 2013. This decrease of $179,000 was primarily due to decreases in the number of loans sold and average gain per sale. For the six months ended June 30, 2013, 70 loans were sold at an average gain of $6,000 per loan compared to 45 loan sales at an average gain of $5,400 per loan for the same period of 2014.

        Gain on sales of other real estate owned.    Gain on sales of other real estate owned was $37,000 and $17,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. This increase of $20,000 or 117.6% was due to the sale of three properties in 2014 for an overall net gain of $37,000 versus the sale of two properties in the same period of 2013 at a total net gain of $17,000.

        Bank-owned life insurance income.    We invest in bank-owned life insurance due to its attractive nontaxable return and protection against the loss of our key employees. We record income based on the growth of the cash surrender value of these policies as well as the annual yield. Income from bank-owned life insurance increased $46,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared to the same period in 2013. The increase in income was primarily attributable to the purchase of $5.0 million in additional bank-owned life insurance on March 25, 2013. We earned tax equivalent yields on these policies of 4.92% for the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared to 5.61% for the same period in 2013. The decline in yield over the period was the result of a decline in market interest rates.

        Other.    This category includes a variety of other income producing activities, including late charges, wire transfer fees, and revenue from other real estate owned. Other income decreased $43,000

61


Table of Contents

or 13.0% for the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared to the same period in 2013, primarily due to a decrease of $9,500 in wire transfer fees and a decrease $21,000 in revenue from other real estate owned.

Noninterest Expense

        Generally, noninterest expense is composed of all employee expenses and costs associated with operating our facilities, obtaining and retaining customer relationships and providing bank services. The major component of noninterest expense is salaries and employee benefits. Noninterest expense also includes operational expenses, such as occupancy expenses, depreciation and amortization of office equipment, professional and regulatory fees, including FDIC assessments, data processing expenses, and advertising and promotion expenses.

        The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the major categories of noninterest expense:

 
  For the Six
Months Ended
June 30,
   
 
 
  Increase
(Decrease)
 
 
  2014   2013  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
(Unaudited)

 

Salaries and employee benefits

  $ 4,838   $ 4,446   $ 392  

Non-staff expenses:

                   

Occupancy of bank premises

    920     830     90  

Depreciation and amortization

    667     607     60  

Data processing

    426     358     68  

FDIC assessment fees

    217     186     31  

Legal fees

    59     48     11  

Other professional fees

    543     274     269  

Advertising and promotions

    93     78     15  

Utilities and telephone

    141     143     (2 )

Other real estate owned expenses and write-downs

    134     243     (109 )

Other

    956     895     61  
               

Total noninterest expense

  $ 8,994   $ 8,108   $ 886  
               
               

        Noninterest expense for the six months ended June 30, 2014 increased $886,000 or 10.9% to $9.0 million compared to noninterest expense of $8.1 million for the same period in 2013. The most significant components of the increase were as follows:

        Salaries and employee benefits.    Salaries and employee benefits are the largest component of noninterest expense and include payroll expense, the cost of incentive compensation, benefit plans, health insurance and payroll taxes. Salaries and employee benefits were $4.8 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014, an increase of $392,000 or 8.8% compared to the same period in 2013. The increase was primarily attributable to the addition of nine full-time equivalent employees since June 30, 2013. As of June 30, 2014, we had 120 full-time equivalent employees and six part-time employees. Salaries and employee benefits included $165,000 and $160,000 in stock-based compensation expense for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

62


Table of Contents

        Occupancy of bank premises.    Our expense associated with occupancy of bank premises was $920,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 compared to $830,000 for the same period of 2013. This increase of $90,000 or 10.8% was due primarily to lease expense increase of $46,000 related to an additional 3,500 square feet resulting from the expansion of our corporate office space, a $24,000 increase in common area maintenance expense, and a $13,000 increase in grounds maintenance.

        Depreciation and amortization.    Depreciation and amortization costs were $667,000 and $607,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. This category includes building, leasehold, furniture, fixtures and equipment depreciation totaling $520,000 and $460,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, as well as intangible asset amortization of $147,000 for the same periods. The increase of $60,000 or 9.9% was due to depreciation from additional furniture and technology equipment purchases.

        Data processing.    Data processing expenses were $426,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and $358,000 for the same period in 2013. The increase of $68,000 or 19.0% was attributable to incremental processing fees resulting from the growth in the volume of our deposit accounts.

        FDIC assessment fees.    Our FDIC assessment fees were $217,000 and $186,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The increase of $31,000 or 16.7% was a result of the growth in assets over this period.

        Legal fees.    Legal fees were $59,000 and $48,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The increase of $11,000 or 22.9% was due to an increase in loan work-out related legal support.

        Other professional fees.    Other professional fees include audit, loan review, regulatory assessments, and information technology services. These fees were $543,000 and $274,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. This increase of $269,000 or 98.2% was primarily attributable to increased audit and accounting fees of $140,000 for services related to our initial public offering and an $81,000 increase in professional services for a compensation analysis and review.

        Other real estate owned expenses and write-downs.    Expenses related to other real estate owned were $134,000 and $243,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The decrease of $109,000 or 44.9% was due to a reduction in the number of properties comprising other real estate owned and in related property write-downs. The bank sold six other real estate owned properties and foreclosed on three additional properties between June 30, 2013 and June 30, 2014 reducing the number of properties held from seven as of June 30, 2013, to four as of June 30, 2014. In addition, we had no write-downs of other real estate owned for the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared to a write-down of $137,000 related to a commercial retail property for the six months ended June 30, 2013.

        Other.    This category includes operating and administrative expenses including small hardware and software purchases, business development expenses (i.e. travel and entertainment, donations and club memberships), insurance and security expenses. Other noninterest expense increased $61,000 or 6.8% to $956,000 for the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared to $895,000 for the same period in 2013 primarily related to an increase in software expenses, security expenses and business development related expenses required to support our marketing efforts.

Income Tax Expense

        The amount of income tax expense is influenced by the amounts of our pre-tax income, tax-exempt income and other nondeductible expenses. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are reflected at currently enacted income tax rates in effect for the period in which the deferred tax assets and liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and

63


Table of Contents

liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized.

        For the six months ended June 30, 2014, income tax expense totaled $1.2 million, an increase of $416,000 or 53.7% compared to $774,000 for the same period in 2013. The increase was primarily attributable to the $1.1 million increase in net operating income from $2.2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2013 to $3.3 million for the same period in 2014. Our effective tax rates for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 were 35.6% and 34.7%, respectively. Our effective tax rates for both periods were affected primarily by tax-exempt income generated by bank-owned life insurance and other nondeductible expenses.

Results of Operations For the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

Net Interest Income

        For additional information on net interest income and how we measure and monitor it, see "—Results of Operations for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013—Net Interest Income."

        2013 vs. 2012.    Net interest income for 2013 was $21.0 million compared to $19.1 million for 2012, an increase of $1.9 million or 9.95%. The increase in net interest income was primarily due to a $2.1 million or 9.8% increase in interest income, which was partially offset by a $164,000 or 7.1% increase in interest expense. The growth in interest income was primarily attributable to a $91.5 million or 26.7% increase in average loans outstanding for the year ended December 31, 2013, compared to 2012, partially offset by a 62 basis point decrease in the yield on interest-earning assets. The increase in average loans outstanding was due to an increase in new customer accounts and an increase in existing customer balances. The decrease in the average yield on the loan portfolio was primarily due to the low interest rate environment and its impact on competitive loan pricing. While we experienced significant growth in average loan balances, market yields on new loan originations were below the average yield of amortizing or paid-off loans. Due to the continued impact of new loan growth and the runoff of higher yielding loan balances, we anticipate continued interest rate pressure on our total interest-earning assets. The decline in average loan yields is also the result of a reduction in deferred loan fees and a declining purchase discount accretion. Interest income on loans was $22.8 million for 2013, an increase of $2.2 million or 10.7% compared to 2012 due to the increase in average loans outstanding. Interest income on securities was $613,000 during 2013, a decrease of $42,000 over 2012, due to the continued low rate environment. Investment portfolio purchases during 2013 were targeted short duration, low price risk mortgage-backed securities, which provided lower yields.

        Interest expense was $2.5 million for 2013, an increase of $164,000 over 2012. Average interest-bearing deposits increased $44.0 million for 2013 compared to 2012, $36.7 million of which resulted from increases in money market balances. The average rate on interest-bearing deposits decreased from 0.74% to 0.71% for the same period, resulting in a $29,000 decrease in related interest expense. Average certificates and other time deposits increased $7.8 million for 2013 compared to 2012, $5.0 million of which resulted from the purchase of six month brokered deposits, and the average rate decreased from 1.10% to 1.06% for the same period, resulting in a decrease in related interest expense of $48,000.

        Net interest income was also materially impacted by a $49.3 million or 35.4% increase in average noninterest-bearing deposits during 2013, which was primarily attributable to growth in customer relationships and noninterest-bearing checking accounts. Total cost of funds decreased 12 basis points to 0.44% for the year ended December 31, 2013 from 0.56% for the year ended December 31, 2012. Net interest margin, defined as net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets, for 2013 was 3.96%, a decrease of 54 basis points compared to 4.50% for 2012.

64


Table of Contents

        2012 vs. 2011.    Net interest income for 2012 was $19.1 million compared to $12.6 million for 2011, an increase of $6.5 million or 51.6%. The increase in net interest income was primarily due to a $6.5 million or 43.9% increase in interest income, as interest expense remained flat year over year. The growth in interest income was primarily attributable to a $125.1 million or 57.6% increase in average loans outstanding for 2012, compared to 2011, which was primarily due to the acquisition of Fidelity Bank in March 2011 and Bank of Las Colinas in October 2011. The growth in interest income was also impacted by an increase of 17 basis points in our yield on interest-earning assets, which resulted primarily for a shift in the composition of our interest-earning assets from investment securities to loans, although our average yield on loans decreased 19 basis points year over year. The decrease in the average yield on the loan portfolio was primarily due to the low interest rate environment and its impact on competitive pricing for new loan originations compared to rates on runoff of the higher yielding loans. Interest income on loans was $20.6 million for 2012, an increase of $7.1 million or 52.6% compared to 2011 due to the increase in average loans outstanding. Interest income on securities was $655,000 during 2012, a decrease of $632,000 from 2011, due to a decrease in average balances of the investment portfolio. Specifically, we sold certain low yielding securities and reinvested the proceeds of the sale in higher yielding loans.

        The average balance of interest-bearing liabilities increased by $54.1 million or 24.8% in 2012, compared to 2011, although the average rate on interest-bearing liabilities decreased 21 basis points, resulting in total interest expense remaining flat year over year at $2.3 million. Average interest-bearing demand deposits, money market and savings accounts increased $42.4 million for 2012 compared to 2011 due to the acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas ($33.5 million of the increase resulted from increase in money market accounts) but were partially offset by a decrease in the average rate on interest-bearing demand deposits, money market and savings accounts from 0.72% to 0.55% for the same time period. Average certificates and other time deposits increased by $11.1 million or 14.3% in 2012 compared to 2011. A majority of this increase was due to growth in certificates of deposits greater than $100,000, which was partially offset by a decrease in the average rate on time deposits from 1.15% in 2011 to 1.10% in 2012.

        Net interest income was also impacted by a $58.4 million or 72.3% increase in average noninterest-bearing deposits during 2012, which was primarily attributable to the two bank acquisitions, coupled with growth in customer relationships and noninterest-bearing checking accounts. Total cost of funds decreased 21 basis points to 0.56% for 2012 from 0.77% for 2011. Net interest margin for 2012 was 4.50%, an increase of 38 basis points compared to 4.12% for 2011.

        The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the total dollar amount of average balances, interest income from average interest-earning assets and the resultant yields, as well as the interest expense on average interest-bearing liabilities, expressed both in dollars and rates. Average

65


Table of Contents

balances for 2013 and 2012 are daily average balances and average balances for 2011 are monthly average balances. Any non-accrual loans have been included in the table as loans carrying a zero yield.

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  
 
  Average
Outstanding
Balance
  Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
  Average
Yield/
Rate
  Average
Outstanding
Balance
  Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
  Average
Yield/
Rate
  Average
Outstanding
Balance
  Interest
Earned/
Interest
Paid
  Average
Yield/
Rate
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Assets

                                                       

Interest-earning assets:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Total loans(1)

  $ 433,612   $ 22,755     5.25 % $ 342,130   $ 20,619     6.03 % $ 217,064   $ 13,494     6.22 %

Securities available for sale

   
37,066
   
613
   
1.65
   
34,496
   
655
   
1.90
   
65,243
   
1,287
   
1.97
 

Investment in subsidiary

    93     2     2.15     93     8     8.60     72     5     6.94  

Interest-earning deposits in financial institutions

   
60,931
   
132
   
0.22
   
47,813
   
108
   
0.23
   
22,483
   
73
   
0.32
 
                                       

Total interest-earning assets

    531,702     23,502     4.42     424,532     21,390     5.04     304,862     14,859     4.87  

Allowance for loan losses

   
(4,047

)
             
(1,924

)
             
(824

)
           

Noninterest-earning assets

   
56,411
               
50,185
               
43,803
             
                                                   

Total assets

  $ 584,066               $ 472,793               $ 347,841              
                                                   
                                                   

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

                                                       

Interest-bearing liabilities:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Interest-bearing deposits

  $ 311,162   $ 2,207     0.71 % $ 259,278   $ 1,911     0.74 % $ 205,791   $ 1,817     0.88 %

Advances from FHLB

    14,932     190     1.27     10,000     314     3.14     10,000     312     3.12  

Other borrowings

    3,207     63     1.96     3,093     72     2.33     2,398     163     6.80  
                                       

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    329,301     2,460     0.75     272,371     2,297     0.84     218,189     2,292     1.05  
                                       

Noninterest-bearing liabilities:

                                                       

Noninterest-bearing deposits

    188,405                 139,128                 80,761              

Other liabilities

    1,714                 1,400                 1,538              
                                                   

Total noninterest-bearing liabilities           

    190,119                 140,528                 82,299              

Stockholders' equity

    64,646                 59,894                 47,353              
                                                   

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 584,066               $ 472,793               $ 347,841              
                                                   
                                                   

Net interest rate spread(2)

                3.67 %               4.20 %               3.82 %

Net interest income

        $ 21,042               $ 19,093               $ 12,567        
                                                   
                                                   

Net interest margin(3)

                3.96 %               4.50 %               4.12 %

(1)
Includes average outstanding balances of loans held for sale of $2.2 million, $741,000 for 2013 and 2012. There were no loans held for sale in 2011.

(2)
Net interest spread is the average yield on interest-earning assets minus the average rate on interest-bearing liabilities.

(3)
Net interest margin is equal to net interest income divided by average interest-earning assets.

66


Table of Contents

        The following table presents information regarding the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for the periods indicated for each major component of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities and distinguishes between the changes attributable to changes in volume and changes attributable to changes in interest rates. For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume which cannot be segregated have been allocated to rate.

 
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013 vs. 2012   2012 vs. 2011  
 
  Increase
(Decrease)
Due to Change in
   
  Increase
(Decrease)
Due to Change in
   
 
 
  Volume   Rate   Total   Volume   Rate   Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Interest-earning assets:

                                     

Total loans

  $ 5,513   $ (3,377 ) $ 2,136   $ 7,775   $ (650 ) $ 7,125  

Securities available for sale

    49     (91 )   (42 )   (606 )   (26 )   (632 )

Investment in subsidiary

        (6 )   (6 )   1     2     3  

Interest-earning deposits in other banks

    30     (6 )   24     82     (47 )   35  
                           

Total increase (decrease) in interest income

  $ 5,592   $ (3,480 ) $ 2,112   $ 7,252   $ (721 ) $ 6,531  
                           
                           

Interest-bearing liabilities:

                                     

Interest-bearing deposits

  $ 327   $ (31 ) $ 296   $ 434   $ (340 ) $ 94  

Advances from FHLB

    155     (279 )   (124 )       2     2  

Other borrowings

    3     (12 )   (9 )   47     (138 )   (91 )
                           

Total increase (decrease) in interest expense

    485     (322 )   163     481     (476 )   5  
                           

Increase (decrease) in net interest income

  $ 5,107   $ (3,158 ) $ 1,949   $ 6,771   $ (245 ) $ 6,526  
                           
                           

Provision for Loan Losses

        The provision for loan losses for the year ended December 31, 2013 was $1.9 million compared to $3.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The decrease in provision expense was due to a reduction in the level of specific reserves needed to cover classified loans and a lower amount of expense required to replenish the reserve from the net charge-off of loans. This reduction was partially offset by general reserves needed to cover the amount of growth in the loan portfolio. Net charge-offs for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 were $103,000 and $727,000, respectively. This decrease of 86.0% reflected a decrease in gross charge-offs from $801,000 for the year ended December 31, 2012 to $240,000 for the year ended December 31, 2013 and an increase in recoveries from $74,000 for the year ended December 31, 2012 to $137,000 for the year ended December 31, 2013. The decrease in net charge-offs was largely a result of improvement in the quality of our loan portfolio.

67


Table of Contents

Noninterest Income

        For the year ended December 31, 2013, noninterest income totaled $2.4 million, an increase of $744,000 or 45.2% compared to 2012. The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the major categories of noninterest income:

 
  For the Years Ended
December 31,
  Increase (Decrease)  
 
  2013   2012   2011   2013 v 2012   2012 v 2011  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Noninterest income:

                               

Service charges on deposit accounts          

  $ 726   $ 700   $ 563   $ 26   $ 137  

Gain on sales of loans

    632     248         384     248  

Gain on sales of other real estate owned

    20     61     43     (41 )   18  

Bank-owned life insurance income

    385     180         205     180  

Gain on sales of investment securities          

            421         (421 )

Other

    628     458     250     170     208  
                       

Total noninterest income

  $ 2,391   $ 1,647   $ 1,277   $ 744   $ 370  
                       
                       

        Service charges on deposit accounts.    Service charges on deposit accounts increased $26,000 or 3.7% in 2013 compared to 2012 primarily due to the increase in the number of deposit accounts from organic deposit growth. The increase of $137,000 or 24.3% in 2012 compared to 2011 was due primarily to a full year of service charge income on the deposit accounts acquired in 2011 from Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas. The number of deposit accounts increased by 793 or 11.8% from 6,746 to 7,539 between December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2012, and 683 or 9.1% from 7,539 to 8,222 between December 31, 2012 and December 31, 2013.

        Gain on sales of loans.    Gain on sales of loans increased $384,000 or 154.8% in 2013 compared to 2012 due to an increase in the number of mortgage loans sold in 2013 compared to 2012. We began originating mortgage loans for sale in April 2012. Accordingly, our 2013 results reflect a full year of income related to the sale of mortgage loans. We sold 109 loans in 2013 with an average gain on sale of $5,900, compared to 40 loans in 2012 with an average gain on sale of $6,200. We did not sell any mortgage loans in 2011.

        Gain on sales of other real estate owned.    The decrease of $41,000 in gain on sales of other real estate owned for 2013 compared to 2012 was due to market conditions, which resulted in a loss taken on five out of six properties sold in 2013, although the loss was more than offset by a gain of $68,000 on 18 lots of a residential development held as other real estate owned. The increase of $18,000 or 41.9% for 2012 compared to 2011 was due primarily to the sale of eight lots sold at a gain of $34,000 from a residential development property held as other real estate owned, as well as a $25,000 gain on the sale of a participation in property classified as other real estate owned.

        Bank-owned life insurance.    Income from bank-owned life insurance income increased $205,000 or 113.9% in 2013 compared to 2012 due to the purchase of $5.0 million of additional bank-owned life insurance in March 2013. We did not own bank-owned life insurance during 2011.

        Gain on sales of investment securities.    We had no gain on the sale of securities in 2013 or 2012. In 2011, we had a gain on sales of our investment securities of $421,000, which was due to the sale of low yielding mortgage-backed securities and reinvestment of the proceeds from such sale into higher yielding loans.

        Other.    Other noninterest income increased $170,000 or 37.1% in 2013 compared to 2012 due primarily to an increase of $98,000 in wire transfer fees, an increase of $20,000 in Federal Reserve stock dividends, and an increase in income generated from other real estate owned rental income of

68


Table of Contents

$31,000, as well as an increase in certain customer fees. Other noninterest income increased $208,000 from 2011 to 2012 due to increases in wire transfer fees, Federal Reserve stock dividends and other customer fees from the additional deposit accounts acquired from Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas in 2011.

Noninterest Expense

        For the year ended December 31, 2013, noninterest expense totaled $16.3 million, an increase of $192,000 or 1.2% compared to 2012. For the year ended December 31, 2012, noninterest expense totaled $16.1 million, an increase of $3.4 million or 26.7% compared to $12.7 million for the same period in 2011. The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the major categories of noninterest expense:

 
  For the Years Ended
December 31,
  Increase
(Decrease)
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2013 v
2012
  2012 v
2011
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Salaries and employee benefits

  $ 9,084   $ 9,205   $ 6,967   $ (121 ) $ 2,238  

Non-staff expenses:

                               

Occupancy of bank premises

    1,694     1,546     888     148     658  

Depreciation and amortization

    1,266     1,059     751     207     308  

Data processing

    729     880     610     (151 )   270  

FDIC assessment fees

    378     234     383     144     (149 )

Legal fees

    80     380     630     (300 )   (250 )

Other professional fees

    574     668     560     (94 )   108  

Advertising and promotions

    142     167     232     (25 )   (65 )

Utilities and telephone

    295     399     322     (104 )   77  

Other real estate owned expenses and writedowns

    399     175     40     224     135  

Other

    1,723     1,459     1,379     264     80  
                       

Total noninterest expense

  $ 16,364   $ 16,172   $ 12,762   $ 192   $ 3,410  
                       
                       

        Salaries and employee benefits.    Salaries and employee benefits decreased by $121,000 between 2012 and 2013 primarily as a result of an increase in deferred compensation costs in accordance with ASC 310-20, "Nonrefundable Fees and Other Costs." ASC 310-20 requires that direct loan origination costs and related loan origination fees be deferred and the resulting net fee or cost amortized or accreted to interest income as an adjustment of the loan yield. The increase in deferred compensation cost was partially offset by a $450,000 increase in salaries and a $660,000 increase in stock and incentive pay due to additional full-time employees and higher incentive cost related to growth in loans and income. Salaries and employee benefits increased $2.2 million to $9.2 million for 2012, compared to $7.0 million for 2011, primarily due to an increase in full-time employees resulting from the acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas in 2011. Salaries and employee benefits for the year ended December 31, 2013 included $323,000 in stock-based compensation expense compared to $255,000 and $207,000 recorded for each of the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

        Occupancy of bank premises.    Occupancy expenses were $1.7 million, $1.5 million and $888,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The increase of $148,000 or 9.6% for 2013 compared to 2012 was due primarily to increased rent and leasehold improvements related to relocating the corporate office and Preston Center branch in July 2012. The increase of $658,000 or 74.1% for 2012 compared to 2011 was due primarily to the acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas, which increased our branch locations by four. The bank also opened two additional branches in the fall of 2011.

69


Table of Contents

        Depreciation and amortization.    Depreciation and amortization costs were $1.3 million, $1.1 million, and $751,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. This category includes building, leasehold, furniture, fixtures and equipment depreciation totaling $972,000, $764,000 and $535,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively, as well as intangible asset amortization of $294,000, $295,000 and $216,000 for these same periods, respectively. The increase of $207,000 or 19.5% for 2013 compared to 2012, was due to depreciation from additional furniture and technology equipment purchases required to support our expansion and build the infrastructure needed for growth in the volume of our business. The increase of $308,000 or 41.0% for 2012 compared to 2011 was due to the addition of $6.6 million and $306,000 in premises and equipment we acquired in connection with the acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas, respectively.

        Data processing.    Data processing expenses were $729,000, $880,000 and $610,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, respectively. These expenses decreased $151,000 or 17.2% in 2013 and increased $270,000 or 44.2% from 2011 due to one-time project related expenses in 2012. Partially offsetting the decrease in expense in 2013, was an increase in transaction volumes associated with deposit growth. The increase during 2012 also reflects the full year impact of system usage resulting from the acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas in 2011.

        Legal fees.    Legal fees were $80,000, $380,000 and $630,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The decrease in legal fees of $300,000, or 78.9%, for 2013 compared with 2012 was due in part to the completion of our conversion to a state chartered bank in 2012, and no acquisitions in 2013. The decrease of $250,000, or 39.7%, for 2012 compared with 2011 was due primarily to a decrease in legal and regulatory fees related to the completion of our acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas.

        FDIC assessment fees.    FDIC assessment fees were $378,000, $234,000 and $383,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The increase of $144,000, or 61.5% for 2013 compared to 2012 was due to an increase in our average consolidated assets and average tangible equity, the two components of the assessment base. The decrease of $149,000 or 38.9%, for 2012 compared to 2011 was due to a change in methodology used by the FDIC to calculate the assessment base, which resulted in lower assessment fees for 2012.

        Other professional fees.    Other professional fees, which includes audit, loan review, regulatory assessments, and IT professional services, were $574,000, $668,000 and $560,000 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively. The decrease of $94,000 or 14.1% for 2013 and the increase of $108,000 or 19.3% from 2011 compared to 2012 was due primarily to the fluctuation in IT support fees related to network infrastructure projects during 2012.

        Other real estate owned expense and write-downs.    Expenses related to other real estate owned increased $224,000 or 128.0% in 2013 compared to 2012 due to write-downs of $208,000 taken on four properties in 2013 and other miscellaneous expenses relating to the upkeep and maintenance of these types of properties. The increase of $135,000 or 337.5% in 2012 compared to 2011 was due to write-downs taken on four properties in 2012.

        Other.    Other noninterest income increased $264,000 or 18.1% in 2013 compared to 2012 and increased $80,000 or 5.8% for 2012 compared to 2011 due primarily to business development expenses required to support sales activities in these years.

Income Tax Expense

        For the year ended December 31, 2013, income tax expense was $1.7 million compared to $136,000 for the year ended December 31, 2012 and $13,000 for the year ended December 31, 2011. The

70


Table of Contents

increase in income tax expense of $1.6 million in 2013 was primarily attributable to the $3.6 million increase in net operating income during 2013. The increase in income tax expense of $123,000 in 2012 was primarily attributable to the $1.5 million increase in net operating income in 2012. Our effective income tax rates for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011 were 34.3%, 8.4% and 10.6%, respectively, compared to the U.S. statutory rate of 34% for each year.

        Our effective tax rate for 2013 was essentially the same as the statutory rate because our tax-exempt bank-owned life insurance earnings were approximately equal to our other non-deductible expenses. Our effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2012 was affected primarily by tax-exempt bank-owned life insurance earnings and the reversal of our deferred tax asset valuation allowance. Our effective tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2011 was affected primarily by the partial reversal of our deferred tax asset valuation allowance.

Financial Condition

        Our total assets increased $45.4 million or 6.8% from $665.0 million as of December 31, 2013 to $710.4 million as of June 30, 2014, and increased $140.9 million or 26.9% from $524.1 million as of December 31, 2012 to December 31, 2013. Our asset growth was due to the successful execution of our strategy of establishing deep relationships in the Dallas metropolitan area resulting in new customer accounts and growth in balances from existing loan and deposit customers.

Loan Portfolio

        Our primary source of income is interest on loans to individuals, professionals, small to medium-sized businesses and commercial companies located in the Dallas metropolitan area. Our loan portfolio consists primarily of commercial loans and real estate loans secured by commercial real estate properties located in our primary market area. Our loan portfolio represents the highest yielding component of our earning asset base.

        As of June 30, 2014, total loans were $541.0 million, an increase of $45.7 or 9.2% million compared to $495.3 million as of December 31, 2013. Total loans as of December 31, 2013 represented an increase of $97.6 million or 24.5% compared to $397.7 million as of December 31, 2012. These increases were primarily due to our continued penetration in our primary market area. Of these amounts, $6.3 million, $2.1 million and $2.8 million in loans were classified as held for sale as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively.

        Total loans as a percentage of deposits were 88.5%, 86.3% and 88.8% as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Total loans as a percentage of assets were 76.2%, 74.5% and 75.9% as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        The following table summarizes our loan portfolio by type of loan as of the dates indicated:

 
   
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of June 30,
2014
(Unaudited)
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  Amount   Percent   Amount   Percent   Amount   Percent   Amount   Percent   Amount   Percent  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Commercial

  $ 174,094     32.2 % $ 160,823     32.5 % $ 123,779     31.1 % $ 83,381     28.0 % $ 28,369     28.1 %

Real estate:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Construction and land

    56,818     10.5     47,643     9.6     41,497     10.4     38,291     12.9     10,603     10.5  

Farmland

    11,982     2.2     11,656     2.4     6,281     1.6     5,211     1.7     1,141     1.1  

1 - 4 family residential

    98,030     18.1     86,908     17.5     71,875     18.1     51,356     17.2     26,431     26.2  

Multi-family residential

    14,866     2.7     11,862     2.4     12,997     3.3     14,360     4.8     2,088     2.1  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    180,921     33.5     171,451     34.6     134,449     33.8     92,913     31.2     28,211     28.0  

Consumer

    4,279     .8     4,927     1.0     6,858     1.7     12,505     4.2     4,079     4.0  
                                           

Total loans held for investment

  $ 540,990     100.0 % $ 495,270     100.0 % $ 397,736     100.0 % $ 298,017     100.0 % $ 100,922     100.0 %
                                           
                                           

Total loans held for sale

  $ 6,342         $ 2,051         $ 2,818         $         $        

71


Table of Contents

        Commercial loans.    Our commercial loans are underwritten after evaluating and understanding the borrower's ability to operate profitably and effectively. These loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower, and secondarily, on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Most commercial loans are secured by the assets being financed or other business assets, such as accounts receivable or inventory, and generally include personal guarantees.

        Commercial loans increased $13.3 million or 8.3% to $174.1 million as of June 30, 2014 from $160.8 million as of December 31, 2013. The increase in lending activity was due to a relatively robust business environment in our primary market area and the efforts of our relationship-based lenders who leveraged these growth opportunities. Commercial loans as of December 31, 2013 represented an increase of $37.0 million or 29.9% from $123.8 million as of December 31, 2012. The increase in commercial loans during 2013 primarily resulted from our hiring of additional experienced lending officers in 2013.

        Construction and land.    Our construction and land development loans are comprised of loans to fund construction, land acquisition and land development construction. The properties securing the portfolio are located throughout North Texas and are generally diverse in terms of type.

        Construction and land loans increased $9.2 million or 19.3% to $56.8 million as of June 30, 2014 from $47.6 million as of December 31, 2013. The increase in lending activity was due to a robust business environment in our primary market area and the continued efforts of our relationship-based lenders. Construction and land loans as of December 31, 2013 represented an increase of $6.1 million or 14.8% from $41.5 million as of December 31, 2012. The increase in construction and land loans during 2013 primarily resulted from our hiring of additional experienced lending officers in 2013 as well as an increase in market demand.

        1-4 family residential.    Our 1-4 family residential loans are comprised of loans secured by single family homes, which are both owner-occupied and investor owned. Our 1-4 family residential loans have a relatively small balance spread between many individual borrowers.

        1-4 family residential loans increased $11.1 million or 12.8% to $98.0 million as of June 30, 2014 from $86.9 million as of December 31, 2013. This slight increase resulted primarily from an increase in market demand due to growth in the housing market in our primary market area. 1-4 family residential loans as of December 31, 2013 represented an increase of $15.0 million or 20.9% from $71.9 million as of December 31, 2012. The increase in 1-4 family residential loans during 2013 primarily resulted from our hiring of additional experienced lending officers in 2013 as well as an increase in market demand due to an improved housing market in our primary market area.

        Nonfarm nonresidential.    Our nonfarm nonresidential loans are underwritten primarily based on projected cash flows and, secondarily, as loans secured by real estate. These loans may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing the portfolio are located throughout north Texas and are generally diverse in terms of type. This diversity helps reduce the exposure to adverse economic events that affect any single industry.

        Nonfarm nonresidential loans increased $9.4 million or 5.5% to $180.9 million as of June 30, 2014 from $171.5 million as of December 31, 2013. This slight increase primarily resulted from increased lending activity due to an increase in demand and favorable market conditions. Nonfarm nonresidential loans as of December 31, 2013 represented an increase of $37.1 million or 27.5% from $134.4 million as of December 31, 2012. The increase in nonfarm nonresidential loans during 2013 mainly resulted from our hiring of additional experienced lending officers in 2013 as well as an increase in market demand due to favorable market conditions.

        Other loan categories.    Other categories of loans included in our loan portfolio include farmland and agricultural loans made to farmers and ranchers relating to their operations, multi-family

72


Table of Contents

residential loans and consumer loans. None of these categories of loans represents a significant portion of our total loan portfolio.

        The contractual maturity ranges of loans in our loan portfolio and the amount of such loans with fixed and floating interest rates in each maturity range as of date indicated are summarized in the following tables:

 
  As of June 30, 2014  
 
  One Year
or Less
  One
Through
Five Years
  After Five
Years
  Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)(Unaudited)
 

Commercial

  $ 55,646   $ 94,541   $ 23,907   $ 174,094  

Real estate:

                         

Construction and land

    30,905     21,313     4,600     56,818  

Farmland

    2,042     9,375     565     11,982  

1 - 4 family residential

    8,107     58,159     31,764     98,030  

Multi-family residential

    2,101     11,935     830     14,866  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    15,863     123,960     41,098     180,921  

Consumer

    1,581     2,124     574     4,279  
                   

Total loans

  $ 116,245   $ 321,407   $ 103,338   $ 540,990  
                   
                   

Amounts with fixed rates

  $ 36,934   $ 179,496   $ 38,666   $ 255,096  

Amounts with floating rates

  $ 79,311   $ 141,911   $ 64,672   $ 285,894  

 

 
  As of December 31, 2013  
 
  One Year
or Less
  One
Through
Five Years
  After Five
Years
  Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Commercial

  $ 70,021   $ 72,156   $ 18,646   $ 160,823  

Real estate:

                         

Construction and land

    21,071     23,776     2,796     47,643  

Farmland

    863     9,620     1,173     11,656  

1 - 4 family residential

    10,427     45,211     31,270     86,908  

Multi-family residential

    2,604     7,968     1,290     11,862  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    15,861     123,846     31,744     171,451  

Consumer

    1,803     2,656     468     4,927  
                   

Total loans

  $ 122,650   $ 285,233   $ 87,387   $ 495,270  
                   
                   

Amounts with fixed rates

  $ 36,610   $ 158,114   $ 29,125   $ 223,849  

Amounts with floating rates

  $ 86,040   $ 127,119   $ 58,262   $ 271,421  

Nonperforming Assets

        Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments were due. Loans are placed on non-accrual status when, in management's opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. Loans may be placed on non-accrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received in excess of principal due. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

73


Table of Contents

        We have several procedures in place to assist us in maintaining the overall quality of our loan portfolio. We have established underwriting guidelines to be followed by our bankers, and we also monitor our delinquency levels for any negative or adverse trends. There can be no assurance, however, that our loan portfolio will not become subject to increasing pressures from deteriorating borrower credit due to general economic conditions.

        We believe our conservative lending approach and focused management of nonperforming assets has resulted in sound asset quality and timely resolution of problem assets. We had $3.0 million in nonperforming assets as of June 30, 2014 compared to $2.9 million and $3.7 million in nonperforming assets as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. We had $497,000 in nonperforming loans as of June 30, 2014 compared to $1.1 million and $1.3 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        The following table presents information regarding nonperforming loans at the dates indicated:

 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of June 30,
2014
(Unaudited)
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-accrual loans(1)

  $ 107   $ 1,117   $ 1,211   $   $ 364  

Accruing loans 90 or more days past due

    390     9     93     153      
                       

Total nonperforming loans

    497     1,126     1,304     153     364  
                       

Other real estate owned:

                               

Commercial real estate, construction, land and land development

    2,494     1,797     2,438     729     319  

Residential real estate

                     
                       

Total other real estate owned

    2,494     1,797     2,438     729     319  
                       

Total nonperforming assets

  $ 2,991   $ 2,923   $ 3,742   $ 882   $ 683  
                       
                       

Restructured loans—non-accrual

  $ 541   $ 1,611   $ 1,525   $   $  

Restructured loans—accruing

  $ 1,271   $ 2,465   $ 1,156   $   $  

Ratio of nonperforming loans to total loans

    0.09 %   0.23 %   0.33 %   0.05 %   0.36 %

Ratio of nonperforming assets to total assets

    0.42 %   0.44 %   0.71 %   0.20 %   0.35 %

(1)
Does not include purchased credit impaired loan of $541,000, $569,000 and $644,000 as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively.

 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of June 30,
2014
(Unaudited)
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-accrual loans by category:

                               

Real estate:

                               

Construction and land

  $ 76   $ 76   $   $   —   $  

Farmland

                     

1 - 4 family residential

        1,041     879          

Multi-family residential

                     

Nonfarm residential

            331          

Commercial

    30                  

Consumer

            1          
                       

Total

  $ 106   $ 1,117   $ 1,211   $   $ 364 (1)
                       
                       

(1)
Classification by category was not available for 2010 data.

74


Table of Contents

Potential Problem Loans

        From a credit risk standpoint, we classify loans in one of four categories: pass, special mention, substandard or doubtful. Loans classified as loss are charged-off. The classifications of loans reflect a judgment about the risks of default and loss associated with the loan. We review the ratings on credits monthly. Ratings are adjusted to reflect the degree of risk and loss that is felt to be inherent in each credit as of each monthly reporting period. Our methodology is structured so that specific allocations are increased in accordance with deterioration in credit quality (and a corresponding increase in risk and loss) or decreased in accordance with improvement in credit quality (and a corresponding decrease in risk and loss).

        Credits rated special mention show clear signs of financial weaknesses or deterioration in credit worthiness, however, such concerns are not so pronounced that we generally expect to experience significant loss within the short-term. Such credits typically maintain the ability to perform within standard credit terms and credit exposure is not as prominent as credits with a lower rating.

        Credits rated substandard are those in which the normal repayment of principal and interest may be, or has been, jeopardized by reason of adverse trends or developments of a financial, managerial, economic or political nature, or important weaknesses which exist in collateral. A protracted workout on these credits is a distinct possibility. Prompt corrective action is therefore required to strengthen our position, and/or to reduce exposure and to assure that adequate remedial measures are taken by the borrower. Credit exposure becomes more likely in such credits and a serious evaluation of the secondary support to the credit is performed.

        The following table summarizes our internal ratings of our loans, including purchase credit impaired loans, as of the dates indicated.

 
  As of June 30, 2014  
 
  Pass   Special Mention   Substandard   Doubtful   Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands) (Unaudited)
 

Real estate:

                               

Construction

  $ 56,201   $   $ 617   $   $ 56,818  

Farmland

    11,982                 11,982  

1 - 4 family residential

    97,819         211         98,030  

Multi-family residential

    14,866                 14,866  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    180,546         375         180,921  

Commercial

    171,625     975     1,464     30     174,094  

Consumer

    4,239         40         4,279  
                       

Total

  $ 537,278   $ 975   $ 2,707   $ 30   $ 540,990  
                       
                       

 

 
  As of December 31, 2013  
 
  Pass   Special Mention   Substandard   Doubtful   Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Real estate:

                               

Construction

  $ 46,998   $   $ 645   $   $ 47,643  

Farmland

    11,656                 11,656  

1 - 4 family residential

    85,649         1,259         86,908  

Multi-family residential

    11,862                 11,862  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    171,371         80         171,451  

Commercial

    158,919     731     1,173         160,823  

Consumer

    4,878     7     42         4,927  
                       

Total

  $ 491,333   $ 738   $ 3,199   $   $ 495,270  
                       
                       

75


Table of Contents

 

 
  As of December 31, 2012  
 
  Pass   Special Mention   Substandard   Doubtful   Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Real estate:

                               

Construction

  $ 39,349   $   $ 2,148   $   $ 41,497  

Farmland

    6,281                 6,281  

1 - 4 family residential

    71,821         54         71,875  

Multi-family residential

    12,997                 12,997  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    132,330     1,787     332         134,449  

Commercial

    123,407     201     171         123,779  

Consumer

    6,570     14     274         6,858  
                       

Total

  $ 392,755   $ 2,002   $ 2,979   $   $ 397,736  
                       
                       

Allowance for loan losses

        We maintain an allowance for loan losses that represents management's best estimate of the loan losses and risks inherent in the loan portfolio. In determining the allowance for loan losses, we estimate losses on specific loans, or groups of loans, where the probable loss can be identified and reasonably determined. The balance of the allowance for loan losses is based on internally assigned risk classifications of loans, historical loan loss rates, changes in the nature of the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality, industry concentrations, delinquency trends, current economic factors and the estimated impact of current economic conditions on certain historical loan loss rates. For additional discussion of our methodology, please refer to "—Critical Accounting Policies—Allowance for loan losses."

        In connection with our review of the loan portfolio, we consider risk elements attributable to particular loan types or categories in assessing the quality of individual loans. Some of the risk elements we consider include:

        As of June 30, 2014, the allowance for loan losses totaled $5.5 million or 1.02% of total loans. As of December 31, 2013, the allowance for loan losses totaled $5.0 million or 1.01% of total loans. As of December 31, 2012, the allowance for loan losses totaled $3.2 million or 0.81% of total loans. Ending balances for the purchase discount related to non-impaired acquired loans were $434,000, $667,000 and $1.1 million as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Purchase credit impaired

76


Table of Contents

loans are not considered nonperforming loans. Purchase credit impaired loans had no purchase discount outstanding as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and $250,000 of non-accretable purchase discounts outstanding as of December 31, 2012.

        The following table presents, as of and for the periods indicated, an analysis of the allowance for loan losses and other related data:

 
  For the Six
Months Ended
June 30, 2014
(Unaudited)
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Average loans outstanding(1)

  $ 508,836   $ 433,612   $ 342,130   $ 217,064   $ 91,948  
                       
                       

Gross loans outstanding at end of period(1)

  $ 540,990   $ 495,270   $ 397,736   $ 298,017   $ 100,922  
                       
                       

Allowance for loan losses at beginning of period

  $ 5,018   $ 3,238   $ 1,012   $ 166   $  

Provision for loan losses

    677     1,883     2,953     960     166  

Charge-offs:

                               

Real estate:

                               

Construction, land and farmland

    (28 )                

Residential

    (30 )   (85 )   (265 )   (54 )    

Nonfarm non-residential

            (231 )        

Commercial

    (146 )   (110 )   (172 )   (77 )    

Consumer

        (45 )   (133 )   (18 )    
                       

Total charge-offs

    (204 )   (240 )   (801 )   (149 )      

Recoveries:

                               

Real estate:

                               

Construction, land and farmland

                     

Residential

        60         22      

Nonfarm non-residential

                     

Commercial

    23     32     61     3      

Consumer

    2     45     13     10      
                       

Total recoveries

    25     137     74     35      

Net charge-offs

    (179 )   (103 )   (727 )   (114 )    
                       

Allowance for loan losses at end of period

  $ 5,516   $ 5,018   $ 3,238   $ 1,012   $ 166  
                       
                       

Ratio of allowance to end of period loans

    1.02 %   1.01 %   0.81 %   0.34 %   0.16 %

Ratio of net charge-offs to average loans

    0.04 %   0.02 %   0.21 %   0.05 %    

(1)
Excluding loans held for sale.

        We believe the successful execution of our growth strategy through key acquisitions and organic growth is demonstrated by the upward trend in loan balances from December 31, 2010 to June 30, 2014. Loan balances increased from $100.9 million as of December 31, 2010, to $541.0 million as of June 30, 2014. Our provision has increased consistently with the growth in our loan portfolio during the same period. Further, charge-offs have been immaterial, representing less than 0.25% of total loan balances during the same period.

77


Table of Contents

        Although we believe that we have established our allowance for loan losses in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States and that the allowance for loan losses was adequate to provide for known and inherent losses in the portfolio at all times shown above, future provisions will be subject to ongoing evaluations of the risks in our loan portfolio. If we experience economic declines or if asset quality deteriorates, material additional provisions could be required.

        The following table shows the allocation of the allowance for loan losses among our loan categories and certain other information as of the dates indicated. The allocation of the allowance for loan losses as shown in the table should neither be interpreted as an indication of future charge-offs, nor as an indication that charge-offs in future periods will necessarily occur in these amounts or in the indicated proportions. The total allowance is available to absorb losses from any loan category.

 
   
   
  As of December 31,    
   
   
   
 
 
  As of
June 30, 2014
(Unaudited)
   
   
   
   
 
 
  2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  Amount   Percent
to Total
  Amount   Percent
to Total
  Amount   Percent
to Total
  Amount   Percent
to Total
  Amount   Percent
to Total
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Real estate:

                                                             

Construction and land

  $ 701     12.7 % $ 660     13.2 % $ 455     14.1 %   n/a     n/a     n/a     n/a  

Farmland

   
   
   
   
   
   
   
n/a
   
n/a
   
n/a
   
n/a
 

1 - 4 family residential

    1,062     19.3     861     17.1     672     20.8     n/a     n/a     n/a     n/a  

Multi-family residential

    138     2.5     109     2.2     83     2.6     n/a     n/a     n/a     n/a  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1,780     32.3     1,726     34.4     1,028     31.7     n/a     n/a     n/a     n/a  
                                           

Total real estate

    3,681     66.8     3,356     66.9     2,238     69.2   $ 660 (1)   65.2 %   n/a     n/a  

Commercial

   
1,772
   
32.1
   
1,585
   
31.6
   
947
   
29.2
   
317
   
31.3
   
n/a
   
n/a
 

Consumer

    63     1.1     77     1.5     53     1.6     35     3.5     n/a     n/a  
                                           

Total allowance for loan losses

  $ 5,516     100.0 % $ 5,018     100.0 % $ 3,238     100.0 % $ 1,012     100.0 % $ 166     100.0 %
                                           
                                           

(1)
In 2011 we did not break out real estate loans by category.

Securities

        We use our securities portfolio to provide a source of liquidity, provide an appropriate return on funds invested, manage interest rate risk, meet collateral requirements and meet regulatory capital requirements. As of June 30, 2014, the carrying amount of investment securities totaled $50.5 million, an increase of $4.9 million or 10.8% compared to $45.6 million as of December 31, 2013. The balance in our securities portfolio as of December 31, 2013 represented an increase of $16.1 million or 54.4% compared to $29.5 million as of December 31, 2012. The increases in our investment securities were funded primarily from increases in deposits. Securities represented 7.1%, 6.9% and 5.6% of total assets as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

78


Table of Contents

        Our investment portfolio consists entirely of securities classified as available for sale. As a result, the carrying values of our investment securities are adjusted for unrealized gain or loss, and any gain or loss is reported on an after-tax basis as a component of other comprehensive income in stockholders' equity. The following table summarizes the amortized cost and estimated fair value of our investment securities as of the dates shown:

 
  As of June 30, 2014  
 
  Amortized Cost   Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized Losses
  Fair Value  
 
  (Dollars in thousands) (Unaudited)
 

U.S. government agencies

  $ 2,000   $   $ 71   $ 1,929  

Corporate bonds

    500     3         503  

Municipal securities

    949     32         981  

Mortgage-backed securities

    32,248     283     97     32,434  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    13,305     159     42     13,422  

Asset-backed securities

    1,251     27         1,278  
                   

Total

  $ 50,253   $ 504   $ 210   $ 50,547  
                   
                   

 

 
  As of December 31, 2013  
 
  Amortized Cost   Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Fair Value  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

U.S. government agencies

  $ 2,019   $   $ 95   $ 1,924  

Corporate bonds

    1,445     35         1,480  

Municipal securities

    934     24         958  

Mortgage-backed securities

    24,898     220     187     24,931  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    14,898     158     141     14,915  

Asset-backed securities

    1,370     26         1,396  
                   

Total

  $ 45,564   $ 463   $ 423   $ 45,604  
                   
                   

 

 
  As of December 31, 2012  
 
  Amortized Cost   Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Fair Value  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

U.S. government agencies

  $   $   $   $  

Corporate bonds

    1,435     31     4     1,462  

Municipal securities

    904     40         944  

Mortgage-backed securities

    15,006     448         15,454  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    9,867     193     15     10,045  

Asset-backed securities

    1,600     33         1,633  
                   

Total

  $ 28,812   $ 745   $ 19   $ 29,538  
                   
                   

        All of our mortgage-backed securities are agency securities. We do not hold any Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac preferred stock, corporate equity, collateralized debt obligations, collateralized loan obligations, structured investment vehicles, private label collateralized mortgage obligations, subprime, Alt-A, or second lien elements in our investment portfolio. As of June 30, 2014, our investment portfolio did not contain any securities that are directly backed by subprime or Alt-A mortgages.

79


Table of Contents

        Management evaluates securities for other-than-temporary impairment, at least on a quarterly basis, and more frequently when economic or market conditions warrant such an evaluation.

        The following table sets forth the fair value, maturities and approximated weighted average yield based on estimated annual income divided by the average amortized cost of our securities portfolio as of the dates indicated. The contractual maturity of a mortgage-backed security is the date at which the last underlying mortgage matures.

 
  As of June 30, 2014  
 
  Within One Year   After One Year
but
Within Five
Years
  After Five Years
but
Within Ten
Years
  After Ten
Years
  Total  
 
  Amount   Yield   Amount   Yield   Amount   Yield   Amount   Yield   Total   Yield  
 
  (Dollars in thousands) (Unaudited)
 

U.S. government agencies

  $     % $     % $ 1,929     1.67 % $     % $ 1,929     1.67 %

Corporate bonds/Certificates of deposit

    503     3.01                             503     3.01  

Municipal securities

            981     3.25                     981     3.25  

Mortgage-backed securities

            29,779     1.72     2,565     0.99     90     1.60     32,434     1.66  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    223     1.77     8,975     2.50     3,324     2.22     900     0.49     13,422     2.28  

Asset-backed securities

            298     0.47     980     1.01             1,278     0.88  
                                                     

Total

  $ 726     2.63 % $ 40,033     1.92 % $ 8,798     1.61 % $ 990     0.59 % $ 50,547     1.85 %
                                                     
                                                     

 

 
  As of December 31, 2013  
 
  Within One Year   After One Year
but
Within Five
Years
  After Five Years
but
Within Ten
Years
  After Ten
Years
  Total  
 
  Amount   Yield   Amount   Yield   Amount   Yield   Amount   Yield   Total   Yield  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

U.S. government agencies

  $     % $     % $ 1,924     1.57 % $     % $ 1,924     1.57 %

Corporate bonds/Certificates of deposit

            1,480     2.17                     1,480     2.17  

Municipal securities

            958     3.25                     958     3.25  

Mortgage-backed securities

            20,794     1.83     4,046     1.21     91     1.60     24,931     1.73  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    719     1.18     9,863     2.32     3,411     2.24     922     0.50     14,915     2.15  

Asset-backed securities

            418     0.46     978     1.00             1,396     0.83  
                                                     

Total

  $ 719     1.18 % $ 33,513     2.01 % $ 10,359     1.60 % $ 1,013     0.60 % $ 45,604     1.88 %
                                                     
                                                     

        The contractual maturity of mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset backed securities is not a reliable indicator of their expected life because borrowers have the right to prepay their obligations at any time. Mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities are typically issued with stated principal amounts and are backed by pools of mortgage loans and other loans with varying maturities. The term of the underlying mortgages and loans may vary significantly due to the ability of a borrower to pre-pay. Monthly pay downs on mortgage-backed securities tend to cause the average life of the securities to be much different than the stated contractual maturity. During a period of increasing interest rates, fixed rate mortgage-backed securities do not tend to experience heavy prepayments of principal and consequently, the average life of this security will be lengthened. If interest rates begin to fall, prepayments may increase, thereby shortening the estimated life of this security. The weighted average life of our investment portfolio was 3.72 years with an estimated effective duration of 2.17 years as of June 30, 2014.

        As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, we did not own securities of any one issuer for which aggregate adjusted cost exceeded 10.0% of the consolidated stockholders' equity as of such respective dates.

80


Table of Contents

        The average yield of the securities portfolio was 1.65% during 2013 compared to 1.90% during 2012. The decrease in average yield during 2013 compared to 2012 was primarily due to the reinvestment of funds at lower rates in 2013 and the speed of prepayments on our mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligation portfolios.

Deposits

        We offer a variety of deposit accounts having a wide range of interest rates and terms including demand, savings, money market and time accounts. We rely primarily on competitive pricing policies, convenient locations and personalized service to attract and retain these deposits.

        Total deposits as of June 30, 2014 were $611.2 million, an increase of $37.3 million or 6.5% compared to $573.9 million as of December 31, 2013 due primarily to increases of $17.2 million and $17.0 million in our noninterest-bearing deposit accounts and money market accounts, respectively. Total deposits as of December 31, 2013 were $573.9 million, an increase of $126.0 million or 28.1% compared to December 31, 2012 due primarily to increases of $48.5 million and $61.0 million in our noninterest-bearing deposit accounts and money market accounts, respectively. We believe our deposit growth was primarily due to our continued penetration in our primary market area and the increase in commercial lending relationships for which we also seek deposit balances.

        Noninterest-bearing deposits as of June 30, 2014 were $236.2 million compared to $219.0 million as of December 31, 2013, an increase of $17.2 million or 7.9%. The December 31, 2013 balance for noninterest-bearing deposits represented an increase of $48.5 million or 28.4% compared to $170.5 million as of December 31, 2012.

        Interest-bearing checking account balances as of June 30, 2014 were $40.1 million compared to $40.2 million as of December 31, 2013, a decrease of $98,000 or 0.24%. The December 31, 2013 balance for interest-bearing checking accounts represented an increase of $5.1 million or 15.0% compared to $35.0 million as of December 31, 2012.

        Average deposits for the six months ended June 30, 2014 were $574.0 million, an increase of $74.4 million or 14.9% over the full year average for the year ended December 31, 2013 of $499.6 million. Average deposits grew $101.2 million or 25.4% from $398.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The average rate paid on total interest-bearing deposits decreased consistently over this period from 0.74% for the year ended December 31, 2012 to 0.71% for the year ended December 31, 2013 to 0.65% for the six months ended June 30, 2014. The decreases in average rates were driven primarily by strategic reductions in limited access money market and certificate of deposit pricing during this time period. In addition, the continued growth of noninterest-bearing demand accounts resulted in further reductions to the cost of deposits from 0.48% for the year ended December 31, 2012 to 0.44% for the year ended December 31, 2013 and 0.40% for the six months ended June 30, 2014.

81


Table of Contents

        The following table presents the daily average balances and weighted average rates paid on deposits for the periods indicated:

 
  For the Six
Months Ended
June 30, 2014
(Unaudited)
  For the Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  
 
  Average
Balance
  Average
Rate
  Average
Balance
  Average
Rate
  Average
Balance
  Average
Rate
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Interest-bearing demand accounts

  $ 39,005     0.26 % $ 35,021     0.25 % $ 28,543     0.28 %

Savings accounts

    5,150     0.10     4,767     0.10     3,909     0.10  

Limited access money market accounts

    210,298     0.59     174,878     0.62     138,138     0.62  

Certificates and other time deposits > $100k

    85,610     0.96     79,278     1.01     72,097     1.08  

Certificates and other time deposits < $100k

    17,258     0.91     17,218     1.07     16,591     1.04  
                                 

Total interest-bearing deposits

    357,321     0.65     311,162     0.71     259,278     0.74  
                                 

Noninterest-bearing demand accounts

    216,721           188,405           139,128        
                                 

Total deposits

  $ 574,042     0.40 % $ 499,567     0.44   $ 398,406     0.48  
                                 
                                 

        Our ratio of average noninterest-bearing deposits to average total deposits for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 was 38%, 38% and 35%, respectively.

        Factors affecting the cost of funding our interest-bearing assets include the volume of noninterest and interest-bearing deposits, changes in market interest rates and economic conditions in our target markets and their impact on interest paid on our deposits, as well as the ongoing execution of our balance sheet management strategy. As a result of our experienced bankers successfully acquiring new deposit-rich commercial lending relationships, we experienced significant year over year organic deposit growth of 28.1% in 2013, 22.8% in 2012 and 21.2% in 2011, while at the same time we reduced our overall cost of funds. Cost of funds is calculated as total interest expense divided by total deposits plus total borrowings. Our cost of funds was 0.44% in 2013, 0.56% in 2012 and 0.77% in 2011. This reduction in our cost of funds was the result of our focus on acquisition of noninterest-bearing demand deposits through organic growth and bank acquisitions. Noninterest-bearing demand deposits as a percentage of total deposits grew to 38.2% in 2013, and 38.1% in 2012, compared to 30.9% in 2011. Average rates on interest-bearing deposits were 0.71% in 2013, 0.74% in 2012 and 0.88% in 2011.

        The following table sets forth the amount of our certificates of deposit that are $100,000 or greater by time remaining until maturity:

 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of
June 30, 2014
(Unaudited)
 
 
  2013   2012  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

1 year or less

  $ 68,233   $ 65,069   $ 63,269  

More than 1 year but less than 3 years

    11,973     12,226     6,181  

3 years or more but less than 5 years

    4,567     4,185     2,296  

5 years or more

             
               

Total

  $ 84,773   $ 81,480   $ 71,746  
               
               

82


Table of Contents

Borrowings

        We utilize short-term and long-term borrowings to supplement deposits to fund our lending and investment activities, each of which is discussed below.

        Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) advances.    The FHLB allows us to borrow on a blanket floating lien status collateralized by certain securities and loans. As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, total borrowing capacity of $249.6 million, $227.6 million and $22.6 million, respectively, was available under this arrangement and $15.0 million, $15.0 million and $10.0 million, respectively, was outstanding with an average interest rate of 0.80% as of June 30, 2014, 0.80% as of December 31, 2013 and 3.13% as of December 31, 2012. Our current FHLB advances mature within five years. We utilize these borrowings to meet liquidity needs and to fund certain fixed rate loans in our portfolio.

        The following table presents our FHLB borrowings at the dates indicated. Other than FHLB borrowings, we had no other short-term borrowings at the dates indicated.

 
  FHLB
Advances
 
 
  (Dollars in
Thousands)

 

June 30, 2014

       

Amount outstanding at quarter-end

  $ 15,000  

Weighted average interest rate at quarter-end

    0.80 %

Maximum month-end balance during the quarter

    15,000  

Average balance outstanding during the quarter

    15,000  

Weighted average interest rate during the quarter

    0.80 %

December 31, 2013

   
 
 

Amount outstanding at year-end

  $ 15,000  

Weighted average interest rate at year-end

    0.80 %

Maximum month-end balance during the year

    15,000  

Average balance outstanding during the year

    14,932  

Weighted average interest rate during the year

    1.28 %

December 31, 2012

   
 
 

Amount outstanding at year-end

  $ 10,000  

Weighted average interest rate at year-end

    3.13 %

Maximum month-end balance during the year

    10,000  

Average balance outstanding during the year

    10,000  

Weighted average interest rate during the year

    3.13 %

        Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas.    The Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas has an available borrower in custody arrangement, which allows us to borrow on a collateralized basis. Certain commercial and consumer loans are pledged under this arrangement. We maintain this borrowing arrangement to meet liquidity needs pursuant to our contingency funding plan. As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, $131.9 million, $127.1 million and $83.3 million, respectively, were available under this arrangement. As of June 30, 2014, approximately $162.9 million in commercial loans were pledged as collateral. As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and 2012, no borrowings were outstanding under this arrangement.

        Junior subordinated debentures.    In connection with the acquisition of Fidelity Resource Company during 2011, we assumed $3.1 million in fixed/floating rate junior subordinated debentures underlying common securities and preferred capital securities, or the Trust Securities, issued by Parkway National Capital Trust I, a statutory business trust and acquired wholly-owned subsidiary. We assumed the guarantor position and as such, unconditionally guarantee payment of accrued and unpaid distributions

83


Table of Contents

required to be paid on the Trust Securities subject to certain exceptions, the redemption price when a capital security is called for redemption and amounts due if a trust is liquidated or terminated.

        We own all of the outstanding common securities of the trust. The trust used the proceeds from the issuance of its Trust Securities to buy the debentures originally issued by Fidelity Resource Company. These debentures are the trust's only assets and the interest payments from the debentures finance the distributions paid on the Trust Securities.

        The Trust Securities pay cumulative cash distributions quarterly at a rate per annum equal to the 3-month LIBOR plus 1.85% percent. The effective rate as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 was 2.10% and 2.19%, respectively. The Trust Securities are subject to mandatory redemption in whole or in part, upon repayment of the debentures at the stated maturity in the year 2036 or their earlier redemption, in each case at a redemption price equal to the aggregate liquidation preference of the Trust Securities plus any accumulated and unpaid distributions thereon to the date of redemption. Prior redemption is permitted under certain circumstances.

        The Trust Securities qualify as Tier 1 capital, subject to regulatory limitations, under guidelines established by the Federal Reserve.

        Subordinated notes.    On December 23, 2013, we completed a private offering of $5.0 million in aggregate principal amount of subordinated promissory notes. The notes were structured to qualify as Tier 2 capital under applicable rules and regulations of the Federal Reserve. The proceeds from the offering were used to support our continued growth. The notes are unsecured, with quarterly interest payable at a fixed rate of 6.0% per annum, and unpaid principal and interest on the notes is due at the stated maturity on December 31, 2023. We may redeem the notes in whole or in part on any interest payment date that occurs on or after December 23, 2018 subject to approval of the Federal Reserve.

        Under the terms of the notes, if we have not paid interest on the notes within 30 days of any interest payment date, or if our classified assets to total tangible capital ratio exceeds 40.0%, then the note holder that holds the greatest aggregate principal amount of the notes may appoint one representative to attend meetings of our board of directors as an observer. The board observation rights terminate when such overdue interest is paid or our classified assets to total tangible capital ratio no longer exceeds 40.0%. In addition, the terms of the notes provide that the note holders will have the same rights to inspect our books and records provided to holders our common stock under Texas law.

        In connection with the issuance of the notes, we also issued warrants to purchase 25,000 shares of our common stock, at an exercise price of $11.00 per share, exercisable at any time, in whole or in part, on or prior to December 31, 2023. See "Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Private Placement of Subordinated Notes and Warrants" for additional discussion of these subordinated notes and warrants.

 
  As of June 30
(Unaudited)
  As of December 31,  
 
  2014   2013   2012  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Junior subordinated debentures

  $ 3,093   $ 3,093   $ 3,093  

Subordinated notes

    4,980     4,979      
               

Total

  $ 8,073   $ 8,072   $ 3,093  
               
               

84


Table of Contents

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Liquidity

        Liquidity involves our ability to raise funds to support asset growth and acquisitions or reduce assets to meet deposit withdrawals and other payment obligations, to maintain reserve requirements and otherwise to operate on an ongoing basis and manage unexpected events. For the six months ended June 30, 2014 and the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, our liquidity needs were primarily met by core deposits, security and loan maturities and amortizing investment and loan portfolios. Although access to brokered deposits, purchased funds from correspondent banks and overnight advances from the FHLB and the Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas are available and have been utilized on occasion to take advantage of investment opportunities, we do not generally rely on these external funding sources. We maintained two lines of credit with commercial banks which provide for extensions of credit with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate $14.6 million as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and $12.6 million as of December 31, 2012. There were no advances under these lines of credit outstanding as of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012.

        The following table illustrates, during the periods presented, the mix of our funding sources and the average assets in which those funds are invested as a percentage of our average total assets for the period indicated. Average assets totaled $671.5 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014, $584.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 and $472.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2012.

 
  For the Six
Months Ended
June 30,
2014
(Unaudited)
  For the Years Ended
December 31,
 
 
  2013   2012  

Sources of Funds:

                   

Deposits:

                   

Noninterest-bearing

    33.2 %   32.9 %   32.6 %

Interest-bearing

    52.8     53.4     52.9  

Advances from FHLB

    2.1     2.2     1.9  

Other borrowings

    1.1     1.2     0.6  

Other liabilities

    0.3     0.3     0.2  

Stockholders' equity

    10.5     10.0     11.8  
               

Total

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
               

Uses of Funds:

                   

Loans

    75.3 %   74.0 %   75.8 %

Securities available for sale

    7.1     6.9     5.6  

Interest-bearing deposits in other banks

    8.0     10.2     8.6  

Other noninterest-earning assets

    9.6     8.9     10.0  
               

Total

    100.0 %   100.0 %   100.0 %
               
               

Average noninterest-bearing deposits to average deposits

    37.8 %   37.7 %   34.9 %

Average loans to average deposits

    88.6 %   86.8 %   85.9 %

        Our primary source of funds is deposits, and our primary use of funds is loans. We do not expect a change in the primary source or use of our funds in the foreseeable future. Our average loans increased 24.3% for the six months ended June 30, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 and 26.7% for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the year ended December 31, 2012. We predominantly invest excess deposits in overnight deposits with the Federal Reserve, securities, interest-bearing deposits at other banks or other short-term liquid investments until needed to fund loan growth. Our securities portfolio had a weighted average life of 3.72 years and an effective duration of

85


Table of Contents

2.17 years as of June 30, 2014 and a weighted average life of 4.07 years and an effective duration of 2.76 years as of December 31, 2013.

        As of June 30, 2014, we had outstanding $107.1 million in commitments to extend credit and $680,000 in commitments associated with outstanding standby and commercial letters of credit. As of December 31, 2013, we had outstanding $92.8 million in commitments to extend credit and $210,000 in commitments associated with outstanding standby and commercial letters of credit. Since commitments associated with letters of credit and commitments to extend credit may expire unused, the total outstanding may not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

        As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, we had no exposure to future cash requirements associated with known uncertainties or capital expenditures of a material nature. As of June 30, 2014, we had cash and cash equivalents of $66.5 million compared to $76.6 million as of December 31, 2013. The decrease was primarily due to an increase in loans and a seasonal reduction in customer deposit balances.

Capital Resources

        Total stockholders' equity increased to $74.2 million as of June 30, 2014, compared to $66.2 million as of December 31, 2013, an increase of $8.0 million or 12.1%. This increase was primarily the result of $5.4 million in proceeds from the sale of our common stock and $2.2 million of net income for the period. Total stockholders' equity increased to $66.2 million as of December 31, 2013, compared to $61.9 million as of December 31, 2012, an increase of $4.3 million or 6.9%. This increase was primarily the result of our net income of $3.4 million and the sale of 120,363 additional shares of common stock representing $1.2 million of additional paid-in capital.

        For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, we declared and paid cash dividends on our Series C preferred stock of $60,000, $100,000 and $8,000, respectively. See "Description of Capital Stock—Preferred Stock—Series C Preferred Stock" for additional discussion of our Series C preferred stock. To date, we have not declared or paid dividends on our common stock. We purchased 10,000 shares of our common stock for $70,000 during the year ended December 31, 2013. We did not purchase any of our common stock for the six months ended June 30, 2014 or for the years ended December 31, 2012 or 2011.

        Capital management consists of providing equity to support our current and future operations. The bank regulators view capital levels as important indicators of an institution's financial soundness. As a general matter, FDIC-insured depository institutions and their holding companies are required to maintain minimum capital relative to the amount and types of assets they hold. We are subject to regulatory capital requirements at the bank holding company and bank levels. See "Regulation and Supervision—Prompt Corrective Action" for additional discussion regarding the regulatory capital requirements applicable to us and the Bank. As of June 30, 2014, December 31, 2013 and 2012, we and the Bank were in compliance with all applicable regulatory capital requirements, and the Bank was classified as "well capitalized," for purposes of the prompt corrective action regulations. As we employ our capital and continue to grow our operations, our regulatory capital levels may decrease depending on our level of earnings. However, we expect to monitor and control our growth in order to remain in compliance with all regulatory capital standards applicable to us.

86


Table of Contents

        The following table presents the actual capital amounts and regulatory capital ratios for us and the Bank as of the dates indicated.

 
  As of
June 30, 2014
(Unaudited)
  As of
December 31, 2013
 
 
  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

                         

Total capital (to risk weighted assets)

  $ 67,540     12.35 % $ 59,100     11.74 %

Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)

    57,044     10.44     49,103     9.75  

Tier 1 capital (to average assets)

    57,044     8.66     49,103     8.06  

Veritex Community Bank

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Total capital (to risk weighted assets)

  $ 65,480     11.99 % $ 57,275     11.37 %

Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)

    59,964     10.98     52,257     10.37  

Tier 1 capital (to average assets)

    59,964     9.11     52,257     8.58  

Contractual Obligations

        The following table summarizes our contractual obligations and other commitments to make future payments as of December 31, 2013 (other than deposit obligations), which consist of our future cash payments associated with our contractual obligations pursuant to our FHLB advances and non-cancelable future operating leases. Payments for FHLB advances include interest of $390,000 that will be paid over future periods. Payments related to leases are based on actual payments specified in underlying contracts. Advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank totaled approximately $15.0 million and $10.0 million as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. As of December 31, 2013, the advances are collateralized by a blanket floating lien on certain securities and loans, had a weighted average rate of 0.80% and mature on various dates during 2016 and 2018.

 
  As of December 31, 2013  
 
  1 year or less   More than
1 year but less
than 3 years
  3 years or
more but less
than 5 years
  5 years
or more
  Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Non-cancelable future operating leases

  $ 1,118   $ 991   $ 1,811   $ 3,284   $ 7,204  

Time deposits

    80,878     14,105     4,370         99,353  

Advances from FHLB

        10,000     5,000         15,000  

Other borrowings

                8,072     8,072  

Standby and commercial letters of credit

    210                 210  

Commitments to extend credit

    52,687     20,360     3,035     16,955     93,037  
                       

Total

  $ 134,893   $ 45,456   $ 14,216   $ 28,311   $ 222,876  
                       
                       

Off-Balance Sheet Items

        In the normal course of business, we enter into various transactions, which, in accordance with GAAP, are not included in our consolidated balance sheets. We enter into these transactions to meet the financing needs of our customers. These transactions include commitments to extend credit and standby and commercial letters of credit, which involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk and interest rate risk in excess of the amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets.

87


Table of Contents

        Our commitments associated with outstanding standby and commercial letters of credit and commitments to extend credit expiring by period as of the date indicated are summarized below. Since commitments associated with letters of credit and commitments to extend credit may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

 
  As of December 31, 2013  
 
  1 year or less   More than
1 year but less
than 3 years
  3 years or
more but less
than 5 years
  5 years
or more
  Total  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Standby and commercial letters of credit

  $ 210   $   $   $   $ 210  

Commitments to extend credit

    52,687     20,360     3,035     16,955     93,037  
                       

Total

  $ 52,897   $ 20,360   $ 3,035   $ 16,955   $ 93,247  
                       
                       

        Standby and commercial letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by us to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. In the event of nonperformance by the customer, we have rights to the underlying collateral, which can include commercial real estate, physical plant and property, inventory, receivables, cash and/or marketable securities. The credit risk to us in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to our customers.

        Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being fully drawn upon, the total commitment amounts disclosed above do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. We evaluate each customer's creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if considered necessary by us, upon extension of credit, is based on management's credit evaluation of the customer.

Interest Rate Sensitivity and Market Risk

        As a financial institution, our primary component of market risk is interest rate volatility. Our asset liability and funds management policy provides management with the guidelines for effective funds management, and we have established a measurement system for monitoring our net interest rate sensitivity position. We manage our sensitivity position within our established guidelines.

        Fluctuations in interest rates will ultimately impact both the level of income and expense recorded on most of our assets and liabilities, and the market value of all interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, other than those which have a short term to maturity. Interest rate risk is the potential of economic losses due to future interest rate changes. These economic losses can be reflected as a loss of future net interest income and/or a loss of current fair market values. The objective is to measure the effect on net interest income and to adjust the balance sheet to minimize the inherent risk while at the same time maximizing income.

        We manage our exposure to interest rates by structuring our balance sheet in the ordinary course of business. We do not enter into instruments such as leveraged derivatives, interest rate swaps, financial options, financial future contracts or forward delivery contracts for the purpose of reducing interest rate risk. Based upon the nature of our operations, we are not subject to foreign exchange or commodity price risk. We do not own any trading assets.

        Our exposure to interest rate risk is managed by the Asset-Liability Committee of the Bank, in accordance with policies approved by its board of directors. The committee formulates strategies based on appropriate levels of interest rate risk. In determining the appropriate level of interest rate risk, the committee considers the impact on earnings and capital of the current outlook on interest rates, potential changes in interest rates, regional economies, liquidity, business strategies and other factors.

88


Table of Contents

The committee meets regularly to review, among other things, the sensitivity of assets and liabilities to interest rate changes, the book and market values of assets and liabilities, unrealized gains and losses, purchase and sale activities, commitments to originate loans and the maturities of investments and borrowings. Additionally, the committee reviews liquidity, cash flow flexibility, maturities of deposits and consumer and commercial deposit activity. Management employs methodologies to manage interest rate risk which include an analysis of relationships between interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, and an interest rate shock simulation model.

        We use interest rate risk simulation models and shock analysis to test the interest rate sensitivity of net interest income and fair value of equity, and the impact of changes in interest rates on other financial metrics. Contractual maturities and re-pricing opportunities of loans are incorporated in the model as are prepayment assumptions, maturity data and call options within the investment portfolio. Average life of our non-maturity deposit accounts are based on standard regulatory decay assumptions and are incorporated into the model. The assumptions used are inherently uncertain and, as a result, the model cannot precisely measure future net interest income or precisely predict the impact of fluctuations in market interest rates on net interest income. Actual results will differ from the model's simulated results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes as well as changes in market conditions and the application and timing of various management strategies.

        On a quarterly basis, we run two simulation models including a static balance sheet and dynamic growth balance sheet. These models test the impact on net interest income and fair value of equity from changes in market interest rates under various scenarios. Under the static and dynamic growth models, rates are shocked instantaneously and ramped rate changes over a twelve-month horizon based upon parallel and non-parallel yield curve shifts. Parallel shock scenarios assume instantaneous parallel movements in the yield curve compared to a flat yield curve scenario. Non-parallel simulation involves analysis of interest income and expense under various changes in the shape of the yield curve. Internal policy regarding internal rate risk simulations currently specifies that for instantaneous parallel shifts of the yield curve, estimated net income at risk for the subsequent one-year period should not decline by more than 6.0% for a 100 basis point shift, 12.0% for a 200 basis point shift, and 18.0% for a 300 basis point shift.

        The following table summarizes the simulated change in net interest income and fair value of equity over a 12-month horizon as of the date indicated:

 
  As of June 30, 2014   As of December 31, 2013  
Change in Interest
Rates (Basis Points)
  Percent Change
in Net Interest
Income
  Percent Change
in Fair Value of
Equity
  Percent Change
in Net Interest
Income
  Percent Change
in Fair Value of
Equity
 

+300

    5.92 %   11.66 %   5.68 %   13.94 %

+200

    3.69 %   9.32 %   2.90 %   10.48 %

+100

    1.54 %   5.27 %   0.59 %   5.46 %

Base

    (0.41 )%   0.00 %   (0.48 )%   0.00 %

-100

    (0.61 )%   4.89 %   (0.29 )%   4.22 %

        The results are primarily due to behavior of demand, money market and savings deposits during such rate fluctuations. We have found that, historically, interest rates on these deposits change more slowly than changes in the discount and federal funds rates. This assumption is incorporated into the simulation model and is generally not fully reflected in a gap analysis. The assumptions incorporated into the model are inherently uncertain and, as a result, the model cannot precisely measure future net interest income or precisely predict the impact of fluctuations in market interest rates on net interest income. Actual results will differ from the model's simulated results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes as well as changes in market conditions and the application and timing of various strategies.

89


Table of Contents

Impact of Inflation

        Our consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. These require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars, without considering changes in the relative value of money over time due to inflation or recession.

        Unlike many industrial companies, substantially all of our assets and liabilities are monetary in nature. As a result, interest rates have a more significant impact on our performance than the effects of general levels of inflation. Interest rates may not necessarily move in the same direction or in the same magnitude as the prices of goods and services. However, other operating expenses do reflect general levels of inflation.

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

        Our accounting and reporting policies conform to GAAP, and the prevailing practices in the banking industry. However, we also evaluate our performance based on certain additional financial measures discussed in this prospectus as being non-GAAP financial measures. We classify a financial measure as being a non-GAAP financial measure if that financial measure excludes or includes amounts, or is subject to adjustments that have the effect of excluding or including amounts, that are included or excluded, as the case may be, in the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP as in effect from time to time in the United States in our statements of income, balance sheets or statements of cash flows. Non-GAAP financial measures do not include operating and other statistical measures or ratios or statistical measures calculated using exclusively either financial measures calculated in accordance with GAAP, operating measures or other measures that are not non-GAAP financial measures or both.

        The non-GAAP financial measures that we discuss in this prospectus should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for the most directly comparable or other financial measures calculated in accordance with GAAP. Moreover, the manner in which we calculate the non-GAAP financial measures that we discuss in this prospectus may differ from that of other companies reporting measures with similar names. You should understand how such other banking organizations calculate their financial measures similar or with names similar to the non-GAAP financial measures we have discussed in this prospectus when comparing such non-GAAP financial measures.

        Tangible Book Value Per Common Share.    Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP measure generally used by financial analysts and investment bankers to evaluate financial institutions. We calculate (1) tangible common equity as stockholders' equity less preferred stock, goodwill and core deposit intangible and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization, and (2) tangible book value per common share as tangible common equity divided by shares of common stock outstanding. The most directly comparable GAAP financial measure for tangible book value per common share is book value per common share.

        We believe that this measure is important to many investors in the marketplace who are interested in changes from period to period in book value per common share exclusive of changes in intangible assets. Goodwill and other intangible assets have the effect of increasing total book value while not increasing our tangible book value.

90


Table of Contents

        The following table reconciles, as of the dates set forth below, total stockholders' equity to tangible common equity and presents our tangible book value per common share compared to our book value per common share:

 
  As of June 30,   As of December 31,  
 
  2014   2013   2013   2012   2011  
 
  (Unaudited)
   
   
   
 
 
  (Dollars in thousands, except per share data)
 

Tangible Common Equity

                               

Total stockholders' equity

  $ 74,244   $ 64,262   $ 66,239   $ 61,860   $ 58,676  

Adjustments:

                               

Preferred stock

    (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )
                       

Book value

    66,244     56,262     58,239     53,860     50,676  

Goodwill

   
(19,148

)
 
(19,148

)
 
(19,148

)
 
(19,148

)
 
(19,148

)

Core deposit and other intangibles

    (1,413 )   (1,721 )   (1,567 )   (1,875 )   (2,183 )
                       

Total tangible common equity

  $ 45,683   $ 35,393   $ 37,524   $ 32,837   $ 29,345  
                       
                       

Common shares outstanding(1)

    6,358,832     5,808,703     5,804,703     5,694,340     5,554,487  

Book value per common share

  $ 10.42   $ 9.69   $ 10.03   $ 9.46   $ 9.12  

Tangible book value per common share

  $ 7.18   $ 6.09   $ 6.46   $ 5.77   $ 5.28  

(1)
Excludes the dilutive effect, if any, of 830,000, 730,000, 750,000, 765,000 and 700,000 shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options as of June 30, 2014, June 30, 2013, December 31, 2013, December 31, 2012, and December 31, 2011, respectively, and 63,250, 34,000, 35,000, 40,000 and 26,000 shares of common stock issuable upon vesting of outstanding restricted stock units as of June 30, 2014, June 30, 2013, December 31, 2013, December 31, 2012, and December 31, 2011, respectively.

        Tangible Common Equity to Tangible Assets.    Tangible common equity to tangible assets is a non-GAAP measure generally used by financial analysts and investment bankers to evaluate financial institutions. We calculate tangible common equity, as described above, and tangible assets as total assets less goodwill, core deposit intangible and other intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization. The most directly comparable GAAP financial measure for tangible common equity to tangible assets is total common stockholders' equity to total assets.

        We believe that this measure is important to many investors in the marketplace who are interested in the relative changes from period to period in common equity and total assets, each exclusive of changes in intangible assets. Goodwill and other intangible assets have the effect of increasing both total stockholders' equity and assets while not increasing our tangible common equity or tangible assets.

91


Table of Contents

        The following table reconciles, as of the dates set forth below, total stockholders' equity to tangible common equity and total assets to tangible assets:

 
   
  As of December 31,  
 
  As of June 30,
2014
(Unaudited)
  2013   2012   2011  
 
  (Dollars in thousands)
 

Tangible Common Equity

                         

Total stockholders' equity

  $ 74,244   $ 66,239   $ 61,860   $ 58,676  

Adjustments:

                         

Preferred stock

    (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )

Goodwill

    (19,148 )   (19,148 )   (19,148 )   (19,148 )

Core deposit and other intangibles

    (1,413 )   (1,567 )   (1,875 )   (2,183 )
                   

Total tangible common equity

  $ 45,683   $ 37,524   $ 32,837   $ 29,345  
                   
                   

Tangible Assets

                         

Total assets

  $ 710,382   $ 664,971   $ 524,127   $ 437,820  

Adjustments:

                         

Preferred stock

    (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )   (8,000 )

Goodwill

    (19,148 )   (19,148 )   (19,148 )   (19,148 )

Core deposit and other intangibles

    (1,413 )   (1,567 )   (1,875 )   (2,183 )
                   

Total tangible assets

  $ 681,821   $ 636,256   $ 495,104   $ 408,489  
                   
                   

Tangible Common Equity to Tangible Assets

    6.70 %   5.90 %   6.63 %   7.18 %

Critical Accounting Policies

        Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States and with general practices within the financial services industry. Application of these principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. We base our estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under current circumstances. These assumptions form the basis for our judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily available from independent, objective sources. We evaluate our estimates on an ongoing basis. Use of alternative assumptions may have resulted in significantly different estimates. Actual results may differ from these estimates.

        We have identified the following accounting policies and estimates that, due to the difficult, subjective or complex judgments and assumptions inherent in those policies and estimates and the potential sensitivity of our financial statements to those judgments and assumptions, are critical to an understanding of our financial condition and results of operations. We believe that the judgments, estimates and assumptions used in the preparation of our financial statements are appropriate.

Investment Securities

        Securities are classified as held to maturity and carried at amortized cost when we have the positive intent and ability to hold them until maturity. Securities to be held for indefinite periods of time are classified as available for sale and carried at fair value, with the unrealized holding gains and losses reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax. We determined the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase.

        Interest income includes amortization of purchase premiums and discounts. Realized gains and losses are derived from the amortized cost of the security sold. Credit related declines in the fair value

92


Table of Contents

of held to maturity and available for sale securities below their cost that are deemed to be other than temporary are reflected in earnings as realized losses, with the remaining unrealized loss recognized as a component of other comprehensive income. In estimating other-than-temporary impairment losses, we consider, among other things, (1) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and (3) the intent and our ability to retain the investment in the issuer for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.

Loans Held for Sale

        Loans held for sale consist of certain mortgage loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market and are carried at the lower of cost or estimated fair value on an individual loan basis. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recognized through a valuation allowance by charges to income. We obtain purchase commitments from secondary market investors prior to closing the loans and do not retain the servicing obligations related to any such loans upon their sale. Gains and losses on sales of loans held for sale are based on the difference between the selling price and the carrying value of the related loan sold.

Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses

        Loans, excluding certain purchased loans which have shown evidence of deterioration since origination as of the date of the acquisition, that we have the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off are stated at the amount of unpaid principal, reduced by unearned income and an allowance for loan losses. Interest on loans is recognized using the simple-interest method on the daily balances of the principal amounts outstanding. Fees associated with the originating of loans and certain direct loan origination costs are netted and the net amount is deferred and recognized over the life of the loan as an adjustment of yield.

        The accrual of interest on loans is discontinued when there is a clear indication that the borrower's cash flow may not be sufficient to meet payments as they become due, which is generally when a loan is 90 days past due. When a loan is placed on non-accrual status, all previously accrued and unpaid interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized on a cash basis as long as the remaining book balance of the asset is deemed to be collectible. If collectability is questionable, then cash payments are applied to principal. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement.

        The allowance for loan losses is an estimated amount we believe is adequate to absorb inherent losses on existing loans that may be uncollectible based upon review and evaluation of the loan portfolio. Our periodic evaluation of the allowance is based on general economic conditions, the financial condition of borrowers, the value and liquidity of collateral, delinquency, prior loan loss experience, and the results of periodic reviews of the portfolio. The allowance for loan losses is comprised of two components: the general reserve and specific reserves. The general reserve is determined in accordance with current authoritative accounting guidance that considers historical loss rates for the last three years adjusted for qualitative factors based upon general economic conditions and other qualitative risk factors both internal and external to us. Such qualitative factors include current local economic conditions and trends including unemployment, changes in lending staff, policies and procedures, changes in credit concentrations, changes in the trends and severity of problem loans and changes in trends in volume and terms of loans. These qualitative factors serve to compensate for additional areas of uncertainty inherent in the portfolio that are not reflected in our historic loss factors. For purposes of determining the general reserve, the loan portfolio, less cash secured loans, government guaranteed loans and impaired loans, is multiplied by our adjusted historical loss rate.

93


Table of Contents

Specific reserves are determined in accordance with current authoritative accounting guidance based on probable losses on specific classified loans.

        The allowance for loan losses is increased by charges to income and decreased by charge-offs (net of recoveries).

        Due to the growth of the Bank over the past several years, a portion of the loans in our portfolio and our lending relationships are of relatively recent origin. The new loan portfolios have limited delinquency and credit loss history and have not yet exhibited an observable loss trend. The credit quality of loans in these loan portfolios are impacted by delinquency status and debt service coverage generated by the borrowers' business and fluctuations in the value of real estate collateral. We consider delinquency status to be the most meaningful indicator of the credit quality of one-to-four single family residential, home equity loans and lines of credit and other consumer loans. In general, loans do not begin to show signs of credit deterioration or default until they have been outstanding for some period of time, a process we refer to as "seasoning". As a result, a portfolio of older loans will usually behave more predictably than a portfolio of newer loans. Because the majority of our portfolio is relatively new, the current level of delinquencies and defaults may not be representative of the level that will prevail when the portfolio becomes more seasoned, which may be higher than current levels.

        Delinquency statistics are updated at least monthly. Internal risk ratings are considered the most meaningful indicator of credit quality for new commercial, construction, and commercial real estate loans. Internal risk ratings are a key factor in identifying loans that are individually evaluated for impairment and impact our estimates of loss factors used in determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses. Internal risk ratings are updated on a continuous basis.

        Loans are considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due in accordance with the original contractual terms of the loan agreement, including scheduled principal and interest payments. If a loan is impaired, a specific valuation allowance is allocated, if necessary. Interest payments on impaired loans are typically applied to principal unless collectability of the principal amount is reasonably assured, in which case interest is recognized on a cash basis. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.

        Our policy requires measurement of the allowance for an impaired collateral dependent loan based on the fair value of the collateral. Other loan impairments are measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows or the loan's observable market price. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, all significant impaired loans have been determined to be collateral dependent and the allowance for loss has been measured utilizing the estimated fair value of the collateral.

        From time to time, we may modify our loan agreement with a borrower. A modified loan is considered a troubled debt restructuring when two conditions are met: (1) the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and (2) concessions are made by us that would not otherwise be considered for a borrower with similar credit risk characteristics. Modifications to loan terms may include a lower interest rate, a reduction of principal, or a longer term to maturity. All troubled debt restructurings are considered impaired loans. We review each troubled debt restructured loan and determine on a case by case basis if a specific allowance for loan loss is required. An allowance for loan loss allocation is based on either the present value of estimated future cash flows or the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral.

        We have certain lending policies and procedures in place that are designed to maximize loan income with an acceptable level of risk. We review and approve these policies and procedures on a regular basis and makes changes as appropriate. We receive frequent reports related to loan originations, quality, concentrations, delinquencies, non-performing and potential problem loans.

94


Table of Contents

Diversification in the loan portfolio is a means of managing risk associated with fluctuations in economic conditions, both by type of loan and geography.

        Commercial loans are underwritten after evaluating and understanding the borrower's ability to operate profitably and effectively. Underwriting standards are designed to determine whether the borrower possesses sound business ethics and practices and to evaluate current and projected cash flows to determine the ability of the borrower to repay their obligations as agreed. Commercial loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower and, secondarily, on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Most commercial loans are secured by the assets being financed or other business assets, such as accounts receivable or inventory, and include personal guarantees.

        Real estate loans are also subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial loans. These loans are underwritten primarily based on projected cash flows and, secondarily, as loans secured by real estate. The repayment of real estate loans is generally largely dependent on the successful operation of the property securing the loans or the business conducted on the property securing the loan. Real estate loans may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing our real estate portfolio are generally diverse in terms of type and geographic location, through the Dallas metropolitan area. This diversity helps reduce the exposure to adverse economic events that affect any single market or industry.

        We utilize methodical credit standards and analysis to supplement our policies and procedures in underwriting consumer loans. Our loan policy addresses types of consumer loans that may be originated and the collateral, if secured, which must be perfected. The relatively smaller individual dollar amounts of consumer loans that are spread over numerous individual borrowers also minimizes our risk.

Emerging Growth Company

        The JOBS Act permits an "emerging growth company" to take advantage of an extended transition period to comply with new or revised accounting standards applicable to public companies. However, we have "opted out" of this provision. As a result, we will comply with new or revised accounting standards to the same extent that compliance is required for non-emerging growth companies. This decision to opt out of the extended transition period under the JOBS Act is irrevocable.

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

        ASU 2013-02, "Comprehensive Income (Topic 220)—Reporting of Amounts Reclassified Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income." ASU 2013-02 amends recent guidance related to the reporting of comprehensive income to enhance the reporting of reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income. ASU 2013-02 is effective for reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2013 and is not expected to have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.

95


Table of Contents


REGULATION AND SUPERVISION

        The U.S. banking industry is highly regulated under federal and state law. These laws and regulations affect the operations and performance of our company and subsidiaries.

        Statutes, regulations and policies limit the activities in which we may engage and how we conduct certain permitted activities. The system of supervision and regulation applicable to us and our subsidiaries establishes a comprehensive framework for their respective operations and is intended primarily for the protection of the FDIC's Deposit Insurance Fund, the Bank's depositors and the public, rather than our shareholders or creditors. Further, the bank regulatory system imposes reporting and information collection obligations. We incur significant costs relating to compliance with these laws and regulations. Banking statutes, regulations and policies are continually under review by federal and state legislatures and regulatory agencies, and a change in them, including changes in how they are interpreted or implemented, could have a material adverse effect on our business.

        The material statutory and regulatory requirements that are applicable to us are summarized below. This description is not intended to describe all laws and regulations applicable to us and our subsidiaries, and the description is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of the statutes, regulations, policies, interpretive letters and other written guidance that are described herein.

Bank and Bank Holding Company Regulation

        The Bank is a Texas-chartered banking association, the deposits of which are insured by the FDIC's Deposit Insurance Fund. The Bank is a member of the Federal Reserve System; therefore, the Bank is subject to ongoing and comprehensive supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the Texas Department of Banking and the Federal Reserve.

        Any entity that directly or indirectly controls a bank must be approved by the Federal Reserve under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, or the BHC Act to become a bank holding company. Bank holding companies are subject to regulation, inspection, examination, supervision and enforcement by the Federal Reserve under the BHC Act. The Federal Reserve's jurisdiction also extends to any company that is directly or indirectly controlled by a bank holding company.

        Our company, which controls the Bank, became a registered bank holding company in 2009, and is subject to ongoing and comprehensive supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the Federal Reserve. As a bank holding company of a Texas state chartered bank, we are also subject to supervision, regulation, examination and enforcement by the Texas Department of Banking.

Broad Supervision, Examination and Enforcement Powers

        The principal objective of the U.S. bank regulatory system is to protect depositors and to ensure the financial safety and soundness of banking organizations. To that end, the banking regulators have broad regulatory, examination and enforcement authority. The regulators regularly examine the operations of banking organizations. In addition, banking organizations are subject to periodic reporting requirements. Insured depository institutions with total assets of $500.0 million or more must submit annual audit reports prepared by independent auditors to federal and state regulators. In some instances, the audit report of the insured depository institution's bank holding company can be used to satisfy this requirement. Auditors must receive examination reports, supervisory agreements and reports of enforcement actions.

        The regulators have various remedies available if they determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of a banking organization's operations are unsatisfactory. The regulators may also take action if they determine that

96


Table of Contents

the banking organization or its management is violating or has violated any law or regulation. The regulators have the power to, among other things:

        The FDIC may terminate a depository institution's deposit insurance upon a finding that the institution's financial condition is unsafe or unsound or that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or has violated any applicable rule, regulation, order or condition enacted or imposed by the institution's regulatory agency. Engaging in unsafe or unsound practices or failing to comply with applicable laws, regulations and supervisory agreements could subject the Bank and us, or our respective officers, directors and institution-affiliated parties to the remedies described above and other sanctions.

The Dodd-Frank Act

        On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law. The Dodd-Frank Act is having a broad impact on the financial services industry, and imposes significant regulatory and compliance requirements, including the designation of certain financial companies as systemically important financial companies, the changing roles of credit rating agencies, the imposition of increased capital, leverage and liquidity requirements and numerous other provisions designed to improve supervision and oversight of, and strengthen safety and soundness within, the financial services sector. Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act establishes a new framework of authority to conduct systemic risk oversight within the financial system to be distributed among new and existing federal regulatory agencies, including the Financial Stability Oversight Council, the Federal Reserve, the OCC and the FDIC.

        The following items provide a brief description of certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that are most relevant to the Bank and us.

97


Table of Contents

98


Table of Contents

        The requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act are in the process of being implemented and many of the requirements remain subject to regulations to be implemented over the course of several years. Given the uncertainty associated with the manner in which the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will be implemented by the various regulatory agencies and through regulations, the full extent of the impact such requirements will have on our operations is unclear. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act may impact the profitability of our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise adversely affect our business. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements.

        Failure to comply with the new requirements may negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition.

99


Table of Contents

The Volcker Rule

        On December 10, 2013, the federal bank regulatory agencies, together with the SEC and the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission, adopted a final rule, commonly known as the "Volcker Rule," under Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act that generally prohibits "banking entities" from engaging in "proprietary trading" and making investments and conducting certain other activities with "private equity funds and hedge funds." Although the final rule provides some tiering of compliance and reporting obligations based on size, the fundamental prohibitions of the Volcker Rule apply to banking entities of any size, including us and the Bank. The final regulations became effective April 1, 2014; however, at the time the agencies released the final Volcker Rule, the Federal Reserve announced an extension of the conformance period for all banking entities until July 21, 2015.

        In response to industry questions regarding the final rule, the adopting agencies issued a clarifying interim final rule on January 14, 2014, permitting banking entities to retain interests in certain collateralized debt obligations backed by trust preferred securities if the collateralized debt obligations meet certain requirements.

        We have reviewed the scope of the Volcker Rule and have preliminarily determined that we do not have any investments that meet the requirements of the rule.

Notice and Approval Requirements Related to Control

        Federal and state banking laws impose notice, approval and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other party that seeks to acquire direct or indirect "control" of an FDIC-insured depository institution. These laws include the BHC Act and the Change in Bank Control Act. The determination whether an investor "controls" a depository institution is based on all of the facts and circumstances surrounding the investment. As a general matter, a party is deemed to control a depository institution or other company if the party owns or controls 25.0% or more of any class of voting stock. Subject to rebuttal, a party may be presumed to control a depository institution or other company if the investor owns or controls 10.0% or more of any class of voting stock. Ownership by affiliated parties, or parties acting in concert, is typically aggregated for these purposes. If a party's ownership of our company were to exceed certain thresholds, the investor could be deemed to "control" our company for regulatory purposes. This could subject the investor to regulatory filings or other regulatory consequences.

        In addition, except under limited circumstances, bank holding companies are prohibited from acquiring, without prior regulatory approval:

Permissible Activities and Investments

        Banking laws generally restrict our ability to engage in, or acquire 5% or more of the voting shares of a company engaged in, activities other than those determined by the Federal Reserve to be so closely related to banking as to be a proper incident thereto. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Financial Modernization Act of 1999, or the GLB Act, expanded the scope of permissible activities for a bank holding company that qualifies as a financial holding company. Under the regulations implementing the GLB Act, a financial holding company may engage in additional activities that are financial in nature or incidental or complementary to a financial activity. Those activities include, among other activities, certain insurance and securities activities. Qualifications for becoming a financial holding company include, among other things, meeting certain specified capital standards and achieving certain

100


Table of Contents

management ratings in examinations. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, bank holding companies and their subsidiaries must be well-capitalized and well-managed in order for the bank holding company and its nonbank affiliates to engage in the expanded financial activities permissible only for a financial holding company.

        In addition, as a general matter, the establishment or acquisition by our company of a depository institution or, in certain cases, a non-bank entity, requires prior regulatory approval.

        The Texas Constitution, as amended in 1986, provides that a Texas-chartered bank has the same rights and privileges that are or may be granted to national banks domiciled in Texas. To the extent that the Texas laws and regulations may have allowed state-chartered banks to engage in a broader range of activities than national banks, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991, or the FDICIA, has operated to limit this authority in most circumstances. The FDICIA provides that no state bank or subsidiary thereof may engage as a principal in any activity not permitted for national banks, unless the institution complies with applicable capital requirements and the FDIC determines that the activity poses no significant risk to the Deposit Insurance Fund. In general, statutory restrictions on the activities of banks are aimed at protecting the safety and soundness of depository institutions.

Branching

        Texas law provides that a Texas-chartered bank can establish a branch anywhere in Texas provided that the branch is approved in advance by the Texas Department of Banking. The branch must also be approved by the Federal Reserve. When considering whether to approve the establishment of a branch, the Texas Department of Banking and the Federal Reserve consider a number of factors, including financial history, capital adequacy, earnings prospects, character of management, needs of the community and consistency with corporate powers. The Dodd-Frank Act permits insured state banks to engage in de novo interstate branching if the laws of the state where the new branch is to be established would permit the establishment of the branch if it were chartered by such state.

Regulatory Capital Requirements and Capital Adequacy

        The Federal Reserve monitors our capital adequacy, on a consolidated basis, and the Federal Reserve and the Texas Department of Banking monitor the capital adequacy of the Bank. The regulatory agencies use a combination of risk-based guidelines and a leverage ratio to evaluate capital adequacy and consider these capital levels when taking action on various types of applications and when conducting supervisory activities related to safety and soundness. Assets and off-balance sheet items, such as letters of credit and unfunded loan commitments, are assigned to broad risk categories, each with appropriate risk weights. Regulatory capital, in turn, is classified in one of two tiers. "Tier 1" capital includes common equity, retained earnings, qualifying non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock, and minority interests in equity accounts of consolidated subsidiaries, less goodwill, most intangible assets and certain other assets. "Tier 2" capital includes, among other things, qualifying subordinated debt and allowances for loan and lease losses, subject to limitations. The resulting capital ratios represent capital as a percentage of total risk-weighted assets and off-balance sheet items.

        Federal Reserve regulations currently require state chartered member banks and bank holding companies generally to maintain three minimum capital standards: (1) a Tier 1 capital to total assets ratio, or "leverage capital ratio," of at least 4.0%; (2) a Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets ratio, or "Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio," of at least 4.0%; and (3) a total risk-based capital (Tier 1 plus Tier 2) to risk-weighted assets ratio, or "total risk-based capital ratio," of at least 8.0%. In addition, the Texas Department of Banking has issued a policy which generally requires state chartered banks to maintain a leverage capital ratio of 5.0%. In addition, the prompt corrective action standards discussed below, in effect, increase the minimum regulatory capital ratios for banking organizations. These capital

101


Table of Contents

requirements are minimum requirements. Higher capital levels may be required if warranted by the particular circumstances or risk profiles of individual institutions, or if required by the banking regulators due to the economic conditions impacting our primary markets. For example, Federal Reserve regulations provide that higher capital may be required to take adequate account of, among other things, interest rate risk and the risks posed by concentrations of credit, nontraditional activities or securities trading activities.

        Failure to meet capital guidelines could subject us to a variety of enforcement remedies, including issuance of a capital directive, a prohibition on accepting brokered deposits, other restrictions on our business and the termination of deposit insurance by the FDIC.

        The Dodd-Frank Act directed federal banking agencies to establish minimum leverage capital requirements and minimum risk-based capital requirements for depository institution holding companies and non-bank financial companies supervised by the Federal Reserve that are not less than the "generally applicable leverage and risk-based capital requirements" applicable to insured depository institutions, in effect applying the same leverage and risk-based capital requirements that apply to insured depository institutions to most bank holding companies. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act requires the federal banking agencies to adopt capital requirements that address the risks that the activities of an institution pose to the institution and the public and private stakeholders, including risks arising from certain enumerated activities.

Basel III

        The current risk-based capital guidelines that apply to us and the Bank are based on the 1988 capital accord, referred to as Basel I, of the International Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, or Basel Committee, a committee of central banks and bank supervisors, as implemented by federal bank regulators. In 2004, the Basel Committee published a new capital accord, Basel II. Basel II modifies risk weightings in an attempt to make capital requirements more risk sensitive and provides two approaches for setting capital standards for credit risk: an "advanced," internal ratings-based approach tailored to individual institutions' circumstances, and a "standardized" approach that bases risk weightings on external credit assessments to a much greater extent than permitted under existing risk-based capital guidelines. Basel II also sets capital requirements for operational risk and refines the existing capital requirements for market risk exposures. In 2007, the federal banking agencies adopted final rules implementing the advanced approaches of Basel II for "core" bank holding companies and banks having $250.0 billion or more in total consolidated assets or $10.0 billion or more of foreign exposures. These rules did not apply to the Bank or us.

        On December 16, 2010, the Basel Committee released its final framework for strengthening international capital and liquidity regulation, known as Basel III, which substantially revised the existing capital requirements for banking organizations. Modest revisions were made in June 2011. The Basel III standards operate in conjunction with portions of the Basel I and Basel II standards previously released by the Basel Committee. On June 7, 2012, the Federal Reserve, the OCC and the FDIC requested comment on these proposed rules that, taken together, would implement the Basel regulatory capital reforms through what we refer to herein as the "Basel III Capital Rules."

        In July 2013, the federal banking agencies published the final Basel III Capital Rules, which revised their risk-based and leverage capital requirements and their method for calculating risk-weighted assets to implement, in part, agreements reached by the Basel Committee and certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. While some provisions are tailored to larger institutions, the Basel III Capital Rules generally apply to all banking organizations, including the Bank and us. Among other things, the Basel III Capital Rules: (1) introduce a new capital measure entitled "Common Equity Tier 1," or CET1; (2) specify that Tier 1 capital consist of CET1 and additional financial instruments satisfying specified requirements that permit inclusion in Tier 1 capital; (3) define CET1

102


Table of Contents

narrowly by requiring that most deductions or adjustments to regulatory capital measures be made to CET1 and not to the other components of capital; and (4) expand the scope of the deductions or adjustments from capital as compared to the existing regulations.

        Under the Basel III Capital Rules, banking organizations are provided a one-time option in their initial regulatory financial report filed after January 1, 2015 to remove certain components of accumulated other comprehensive income from the computation of common equity regulatory capital.

        The Basel III Capital Rules also provide a permanent exemption from the proposed phase out of existing trust preferred securities and cumulative perpetual preferred stock from regulatory capital for banking organizations with less than $15 billion in total assets, while also implementing stricter eligibility requirements for regulatory capital instruments that should serve to disallow the inclusion of all non-exempt issuances of trust preferred securities and cumulative perpetual preferred stock from Tier 1 capital. The Basel III Capital Rules also provide additional constraints on the inclusion of minority interests, mortgage servicing assets, deferred tax assets and certain investments in the capital of unconsolidated financial institutions in Tier 1 capital, as well as providing stricter risk weighting rules to these assets.

        The Basel III Capital Rules provide for the following minimum capital to risk-weighted assets ratios:

        A minimum leverage ratio (Tier 1 capital as a percentage of total assets) of 4.0% is also required under the Basel III Capital Rules. The Basel III Capital Rules additionally require institutions to retain a capital conservation buffer of 2.5% above these required minimum capital ratio levels. Banking organizations that fail to maintain the minimum 2.5% capital conservation buffer could face restrictions on capital distributions or discretionary bonus payments to executive officers, with distributions and discretionary bonus payments being completely prohibited if no capital conservation buffer exists, or in the event of the following: (1) the banking organization's capital conservation buffer was below 2.5% at the beginning of a quarter; and (2) its cumulative net income for the most recent quarterly period plus the preceding four calendar quarters is less than its cumulative capital distributions (as well as associated tax effects not already reflected in net income) during the same measurement period.

        The Basel III Capital Rules also provide stricter rules related to the risk weighting of past due and certain commercial real estate loans, as well as on some equity investment exposures, and replaces the existing credit rating approach for determining the risk weighting of securitization exposures with an alternative approach.

        Finally, the Basel III Capital Rules amend the thresholds under the prompt corrective action framework applicable to the Bank to reflect both (1) the generally heightened requirements for regulatory capital ratios as well as (2) the introduction of the CET1 capital measure.

        The enactment of the Basel III Capital Rules will increase the required capital levels of the Bank and us. The Basel III Capital Rules become effective as applied to us and the Bank on January 1, 2015, with a phase in period from January 1, 2015 through January 1, 2019. We expect that we will meet all minimum capital requirements under the final rule when it becomes effective and as if fully phased in at the bank and bank holding company levels.

103


Table of Contents

Liquidity Coverage Ratio

        The Basel III Capital Rules did not address the proposed liquidity coverage ratio called for by the Basel Committee's Basel III framework. On October 24, 2013, the Federal Reserve issued a proposed rule implementing a liquidity coverage ratio requirement in the United States for larger banking organizations. Neither the Bank nor we would be subject to the liquidity coverage ratio requirement as proposed.

Prompt Corrective Action

        Under the FDIA, the federal bank regulatory agencies must take prompt corrective action against undercapitalized U.S. depository institutions. U.S. depository institutions are assigned one of five capital categories: "well capitalized," "adequately capitalized," "undercapitalized," "significantly undercapitalized," and "critically undercapitalized," and are subjected to different regulation corresponding to the capital category within which the institution falls. Currently, a depository institution is deemed to be "well capitalized" if the banking institution has a total risk-based capital ratio of 10.0% or greater, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or greater, a leverage ratio of 5.0% or greater and the institution is not subject to an order, written agreement, capital directive or prompt corrective action directive to meet and maintain a specific level for any capital measure. Under certain circumstances, a well-capitalized, adequately capitalized or undercapitalized institution may be treated as if the institution were in the next lower capital category. A banking institution that is undercapitalized is required to submit a capital restoration plan. The capital restoration plan will not be accepted by the regulators unless each company having control of the undercapitalized institution guarantees the subsidiary's compliance with the capital restoration plan up to a certain specified amount.

        Failure to meet capital guidelines could subject the institution to a variety of enforcement remedies by federal bank regulatory agencies, including termination of deposit insurance by the FDIC, restrictions on certain business activities and appointment of the FDIC as conservator or receiver. As of June 30, 2014, the Bank met the requirements to be "well capitalized" under the prompt corrective action regulations.

        As discussed above, the Basel III Capital Rules amend the thresholds under the prompt corrective action framework applicable to the Bank to reflect both (1) the generally heightened requirements for regulatory capital ratios as well as (2) the introduction of the CET1 capital measure.

Regulatory Limits on Dividends and Distributions

        As a bank holding company, we are subject to certain restrictions on dividends under applicable banking laws and regulations. The Federal Reserve has issued a policy statement that provides that a bank holding company should not pay dividends unless (1) its net income over the last four quarters (net of dividends paid) has been sufficient to fully fund the dividends, (2) the prospective rate of earnings retention appears to be consistent with the capital needs, asset quality and overall financial condition of the bank holding company and its subsidiaries and (3) the bank holding company will continue to meet minimum required capital adequacy ratios. Accordingly, a bank holding company should not pay cash dividends that exceeds its net income or that can only be funded in ways that weaken the bank holding company's financial health, such as by borrowing. The Dodd-Frank Act imposes, and Basel III results in, additional restrictions on the ability of banking institutions to pay dividends.

        Substantially all of our income, and a principal source of our liquidity, are dividends from the Bank, and the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to us is also restricted by federal and state laws, regulations and policies. Texas state law places limitations on the amount that state banks may pay in dividends, which the Bank must adhere to when paying dividends to us. Federal law also imposes

104


Table of Contents

limitations upon certain capital distributions by banks that are members of the Federal Reserve System, such as certain cash dividends, payments to repurchase or otherwise acquire its shares, payments to shareholders of another institution in a cash-out merger and other distributions charged against capital. The Federal Reserve and Texas Department of Banking regulate all capital distributions by the Bank directly or indirectly to us, including dividend payments.

        Additionally, under federal law, the Bank may not pay a dividend to us if, after paying those dividends, the Bank would fail to meet the required minimum levels under risk-based capital guidelines and the minimum leverage and tangible capital ratio requirements. Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, or the FDIA, an insured depository institution such as the Bank is prohibited from making capital distributions, including the payment of dividends, if, after making such distribution, the institution would become "undercapitalized." The Federal Reserve may further restrict the payment of dividends by requiring the Bank to maintain a higher level of capital than would otherwise be required to be adequately capitalized for regulatory purposes. Payment of dividends by the Bank also may be restricted at any time at the discretion of the appropriate regulator if it deems the payment to constitute an unsafe and unsound banking practice. As noted above, the capital conservation buffer created under the Basel III Capital Rules, when fully implemented, may also have the effect of limiting the payment of capital distributions from the Bank.

Reserve Requirements

        In accordance with regulations of the Federal Reserve, all banking organizations are required to maintain average daily reserves at mandated ratios against their transaction accounts. In addition, reserves must be maintained on certain non-personal time deposits. These reserves must be maintained in the form of vault cash or in an account at a Federal Reserve Bank.

Limits on Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders

        Insured depository institutions are subject to restrictions on their ability to conduct transactions with affiliates and other related parties. Section 23A of the Federal Reserve Act imposes quantitative limits, qualitative requirements and collateral requirements on certain transactions by an insured depository institution with, or for the benefit of, its affiliates. Transactions covered by Section 23A include loans, extensions of credit, investment in securities issued by an affiliate and acquisitions of assets from an affiliate. Section 23B of the Federal Reserve Act requires that most types of transactions by an insured depository institution with, or for the benefit of, an affiliate be on terms at least as favorable to the insured depository institution as if the transaction were conducted with an unaffiliated third party.

        As noted above, the Dodd-Frank Act generally enhances the restrictions on transactions with affiliates under Section 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, including an expansion of the definition of "covered transactions" and a clarification regarding the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered credit transactions must be satisfied. The ability of the Federal Reserve to grant exemptions from these restrictions is also narrowed by the Dodd-Frank Act, including by requiring coordination with other bank regulators.

        The Federal Reserve's Regulation O regulations impose restrictions and procedural requirements in connection with the extension of credit by an insured depository institution to directors, executive officers, principal shareholders and their related interests.

Brokered Deposits

        The FDIA restricts the use of brokered deposits by certain depository institutions. Under the applicable regulations, (1) a well capitalized insured depository institution may solicit and accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit without restriction, (2) an adequately capitalized insured depository

105


Table of Contents

institution may not accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit unless it has applied for and been granted a waiver of this prohibition by the FDIC, and (3) an undercapitalized insured depository institution may not accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit. The FDIC may, on a case-by-case basis and upon application by an adequately capitalized insured depository institution, waive the restriction on brokered deposits upon a finding that the acceptance of brokered deposits does not constitute an unsafe or unsound practice with respect to such institution.

Concentrated Commercial Real Estate Lending Guidance

        The federal banking agencies, including the Federal Reserve, have promulgated guidance governing financial institutions with concentrations in commercial real estate lending. The guidance provides that a bank has a concentration in commercial real estate lending if (1) total reported loans for construction, land development and other land represent 100.0% or more of total capital or (2) total reported loans secured by multifamily and nonfarm residential properties and loans for construction, land development and other land represent 300.0% or more of total capital and the bank's commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased 50.0% or more during the prior 36 months. Owner occupied commercial real estate loans are excluded from this second category. If a concentration is present, management must employ heightened risk management practices that address the following key elements: including board and management oversight and strategic planning, portfolio management, development of underwriting standards, risk assessment and monitoring through market analysis and stress testing and maintenance of increased capital levels as needed to support the level of commercial real estate lending.

Examination and Examination Fees

        The Federal Reserve periodically examines and evaluates state member banks. Based on such an evaluation, the Bank, among other things, may be required to revalue its assets and establish specific reserves to compensate for the difference between the Bank's assessment and that of the Federal Reserve. The Texas Department of Banking also conducts examinations of state banks but may accept the results of a federal examination in lieu of conducting an independent examination. In addition, the Federal Reserve and Texas Department of Banking may elect to conduct a joint examination. The Federal Reserve currently charges fees to recover the costs of examining member banks, processing applications and other filings and covering direct and indirect expenses in regulating member banks. The Texas Department of Banking charges fees to recover the costs of examining Texas chartered banks. The Dodd-Frank Act provides various agencies with the authority to assess additional supervision fees.

Deposit Insurance and Deposit Insurance Assessments

        The FDIC is an independent federal agency that insures the deposits of federally insured depository institutions up to applicable limits. The FDIC also has certain regulatory, examination and enforcement powers with respect to FDIC-insured institutions. The deposits of the Bank are insured by the FDIC up to applicable limits. As a general matter, the maximum deposit insurance amount is $250,000 per depositor.

        FDIC-insured depository institutions are required to pay deposit insurance assessments to the FDIC. The amount of a particular institution's deposit insurance assessment for institutions with less than $10.0 billion in assets is based on that institution's risk classification under an FDIC risk-based assessment system, with certain adjustments for any unsecured debt or brokered deposits held by the insured bank. An institution's risk classification is assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to the regulators. Institutions assigned to higher risk categories (that is, institutions that pose a higher risk of loss to the Deposit Insurance Fund) pay assessments at higher rates than institutions that pose a lower risk. An institution's risk classification is

106


Table of Contents

assigned based on a combination of its financial ratios and supervisory ratings, reflecting, among other things, its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern that the institution poses to the regulators. Deposit insurance assessments fund the Deposit Insurance Fund, which is currently underfunded.

        As noted above, the Dodd-Frank Act changed the way an insured depository institution's deposit insurance premiums are calculated. Continued action by the FDIC to replenish the Deposit Insurance Fund, as well as these changes may impact assessment rates, which could impact the profitability of our operations.

Depositor Preference

        The FDIA provides that, in the event of the "liquidation or other resolution" of an insured depository institution, the claims of depositors of the institution (including the claims of the FDIC as subrogee of insured depositors) and certain claims for administrative expenses of the FDIC as a receiver will have priority over other general unsecured claims against the institution. If we invest in or acquire an insured depository institution that fails, insured and uninsured depositors, along with the FDIC, will have priority in payment ahead of unsecured, non-deposit creditors, including us, with respect to any extensions of credit they have made to such insured depository institution.

Anti-Money Laundering and OFAC

        Under federal law, financial institutions must maintain anti-money laundering programs that include established internal policies, procedures and controls; a designated compliance officer; an ongoing employee training program; and testing of the program by an independent audit function. Financial institutions are also prohibited from entering into specified financial transactions and account relationships and must meet enhanced standards for due diligence and customer identification in their dealings with non-U.S. financial institutions and non-U.S. customers. Financial institutions must take reasonable steps to conduct enhanced scrutiny of account relationships to guard against money laundering and to report any suspicious transactions, and law enforcement authorities have been granted increased access to financial information maintained by financial institutions. Bank regulators routinely examine institutions for compliance with these obligations and they must consider an institution's compliance with such obligations in connection with the regulatory review of applications, including applications for banking mergers and acquisitions. The regulatory authorities have imposed "cease and desist" orders and civil money penalty sanctions against institutions found to be violating these obligations.

        The U.S. Department of the Treasury's Office of Foreign Assets Control, or OFAC, is responsible for helping to ensure that U.S. entities do not engage in transactions with certain prohibited parties, as defined by various Executive Orders and Acts of Congress. OFAC publishes lists of persons, organizations and countries suspected of aiding, harboring or engaging in terrorist acts, known as Specially Designated Nationals and Blocked Persons. If we or the Bank find a name on any transaction, account or wire transfer that is on an OFAC list, we or the Bank must freeze or block such account or transaction, file a suspicious activity report and notify the appropriate authorities.

Consumer Laws and Regulations

        Banking organizations are subject to numerous laws and regulations intended to protect consumers. These laws include, among others:

107


Table of Contents

        Many states and local jurisdictions have consumer protection laws analogous, and in addition, to those listed above. These federal, state and local laws regulate the manner in which financial institutions deal with customers when taking deposits, making loans, or conducting other types of transactions. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations could give rise to regulatory sanctions, customer rescission rights, action by state and local attorneys general and civil or criminal liability. The creation of the CFPB by the Dodd-Frank Act has led to enhanced enforcement of consumer financial protection laws.

Community Reinvestment Act

        The CRA is intended to encourage banks to help meet the credit needs of their service areas, including low and moderate-income neighborhoods, consistent with safe and sound operations. The bank regulators examine and assign each bank a public CRA rating. The CRA then requires bank regulators to take into account the federally insured bank's record in meeting the needs of its service area when considering an application by a bank to establish or relocate a branch or to conduct certain mergers or acquisitions. The Federal Reserve is required to consider the CRA records of a bank holding company's controlled banks when considering an application by the bank holding company to acquire a banking organization or to merge with another bank holding company. When we or the Bank applies for regulatory approval to engage in certain transactions, the regulators will consider the CRA record of target institutions and our depository institution subsidiaries. An unsatisfactory CRA record could substantially delay approval or result in denial of an application. The regulatory agency's assessment of the institution's record is made available to the public. The Bank received an overall CRA rating of "satisfactory" on its most recent CRA examination.

Changes in Laws, Regulations or Policies

        Federal, state and local legislators and regulators regularly introduce measures or take actions that would modify the regulatory requirements applicable to banks, their holding companies and other financial institutions. Changes in laws, regulations or regulatory policies could adversely affect the operating environment for our company in substantial and unpredictable ways, increase our cost of doing business, impose new restrictions on the way in which we conduct our operations or add significant operational constraints that might impair our profitability. We cannot predict whether new legislation will be enacted and, if enacted, the effect that it, or any implementing regulations, would have on our business, financial condition or results of operations. The Dodd-Frank Act is in the process

108


Table of Contents

of imposing substantial changes to the regulatory framework applicable to us and our subsidiaries. The majority of these changes will be implemented over time by various regulatory agencies. The full effect that these changes will have on us remains uncertain at this time and may have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.

Effect on Economic Environment

        The policies of regulatory authorities, including the monetary policy of the Federal Reserve, have a significant effect on the operating results of bank holding companies and their subsidiaries. Among the means available to the Federal Reserve to affect the money supply are open market operations in U.S. government securities, changes in the discount rate on member bank borrowings and changes in reserve requirements against member bank deposits. These means are used in varying combinations to influence overall growth and distribution of bank loans, investments and deposits, and their use may affect interest rates charged on loans or paid for deposits. Federal Reserve monetary policies have materially affected the operating results of commercial banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future. We cannot predict the nature of future monetary policies and the effect of such policies on our business and earnings.

109


Table of Contents


MANAGEMENT

Executive Officers and Directors

        The following table sets forth information regarding our directors and executive officers as of the date of this prospectus.

Name
  Age   Position

C. Malcolm Holland, III

    54   Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and President

William C. Murphy

    65   Vice Chairman

Noreen E. Skelly

    49   Chief Financial Officer

LaVonda Renfro

    53   Executive Vice President and Chief Retail Officer

Angela Harper

    45   Executive Vice President and Credit Risk Officer

Jeff Kesler

    36   Chief Lending Executive

Pat S. Bolin

    63   Director

Blake Bozman

    43   Director

Mark Griege

    55   Director

Michael D. Ilagan

    47   Director

Michael Kowalski

    60   Director

John Sughrue

    53   Director

Ray W. Washburne

    54   Director

        The following is a brief discussion of the business and banking background and experience of our directors and executive officers. No director has any family relationship, as defined in Item 401 of Regulation S-K, with any other director or with any of our executive officers.

        C. Malcolm Holland, III founded our company and has been our Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President since 2009 and the Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President of the Bank since its inception in 2010. Mr. Holland began his career in 1982 as a credit analyst and commercial lender at First City Bank. In 1984, Mr. Holland joined Capital Bank as a vice president of commercial lending. From 1985 to 1998, Mr. Holland was an organizer and executive vice president of EastPark National Bank, a de novo bank that opened in 1986. EastPark National Bank was acquired by Fidelity Bank of Dallas in 1995, and Mr. Holland served as executive vice president and head of commercial lending for Fidelity Bank of Dallas from 1995 to 1998, when the bank was acquired by Compass Bank. From 1998 to 2000, Mr. Holland served as senior vice president and head of business banking for Compass Bank. Mr. Holland served as President of First Mercantile Bank from 2000 to 2002, when the bank was acquired by Colonial Bank. From 2003 to 2009, Mr. Holland served as Chief Executive Officer for the Texas Region of Colonial Bank. Mr. Holland is a past president of the Texas Golf Association and was one of 15 members of the Executive Committee of the United States Golf Association in 2013. Mr. Holland is an active member and chairman of the business advisory committee of Watermark Community Church. He has served as chairman of the College Golf Fellowship since 2002. Mr. Holland received his Bachelor of Business Administration from Southern Methodist University in 1982. With over 30 years of banking experience in the Dallas metropolitan area, Mr. Holland's extensive business and banking experience and his community involvement and leadership skills qualify him to serve as on our board and as Chairman.

        William C. Murphy has served as the Vice Chairman of both our company and the Bank since 2011 and actively participates in the execution of our business strategy and assists in the credit review process. From 2006 to 2011, Mr. Murphy served as the Chairman of the Board of Parkway National Bank and Parkway Bancshares, Inc., which were renamed Fidelity Bank of Dallas and Fidelity Resources Company, respectively. From 2001 to 2005, Mr. Murphy was the President and Chief Executive Officer of Mercantile Bank & Trust, and from 1999 to 2000, he served as a consultant for the Houston-based Sterling Bank to evaluate expansion opportunities in the Dallas market. From 1988 to

110


Table of Contents

1998, Mr. Murphy served as the President and Chief Executive Officer of Fidelity Bank of Dallas, and then as an executive officer of the bank after it was acquired by Compass Bank in 1998. Under his leadership Fidelity completed four bank acquisition and three branch acquisitions and grew to $350 million in total assets with 14 banking offices. Mr. Murphy serves on the boards of Eagle Oil & Gas Co. and Foundation One Insurance Services. Mr. Murphy received a Bachelor of Business Administration in accounting from Southern Methodist University in 1971 and a Masters of Business Administration from Southern Methodist University in 1973. With over 40 years of banking experience in the Dallas metropolitan area, Mr. Murphy's perspective, knowledge and extensive community relationships qualify him to serve on our board and as Vice Chairman.

        Noreen E. Skelly has served as the Chief Financial Officer of our company and the Bank since June 2012. Ms. Skelly is responsible for the Finance, Accounting, Treasury, and Information Technology functions of the Bank. From 2009 to March 2012, Ms. Skelly was the Chief Financial Officer of Highlands Bancshares, Inc., and from 2007 to 2009, she served as Senior Vice President and Retail Bank Division Finance Officer of Comerica Bank. From 1996 to 2007, Ms. Skelly served in various capacities for ABN AMRO/LaSalle Bank eventually becoming Senior Vice President and Chief Finance Officer of the Retail Line of Business. Ms. Skelly started her professional career at the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago in 1987 and was promoted in 1996 to serve as an accounting policy analyst for the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System in Washington D.C. Ms. Skelly received a Bachelor of Business Administration in finance from the University of Texas at Austin in 1987 and a Masters of Business Administration from the University of Chicago Booth School of Business in 1993.

        LaVonda Renfro has served as Executive Vice President and Chief Retail Officer of the Bank since 2010. Ms. Renfro is responsible for the overall administration and coordination of the activities of the Bank's branches, including operations, sales and marketing, deposit operations, merchant services, private banking, business banking and treasury management. From 2005 to 2010, Ms. Renfro served as the Retail Executive of Colonial Bank/BB&T. From 1994 to 2005, Ms. Renfro was Senior Vice President, District Manager for Bank of America's Austin and San Antonio Markets.

        Angela Harper has served as Executive Vice President and Credit Risk Officer of the Bank since 2009. Ms. Harper oversees the credit underwriting, loan operations, compliance and Bank Secrecy Act departments. From 2002 to 2009, Ms. Harper served in various capacities at Colonial Bank including Senior Vice President, Chief Credit Administration and Risk Management Officer for the Texas region. Ms. Harper began her career in banking as an OCC Bank Examiner from 1991 to 1995 working in the Dallas Duty Station. Ms. Harper received a Bachelor of Business Administration in Finance in 1989 and a Masters of Business Administration from Texas Tech University in 1990 and is a Certified Regulatory Compliance Manager (CRCM).

        Jeff Kesler has served as the Chief Lending Executive of the Bank since May 2014. Mr. Kesler is responsible for credit quality and profitability of the lending function. From May 2013 to May 2014, Mr. Kesler served as the Director of Loan Originations for United Development, a real estate investment trust. From 2009 to 2013, Mr. Kesler served as a Market President of Veritex Community Bank's North Dallas region. Mr. Kesler began his career in 2000 at Colonial Bank where he served in various capacities, eventually becoming an area president for the Dallas and Austin markets. Mr. Kesler received a Bachelor of Business Administration from Fort Hays State University in 2000.

        Pat S. Bolin joined our board of directors in March 2011 upon our acquisition of Fidelity Bank of Dallas. Mr. Bolin is the Executive Chairman of the Board of Eagle Oil & Gas Co. a private independent oil and gas company based in Dallas founded by Mr. Bolin in 1976. Mr. Bolin is also Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive officer of Eagle Corp., Inc. Mr. Bolin began his professional career as a landman for Mitchell Energy Corp. in 1973. Mr. Bolin currently serves on the board of directors of Fidelity Bank, Wichita Falls, Texas and its holding company, FB Bancshares, Inc. Mr. Bolin has previously served on the boards of directors of Mercantile Bank & Trust and Fidelity

111


Table of Contents

Bank of Dallas. Mr. Bolin also serves on the board of directors for Goodwill Industries and the executive board of the Southern Methodist University Cox School of Business and the Second Century Campaign Steering Committee at Southern Methodist University. Mr. Bolin received a Bachelor of Arts in Psychology from Southern Methodist University in 1973. Mr. Bolin's diverse business and community banking experience along with his community involvement qualify him to serve on our board.

        Blake Bozman has served on our board since September 2010. Mr. Bozman is a Managing Director of Freedom Truck Finance, a secondary truck finance company based in Dallas. From 2007 to 2013, Mr. Bozman oversaw the operations of Prattco International, Inc., a family-owned business specializing in real estate investments and purchasing oil and gas properties. From 1995 to 2006, Mr. Bozman was with Drive Financial Services, a consumer finance company focused on sub-prime auto finance, which he co-founded in 1995 and served as Executive Vice President of Sales and Originations. Mr. Bozman received a Bachelor of Arts in Marketing from Southern Methodist University in 1993. Mr. Bozman's business experience, particularly in the consumer financial services industry, qualifies him to serve on our board.

        Mark Griege has served on our board since 2009. Mr. Griege is a Managing Partner of Robertson, Griege & Thoele, a large-independent wealth management firm based in Dallas, which he co-founded in 1985. Mr. Griege received a Bachelor of Business Administration from Southern Methodist University in 1981, and a Juris Doctor from the University of Texas School of Law in 1985. His significant experience and leadership of Robertson, Griege & Thoele brings perspective and knowledge to our board regarding a variety of investment, businesses and leadership and qualifies him to serve on our board.

        Michael D. Ilagan has served on our board since 2014. Since 2006, Mr. Ilagan has been with SunTx Capital Partners, where he is currently a Principal. From 1998 to 2005, Mr. Ilagan was an attorney at Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher, & Flom, LLP, and from 1988 to 1991, he was a consultant at Bain & Company. He also serves on the board of directors of Carolina Beverage Group LLC and The Park Group Ltd. and previously served on the board of directors of Huron Inc. Mr. Ilagan received a Bachelor of Arts in Economics from the University of Chicago in 1988, a Masters of Business Administration from the University of Chicago in 1992, and a Juris Doctor from the Chicago-Kent College of Law in 1998. Mr. Ilagan's business experience and legal understanding qualifies him to serve on our board.

        Michael Kowalski has served as a director of our company and the Bank since June 2013. Since March 2013, Mr. Kowalski has served as Senior Vice President of Pacific Premier Bank, following its acquisition of First Associations Bank. From 2007 to March 2013, Mr. Kowalski served as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of First Associations Bank. Mr. Kowalski received a Bachelor of Science in Mathematics from John Carroll University in 1976 and has been a licensed Certified Public Accountant since 1979. Mr. Kowalski's financial expertise and 30 years of community banking experience provides our board with significant knowledge and insight regarding the business and operations of banks and qualifies him to serve on our board.

        John Sughrue has served as a director of our company since 2009. Mr. Sughrue currently serves as the Chairman of FIG Enterprises, Inc., the parent company of the Fashion Industry Gallery, a boutique wholesale venue for the fashion retail trade. Mr. Sughrue also serves as a Director and Chief Executive Officer of Brooks Partners, Inc., a diversified real estate company based in Dallas, which he founded in 1994. From 2007 to 2009, Mr. Sughrue served as an advisory board member for the Texas Region of Colonial Bank. From 1987 to 1989, Mr. Sughrue was an associate at Merrill Lynch Capital Markets and from 1983 to 1985 he was a Real Estate Lending Officer at Chemical Bank. Mr. Sughrue received a Bachelor of Arts in Economics from Harvard College in 1982 and a Masters of Business

112


Table of Contents

Administration from the Amos Tuck School of Business at Dartmouth College in 1988. Mr. Sughrue's significant business experience and community involvement qualifies him to serve on our board.

        Ray W. Washburne has served on our board since 2009. Mr. Washburne is currently the owner and serves as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Charter Holdings, a Dallas based private investment company. In addition, Mr. Washburne is the co-owner of M Crowd Restaurant Group, which owns the Mi Cocina and Taco Diner restaurant chains, which he co-founded in 1991. Since 2009 he has also served as the managing partner of the Highland Park Village, a premier retail destination in Dallas. Additionally, Mr. Washburne currently serves as the Finance Chairman of the Republican National Committee. Mr. Washburne received his Bachelor of Arts from Southern Methodist University in 1984. Mr. Washburne's leadership skills and business experience qualify him to serve on our board.

Composition of the Board of Directors

        Upon completion of the proposed offering, our board of directors will consist of                    members. As discussed in greater detail below, our board of directors has affirmatively determined that                    of our                    current directors qualify as independent directors based upon the corporate governance standards of the Nasdaq Stock Market.

        Under the terms of our amended and restated certificate of formation, our board of directors is elected at the annual meeting of shareholders, or special meeting in lieu thereof. Accordingly, the directors named above will stand for election at the 2015 annual meeting of shareholders, at which time their successors will be elected to serve from the time of election until the next annual meeting of shareholders following his or her election and the election and qualification of his or her successor. Individuals appointed to fill additional directorships resulting from an increase in the number of directors (as discussed above) will serve from the time such individual is appointed until the next annual meeting of shareholders and the election and qualification of his or her successor.

Director Independence

        Under the rules of the Nasdaq Stock Market, independent directors must comprise a majority of our board of directors within a specified period of time of this offering. The rules of the Nasdaq Stock Market, as well as those of the SEC, also impose several other requirements with respect to the independence of our directors. Our board of directors has undertaken a review of the independence of each director based upon these rules. Applying these standards, our board of directors has affirmatively determined that, with the exception of Messrs. Holland and Murphy, each of our current directors qualifies as an independent director under applicable rules. In making these determinations, our board of directors considered the current and prior relationships that each director has with our company and all other facts and circumstances our board of directors deemed relevant in determining their independence, including the beneficial ownership of our capital stock by each director, and the transactions involving them described in the section titled "Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions."

Risk Management and Oversight

        Our board of directors oversees our risk management process, including a company-wide approach to risk management, carried out by our management. Our full board determines the appropriate risk for us generally, assesses the specific risks faced by us, and reviews the steps taken by management to manage those risks. While our full board maintains the ultimate oversight responsibility for the risk management process, its committees oversee risk in certain specified areas. In particular, our compensation committee is responsible for overseeing the management of risks relating to our executive compensation plans and arrangements, and the incentives created by the compensation awards it administers. Our audit committee oversees management of enterprise risks as well as financial

113


Table of Contents

risks and, effective upon the consummation of this offering, will also be responsible for overseeing potential conflicts of interests. Effective upon the listing of our common stock on an exchange, our nominating and corporate governance committee will be responsible for overseeing the management of risks associated with the independence of our board of directors. Management regularly reports on applicable risks to the relevant committee or the full board, as appropriate, with additional review or reporting on risks conducted as needed or as requested by our board of directors and its committees.

Leadership Structure

        Our board of directors meets quarterly, and the board of directors of the Bank meets monthly. Our board of directors does not have a policy regarding the separation of the roles of Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board, as the board believes that it is in the best interests of our organization to make that determination from time to time based on the position and direction of our organization and the membership of the board. The board has determined that having our Chief Executive Officer serve as Chairman of the Board is in the best interests of our shareholders at this time. This structure makes best use of the Chief Executive Officer's extensive knowledge of our organization and the banking industry. The board views this arrangement as also providing an efficient nexus between our organization and the board, enabling the board to obtain information pertaining to operational matters expeditiously and enabling our Chairman to bring areas of concern before the board in a timely manner.

Committees of the Board of Directors

        Our board of directors plans to establish the following committees in connection with this offering: an audit committee, a compensation committee and a corporate governance and nominating committee. The composition and responsibilities of each committee are described below. Members will serve on these committees until their resignation or until otherwise determined by our board of directors.

Audit Committee

        Upon completion of this offering, our audit committee will consist of                    ,                     and                    , with                     serving as chair of the audit committee. Our audit committee will have responsibility for, among other things:

        Rule 10A-3 promulgated by the SEC under the Exchange Act and applicable Nasdaq Stock Market rules require our audit committee to be composed entirely of independent directors upon the effective date of our registration statement. Our board of directors has affirmatively determined that each of the members of our audit committee will qualify as independent directors under the rules of the Nasdaq

114


Table of Contents

Stock Market and for purposes of serving on an audit committee under applicable SEC rules. Our board of directors also has determined that qualifies as an "audit committee financial expert" as defined by the SEC.

        Our board of directors will adopt a written charter for our audit committee, which will be available on our corporate website upon completion of this offering.

Compensation Committee

        Upon completion of this offering, our compensation committee will consist of                    ,                    ,                     and                     , with                    serving as chair of the compensation committee. The compensation committee will be responsible for, among other things:

        Our board of directors has evaluated the independence of the members of our compensation committee and has determined that each of the members of our compensation committee is independent under Nasdaq Stock Market standards. The members of the compensation committee also qualify as "non-employee directors" within the meaning of Rule 16b-3 under the Exchange Act and "outside directors" within the meaning of Section 162(m) of the Code.

        Our board of directors will adopt a written charter for our compensation committee, which will be available on our corporate website upon completion of this offering.

Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee

        Upon completion of this offering, our corporate governance and nominating committee will consist of                    ,                     and                    , with                    serving as chair of the corporate governance and nominating committee. The corporate governance and nominating committee will be responsible for, among other things:

115


Table of Contents

        Our board of directors has evaluated the independence of the members of our corporate governance and nominating committee and has determined that each of the members of our corporate governance and nominating committee is independent under Nasdaq Stock Market standards.

        Our board of directors will adopt a written charter for our corporate governance and nominating committee, which will be available on our corporate website upon completion of this offering.

Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation

        None of our executive officers currently serves, or in the past year has served, as a member of the board of directors or compensation committee or other board committee serving equivalent functions of any entity that has one or more executive officers serving on our board of directors.

Corporate Governance Guidelines and Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

        Our board of directors will adopt corporate governance guidelines, which will set forth a flexible framework within which our board of directors, assisted by board committees, will direct the affairs of our company. The guidelines will address, among other things, the composition and functions of our board of directors, director independence, compensation of directors, management succession and review, board committees and selection of new directors.

        We will adopt a code of business conduct and ethics applicable to our directors, officers and employees including specific standards and guidelines applicable to our principal executive, financial and accounting officers and all persons performing similar functions. A copy of that code and the corporate governance guidelines will be available on our corporate website upon completion of this offering. We expect that any amendments to such code and guidelines, or any waivers of their requirements, will be disclosed on our corporate website and by other means required by the Nasdaq Stock Market rules.

116


Table of Contents


EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

        We are providing compensation disclosure that satisfies the requirements applicable to emerging growth companies, as defined in the JOBS Act. Our named executive officers for 2013, which consist of our principal executive officer and the two other most highly compensated executive officers, are:

Summary Compensation Table

        The following table provides information regarding the compensation of our named executive officers for the year ended December 31, 2013. Except as set forth in the notes to the table, all cash compensation for each of our named executive officers was paid by the Bank, where each serves in the same capacity.

Name and Principal Position
  Year   Salary(1)
($)
  Bonus(2)
($)
  Stock
Awards
($)
  Option
Awards
($)
  Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)
  Nonqualified
Deferred
Compensation
Earnings
($)
  All Other
Compensation
($)(3)
  Total
($)
 

C. Malcolm Holland, III

    2013   $ 260,000   $ 91,000                   $ 29,043   $ 377,543  

Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer & President

                                                       

William C. Murphy,

    2013     200,000     70,000                     25,817     295,817  

Vice Chairman of the Board

                                                       

Noreen E. Skelly,

    2013     200,000     60,000                         260,000  

Chief Financial Officer

                                                       

(1)
The amounts shown in this column reflect salaries earned during 2013.

(2)
The amounts shown reflect cash bonuses earned in 2013, but paid in 2014.

(3)
The amounts shown in this column include (i) club dues of $26,236 for Mr. Holland and $25,207 for Mr. Murphy, (ii) $307 in premiums for bank-owned life insurance policies with a death benefit of $100,000 payable to the designated beneficiary of the named executive officer and (iii) $2,500 in premiums for a life insurance policy we maintain that provides a death benefit payable to Mr. Holland's spouse.

117


Table of Contents

Outstanding Equity Awards at 2013 Fiscal Year-End

        The following table sets forth information relating to the unexercised options and outstanding stock awards held by the named executive officers as of December 31, 2013.

 
  Options Awards   Stock Awards  
Name
  Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
Exercisable
(#)(2)
  Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
Unexercisable
(#)
  Equity Incentive
Plan Awards:
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Unearned
Options
(#)
  Option
Exercise
Price
($)
  Option
Expiration
Date
  Number of
shares or
units of
stock that
have not
vested
(#)(3)
  Market
value of
shares or
units of
stock that
have not
vested
($)(10)
  Equity incentive
plan awards:
Number of
unearned
shares, units or
other rights
that have not
vested
(#)
  Equity incentive
plan awards:
Market or
payout value of
unearned
shares, units or
other rights
that have not
vested
($)
 

C. Malcolm Holland, III

                                  5,000 (4)   64,500          

                                  1,000 (5)   12,900          

    50,000     75,000 (6)       10.00     12/31/2020                          

        170,000 (7)       10.00     12/31/2020                          

William C. Murphy(1)

         
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Noreen E. Skelly

                                 
5,000

(8)
 
64,500
   
   
 

    4,000     16,000 (9)       10.00     6/30/2022                      

        20,000 (7)       10.00     6/30/2022                      

(1)
As of December 31, 2013, Mr. Murphy had no options or stock awards outstanding. On January 21, 2014, we issued Mr. Murphy time-based options to purchase 15,000 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $10.85, of which 9,000 were vested and fully exercisable as of the grant date, performance based options to purchase 35,000 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $10.85, which will become exercisable only upon a change of control and the achievement of certain investor returns as described below under "—Awards to Named Executive Officers," and 1,000 restricted stock units, the restrictions on which will lapse on January 21, 2016.

(2)
The time-based options shown in this column are fully vested and presently exercisable as of December 31, 2013.

(3)
Restrictions on shares disclosed in this column lapse on the fourth anniversary of the grant date.

(4)
Restrictions on restricted stock units lapse on January 1, 2015.

(5)
Restrictions on restricted stock units lapse on January 21, 2016.

(6)
Time-based options granted on January 1, 2011. Options to purchase 25,000 shares at an exercise price of $10.00 per share vested and became exercisable on January 1, 2014. As to the remaining 50,000 shares, options to purchase 25,000 will vest and become exercisable on each of January 1, 2015 and 2016.

(7)
Performance-based options will become exercisable only upon a change of control and the achievement of certain investor returns as described below under "—Awards to Named Executive Officers". Prior to the completion of this offering, we intend to cancel all of our performanced-based options as described below under "—2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan."

(8)
Restrictions on restricted stock units lapse on July 1, 2016.

(9)
Time-based options granted on July 1, 2012. Options to purchase 4,000 shares at an exercise price of $10.00 per share vested and became exercisable on July 1, 2014. As to the remaining 12,000 shares, options to purchase 4,000 shares will vest and become exercisable on each of July 1, 2015, 2016 and 2017.

(10)
Calculated using a market value of $12.90 per share based on a valuation of our Employee Stock Ownership Plan as of December 31, 2013.

2010 Equity Incentive Plan

        In 2010, we adopted the Veritex Holdings, Inc. 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan, or the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan, to provide incentive compensation opportunities that are competitive with those of similar companies in order to attract, retain and motivate eligible participants by providing for both the direct award or sale of shares and for the grant of options to purchase shares of our common stock. The maximum number of shares of our common stock that may be issued pursuant to grants or options under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan is 1,000,000. The board of directors authorized the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan to provide for the award of up to 100,000 shares of direct stock awards in the form of restricted shares and up to 900,000 shares of stock options, of which 500,000 shares are performance-based stock options. During 2013, we awarded 1,000 restricted shares,

118


Table of Contents

10,000 time-based stock options and 10,000 performance-based stock options. As of the date of this prospectus, we have granted 63,250 restricted stock units and options to purchase 830,000 shares of our common stock under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan. We have granted options under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan to our named executive officers, as described in greater detail below in "—Awards to Named Executive Officers." After this offering, no further options will be granted under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan. A summary of the material terms of the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan are described below.

        Plan Administration.    The 2010 Equity Incentive Plan is administered by our board of directors, which has the authority to designate participants, determine the type and number of awards to be granted under the plan and determine the terms and conditions of any such award.

        Eligibility.    The 2010 Equity Incentive Plan permits the grant of stock options not described in Sections 422(b) or 423(b) of the Code and the direct award or sale of shares of common stock to our employees, officers, outside directors and consultants. The plan also permits the grant of incentive stock options, or ISOs, to employees and officers.

        Agreements.    The terms of each grant or award of shares or stock options, including terms relating to vesting, are set forth in a stock option agreement or stock grant agreement; provided that no stock option award will have a term that exceeds 10 years from the date of grant. The awards of restricted shares generally vest after four (4) years of continuous service. The vesting of performance-based stock options that are issued and outstanding are generally contingent upon a change of control and the achievement of specific performance criteria or other objectives set at the grant date.

        Transfer Restrictions.    Any shares granted or issued upon exercise of an option are subject to special forfeiture conditions, rights of repurchase, rights of first refusal and other transfer restrictions as the board of directors may determine at the time of grant. Stock options are generally only transferable by beneficiary designation, gift to an immediate family member, a will or other laws of descent and distribution.

        Termination of Employment.    Unless the board of directors provides otherwise in an agreement, upon a termination of a participant's employment, such participant's stock options or unvested grant of shares will generally cease to be exercisable and will terminate on the date of such termination.

        Change in Control.    Unless the board of directors provides otherwise in a stock option agreement or stock grant agreement, upon a "change in control" (as defined in the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan) in which there is an acquiring or surviving entity, all options or grants to the extent not previously terminated or vested will be accelerated and fully exercisable.

        Right of Repurchase.    We generally have the right to repurchase the shares of stock, and the shares issuable upon the exercise of any stock option, issued under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan from the holder upon the termination of the holder's employment or upon the occurrence certain events relating to the holder's solvency. That repurchase right will terminate upon the completion of this offering.

        Amendment and Termination.    Our board of directors may, in its discretion, amend or alter the terms of the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan or any outstanding award under the plan at any time, provided that our shareholders must approve any amendment if the amendment increases the number of shares available for issuance under the plan or materially changes the class of persons who are eligible for the grant of ISOs. The 2010 Equity Incentive Plan will automatically terminate 10 years after the later of its adoption or the most recent increase in the number of shares reserved under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan that was approved by our shareholders.

119


Table of Contents

Awards to Named Executive Officers

        We have granted time-based options to each of our named executive officers. The time-based options held by Mr. Holland and Ms. Skelly vest annually in 20.0% increments on each of the first five anniversaries of the grant date. Forty percent of the time-based options held by Mr. Murphy vested on the grant date and the remaining time-based options vest in 20.0% increments beginning March 2014 and annually thereafter.

        We have also granted performance-based options to each of our named executive officers that will generally become exercisable as follows: (1) 35.0% of the performance-based options vest upon the occurrence of a "change in control"; (2) 35.0% of the performance-based options vest upon the occurrence of a "change of control" and the persons that acquired shares of our common stock in March 2010, or the 2010 Investors, having received either a 20.0% internal rate of return, defined as the fully diluted rate of return annualized for one share of stock on an original investment of $10.00 per share, or 2.5 times their original investment of $10.00 per share; and (3) the final 30.0% of the performance-based options vest upon the occurrence of a "change of control" and 2010 Investors having received either a 30.0% internal rate of return or 3.5 times their original investment of $10.00 per share. For purposes of the option agreements, a "change of control" is defined as (1) the consummation of a merger or consolidation of Veritex Holdings with or into another entity or any other corporate organization, if persons who were not shareholders immediately prior to such merger, consolidation or other reorganization own immediately after such merger, consolidation or other reorganization 50.0% or more of the voting power of the outstanding securities of each of the continuing or surviving entity, and any direct or indirect parent corporation of such continuing or surviving entity; or (2) the sale, transfer or other disposition of all or substantially all of our assets. Prior to the completion of this offering, we intend to cancel all of our performance based options as described below under "—2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan."

        We have also granted restricted stock units to each of our named executive officers. The restrictions on the restricted stock units held by Mr. Holland and Ms. Skelly lapse and the units are fully vested on the fourth anniversary of the grant date. The restrictions on the restricted stock units held by Mr. Murphy lapse and are fully vested on the third anniversary of the grant date.

        In addition to the terms described above, the stock grant and stock option agreements provide for the number of shares granted, the price per share, the initial vesting date, the vesting schedule, and the expiration date of the grant. We have a right of first refusal that will terminate on the closing of an initial public offering.

Employment Agreements

        Mr. Holland does not have a formal employment agreement. We and the Bank have entered into an executive employment agreement with Mr. Murphy, and the Bank has entered into a change of control agreement with Ms. Skelly.

        Mr. Murphy's employment agreement provides that Mr. Murphy will serve as vice chairman of our board of directors, and the board of directors of the Bank, for a term commencing on March 23, 2011 and ending on March 31, 2015. Under the employment agreement, Mr. Murphy is entitled to an annual base salary of $185,000 with merit increases, bonus and other incentives, if any, in accordance with the Bank's salary administration program based upon performance, as well as to certain other employment related benefits. Upon an involuntary termination of Mr. Murphy's employment by the board of directors without "good cause," as defined in the employment agreement, Mr. Murphy would be entitled to receive all compensation and benefits due to him under the employment agreement as if his employment had not been terminated. The employment agreement also contains post-termination non-solicitation covenants for one year after the date of the termination of his employment, except upon his termination by the Bank without "good cause."

120


Table of Contents

        The change of control agreement for Ms. Skelly provides that if a change of control occurs and the gross amount of the proceeds from Ms. Skelly's stock options and grants do not equal at least $200,000, then the Bank will supplement the deficiency such that the total gross amount received by Ms. Skelly as a result of the stock options, grants and change of control payment will be equal to $200,000.

2014 Omnibus Incentive Plan

        Prior to the completion of this offering, we intend to adopt an omnibus incentive plan or the 2014 Omnibus Plan. The purpose of the 2014 Omnibus Plan will be to align the long-term financial interests of our employees, directors, consultants and other service providers with those of our shareholders, to attract and retain those employees, directors, consultants and other service providers by providing compensation opportunities that are competitive with other companies and to provide incentives to those individuals who contribute significantly to our long-term performance and growth. To accomplish these goals, the 2014 Omnibus Plan may permit the issuance of stock options, share appreciation rights, restricted shares, restricted share units, deferred shares, unrestricted shares and cash-based awards. The maximum number of shares of our common stock that may be issued pursuant to grants or options under the 2014 Omnibus Plan is 1,000,000.

        Prior to the completion of this offering, we intend to cancel all of our outstanding performance-based options to purchase an aggregate of 472,500 shares of our common stock (none of which are currently exercisable). Concurrently with such cancellation, we intend to grant to our named executive officers and certain of our directors and employees a number of restricted stock units having an initial fair market value that is approximately 45.0% of the estimated fair value of the performance-based options that are cancelled. The new restricted stock units will vest in equal installments over a five year period beginning on the first anniversary of the closing of this offering. These grants will be made under our 2014 Omnibus Plan.

Director Compensation

        We currently pay our directors, other than those directors who are employed by the Bank or us, based on the directors' participation in board and committee meetings, and the Bank currently pays its directors in the same manner. Directors who are also employed by the Bank or us do not receive director remuneration for serving as a director of the Bank or us, but are compensated in their capacity as employees. The following table sets forth the compensation paid to each director who served on our board of directors in 2013, other than Messrs. Holland and Murphy, whose compensation is described in the "Summary Compensation Table" above. The table also includes compensation earned by each director that is attributable to his service as a director of the Bank.

Name
  Fees Earned or Paid
in Cash ($)
  Option
Awards ($)(1)
  Total ($)  

Pat S. Bolin

  $ 9,450       $ 9,450  

Blake Bozman

    13,500         13,500  

Ned Fleming, III

    (2)        

Mark Griege

    11,100         11,100  

John Sughrue

    13,200         13,200  

Ray W. Washburne

    11,250         11,250  

(1)
No options were granted to directors during the year ended December 31, 2013; however, as of December 31, 2013, Mr. Bolin held options to acquire 2,500 shares of our common stock, of which 2,000 were unvested, and each of Messrs. Bozman, Griege, Sughrue and Washburne held options to acquire 2,500 shares of our common stock, 1,500 of which were unvested.

(2)
In lieu of paying board fees to Mr. Fleming, at his request we donated the board fees to which he would otherwise be entitled to receive to a charity of his choice. In 2013, such donation was $10,750.

        All non-employee directors have been and will continue to be reimbursed for their reasonable out-of-pocket travel expenses incurred in attending meetings of our board of directors or any committees of the board of directors. Directors are also entitled to the protection provided by the indemnification provisions in our certificate of formation and bylaws, as well as the articles of association and bylaws of the Bank.

121


Table of Contents


PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

        The following table sets forth information with respect to the beneficial ownership of our common stock as of August 29, 2014, subject to certain assumptions set forth in the footnotes and as adjusted to reflect the sale of the shares of our common stock offered in this offering for:

        Beneficial ownership is determined in accordance with rules of the SEC and generally includes any shares over which a person exercises sole or shared voting and/or investment power. Shares of common stock subject to options and warrants currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days are deemed outstanding for purposes of computing the percentage ownership of the person holding the options or warrants but are not deemed outstanding for purposes of computing the percentage ownership of any other person. Except as otherwise indicated, we believe the beneficial owners of the common stock listed below, based on information furnished by them, have sole voting and investment power with respect to the number of shares listed opposite their names.

        The number of shares to be sold in this offering and the number of shares and percentages of beneficial ownership after this offering set forth below are based on 6,358,832 shares of our common stock outstanding on August 29, 2014, plus the number of shares of our common stock to be sold in this offering, assuming no exercise of the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares.

        Unless otherwise indicated, the address of each of the individuals named in the table below under "Executive Officers and Directors" is c/o Veritex Holdings, Inc., 8214 Westchester Drive, Suite 400, Dallas, Texas 75225.

 
  Shares
Beneficially Owned
Prior to this Offering
  Shares
Beneficially Owned
After Giving Effect
to this Offering
 
Name
  Number   Percentage   Percentage  

Executive Officers and Directors:

                   

C. Malcolm Holland, III(1)

    139,825     2.2 %      

William C. Murphy(2)

    568,862     8.9 %      

Noreen E. Skelly(3)

    8,000     *        

Pat S. Bolin(4)

    65,610     1.0 %      

Blake Bozman(5)

    110,718     1.7 %      

Mark Griege(6)

    36,500     *        

Michael Kowalski

    10,000     *        

Michael D. Ilagan

               

John Sughrue(7)

    28,805     *        

Ray W. Washburne(8)

    148,943     2.3 %      

All Executive Officers and Directors as a group (10 persons)

    1,117,263     17.3 %      

Other 5% Shareholders:

                   

SunTx Veritex Holdings, LP(9)

    1,572,370     24.7 %      

Gregg Allen(10)

    344,515     5.4 %      

*
Amount represents less than 1.0% of outstanding common stock.

122


Table of Contents

(1)
Includes: (i) 54,825 shares owned jointly by Mr. Holland and his spouse, (ii) 10,000 shares held by Pershing LLC IRA for his benefit and (iii) stock options to purchase 75,000 shares of our common stock.

(2)
Includes: (i) 65,000 shares held by William C. Murphy Pension & Profit Sharing Plan & Trust, (ii) 32,259 shares held by William C. Murphy, a sole proprietor, 401(k) Plan, (iii) stock options to purchase 9,000 shares, and (iv) 462,603 shares held by WCM Parkway, Ltd., over which Mr. Murphy has sole voting control. The principal address of WCM Parkway, Ltd. is 3836 Caruth Boulevard, Dallas, Texas 75225.

(3)
Includes options to purchase 8,000 shares of our common stock.

(4)
Includes: (i) 27,305 shares held by the Aurora S. Bolin Revocable Trust, of which Mr. Bolin is the trustee; (ii) 27,305 shares held by Eagle Creek Capital, LP, which is controlled by Mr. Bolin, (iii) options to purchase 1,000 shares, and (iv) warrants to purchase 10,000 shares of common stock presently exercisable, issued to Red Star Yield Holdings, Inc. a wholly owned subsidiary of Eagle Oil & Gas, which is controlled by Mr. Bolin.

(5)
Includes: (i) 81,913 shares held in Mr. Bozeman's name, (ii) 27,305 shares held by Bozman DFS Partnership, and (iii) options to purchase 1,500 shares of our common stock.

(6)
Includes: (i) 35,000 shares held jointly by Mr. Griege and his spouse and (ii) options to purchase 1,500 shares of our common stock.

(7)
Includes: (i) 27,305 shares held individually by Mr. Sughrue and (ii) options to purchase 1,500 shares of our common stock.

(8)
Includes: (i) 5,530 shares held by the Incline Trust, of which Mr. Washburne is the Trustee, (ii) 60,000 shares held by Huron Holdings, Inc., Profit Sharing Plan, over which Mr. Washburne has sole voting control, and (iii) options to purchase 1,500 shares.

(9)
All of these shares are held by SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P., an entity controlled by Ned Fleming, III. The business address of SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P., is 5420 LBJ Freeway, Suite 1000, Dallas, Texas 75240.

(10)
The business address of Mr. Allen is 13455 Noel Road, Suite 2000, Dallas, Texas 75240.

123


Table of Contents


CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

General

        Some of our officers, directors and principal shareholders and their affiliates are customers of the Bank. Such officers, directors and principal shareholders and their affiliates have had transactions in the ordinary course of business with the Bank, including borrowings, all of which were effected on substantially the same terms and conditions, including interest rate and collateral, as those prevailing from time to time for comparable transactions with unaffiliated persons and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or other unfavorable features. We expect to continue to have such transactions on similar terms and conditions with such officers, directors and shareholders and their affiliates in the future.

        In addition to the above-described relationships and the director and executive officer compensation arrangements discussed above under "Executive Compensation," the following is a description of transactions since January 1, 2011, including currently proposed transactions to which we have been or are to be a party in which the amount involved exceeded or will exceed $120,000, and in which any of our directors (including nominees), executive officers or beneficial holders of more than 5.0% of our capital stock, or their immediate family members or entities affiliated with them, had or will have a direct or indirect material interest. We believe the terms and conditions set forth in such agreements are reasonable and customary for transactions of this type.

Directed Share Program

        At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to        shares of our common stock offered by this prospectus for sale, at the initial public offering price, to our directors, executive officers and employees who have expressed an interest in purchasing our common stock in this offering. We will offer these shares to the extent permitted under applicable regulations in the United States through a directed share program. See "Underwriting—Directed Share Program."

124


Table of Contents

Private Placements of Common Stock

        The following table summarizes the purchases of our common stock in private placement transactions since January 1, 2011 by certain of our directors, executive officers and beneficial holders of more than 5.0% of our capital stock and their respective affiliates:

Stockholder
  Issue Date   Shares   Total Purchase Price  

Pat S. Bolin (director)

  March 23, 2011     25,000 (1) $ 250,000  

  March 23, 2011     25,000 (2)   250,000  

C. Malcolm Holland, III (Chairman and Chief Executive Officer)

 

February 1, 2014

   
13,825
   
150,001
 

William C. Murphy (Vice Chairman and 5% holder)

 

March 23, 2011

   
65,000

(3)
 
650,000
 

  March 23, 2011     462,603 (4)   4,626,030  

  February 1, 2014     32,259 (5)   350,010  

Mark Griege (director)

 

December 23, 2013

   
35,000
   
358,500
 

Ray W. Washburne (director)

 

March 23, 2011

   
25,000
   
250,000
 

  September 20, 2011     25,000     250,000  

  May 14, 2012     60,000 (6)   600,000  

SunTx Veritex Holdings, LP. (5% holder)

 

March 23, 2011

   
458,881
   
4,588,810
 

  June 27, 2011     10,610     106,100  

  September 26, 2011     38,792     387,920  

  May 30, 2012     27,353     273,530  

  January 23, 2013     21,552     215,520  

  January 21, 2014     17,274     187,423  

  February 1, 2014     123,124     1,335,895  

(1)
Shares purchased by the Aurora S. Bolin Revocable Trust, of which Pat S. Bolin is the Trustee.

(2)
Shares purchased by Eagle Creek Capital, LP, which Pat S. Bolin is the managing partner.

(3)
Shares purchased by William C. Murphy, a sole proprietor, 401K plan.

(4)
Shares purchased by WCM Parkway, Ltd. a limited partnership controlled by Mr. Murphy.

(5)
Shares purchased by William C. Murphy Pension & Profit Sharing Plan & Trust.

(6)
Shares purchased by Huron Holdings, Inc. profit sharing plan, which is controlled by Mr. Washburne.

Private Placement of Subordinated Notes and Warrants

        On December 23, 2013, we completed a private placement of $5.0 million in aggregate principal amount of subordinated promissory notes to Fidelity Bank, Wichita Falls, Texas, and Red Star Yield Holdings, LLC, each of which is an affiliate of Pat S. Bolin, one of our directors. In connection with the issuance of the notes, we also issued to these investors warrants to purchase an aggregate of 25,000 shares of our common stock at an exercise price of $11.00 per share. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Subordinated Notes" for additional description of the subordinated notes and warrants.

Agreements with SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P.

        SunTx currently owns 24.7% of our outstanding common stock, and is expected to own, following the completion of this offering,         % of our outstanding common stock (or        % if the underwriters

125


Table of Contents

exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full). Pursuant to an agreement between SunTx and us, SunTx is entitled to nominate one representative to serve on our board of directors and the board of directors of the Bank for so long as SunTx holds at least 4.9% of our issued and outstanding common stock. We must use our reasonable best efforts to have the SunTx representative elected to our board. The director representative of SunTx is entitled to the same compensation, indemnification and reimbursement rights as the other members of our board of directors. In addition, SunTx also has the right to appoint a non-voting observer to attend our board meetings and those of the Bank. We also granted SunTx information and access rights with respect to our business. Michael D. Ilagan currently serves as the SunTx representative on our board of directors and the board of directors of the Bank.

        In connection with the investment, we also made certain representations and warranties and covenants and agreed to provide indemnification rights to SunTx in connection with such representations and warranties.

Registration Rights Agreement

        Prior to the completion of this offering, we will enter into a registration rights agreement with SunTx and WCM Parkway, Ltd. Under this agreement, beginning 180 days after the date of this prospectus, each of these holders may require us to file a registration statement under the Securities Act to register the sale of shares of our common stock, subject to certain limitations. These stockholders may each request a total of two such registrations and only one in any six-month period. These holders also have the right to cause us to register their shares of our common stock on Form S-3, when it becomes available to us. In addition, if we propose to register securities under the Securities Act, then the holders who are party to the agreement will have "piggy-back" rights to request that we register their shares of our common stock, subject to certain limitations including quantity limitations determined by underwriters if the offering involves an underwriting. There is no limit to the number of these "piggy-back" registrations in which these holders may request their shares be included. We will bear the registration expenses incurred in connection with these registrations, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, except that the holders will bear the registration expenses incurred in connection with registrations requested and filed prior to the first anniversary of the date of this prospectus. We have agreed to indemnify these stockholders against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, in connection with any registration effected under the agreement.

Review and Approval of Transactions with Related Persons

        Transactions by us with related parties are subject to a formal written policy, as well as regulatory requirements and restrictions. These requirements and restrictions include Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act (which govern certain transactions by the Bank with its affiliates) and the Federal Reserve's Regulation O (which governs certain loans by the Bank to its executive officers, directors, and principal shareholders). See "Regulation and Supervision—Limits on Transactions with Affiliates and Insiders." We have adopted policies to comply with these regulatory requirements and restrictions.

        In connection with this offering, we intend to supplement our related party transaction policy in order to comply with all applicable requirements of the SEC and the Nasdaq Stock Market concerning related party transactions. Related party transactions will be referred for approval or ratification to our audit committee. In determining whether to approve a related party transaction, our audit committee will consider, among other factors, the fairness of the proposed transaction, the direct or indirect nature of the director's, executive officer's or related party's interest in the transaction, the appearance of an improper conflict of interests for any director, executive officer or related party, taking into account the size of the transaction and the financial position of the director, executive officer or related party, whether the transaction would impair an outside director's independence, the acceptability of the transaction to our regulators and the potential violations of other corporate policies. A copy of this policy and our audit committee charter will be available on our corporate website upon completion of this offering.

126


Table of Contents


DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

General

        The following discussion summarizes some of the important rights of our shareholders upon completion of this offering. This discussion does not purport to be a complete description of these rights and may not contain all of the information regarding our common stock that is important to you. These rights can be determined in full only by reference to federal and state banking laws and regulations, the Texas Business Organizations Code and our certificate of formation and bylaws.

        We are incorporated in the State of Texas. The rights of our shareholders are generally covered by Texas law and our certificate of formation and bylaws (each as amended and restated and in effect as of the completion of this offering). The terms of our capital stock are therefore subject to Texas law, including the Texas Business Organizations Code, and the common and constitutional law of Texas. The following discussion describes the terms of our amended and restated certificate of formation and bylaws. Our amended and restated certificate of formation and bylaws will be filed with the SEC as Exhibit 3.1 and Exhibit 3.2 to the registration statement on Form S-1 of which this prospectus is a part, and we encourage you to read those documents.

        Upon completion of this offering, our amended and restated certificate of formation will authorize us to issue up to 75,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $0.01 per share, and 10,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $1.00 per share, of which 8,000 shares are designated as Series C preferred stock. The authorized but unissued shares of our capital stock will be available for future issuance without shareholder approval, unless otherwise required by applicable law or the rules of any applicable securities exchange.

        As of June 30, 2014, 6,358,832 shares of our common stock were issued and outstanding, and held by approximately 300 shareholders of record, and 8,000 shares of our Series C preferred stock were issued and outstanding and held by the U.S. Treasury. All of our shares outstanding at that date were fully paid and non-assessable. Also as of June 30, 2014, options to purchase 830,000 shares of our common stock and 63,250 restricted stock units held by our employees, officers and directors under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan, and warrants to purchase 25,000 shares of common stock were outstanding.

Common Stock

        Voting Rights.    Subject to any special voting rights that may be given to any series of preferred stock that we may issue in the future, holders of our common stock are entitled to one vote per share in the election of directors and on all other matters submitted to a vote of our shareholders. Shareholders are not entitled to cumulate their votes with respect to the election of directors. Directors are elected by a plurality of the votes cast.

        Dividend Rights.    Holders of our common stock are entitled to dividends when, as and if declared by our board of directors out of funds legally available therefor.

        Liquidation Rights.    Upon any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our affairs, all shares of our common stock will be entitled to share equally in all remaining assets after the holders of shares of preferred stock or other senior securities have received the liquidation preference of their shares plus any declared but unpaid dividends, if any, and after all other indebtedness has been retired.

        Other.    Our common stock has no preemptive or conversion rights and is not entitled to the benefits of any redemption or sinking fund provision.

127


Table of Contents

Preferred Stock

        Our amended and restated certificate of formation permits us to issue one or more series of preferred stock and authorizes our board of directors to designate the preferences, limitations and relative rights of any such series of preferred stock, in each case, without any further action by our shareholders. Preferred stock may have voting rights, subject to applicable law and the determination at issuance by our board of directors. While the terms of preferred stock may vary from series to series, holders of our common stock should assume that all shares of preferred stock will be senior to our common stock in respect of distributions and on liquidation.

        Although the creation and authorization of preferred stock does not, in and of itself, have any effect on the rights of the holders of our common stock, the issuance of one or more series of preferred stock may affect the holders of common stock in a number of respects, including the following:

Series C Preferred Stock

        As of the date of this prospectus, only one series of preferred stock is authorized, issued and outstanding. On August 25, 2011, we issued 8,000 shares of our Series C preferred stock, $1,000 liquidation value per share, in connection with our participation in the U.S. Treasury's SBLF program, all of which are currently outstanding.

        Voting Rights.    The holders of the Series C preferred stock do not have voting rights other than with respect to certain matters relating to the rights of holders of Series C preferred stock, on certain corporate transactions such as a merger or sale of all or substantially all of our assets, and, if applicable, the election of additional directors described below.

        Dividends.    The Series C preferred stock is entitled to receive non-cumulative dividends, payable quarterly, on each January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1. The dividend rate is currently 1.0% per annum. Beginning February, 2016, the dividend rate will increase to 9.0% per annum.

        Dividends on the Series C preferred stock are non-cumulative. If for any reason our board of directors does not declare a dividend on the Series C preferred stock for a particular dividend period, then the holders of the Series C preferred stock will have no right to receive any dividend for that dividend period, and we will have no obligation to pay a dividend for that dividend period. Our failure to pay a dividend on the Series C preferred stock will restrict our ability to pay dividends on and repurchase other classes and series of our capital stock, including our common stock. In addition, our failure to pay dividends on the Series C preferred stock for six or more dividend periods, whether consecutive or not, will give the holders of the Series C preferred stock the right to appoint a non-voting observer on our board of directors.

        Redemption.    The Series C preferred stock may be redeemed at any time at our option, at a redemption price of 100% of the liquidation amount plus accrued but unpaid dividends to the date of redemption for the current period, regardless of whether such dividends have been declared for that period, subject to the approval of our primary federal banking regulator.

128


Table of Contents

        Liquidation Rights.    In the event of any voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of our affairs, holders of the Series C preferred stock will be entitled to receive for each share of Series C preferred stock, out of our assets or proceeds available for distribution to our shareholders, subject to any rights of our creditors, before any distribution of assets or proceeds is made to or set aside for the holders of our common stock payment of an amount equal to the sum of (1) the $1,000 liquidation preference amount per share of Series C preferred stock and (2) the amount of any accrued and unpaid dividends on the Series C preferred stock.

        Registration Rights.    As part of the terms of our participation in the SBLF, we agreed to provide the holders of our Series C preferred stock with the right to demand that we file a registration statement on Form S-3 or request that their shares be covered by a registration statement that we are otherwise filing. However, because this is our initial public offering and we are not eligible to file a registration statement on Form S-3, neither the demand registration rights nor the "piggyback" registration rights granted to the U.S. Treasury will apply at the time of this offering. Following our initial public offering, the U.S. Treasury may exercise its "piggyback" registration rights in connection with future offerings of our common stock, other than registration statements filed on Forms S-4 or S-8.

Warrants

        We have issued warrants to purchase 25,000 shares of our common stock, at an exercise price of $11.00 per share, exercisable at any time, in whole or in part, on or prior to December 31, 2023. All of such warrants are outstanding.

Business Combinations under Texas Law

        A number of provisions of Texas law and our amended and restated certificate of formation and bylaws could have an anti-takeover effect and make any potential acquisition of our organization by means of a tender offer, a proxy contest or otherwise and the removal of incumbent directors more difficult. These provisions are intended to discourage coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids and to encourage persons seeking to acquire control of our company to negotiate first with our board of directors.

        We are subject to the provisions of Title 2, Chapter 21, Subchapter M of the Texas Business Organizations Code, or the Texas Business Combination Law, which provides that a Texas corporation that qualifies as an "issuing public corporation" (as defined in the Texas Business Combination Law) may not engage in specified types of business combinations, including mergers, consolidations and asset sales, with a person, or an affiliate or associate of that person, who is an "affiliated shareholder." For purposes of this law, an "affiliated shareholder" is, or was, during the prior three years, the beneficial owner of 20.0% or more of the corporation's voting shares. The prohibition on certain transactions with such affiliated shareholders extends for a three-year period from the date such shareholder first becomes an affiliated shareholder. These prohibitions do not apply if:

129


Table of Contents

        As we currently have more than 100 shareholders, we are considered an "issuing public corporation" for purposes of this law. The Texas Business Combination Law does not apply to the following:

        Neither our amended and restated certificate of formation nor our amended and restated bylaws contains any provision expressly providing that we will not be subject to the Texas Business Combination Law. As a result, the Texas Business Combination Law may prevent a non-negotiated merger or other business combination involving us, even if such a merger or combination would be beneficial to our shareholders.

Action by Written Consent

        Under Texas law, no action required or permitted to be taken at an annual or special meeting of shareholders may be taken by written consent in lieu of a meeting of shareholders without the unanimous written consent of all shareholders entitled to vote on the action unless the certificate of formation specifically allows action to be taken by a written consent of the shareholders holding at least the minimum number of shares necessary to take the action that is subject to that consent at a meeting of shareholders, even though such consent is not signed by all of the corporation's shareholders. Our amended and restated certificate of formation provides for shareholder action by less than unanimous written consent.

Certain Certificate of Formation and Bylaw Provisions Potentially Having an Anti-takeover Effect

        Certain provisions of our amended and restated certificate of formation and bylaws may have an anti-takeover effect and thus discourage potential takeover attempts and make it more difficult for our shareholders to change management or receive a premium for their shares. These provisions include:

130


Table of Contents

        In addition to these provisions of our amended and restated certificate of formation and bylaws, banking laws impose notice, approval, and ongoing regulatory requirements on any shareholder or other party that seeks to acquire direct or indirect "control" of an FDIC-insured depository institution. These laws include the BHC Act and the Change in Bank Control Act. These laws could delay or prevent an acquisition. See "Regulation and Supervision—Notice and Approval Requirements Related to Control."

Limitation of Liability and Indemnification of Officers and Directors

        Our amended and restated certificate of formation will provide that our directors and officers will be indemnified by us to the fullest extent permitted by the Texas Business Organizations Code, against all expenses incurred in connection with their service for or on our behalf. In addition, our amended and restated certificate of formation will provide that our directors and officers will not be personally liable for monetary damages to us to the fullest extent permitted by the Texas Business Organizations Code.

        In connection with this offering, we intend to enter into indemnification agreements with our officers and directors pursuant to which they will be indemnified as described above and will be advanced costs and expenses subject to the condition that such officers and directors will reimburse us for all advancements paid if a final judicial determination is made that such officer or director is not entitled to indemnification under applicable law or regulation.

Transfer Agent and Registrar

        The transfer agent and registrar for our common stock is                    , at                    .

Listing

        We intend to apply to list our common stock on the NASDAQ Global Market under the symbol "VBTX."

131


Table of Contents


SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

        Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our common stock, and no predictions can be made about the effect, if any, that market sales of shares of our common stock or the availability of such shares for sale will have on the market price prevailing from time to time. Nevertheless, the actual sale of, or the perceived potential for the sale of, our common stock in the public market may have a material adverse effect on the market price for our common stock and could impair our ability to raise capital through future sales of our securities.

Sale of Restricted Shares

        Upon completion of this offering, we will have an aggregate of                    shares of our common stock outstanding. Of these shares, the                    shares of our common stock to be sold in this offering (or                    shares of our common stock if the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full) will be freely tradable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act, except for any shares which may be acquired by any of our affiliates as that term is defined in Rule 144 under the Securities Act. The remaining                    shares of our common stock outstanding, and the 25,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of our currently outstanding warrants, will be restricted securities, as that term is defined in Rule 144, and such shares and any unrestricted shares acquired by any of our affiliates may in the future be sold under the Securities Act to the extent permitted by Rule 144 or any applicable exemption under the Securities Act.

Stock Incentive Plans

        Following the completion of this offering, we intend to file a registration statement on Form S-8 under the Securities Act with the SEC to register                    shares of our common stock issued or reserved for issuance under the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan and the 2014 Omnibus Plan. The Form S-8 is expected to become effective immediately upon filing. As a result, subject to expiration of any lock-up restrictions as described below and following the completion of any remaining vesting periods and other vesting requirements, shares of our common stock issued under our plans, and shares of our common stock issuable upon the exercise of options granted or to be granted under our plans, will be freely tradable without restriction under the Securities Act, unless such shares are held by any of our affiliates.

        As of June 30, 2014, time-based options to purchase a total of 357,500 shares of common stock under our stock option plans were outstanding, of which options to purchase 181,200 shares were exercisable, performance-based options to purchase a total of 472,500 shares of common stock were outstanding, none of which were exercisable, and 63,250 restricted stock units were outstanding that were not fully vested. Prior to the completion of this offering, we intend to cancel all of our performance-based options and to grant additional restricted stock units. See the section titled "Executive Compensation" for a description of our stock option plans.

Lock-up Agreements

        Holders of approximately        % of the shares of our common stock outstanding prior to this offering, including all of our executive officers and directors, have agreed not to sell any shares of our common stock for a period of at least 180 days from the date of this prospectus, subject to certain exceptions. See "Underwriting."

Rule 144

        In general, under Rule 144 under the Securities Act as currently in effect, beginning 90 days after the date of this offering, a person who is not one of our affiliates who has beneficially owned shares of our common stock for at least six months may sell shares without restriction, provided the current

132


Table of Contents

public information requirements of Rule 144 continue to be satisfied. If a person who is not one of our affiliates has beneficially owned the shares of common stock proposed to be sold for at least one year, then that person may sell those shares without complying with any of the requirements of Rule 144, including the 90 day period described above. We estimate that substantially all of the shares of common stock that are not subject to the lock-up restrictions described above have been held by non-affiliates for at least one year and therefor may be freely sold by such persons upon the completion of this offering.

        Our affiliates who have beneficially owned shares of our common stock for at least six months may, in reliance on Rule 144, sell within any three-month period a number of shares that does not exceed the greater of:

Sales of restricted shares by our affiliates under Rule 144 are also subject to requirements regarding the manner of sale, notice, and the availability of current public information about us. Rule 144 also provides that affiliates relying on Rule 144 to sell shares of our common stock that are not restricted shares must nonetheless comply with the same restrictions applicable to restricted shares, other than the holding period requirement.

Registration Rights

        SunTx and WCM Parkway, Ltd. have certain registration rights with respect to their shares. See "Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions—Registration Rights Agreement."

Rule 701

        In general, under Rule 701 of the Securities Act, any of our employees, consultants or advisors who purchased shares from us in connection with a qualified compensatory stock plan or other written agreement, such as our 2010 Equity Incentive Plan, before the effective date of the registration statement for this offering that was completed in reliance on Rule 701 and complied with the requirements of Rule 701 will, subject to the lock-up restrictions described below, be eligible to resell such shares 90 days after the date of this prospectus in reliance on Rule 144, but without compliance with certain restrictions, including the holding period, contained in Rule 144.

133


Table of Contents


MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES FOR NON-U.S. HOLDERS

        The following is a general discussion of the material U.S. federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of our common stock by a non-U.S. holder (as defined below) that purchases our common stock pursuant to this offering and holds such common stock as a capital asset (generally, property held for investment). This discussion is based on currently existing provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, or the Code, applicable U.S. Treasury regulations promulgated thereunder, judicial decisions, and rulings and pronouncements of the U.S. Internal Revenue Service, or the IRS, all as in effect on the date hereof and all of which are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect, or subject to different interpretation.

        This discussion does not address all the tax consequences that may be relevant to specific holders in light of their particular circumstances or to holders subject to special treatment under U.S. federal income tax laws (such as financial institutions, insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, controlled foreign corporations, passive foreign investment companies, retirement plans, partnerships and their partners, dealers in securities, brokers, U.S. expatriates, persons who have acquired our common stock as compensation or otherwise in connection with the performance of services, or persons who have acquired our common stock as part of a straddle, hedge, conversion transaction or other integrated investment). In addition, this discussion does not address any other U.S. federal tax consequences (such as the Medicare contribution tax or U.S. federal estate or gift tax) or any aspects of state, local, or foreign tax laws.

        If a partnership or other entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes holds our common stock, the tax treatment of a partner will generally depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. A partnership that holds our common stock and any partner who owns an interest in such a partnership should consult their tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal income tax consequences of an investment in our common stock.

        YOU ARE URGED TO CONSULT YOUR TAX ADVISOR WITH RESPECT TO THE APPLICATION OF THE U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX LAWS TO YOUR PARTICULAR SITUATION, AS WELL AS ANY TAX CONSEQUENCES OF THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF OUR COMMON STOCK ARISING UNDER THE U.S. FEDERAL ESTATE OR GIFT TAX RULES OR UNDER THE LAWS OF ANY STATE, LOCAL, NON-U.S. OR OTHER TAXING JURISDICTION OR UNDER ANY APPLICABLE TAX TREATY.

        As used in this discussion, the term "non-U.S. holder" refers to a beneficial owner of our common stock that for U.S. federal income tax purposes is neither a partnership (including any entity or arrangement treated as a partnership for such purposes) nor:

Dividends and Distributions

        In the event that we make a distribution of cash or other property (other than certain distributions of our stock) in respect of our common stock, the distribution generally will be treated as a dividend to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits as determined under U.S. federal income

134


Table of Contents

tax principles. To the extent those distributions exceed both our current and our accumulated earnings and profits, they will first constitute a nontaxable return of capital, on a share-by-share basis, and will first reduce your basis in our common stock, but not below zero, and then will be treated as gain from the disposition of the common stock, the tax treatment of which is discussed below under "Sale, Exchange or Other Taxable Disposition."

        Any dividend paid to you generally will be subject to U.S. withholding tax either at a rate of 30.0% of the gross amount of the dividend or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty. In order to receive a reduced treaty rate, you must provide us with an IRS Form W-8BEN (or successor form) or other appropriate version of IRS Form W-8 (or successor form), including a U.S. taxpayer identification number, certifying qualification for the reduced rate. A non-U.S. holder of shares of our common stock eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS. If the non-U.S. holder holds the stock through a financial institution or other agent acting on the non-U.S. holder's behalf, the non-U.S. holder will be required to provide appropriate documentation to the agent, which then will be required to provide certification to us or our paying agent, either directly or through other intermediaries.

        Dividends received by you that are effectively connected with your conduct of a U.S. trade or business (and, if an income tax treaty applies, that are attributable to a permanent establishment or a fixed base maintained by you in the United States), are exempt from such withholding tax. In order to obtain this exemption, you must provide us with an IRS Form W-8ECI (or successor form) or other applicable IRS Form W-8 (or successor form) properly certifying such exemption. Such effectively connected dividends, although not subject to withholding tax, generally are taxed at the same graduated rates applicable to U.S. persons, net of certain deductions and credits. In addition, if you are a corporate non-U.S. holder, dividends you receive that are effectively connected with your conduct of a U.S. trade or business may also be subject to a branch profits tax at a rate of 30.0% or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty.

        A non-U.S. holder eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. withholding tax pursuant to an income tax treaty may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by timely filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS.

Sale, Exchange or Other Taxable Disposition

        Subject to the discussion below regarding backup withholding and foreign accounts, you generally will not be required to pay U.S. federal income tax on any gain realized upon the sale or other disposition of our common stock unless:

        We believe that we are not currently and will not become a USRPHC. However, because the determination of whether we are a USRPHC depends on the fair market value of our U.S. real property relative to the fair market value of our other business assets, there can be no assurance that

135


Table of Contents

we will not become a USRPHC in the future. Even if we become a USRPHC, however, as long as our common stock is regularly traded on an established securities market, such common stock will be treated as U.S. real property interests only if you actually or constructively hold more than 5.0% of such regularly traded common stock at any time during the shorter of the five-year period preceding your disposition of, or your holding period for, our common stock.

        If you are a non-U.S. holder described in the first bullet above, you will be required to pay tax on the net gain derived from the sale under regular graduated U.S. federal income tax rates, and a corporate non-U.S. holder described in the first bullet above also may be subject to the branch profits tax at a 30.0% rate, or such lower rate as may be specified by an applicable income tax treaty. If you are an individual non-U.S. holder described in the second bullet above, you will be required to pay a flat 30% tax on the gain derived from the sale, which tax may be offset by U.S.-source capital losses for the year. You should consult any applicable income tax or other treaties that may provide for different rules.

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

        Information returns will be filed with the IRS in connection with payments of dividends and the proceeds from a sale or other disposition of our common stock. Information reporting and backup withholding (at the then applicable rate) may also apply to payments made to you on or with respect to our common stock, unless you certify as to your status as a non-U.S. person under penalties of perjury or otherwise establishes an exemption and certain other conditions are satisfied. Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to you will be allowed as a refund or a credit against your U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that the required information is timely furnished to the IRS.

Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act

        After June 30, 2014, withholding at a rate of 30.0% generally will be required on dividends in respect of, and, after December 31, 2016, gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of, our common stock held by or through certain foreign financial institutions (including investment funds), unless such institution enters into an agreement with the U.S. Treasury Department to report, on an annual basis, information with respect to interests in, and accounts maintained by, the institution that are owned by certain U.S. persons and by certain non-U.S. entities that are wholly or partially owned by U.S. persons and to withhold on certain payments. An intergovernmental agreement between the United States and an applicable foreign country, or future Treasury regulations or other guidance, may modify these requirements. Accordingly, the entity through which our common stock is held will affect the determination of whether such withholding is required. Similarly, dividends in respect of, and gross proceeds from the sale or other disposition of, our common stock held by an investor that is a non-financial non-U.S. entity that does not qualify under certain exemptions generally will be subject to withholding at a rate of 30.0%, unless such entity either (1) certifies that such entity does not have any "substantial United States owners" or (2) provides certain information regarding the entity's "substantial United States owners." Prospective investors should consult their tax advisors regarding the possible implications of these rules on their investment in our common stock.

136


Table of Contents


UNDERWRITING

        We are offering the shares of our common stock described in this prospectus in an underwritten offering in which we and Sandler O'Neill + Partners, L.P. and Stephens Inc., as representatives of the underwriters for this offering, will enter into an underwriting agreement with respect to the common stock being offered. Subject to the terms and conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, the underwriters named below have agreed, severally and not jointly, to purchase the respective number of shares of our common stock set forth opposite their respective names below:

Name
  Numbers of
Shares

Sandler O'Neill + Partners, L.P. 

   

Stephens Inc. 

   

Sterne, Agee & Leach, Inc. 

   
     

Total

   
     
     

        The underwriting agreement provides that the underwriters' obligation to purchase shares of our common stock depends on the satisfaction of the conditions contained in the underwriting agreement, including:

        Subject to these conditions, the underwriters are committed to purchase and pay for all of the shares of our common stock offered by this prospectus, if any such shares are purchased. However, the underwriters are not obligated to take or pay for the shares of our common stock covered by the underwriters' purchase option described below, unless and until that option is exercised. The underwriting agreement also provides that if an underwriter defaults, the purchase commitments of non-defaulting underwriters may be increased or this offering may be terminated.

        We intend to apply to list our common stock on the NASDAQ Global Market under the symbol "VBTX."

Discounts, Commissions and Expenses

        Shares of our common stock sold by the underwriters to the public will be offered at the initial public offering price set forth on the cover of this prospectus. Any shares of our common stock sold by the underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount of up to $        per share from the initial public offering price. Any of these securities dealers may resell any shares of our common stock purchased from the underwriters to other brokers or dealers at a discount of up to $        per share from the initial public offering price. If all of the shares of our common stock are not sold at the initial public offering price, the representatives may change the offering price and the other selling terms. Sales of shares of our common stock made outside of the United States may be made by affiliates of the underwriters. The underwriters reserve the right to reject an order for the purchase of shares, in whole or in part.

137


Table of Contents

        The following table shows the initial public offering price, underwriting discount and proceeds before expenses to us. The information assumes either no exercise or full exercise by the underwriters of their over-allotment option to purchase an additional            shares, discussed below:

 
  Per Share   No Exercise   Full Exercise

Initial public offering price

  $               $               $            

Underwriting discounts and commissions to be paid by us

           

Proceeds to us, before expenses

           

        In addition to the underwriting discount, we will reimburse the underwriters for their reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with their engagement as underwriters, including marketing, syndication and travel expenses, and will pay the fees and expenses of the underwriters in connection with the directed share program and the reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel for the underwriters in connection with this offering and the directed share program, in each case regardless of whether this offering is consummated. These reimbursements and payments will not exceed $450,000. In addition to these amounts and the underwriting discount, we estimate the expenses of this offering to be approximately $                    and are payable by us.

Purchase Option

        We have granted the underwriters an option to buy up to            additional shares of our common stock, at the initial public offering price less underwriting discounts, to cover over-allotments. The underwriters may exercise this option, in whole or from time to time in part, solely for the purpose of covering over-allotments, if any, made in connection with this offering. The underwriters have 30 days from the date of this prospectus to exercise this option. If the underwriters exercise this option, each underwriter will be obligated, subject to the conditions in the underwriting agreement, to purchase a number of additional shares of our common stock proportionate to such underwriter's initial amount relative to the total amount reflected next to their name in the table above. We will be obligated to sell these shares of common stock to the underwriters to the extent the purchase option is exercised.

Indemnification and Contribution

        We have agreed to indemnify the underwriters, and persons who control the underwriters, against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act, and to contribute to payments that the underwriters may be required to make in respect of these liabilities.

Lock-Up Agreements

        We, our directors and executive officers, and certain other current shareholders have entered into lock-up agreements with the underwriters. Under these agreements, we and each of these persons may not, without the prior written approval of the representatives, subject to limited exceptions,

138


Table of Contents

        These restrictions will be in effect for a period of 180 days after the date of the underwriting agreement. The representatives may, in its sole discretion, waive or release all or some of the securities from these lock-up agreements.

        These restrictions also apply to any shares of our common stock sold in the directed share program described below under "—Directed Share Program."

Pricing of the Offering

        Prior to this offering, there has been no established public market for our common stock. The initial public offering price will be determined by negotiations among us and the representatives of the underwriters. In addition to prevailing market conditions, among the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price of our common stock will be our historical performance, estimates of our business potential and our earnings prospects, an assessment of our management and the consideration of the above factors in relation to market valuation of companies in related businesses. The estimated initial public offering price range set forth on the cover page of this preliminary prospectus is subject to change as a result of market conditions and other factors. An active trading market for the shares of our common stock may not develop. It is also possible that the shares will not trade in the public market at or above the initial public offering price following the completion of this offering.

Directed Share Program

        At our request, the underwriters have reserved up to            shares of our common stock offered by this prospectus, for sale, at the initial public offering price, to our directors, executive officers and employees who have expressed an interest in purchasing our common stock in this offering. The number of shares available for sale to the general public in the offering will be reduced to the extent these persons purchase the reserved shares. Any reserved shares not so purchased will be offered by the underwriters to the general public on the same terms as the other shares. Any shares sold in the directed share program will be subject to the 180-day lock-up agreements described above.

Stabilization

        In connection with this offering, the underwriters may, but are not obligated to, engage in stabilizing transactions, overallotment transactions, syndicate covering transactions and penalty bids.

139


Table of Contents

        These stabilizing transactions, syndicate covering transactions and penalty bids may have the effect of raising or maintaining the market price of our common stock or preventing or mitigating a decline in the market price of our common stock. As a result, the price of our common stock in the open market may be higher than it would otherwise be in the absence of these transactions. Neither we nor the underwriters make any representation or prediction as to the effect that the transactions described above may have on the price of our common stock. These transactions may be effected on the NASDAQ Global Market, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.

Passive Market Making

        In connection with this offering, the underwriters and selling group members may engage in passive market making transactions in our common stock on the NASDAQ Global Market in accordance with Rule 103 of Regulation M under the Exchange Act during a period before the commencement of offers or sales of our common stock and extending through the completion of the distribution of this offering. A passive market maker must display its bid at a price not in excess of the highest independent bid of that security. However, if all independent bids are lowered below the passive market maker's bid, that bid must then be lowered when specified purchase limits are exceeded. Passive market making may cause the price of our common stock to be higher than the price that otherwise would exist in the open market in the absence of those transactions. The underwriters and dealers are not required to engage in a passive market making and may end passive market making activities at any time.

Electronic Distribution

        This prospectus may be made available in electronic format on websites or through other online services maintained by one or more of the underwriters, or by their affiliates. Other than this prospectus in electronic format, information on such websites and any information contained in any other website maintained by the underwriters or any of their affiliates is not part of this prospectus or registration statement of which the prospectus forms a part, has not been approved or endorsed by us or the underwriters in their capacities as underwriters and should not be relied on by investors.

Our Relationship with the Underwriters

        The underwriters and their respective affiliates are full service financial institutions engaged in various activities, which may include securities trading, commercial and investment banking, financial advisory, investment management, investment advisory, investment research, principal investment, hedging, financing, loan referrals, valuation and brokerage activities. From time to time, the underwriters and/or their respective affiliates have directly and indirectly engaged, and may in the future engage, in various financial advisory, investment banking loan referrals and commercial banking services with us and our affiliates, for which they received or paid, or may receive or pay, customary compensation, fees and expense reimbursement. In the ordinary course of their various business activities, the underwriters and their respective affiliates may make or hold a broad array of

140


Table of Contents

investments and actively trade debt and equity securities (or related derivative securities) and financial instruments (including bank loans) for their own account and for the accounts of their customers, and those investment and securities activities may involve securities and/or instruments of ours. The underwriters and their respective affiliates may also make investment recommendations and/or publish or express independent research views in respect of those securities or instruments and may at any time hold, or recommend to clients that they acquire, long and/or short positions in those securities and instruments.

141


Table of Contents


LEGAL MATTERS

        The validity of the common stock offered hereby will be passed upon for us by Bracewell & Giuliani LLP, Houston, Texas, and for the underwriters by Fenimore, Kay, Harrison & Ford, LLP, Austin, Texas.


EXPERTS

        The consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2013 included in this prospectus and included elsewhere in the registration statement have been so included in reliance upon the Grant Thornton LLP, independent registered public accountants, upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

        The consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2012 and for the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011 included in this prospectus and included elsewhere in the registration statement have been audited by JonesBaggett LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing elsewhere herein. Such consolidated financial statements are included in reliance upon the report of such firm given upon their authority as experts in accounting and auditing.


WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION

        We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act relating to the shares of common stock offered by this prospectus that includes important business and financial information about us that is not included in or delivered with this prospectus. If we have made references in this prospectus to any contracts, agreements or other documents and also filed any of those contracts, agreements or other documents as exhibits to the registration statement, you should read the relevant exhibit for a more complete understanding of the document or the matter involved.

        You may read and copy the registration statement and the related exhibits, and the reports, proxy statements and other information we will file with the SEC, at the SEC's public reference room maintained by the SEC at Room 1580, 100 F Street N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. You can also request copies of those documents, upon payment of a duplicating fee, by writing to the SEC. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the operation of the public reference room. The SEC also maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other information regarding issuers that file with the SEC. The site's Internet address is www.sec.gov. We also maintain a website at www.veritexbank.com. Upon completion of this offering, you may access these materials free of charge as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. Information contained on our website is not a part of this prospectus and the inclusion of our website address in this prospectus is an inactive textual reference only. You should not rely on any such information in making your decision whether to purchase our securities.

142


Table of Contents


INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements of Veritex Holdings, Inc.:

   

Consolidated Condensed Balance Sheets as of June 30, 2014 (Unaudited) and December 31, 2013

 
F-2

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Income for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 (Unaudited)

  F-3

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 (Unaudited)

  F-4

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 (Unaudited)

  F-5

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Cash Flows for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 (Unaudited)

  F-6

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

  F-7

Audited Consolidated Financial Statements of Veritex Holdings, Inc.:

 
 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 
F-38

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  F-39

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2013 and 2012

  F-40

Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

  F-41

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

  F-42

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

  F-43

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

  F-44

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

  F-45

F-1


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Condensed Balance Sheets (Unaudited)

June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013

(Dollars in thousands, except par value information)

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

ASSETS

             

Cash and due from banks

  $ 10,038   $ 8,484  

Interest bearing deposits in other banks

    56,512     68,162  
           

Total cash and cash equivalents

    66,550     76,646  

Investment securities

    50,547     45,604  

Loans held for sale

    6,342     2,051  

Loans, net

    535,403     490,158  

Accrued interest receivable

    1,359     1,351  

Bank-owned life insurance

    10,647     10,475  

Bank premises, furniture and equipment, net

    11,303     9,952  

Non-marketable equity securities

    2,959     2,714  

Investment in subsidiary

    93     93  

Other real estate owned

    2,494     1,797  

Intangible assets

    1,413     1,567  

Goodwill

    19,148     19,148  

Other assets

    2,124     3,415  
           

Total assets

  $ 710,382   $ 664,971  
           
           

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

             

Deposits:

             

Noninterest-bearing

  $ 236,198   $ 218,990  

Interest-bearing

    374,976     354,948  
           

Total deposits

    611,174     573,938  

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

    1,195     1,214  

Accrued interest payable and other liabilities

    696     508  

Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    15,000     15,000  

Other borrowings

    8,073     8,072  
           

Total liabilities

    636,138     598,732  

Commitments and contingencies (Note 6)

             

Stockholders' equity:

             

Preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 500,000 shares authorized; 8,000 shares Series C, issued and outstanding with a $1,000 liquidation value

    8,000     8,000  

Common stock, $0.01 par value; 10,000,000 shares authorized, 6,358,832 and 5,804,703 shares issued and outstanding at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, (excluding 10,000 shares held in treasury)

    64     58  

Additional paid-in capital

    61,419     55,303  

Retained earnings

    5,038     2,922  

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    194     26  

Unallocated Employee Stock Ownership Plan shares; 36,935 shares at June 30, 2014

    (401 )    

Less: Treasury stock, 10,000 shares at cost

    (70 )   (70 )
           

Total stockholders' equity

    74,244     66,239  
           

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 710,382   $ 664,971  
           
           

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-2


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Income (Unaudited)

For the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2014   2013  

Interest income:

             

Interest and fees on loans

  $ 12,718   $ 10,918  

Interest on investment securities

    422     280  

Interest on deposits in other banks

    77     60  

Interest on other

    1     1  
           

Total interest income

    13,218     11,259  
           

Interest expense:

             

Interest on deposit accounts

    1,161     1,060  

Interest on borrowings

    251     156  
           

Total interest expense

    1,412     1,216  
           

Net interest income

    11,806     10,043  

Provision for loan losses

    677     1,008  
           

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    11,129     9,035  
           

Noninterest income:

             

Service charges on deposit accounts

    396     369  

Gain on sales of investment securities

    34      

Gain on sales of loans held for sale

    245     424  

Gain on sales of other real estate owned

    37     17  

Bank-owned life insurance

    212     166  

Other

    287     330  
           

Total noninterest income

    1,211     1,306  
           

Noninterest expense:

             

Salaries and employee benefits

    4,838     4,446  

Occupancy of bank premises

    920     830  

Depreciation and amortization

    667     607  

Data processing

    426     358  

FDIC assessment fees

    217     186  

Legal fees

    59     48  

Other professional fees

    543     274  

Advertising and promotions

    93     78  

Utilities and telephone

    141     143  

Other real estate owned expenses and writedowns

    134     243  

Other

    956     895  
           

Total noninterest expense

    8,994     8,108  
           

Net income from operations

    3,346     2,233  

Income tax expense

    1,190     774  
           

Net income

  $ 2,156   $ 1,459  
           
           

Preferred stock dividends

    40     40  
           

Net income available to common stockholders

  $ 2,116   $ 1,419  
           

Basic earnings per share

  $ 0.34   $ 0.25  
           
           

Diluted earnings per share

  $ 0.33   $ 0.24  
           
           

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-3


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Comprehensive Income (Unaudited)

For the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

(Dollars in thousands)

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2014   2013  

Net income

  $ 2,156   $ 1,459  
           

Other comprehensive (loss) income:

             

Unrealized gains (losses) on securities available for sale arising during the period, net

    289     (498 )

Reclassification adjustment for net gains included in net income

    34      
           

Other comprehensive gains (losses) before tax

    255     (498 )

Income tax expense (benefit)

    87     (169 )
           

Other comprehensive gains (losses), net of tax

    168     (329 )
           

Comprehensive income

  $ 2,324   $ 1,130  
           
           

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-4


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity (Unaudited)

For the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

(Dollars in thousands)

 
   
   
   
   
   
   
  Unallocated
Employee
Stock
Ownership
Plan Shares
   
   
 
 
   
  Common stock    
   
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
   
   
 
 
  Preferred
Stock
  Additional
Paid-In
Capital
  Retained
Earnings
  Treasury
Stock
   
 
 
  Shares   Amount   Total  

Balance at December 31, 2013

  $ 8,000     5,804,703   $ 58   $ 55,303   $ 2,922   $ 26   $   $ (70 ) $ 66,239  

Sale of common stock

        508,047     6     5,432                     5,438  

Preferred stock dividend Series C

                    (40 )               (40 )

Sale and finance of stock to ESOP

        46,082         500             (500 )        

ESOP shares allocated

                19             99         118  

Stock based compensation

                165                     165  

Net income

                    2,156                 2,156  

Other comprehensive income

                        168             168  
                                       

Balance at June 30, 2014

  $ 8,000     6,358,832   $ 64   $ 61,419   $ 5,038   $ 194   $ (401 ) $ (70 ) $ 74,244  
                                       
                                       

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-5


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Condensed Statements of Cash Flows (Unaudited)

For the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

(Dollars in thousands)

 
  Six Months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2014   2013  

Cash flows from operating activities:

             

Net income

  $ 2,156   $ 1,459  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

             

Depreciation and amortization

    667     607  

Provision for loan losses

    677     1,008  

Accretion of loan purchase discount

    (234 )   (226 )

Stock based compensation expense

    165     160  

Amortization of other intangible assets

    7     7  

Net amortization of premiums on investment securities

    217     184  

Change in cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    (172 )   (141 )

Gain on sales of investment securities

    (34 )    

Gain on sales of loans held for sale

    (245 )   (424 )

Amortization of subordinated note discount

    1      

Net gain on sales of other real estate owned

    (37 )   (2 )

Writedowns of other real estate owned

        171  

Net originations of loans held for sale

    (18,779 )   (23,958 )

Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale

    14,733     24,407  

Decrease in accrued interest receivable, prepaids and other assets

    1,283     415  

Increase in accrued expenses and other liabilities

    83     309  
           

Net cash provided by operating activities

    488     3,976  
           

Cash flows from investing activities:

             

Purchases of securities available for sale

    (10,983 )   (14,560 )

Sales of securities available for sale

    981      

Proceeds from maturities, calls and pay downs of securities available for sale

    5,130     4,886  

Purchases of non-marketable equity securities, net

    (245 )   (124 )

Net loans originated

    (46,798 )   (25,772 )

Purchases of bank-owned life insurance

        (5,000 )

Net additions to bank premises and equipment

    (1,871 )   (246 )

Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned

    450     1,009  
           

Net cash used in investing activities

    (53,336 )   (39,807 )
           

Cash flows from financing activities:

             

Net change in deposits

    37,236     64,631  

Net increase in advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

        5,000  

Dividends paid on preferred stock

    (40 )   (40 )

Proceeds from payments on ESOP Loan

    118      

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

    5,438     1,151  
           

Net cash provided by financing activities

    42,752     70,742  
           

Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents

    (10,096 )   34,911  

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

    76,646     53,160  
           

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

  $ 66,550   $ 88,071  
           
           

Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:

             

Cash paid for interest

  $ 1,346   $ 1,212  

Cash paid for income taxes

  $ 1,230   $ 800  

Supplemental disclosures of non-cash flow information:

             

Sale and finance of stock to ESOP

  $ 500      

Net foreclosure of other real estate owned

  $ 1,110   $ 1,092  

   

See accompanying notes to condensed consolidated financial statements.

F-6


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

Nature of Operations

        Veritex Holdings, Inc. (Veritex) through its wholly-owned subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank, a Texas state banking organization (Bank) (collectively known as the Company), with corporate offices in Dallas, Texas, currently operates nine branches located throughout the greater Dallas, Texas metropolitan area. The Bank provides a full range of banking services to individual and corporate customers, which include commercial and retail lending, and the acceptance of checking and savings deposits. The Texas Department of Banking and the Federal Reserve are the primary regulators of the Bank, which undergoes periodic examinations by those regulatory authorities in addition to the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.

Organization and Basis of Presentation

        The accompanying unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Veritex and its wholly-owned subsidiary, the Bank. All material intercompany transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

        The accompanying unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (U.S. GAAP), but do not include all of the information and footnotes required for complete financial statements. In management's opinion, these interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements include all adjustments of a normal recurring nature necessary for a fair statement of the Company's consolidated financial position at June 30, 2014, consolidated results of operations for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, consolidated stockholders' equity for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and consolidated cash flows for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013.

        Accounting measurements at interim dates inherently involve greater reliance on estimates than at year end and the results for the interim periods shown in this report are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for the full year due in part to global economic and financial market conditions, interest rates, access to sources of liquidity, market competition and interruptions of business processes. These interim unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the Company's audited consolidated financial statements and notes thereto for the year ended December 31, 2013 included within this Company's Form S-1 registration statement.

        The preparation of financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. These estimates and assumptions may also affect disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from these estimates.

Segment Reporting:

        The Company has one reportable segment. The Company's chief operating decision- maker uses consolidated results to make operating and strategic decisions.

F-7


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


ESOP

        Shares of the Company's common stock purchased by the Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) are held in a suspense account until released for allocation to participants. Shares released are allocated to each eligible participant based on the participant's 401(k) contribution made during that year.

        Compensation expense is measured based upon the expected amount of the Company's discretionary contribution which is determined on an annual basis and is accrued ratably over the year. Shares are committed to be released to settle the liability upon formal declaration of the contribution at the end of the year. The number of shares released to settle the liability is based upon fair value of the shares as of the end of year and become outstanding shares for earnings per share computations. The cost of shares issued to the ESOP, but not yet committed to be released, is shown as a reduction of stockholders' equity. To the extent that the fair value of the ESOP shares differs from the cost of such shares, the difference is charged or credited to stockholders' equity as additional paid in capital. During the six months ended June 30, 2014 the ESOP loan was repaid approximately $118 from contributions to ESOP from the Company. As a result of the repayment, 9,147 shares were released from collateral and allocated to employee participant accounts. Dividends on allocated ESOP shares are charged to retained earnings and paid to participants of the ESOP. Dividends on unallocated ESOP shares are used to repay the ESOP loan and related accrued interest. No cash dividends were declared or paid by the Company during the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013.

Earnings Per Share

        Earnings per share (EPS) are based upon the weighted-average shares outstanding. The table below sets forth the reconciliation between weighted average shares used for calculating basic and diluted EPS for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013:

 
  Six months Ended
June 30,
 
 
  2014   2013  

Earnings (numerator)

             

Net income for common stockholders

  $ 2,156   $ 1,459  

Less: preferred stock dividends

    40     40  
           

Net income allocated to common stockholders

  $ 2,116   $ 1,419  
           
           

Shares (denominator)

             

Weighted average shares outstanding for basic EPS (thousands)

    6,231     5,772  

Dilutive effect of employee stock based awards and warrants          

    128     64  
           

Adjusted weighted average shares outstanding

    6,359     5,836  
           
           

Earnings per share:

             

Basic

  $ 0.34   $ 0.25  
           
           

Diluted

  $ 0.33   $ 0.24  
           
           

F-8


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        For the six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company excluded from diluted EPS weighted average shares of performance stock options representing the right to purchase 459,000 shares of the Company's common stock, because the issuance of shares related to these options is contingent upon the satisfaction of certain conditions unrelated to earnings or market value and these conditions were not expected to be met.

        For the six months ended June 30, 2013 the Company excluded from diluted EPS weighted average shares of performance stock options representing the right to purchase 426,000 shares of the Company's common stock, because the issuance of shares related to these options is contingent upon the satisfaction of certain conditions unrelated to earnings or market value and these conditions were not expected to be met.

2. Common Stock

        During January 2014, the Company engaged in a private offering of up to 500,000 shares of its common stock, par value $0.01 per share, at $10.85 per share. As of March 31, 2014, the offering was completed and closed. The Company issued 490,773 shares under the offering generating total proceeds of approximately $5,325 and had offering costs of approximately $60. In addition, the Company issued 17,274 shares of common stock at $10 per share generating total proceeds of approximately $173. The Company intends to use the proceeds from the stock issuances to support the growth of the Company.

3. Investment Securities

        The carrying amount of securities and their approximate fair values at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 are as follows:

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
 

Available for Sale

                         

U.S. government agencies

  $ 2,000   $   $ 71   $ 1,929  

Corporate bonds

    500     3         503  

Municipal securities

    949     32         981  

Mortgage-backed securities

    32,248     283     97     32,434  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    13,305     159     42     13,422  

Asset-backed securities

    1,251     27         1,278  
                   

  $ 50,253   $ 504   $ 210   $ 50,547  
                   
                   

F-9


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

3. Investment Securities (Continued)


 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Fair
Value
 

Available for Sale

                         

U.S. government agencies

  $ 2,019   $   $ 95   $ 1,924  

Corporate bonds

    1,445     35         1,480  

Municipal securities

    934     24         958  

Mortgage-backed securities

    24,898     220     187     24,931  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    14,898     158     141     14,915  

Asset-backed securities

    1,370     26         1,396  
                   

  $ 45,564   $ 463   $ 423   $ 45,604  
                   
                   

        The following tables disclose the Company's investment securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than 12 months and those that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for 12 or more months:

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Less Than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Totals  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
 

Available for Sale

                                     

U.S. government agencies

  $   $   $ 1,929   $ 71   $ 1,929   $ 71  

Mortgage-backed securities

    6,635     10     8,776     87     15,411     97  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    3,222     31     900     11     4,122     42  
                           

  $ 9,857   $ 41   $ 11,605   $ 169   $ 21,462   $ 210  
                           
                           

 

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Less Than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Totals  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
 

Available for Sale

                                     

U.S. government agencies

  $ 1,924   $ 95   $   $   $ 1,924   $ 95  

Mortgage-backed securities

    10,612     187             10,612     187  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    10,222     140     46     1     10,268     141  
                           

  $ 22,758   $ 422   $ 46   $ 1   $ 22,804   $ 423  
                           
                           

F-10


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

3. Investment Securities (Continued)

        The number of investment positions in an unrealized loss position totaled 22 at June 30, 2014. The Company does not believe these unrealized losses are "other than temporary" as (i) the Company does not have the intent to sell investment securities prior to recovery and (ii) it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell these securities prior to recovery. The unrealized losses noted are interest rate related due to the level of interest rates at June 30, 2014. The Company has reviewed the ratings of the issuers and has not identified any issues related to the ultimate repayment of principal as a result of credit concerns on these securities.

        The amortized costs and estimated fair values of securities available for sale, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayments penalties. Mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations, and asset-backed securities typically are issued with stated principal amounts, and the securities are backed by pools of mortgage loans and other loans that have varying maturities. The term of mortgage-backed, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities thus approximates the term of the underlying mortgages and loans and can vary significantly due to prepayments. Therefore, these securities are not included in the maturity categories below.

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Available For Sale  
 
  Amortized Cost   Fair Value  

Due in one year or less

  $ 500   $ 503  

Due from one year to five years

    949     981  

Due from five years to ten years

    2,000     1,929  

Due after ten years

         
           

    3,449     3,413  

Mortgage-backed securities

    32,248     32,434  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    13,305     13,422  

Asset-backed securities

    1,251     1,278  
           

  $ 50,253   $ 50,547  
           
           

F-11


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

3. Investment Securities (Continued)


 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Available For Sale  
 
  Amortized Cost   Fair Value  

Due in one year or less

  $   $  

Due from one year to five years

    2,379     2,438  

Due from five years to ten years

    2,019     1,924  

Due after ten years

         
           

    4,398     4,362  

Mortgage-backed securities

    24,898     24,931  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    14,898     14,915  

Asset-backed securities

    1,370     1,396  
           

  $ 45,564   $ 45,604  
           
           

        Proceeds from sales of investment securities available for sale and gross gains and losses for the six months ended June 30, 2014 were as follows:

 
  June 30,
2014
 

Proceeds from sales

  $ 981  

Gross realized gains

    34  

Gross realized losses

     

        There were no sales of investment securities available for sale for the six months ended June 30, 2013.

        There was a blanket floating lien on certain securities to secure Federal Home Loan Bank advances as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

F-12


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses

        Loans in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Real estate:

             

Construction and land

  $ 56,818   $ 47,643  

Farmland

    11,982     11,656  

1 - 4 family residential

    98,030     86,908  

Multi-family residential

    14,866     11,862  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    180,921     171,451  

Commercial

    174,094     160,823  

Consumer

    4,279     4,927  
           

    540,990     495,270  
           

Deferred loan fees

    (71 )   (94 )

Allowance for loan losses

    (5,516 )   (5,018 )
           

  $ 535,403   $ 490,158  
           
           

        Included in the net loan portfolio as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 is an accretable discount related to loans acquired within a business combination in the approximate amounts of $434 and $667, respectively. The discount is being accreted into income using the interest method over the life of the loans.

        The majority of the loan portfolio is comprised of loans to businesses and individuals in the Dallas metropolitan area. This geographic concentration subjects the loan portfolio to the general economic conditions within this area. The risks created by this concentration have been considered by management in the determination of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. Management believes the allowance for loan losses is adequate to cover estimated losses on loans as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

Non-Accrual and Past Due Loans

        Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments were due. Loans are placed on non-accrual status when, in management's opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. Loans may be placed on non-accrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received in excess of principal due. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

F-13


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        Non-accrual loans, excluding purchased credit impaired loans, aggregated by class of loans as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 are as follows:

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Real estate:

             

Construction and land

  $ 76   $ 76  

Farmland

         

1 - 4 family residential

        1,041  

Multi-family residential

         

Nonfarm nonresidential

         

Commercial

    30      

Consumer

         
           

  $ 106   $ 1,117  
           
           

        For the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, gross interest income that would have been recorded had the Company's non-accrual loans been current in accordance with their original terms was minimal.

        An age analysis of past due loans, excluding purchased credit impaired loans, aggregated by class of loans, as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 is as follows:

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  30 to 59
Days
  60 to 89
Days
  90 Days
or Greater
  Total
Past Due
  Total
Current
  Total
Loans
  Total
90 Days
Past Due
and Still
Accruing
 

Real estate:

                                           

Construction and land

  $   $   $ 76   $ 76   $ 56,742   $ 56,818   $  

Farmland

                    11,982     11,982      

1 - 4 family residential

    244             244     97,786     98,030      

Multi-family residential

                    14,866     14,866      

Nonfarm nonresidential

            375     375     180,546     180,921     375 (1)

Commercial

    571         41     612     173,482     174,094     11  

Consumer

    16     3     4     23     4,256     4,279     4  
                               

  $ 831   $ 3   $ 496   $ 1,330   $ 539,660   $ 540,990   $ 390  
                               
                               

(1)
Entire balance of $375 was placed on non-accrual in July 2014.  

F-14


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  30 to 59
Days
  60 to 89
Days
  90 Days
or Greater
  Total
Past Due
  Total
Current
  Total
Loans
  Total
90 Days
Past Due
and Still
Accruing
 

Real estate:

                                           

Construction and land

  $ 19   $   $ 76   $ 95   $ 47,548   $ 47,643   $  

Farmland

                    11,656     11,656      

1 - 4 family residential

    168         1,041     1,209     85,699     86,908      

Multi-family residential

                    11,862     11,862      

Nonfarm nonresidential

                    171,451     171,451      

Commercial

    94             94     160,729     160,823      

Consumer

    34     9     9     52     4,875     4,927     9  
                               

  $ 315   $ 9   $ 1,126   $ 1,450   $ 493,820   $ 495,270   $ 9  
                               
                               

Impaired Loans

        Impaired loans are those loans where it is probable the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due in accordance with the original contractual terms of the loan agreement, including scheduled principal and interest payments. All troubled debt restructurings (TDRs) are considered impaired loans. Impaired loans are measured based on either the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan's effective interest rate; the loan's observable market price; or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. Substantially all of the Company's impaired loans are measured at the fair value of the collateral. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.

        Impaired loans, including purchased credit impaired loans, at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 are summarized in the following tables.

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Unpaid
Contractual
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
with No
Allowance
  Recorded
Investment
With
Allowance
  Total
Recorded
Investment
  Related
Allowance
  Average
Recorded
Investment
During Year
 

Real estate:

                                     

Construction and land

  $ 970   $ 76   $ 541   $ 617   $ 34   $ 645  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    169     169         169         221  

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1,094     1,094         1,094         1,097  

Commercial

    368     291     77     368     52     333  

Consumer

    44     15     29     44     14     47  
                           

Total

  $ 2,645   $ 1,645   $ 647   $ 2,292   $ 100   $ 2,343  
                           
                           

F-15


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Unpaid
Contractual
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
with No
Allowance
  Recorded
Investment
With
Allowance
  Total
Recorded
Investment
  Related
Allowance
  Average
Recorded
Investment
During Year
 

Real estate:

                                     

Construction and land

  $ 971   $ 645   $   $ 645   $   $ 871  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    1,212     1,212         1,212         1,306  

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1,900     1,900         1,900         1,462  

Commercial

    366     366         366         366  

Consumer

    32     32         32         28  
                           

Total

  $ 4,481   $ 4,155   $   $ 4,155   $   $ 4,033  
                           
                           

        Interest payments on impaired loans are typically applied to principal unless collectability of the principal amount is reasonably assured, in which case interest is recognized on a cash basis.

        For the six months ended June 30, 2014, total interest income and cash-based interest income recognized on impaired loans was minimal.

Troubled Debt Restructuring

        Modifications of terms for the Company's loans and their inclusion as troubled debt restructurings are based on individual facts and circumstances. Loan modifications that are included as troubled debt restructurings may involve a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan, an extension of the maturity date at a stated rate of interest lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, or deferral of principal payments, regardless of the period of the modification. The recorded investment in TDRs was approximately $1,812 and $4,078 as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

F-16


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

During the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the terms of certain loans were modified as troubled debt restructurings as follows:

 
   
   
  During the six months ended June 30, 2014  
 
   
   
  Post-Modification Outstanding Recorded Investment  
 
  Number of
Loans
  Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
  Adjusted
Interest
Rate
  Extended
Maturity
  Extended
Maturity and
Restructured
Payments
  Extended
Maturity,
Restructured
Payments and
Adjusted
Interest Rate
 

Real estate loans:

                                     

Construction and land

      $   $   $   $   $  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

                         

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

                         

Commercial

                         

Consumer

    2     17         11     6      
                           

Total

    2   $ 17   $   $ 11   $ 6   $  
                           
                           

 

 
   
   
  During the six months ended June 30, 2013  
 
   
   
  Post-Modification Outstanding Recorded Investment  
 
  Number of
Loans
  Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
  Adjusted
Interest
Rate
  Extended
Maturity
  Extended
Maturity and
Restructured
Payments
  Extended
Maturity,
Restructured
Payments and
Adjusted
Interest Rate
 

Real estate loans:

                                     

Construction and land

      $   $   $   $   $  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    1     1,032         1,032          

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1     1,180         1,180          

Commercial

                         

Consumer

                         
                           

Total

    2   $ 2,212   $   $ 2,212   $   $  
                           
                           

        All TDRs are measured individually for impairment. The two loans restructured during the six months ending June 30, 2014 are performing as agreed to the modified terms. No specific allowance for loan losses is recorded for loans that were modified as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013. Of the two loans restructured during the six months ended June 30, 2013, both were performing as agreed to the modified terms. No specific allowance for loan losses was recorded for loans that were modified as of June 30, 2013.

F-17


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        Interest income recorded during the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 on the restructured loans and interest income that would have been recorded had the terms of the loan not been modified was minimal.

        There was one loan modified as a troubled debt restructured loan within the previous 12 months and for which there was a payment default during the six months ended June 30, 2014. The loan was secured by real estate and the collateral property was foreclosed upon subsequent to the default. No amounts were recorded against the allowance for loan losses related to the foreclosure. There were no loans modified as a troubled debt restructured loan within the previous 12 months and for which there was a payment default during the six months ended June 30, 2013. A default for purposes of this disclosure is a troubled debt restructured loan in which the borrower is 90 days past due or results in the foreclosure and repossession of the applicable collateral.

        The Company has not committed to lend additional amounts to customers with outstanding loans that were classified as TDRs as of June 30, 2014 or December 31, 2013.

Credit Quality Indicators

        From a credit risk standpoint, the Company classifies its loans in one of four categories: (i) pass, (ii) special mention, (iii) substandard or (iv) doubtful. Loans classified as loss are charged-off.

        The classifications of loans reflect a judgment about the risks of default and loss associated with the loan. The Company reviews the ratings on criticized credits monthly. Ratings are adjusted to reflect the degree of risk and loss that is felt to be inherent in each credit as of each monthly reporting period. All classified credits are evaluated for impairments. If impairment is determined to exist, a specific reserve is established. The Company's methodology is structured so that specific reserves are increased in accordance with deterioration in credit quality (and a corresponding increase in risk and loss) or decreased in accordance with improvement in credit quality (and a corresponding decrease in risk and loss).

        Credits rated special mention show clear signs of financial weaknesses or deterioration in credit worthiness, however, such concerns are not so pronounced that the Company generally expects to experience significant loss within the short-term. Such credits typically maintain the ability to perform within standard credit terms and credit exposure is not as prominent as credits rated more harshly.

        Credits rated substandard are those in which the normal repayment of principal and interest may be, or has been, jeopardized by reason of adverse trends or developments of a financial, managerial, economic or political nature, or important weaknesses which exist in collateral. A protracted workout on these credits is a distinct possibility. Prompt corrective action is therefore required to strengthen the Company's position, and/or to reduce exposure and to assure that adequate remedial measures are taken by the borrower. Credit exposure becomes more likely in such credits and a serious evaluation of the secondary support to the credit is performed.

        Credits rated doubtful are those in which full collection of principal appears highly questionable, and which some degree of loss is anticipated, even though the ultimate amount of loss may not yet be certain and/or other factors exist which could affect collection of debt. Based upon available

F-18


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

information, positive action by the Company is required to avert or minimize loss. Credits rated doubtful are generally also placed on non-accrual.

        As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the following summarizes the Company's internal ratings of its loans, including purchased credit impaired loans:

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

Real estate:

                               

Construction and land

  $ 56,201   $   $ 617   $   $ 56,818  

Farmland

    11,982                 11,982  

1 - 4 family residential

    97,819         211         98,030  

Multi-family residential

    14,866                 14,866  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    180,546         375         180,921  

Commercial

    171,625     975     1,464     30     174,094  

Consumer

    4,239         40         4,279  
                       

Total

  $ 537,278   $ 975   $ 2,707   $ 30   $ 540,990  
                       
                       

 

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

Real estate:

                               

Construction and land

  $ 46,998   $   $ 645   $   $ 47,643  

Farmland

    11,656                 11,656  

1 - 4 family residential

    85,649         1,259         86,908  

Multi-family residential

    11,862                 11,862  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    171,371         80         171,451  

Commercial

    158,919     731     1,173         160,823  

Consumer

    4,878     7     42         4,927  
                       

Total

  $ 491,333   $ 738   $ 3,199   $   $ 495,270  
                       
                       

F-19


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        An analysis of the allowance for loan losses for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 and the twelve months ended December 31, 2013 is as follows:

 
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2014
  Twelve Months
Ended
December 31,
2013
  Six Months
Ended
June 30,
2013
 

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 5,018   $ 3,238   $ 3,238  

Provision charged to earnings

    677     1,883     1,008  

Charge-offs

    (204 )   (240 )   (218 )

Recoveries

    25     137     117  
               

Net charge-offs

    (179 )   (103 )   (101 )
               

Balance at end of period

  $ 5,516   $ 5,018   $ 4,145  
               
               

        The following tables summarize the activity in the allowance for loan losses by class of loans for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 and the twelve months ended December 31, 2013 is as follows:

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 660   $ 970   $ 1,726   $ 1,585   $ 77   $ 5,018  

Provision charged to earnings

    69     260     54     311     (17 )   677  

Charge-offs

    (28 )   (30 )       (146 )       (204 )

Recoveries

                22     3     25  
                           

Net charge-offs

    (28 )   (30 )       (124 )   3     (179 )
                           

Balance at end of period

  $ 701   $ 1,200   $ 1,780   $ 1,772   $ 63   $ 5,516  
                           
                           

Period-end amount allocated to:

                                     

Specific Reserves:

                                     

Impaired loans

  $   $   $   $ 52   $ 14   $ 66  

Purchased credit impaired loans

    34                     34  
                           

Total specific reserves

    34             52     14     100  
                           

General reserves

    667     1,200     1,780     1,720     49     5,416  
                           

Total

  $ 701   $ 1,200   $ 1,780   $ 1,772   $ 63   $ 5,516  
                           
                           

F-20


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)


 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 455   $ 755   $ 1,028   $ 947   $ 53   $ 3,238  

Provision charged to earnings

    205     240     698     716     24     1,883  

Charge-offs

        (85 )       (110 )   (45 )   (240 )

Recoveries

        60         32     45     137  
                           

Net charge-offs

        (25 )       (78 )       (103 )
                           

Balance at end of year

  $ 660   $ 970   $ 1,726   $ 1,585   $ 77   $ 5,018  
                           
                           

Period-end amount allocated to:

                                     

Specific Reserves:

                                     

Impaired loans

  $   $   $   $   $   $  

Purchased credit impaired loans

                         
                           

Total specific reserves

                         
                           

General reserves

    660     970     1,726     1,585     77     5,018  
                           

Total

  $ 660   $ 970   $ 1,726   $ 1,585   $ 77   $ 5,018  
                           
                           

 

 
  June 30, 2013  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 455   $ 755   $ 1,028   $ 947   $ 53   $ 3,238  

Provision charged to earnings

    (7 )   147     346     482     40     1,008  

Charge-offs

        (85 )       (90 )   (43 )   (218 )

Recoveries

        60         26     31     117  
                           

Net charge-offs

        (25 )       (64 )   (12 )   (101 )
                           

Balance at end of period

  $ 448   $ 877   $ 1,374   $ 1,365   $ 81   $ 4,145  
                           
                           

Period-end amount allocated to:

                                     

Specific Reserves:

                                     

Impaired loans

  $   $   $   $   $   $  

Purchased credit impaired loans

                         
                           

Total specific reserves

                         
                           

General reserves

    448     877     1,374     1,365     81     4,145  
                           

Total

  $ 448   $ 877   $ 1,374   $ 1,365   $ 81   $ 4,145  
                           
                           

F-21


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        The Company's recorded investment in loans as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 related to the balance in the allowance for loan losses on the basis of the Company's impairment methodology is as follows:

 
  June 30, 2014  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Loans individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 76   $ 169   $ 1,094   $ 368   $ 44   $ 1,751  

Purchased credit impaired loans

    541                     541  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment

    68,183     112,727     179,827     173,726     4,235     538,698  
                           

Total

  $ 68,800   $ 112,896   $ 180,921   $ 174,094   $ 4,279   $ 540,990  
                           
                           

 

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Loans individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 76   $ 1,212   $ 1,900   $ 366   $ 32   $ 3,586  

Purchased credit impaired loans

    569                     569  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment

    58,654     97,558     169,551     160,457     4,895     491,115  
                           

Total

  $ 59,299   $ 98,770   $ 171,451   $ 160,823   $ 4,927   $ 495,270  
                           
                           

        The Company acquired certain loans which experienced credit deterioration since origination (Purchased credit impaired loans). Accretion on purchased credit impaired loans is based on estimated future cash flows, regardless of contractual maturity.

        The outstanding balance and related carrying amount of those loans as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 is as follows:

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Outstanding balance

  $ 791   $ 819  

Nonaccretable difference

    (250 )   (250 )

Accretable yield

         
           

Carrying amount

  $ 541   $ 569  
           
           

        At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, there was no allocation established in the allowance for loan losses related to purchased credit impaired loans. During the six months ending June 30, 2014, the

F-22


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

Company charged off approximately $28 of the purchased credit impaired loans that was deemed uncollectible.

        Income is not recognized on certain purchased credit impaired loans if the Company cannot reasonably estimate cash flows expected to be collected. Income on these loans is recognized using the asset recovery method. As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, there was only one purchased credit impaired loan remaining, which was accounted for using the cost recovery method. The carrying amounts of the loan was as follows:

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Loans purchased during the year

  $   $  

Loans at the end of the period

  $ 541   $ 569  

5. Income Taxes

        Income tax expense and the effective tax rates for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 is summarized as follows:

 
  Six months
ended June 30,
 
 
  2014   2013  

Income tax expense:

  $ 1,190   $ 774  

Effective tax rate

    35.6 %   34.7 %

        The differences between the statutory rate of 34.0% and the effective tax rates presented in the table above were primarily attributable to permanent differences related to stock option expense, bank-owned life insurance income, and other non-deductible expenses.

        Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the recorded amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes, and the amounts used for income tax

F-23


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

5. Income Taxes (Continued)

purposes. Significant components of the Company's deferred tax assets and liabilities at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 are as follows:

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Deferred tax assets:

             

Net operating loss

  $   $ 96  

Organizational costs

    175     183  

Allowance for loan losses

    1,812     1,619  

Deferred loan fees

    24     32  

Non-accrual interest

    59     62  

Capital loss carryforward

    85     85  

OREO write down for book purposes

    55     55  

Deferred rent expenses

    62     70  

Restricted stock

    103     84  

Accrued bonuses

    162     243  

Other

    135     134  
           

Total deferred tax assets

    2,672     2,663  
           

Deferred tax liabilities:

             

Net unrealized gain on securities available for sale

    100     14  

Core deposit intangibles

    462     512  

FHLB stock dividends

    26     26  

Bank premises and equipment

    993     1,118  
           

Total deferred tax liabilities

    1,581     1,670  
           

Net deferred tax asset

  $ 1,091   $ 993  
           
           

        Included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets as of June 30, 2014 is a current tax receivable of approximately $181 in other assets and a net deferred tax asset of approximately $1,091 in other assets. Included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets in other assets as of December 31, 2013 is a current tax receivable of approximately $292 and a net deferred tax asset of approximately $993.

6. Commitments and Contingencies

Litigation

        The Company may from time to time be involved in legal actions arising from normal business activities. Management believes that these actions are without merit or that the ultimate liability, if any, resulting from them will not materially affect the financial position or results of operations of the Company.

F-24


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

6. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

Operating Leases

        The Company leases several of its banking facilities under operating leases. Rental expense related to these leases was approximately $721 and $651 for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

7. Fair Value Disclosures

        ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures, defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. A fair value measurement assumes that the transaction to sell the asset or transfer the liability occurs in the principal market for the asset or liability or, in the absence of a principal market, the most advantageous market for the asset or liability. The price in the principal (or most advantageous) market used to measure the fair value of the asset or liability shall not be adjusted for transaction costs. An orderly transaction is a transaction that assumes exposure to the market for a period prior to the measurement date to allow for marketing activities that are usual and customary for transactions involving such assets and liabilities; it is not a forced transaction. Market participants are buyers and sellers in the principal market that are (i) independent, (ii) knowledgeable, (iii) able to transact and (iv) willing to transact.

        ASC Topic 820 requires the use of valuation techniques that are consistent with the market approach, the income approach and/or the cost approach. The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets and liabilities. The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts, such as cash flows or earnings, to a single present amount on a discounted basis. The cost approach is based on the amount that currently would be required to replace the service capacity of an asset (replacement costs). Valuation techniques should be consistently applied. Inputs to valuation techniques refer to the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Inputs may be observable, meaning those that reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from independent sources, or unobservable, meaning those that reflect the reporting entity's own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. In that regard, the authoritative guidance establishes a fair value hierarchy for valuation inputs that gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is as follows:

        Level 1 Inputs.    Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the reporting entity has the ability to access at the measurement date.

        Level 2 Inputs.    Inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly. These include quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in markets that are not active, inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability (for example, interest rates, volatilities, prepayment speeds, loss severities, credit risks and default rates) or inputs that are derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data by correlation or other means. Level 2 investments consist primarily of obligations of U.S. government sponsored enterprises

F-25


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

7. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

and agencies, obligations of state and municipal subdivisions, corporate bonds and mortgage-backed securities.

        Level 3 Inputs.    Significant unobservable inputs that reflect an entity's own assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the assets or liabilities.

        In general, fair value is based upon quoted market prices, where available. If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon internally developed models that primarily use, as inputs, observable market-based parameters. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. While management believes the Company's valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.

        A description of the valuation methodologies used for instruments measured at fair value, as well as the general classification of such instruments pursuant to the valuation hierarchy, is set forth below.

        Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis include the following:

        Investment Securities Available for Sale:    Securities classified as available for sale are reported at fair value utilizing Level 2 inputs. For those securities classified as Level 2, the Company obtains fair value measurements from an independent pricing service. The fair value measurements consider observable data that may include dealer quotes, market spreads, cash flows, the U. S. Treasury yield curve, live trading levels, trade execution data, market consensus prepayments speeds, credit information and the bond's terms and conditions, among other things.

        The following table summarizes assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:

 
  Fair Value Measurements
Using
   
 
 
  Level 1
Inputs
  Level 2
Inputs
  Level 3
Inputs
  Total
Fair Value
 

At June 30, 2014:

                         

Investment securities available for sale

  $   $ 50,547   $   $ 50,547  

At December 31, 2013:

                         

Investment securities available for sale

  $   $ 45,604   $   $ 45,604  

        There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of June 30, 2014 or December 31, 2013.

        There were no transfers between Level 2 and Level 3 during the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013.

        In accordance with ASC Topic 820, certain assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are

F-26


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

7. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).

        Assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis include impaired loans and other real estate owned. The fair value of impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses and other real estate owned is based upon recent real estate appraisals less estimated costs of sale. For residential real estate impaired loans and other real estate owned, appraised values are based on the comparative sales approach. For commercial and commercial real estate impaired loans and other real estate owned, appraisers may use either a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches such as comparative sales, cost or the income approach. A significant unobservable input in the income approach is the estimated income capitalization rate for a given piece of collateral. Adjustments to appraisals may be made to reflect local market conditions or other economic factors and may result in changes in the fair value of a given asset over time. As such, the fair value of impaired loans and other real estate owned are considered a Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

        The Company recovers the carrying value of other real estate owned through the sale of the property. The ability to affect future sales prices is subject to market conditions and factors beyond the Company's control and may impact the estimated fair value of a property.

        Appraisals for impaired loans and other real estate owned are performed by certified general appraisers whose qualifications and licenses have been reviewed and verified by the Company. Once reviewed, a member of the credit department reviews the assumptions and approaches utilized in the appraisal as well as the overall resulting fair value in comparisons to independent data sources such as recent market data or industry wide-statistics. On a periodic basis, the Company compares the actual selling price of collateral that has been sold to the most recent appraised value to determine what additional adjustments, if any, should be made to the appraisal value to arrive at fair value.

        The following table summarizes assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:

 
  Fair Value Measurements Using    
   
 
 
  Level 1
Inputs
  Level 2
Inputs
  Level 3
Inputs
  Total Fair Value   Period
Ended
Total Losses
 

At June 30, 2014:

                               

Assets:

                               

Impaired loans

  $   $   $ 2,192   $ 2,192   $ 100  

Other real estate owned

  $   $   $ 2,395   $ 2,395   $  

At December 31, 2013:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Assets:

                               

Impaired loans

  $   $   $ 4,155   $ 4,155   $  

Other real estate owned

  $   $   $ 1,797   $ 1,797   $ 162  

        There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

F-27


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

7. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

        For Level 3 financial and nonfinancial assets measured at fair value as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurements were as follows:

June 30, 2014  
Assets/Liabilities
  Fair
Value
  Valuation
Technique
  Unobservable
Input(s)
  Weighted
Average
 

Impaired loans

  $ 2,192   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

Other real estate owned

  $ 2,395   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     13 %

 

December 31, 2013  
Assets/Liabilities
  Fair
Value
  Valuation
Technique
  Unobservable
Input(s)
  Weighted
Average
 

Impaired loans

  $ 4,155   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

Other real estate owned

  $ 1,797   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

        The Company is required under current authoritative guidance to disclose the estimated fair value of their financial instrument assets and liabilities including those subject to the requirements discussed above. For the Company, as for most financial institutions, substantially all of its assets and liabilities are considered financial instruments, as defined. Many of the Company's financial instruments, however, lack an available trading market as characterized by a willing buyer and willing seller engaging in an exchange transaction.

        The estimated fair value amounts of financial instruments have been determined by the Company using available market information and appropriate valuation methodologies. However, considerable judgment is required to interpret data to develop the estimates of fair value. Accordingly, the estimates presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts the Company could realize in a current market exchange. The use of different market assumptions and/or estimation methodologies may have a material effect on the estimated fair value amounts. In addition, reasonable comparability between financial institutions may not be likely due to the wide range of permitted valuation techniques and numerous estimates that must be made given the absence of active secondary markets for many of the financial instruments. This lack of uniform valuation methodologies also introduces a greater degree of subjectivity to these estimated fair values.

        The methods and assumptions used by the Company in estimating fair values of financial instruments as disclosed herein in accordance with ASC Topic 825, Financial Instruments, other than for those measured at fair value on a recurring and nonrecurring basis discussed above, are as follows:

        Cash and cash equivalents:    The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents approximate their fair value.

        Loans and loans held for sale:    For variable-rate loans that reprice frequently and have no significant changes in credit risk, fair values are based on carrying values. Fair values for certain mortgage loans (for example, one-to-four family residential), commercial real estate and commercial

F-28


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

7. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

loans are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality.

        Bank-owned life insurance:    The carrying amounts of bank-owned life insurance approximate their fair values.

        Non-marketable equity securities:    The carrying value of restricted securities such as stock in the Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas and Independent Bankers Financial Corporation approximates fair value.

        Deposits:    The fair values disclosed for demand deposits are, by definition, equal to the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (that is their carrying amounts). The carrying amounts of variable-rate certificates of deposit (CDs) approximate their fair values at the reporting date. Fair values for fixed-rate CDs are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.

        Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank:    The fair value of advances maturing within 90 days approximates carrying value. Fair value of other advances is based on the Company's current borrowing rate for similar arrangements.

        Other borrowings:    The fair values are based upon prevailing rates on similar debt in the market place.

        Accrued interest:    The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate their fair values due to short term maturity.

        Off-balance sheet instruments:    Commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit are generally priced at market at the time of funding and were not material to the Company's consolidated financial statements.

F-29


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

7. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

        The estimated fair values and carrying values of all financial instruments under current authoritative guidance as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 were as follows:

 
  June 30, 2014   December 31, 2013  
 
  Carrying
Amount
  Fair
Value
  Carrying
Amount
  Fair
Value
 

Financial assets:

                         

Level 2 inputs:

                         

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 66,550   $ 66,550   $ 76,646   $ 76,646  

Securities available for sale

    50,547     50,547     45,604     45,604  

Loans held for sale

    6,342     6,342     2,051     2,051  

Accrued interest receivable

    1,359     1,359     1,351     1,351  

Bank-owned life insurance

    10,647     10,647     10,475     10,475  

Non-marketable equity securities

    2,959     2,959     2,714     2,714  

Level 3 inputs:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Loans, net

    535,403     534,047     490,158     490,344  

Financial liabilities:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Level 2 inputs:

                         

Deposits

  $ 611,174   $ 605,961   $ 573,938   $ 568,451  

Advances from FHLB

    15,000     15,028     15,000     15,055  

Accrued interest payable

    203     203     134     134  

Other borrowings

    8,073     8,073     8,072     8,072  

8. Financial Instruments with Off-Balance Sheet Risk

        The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amount recognized in the consolidated balance sheet.

        The Company's exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for on balance sheet instruments.

        The following table sets forth the approximate amounts of these financial instruments as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Commitments to extend credit

  $ 107,113   $ 92,827  

Standby letters of credit

    680     210  
           

  $ 107,793   $ 93,037  
           
           

F-30


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

8. Financial Instruments with Off-Balance Sheet Risk (Continued)

        Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. Management evaluates each customer's creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary upon extension of credit, is based on management's credit evaluation of the borrower.

        Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Standby letters of credit generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The Company's policy for obtaining collateral and the nature of such collateral is essentially the same as that involved in making commitments to extend credit.

        Although the maximum exposure to loss is the amount of such commitments, management currently anticipates no material losses from such activities.

9. Employee Benefits

Defined contribution plan

        The Company maintains a retirement savings 401(k) profit sharing plan (Plan) in which substantially all employees may participate. The Plan provides for "before tax" employee contributions through salary reductions under section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code. The Company may make a discretionary match of employees' contributions based on a percentage of salary deferrals and certain discretionary profit sharing contributions. No matching contributions to the Plan were made during the six months ending June 30, 2014 and 2013.

ESOP

        Effective January 1, 2012, the Company adopted an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) covering all employees that meet certain age and service requirements. Plan assets are held and managed by the Company. The Company accrued approximately $120 as of December 31, 2013 to contribute to the ESOP. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the ESOP purchased 7,811 shares of the Company's common stock and allocated the shares to the plan participants.

        In January 2014, the ESOP borrowed $500 from the Company and purchased 46,082 shares of the common stock of the Company. The ESOP debt is secured by shares of the Company. The loan will be repaid from contributions to the ESOP from the Company. As the debt is repaid, shares are released from collateral and allocated to employees' accounts. The shares pledged as collateral are reported as unearned ESOP shares in the consolidated balance sheets. During the six months ended June 30, 2014 the ESOP loan was repaid approximately $118 from contributions to ESOP from the Company. As a result of the repayment, 9,147 shares were released from collateral and allocated to employee participant accounts. Compensation expense attributed to the ESOP contributions recorded in the accompanying consolidated statements of income for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 was approximately $90 and $60, respectively.

F-31


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

9. Employee Benefits (Continued)

        The following is a summary of ESOP shares as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

 
  June 30,
2014
  December 31,
2013
 

Allocated shares

    16,958     7,811  

Unearned shares

    36,935      
           

Total ESOP shares

    53,893     7,811  
           

Fair value of unearned shares

  $ 476   $  
           
           

10. Stock Incentive Plan

        In 2010, the Company adopted the 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (the Incentive Plan), which the Company's shareholders' approved in 2011, The maximum number of shares of common stock that may be issued pursuant to grants or options under the Incentive Plan is 1,000,000. The Incentive Plan is administered by the Board of Directors and provides for both the direct award of stock and the grant of stock options to eligible directors, officers, employees and outside consultants of the Company or its affiliates as defined in the Incentive Plan. The Company may grant either incentive stock options or nonqualified stock options as directed in the Incentive Plan.

        The Board authorized that the Incentive Plan provide for the award of 100,000 shares of direct stock awards (restricted shares) and 900,000 shares of stock options, of which 500,000 shares are performance-based stock options. Options are generally granted with an exercise price equal to the market price of the Company's stock at the date of the grant; those option awards generally vest based on 5 years of continuous service and have 10-year contractual terms for non-controlling participants as defined by the Incentive Plan, and forfeiture of unexercised options upon termination of employment with the Company. Other grant terms can vary for controlling participants as defined by the Incentive Plan. Restricted share awards generally vest after 4 years of continuous service. The terms of the Incentive Plan include a provision whereby all unearned non-performance options and restricted shares become immediately exercisable and fully vested upon a change in control. The vesting of a performance-based stock option is contingent upon a change of control and the achievement of specific performance criteria or other objectives set at the grant date.

        During the six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company awarded 28,500 restricted shares, 30,000 nonperformance-based stock options and 50,000 performance-based stock options. During the six months ended June 30, 2013, the Company did not grant any awards or options.

        Stock based compensation expense is measured based upon the fair market value of the award at the grant date and is recognized ratably over the period during which the shares are earned (the requisite service period). For the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, approximately $165 and $160, respectively, was recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. As of June 30, 2014, there was approximately $1,832 of unrecognized compensation expense related to non-vested share-based compensation awards that is expected to be recognized over the remaining requisite service periods of the options granted.

F-32


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

10. Stock Incentive Plan (Continued)

        The fair value of each option award is estimated on the grant date using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following assumptions used for the awards granted during the six months ended June 30, 2014:

 
  June 30, 2014

Dividend yield

  0.00%

Expected life

  10 years

Expected volatility

  5.60%

Risk-free interest rate

  2.54% to 2.71%

        The expected life is based on the expected amount of time that options granted are expected to be outstanding. The dividend yield assumption is based on the Company's history. The expected volatility is based on historical volatility of the Company. The risk-free interest rates are based upon yields of U.S. Treasury issues with a term equal to the expected life of the option being valued.

        A summary of option activity under the Incentive Plan as of June 30, 2014 and 2013, and changes during the six month periods then ended is presented below:

 
  2014
 
  Nonperformance-based stock options   Performance-based stock options
 
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term

Outstanding at beginning of period

    327,500   $ 10.03   7.69 years     422,500   $ 10.02   8.0 years
                                 
                                 

Granted during the period

    30,000     11.86         50,000     11.19    

Forfeited during the period

                       

Exercised during the period

                       
                           

Outstanding at the end of period

    357,500   $ 10.15   7.17 years     472,500   $ 10.15   8.0 years
                         
                         

Options exercisable at end of period

    181,200   $ 10.04   6.71 years       $  
                         
                         

Weighted average fair value of options granted during the period

        $ 1.94             $ 2.01    
                             
                             

F-33


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

10. Stock Incentive Plan (Continued)

 

 
  2013
 
  Nonperformance-based stock options   Performance-based stock options
 
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term

Outstanding at beginning of period

    332,500   $ 10.00   8.18 years     432,500   $ 10.00   8.0 years
                                 
                                 

Granted during the period

                       

Forfeited during the period

    15,000             20,000        

Exercised during the period

                       
                             

Outstanding at the end of period

    317,500   $ 10.00   6.92 years     412,500   $ 10.00   6.68 years
                         
                         

Options exercisable at end of period

    108,700   $ 10.00   7.50 years       $  
                         
                         

Weighted average fair value of options granted during the period

        $             $    
                             
                             

        As of June 30, 2014 and 2013, the aggregate intrinsic value was $983 and $270, respectively, for outstanding nonperformance-based stock options and $518 and $92, respectively, for exercisable nonperformance-based stock options.

        As of June 30, 2014 and 2013, the aggregate intrinsic value was $1,300 and $351, respectively, for outstanding performance-based stock options. No performance-based stock options were exercisable as of June 30, 2014 and 2013.

        As of June 30, 2014 there was $1,464 of total unrecognized compensation expense related to nonvested option shares, of which $343 was related to the nonperformance-based stock options. The nonperformance-based stock option cost is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.10 years. Expense associated with the performance-based stock options is based on the probability of future changes in control and other market conditions. During 2013, management determined that one performance condition had been met and expensed a portion of the performance-based option cost. Total unrecognized compensation expense related to these performance-based options as of June 30, 2014 was approximately $392 and is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 6.51 years. Management does not anticipate meeting the other market conditions in the foreseeable future; therefore no performance-based stock option expense related to these conditions was recorded for the six months ending June 30, 2014

F-34


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

10. Stock Incentive Plan (Continued)

        A summary of the status of the Company's restricted shares as of June 30, 2014 and 2013, and changes during the periods then ended is as follows:

 
  2014   2013  
 
  Shares   Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
  Shares   Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
 

Nonvested at January 1,

    35,000   $ 10.02     40,000   $ 10.00  

Granted

    28,500     11.93          

Vested

                 

Forfeited

    (250 )   10.85     (6,000 )    
                       

Nonvested at June 30,

    63,250   $ 10.88     34,000   $ 10.00  
                   
                   

        As of June 30, 2014, there was $369 of total unrecognized compensation expense related to nonvested restricted shares. The compensation expense is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.14 years.

11. Significant Concentrations of Credit Risk

        Most of the Company's business activity is with customers located within the Dallas metropolitan area. Such customers are normally also depositors of the Company.

        The distribution of commitments to extend credit approximates the distribution of loans outstanding. Commercial and standby letters of credit were granted primarily to commercial borrowers.

        The contractual amounts of credit related financial instruments such as commitments to extend credit, credit card arrangements, and letters of credit represent the amounts of potential accounting loss should the contract be fully drawn upon, the customer default, and the value of any existing collateral become worthless.

12. Preferred Stock

        On August 25, 2011 the Company entered into a Small Business Lending Fund-Securities Purchase Agreement (SBLF Purchase Agreement) with the Secretary of the Treasury, pursuant to which the Company (i) sold 8,000 shares of the Company's Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C (the SBLF Preferred Stock) to the Secretary of the Treasury for a purchase price of $8,000. The issuance was pursuant to the SBLF program, a fund established under the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010 that was created to encourage lending to small business by providing capital to qualified community banks.

        The SBLF Preferred Stock qualifies as Tier 1 capital and pays non-cumulative dividends quarterly, on each January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1. The dividend rate, as a percentage of the liquidation amount, can fluctuate on a quarterly basis during the first 10 quarters during which the SBLF Preferred Stock is outstanding, based upon changes in the level of "Qualified Small Business Lending" or "QBSL" (as defined in the SBLF Purchase Agreement) by the Bank. Based upon the increase in the Bank's level of QBSL over the baseline level calculated under the terms of the SBLF Purchase

F-35


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

12. Preferred Stock (Continued)

Agreement, the dividend rate for the initial dividend period for the Company was set at 1.00%. For the tenth calendar quarter through four and one half years after issuance, the dividend rate will be fixed and as of June 30, 2014 was set at one percent (1%) based upon the increase in QBSL as compared to the baseline. After four and one half years from issuance, the dividend rate will increase to 9% (including a quarterly lending incentive fee of 0.5%).

        The SBLF Preferred Stock is non-voting, except in limited circumstances. In the event that the Company misses five dividend payments, whether or not consecutive, the holder of the SBLF Preferred Stock will have the right, but not the obligation, to appoint a representative as an observer on the Company's Board of Directors. The right expires when full dividends have been paid for four consecutive dividend periods. The SBLF Preferred Stock may be redeemed at any time at the Company's option, at a redemption price of 100% of the liquidation amount plus accrued but unpaid dividends to the date of redemption for the current period, subject to the approval of its federal banking regulator.

13. Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Retained Earnings

        Under banking law, there are legal restrictions limiting the amount of dividends the Company can declare. Approval of the regulatory authorities is required if the effect of the dividends declared would cause regulatory capital of the Company to fall below specified minimum levels.

        The Company (on a consolidated basis) and the Bank are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Bank's financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank's assets, liabilities, and certain off balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The Bank's capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

        Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined). Management believes, as of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, that the Company and the Bank met all capital adequacy requirements to which it was subject.

        As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 the Bank's capital ratios exceeded those levels necessary to be categorized as "well capitalized" under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as "well capitalized" the Bank must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based and Tier 1 leverage ratios as set forth in the table. There are no conditions or events since June 30, 2014 that management believes have changed the Bank's category.

F-36


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (Unaudited) (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

13. Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Retained Earnings (Continued)

        A comparison of the Company's and Bank's actual capital amounts and ratios to required capital amounts and ratios is presented in the following table:

 
  Actual   For Capital
Adequacy Purposes
  To Be Well
Capitalized Under
Prompt Corrective
Action Provisions
 
 
  Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio   Amount   Ratio  

As June 30, 2014:

                                     

Total capital
(to risk weighted assets)

                                     

Company

  $ 67,540     12.35 % ³ $ 43,733 ³     8.0 % ³   N/A ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 65,480     11.99 % ³ $ 43,707 ³     8.0 % ³ $ 54,634 ³     10.0 %

Tier 1 capital
(to risk weighted assets)

                                     

Company

  $ 57,044     10.44 % ³ $ 21,866 ³     4.0 % ³   N/A ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 59,964     10.98 % ³ $ 21,854 ³     4.0 % ³ $ 32,780 ³     6.0 %

Tier 1 capital
(to average assets)

                                     

Company

  $ 57,044     8.66 % ³ $ 26,352 ³     4.0 % ³   N/A ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 59,964     9.11 % ³ $ 26,340 ³     4.0 % ³ $ 32,925 ³     5.0 %

As of December 31, 2013:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Total capital
(to risk weighted assets)

                                     

Company

  $ 59,100     11.74 % ³ $ 40,288 ³     8.0 % ³   N/A ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 57,275     11.37 % ³ $ 40,296 ³     8.0 % ³ $ 38,817 ³     10.0 %

Tier 1 capital
(to risk weighted assets)

                                     

Company

  $ 49,103     9.75 % ³ $ 20,144 ³     4.0 % ³   N/A ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 52,257     10.37 % ³ $ 20,148 ³     4.0 % ³ $ 23,290 ³     6.0 %

Tier 1 capital
(to average assets)

                                     

Company

  $ 49,103     8.06 % ³ $ 24,373 ³     4.0 % ³   N/A ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 52,257     8.58 % ³ $ 24,369 ³     4.0 % ³ $ 24,762 ³     5.0 %

14. Subsequent Events

        The Company has evaluated subsequent events through August 29, 2014 which was the date the condensed consolidated financial statements were available to be issued and noted no subsequent events requiring financial statement recognition or disclosure.

F-37


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

Board of Directors and Shareholders
Veritex Holdings, Inc.

        We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Veritex Holdings, Inc. (a Texas corporation) and subsidiary (the "Company") as of December 31, 2013, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders' equity, and cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2013. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit.

        We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Our audit included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and subsidiary as of December 31, 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2013 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

/s/ Grant Thornton LLP

Dallas, Texas
July 22, 2014

F-38


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

The Board of Directors
Veritex Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiary

        We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiary (the "Company") as of December 31, 2012, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, stockholders' equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2012. The Company's management is responsible for these financial statements. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

        We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement. The company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. Our audit included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the company's internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiary as of December 31, 2012, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period ended December 31, 2012 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

/s/ JonesBaggett LLP

Dallas, Texas
July 22, 2014

F-39


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Balance Sheets

December 31, 2013 and 2012

(Dollars in thousands, except par value information)

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

ASSETS

             

Cash and due from banks

  $ 8,484   $ 8,197  

Interest bearing deposits in other banks

    68,162     44,963  
           

Total cash and cash equivalents

    76,646     53,160  

Investment securities

   
45,604
   
29,538
 

Loans held for sale

    2,051     2,818  

Loans, net of allowance for loan losses of $5,018 and $3,238, respectively

    490,158     394,278  

Accrued interest receivable

    1,351     1,201  

Prepaid FDIC assessment

        501  

Bank-owned life insurance

    10,475     5,152  

Bank premises, furniture and equipment, net

    9,952     10,348  

Non-marketable equity securities

    2,714     2,589  

Investment in subsidiary

    93     93  

Other real estate owned

    1,797     2,438  

Intangible assets

    1,567     1,875  

Goodwill

    19,148     19,148  

Other assets

    3,415     988  
           

Total assets

  $ 664,971   $ 524,127  
           
           

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

             

Deposits:

   
 
   
 
 

Noninterest-bearing

  $ 218,990   $ 170,497  

Interest-bearing

    354,948     277,405  
           

Total deposits

    573,938     447,902  

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

   
1,214
   
607
 

Accrued interest payable and other liabilities

    508     665  

Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    15,000     10,000  

Junior subordinated debentures

    3,093     3,093  

Subordinated notes

    4,979      
           

Total liabilities

    598,732     462,267  

Commitments and contingencies (Note 14)

   
 
   
 
 

Stockholders' equity:

   
 
   
 
 

Preferred stock, $0.01 par value; 500,000 shares authorized; 8,000 shares Series C, issued and outstanding with a $1,000 liquidation value

    8,000     8,000  

Common stock, $0.01 par value; 10,000,000 shares authorized, 5,804,703 and 5,694,340 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively (excluding 10,000 shares held in treasury at December 31, 2013)

    58     57  

Additional paid-in capital

    55,303     53,750  

Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)

    2,922     (426 )

Accumulated other comprehensive income

    26     479  

Less: Treasury stock, 10,000 shares at cost

    (70 )    
           

Total stockholders' equity

    66,239     61,860  
           

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 664,971   $ 524,127  
           
           

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-40


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Statements of Income

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

(Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Interest income:

                   

Interest and fees on loans

  $ 22,755   $ 20,619   $ 13,494  

Interest on investment securities

    613     655     1,287  

Interest on federal fund sold

            16  

Interest on deposits in other banks

    132     108     57  

Interest on other

    2     8     5  
               

Total interest income

    23,502     21,390     14,859  
               

Interest expense:

                   

Interest on deposit accounts

    2,207     1,911     1,817  

Interest on borrowings

    254     386     475  
               

Total interest expense

    2,461     2,297     2,292  
               

Net interest income

    21,041     19,093     12,567  

Provision for loan losses

   
1,883
   
2,953
   
960
 
               

Net interest income after provision for loan losses

    19,158     16,140     11,607  
               

Noninterest income:

                   

Service charges on deposit accounts

    726     700     563  

Gain on sales of investment securities

            421  

Gain on sales of loans held for sale

    632     248      

Gain on sales of other real estate owned

    20     61     43  

Bank-owned life insurance

    385     180      

Other

    628     458     250  
               

Total noninterest income

    2,391     1,647     1,277  
               

Noninterest expense:

                   

Salaries and employee benefits

    9,084     9,205     6,967  

Occupancy of bank premises

    1,694     1,546     888  

Depreciation and amortization

    1,266     1,059     751  

Data processing

    729     880     610  

FDIC assessment fees

    378     234     383  

Legal fees

    80     380     630  

Other professional fees

    574     668     560  

Advertising and promotions

    142     167     232  

Utilities and telephone

    295     399     322  

Other real estate owned expenses and writedowns

    399     175     40  

Other

    1,723     1,459     1,379  
               

Total noninterest expense

    16,364     16,172     12,762  
               

Net income from operations

    5,185     1,615     122  

Income tax expense

   
1,777
   
136
   
13
 
               

Net income

  $ 3,408   $ 1,479   $ 109  
               
               

Preferred stock dividends

  $ 60   $ 100   $ 76  
               

Net income available to common stockholders

  $ 3,348   $ 1,379   $ 33  
               
               

Basic earnings per share

 
$

0.58
 
$

0.24
 
$

0.01
 
               
               

Diluted earnings per share

  $ 0.57   $ 0.24   $ 0.01  
               
               

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-41


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

(Dollars in thousands)

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

                   

Net income

  $ 3,408   $ 1,479   $ 109  
               

Other comprehensive (loss) income:

                   

Unrealized (losses) gains on securities available for sale arising during the period, net

    (686 )   230     1,262  

Reclassification adjustment for net gains included in net income

            (421 )
               

Other comprehensive (loss) income before tax

    (686 )   230     841  

Income tax (benefit) expense

    (233 )   78     286  
               

Other comprehensive (loss) income, net of tax

    (453 )   152     555  
               

Comprehensive income

  $ 2,955   $ 1,631   $ 664  
               
               

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-42


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

(Dollars in thousands)

 
   
  Common Stock    
  (Accumulated
Deficit)
Retained
Earnings
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income
   
   
 
 
  Preferred
Stock
  Additional
Paid-In
Capital
  Treasury
Stock
   
 
 
  Shares   Amount   Total  

Balance at January 1, 2011

  $     3,553,333   $ 36   $ 34,946   $ (1,735 ) $ (228 ) $   $ 33,019  

Sale of common stock

        1,277,543     13     12,763                 12,776  

Common stock issued and preferred stock acquired in connection with FRC business combination

    3,047     723,611     7     4,182                 7,236  

Preferred stock dividend and accretion of preferred stock discount—Series A and B

    103                 (171 )           (68 )

Issuance of preferred stock Series C

    8,000                             8,000  

Redemption of preferred stock Series A and B

    (3,150 )                           (3,150 )

Preferred stock dividend Series C

                    (8 )           (8 )

Stock based compensation

                207                 207  

Net income

                    109             109  

Other comprehensive income

                        555         555  
                                   

Balance at December 31, 2011

    8,000     5,554,487     56     52,098     (1,805 )   327         58,676  

Sale of common stock

        139,853     1     1,397                 1,398  

Preferred stock dividend Series C

                    (100 )           (100 )

Stock based compensation

                255                 255  

Net income

                    1,479             1,479  

Other comprehensive income

                        152         152  
                                   

Balance at December 31, 2012

    8,000     5,694,340     57     53,750     (426 )   479         61,860  

Sale of common stock

        120,363     1     1,209                 1,210  

Preferred stock dividend Series C

                    (60 )           (60 )

Purchase of treasury stock at cost

        (10,000 )                   (70 )   (70 )

Issuance of warrants related to subordinated debt

                21                 21  

Stock based compensation

                323                 323  

Net income

                    3,408             3,408  

Other comprehensive loss

                        (453 )       (453 )
                                   

Balance at December 31, 2013

  $ 8,000     5,804,703   $ 58   $ 55,303   $ 2,922   $ 26   $ (70 ) $ 66,239  
                                   
                                   

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-43


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011

(Dollars in thousands)

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Cash flows from operating activities:

                   

Net income

  $ 3,408   $ 1,479   $ 109  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash

                   

provided by operating activities:

                   

Depreciation and amortization

    1,266     1,059     751  

Provision for loan losses

    1,883     2,953     960  

Accretion of loan purchase discount

    (404 )   (1,150 )   (885 )

Stock-based compensation expense

    323     255     207  

Amortization of other intangible assets

    14     13     16  

Net amortization of premiums on investment securities

    371     445     1,440  

Change in cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

    (323 )   (152 )    

Net gain on sales of investment securities

            (421 )

Gain on sales of loans held for sale

    (632 )   (248 )    

Net gain on sales of other real estate owned

    (20 )   (61 )   (43 )

Writedowns of other real estate owned

    249     48      

Net originations of loans held for sale

    (35,895 )   (16,606 )    

Proceeds from sales of loans held for sale

    37,294     14,036      

(Increase) decrease in accrued interest receivable, prepaids and other assets

    (2,076 )   (338 )   60  

Increase (decrease) in accrued expenses and other liabilities

    683     (100 )   336  
               

Net cash provided by operating activities

    6,141     1,633     2,530  
               

Cash flows from investing activities:

                   

Net cash received in business combination

            22,821  

Purchases of securities available for sale

    (146,787 )   (242,462 )   (78,068 )

Sales of securities available for sale

    120,000     239,997     90,224  

Proceeds from maturities, calls and pay downs of securities available for sale

    9,664     15,401     18,589  

(Purchases) sales of non-marketable equity securities, net

    (125 )   (1,554 )   260  

Net loans originated

    (98,513 )   (102,640 )   (47,942 )

Purchases of bank-owned life insurance

    (5,000 )   (5,000 )    

Net additions to bank premises and equipment

    (576 )   (909 )   (1,266 )

Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned

    1,566     1,462     767  
               

Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities

    (119,771 )   (95,705 )   5,385  
               

Cash flows from financing activities:

                   

Net change in deposits

    126,036     83,144     25,879  

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock Series C

            8,000  

Redemption of preferred stock Series A and B

            (3,150 )

Net increase in advances from Federal Home Loan Bank

    5,000          

Issuance of subordinated notes

    5,000          

Purchase of common stock held in treasury

    (70 )        

Dividends paid on preferred stock

    (60 )   (100 )   (76 )

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

    1,210     1,398     12,776  
               

Net cash provided by financing activities

    137,116     84,442     43,429  
               

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    23,486     (9,630 )   51,344  

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

   
53,160
   
62,790
   
11,446
 
               

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

  $ 76,646   $ 53,160   $ 62,790  
               
               

Supplemental Disclosures of Cash Flow Information:

                   

Cash paid for interest

  $ 2,470   $ 2,300   $ 2,218  

Cash paid for income taxes

  $ 2,475   $ 900   $  

Supplemental Disclosures of Non-Cash Flow Information:

   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Net unrealized (depreciation) appreciation on securities available for sale

  $ (686 ) $ 230   $ 841  

Net foreclosure of other real estate owned

  $ 1,154   $ 3,158   $ 414  

Acquisitions in connection with business combinations:

                   

Fair value of assets acquired

  $   $   $ 220,082  

Cash paid for common stock

            (24,405 )

Common stock exchanged

            (7,236 )
               

Liabilities assumed

  $   $   $ 188,441  
               
               

   

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

F-44


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

        A summary of significant accounting policies of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiary (together referred to as the Company) applied in the preparation of the accompanying consolidated financial statements are as follows. The accounting principles followed by the Company and the methods of applying them are in conformity with both U.S. generally accepted accounting principles and prevailing practices of the banking industry.

Organization and Basis of Presentation

        The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Veritex Holdings, Inc. (Veritex) and its wholly-owned subsidiary, Veritex Community Bank (Bank), formerly known as Veritex Community Bank, National Association. During 2012, the Bank applied to the Texas Department of Banking to convert to a state banking institution pursuant to Section 32.502 of the Texas Finance Code. The application was approved by the Banking Commissioner effective December 1, 2012.

        Veritex Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation and bank holding company, was incorporated in July 2009 and was formed for the purpose of acquiring one or more financial institutions located in Dallas, Texas and surrounding areas.

        The Bank, a state banking institution with corporate offices in Dallas, Texas, currently operates nine branches located throughout the greater Dallas, Texas metropolitan area. The Bank provides a full range of banking services to individual and corporate customers and is subject to competition from other local, regional, and national financial institutions. The Bank is also subject to the regulations of certain state and federal agencies and undergoes periodic examinations by those regulatory authorities.

        All material intercompany transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Segment Reporting:

        The Company has one reportable segment. The Company's chief operating decision-maker uses consolidated results to make operating and strategic decisions.

Use of Estimates

        The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements. Actual results could differ from those estimates. The allowance for loan losses, the fair values of financial instruments and the status of contingencies are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

        For the purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, amounts due from banks and federal funds sold.

        The Bank maintains deposits with other financial institutions in amounts that exceed federal deposit insurance coverage. Furthermore, federal funds sold are essentially uncollateralized loans to other financial institutions. Management regularly evaluates the credit risk associated with the

F-45


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

counterparties to these transactions and believes that the Company is not exposed to any significant credit risks on cash and cash equivalents.

Restrictions on cash

        The Bank is required to maintain regulatory reserve balances with the Federal Reserve Bank. The reserve balances required as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 were approximately $15,325 and $12,917, respectively.

Investment Securities

        Securities are classified as held to maturity and carried at amortized cost when management has the positive intent and ability to hold them until maturity. Securities to be held for indefinite periods of time are classified as available for sale and carried at fair value, with the unrealized holding gains and losses reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax. Management determines the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase.

        Interest income includes amortization of purchase premiums and discounts. Realized gains and losses are derived from the amortized cost of the security sold. Credit related declines in the fair value of held to maturity and available for sale securities below their cost that are deemed to be other than temporary are reflected in earnings as realized losses, with the remaining unrealized loss recognized as a component of other comprehensive income. In estimating other-than-temporary impairment losses, management considers, among other things, (i) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost, (ii) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and (iii) the intent and ability of the Company to retain its investment in the issuer for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in fair value.

Loans Held for Sale

        Loans held for sale consist of certain mortgage loans originated and intended for sale in the secondary market and are carried at the lower of cost or estimated fair value on an individual loan basis. Net unrealized losses, if any, are recognized through a valuation allowance by charges to income. The Company obtains commitments to purchase the loans from the secondary market investors prior to closing of the loans. Loans held for sale are sold with servicing released. Gains and losses on sales of loans held for sale are based on the difference between the selling price and the carrying value of the related loan sold.

Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses

        Loans, excluding certain purchased loans which have shown evidence of deterioration since origination as of the date of the acquisition, that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off are stated at the amount of unpaid principal, reduced by unearned income and an allowance for loan losses. Interest on loans is recognized using the simple-interest method on the daily balances of the principal amounts outstanding. Fees associated with the originating of loans and certain direct loan origination costs are netted and the net amount is deferred and recognized over the life of the loan as an adjustment of yield.

F-46


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        The accrual of interest on loans is discontinued when there is a clear indication that the borrower's cash flow may not be sufficient to meet payments as they become due, which is generally when a loan is 90 days past due. When a loan is placed on non-accrual status, all previously accrued and unpaid interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized on a cash basis as long as the remaining book balance of the asset is deemed to be collectible. If collectability is questionable, then cash payments are applied to principal. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured in accordance with the terms of the loan agreement.

        The allowance for loan losses is an estimated amount management believes is adequate to absorb inherent losses on existing loans that may be uncollectible based upon review and evaluation of the loan portfolio. Management's periodic evaluation of the allowance is based on general economic conditions, the financial condition of borrowers, the value and liquidity of collateral, delinquency, prior loan loss experience, and the results of periodic reviews of the portfolio. The allowance for loan losses is comprised of two components: the general reserve and specific reserves. The general reserve is determined in accordance with current authoritative accounting guidance that considers historical loss rates for the last three years adjusted for qualitative factors based upon general economic conditions and other qualitative risk factors both internal and external to the Company. Such qualitative factors include current local economic conditions and trends including unemployment, changes in lending staff, policies and procedures, changes in credit concentrations, changes in the trends and severity of problem loans and changes in trends in volume and terms of loans. These qualitative factors serve to compensate for additional areas of uncertainty inherent in the portfolio that are not reflected in the Company's historic loss factors. For purposes of determining the general reserve, the loan portfolio, less cash secured loans, government guaranteed loans and impaired loans, is multiplied by the Company's adjusted historical loss rate. Specific reserves are determined in accordance with current authoritative accounting guidance based on probable losses on specific classified loans.

        The allowance for loan losses is increased by charges to income and decreased by charge-offs (net of recoveries).

        Due to the growth of the Bank over the past several years, a portion of the loans in its portfolio and its lending relationships are of relatively recent origin. The new loan portfolios have limited delinquency and credit loss history and have not yet exhibited an observable loss trend. The credit quality of loans in theses loan portfolios are impacted by delinquency status and debt service coverage generated by the borrowers' business and fluctuations in the value of real estate collateral. Management considers delinquency status to be the most meaningful indicator of the credit quality of one-to-four single family residential, home equity loans and lines of credit and other consumer loans. In general, loans do not begin to show signs of credit deterioration or default until they have been outstanding for some period of time, a process we refer to as "seasoning." As a result, a portfolio of older loans will usually behave more predictably than a portfolio of newer loans. Because the majority of the portfolio is relatively new, the current level of delinquencies and defaults may not be representative of the level that will prevail when the portfolio becomes more seasoned, which may be higher than current levels.

        Delinquency statistics are updated at least monthly. Internal risk ratings are considered the most meaningful indicator of credit quality for new commercial, construction, and commercial real estate

F-47


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

loans. Internal risk ratings are a key factor in identifying loans that are individually evaluated for impairment and impact management's estimates of loss factors used in determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses. Internal risk ratings are updated on a continuous basis.

        Loans are considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due in accordance with the original contractual terms of the loan agreement, including scheduled principal and interest payments. If a loan is impaired, a specific valuation allowance is allocated, if necessary. Interest payments on impaired loans are typically applied to principal unless collectability of the principal amount is reasonably assured, in which case interest is recognized on a cash basis. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.

        The Company's policy requires measurement of the allowance for an impaired collateral dependent loan based on the fair value of the collateral. Other loan impairments are measured based on the present value of expected future cash flows or the loan's observable market price. At December 31, 2013 and 2012, all significant impaired loans have been determined to be collateral dependent and the allowance for loss has been measured utilizing the estimated fair value of the collateral.

        From time to time, the Company modifies its loan agreement with a borrower. A modified loan is considered a troubled debt restructuring when two conditions are met: (i) the borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and (ii) concessions are made by the Company that would not otherwise be considered for a borrower with similar credit risk characteristics. Modifications to loan terms may include a lower interest rate, a reduction of principal, or a longer term to maturity. All troubled debt restructurings are considered impaired loans. The Company reviews each troubled debt restructured loan and determines on a case by case basis if a specific allowance for loan loss is required. An allowance for loan loss allocation is based on either the present value of estimated future cash flows or the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral.

        The Company has certain lending policies and procedures in place that are designed to maximize loan income with an acceptable level of risk. Management reviews and approves these policies and procedures on a regular basis and makes changes as appropriate. Management receives frequent reports related to loan originations, quality, concentrations, delinquencies, non-performing and potential problem loans. Diversification in the loan portfolio is a means of managing risk associated with fluctuations in economic conditions, both by type of loan and geography.

        Commercial loans are underwritten after evaluating and understanding the borrower's ability to operate profitably and effectively. Underwriting standards are designed to determine whether the borrower possesses sound business ethics and practices and to evaluate current and projected cash flows to determine the ability of the borrower to repay their obligations as agreed. Commercial loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flows of the borrower and, secondarily, on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower. Most commercial loans are secured by the assets being financed or other business assets, such as accounts receivable or inventory, and include personal guarantees.

        Real estate loans are also subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial loans. These loans are underwritten primarily based on projected cash flows and, secondarily, as loans

F-48


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

secured by real estate. The repayment of real estate loans is generally largely dependent on the successful operation of the property securing the loans or the business conducted on the property securing the loan. Real estate loans may be more adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or in the general economy. The properties securing the Company's real estate portfolio are generally diverse in terms of type and geographic location, through the Dallas metropolitan area. This diversity helps reduce the exposure to adverse economic events that affect any single market or industry.

        The Company utilizes methodical credit standards and analysis to supplement its policies and procedures in underwriting consumer loans. The Company's loan policy addresses types of consumer loans that may be originated and the collateral, if secured, which must be perfected. The relatively smaller individual dollar amounts of consumer loans that are spread over numerous individual borrowers also minimizes the Company's risk.

Certain Acquired Loans

        As part of business acquisitions, the Company evaluated each of the acquired loans under ASC 310-30 to determine whether (i) there was evidence of credit deterioration since origination, and (ii) it was probable that the Company would not collect all contractually required payments receivable. The Company determined the best indicator of such evidence was an individual loan's payment status and/or whether a loan was determined to be classified based on a review of each individual loan. Therefore, generally each individual loan that should have been or was on non-accrual at the acquisition date and each individual loan that was deemed impaired were included subject to ASC 310-30 accounting. These loans were recorded at the discounted expected cash flows of the individual loan.

        Loans which were evaluated under ASC 310-30, and where the timing and amount of cash flows can be reasonably estimated, were accounted for in accordance with ASC 310-30-35. The Company applies the interest method for these loans under this subtopic and the loans are excluded from non-accrual. If, at acquisition, the Company identified loans that they could not reasonably estimate cash flows or, if subsequent to acquisition, such cash flows could not be estimated, such loans would be included in non-accrual. These acquired loans are recorded at the allocated fair value, such that there is no carryover of the seller's allowance for loan losses. Such acquired loans are accounted for individually. The Company estimates the amount and timing of expected cash flows for each purchased loan, and the expected cash flows in excess of the allocated fair value is recorded as interest income over the remaining life of the loan (accretable yield). The excess of the loan's contractual principal and interest over expected cash flows is not recorded (non-accretable difference). Over the life of the loan, expected cash flows continue to be estimated. If the present value of expected cash flows is less than the carrying amount, a loss is recorded through the allowance for loan losses. If the present value of expected cash flows is greater than the carrying amount, any related allowance for loan loss is reversed, with the remaining yield being recognized prospectively through interest income.

Transfers of Financial Assets

        Transfers of financial assets (generally consisting of sales of loans held for sale and loan participations with unaffiliated banks) are accounted for as sales, when control over the assets has been

F-49


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

relinquished. Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when the assets have been isolated from the Company, the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.

Bank Premises and Equipment

        Buildings and improvements, furniture and equipment are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation computed using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the respective assets as follows:

Buildings and improvements

  10 - 40 years

Leasehold improvements

  Term of lease

Furniture and equipment

  3 - 10 years

        Major replacements and betterments are capitalized while maintenance and repairs are charged to expense when incurred. Gains or losses on dispositions are reflected in operations as incurred.

Non-Marketable Equity Securities

        The Bank is a member of its regional Federal Reserve Bank (FRB) and of the Federal Home Loan Bank system (FHLB). FHLB members are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other factors, and may invest in additional amounts. Both FRB and FHLB stock are carried at cost, restricted for sale, and periodically evaluated for impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value. Both cash and stock dividends are reported as income. Other non-marketable equity securities are carried at cost which approximates fair value.

Other Real Estate Owned

        Other real estate owned represents properties acquired through or in lieu of loan foreclosure and are initially recorded at fair value less estimated costs to sell. At foreclosure, if the fair value, less estimated costs to sell, of the real estate acquired is less than the Bank's recorded investment in the related loan, a write-down is recognized through a charge to the allowance for loan losses. Any subsequent reduction in value is recognized by a charge to income. Operating and holding expenses of such properties, net of related income, and gains and losses on their disposition are included in noninterest expense.

Bank-Owned Life Insurance

        The Company has purchased life insurance policies on certain employees. These bank-owned life insurance (BOLI) policies are recorded in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at their cash surrender values. Income from these policies and changes in the cash surrender values are recorded in other income in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.

F-50


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)


Goodwill and Intangible Assets

        Goodwill resulting from a business combination represents the excess of the fair value of the consideration transferred over the fair value of the net assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. Goodwill is not amortized but is reviewed for potential impairment annually on December 31 or when a triggering event occurs. The Company's goodwill test involves a two-step process. Under the first step, the estimation of fair value of the reporting unit is compared to its carrying value including goodwill. If step one indicates a potential impairment, the second step is performed to measure the amount of impairment, if any. If the carrying amount of the reporting goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. Any such adjustments are reflected in our results of operations in the periods in which they become known. Intangible assets consist of core deposit intangibles and other intangible assets related to operating leases with favorable market terms acquired in business combinations. Intangible assets are initially recognized based on a valuation performed as of the acquisition date. Intangible assets are amortized over the average remaining life of the acquired intangible using the straight-line method. All indefinite lived intangible assets are tested annually for potential impairment or when triggering events occur. Intangible assets with definite lives are tested for impairment when a triggering event occurs. No impairment charges were recorded during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.

Advertising

        Advertising consists of the Company's advertising in its local market. Advertising is expensed as incurred.

Income Taxes

        The Company files a consolidated income tax return with its subsidiary. Federal income tax expense or benefit is allocated on a separate return basis.

        The Company accounts for income taxes using the asset and liability approach for financial accounting and reporting. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are reflected at currently enacted income tax rates applicable to the period in which the deferred tax assets and liabilities are expected to be realized or settled. As changes in tax laws or rates are enacted, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted through the provision for income taxes. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized. Realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of a sufficient level of future taxable income and recoverable taxes paid in prior years.

        The Company may recognize the tax benefit of an uncertain tax position only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained upon examination by the taxing authorities based on the technical merits of the position. For tax positions meeting the more-likely-than-not threshold, the amount recognized in the financial statements would be the benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the relevant tax authority. For the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, management has determined there are no material uncertain tax positions.

F-51


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        When necessary, the Company would include interest assessed by taxing authorities in "Interest expense" and penalties related to income taxes in "Other expense" on its consolidated statements of income. The Company did not record any interest or penalties related to income tax for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011. The Company is no longer subject to U.S. federal income tax examinations by tax authorities for the years before 2010.

Fair Values of Financial Instruments

        Fair values of financial instruments are estimated using relevant market information and other assumptions. Fair value estimates involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment regarding interest rates, credit risk, prepayments and other factors, especially in the absence of broad markets for particular items. Changes in assumptions or in market conditions could significantly affect the estimates. The fair value estimates of existing on and off-balance sheet financial instruments do not include the value of anticipated future business or the value of assets and liabilities not considered financial instruments.

Stock Based Compensation

        Compensation cost is recognized for stock options and stock awards issued to employees and directors, based on the fair value of these awards at the date of grant. A Black-Scholes model is utilized to estimate the fair value of stock options, while the market price of the Company's common stock at the date of grant is used for stock awards. Compensation cost is recognized over the required service period, generally defined as the vesting period. For awards with graded vesting, compensation cost is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire award.

Treasury Stock

        Treasury stock is stated at cost, which is determined by the first-in, first-out method.

Comprehensive Income

        Comprehensive income includes all changes in stockholders' equity during a period, except those resulting from transactions with stockholders. In addition to net income, comprehensive income includes the net effect of changes in the fair value of securities available for sale, net of tax. Comprehensive income is reported in the accompanying consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

ESOP

        Shares of the Company's common stock purchased by the Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) are held in a suspense account until released for allocation to participants. Shares released are allocated to each eligible participant based on the participant's 401(k) contribution made during that year.

        Compensation expense is measured based upon the expected amount of the Company's discretionary contribution to the ESOP which is determined on an annual basis and is accrued ratably over the year. The Company's contributions to the ESOP are used to purchase shares of the

F-52


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

1. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

Company's common stock at the current market value as of the end of the calendar year. Shares become outstanding for earnings per share computations upon allocation. Dividends on allocated ESOP shares are charged to retained earnings and paid to participants of the ESOP.

Earnings Per Share

        Earnings per share (EPS) are based upon the weighted-average shares outstanding. The table below sets forth the reconciliation between weighted average shares used for calculating basic and diluted EPS for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011:

 
  Years ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Earnings (numerator)

                   

Net income for common stockholders

  $ 3,408   $ 1,479   $ 109  

Less: preferred stock dividends

    60     100     76  
               

Net income allocated to common stockholders

  $ 3,348   $ 1,379   $ 33  
               
               

Shares (denominator)

                   

Weighted average shares outstanding for basic EPS (thousands)

    5,788     5,641     5,041  

Dilutive effect of employee stock-based awards

    61     37     27  
               

Adjusted weighted average shares outstanding

    5,849     5,678     5,068  
               
               

Earnings per share:

                   

Basic

  $ 0.58   $ 0.24   $ 0.01  
               
               

Diluted

  $ 0.57   $ 0.24   $ 0.01  
               
               

        For the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company excluded from diluted EPS weighted average shares of performance stock options representing the right to purchase 423,000 shares of the Company's common stock because the issuance of shares related to these options is contingent upon the satisfaction of certain conditions unrelated to earnings or market value and these conditions were not met. In addition, for the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company excluded from diluted EPS weighted average warrants representing the right to purchase 1,000 shares of the Company's common stock because the effect was anti-dilutive.

        For the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011, the Company excluded from diluted EPS weighted average shares of performance stock options representing the right to purchase 419,000 and 394,000 shares, respectively, of the Company's common stock because the issuance of shares related to these options is contingent upon the satisfaction of certain conditions unrelated to earnings or market value and these conditions were not met.

2. Recent Accounting Pronouncements

        ASU 2011-11, "Balance Sheet (Topic 210)—Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities." ASU 2011-11 amends Topic 210, "Balance Sheet," to require an entity to disclose both gross and net information about financial instruments, such as sales and repurchase agreements and reverse sale and

F-53


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

2. Recent Accounting Pronouncements (Continued)

repurchase agreements and securities borrowing/lending arrangements, and derivative instruments that are eligible for offset in the statement of financial position and/or subject to a master netting arrangement or similar agreement. ASU No. 2013-01, "Balance Sheet (Topic 210)—Clarifying the Scope of Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities," clarifies that ordinary trade receivables are not within the scope of ASU 2011-11. ASU 2011-11, as amended by ASU 2013-01, became effective for fiscal years beginning on or after January 1, 2013. Adoption of this new guidance did not have a significant impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        ASU 2013-02, "Comprehensive Income (Topic 220)—Reporting of Amounts Reclassified Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income." ASU 2013-02 amends recent guidance related to the reporting of comprehensive income to enhance the reporting of reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income. ASU 2013-02 is effective for reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2013 and is not expected to have a significant impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        ASU 2014-04, "Receivables—Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors (Subtopic 310-40): Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure" amends ASC Sub-Topic 310-40 "Receivables—Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors." The amendments clarify that an in substance repossession or foreclosure occurs when the Company is considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a mortgage loan, upon either (1) the creditor obtaining legal title to the residential real estate property upon completion of a foreclosure or (2) the borrower conveying all interest in the residential real estate property to the creditor to satisfy that loan through completion of a deed in lieu of foreclosure or through a similar legal agreement. The amendments in this update are effective for the annual periods beginning on or after December 15, 2014 and an entity can elect to adopt the amendments in this update using either a modified retrospective transition method or a prospective transition method as allowed in ASU No. 2014-04. The implementation of ASU No. 2014-04 is not expected to have a material effect on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

F-54


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

3. Investment Securities

        Debt and equity securities have been classified in the consolidated balance sheets according to management's intent. The carrying amount of securities and their approximate fair values are as follows:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Fair Value  

Available for Sale

                         

U.S. government agencies

  $ 2,019   $   $ 95   $ 1,924  

Corporate bonds

    1,445     35         1,480  

Municipal securities

    934     24         958  

Mortgage-backed securities

    24,898     220     187     24,931  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    14,898     158     141     14,915  

Asset-backed securities

    1,370     26         1,396  
                   

  $ 45,564   $ 463   $ 423   $ 45,604  
                   
                   

 

 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Amortized
Cost
  Gross
Unrealized
Gains
  Gross
Unrealized
Losses
  Fair Value  

Available for Sale

                         

Corporate bonds

  $ 1,435   $ 31   $ 4   $ 1,462  

Municipal securities

    904     40         944  

Mortgage-backed securities

    15,006     448         15,454  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    9,867     193     15     10,045  

Asset-backed securities

    1,600     33         1,633  
                   

  $ 28,812   $ 745   $ 19   $ 29,538  
                   
                   

        The following tables disclose the Company's investment securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for less than 12 months and those that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position for 12 or more months:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Less Than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Totals  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
 

Available for Sale

                                     

U.S. government agencies

  $ 1,924   $ 95   $   $   $ 1,924   $ 95  

Mortgage-backed securities

    10,612     187             10,612     187  

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    10,222     140     46     1     10,268     141  
                           

  $ 22,758   $ 422   $ 46   $ 1   $ 22,804   $ 423  
                           
                           

F-55


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

3. Investment Securities (Continued)


 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Less Than 12 Months   12 Months or More   Totals  
 
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
  Fair
Value
  Unrealized
Loss
 

Available for Sale

                                     

Corporate bonds

  $ 496   $ 4   $   $   $ 496   $ 4  

Collateralized mortgage obligations          

    1,412     10     314     5     1,726     15  
                           

  $ 1,908   $ 14   $ 314   $ 5   $ 2,222   $ 19  
                           
                           

        The number of investment positions in an unrealized loss position totaled 25 at December 31, 2013. The Company does not believe these unrealized losses are "other than temporary" as (i) the Company does not have the intent to sell investment securities prior to recovery and (ii) it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell these securities prior to recovery. The unrealized losses noted are interest rate related due to the level of interest rates at December 31, 2013. The Company has reviewed the ratings of the issuers and has not identified any issues related to the ultimate repayment of principal as a result of credit concerns on these securities.

        The amortized costs and estimated fair values of securities available for sale, by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities will differ from contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayments penalties. Mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations, and asset-backed securities typically are issued with stated principal amounts, and the securities are backed by pools of mortgage loans and other loans that have varying maturities. The term of mortgage-backed, collateralized mortgage obligations and asset-backed securities thus approximates the term of the underlying mortgages and loans and can vary significantly due to prepayments. Therefore, these securities are not included in the maturity categories below.

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Available For Sale  
 
  Amortized Cost   Fair Value  

Due in one year or less

  $   $  

Due from one year to five years

    2,379     2,438  

Due from five years to ten years

    2,019     1,924  

Due after ten years

         
           

    4,398     4,362  

Mortgage-backed securities

   
24,898
   
24,931
 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

    14,898     14,915  

Asset-backed securities

    1,370     1,396  
           

  $ 45,564   $ 45,604  
           
           

F-56


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

3. Investment Securities (Continued)

        Proceeds from sales of investment securities available for sale and gross gains and losses for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 were as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Proceeds from sales

  $ 120,000   $ 239,997   $ 90,224  

Gross realized gains

            432  

Gross realized losses

            11  

        The majority of the investment securities sold during the years ending 2013 and 2012, were sold for tax planning purposes.

        As further explained in Note 10, there was a blanket floating lien on certain securities to secure Federal Home Loan Bank advances as of December 31, 2013. There was approximately $10,000 in investment securities pledged to secure borrowings as of December 31, 2012.

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses

        Loans in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Real estate:

             

Construction and land

  $ 47,643   $ 41,497  

Farmland

    11,656     6,281  

1 - 4 family residential

    86,908     71,875  

Multi-family residential

    11,862     12,997  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    171,451     134,449  

Commercial

    160,823     123,779  

Consumer

    4,927     6,858  
           

    495,270     397,736  
           

Deferred loan fees

    (94 )   (220 )

Allowance for loan losses

    (5,018 )   (3,238 )
           

  $ 490,158   $ 394,278  
           
           

        Included in the net loan portfolio as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is an accretable discount related to loans acquired within a business combination in the approximate amounts of $667 and $1,071, respectively. The discount is being accreted into income using the interest method over the life of the loans.

F-57


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        As of December 31, 2013, the Company had total commercial real estate loans (CRE) representing 274% of total risk-based capital. Included in these amounts, the Company had construction, land development, and other land loans representing 83% of total risk-based capital at December 31, 2013. Sound risk management practices and appropriate levels of capital are essential elements of a sound commercial real estate lending program). Concentrations of CRE exposures add a dimension of risk that compounds the risk inherent in individual loans. Interagency guidance on CRE concentrations describes sound risk management practices, which include board and management oversight, portfolio management, management information systems, market analysis, portfolio stress testing and sensitivity analysis, credit underwriting standards, and credit risk review functions. Management believes it has implemented these practices in order to monitor its CRE lending program. An institution which has reported loans for construction, land development, and other land loans representing 100% or more of total risk-based capital, or total non-owner occupied commercial real estate loans representing 300% or more of the institution's total risk-based capital and the outstanding balance of commercial real estate loan portfolio has increased by 50% or more during the prior 36 months, may be identified for further supervisory analysis by regulators to assess the nature and risk posed by the concentration.

        The majority of the loan portfolio is comprised of loans to businesses and individuals in the Dallas metropolitan area. This geographic concentration subjects the loan portfolio to the general economic conditions within this area. The risks created by this concentration have been considered by management in the determination of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses. Management believes the allowance for loan losses was adequate to cover estimated losses on loans as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

Non-Accrual and Past Due Loans

        Loans are considered past due if the required principal and interest payments have not been received as of the date such payments were due. Loans are placed on non-accrual status when, in management's opinion, the borrower may be unable to meet payment obligations as they become due, as well as when required by regulatory provisions. Loans may be placed on non-accrual status regardless of whether or not such loans are considered past due. When interest accrual is discontinued, all unpaid accrued interest is reversed. Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent cash payments are received in excess of principal due. Loans are returned to accrual status when all the principal and interest amounts contractually due are brought current and future payments are reasonably assured.

F-58


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        Non-accrual loans, excluding purchased credit impaired loans, aggregated by class of loans are as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Real estate:

             

Construction and land

  $ 76   $  

Farmland

         

1 - 4 family residential

    1,041     879  

Multi-family residential

         

Nonfarm nonresidential

        331  

Commercial

         

Consumer

        1  
           

  $ 1,117   $ 1,211  
           
           

        During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, interest income not recognized on non-accrual loans was minimal.

        An age analysis of past due loans, excluding purchased credit impaired loans, aggregated by class of loans, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 is as follows:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  30 to 59
Days
  60 to 89
Days
  90 Days
or Greater
  Total
Past Due
  Total
Current
  Total
Loans
  Total 90 Days
Past Due
and Still
Accruing
 

Real estate:

                                           

Construction and land

  $ 19   $   $ 76   $ 95   $ 47,548   $ 47,643   $  

Farmland

                    11,656     11,656      

1 - 4 family residential

    168         1,041     1,209     85,699     86,908      

Multi-family residential

                    11,862     11,862      

Nonfarm nonresidential

                    171,451     171,451      

Commercial

    94             94     160,729     160,823      

Consumer

    34     9     9     52     4,875     4,927     9  
                               

  $ 315   $ 9   $ 1,126   $ 1,450   $ 493,820   $ 495,270   $ 9  
                               
                               

F-59


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)


  December 31, 2012    

    30 to 59
Days
    60 to 89
Days
    90 Days
or Greater
    Total
Past Due
    Total
Current
    Total
Loans
    Total 90 Days
Past Due
and Still
Accruing
 
                               

Real estate:

                                           

Construction and land

  $   $   $   $   $ 41,497   $ 41,497   $  

Farmland

                    6,281     6,281      

1 - 4 family residential

                    71,875     71,875      

Multi-family residential

                    12,997     12,997      

Nonfarm nonresidential

            331     331     134,118     134,449      

Commercial

    17     16     80     113     123,666     123,779     80  

Consumer

    34     1     13     48     6,810     6,858     13  
                               

  $ 51   $ 17   $ 424   $ 492   $ 397,244   $ 397,736   $ 93  
                               
                               

Impaired Loans

        Impaired loans are those loans where it is probable the Company will be unable to collect all amounts due in accordance with the original contractual terms of the loan agreement, including scheduled principal and interest payments. All troubled debt restructurings (TDRs) are considered impaired loans. Impaired loans are measured based on either the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan's effective interest rate; the loan's observable market price; or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent. Substantially all of the Company's impaired loans are measured at the fair value of the collateral. Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.

        Impaired loans, including purchased credit impaired loans and troubled debt restructurings, at December 31, 2013 and 2012 are summarized in the following tables.

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Unpaid
Contractual
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
with No
Allowance
  Recorded
Investment
With
Allowance
  Total
Recorded
Investment
  Related
Allowance
  Average
Recorded
Investment
During Year
 

Real estate:

                                     

Construction and land

  $ 971   $ 645   $   $ 645   $   $ 871  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    1,212     1,212         1,212         1,306  

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1,900     1,900         1,900         1,462  

Commercial

    366     366         366         366  

Consumer

    32     32         32         28  
                           

Total

  $ 4,481   $ 4,155   $   $ 4,155   $   $ 4,033  
                           
                           

F-60


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)


 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Unpaid
Contractual
Principal
Balance
  Recorded
Investment
with No
Allowance
  Recorded
Investment
With
Allowance
  Total
Recorded
Investment
  Related
Allowance
  Average
Recorded
Investment
During Year
 

Real estate:

                                     

Construction and land

  $ 894   $   $ 644   $ 644   $ 90   $ 644  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    880         880     880     85     1,110  

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1,074     1,074         1,074         2,109  

Commercial

    384     384         384         244  

Consumer

    29     29         29         2  
                           

Total

  $ 3,261   $ 1,487   $ 1,524   $ 3,011   $ 175   $ 4,109  
                           
                           

        Interest payments on impaired loans are typically applied to principal unless collectability of the principal amount is reasonably assured, in which case interest is recognized on a cash basis.

        During the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, total interest income and cash-based interest income recognized on impaired loans was minimal.

Troubled Debt Restructuring

        Modifications of terms for the Company's loans and their inclusion as troubled debt restructurings are based on individual facts and circumstances. Loan modifications that are included as troubled debt restructurings may involve a reduction of the stated interest rate of the loan, an extension of the maturity date at a stated rate of interest lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, or deferral of principal payments, regardless of the period of the modification. The recorded investment in troubled debt restructurings was $4,078 and $2,681 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

F-61


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

During the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, the terms of certain loans were modified as troubled debt restructurings as follows:

 
   
   
  2013  
 
   
   
  Post-Modification Outstanding Recorded Investment  
 
  Number
of Loans
  Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
  Adjusted
Interest
Rate
  Extended
Maturity
  Extended
Maturity
and
Restructured
Payments
  Extended
Maturity,
Restructured
Payments and
Adjusted
Interest Rate
 

Real estate loans:

                                     

Construction and land

      $   $   $   $   $  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    2     1,203         1,051         171  

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1     1,180         1,180          

Commercial

    1     16             16      

Consumer

    1     6             6      
                           

Total

    5   $ 2,405   $   $ 2,231   $ 22   $ 171  
                           
                           

 

 
   
   
  2012  
 
   
   
  Post-Modification Outstanding Recorded Investment  
 
  Number
of Loans
  Pre-
Modification
Outstanding
Recorded
Investment
  Adjusted
Interest
Rate
  Extended
Maturity
  Extended
Maturity
and
Restructured
Payments
  Extended
Maturity,
Restructured
Payments and
Adjusted
Interest Rate
 

Real estate loans:

                                     

Construction and land

      $   $   $   $   $  

Farmland

                         

1 - 4 family residential

    1     880             880      

Multi-family residential

                         

Nonfarm nonresidential

    1     750     750              

Commercial

    3     400     400              

Consumer

    1     29     29              
                           

Total

    6   $ 2,059   $ 1,179   $   $ 880   $  
                           
                           

F-62


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        All TDRs are measured individually for impairment. Of the five loans restructured during the year ended December 31, 2013, four are performing as agreed to the modified terms and one was on non-accrual status as of December 31, 2013. No specific allowance for loan losses is recorded for this loan as of December 31, 2013. Of the six loans restructured during the year ended December 31, 2012, five are performing as agreed to the modified terms and one was on non-accrual status as of December 31, 2012. Approximately $85 of the allowance for loan losses was related to this loan as of December 31, 2012.

        Interest income recorded during 2013, 2012 and 2011 on the restructured loans and interest income that would have been recorded had the terms of the loan not been modified was immaterial.

        There was one loan modified as a troubled debt restructured loan within the previous 12 months and for which there was a payment default during the year ended December 31, 2013. The loan was secured by real estate, and a portion of the collateral property was foreclosed upon subsequent to the default. A charge-off of approximately $85 was recorded against the allowance for loan losses. There were no loans modified as a troubled debt restructured loan within the previous 12 months and for which there was a payment default during the year ending December 31, 2012. A default for purposes of this disclosure is a troubled debt restructured loan in which the borrower is 90 days past due or results in the foreclosure and repossession of the applicable collateral.

        The Company has not committed to lend additional amounts to customers with outstanding loans that were classified as TDRs as of December 31, 2013 or 2012.

Credit Quality Indicators

        From a credit risk standpoint, the Company classifies its loans in one of four categories: (i) pass, (ii) special mention, (iii) substandard or (iv) doubtful. Loans classified as loss are charged-off.

        The classifications of loans reflect a judgment about the risks of default and loss associated with the loan. The Company reviews the ratings on criticized credits monthly. Ratings are adjusted to reflect the degree of risk and loss that is felt to be inherent in each credit as of each monthly reporting period. All classified credits are evaluated for impairments. If impairment is determined to exist, a specific reserve is established. The Company's methodology is structured so that specific reserves are increased in accordance with deterioration in credit quality (and a corresponding increase in risk and loss) or decreased in accordance with improvement in credit quality (and a corresponding decrease in risk and loss).

        Credits rated special mention show clear signs of financial weaknesses or deterioration in credit worthiness, however, such concerns are not so pronounced that the Company generally expects to experience significant loss within the short-term. Such credits typically maintain the ability to perform within standard credit terms and credit exposure is not as prominent as credits rated more harshly.

        Credits rated substandard are those in which the normal repayment of principal and interest may be, or has been, jeopardized by reason of adverse trends or developments of a financial, managerial, economic or political nature, or important weaknesses which exist in collateral. A protracted workout on these credits is a distinct possibility. Prompt corrective action is therefore required to strengthen the Company's position, and/or to reduce exposure and to assure that adequate remedial measures are

F-63


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

taken by the borrower. Credit exposure becomes more likely in such credits and a serious evaluation of the secondary support to the credit is performed.

        Credits rated doubtful are those in which full collection of principal appears highly questionable, and which some degree of loss is anticipated, even though the ultimate amount of loss may not yet be certain and/or other factors exist which could affect collection of debt. Based upon available information, positive action by the Company is required to avert or minimize loss. Credits rated doubtful are generally also placed on non-accrual.

        As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the following summarizes the Company's internal ratings of its loans, including purchased credit impaired loans:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

Real estate:

                               

Construction and land

  $ 46,998   $   $ 645   $   $ 47,643  

Farmland

    11,656                 11,656  

1 - 4 family residential

    85,649         1,259         86,908  

Multi-family residential

    11,862                 11,862  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    171,371         80         171,451  

Commercial

    158,919     731     1,173         160,823  

Consumer

    4,878     7     42         4,927  
                       

Total

  $ 491,333   $ 738   $ 3,199   $   $ 495,270  
                       
                       

 

 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Pass   Special
Mention
  Substandard   Doubtful   Total  

Real estate:

                               

Construction and land

  $ 39,349   $   $ 2,148   $   $ 41,497  

Farmland

    6,281                 6,281  

1 - 4 family residential

    71,821         54         71,875  

Multi-family residential

    12,997                 12,997  

Nonfarm nonresidential

    132,330     1,787     332         134,449  

Commercial

    123,407     201     171         123,779  

Consumer

    6,570     14     274         6,858  
                       

Total

  $ 392,755   $ 2,002   $ 2,979   $   $ 397,736  
                       
                       

F-64


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        An analysis of the allowance for loan losses for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, is as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 3,238   $ 1,012   $ 166  

Provision charged to earnings

    1,883     2,953     960  

Charge-offs

   
(240

)
 
(801

)
 
(149

)

Recoveries

    137     74     35  
               

Net charge-offs

    (103 )   (727 )   (114 )
               

Balance at end of year

  $ 5,018   $ 3,238   $ 1,012  
               
               

        The following tables summarize the activity in the allowance for loan losses by portfolio segment for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 455   $ 755   $ 1,028   $ 947   $ 53   $ 3,238  

Provision charged to earnings

    205     240     698     716     24     1,883  

Charge-offs

   
   
(85

)
 
   
(110

)
 
(45

)
 
(240

)

Recoveries

        60         32     45     137  
                           

Net charge-offs

        (25 )       (78 )       (103 )
                           

Balance at end of year

  $ 660   $ 970   $ 1,726   $ 1,585   $ 77   $ 5,018  
                           
                           

Period-end amount allocated to:

                                     

Specific reserves:

                                     

Impaired loans

  $   $   $   $   $   $  

Purchased credit impaired loans

                         
                           

Total specific reserves

                         
                           

General reserves

    660     970     1,726     1,585     77     5,018  
                           

Total

  $ 660   $ 970   $ 1,726   $ 1,585   $ 77   $ 5,018  
                           
                           

F-65


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)


 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 142   $ 215   $ 303   $ 317   $ 35   $ 1,012  

Provision charged to earnings

    313     805     956     741     138     2,953  

Charge-offs

   
   
(265

)
 
(231

)
 
(172

)
 
(133

)
 
(801

)

Recoveries

                61     13     74  
                           

Net charge-offs

        (265 )   (231 )   (111 )   (120 )   (727 )
                           

Balance at end of year

  $ 455   $ 755   $ 1,028   $ 947   $ 53   $ 3,238  
                           
                           

Period-end amount allocated to:

                                     

Specific reserves:

                                     

Impaired loans

  $   $ 85   $   $   $   $ 85  

Purchased credit impaired loans

    90                     90  
                           

Total specific reserves

    90     85                 175  
                           

General reserves

    365     670     1,028     947     53     3,063  
                           

Total

  $ 455   $ 755   $ 1,028   $ 947   $ 53   $ 3,238  
                           
                           

 

 
  December 31, 2011  
 
  Real Estate   Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Balance at beginning of year

  $ 93   $ 69   $ 4   $ 166  

Provision charged to earnings

    599     322     39     960  

Charge-offs

   
(54

)
 
(77

)
 
(18

)
 
(149

)

Recoveries

    22     3     10     35  
                   

Net charge-offs

    (32 )   (74 )   (8 )   (114 )
                   

Balance at end of year

  $ 660   $ 317   $ 35   $ 1,012  
                   
                   

Period-end amount allocated to:

                         

Specific reserves:

                         

Impaired loans

  $   $   $   $  

Purchased credit impaired loans

                 
                   

Total specific reserves

                 
                   

General reserves

    660     317     35     1,012  
                   

Total

  $ 660   $ 317   $ 35   $ 1,012  
                   
                   

F-66


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        The Company's recorded investment in loans as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 related to the balance in the allowance for loan losses on the basis of the Company's impairment methodology is as follows:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Loans individually evaluated for impairment

  $ 76   $ 1,212   $ 1,900   $ 366   $ 32   $ 3,586  

Purchased credit impaired loans

    569                     569  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment

    58,654     97,558     169,551     160,457     4,895     491,115  
                           

Total

  $ 59,299   $ 98,770   $ 171,451   $ 160,823   $ 4,927   $ 495,270  
                           
                           

 

 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Real Estate    
   
   
 
 
  Construction
Land and
Farmland
  Residential   Nonfarm
Non-
Residential
  Commercial   Consumer   Total  

Loans individually evaluated for impairment

  $   $ 880   $ 1,074   $ 384   $ 29   $ 2,367  

Purchased credit impaired loans

    644                     644  

Loans collectively evaluated for impairment

    47,134     83,992     133,375     123,395     6,829     394,725  
                           

Total

  $ 47,778   $ 84,872   $ 134,449   $ 123,779   $ 6,858   $ 397,736  
                           
                           

        The Company has acquired certain loans which experienced credit deterioration since origination (purchased credit impaired loans). Accretion on purchased credit impaired loans is based on estimated future cash flows, regardless of contractual maturity.

F-67


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

        The carrying amount of those loans as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 was as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Real estate:

             

Construction and land

  $ 819   $ 894  

Farmland

         

1 - 4 family residential

         

Multi-family residential

         

Nonfarm nonresidential

         

Commercial

         

Consumer

         
           

Unpaid principal balance

  $ 819   $ 894  
           
           

Carrying amount

  $ 569   $ 644  
           
           

        For those purchased credit impaired loans disclosed above, the Company did not increase the allowance for loan losses during 2013 and there was no allowance for loan losses related to these loans as of December 31, 2013. During 2012, the Company increased the allowance for loan losses by approximately $138. There was approximately $90 of the allowance for loan losses related to these loans as of December 31, 2012. No allowance for loan losses was reversed during the years ended 2013, 2012 and 2011.

        There were no loans purchased during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012.

        Accretable yield, or income expected to be collected from purchased loans, for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, was as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Balance at beginning of year

  $   $   $  

New loans purchased

             

Accretion of income

        (76 )   (180 )

Reclassifications from non-accretable difference

        76     180  

Disposals

             
               

Balance at end of year

  $   $   $  
               
               

        Income is not recognized on certain purchased credit impaired loans if the Company cannot reasonably estimate cash flows expected to be collected. Income on these loans is recognized using the asset recovery method. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, there was only one purchased credit

F-68


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

4. Loans and Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

impaired loan remaining, which was accounted for using the cost recovery method. The carrying amounts of such loans were as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Loans purchased during the year

  $   $   $ 1,875  

Loans at the end of the year

  $ 569   $ 644   $ 2,149  

5. Bank Premises and Equipment

        Bank premises and equipment in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Building and improvements

  $ 2,343   $ 2,334  

Leasehold improvements

    2,873     2,800  

Land

    3,609     3,609  

Furniture, fixtures and equipment

    3,459     2,994  
           

    12,284     11,737  

Less accumulated depreciation

   
2,332
   
1,389
 
           

  $ 9,952   $ 10,348  
           
           

        The Company recorded expense of approximately $972, $764 and $535 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

6. Non-marketable Equity Securities

        Investments in non-marketable equity securities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas stock

  $ 827   $ 667  

Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas stock

    1,837     1,872  

Other non-marketable equity securities

    50     50  
           

  $ 2,714   $ 2,589  
           
           

F-69


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

7. Intangible Assets

        Intangible assets in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:

 
  December 31, 2013  
 
  Weighted
Amortization
Period
  Gross
Intangible
Asset
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Net
Intangible
Asset
 

Core deposit intangibles

  6.0 years   $ 2,380   $ 875   $ 1,505  

Other intangible assets

  5.9 years     107     45     62  
                   

      $ 2,487   $ 920   $ 1,567  
                   
                   

 

 
  December 31, 2012  
 
  Weighted
Amortization
Period
  Gross
Intangible
Asset
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Net
Intangible
Asset
 

Core deposit intangibles

  7.0 years   $ 2,380   $ 581   $ 1,799  

Other intangible assets

  6.9 years     107     31     76  
                   

      $ 2,487   $ 612   $ 1,875  
                   
                   

        For each of the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, amortization expense related to intangible assets totaled approximately $308. For the year ended December 31, 2011, amortization expense totaled approximately $232. The estimated aggregate future amortization expense for intangible assets remaining as of December 31, 2013 was as follows:

Year
  Amount  

2014

  $ 305  

2015

    301  

2016

    297  

2017

    297  

2018

    206  

Thereafter

    161  
       

  $ 1,567  
       
       

8. Goodwill

        Changes in the carrying amount of goodwill are summarized as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Beginning of year

  $ 19,148   $ 19,148  

Effect of acquisitions

         

Impairment losses

         
           

End of year

  $ 19,148   $ 19,148  
           
           

F-70


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

9. Deposits

        Deposits in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are summarized as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Noninterest-bearing demand accounts

  $ 218,990   $ 170,497  

Interest-bearing demand accounts

    40,178     35,057  

Savings accounts

    5,286     4,411  

Limited access money market accounts

    210,131     149,158  

Certificates of deposit, greater than $100,000

    81,478     72,030  

Certificates of deposit, less than $100,000

    17,875     16,749  
           

  $ 573,938   $ 447,902  
           
           

        As of December 31, 2013, the scheduled maturities of certificates of deposit were as follows:

Year
  Amount  

2014

  $ 80,878  

2015

    11,720  

2016

    2,385  

2017

    2,021  

2018

    2,349  
       

  $ 99,353  
       
       

        The aggregate amount of demand deposit overdrafts that have been reclassified as loans was $47 and $79 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

10. Advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank

        Advances from the Federal Home Loan Bank totaled approximately $15,000 and $10,000 at December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. As of December 31, 2013, the advances were collateralized by a blanket floating lien on certain securities and loans, had a weighted average rate of 0.80% and mature on various dates during 2016 and 2018. The Company had the availability to borrow additional funds of approximately $212,622 as of December 31, 2013.

11. Other Credit Extensions

        As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the Company maintained two credit facilities with commercial banks which provide federal funds credit extensions with an availability to borrow up to an aggregate amount of approximately $14,600 and $12,600, respectively. There were no borrowings against these lines as of December 31, 2013 or 2012.

        As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the Company maintained a secured line of credit with the Federal Reserve Bank with an availability to borrow approximately $127,088 and $83,314, respectively. Approximately $155,895 and $102,789 of commercial loans were pledged as collateral at December 31,

F-71


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

11. Other Credit Extensions (Continued)

2013 and 2012, respectively. There were no borrowings against this line as of December 31, 2013 or 2012.

12. Junior Subordinated Debentures and Subordinated Notes

        Junior subordinated debentures and subordinated notes in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Junior subordinated debentures—Trust Securities with a rate of LIBOR plus 1.85% debentures payable to Parkway National Capital Trust 1 with stated maturity of 2036

  $ 3,093   $ 3,093  
           
           

Subordinated notes—unsecured notes with a fixed rate of 6% payable to entities of an affiliate with stated maturity of 2023 (less discount of $21—effective interest rate of 6.025%)

  $ 4,979   $  
           
           

        In connection with the acquisition of Fidelity Resource Company during 2011, the Company assumed $3.1 million in fixed/floating rate junior subordinated debentures underlying common securities and preferred capital securities, or the Trust Securities, issued by Parkway National Capital Trust I, a statutory business trust and acquired wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The Company assumed the guarantor position and as such, unconditionally guarantees payment of accrued and unpaid distributions required to be paid on the Trust Securities subject to certain exceptions, the redemption price when a capital security is called for redemption and amounts due if a trust is liquidated or terminated.

        The Company owns all of the outstanding common securities of the trust. The trust used the proceeds from the issuance of its Trust Securities to buy the debentures originally issued by Fidelity Resource Company. These debentures are the trust's only assets and the interest payments from the debentures finance the distributions paid on the Trust Securities.

        The Trust Securities pay cumulative cash distributions quarterly at a rate per annum equal to the 3-month LIBOR plus 1.85% percent. The effective rate as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 was 2.10% and 2.19%, respectively. The Trust Securities are subject to mandatory redemption in whole or in part, upon repayment of the debentures at the stated maturity in the year 2036 or their earlier redemption, in each case at a redemption price equal to the aggregate liquidation preference of the Trust Securities plus any accumulated and unpaid distributions thereon to the date of redemption. Prior redemption is permitted under certain circumstances.

        The Trust Securities qualify as Tier 1 capital, subject to regulatory limitations, under guidelines established by the Federal Reserve.

Subordinated Notes

        During 2013 the Company issued, in the aggregate principal amount of $5,000, subordinated promissory notes (Notes) via a private offering. The Notes were issued to certain entities controlled by

F-72


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

12. Junior Subordinated Debentures and Subordinated Notes (Continued)

an affiliate of the Company for the purpose of using the proceeds to support the growth of the Company. The Notes are unsecured, with interest payable quarterly at a fixed rate of 6% per annum, and unpaid principal and interest due at the stated maturity in the year 2023. The Notes qualify as Tier 2 Capital, subject to regulatory limitations, under guidelines established by the Federal Reserve. In addition, the Notes may be redeemed in whole or in part on any interest payment date that occurs on or after December 23, 2018 subject to approval of the Federal Reserve in compliance with applicable statues and regulations.

        In connection with the issuance of the Notes, the Company issued warrants to purchase 25,000 shares of common stock of the Company at $11 per share, exercisable at any time, in whole or in part, prior to December 31, 2023. The fair value of the warrants was calculated at $0.80 and is recorded as additional paid-in capital and the related debt discount is being accreted into interest expense.

13. Income Taxes

        The provision for income taxes is summarized as follows:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Income tax expense (benefit):

                   

Current

  $ 2,491   $ 534   $ (179 )

Deferred

    (714 )   (398 )   192  
               

  $ 1,777   $ 136   $ 13  
               
               

        The table below reconciles income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011 computed by applying the applicable U.S. Federal statutory income tax rate, reconciled to the tax expense computed at the effective income tax rate:

 
  Year Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Federal income tax expense rate at 34%

  $ 1,763   $ 549   $ 42  

Stock option expense

    76     58     50  

Bank-owned life insurance income

    (110 )   (52 )    

Non-deductible dues and memberships

    48     44     33  

Other

        55     (53 )

Change in valuation allowance

        (518 )   (59 )
               

Total income tax expense

    1,777     136     13  
               

Effective tax rate

    34.3 %   8.4 %   10.6 %
               
               

F-73


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

13. Income Taxes (Continued)

        Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the recorded amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes, and the amounts used for income tax purposes. Significant components of the Company's deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Deferred tax assets:

             

Net operating loss

  $ 96   $ 197  

Organizational costs

    183     203  

Allowance for loan losses

    1,619     1,183  

Deferred loan fees

    32     75  

Non-accrual interest

    62     48  

Capital loss carryforward

    85     85  

ORE write down for book purposes

    55     16  

Deferred rent expenses

    70     92  

Restricted stock

    84     50  

Accrued bonuses

    243      

Other

    134     141  
           

Total deferred tax assets

    2,663     2,090  
           

Deferred tax liabilities:

             

Net unrealized gain on securities available for sale

    14     247  

Core deposit intangibles

    512     612  

FHLB stock dividends

    26     25  

Bank premises and equipment

    1,118     1,160  
           

Total deferred tax liabilities

    1,670     2,044  
           

Net deferred tax asset

  $ 993   $ 46  
           
           

        The net change in the valuation allowance for the year ended December 31, 2012 was approximately $518. Included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets in other assets as of December 31, 2013 is a current tax receivable of approximately $292 and a net deferred tax asset of approximately $993. Included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets in other assets as of December 31, 2012 was a current tax receivable of approximately $333 and a net deferred tax asset of approximately $46.

        For federal income tax purposes, the Company has an operating loss carryforward of approximately $281 that will expire beginning in 2029.

14. Commitments and Contingencies

Litigation

        The Company may from time to time be involved in legal actions arising from normal business activities. Management believes that these actions are without merit or that the ultimate liability, if any,

F-74


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

14. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

resulting from them will not materially affect the financial position or results of operations of the Company.

Operating Leases

        The Company leases several of its banking facilities under operating leases expiring in various years through 2022. Minimum future rental payments under these non-cancelable operating leases in excess of one year as of December 31, 2013 for each of the next five years and in the aggregate are:

Year Ended December 31,
  Amount  

2014

  $ 1,118  

2015

    991  

2016

    907  

2017

    904  

2018

    816  

Thereafter

    2,468  
       

  $ 7,204  
       
       

        Rental expense was approximately $1,353, $1,205, and $661 for the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

        Certain of the operating leases above provide for renewal options at their fair value at the time of renewal. In the normal course of business, operating leases are generally renewed or replaced by other leases.

        During 2012, the Company relocated its corporate office facilities and incurred an approximate loss of $102 for early contract termination of the leased space. All terminating costs were recorded in occupancy of bank premises in the accompanying consolidated statements of income with a corresponding deferral recorded in other liabilities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, approximately $7 and $91, respectively, is remaining as a liability in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

15. Fair Value Disclosures

        The authoritative guidance for fair value measurements defines fair value as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. A fair value measurement assumes that the transaction to sell the asset or transfer the liability occurs in the principal market for the asset or liability or, in the absence of a principal market, the most advantageous market for the asset or liability. The price in the principal (or most advantageous) market used to measure the fair value of the asset or liability shall not be adjusted for transaction costs. An orderly transaction is a transaction that assumes exposure to the market for a period prior to the measurement date to allow for marketing activities that are usual and customary for transactions involving such assets and liabilities; it is not a forced transaction. Market participants are buyers and sellers in the principal market that are (i) independent, (ii) knowledgeable, (iii) able to transact and (iv) willing to transact.

F-75


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

15. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

        The authoritative guidance requires the use of valuation techniques that are consistent with the market approach, the income approach and/or the cost approach. The market approach uses prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable assets and liabilities. The income approach uses valuation techniques to convert future amounts, such as cash flows or earnings, to a single present amount on a discounted basis. The cost approach is based on the amount that currently would be required to replace the service capacity of an asset (replacement costs). Valuation techniques should be consistently applied. Inputs to valuation techniques refer to the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability. Inputs may be observable, meaning those that reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on market data obtained from independent sources, or unobservable, meaning those that reflect the reporting entity's own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability developed based on the best information available in the circumstances. In that regard, the authoritative guidance establishes a fair value hierarchy for valuation inputs that gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The fair value hierarchy is as follows:

        In general, fair value is based upon quoted market prices, where available. If such quoted market prices are not available, fair value is based upon internally developed models that primarily use, as inputs, observable market-based parameters. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value. While management believes the Company's valuation methodologies are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.

        A description of the valuation methodologies used for instruments measured at fair value, as well as the general classification of such instruments pursuant to the valuation hierarchy, is set forth below.

        Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis include the following:

        Investment Securities Available For Sale:    Securities classified as available for sale are reported at fair value utilizing Level 2 inputs. For those securities classified as Level 2, the Company obtains fair

F-76


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

15. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

value measurements from an independent pricing service. The fair value measurements consider observable data that may include dealer quotes, market spreads, cash flows, the U. S. Treasury yield curve, live trading levels, trade execution data, market consensus prepayments speeds, credit information and the bond's terms and conditions, among other things.

        The following table summarizes assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:

 
  Fair Value
Measurements Using
   
 
 
  Level 1
Inputs
  Level 2
Inputs
  Level 3
Inputs
  Total
Fair Value
 

As of December 31, 2013:

                         

Investment securities available for sale

  $   —   $ 45,604   $   —   $ 45,604  

As of December 31, 2012:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Investment securities available for sale

  $   —   $ 29,538   $   —   $ 29,538  

        There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

        There were no transfers between Level 2 and Level 3 during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012.

        Certain assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis; that is, the instruments are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).

        Assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis include impaired loans and other real estate owned. The fair value of impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses and other real estate owned is based upon recent real estate appraisals less estimated costs of sale. For residential real estate impaired loans and other real estate owned, appraised values are based on the comparative sales approach. For commercial and commercial real estate impaired loans and other real estate owned, appraisers may use either a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches such as comparative sales, cost or the income approach. A significant unobservable input in the income approach is the estimated income capitalization rate for a given piece of collateral. Adjustments to appraisals may be made to reflect local market conditions or other economic factors and may result in changes in the fair value of a given asset over time. As such, the fair value of impaired loans and other real estate owned are considered a Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy.

        The Company recovers the carrying value of other real estate owned through the sale of the property. The ability to affect future sales prices is subject to market conditions and factors beyond the Company's control and may impact the estimated fair value of a property.

F-77


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

15. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

        Appraisals for impaired loans and other real estate owned are performed by certified general appraisers whose qualifications and licenses have been reviewed and verified by the Company. Once reviewed, a member of the credit department reviews the assumptions and approaches utilized in the appraisal as well as the overall resulting fair value in comparisons to independent data sources such as recent market data or industry wide-statistics. On a periodic basis, the Company compares the actual selling price of collateral that has been sold to the most recent appraised value to determine what additional adjustments, if any, should be made to the appraisal value to arrive at fair value.

        The following table summarizes assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:

 
  Fair Value
Measurements Using
   
 
 
  Level 1
Inputs
  Level 2
Inputs
  Level 3
Inputs
  Total
Fair Value
 

As of December 31, 2013:

                         

Assets:

                         

Impaired loans

  $   $   $ 4,155   $ 4,155  

Other real estate owned

  $   $   $ 1,797   $ 1,797  

As of December 31, 2012:

                         

Assets:

                         

Impaired loans

  $   $   $ 2,836   $ 2,836  

Other real estate owned

  $   $   $ 2,438   $ 2,438  

        At December 31, 2013, impaired loans had a carrying value of $4,155, with no specific allowance for loan loss allocated. At December 31, 2012, impaired loans, which had a specific allowance for loan losses allocated, had a carrying amount of approximately $3,011, with a specific valuation allowance of approximately $175, resulting in no additional provision for loan losses for the year ended December 31, 2012.

        Other real estate owned properties are measured for impairment using the fair value of the collateral less estimated cost to sell and had a carrying amount of approximately $1,959 and $2,687 reduced by approximately $162 and $48, for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        There were no liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

        For Level 3 financial and nonfinancial assets and liabilities measured at fair value as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the significant unobservable inputs used in the fair value measurements were as follows:

December 31, 2013  
Assets/Liabilities
  Fair Value   Valuation
Technique
  Unobservable
Input(s)
  Weighted
Average
 

Impaired loans

  $ 4,155   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

Other real estate owned

  $ 1,797   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

F-78


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

15. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)


December 31, 2012  
Assets/Liabilities
  Fair Value   Valuation
Technique
  Unobservable
Input(s)
  Weighted
Average
 

Impaired loans

  $ 2,836   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

Other real estate owned

  $ 2,438   Collateral Method   Adjustments for selling costs     8 %

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

        The Company is required under current authoritative guidance to disclose the estimated fair value of their financial instrument assets and liabilities including those subject to the requirements discussed above. For the Company, as for most financial institutions, substantially all of its assets and liabilities are considered financial instruments, as defined. Many of the Company's financial instruments, however, lack an available trading market as characterized by a willing buyer and willing seller engaging in an exchange transaction.

        The estimated fair value amounts of financial instruments have been determined by the Company using available market information and appropriate valuation methodologies. However, considerable judgment is required to interpret data to develop the estimates of fair value. Accordingly, the estimates presented herein are not necessarily indicative of the amounts the Company could realize in a current market exchange. The use of different market assumptions and/or estimation methodologies may have a material effect on the estimated fair value amounts. In addition, reasonable comparability between financial institutions may not be likely due to the wide range of permitted valuation techniques and numerous estimates that must be made given the absence of active secondary markets for many of the financial instruments. This lack of uniform valuation methodologies also introduces a greater degree of subjectivity to these estimated fair values.

        The methods and assumptions used by the Company in estimating fair values of financial instruments as disclosed herein in accordance with ASC Topic 825, Financial Instruments, other than for those measured at fair value on a recurring and nonrecurring basis discussed above, are as follows:

        Cash and cash equivalents:    The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents approximate their fair value.

        Loans and loans held for sale:    For variable-rate loans that reprice frequently and have no significant changes in credit risk, fair values are based on carrying values. Fair values for certain mortgage loans (for example, one-to-four family residential), commercial real estate and commercial loans are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates currently being offered for loans with similar terms to borrowers of similar credit quality.

        Bank-owned life insurance:    The carrying amounts of bank-owned life insurance approximate their fair value.

        Non-marketable equity securities:    The carrying value of restricted securities such as stock in the Federal Home Loan Bank of Dallas and Independent Bankers Financial Corporation approximates fair value.

        Deposits:    The fair values disclosed for demand deposits are, by definition, equal to the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (that is their carrying amounts). The carrying amounts of

F-79


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

15. Fair Value Disclosures (Continued)

variable-rate certificates of deposit (CDs) approximate their fair values at the reporting date. Fair values for fixed-rate CDs are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.

        Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank:    The fair value of advances maturing within 90 days approximates carrying value. Fair value of other advances is based on the Company's current borrowing rate for similar arrangements.

        Junior subordinated debentures and subordinated notes:    The fair values are based upon prevailing rates on similar debt in the market place.

        Accrued interest:    The carrying amounts of accrued interest approximate their fair values due to short term maturity.

        Off-balance sheet instruments:    Commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit are generally priced at market at the time of funding and were not material to the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        The estimated fair values and carrying values of all financial instruments under current authoritative guidance as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 were as follows:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  
 
  Carrying
Amount
  Fair
Value
  Carrying
Amount
  Fair
Value
 

Financial assets:

                         

Level 2 inputs:

                         

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 76,646   $ 76,646   $ 53,160   $ 53,160  

Securities available for sale

    45,604     45,604     29,538     29,538  

Loans held for sale

    2,051     2,051     2,818     2,818  

Accrued interest receivable

    1,351     1,351     1,201     1,201  

Bank-owned life insurance

    10,475     10,475     5,152     5,152  

Non-marketable equity securities

    2,714     2,714     2,589     2,589  

Level 3 inputs:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Loans, net

    490,158     490,344     394,278     398,427  

Financial liabilities:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Level 2 inputs:

                         

Deposits

  $ 573,938   $ 568,451   $ 447,902   $ 443,033  

Advances from FHLB

    15,000     15,055     10,000     10,000  

Accrued interest payable

    134     134     148     148  

Junior subordinated debentures

    3,093     3,093     3,093     3,093  

Subordinated notes

    4,979     4,979          

F-80


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

16. Financial Instruments with Off-Balance Sheet Risk

        The Company is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amount recognized in the consolidated balance sheets.

        The Company's exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit and standby letters of credit is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for on balance sheet instruments.

        The following table sets forth the approximate amounts of these financial instruments as of December 31, 2013 and 2012:

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Commitments to extend credit

  $ 92,827   $ 76,252  

Standby letters of credit

    210     222  
           

  $ 93,037   $ 76,474  
           
           

        Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract. Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. Since many of the commitments may expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements. Management evaluates each customer's creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis. The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary upon extension of credit, is based on management's credit evaluation of the borrower.

        Standby letters of credit are conditional commitments issued by the Company to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party. Standby letters of credit generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee. The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers. The Company's policy for obtaining collateral and the nature of such collateral is essentially the same as that involved in making commitments to extend credit.

        Although the maximum exposure to loss is the amount of such commitments, management currently anticipates no material losses from such activities.

17. Employee Benefits

        The Company maintains a retirement savings 401(k) profit sharing plan (Plan) in which substantially all employees may participate. The Plan provides for "before tax" employee contributions through salary reductions under section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code. The Company may make a discretionary match of employees' contributions based on a percentage of salary deferrals and certain discretionary profit sharing contributions. No matching contributions to the Plan were made during the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011.

        Effective January 1, 2012, the Company adopted an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (ESOP) covering all employees that meet certain age and service requirements. Plan assets are held and managed by the Company. The Company accrued approximately $120 and $96 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively, to contribute to the ESOP. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the ESOP purchased 7811 shares of the Company's common stock and allocated the shares to the plan participants. The ESOP did not purchase shares during the year ended December 31, 2012

F-81


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

18. Stock Incentive Plan

        In 2010, the Company adopted the 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (the Incentive Plan), which the Company's shareholders approved in 2011. The maximum number of shares of common stock that may be issued pursuant to grants or options under the Incentive Plan is 1,000,000. The Incentive Plan is administered by the Board of Directors and provides for both the direct award of stock and the grant of stock options to eligible directors, officers, employees and outside consultants of the Company or its affiliates as defined in the Incentive Plan. The Company may grant either incentive stock options or nonqualified stock options as directed in the Incentive Plan.

        The Board authorized that the Incentive Plan provide for the award of 100,000 shares of direct stock awards (restricted shares) and 900,000 shares of stock options, of which 500,000 shares are performance-based stock options. Options are generally granted with an exercise price equal to the market price of the Company's stock at the date of the grant; those option awards generally vest based on 5 years of continuous service and have 10-year contractual terms for non-controlling participants as defined by the Incentive Plan, and forfeiture of unexercised options upon termination of employment with the Company. Other grant terms can vary for controlling participants as defined by the Incentive Plan. Restricted share awards generally vest after 4 years of continuous service. The terms of the Incentive Plan include a provision whereby all unearned non-performance options and restricted shares become immediately exercisable and fully vested upon a change in control. The vesting of a performance-based stock option is contingent upon a change of control and the achievement of specific performance criteria or other objectives set at the grant date.

        During 2013, the Company awarded 1,000 restricted shares, 10,000 nonperformance-based stock options and 10,000 performance-based stock options. During 2012, the Company awarded 16,000 restricted shares, 57,500 nonperformance-based stock options and 62,500 performance-based stock options.

        Stock based compensation expense is measured based upon the fair market value of the award at the grant date and is recognized ratably over the period during which the shares are earned (the requisite service period). For the years ended December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, approximately $323, $255 and $207, respectively, was recognized in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. As of December 31, 2013, there was approximately $1,670 of unrecognized compensation expense related to non-vested share-based compensation awards that is expected to be recognized over the remaining requisite service periods of the options granted.

        The fair value of each option award is estimated on the grant date using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model with the following assumptions used for the grants:

 
  December 31,
 
  2013   2012

Dividend yield

  0.00%   0.00%

Expected life

  10 years   10 years

Expected volatility

  4.00%   4.00%

Risk-free interest rate

  2.05% to 2.75%   1.47% to 2.03%

        The expected life is based on the expected amount of time that options granted are expected to be outstanding. The dividend yield assumption is based on the Company's history. The expected volatility

F-82


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

18. Stock Incentive Plan (Continued)

is based on historical volatility of the Company. The risk-free interest rates are based upon yields of U.S. Treasury issues with a term equal to the expected life of the option being valued.

        A summary of option activity under the Incentive Plan as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and changes during the years then ended is presented below:

 
  2013
 
  Nonperformance-based stock options   Performance-based stock options
 
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term

Outstanding at beginning of year

    332,500   $ 10.00   8.18 years     432,500   $ 10.00   8.0 years
                                 
                                 

Granted during the year

    10,000     10.85         10,000     10.85    

Forfeited during the year

    (15,000 )   10.00         (20,000 )   10.00    

Exercised during the year

                       
                         

Outstanding at the end of year

    327,500   $ 10.03   7.69 years     422,500   $ 10.02   8.0 years
                         
                         

Options exercisable at end of year

    115,500   $ 10.00   7.02 years       $  
                         
                         

Weighted average fair value of options granted during the year

        $ 2.51             $ 2.51    
                             
                             

 

 
  2012
 
  Nonperformance-based stock options   Performance-based stock options
 
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term
  Shares
Underlying
Options
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
  Weighted
Average
Contractual
Term

Outstanding at beginning of year

    302,500   $ 10.00   9.08 years     397,500   $ 10.00   9.08 years
                                 
                                 

Granted during the year

    57,500     10.00         62,500     10.00    

Forfeited during the year

    (27,500 )   10.00         (27,500 )   10.00    

Exercised during the year

                       
                         

Outstanding at the end of year

    332,500   $ 10.00   8.18 years     432,500   $ 10.00   8.0 years
                         
                         

Options exercisable at end of year

    55,000   $ 10.00   7.83 years       $  
                         
                         

Weighted average fair value of options granted during the year

        $ 1.61             $ 1.59    
                             
                             

        As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the aggregate intrinsic value was $939 and $283, respectively, for outstanding nonperformance-based options and $335 and $47, respectively, for exercisable nonperformance-based stock options.

        As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the aggregate intrinsic value was $1,216 and $368, respectively for performance-based stock options. No performance-based stock options were exercisable as of December 31, 2013 and 2012.

F-83


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

18. Stock Incentive Plan (Continued)

        As of December 31, 2013, 2012, and 2011, there was $1,520, $1,699, and $1,631, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation expense related to non-vested option shares, of which $402, $555, and $609, respectively, was related to the nonperformance-based stock options. The nonperformance-based stock option expense will be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 2.33 years. Expense associated with the performance-based stock options is based on the probability of future changes in control and other market conditions. During 2013, management determined that one performance condition had been met and expensed a portion of the performance-based option expense. Total unrecognized compensation expense related to these performance-based options as of December 31, 2013 was approximately $349, and is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 7 years. Management does not anticipate meeting the other market conditions in the foreseeable future; therefore, no performance-based stock option expense related to these conditions was recorded for the year ended December 31, 2013.

        A summary of the status of the Company's restricted shares as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, and changes during the years then ended is as follows:

 
  2013   2012  
 
  Shares   Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
  Shares   Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value
 

Nonvested at January 1,

    40,000   $ 10.00     26,000   $ 10.00  

Granted during the year

    1,000     10.85     16,000     10.00  

Vested during the year

                 

Forfeited during the year

    (6,000 )   10.00     (2,000 )   10.00  
                       

Nonvested at December 31,

    35,000   $ 10.02     40,000   $ 10.00  
                   
                   

        As of December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, there was $150, $239 and $176, respectively, of total unrecognized compensation expense related to nonvested restricted shares. The compensation expense is expected to be recognized over the remaining weighted average requisite service period of 1.81 years.

19. Significant Concentrations of Credit Risk

        Most of the Company's business activity is with customers located within the Dallas Metropolitan area. Such customers are normally also depositors of the Company.

        The distribution of commitments to extend credit approximates the distribution of loans outstanding. Commercial and standby letters of credit were granted primarily to commercial borrowers.

        The contractual amounts of credit related financial instruments such as commitments to extend credit, credit card arrangements, and letters of credit represent the amounts of potential accounting loss should the contract be fully drawn upon, the customer default, and the value of any existing collateral become worthless.

F-84


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

20. Related Party Transactions

        In the ordinary course of business, the Company has and expects to continue to have transactions, including borrowings, with its employees, officers, directors and their affiliates. In the opinion of management, such transactions are on the same terms, including interest rates and collateral requirements, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with unaffiliated persons. The aggregate amounts of such loans were approximately $16,699 and $18,384 as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. During the year ended December 31, 2013, new advances of approximately $7,102 were made with approximately $8,787 principal payments received. There were $8,787 and $1,213 in unfunded commitments to related parties as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        Deposits received from related parties as of December 31, 2013 and 2012 totaled approximately $15,511 and $6,873, respectively.

        As disclosed in Note 12, the Company issued $5,000 in subordinated notes to two entities controlled by a certain affiliate of the Company.

21. Preferred Stock

        In connection with the acquisition of Fidelity Resources Company, the Company acquired 3,000 shares of Fidelity Resources Company Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A (Series A Preferred Stock) with a liquidation preference of $1 per share for $3,000 and 150 warrant shares issued to the U.S. Treasury Department (Treasury) in connection with the Troubled Asset Relief Program (TARP) Capital Purchase Program established as part of the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008. The Series A Preferred Stock initially paid quarterly dividends at a five percent annual rate that was to increase to nine percent after five years from issuance. The warrant shares were issued in the form of 150 shares of Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B (Series B Preferred Stock). The Series B Preferred Stock had an exercise price of $.01 per share with a liquidation preference of $1 per share for $150. The warrants were exercised immediately and the purchase discount was accreted using the level yield method. The Series B Preferred Stock paid quarterly dividends at a nine percent annual rate.

        On August 25, 2011 the Company entered into a Small Business Lending Fund-Securities Purchase Agreement (SBLF Purchase Agreement) with the Secretary of the Treasury, pursuant to which the Company (i) sold 8,000 shares of the Company's Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C (the SBLF Preferred Stock) to the Secretary of the Treasury for a purchase price of $8,000. The issuance was pursuant to the SBLF program, a fund established under the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010 that was created to encourage lending to small business by providing capital to qualified community banks. As required by the SBLF Purchase Agreement, approximately $3,155 of the proceeds from the sale of the SBLF Preferred Stock were used to redeem the 3,000 shares of the Company's Series A Preferred Stock and the 150 shares of Series B Preferred Stock, issued to the Treasury, plus the accrued dividends owed the Treasury in connection with the TARP preferred shares.

        The SBLF Preferred Stock qualifies as Tier 1 capital and pays non-cumulative dividends quarterly, on each January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1. The dividend rate, as a percentage of the liquidation amount, can fluctuate on a quarterly basis during the first 10 quarters during which the SBLF Preferred Stock is outstanding, based upon changes in the level of "Qualified Small Business Lending" or "QBSL" (as defined in the SBLF Purchase Agreement) by the Bank. Based upon the increase in the

F-85


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

21. Preferred Stock (Continued)

Bank's level of QBSL over the baseline level calculated under the terms of the SBLF Purchase Agreement, the dividend rate for the initial dividend period for the Company was set at 1.00%. For the tenth calendar quarter through four and one half years after issuance, the dividend rate will be fixed and as of December 31, 2013 was set at one percent (1%) based upon the increase in QBSL as compared to the baseline. After four and one half years from issuance, the dividend rate will increase to 9% (including a quarterly lending incentive fee of 0.5%).

        The SBLF Preferred Stock is non-voting, except in limited circumstances. In the event that the Company misses five dividend payments, whether or not consecutive, the holder of the SBLF Preferred Stock will have the right, but not the obligation, to appoint a representative as an observer on the Company's Board of Directors. The right expires when full dividends have been paid for four consecutive dividend periods. The SBLF Preferred Stock may be redeemed at any time at the Company's option, at a redemption price of 100% of the liquidation amount plus accrued but unpaid dividends to the date of redemption for the current period, subject to the approval of its federal banking regulator.

22. Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Retained Earnings

        Under banking law, there are legal restrictions limiting the amount of dividends the Company can declare. Approval of the regulatory authorities is required if the effect of the dividends declared would cause regulatory capital of the Company to fall below specified minimum levels.

        The Bank is subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Bank's financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Bank's assets, liabilities, and certain off balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. The Bank's capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings, and other factors.

        Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk weighted assets (as defined), and of Tier 1 capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined). Management believes, as of December 31, 2013 and 2012, that the Bank met all capital adequacy requirements to which it was subject.

        As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, the Bank's capital ratios exceeded those levels necessary to be categorized as "well capitalized" under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action. To be categorized as "well capitalized", the Bank must maintain minimum total risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based and Tier 1 leverage ratios as set forth in the table. There are no conditions or events since December 31, 2013 that management believes have changed the Bank's category.

F-86


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

22. Capital Requirements and Restrictions on Retained Earnings (Continued)

        A comparison of the Company's and Bank's actual capital amounts and ratios to required capital amounts and ratios is presented in the following table:

 
  Actual    
  For Capital Adequacy
Purposes
   
  To Be Well
Capitalized
Under Prompt
Corrective
Action Provisions
 
 
  Amount   Ratio    
  Amount    
  Ratio    
  Amount    
  Ratio  

As of December 31, 2013:

                                                     

Total capital (to risk weighted assets)

                                                     

Company

  $ 59,100     11.74 % ³   $ 40,288   ³     8.0 % ³     N/A   ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 57,275     11.37 % ³   $ 40,296   ³     8.0 % ³   $ 38,817   ³     10.0 %

Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)

                                                     

Company

  $ 49,103     9.75 % ³   $ 20,144   ³     4.0 % ³     N/A   ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 52,257     10.37 % ³   $ 20,148   ³     4.0 % ³   $ 23,290   ³     6.0 %

Tier 1 capital (to average assets)

                                                     

Company

  $ 49,103     8.06 % ³   $ 24,373   ³     4.0 % ³     N/A   ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 52,257     8.58 % ³   $ 24,369   ³     4.0 % ³   $ 24,762   ³     5.0 %

As of December 31, 2012:

   
 
   
 
 

 

   
 
 

 

   
 
 

 

   
 
 

 

   
 
 

Total capital (to risk weighted assets)

                                                     

Company

  $ 47,301     12.17 % ³   $ 31,085   ³     8.0 % ³     N/A   ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 45,360     11.69 % ³   $ 31,053   ³     8.0 % ³   $ 38,817   ³     10.0 %

Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)

                                                     

Company

  $ 44,063     11.34 % ³   $ 15,543   ³     4.0 % ³     N/A   ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 42,122     10.85 % ³   $ 15,527   ³     4.0 % ³   $ 23,290   ³     6.0 %

Tier 1 capital (to average assets)

                                                     

Company

  $ 44,063     8.81 % ³   $ 20,013   ³     4.0 % ³     N/A   ³     N/A  

Bank

  $ 42,122     8.51 % ³   $ 19,810   ³     4.0 % ³   $ 24,762   ³     5.0 %

23. Mergers and Acquisitions

        The acquisitions described below were accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with FASB ASC 805, "Business Combinations". The purchased assets and assumed liabilities were recorded at their respective estimated fair values as of the date of acquisition with the excess of the cost of the acquisition over the fair value of the net tangible and intangible assets acquired recorded as goodwill. None of the goodwill is expected to be deducted for federal income tax purposes.

        The operating results of the acquired companies are included with the Company's results of operations since their date of acquisition. There were no acquisitions during the years ended 2013 or 2012.

F-87


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

23. Mergers and Acquisitions (Continued)

2011 Business Combinations

        During 2010, the Company entered into a definitive agreement to acquire Fidelity Resources Company, (FRC), a Texas bank holding company, and its wholly owned subsidiary, Fidelity Bank, a state chartered bank located in Dallas, Texas. On March 23, 2011, pursuant to the terms of the agreement, the Company purchased all of the issued and outstanding (i) common stock, $1.00 par value, (ii) Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, $0.01 par value and (iii) Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, $0.01 par value of FRC for approximately $23,860. The purchase price includes approximately $16,624 in cash and approximately $7,236 in an exchange of Company stock. Simultaneously with the merger, FRC was dissolved which resulted in the Company owning all of the stock of Fidelity. The fair value of $10 per share of the Company's common stock was determined based upon the sales price as stated in the Company's private offering which concluded on May 15, 2011.

        During 2011, the Company through its banking subsidiary entered in an agreement and plan of merger to acquire Bank of Las Colinas (BOLC), a federal savings bank located in Irving, Texas. On October 26, 2011, pursuant to the terms of the agreement, the Company purchased all of the outstanding shares of BOLC for approximately $7,781 in cash.

        The following table summarizes the fair value of the assets and liabilities acquired during 2011:

 
  Fidelity Bank
March 23, 2011
  Bank of
Las Colinas
October 26, 2011
 

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 36,665   $ 10,561  

Investment securities

    4,256      

Non-marketable securities

    147     128  

Loans

    108,055     40,354  

Bank premises and equipment

    6,687     306  

Other real estate owned

    720      

Intangible assets

    1,079     498  

Goodwill

    7,752     987  

Other assets

    921     966  
           

Total assets acquired

  $ 166,282   $ 53,800  
           
           

Deposits

  $ 138,657   $ 45,780  

Junior subordinated debentures

    3,093      

Other liabilities

    672     239  
           

Total liabilities assumed

  $ 142,422   $ 46,019  
           
           

Net assets acquired

  $ 23,860   $ 7,781  
           
           

        As a result of the Fidelity Bank acquisition, the Company recorded the loan portfolio at a discount of approximately $1,913 based upon its fair value. The accretable discount is being accreted into income using the interest method over the life of the loans which have estimated remaining lives ranging from 3.6 to 4 years. The net effect on net income before taxes as of December 31, 2011 was

F-88


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

23. Mergers and Acquisitions (Continued)

approximately $415 and is included in interest income in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.

        As a result of the Bank of Las Colinas acquisition, the Company recorded the loan portfolio at a discount of approximately $592 based upon its fair value. The accretable discount is being accreted into income using the interest method over the life of the loans which have estimated remaining lives ranging from 2.48 to 3.57 years. No accretion was recorded as of December 31, 2011.

        As of their respective acquisition dates, the fair value of loans, not subject to the requirements of FASB ASC 310-30, acquired in the 2011 business combinations noted above was approximately $145,796. The gross contractual amounts receivable was approximately $164,707, of which management estimates the Company will not realize interest income of approximately $4,251 due to anticipated loan prepayments.

        The Company incurred expenses related to the acquisitions of approximately $394 during the year ended December 31, 2011, which are included in legal and other professional fees in the consolidated statements of income.

        Pro forma net income for the year ended December 31, 2011 would have been $927 and revenues would have been $19,540 had the acquisitions occurred as of January 1, 2011. The operations of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas were merged into Veritex Community Bank as of the date of acquisition. Separate revenue and earnings of the former Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas are not available subsequent to the business combination.

        The acquisitions of Fidelity Bank and Bank of Las Colinas are consistent with the Company's plan to enhance its competitive position in the Dallas, Texas metropolitan area. These acquisitions provided for expansion in the Greater Dallas, Texas markets specifically in North Dallas, Plano, and Irving areas. Fidelity Bank operated three branches and Bank of Las Colinas operated one, which all became branches of the Company's banking subsidiary. The Company believes it is well-positioned to deliver superior customer service, achieve stronger financial performance and enhance shareholder value through the synergies of combined operations, all of which contributed to the resulting goodwill associated with the transactions.

24. Subsequent Events

        The Company has evaluated subsequent events through July 22, 2014, which was the date the consolidated financial statements were available to be issued and noted no subsequent events requiring financial statement recognition or disclosure, except as noted below.

        During January 2014, the Company engaged in a private offering of up to 500,000 shares of its common stock, par value $0.01 per share, at $10.85 per share. As of February 21, 2014, the Company had issued 490,773 shares of the offering generating total proceeds of approximately $5,325 and had offering costs of approximately $60. The Company intends to use the proceeds from the offering to support the growth of the Company.

        On January 2, 2014, the Company originated a loan in the approximate amount of $500 to the Company's Employee Stock Ownership Plan for the purpose of purchasing 46,082 shares of the Company's common stock.

F-89


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

25. Parent Company Only Financial Statements

        The following balance sheets, statements of income and statements of cash flows for Veritex Holdings, Inc. should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto.


Balance Sheets

 
  December 31,  
 
  2013   2012  

Assets

             

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 2,018   $ 1,166  

Investment in subsidiaries

    72,579     63,104  

Other assets

    300     689  
           

Total assets

  $ 74,897   $ 64,959  
           
           

Liabilities and Stockholders' Equity

             

Other liabilities

  $ 586   $ 6  

Other borrowings

    8,072     3,093  
           

Total liabilities

    8,658     3,099  
           

Stockholders' equity

             

Preferred stock

    8,000     8,000  

Common stock

    58     57  

Additional paid-in capital

    55,303     53,750  

Retained earnings (accumulated deficit)

    2,922     (426 )

Less: Treasury stock

    (70 )    

Less: Accumulated other comprehensive income

    26     479  
           

Total stockholders' equity

    66,239     61,860  
           

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity

  $ 74,897   $ 64,959  
           
           

F-90


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

25. Parent Company Only Financial Statements (Continued)


Statements of Income

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Interest income:

                   

Other

  $ 2   $ 8   $ 5  

Interest expense:

                   

Interest on borrowings

    63     73     162  
               

Net interest expense

    (61 )   (65 )   (157 )

Noninterest expense:

                   

Salaries and employee benefits

    162         15  

Professional fees

    76     50     432  

Other

            14  
               

Total noninterest expense

    238     50     461  
               

Loss before income tax benefit and equity in undistributed

                   

Income of subsidiaries

    (299 )   (115 )   (618 )

Income tax benefit

    (102 )   (504 )   (210 )
               

(Loss) Income before equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries

    (197 )   389     (408 )

Equity in undistributed income of subsidiaries

    3,605     1,090     517  
               

Net income

  $ 3,408   $ 1,479   $ 109  
               
               

F-91


Table of Contents


VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements (Continued)

(Dollars in thousands, except for per share amounts)

25. Parent Company Only Financial Statements (Continued)


Statements of Cash Flows

 
  Years Ended December 31,  
 
  2013   2012   2011  

Cash flows from operating activities:

                   

Net income

  $ 3,408   $ 1,479   $ 109  

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by

                   

(used in) operating activities:

                   

Equity in undistributed net income of Bank

    (3,605 )   (1,090 )   (517 )

Decrease (increase) in other assets

    389     (428 )   (30 )

Increase (decrease) in other liabilities

    580     (26 )   30  
               

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

    772     (65 )   (408 )
               

Cash flows from investing activities:

                   

Capital investment in subsidiaries

    (6,000 )   (1,000 )   (6,700 )

Acquisition of Fidelity Resource Company

            (16,615 )
               

Net cash used in investing activities

    (6,000 )   (1,000 )   (23,315 )
               

Cash flows from financing activities:

                   

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock Series C

            8,000  

Redemption of preferred stock Series A and B

            (3,150 )

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net

    1,210     1,398     12,776  

Purchase of common stock held in treasury

    (70 )        

Dividends paid on preferred stock

    (60 )   (100 )   (76 )

Issuance of subordinated notes

    5,000          
               

Net cash provided by financing activities

    6,080     1,298     17,550  
               

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    852     233     (6,173 )

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

    1,166     933     7,106  
               

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

  $ 2,018   $ 1,166   $ 933  
               
               

F-92


Table of Contents


            Shares

LOGO

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

Common Stock



PROSPECTUS



Sandler O'Neill + Partners, L.P.   Stephens Inc.

Sterne Agee

The date of this prospectus is              , 2014

        Until                  , 2014, all dealers that effect transactions in our common stock, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus. This is in addition to the dealers' obligation to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters and with respect to any unsold allotments or subscriptions.


Table of Contents


PART II
Information Not Required In Prospectus

ITEM 13.    Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

        The following table sets forth the costs and expenses, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, payable by Veritex Holdings, Inc., or the Registrant, in connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities being registered. All amounts shown are estimates, except the SEC registration fee, the FINRA filing fee and the stock exchange listing fees. All fees below are payable by the Registrant.

SEC registration fee

  $          *

FINRA filing fee

      *

NASDAQ listing fee

      *

Printing and engraving costs

      *

Legal fees and expenses

      *

Accountants' fees and expenses

      *

Transfer agent fees

      *

Miscellaneous

      *
       

Total

  $          *
       
       

*
To be furnished by amendment

ITEM 14.    Indemnification of Directors and Officers

        At the time of this offering, the Registrant's amended and restated certificate of formation will provide that the Registrant's directors and officers will be indemnified by the Registrant to the fullest extent permitted by the Texas Business Organizations Code and applicable federal law and regulation against all expenses incurred in connection with their service for or on behalf of the Registrant.

        At the time of this offering, the Registrant's amended and restated certificate of formation will provide that the personal liability of the directors and officers of the Registrant for monetary damages will be eliminated to the fullest extent permitted by the Texas Business Organizations Code and applicable federal laws and regulations.

        At the time of this offering, the Registrant will have entered into indemnification agreements with the members of its board of directors and officers, each an "indemnitee." Each indemnification agreement requires the Registrant to indemnify each indemnitee as described above. The Registrant will also, among other things, advance costs and expenses subject to the condition that an indemnitee will reimburse the indemnitor for all amounts paid if a final judicial determination is made that the indemnitee is not entitled to be so indemnified under applicable law.

        The Registrant also maintains directors' and officers' liability insurance.

        The form of Underwriting Agreement to be filed as Exhibit 1.1 hereto obligates the underwriters to indemnify our directors, officers and controlling persons under limited circumstances against certain liabilities under the Securities Act.

II-1


Table of Contents


ITEM 15.    Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

        In the three years preceding the filing of this registration statement, the Registrant has issued the following securities:

        The issuances of securities described in the preceding paragraphs were made in reliance upon the exemption from registration under Section 4(2) or its successor 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or Rule 701 promulgated under Section 3(b) of the Securities Act as transactions by an issuer not involving any public offering or pursuant to benefit plans and contracts relating to compensation. All of the foregoing securities are deemed restricted securities for purposes of the Securities Act. The recipients of securities in the transactions exempt under Section 4(2) or its successor 4(a)(2) of the Securities Act represented their intention to acquire the securities for investment purposes only and not with a view to or for sale in connection with any distribution thereof and appropriate legends were affixed to the stock certificates and instruments issued in such transactions.

ITEM 16.    Exhibits and Financial Statements Schedules

        See the Exhibit Index on the page immediately following the signature page for a list of exhibits filed as part of this Registration Statement on Form S-1, which Exhibit Index is incorporated herein by reference.

        All schedules are omitted because the required information is either not present, not present in material amounts or is presented within the consolidated financial statements included in the prospectus that is part of this Registration Statement.

ITEM 17.    Undertakings

        The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes to provide to the underwriters at the closing specified in the underwriting agreement, certificates in such denominations and registered in such names as required by the underwriters to permit prompt delivery to each purchaser.

II-2


Table of Contents

        Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act may be permitted to the directors, officers and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the SEC such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

        The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes that:

II-3


Table of Contents


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement on Form S-1 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Dallas, State of Texas, on August 29, 2014.

  Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

By:

 

/s/ C. MALCOLM HOLLAND, III


      Name:   C. Malcolm Holland, III

      Title:   Chairman and Chief Executive Officer


POWER OF ATTORNEY

        KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints C. Malcolm Holland, III, and William C. Murphy as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments (including post-effective amendments and registration statements filed pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act) to this Registration Statement and to file the same, with all relevant exhibits and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in connection therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes as he might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or any of them, or their or his substitutes or substitute, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act, this Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated below.

Name
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 
/s/ C. MALCOLM HOLLAND, III

C. Malcolm Holland, III
  Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
  August 29, 2014

/s/ WILLIAM C. MURPHY

William C. Murphy

 

Vice Chairman

 

August 29, 2014

/s/ NOREEN E. SKELLY

Noreen E. Skelly

 

Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial and Principal Accounting Officer)

 

August 29, 2014

  

Pat S. Bolin

 

Director

 

                 , 2014

II-4


Table of Contents

Name
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 
/s/ BLAKE BOZMAN

Blake Bozman
  Director   August 29, 2014

/s/ MARK GRIEGE

Mark Griege

 

Director

 

August 29, 2014

  

Michael D. Ilagan

 

Director

 

                 , 2014

/s/ MICHAEL KOWALSKI

Michael Kowalski

 

Director

 

August 29, 2014

/s/ JOHN SUGHRUE

John Sughrue

 

Director

 

August 29, 2014

/s/ RAY W. WASHBURNE

Ray W. Washburne

 

Director

 

August 29, 2014

II-5


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

Exhibit
Number
  Description
  1.1 * Form of Underwriting Agreement

 

3.1

*

Form of Second Amended and Restated Certificate of Formation of Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

3.2

*

Form of Third Amended and Restated Bylaws of Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

4.1

*

Specimen Common Stock Certificate

 

4.2

 

Form of Common Stock Purchase Warrant

 

4.3

 

Statement of Designations of Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C of Veritex Holdings, Inc., as filed with the Office of the Secretary of State of Texas on August 22, 2011.

 

4.4

 

The other instruments defining rights of holders of the long-term debt securities of the Registrant and its subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to section (b)(4)(iii)(A) of Item 601 of Regulation S-K. The Registrant hereby agrees to furnish copies of these instruments to the SEC upon request.

 

5.1

*

Opinion of Bracewell & Giuliani LLP

 

10.1

 

Retention and Nonsolicitation Agreement dated March 23, 2011 by and among Veritex Community Bank, Veritex Holdings, Inc. and William C. Murphy.

 

10.2

 

Change in Control Agreement dated June 18, 2012 by and among Veritex Community Bank, Veritex Holdings, Inc. and Noreen E. Skelly.

 

10.3

 

Veritex Holdings, Inc. First Amended 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (including form of stock option agreement and stock award agreement)

 

10.4

*

Form of Omnibus Incentive Plan for Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

10.5

 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan Adoption Agreement dated December 31, 2012.

 

10.6

 

Securities Purchase Agreement dated August 25, 2011, by and between Veritex Holdings, Inc. and the U.S. Secretary of the Treasury.

 

10.7

 

Form of Subordinated Promissory Note, dated December 23, 2013 issued by Veritex Holdings, Inc. (including associated terms and conditions)

 

10.8

*

Form of Director and Officer Indemnification Agreement

 

10.9

*

Form of Registration Rights Agreement among Veritex Holdings, Inc., SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P. and WCM Parkway, Ltd.

 

10.10

*

Form of Director Nomination Agreement among Veritex Holdings, Inc. and SunTx Veritex Holdings, L.P.

 

23.1

 

Consent of Grant Thornton LLP

 

23.2

 

Consent of JonesBaggett LLP

 

23.3

*

Consent of Bracewell & Giuliani LLP (contained in its opinion filed as Exhibit 5.1 hereto)

 

24.1

 

Powers of Attorney (included on signature page to the Registration Statement)

*
To be filed by amendment.

II-6




EXHIBIT 4.2

 

WARRANT TO PURCHASE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK
OF
VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.
A TEXAS CORPORATION

 

Warrant No. [·]

 

THESE SECURITIES ARE NOT SAVINGS OR DEPOSIT ACCOUNTS, AND THEY ARE NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION (“FDIC”), BANK INSURANCE FUND OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY. THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE TEXAS DEPARTMENT OF BANKING, FDIC OR THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION, AND HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED.

 

1.  Basic Terms.  For value received, the registered owner is entitled, subject to the terms and conditions of this Warrant to purchase the number of shares of the Common Stock, par value $0.01 (“Common Stock”), of Veritex Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation (the “Company”), from the Company at the exercise price shown below, on delivery of this Warrant to the Company with the exercise form duly executed and payment of the purchase price (in cash, by check payable to the order of the Company, or through forfeit of shares to be acquired pursuant to this Warrant) for each share purchased.

 

Registered Owner:

[·]

 

 

Number of Shares:

[·]

 

 

Exercise Price:

Eleven Dollars ($11.00) per share.

 

 

Expiration Date:

The warrants were granted on December 23, 2013 and will expire at 5:00 p.m., Dallas, Texas time, on December 31, 2023, unless terminated sooner under Paragraph 12 of this Warrant.

 

2.  Company’s Covenants as to Common Stock.  Shares deliverable on the exercise of this Warrant shall, at delivery, be fully paid and nonassessable, free from taxes, liens and charges with respect to their purchase.  The Company shall take any necessary steps to assure that the par value per share of the Common Stock is at all times equal to or less than the then current Warrant purchase price per share of the Common Stock issuable pursuant to this Warrant.  The Company shall at all times reserve and hold available, free from preemptive rights, sufficient shares of Common Stock to satisfy all conversion and purchase rights of outstanding convertible securities, options and warrants.

 

3.  Method of Exercise; Fractional Shares; Cashless Exercise.  The purchase rights represented by this Warrant are exercisable at the option of the registered owner in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time, provided, however, that purchase rights are not exercisable with respect to a fraction of a share of Common Stock.  In lieu of issuing a fraction of a share remaining after exercise of this Warrant as to all full shares covered hereby, the

 



 

Company shall pay therefor cash equal to the value of such fractional share, as determined by the Board of Directors of the Company.  In case of the exercise of this Warrant for less than all the shares purchasable, the Company shall cancel the Warrant and execute and deliver a new Warrant of like tenor and date for the balance of the shares purchasable.  In the event that the registered owner elects to exercise this Warrant, in whole or in part, then on receipt of written notice of exercise, the Company may, in its sole discretion and in lieu of receiving payment in whole or in part of the purchase price in cash or check, elect to withhold from the total number of shares to be issued to the registered owner pursuant to the exercising of the Warrant the number of shares of Common Stock the fair market value of which is equal to the aggregate exercise price of the shares of Common Stock issuable upon the exercise of the Warrant.  The fair market value of the shares of Common Stock shall be reasonably determined by the Board of Directors of the Company in good faith and consistent with the  current practices and methodology used by the Company as part of its annual valuation of non-marketable minority shares of Common Stock.

 

4.  Adjustment of Shares Purchasable.  The number of shares purchasable hereunder and the purchase price per share are subject to adjustment from time to time as specified in this Warrant.

 

5.  Limited Rights of Owner.  This Warrant does not entitle the owner to any voting rights or other rights as a shareholder of the Company, or to any other rights whatsoever except the rights herein expressed.  No dividends are payable or will accrue on this Warrant or the shares purchasable hereunder until, and except to the extent that, this Warrant is exercised.

 

6.  Exchange for Other Denominations.  The Warrant is exchangeable, on its surrender by the registered owner to the Company, for new Warrants of like tenor and date representing in the aggregate the right to purchase the number of shares purchasable hereunder in denominations designated by the registered owner at the time of surrender.

 

7.  Transferability.  This Warrant may be assigned or otherwise transferred to an “accredited investor” as defined in Rule 501(a) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”) subject to and in compliance with the Securities Act and other applicable Federal and state laws; provided that the registered owner requests and receives prior written consent from the Company, such consent will not be unreasonably withheld.  Except as provided in this Section 7, this Warrant shall not be assignable or otherwise transferable except by will or by the laws of descent and distribution.

 

8.  Recognition of Registered Owner.  Prior to due presentment for registration of transfer of this Warrant, the Company may treat the registered owner as the person exclusively entitled to receive notices and otherwise to exercise rights hereunder.

 

9.  Effect of Stock Split, Etc.  If the Company, by stock dividend, split, reverse split, reclassification of shares, or otherwise, changes as a whole the outstanding Common Stock into a different number or class of shares, then: (1) the number and class of shares so changed shall, for the purposes of this Warrant, replace the shares outstanding immediately prior to the change; and (2) the Warrant purchase price in effect, and the number of shares purchasable under this Warrant, immediately prior to the date upon which the change becomes effective, shall be

 

2



 

proportionately adjusted (the price to the nearest cent).  Irrespective of any adjustment or change in the Warrant purchase price or the number of shares purchasable under this or any other Warrant of like tenor, the Warrants theretofore issued may continue to express the Warrant purchase price per share and the number of shares purchasable as the Warrant purchase price per share and the number of shares purchasable were expressed in the Warrants when initially issued.  The determination of the Board of Directors of the Company as to the appropriate adjustments, if any, shall be final and binding on all holders of Warrants.

 

10.  Effect of Corporate Transactions.  If the Company consolidates with or merges into another corporation, the registered owner shall thereafter be entitled on exercise to purchase with respect to each share of Common Stock purchasable hereunder immediately before the consolidation or merger becomes effective, the securities or other consideration to which a holder of one share of Common Stock is entitled in the consolidation or merger without any change in or payment in addition to the Warrant purchase price in effect immediately prior to the merger or consolidation.  The Company shall take any necessary steps in connection with a consolidation or merger to assure that all provisions of this Warrant shall thereafter be applicable, as nearly as reasonably may be, to any securities or other consideration so deliverable on exercise of this Warrant.  A sale or lease of all or substantially all the assets of the Company for a consideration (apart from the assumption of obligations) consisting primarily of securities is a consolidation or merger for the foregoing purposes.

 

11.  Notice of Adjustment.  On the happening of an event requiring an adjustment of the Warrant purchase price per share or the number of shares purchasable hereunder, the Company shall forthwith give written notice to the registered owner stating the adjusted Warrant purchase price and the adjusted number and kind of securities or other property purchasable hereunder resulting from the event and setting forth in reasonable detail the method of calculation and the facts upon which the calculation is based.  The Board of Directors of the Company, acting in good faith, shall determine the calculation, and such determination shall be final and binding.

 

12.  Notice and Effect of Dissolution, Etc.  In case a voluntary or involuntary dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the Company (other than in connection with a consolidation or merger covered by Paragraph 10 above) is at any time proposed, the Company shall give at least 30 days’ prior written notice to the registered owner.  Such notice shall contain:  (1) the date on which the transaction is to take place; (2) the record date (which shall be at least 30 days after the giving of the notice) as of which holders of Common Stock will be entitled to receive distributions as a result of the transaction; (3) a brief description of the transaction; (4) a brief description of the distributions to be made to holders of Common Stock as a result of the transaction; and (5) an estimate of the fair value of the distributions.  On the date of the transaction, if it actually occurs, this Warrant and all rights hereunder shall terminate.

 

13.  Method of Giving Notice; Extent Required.  Notices shall be given by first class mail, postage prepaid, addressed to the registered owner at the address of the owner appearing in the records of the Company.  No notice to Warrant holders is required except as specified in Paragraphs 11 and 12.

 

3



 

14.  Compliance With Laws and Regulations.  The Warrant, the transfer of the Warrant and the purchase of shares hereunder, and the obligation of the Company to sell and deliver shares pursuant to exercise of the Warrant, shall be subject to all applicable federal and state laws, rules and regulations and to such approvals by any governmental or regulatory agency as may be required.  The Company (or any successor) shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificates for shares of Common Stock (or other securities) prior to the completion of any registration or qualification of such shares under any federal or state law or issuance of any ruling, order, approval or regulation of any government body which the Company shall, in its sole discretion, determine to be necessary or advisable.  The registered owner agrees to enter into such written representations, warranties and agreements as the Company may request in order to comply with applicable laws, regulations or other requirements.  All sales, transfers and other disposition of this Warrant or securities acquired upon exercise of the Warrant must be made in conformity with the applicable federal and state laws, rules and regulations, and the Company shall not be required to recognize any sale, transfer or other disposition not made in conformity with such laws, rules or regulations.  Compliance with the provisions of such laws, rules and regulations is the responsibility of transferor.

 

15.  Restricted Securities.  The securities represented by this certificate have not been registered under the Securities Act or any state securities laws (collectively, the “Acts”).  The securities have been acquired for investment and may not be sold or offered for sale in the absence of an effective registration statement for the securities under the Acts or an opinion of counsel satisfactory to the Company that such registration is not required.

 

16.  Governing Law.  This Warrant shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Texas and, to the extent applicable, federal law.

 

[Signature Page Follows]

 

4



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this Warrant to be duly executed by a duly authorized officer.

 

Dated effective as of December 23, 2013.

 

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name: C. Malcolm Holland

 

Title: Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

 

 

ATTEST:

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

[Signature Page to Warrant]

 

5



 

ASSIGNMENT FORM

(To be executed by the registered owner
to transfer the Warrant)

 

For value received the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers to [·] (Name), [·] (Address) this Warrant, together with all right, title and interest therein, and irrevocably appoints [·] attorney (with full power of substitution) to transfer this Warrant on the books of the Company.

 

Date:

 

 

 

 

 

(Please sign exactly as name appears on Warrant)

 

 

 

 

 

Social Security or Taxpayer ID No.:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

In the presence of:

 

Signature guaranteed by:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6



 

FORM OF NOTICE OF EXERCISE

(To be executed by the registered owner to purchase
Common Stock pursuant to the Warrant)

 

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

 

The undersigned pursuant to the provisions set forth in the attached Warrant, hereby:  (1) irrevocably subscribes for [·] shares of your Common Stock pursuant to this Warrant and encloses the payment of $[·] therefor; (2) requests that a certificate for the shares be issued in the name(s) indicated below and delivered to the indicated address(es) below; and (3) requests, if such number of shares is not all of the shares purchasable hereunder, that a new Warrant of like tenor for the balance of the remaining shares purchasable hereunder be issued in the name of the undersigned and delivered to the undersigned at the address below.

 

Date: [·], 20[·]

By:

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

(Please sign exactly as name appears on Warrant)

 

 

 

Address:

 

 

 

 

 

Social Security or Taxpayer ID No.:

 

 

 

Name(s) in which shares are
to be registered and address(es)
Please Print or Type

 

 

 

 

Name

 

Name

 

 

 

 

 

 

Street Address or Post Office Box

 

Street Address or Post Office Box

 

 

 

 

 

 

City                    State                    Zip Code

 

City                    State                    Zip Code

 

 

 

 

 

 

Social Security Number/Taxpayer

 

Social Security Number/Taxpayer

Identification Number (If Applicable)

 

Identification Number (If Applicable)

 

If certificates are to be issued in more than one name, please specify.  If certificates are to be issued in the name of one person for the benefit of another, please indicate whether registration should be as trustee or custodian for such other person, and provide full details.

 




Exhibit 4.3

 

 

 

FILED

 

 

In the Office of the

 

 

Secretary of State of Texas

 

 

 

 

 

AUG 22 2011

 

 

 

 

 

Corporations Section

 

STATEMENT OF DESIGNATIONS

OF

SENIOR NON-CUMULATIVE PERPETUAL PREFERRED STOCK, SERIES C

OF

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

Veritex Holdings, Inc., a corporation organized and existing under the laws of the State of Texas (the “Issuer”), in accordance with the provisions of Sections 21.155 of the Business Organizations Code thereof, does hereby certify:

 

The board of directors of the Issuer (the “Board of Directors”) or an applicable committee of the Board of Directors, in accordance with the certificate of formation and bylaws of the Issuer and applicable law, adopted the following resolution on August 16, 2011 creating a series of 8,000 shares of Preferred Stock of the Issuer designated as “Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C”.

 

RESOLVED, that pursuant to the provisions of the certificate of formation and the bylaws of the Issuer and applicable law, a series of Preferred Stock, par value $0.01 per share, of the Issuer be and hereby is created, and that the designation and number of shares of such series, and the voting and other powers, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other rights, and the qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof, of the shares of such series, are as follows:

 

Part 1.  Designation and Number of Shares. There is hereby created out of the authorized and unissued shares of preferred stock of the Issuer a series of preferred stock designated as the “Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock , Series C”  (the “Designated Preferred Stock”).  The authorized number of shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall be 8,000.

 

Part 2.  Standard Provisions. The Standard Provisions contained in Schedule A attached hereto are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety and shall be deemed to be a part of this Statement of Designations to the same extent as if such provisions had been set forth in full herein.

 

Part 3. Definitions. The following terms are used in this Statement of Designations (including the Standard Provisions in Schedule A hereto) as defined below:

 

(a)                                 Common Stock”  means the common stock, par value $0.01 per share, of the Issuer.

 

(b)                                 Definitive Agreement”  means that certain Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Issuer and Treasury, dated as of the Signing Date.

 

(c)                                  Junior Stock”  means the Common Stock and any other class or series of stock of the Issuer the terms of which expressly provide that it ranks junior to Designated

 



 

Preferred Stock as to dividend and redemption rights and/or as to rights on liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Issuer.

 

(d)                                 Liquidation Amount”  means $1,000 per share of Designated Preferred Stock.

 

(e)                                  Minimum Amount”  means (i) the amount equal to twenty-five percent (25%) of the aggregate Liquidation Amount of Designated Preferred Stock issued on the Original Issue Date or (ii) all of the outstanding Designated Preferred Stock, if the aggregate liquidation preference of the outstanding Designated Preferred Stock is less than the amount set forth in the preceding clause (i).

 

(f)                                   Parity Stock”  means any class or series of stock of the Issuer (other than Designated Preferred Stock) the terms of which do not expressly provide that such class or series will rank senior or junior to Designated Preferred Stock as to dividend rights and/or as to rights on liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Issuer (in each case without regard to whether dividends accrue cumulatively or non-cumulatively).  Without limiting the foregoing, Parity Stock shall include the Issuer’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A and Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B.

 

(g)                                  Signing Date”  means August 25, 2011.

 

(h)                                 Treasury”  means the United States Department of the Treasury and any successor in interest thereto.

 

Part 4. Certain Voting Matters. Holders of shares of Designated Preferred Stock will be entitled to one vote for each such share on any matter on which holders of Designated Preferred Stock are entitled to vote, including any action by written consent.

 

[Remainder of Page Intentionally Left Blank]

 

2



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Veritex Holdings, Inc. has caused this Statement of Designations to be signed by C. Malcolm Holland, III, its President and Chief Executive Officer, this 19th day of August, 2011.

 

 

 

 

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ C. Malcolm Holland

 

 

Name: C. Malcolm Holland, III

 

 

Title: President and Chief Executive Officer

 



 

Schedule A

 

STANDARD PROVISIONS

 

Section 1. General Matters. Each share of Designated Preferred Stock shall be identical in all respects to every other share of Designated Preferred Stock. The Designated Preferred Stock shall be perpetual, subject to the provisions of Section 5 of these Standard Provisions that form a part of the Statement of Designations. The Designated Preferred Stock shall rank equally with Parity Stock and shall rank senior to Junior Stock with respect to the payment of dividends and the distribution of assets in the event of any dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the Issuer, as set forth below.

 

Section 2. Standard Definitions. As used herein with respect to Designated Preferred Stock:

 

(a)                                 Acquiror,”  in any Holding Company Transaction, means the surviving or resulting entity or its ultimate parent in the case of a merger or consolidation or the transferee in the case of a sale, lease or other transfer in one transaction or a series of related transactions of all or substantially all of the consolidated assets of the Issuer and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole.

 

(b)                            Affiliate”  means, with respect to any person, any person directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under common control with, such other person. For purposes of this definition, “control” (including, with correlative meanings, the terms “controlled by” and “under common control with”) when used with respect to any person, means the possession, directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, of the power to cause the direction of management and/or policies of such person, whether through the ownership of voting securities by contract or otherwise.

 

(c)                             Applicable Dividend Rate”  has the meaning set forth in Section 3(a).

 

(d)                            Appropriate Federal Banking Agency”  means the “appropriate Federal banking agency” with respect to the Issuer as defined in Section 3(q) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. Section 1813(q)), or any successor provision.

 

(e)                             Bank Holding Cornpany”  means a company registered as such with the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System pursuant to 12 U.S.C. §1842 and the regulations of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System thereunder.

 

(f)                              Baseline” means the “Initial Small Business Lending Baseline” set forth on the Initial Supplemental Report (as defined in the Definitive Agreement), subject to adjustment pursuant to Section 3(a).

 

(g)                             Business Combination” means a merger, consolidation, statutory share exchange or similar transaction that requires the approval of the Issuer’s stockholders.

 

A-1



 

(h)                            Business Day” means any day except Saturday, Sunday and any day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or the District of Columbia generally are authorized or required by law or other governmental actions to close.

 

(i)                                Bylaws” means the bylaws of the Issuer, as they may be amended from time to time.

 

(j)                               Call Report” has the meaning set forth in the Definitive Agreement.

 

(k)                            Statement of Designations” means the Statement of Designations or comparable instrument relating to the Designated Preferred Stock, of which these Standard Provisions form a part, as it may be amended from time to time.

 

(l)                                Charge-Offs” means the net amount of loans charged off by the Issuer or, if the Issuer is a Bank Holding Company or a Savings and Loan Holding Company, by the IDI Subsidiary(ies) during quarters that begin on or after the Signing Date, determined as follows:

 

(i)                                     if the Issuer or the applicable IDI Subsidiary is a bank, by subtracting (A) the aggregate dollar amount of recoveries reflected on line RIAD4605 of its Call Reports for such quarters from (B) the aggregate dollar amount, of charge-offs reflected on line RIAD4635 of its Call Reports for such quarters (without duplication as a result of such dollar amounts being reported on a year-to-date basis); or

 

(ii)                                  if the Issuer or the applicable IDI Subsidiary is a thrift, by subtracting (A) the sum of the aggregate dollar amount of recoveries reflected on line VA140 of its Call Reports for such quarters and the aggregate dollar amount of adjustments reflected on line VA150 of its Call Reports for such quarters from (B) the aggregate dollar amount of charge-offs reflected on line VA160 of its Call Reports for such quarters.

 

(m)                        Charter” means the Issuer’s certificate or articles of incorporation, articles of association, or similar organizational document.

 

(n)                            CPP Lending Incentive Fee” has the meaning set forth in Section 3(e).

 

(o)                            Current Period” has the meaning set forth in Section 3(a)(i)(2).

 

(p)                            Dividend Payment Date” means January 1, April 1, July 1, and October 1 of each year.

 

(q)                            Dividend Period” means the period from and including any Dividend Payment Date to, but excluding, the next Dividend Payment Date; provided, however, the initial Dividend Period shall be the period from and including the Original Issue Date to, but excluding, the next Dividend Payment Date (the “Initial Dividend Period”).

 

(r)                               Dividend Record Date” has the meaning set forth in Section 3(b).

 

A-2



 

(s)                              Dividend Reference Period” has the meaning set forth in Section 3(a)(i)(2).

 

(t)                               GAAP” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States.

 

(u)                            Holding Company Preferred Stock” has the meaning set forth in Section 7(c)(v).

 

(v)                            Holding Company Transaction” means the occurrence of (a) any transaction (including, without limitation, any acquisition, merger or consolidation) the result of which is that a “person” or “group” within the meaning of Section 13(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (i) becomes the direct or indirect ultimate “beneficial owner,” as defined in Rule 13d-3 under that Act, of common equity of the Issuer representing more than 50% of the voting power of the outstanding Common Stock or (ii) is otherwise required to consolidate the Issuer for purposes of generally accepted accounting principles in the United States, or (b) any consolidation or merger of the Issuer or similar transaction or any sale, lease or other transfer in one transaction or a series of related transactions of all or substantially all of the consolidated assets of the Issuer and its subsidiaries, taken as a whole, to any Person other than one of the Issuer’s subsidiaries; provided that, in the case of either clause (a) or (b), the Issuer or the Acquiror is or becomes a Bank Holding Company or Savings and Loan Holding Company.

 

(w)                          IDI Subsidiary” means any Issuer Subsidiary that is an insured depository institution.

 

(x)                            Increase in QSBL” means:

 

(i)                           with respect to the first (1st) Dividend Period, the difference obtained by subtracting (A) the Baseline from (B) QSBL set forth in the Initial Supplemental Report (as defined in the Definitive Agreement); and

 

(ii)                        with respect to each subsequent Dividend Period, the difference obtained by subtracting (A) the Baseline from (B) QSBL for the Dividend Reference Period for the Current Period.

 

(y)                                 Initial Dividend Period” has the meaning set forth in the definition of “Dividend Period”.

 

(z)                                  Issuer Subsidiary” means any subsidiary of the Issuer.

 

(aa)                          Liquidation Preference” has the meaning set forth in Section 4(a).

 

(bb)                          Non-Qualifying Portion Percentage” means, with respect to any particular Dividend Period, the percentage obtained by subtracting the Qualifying Portion Percentage from one (1).

 

A-3



 

(cc)                            Original Issue Date” means the date on which shares of Designated Preferred Stock are first issued.

 

(dd)                          Percentage Change in QSBL” has the meaning set forth in Section 3(a)(ii).

 

(ee)                            Person” means a legal person, including any individual, corporation, estate, partnership, joint venture, association, joint-stock company, limited liability company or trust.

 

(ff)                              Preferred Director” has the meaning set forth in Section 7(c).

 

(gg)                            Preferred Stock” means any and all series of preferred stock of the Issuer, including the Designated Preferred Stock.

 

(hh)                          Previously Acquired Preferred Shares” has the meaning set forth in the Definitive Agreement.

 

(ii)                                  Private Capital” means, if the Issuer is Matching Private Investment Supported (as defined in the Definitive Agreement), the equity capital received by the Issuer or the applicable Affiliate of the Issuer from one or more non-governmental investors in accordance with Section 1.3(m) of the Definitive Agreement.

 

(jj)                                Publicly-traded” means a company that (i) has a class of securities that is traded on a national securities exchange and (ii) is required to file periodic reports with either the Securities and Exchange Commission or its primary federal bank regulator.

 

(kk)                          Qualified Small Business Lending” or “QSBL” means, with respect to any particular Dividend Period, the “Quarter-End Adjusted Qualified Small Business Lending” for such Dividend Period set forth in the applicable Supplemental Report.

 

(II)                              Qualifying Portion Percentage” means, with respect to any particular Dividend Period, the percentage obtained by dividing (i) the Increase in QSBL for such Dividend Period by (ii) the aggregate Liquidation Amount of then-outstanding Designated Preferred Stock.

 

(mm)                  Savings and Loan Holding Company” means a company registered as such with the Office of Thrift Supervision pursuant to 12 U.S.C. §1467a(b) and the regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision promulgated thereunder.

 

(nn)                          Share Dilution Amount” means the increase in the number of diluted shares outstanding (determined in accordance with GAAP applied on a consistent basis, and as measured from the date of the Issuer’s most recent consolidated financial statements prior to the Signing Date) resulting from the grant, vesting or exercise of equity-based compensation to employees and equitably adjusted for any stock split, stock dividend, reverse stock split, reclassification or similar transaction.

 

(oo)                          Signing Date Tier 1 Capital Amount” means $30,348,000.00.

 

A-4



 

(pp)                          Standard Provisions” mean these Standard Provisions that form a part of the Statement of Designations relating to the Designated Preferred Stock.

 

(qq)                          Supplemental Report” means a Supplemental Report delivered by the Issuer to Treasury pursuant to the Definitive Agreement.

 

(rr)                                Tier 1 Dividend Threshold” means, as of any particular date, the result of the following formula:

 

( ( A + B – C ) * 0.9 ) – D

 

where:

 

A = Signing Date Tier 1 Capital Amount;

 

B = the aggregate Liquidation Amount of the Designated Preferred Stock issued to Treasury;

 

C = the aggregate amount of Charge-Offs since the Signing Date; and

 

D = (i) beginning on the first day of the eleventh (11th) Dividend Period, the amount equal to ten percent (10%) of the aggregate Liquidation Amount of the Designated Preferred Stock issued to Treasury as of the Effective Date (without regard to any redemptions of Designated Preferred Stock that may have occurred thereafter) for every one percent (1%) of positive Percentage Change in Qualified Small Business Lending between the ninth (9th) Dividend Period and the Baseline; and

 

(ii) zero (0) at all other times.

 

(ss)                              Voting Parity Stock” means, with regard to any matter as to which the holders of Designated Preferred Stock are entitled to vote as specified in Section 7(d) of these Standard Provisions that form a part of the Statement of Designations, any and all series of Parity Stock upon which like voting rights have been conferred and are exercisable with respect to such matter.

 

Section 3. Dividends.

 

(a)                       Rate.

 

(i)                                     The “Applicable Dividend Rate” shall be determined as follows:

 

(1)                                 With respect to the Initial Dividend Period, the Applicable Dividend Rate shall be one percent (1.0000000%).

 

A-5



 

(2)                                 With respect to each of the second (2nd) through the tenth (10th) Dividend Periods, inclusive (in each case, the “Current Period”), the Applicable Dividend Rate shall be:

 

(A)                               (x) the applicable rate set forth in column “A” of the table in Section 3(a)(iii), based on the Percentage Change in QSBL between the Dividend Period that was two Dividend Periods prior to the Current Period (the “Dividend Reference Period”) and the Baseline, multiplied by (y) the Qualifying Portion Percentage; plus

 

(B)                               (x) five percent (5%) multiplied by (y) the Non-Qualifying Portion Percentage.

 

In each such case, the Applicable Dividend Rate shall be determined at the time the Issuer delivers a complete and accurate Supplemental Report to Treasury with respect to the Dividend Reference Period.

 

(3)                                 With respect to the eleventh (11th) through the eighteenth (18th) Dividend Periods, inclusive, and that portion of the nineteenth (19th) Dividend Period prior to, but not including, the four and one half (41/2) year anniversary of the Original Issue Date, the Applicable Dividend Rate shall be:

 

(A)                               (x) the applicable rate set forth in column “B” of the table in Section 3(a)(iii), based on the Percentage Change in QSBL between the ninth (9th) Dividend Period and the Baseline, multiplied by (y) the Qualifying Portion Percentage, calculated as of the last day of the ninth (9th) Dividend Period; plus

 

(B)                               (x) five percent (5%) multiplied by (y) the Non-Qualifying Portion Percentage, calculated as of the last day of the ninth (9th) Dividend Period.

 

In such case, the Applicable Dividend Rate shall be determined at the time the Issuer delivers a complete and accurate Supplemental Report to Treasury with respect to the ninth (9th) Dividend Period.

 

(4)                                 With respect to (A) that portion of the nineteenth (19th) Dividend Period beginning on the four and one half (41/2) year anniversary of the Original Issue Date and (B) all Dividend Periods thereafter, the Applicable Dividend Rate shall be nine percent (9%).

 

(5)                                 Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, if the Issuer fails to submit a Supplemental Report that is due during any of the second (2nd) through tenth (10th)

 

A-6



 

Dividend Periods on or before the sixtieth (60th) day of such Dividend Period, the Issuer’s QSBL for the Dividend Period that would have been covered by such Supplemental Report shall be zero (0) for purposes hereof.

 

(6)                                 Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, but subject to Section 3(a)(i)(5) above, if the Issuer fails to submit the Supplemental Report that is due during the tenth (10th) Dividend Period, the Issuer’s QSBL shall be zero (0) for purposes of calculating the Applicable Dividend Rate pursuant to Section 3(a)(i)(3) and (4).  The Applicable Dividend Rate shall be re-determined effective as of the first day of the calendar quarter following the date such failure is remedied, provided it is remedied prior to the four and one half (41/2) anniversary of the Original Issue Date.

 

(7)                                 Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, if the Issuer fails to submit any of the certificates required by Sections 3.1(d)(ii) or 3.1(d)(iii) of the Definitive Agreement when and as required thereby, the Issuer’s QSBL shall be zero (0) for purposes of calculating the Applicable Dividend Rate pursuant to Section 3(a)(i)(2) or (3) above until such failure is remedied.

 

(ii)                                  The “Percentage Change in Qualified Lending” between any given Dividend Period and the Baseline shall be the result of the following formula, expressed as a percentage:

 

 

( QSBL for the Dividend Period – Baseline )

x 100

Baseline

 

A-7


 

(iii)                               The following table shall be used for determining the Applicable Dividend Rate:

 

 

 

 

The Applicable Dividend Rate shall be:

 

 

If the Percentage Change in
Qualified Lending is:

 

Column “A”
(each of the
2nd — 10th
Dividend Periods)

 

Column “B”
(11th — 18th, and
the first part of the
19th, Dividend
Periods)

 

 

0% or less

 

5

%

7

%

 

More than 0%, but less than 2.5%

 

5

%

5

%

 

2.5% or more, but less than 5%

 

4

%

4

%

 

5% or more, but less than 7.5%

 

3

%

3

%

 

7.5% or more, but less than 10%

 

2

%

2

%

 

10% or more

 

1

%

1

%

 

(iv)                         If the Issuer consummates a Business Combination, a purchase of loans or a purchase of participations in loans and the Designated Preferred Stock remains outstanding thereafter, then the Baseline shall thereafter be the “Quarter-End Adjusted Small Business Lending Baseline” set forth on the Quarterly Supplemental Report (as defined in the Definitive Agreement).

 

(b)                                 Payment. Holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall be entitled to receive, on each share of Designated Preferred Stock if, as and when declared by the Board of Directors or any duly authorized committee of the Board of Directors, but only out of assets legally available therefor, non-cumulative cash dividends with respect to:

 

(i)                                     each Dividend Period (other than the Initial Dividend Period) at a rate equal to one-fourth (1/4) of the Applicable Dividend Rate with respect to each Dividend Period on the Liquidation Amount per share of Designated Preferred Stock, and no more, payable quarterly in arrears on each Dividend Payment Date; and

 

(ii)                                  the Initial Dividend Period, on the first such Dividend Payment Date to occur at least twenty (20) calendar days after the Original Issue Date, an amount equal to (A) the Applicable Dividend Rate with respect to the Initial Dividend Period multiplied by (B) the number of days from the Original Issue Date to the last day of the Initial Dividend Period (inclusive) divided by 360.

 

In the event that any Dividend Payment Date would otherwise fall on a day that is not a Business Day, the dividend payment due on that date will be postponed to the next day that is a Business Day and no additional dividends will accrue as a result of that postponement. For avoidance of doubt, “payable quarterly in arrears” means that, with respect to any particular Dividend Period, dividends begin accruing on the first day of such Dividend Period and are payable on the first day of the next Dividend Period.

 

The amount of dividends payable on Designated Preferred Stock on any date prior to the end of a Dividend Period, and for the initial Dividend Period, shall be computed on the

 

A-8



 

basis of a 360-day year consisting of four 90-day quarters, and actual days elapsed over a 90-day quarter.

 

Dividends that are payable on Designated Preferred Stock on any Dividend Payment Date will be payable to holders of record of Designated Preferred Stock as they appear on the stock register of the Issuer on the applicable record date, which shall be the 15th calendar day immediately preceding such Dividend Payment Date or such other record date fixed by the Board of Directors or any duly authorized committee of the Board of Directors that is not more than 60 nor less than 10 days prior to such Dividend Payment Date (each, a “Dividend Record Date”). Any such day that is a Dividend Record Date shall be a Dividend Record Date whether or not such day is a Business Day.

 

Holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall not be entitled to any dividends, whether payable in cash, securities or other property, other than dividends (if any) declared and payable on Designated Preferred Stock as specified in this Section 3 (subject to the other provisions of the Statement of Designations).

 

(c)                                  Non-Cumulative. Dividends on shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall be non-cumulative. If the Board of Directors or any duly authorized committee of the Board of Directors does not declare a dividend on the Designated Preferred Stock in respect of any Dividend Period:

 

(i)                           the holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall have no right to receive any dividend for such Dividend Period, and the Issuer shall have no obligation to pay a dividend for such Dividend Period, whether or not dividends are declared for any subsequent Dividend Period with respect to the Designated Preferred Stock; and

 

(ii)                        the Issuer shall, within five (5) calendar days, deliver to the holders of the Designated Preferred Stock a written notice executed by the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer of the Issuer stating the Board of Directors’ rationale for not declaring dividends.

 

(d)                                 Priority of Dividends; Restrictions on Dividends.

 

(i)                                     Subject to Sections 3(d)(ii), (iii) and (v) and any restrictions imposed by the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency or, if applicable, the Issuer’s state bank supervisor (as defined in Section 3(r) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. § 1813(q)), so long as any share of Designated Preferred Stock remains outstanding, the Issuer may declare and pay dividends on the Common Stock, any other shares of Junior Stock, or Parity Stock, in each case only if (A) after giving effect to such dividend the Issuer’s Tier 1 capital would be at least equal to the Tier I Dividend Threshold, and (B) full dividends on all outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock for the most recently completed Dividend Period have been or are contemporaneously declared and paid.

 

(ii)                                  If a dividend is not declared and paid in full on the Designated Preferred Stock in respect of any Dividend Period, then from the last day of such Dividend Period until the last day of the third (3rd) Dividend Period immediately

 

A-9



 

following it, no dividend or distribution shall be declared or paid on the Common Stock or any other shares of Junior Stock (other than dividends payable solely in shares of Common Stock) or Parity Stock; provided, however, that in any such Dividend Period in which a dividend is declared and paid on the Designated Preferred Stock, dividends may be paid on Parity Stock to the extent necessary to avoid any material breach of a covenant by which the Issuer is bound.

 

(iii)                               When dividends have not been declared and paid in full for an aggregate of four (4) Dividend Periods or more, and during such time the Issuer was not subject to a regulatory determination that prohibits the declaration and payment of dividends, the Issuer shall, within five (5) calendar days of each missed payment, deliver to the holders of the Designated Preferred Stock a certificate executed by at least a majority of the Board of Directors stating that the Board of Directors used its best efforts to declare and pay such dividends in a manner consistent with (A) safe and sound banking practices and (B) the directors’ fiduciary obligations.

 

(iv)                              Subject to the foregoing and Section 3(e) below and not otherwise, such dividends (payable in cash, securities or other property) as may be determined by the Board of Directors or any duly authorized committee of the Board of Directors may be declared and paid on any securities, including Common Stock and other Junior Stock, from time to time out of any funds legally available for such payment, and holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall not be entitled to participate in any such dividends.

 

(v)                                 If the Issuer is not Publicly-Traded, then after the tenth (10th) anniversary of the Signing Date, so long as any share of Designated Preferred Stock remains outstanding, no dividend or distribution shall be declared or paid on the Common Stock or any other shares of Junior Stock (other than dividends payable solely in shares of Common Stock) or Parity Stock.

 

(e)                                  Special Lending Incentive Fee Related to CPP. If Treasury held Previously Acquired Preferred Shares immediately prior to the Original Issue Date and the Issuer did not apply to Treasury to redeem such Previously Acquired Preferred Shares prior to December 16, 2010, and if the Issuer’s Supplemental Report with respect to the ninth (9th) Dividend Period reflects an amount of Qualified Small Business Lending that is less than or equal to the Baseline (or if the Issuer fails to timely file a Supplemental Report with respect to the ninth (9th) Dividend Period), then beginning on July 1, 2014 and on all Dividend Payment Dates thereafter ending on April 1, 2016, the Issuer shall pay to the Holders of Designated Preferred Stock, on each share of Designated Preferred Stock, but only out of assets legally available therefor, a fee equal to 0.5% of the Liquidation Amount per share of Designated Preferred Stock (“CPP Lending Incentive Fee”). All references in Section 3(d) to “dividends” on the Designated Preferred Stock shall be deemed to include the CPP Lending Incentive Fee.

 

Section 4. Liquidation Rights.

 

(a)                                 Voluntary or Involuntary Liquidation. In the event of any liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the affairs of the Issuer, whether voluntary or involuntary, holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall be entitled to receive for each share of Designated Preferred

 

A-10



 

Stock, out of the assets of the Issuer or proceeds thereof (whether capital or surplus) available for distribution to stockholders of the Issuer, subject to the rights of any creditors of the Issuer, before any distribution of such assets or proceeds is made to or set aside for the holders of Common Stock and any other stock of the Issuer ranking junior to Designated Preferred Stock as to such distribution, payment in full in an amount equal to the sum of (i) the Liquidation Amount per share and (ii) the amount of any accrued and unpaid dividends on each such share (such amounts collectively, the “Liquidation Preference”).

 

(b)                            Partial Payment. If in any distribution described in Section 4(a) above the assets of the Issuer or proceeds thereof are not sufficient to pay in full the amounts payable with respect to all outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock and the corresponding amounts payable with respect of any other stock of the Issuer ranking equally with Designated Preferred Stock as to such distribution, holders of Designated Preferred Stock and the holders of such other stock shall share ratably in any such distribution in proportion to the full respective distributions to which they are entitled.

 

(c)                             Residual Distributions. If the Liquidation Preference has been paid in full to all holders of Designated Preferred Stock and the corresponding amounts payable with respect of any other stock of the Issuer ranking equally with Designated Preferred Stock as to such distribution has been paid in full, the holders of other stock of the Issuer shall be entitled to receive all remaining assets of the Issuer (or proceeds thereof) according to their respective rights and preferences.

 

(d)                            Merger, Consolidation and Sale of Assets Is Not Liquidation. For purposes of this Section 4, the merger or consolidation of the Issuer with any other corporation or other entity, including a merger or consolidation in which the holders of Designated Preferred Stock receive cash, securities or other property for their shares, or the sale, lease or exchange (for cash, securities or other property) of all or substantially all of the assets of the Issuer, shall not constitute a liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Issuer.

 

Section 5. Redemption.

 

(a)                            Optional Redemption.

 

(i)                                     Subject to the other provisions of this Section 5:

 

(1)         The Issuer, at its option, subject to the approval of the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency, may redeem, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time, out of funds legally available therefor, the shares of Designated Preferred Stock at the time outstanding; and

 

(2)         If, after the Signing Date, there is a change in law that modifies the terms of Treasury’s investment in the Designated Preferred Stock or the terms of Treasury’s Small Business Lending Fund program in a materially adverse respect for the Issuer, the Issuer may, after consultation with the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency,

 

A-11



 

redeem all of the shares of Designated Preferred Stock at the time outstanding.

 

(ii)                                  The per-share redemption price for shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall be equal to the sum of:

 

(1)         the Liquidation Amount per share,

 

(2)         the per-share amount of any unpaid dividends for the then current Dividend Period at the Applicable Dividend Rate to, but excluding, the date fixed for redemption (regardless of whether any dividends are actually declared for that Dividend Period; and

 

(3)         the pro rata amount of CPP Lending Incentive Fees for the current Dividend Period.

 

The redemption price for any shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall be payable on the redemption date to the holder of such shares against surrender of the certificate(s) evidencing such shares to the Issuer or its agent. Any declared but unpaid dividends for the then current Dividend Period payable on a redemption date that occurs subsequent to the Dividend Record Date for a Dividend Period shall not be paid to the holder entitled to receive the redemption price on the redemption date, but rather shall be paid to the holder of record of the redeemed shares on such Dividend Record Date relating to the Dividend Payment Date as provided in Section 3 above.

 

(b)                            No Sinking Fund. The Designated Preferred Stock will not be subject to any mandatory redemption, sinking fund or other similar provisions. Holders of Designated Preferred Stock will have no right to require redemption or repurchase of any shares of Designated Preferred Stock.

 

(c)                             Notice of Redemption. Notice of every redemption of shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall be given by first class mail, postage prepaid, addressed to the holders of record of the shares to be redeemed at their respective last addresses appearing on the books of the Issuer, Such mailing shall be at least 30 days and not more than 60 days before the date fixed for redemption. Any notice mailed as provided in this Subsection shall be conclusively presumed to have been duly given, whether or not the holder receives such notice, but failure duly to give such notice by mail, or any defect in such notice or in the mailing thereof, to any holder of shares of Designated Preferred Stock designated for redemption shall not affect the validity of the proceedings for the redemption of any other shares of Designated Preferred Stock. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if shares of Designated Preferred Stock are issued in book-entry form through The Depository Trust Company or any other similar facility, notice of redemption may be given to the holders of Designated Preferred Stock at such time and in any manner permitted by such facility. Each notice of redemption given to a holder shall state: (1) the redemption date; (2) the number of shares of Designated Preferred Stock to be redeemed and, if less than all the shares held by such holder are to be redeemed, the number of such shares

 

A-12



 

to be redeemed from such holder; (3) the redemption price; and (4) the place or places where certificates for such shares are to be surrendered for payment of the redemption price.

 

(d)                            Partial Redemption. In case of any redemption of part of the shares of Designated Preferred Stock at the time outstanding, the shares to be redeemed shall be selected either pro rata or in such other manner as the Board of Directors or a duly authorized committee thereof may determine to be fair and equitable, but in any event the shares to be redeemed shall not be less than the Minimum Amount. Subject to the provisions hereof, the Board of Directors or a duly authorized committee thereof shall have full power and authority to prescribe the terms and conditions upon which shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall be redeemed from time to time, subject to the approval of the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency. If fewer than all the shares represented by any certificate are redeemed, a new certificate shall be issued representing the unredeemed shares without charge to the holder thereof.

 

(e)                             Effectiveness of Redemption. If notice of redemption has been duly given and if on or before the redemption date specified in the notice all funds necessary for the redemption have been deposited by the Issuer, in trust for the pro rata benefit of the holders of the shares called for redemption, with a bank or trust company doing business in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, and having a capital and surplus of at least $500 million and selected by the Board of Directors, so as to be and continue to be available solely therefor, then, notwithstanding that any certificate for any share so called for redemption has not been surrendered for cancellation, on and after the redemption date dividends shall cease to accrue on all shares so called for redemption, all shares so called for redemption shall no longer be deemed outstanding and all rights with respect to such shares shall forthwith on such redemption date cease and terminate, except only the right of the holders thereof to receive the amount payable on such redemption from such bank or trust company, without interest. Any funds unclaimed at the end of three years from the redemption date shall, to the extent permitted by law, be released to the Issuer, after which time the holders of the shares so called for redemption shall look only to the Issuer for payment of the redemption price of such shares.

 

(f)                              Status of Redeemed Shares. Shares of Designated Preferred Stock that are redeemed, repurchased or otherwise acquired by the Issuer shall revert to authorized but unissued shares of Preferred Stock (provided that any such cancelled shares of Designated Preferred Stock may be reissued only as shares of any series of Preferred Stock other than Designated Preferred Stock).

 

Section 6. Conversion. Holders of Designated Preferred Stock shares shall have no right to exchange or convert such shares into any other securities.

 

Section 7. Voting Rights.

 

(a)                            General. The holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall not have any voting lights except as set forth below or as otherwise from time to time required by law.

 

(b)                            Board Observation Rights. Whenever, at any time or times, dividends on the shares of Designated Preferred Stock have not been declared and paid in full within five (5) Business Days after each Dividend Payment Date for an aggregate of five (5) Dividend Periods

 

A-13



 

or more, whether or not consecutive, the Issuer shall invite a representative selected by the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock, voting as a single class, to attend all meetings of its Board of Directors in a nonvoting observer capacity and, in this respect, shall give such representative copies of all notices, minutes, consents, and other materials that it provides to its directors in connection with such meetings; provided, that the holders of the Designated Preferred Stock shall not be obligated to select such a representative, nor shall such representative, if selected, be obligated to attend any meeting to which he/she is invited. The rights of the holders of the Designated Preferred Stock set forth in this Section 7(b) shall terminate when full dividends have been timely paid on the Designated Preferred Stock for at least four consecutive Dividend Periods, subject to revesting in the event of each and every subsequent default of the character above mentioned.

 

(c)                             Preferred Stock Directors. Whenever, at any time or times, (i) dividends on the shares of Designated Preferred Stock have not been declared and paid in full within five (5) Business Days after each Dividend Payment Date for an aggregate of six (6) Dividend Periods or more, whether or not consecutive, and (ii) the aggregate liquidation preference of the then-outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock is greater than or equal to $25,000,000, the authorized number of directors of the Issuer shall automatically be increased by two and the holders of the Designated Preferred Stock, voting as a single class, shall have the right, but not the obligation, to elect two directors (hereinafter the “Preferred Directors” and each a “Preferred Director”) to fill such newly created directorships at the Issuer’s next annual meeting of stockholders (or, if the next annual meeting is not yet scheduled or is scheduled to occur more than thirty days later, the President of the Company shall promptly call a special meeting for that purpose) and at each subsequent annual meeting of stockholders until full dividends have been timely paid on the Designated Preferred Stock for at least four consecutive Dividend Periods, at which time such right shall terminate with respect to the Designated Preferred Stock, except as herein or by law expressly provided, subject to revesting in the event of each and every subsequent default of the character above mentioned; provided that it shall be a qualification for election for any Preferred Director that the election of such Preferred Director shall not cause the Issuer to violate any corporate governance requirements of any securities exchange or other trading facility on which securities of the Issuer may then be listed or traded that listed or traded companies must have a majority of independent directors. Upon any termination of the right of the holders of shares of Designated Preferred Stock to vote for directors as provided above, the Preferred Directors shall cease to be qualified as directors, the term of office of all Preferred Directors then in office shall terminate immediately and the authorized number of directors shall be reduced by the number of Preferred Directors elected pursuant hereto. Any Preferred Director may be removed at any time, with or without cause, and any vacancy created thereby may be filled, only by the affirmative vote of the holders a majority of the shares of Designated Preferred Stock at the time outstanding voting separately as a class. If the office of any Preferred Director becomes vacant for any reason other than removal from office as aforesaid, the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock, voting as a single class, may choose a successor who shall hold office for the unexpired term in respect of which such vacancy occurred.

 

(d)                            Class Voting Rights as to Particular Matters. So long as any shares of Designated Preferred Stock are outstanding, in addition to any other vote or consent of stockholders required by law or by the Charter, the written consent of (x) Treasury if Treasury

 

A-14



 

holds any shares of Designated Preferred Stock, or (y) the holders of a majority of the outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock, voting as a single class, if Treasury does not hold any shares of Designated Preferred Stock, shall be necessary for effecting or validating:

 

(i)                           Authorization of Senior Stock. Any amendment or alteration of the Statement of Designations for the Designated Preferred Stock or the Charter to authorize or create or increase the authorized amount of, or any issuance of, any shares of, or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for shares of, any class or series of capital stock of the Issuer ranking senior to Designated Preferred Stock with respect to either or both the payment of dividends and/or the distribution of assets on any liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Issuer;

 

(ii)                        Amendment of Designated Preferred Stock. Any amendment, alteration or repeal of any provision of the Statement of Designations for the Designated Preferred Stock or the Charter (including, unless no vote on such merger or consolidation is required by Section 7(d)(iii) below, any amendment, alteration or repeal by means of a merger, consolidation or otherwise) so as to adversely affect the rights, preferences, privileges or voting powers of the Designated Preferred Stock;

 

(iii)                     Share Exchanges, Reclassifications, Mergers and Consolidations. Subject to Section 7(d)(v) below, any consummation of a binding share exchange or reclassification involving the Designated Preferred Stock, or of a merger or consolidation of the Issuer with another corporation or other entity, unless in each case (x) the shares of Designated Preferred Stock remain outstanding or, in the case of any such merger or consolidation with respect to which the Issuer is not the surviving or resulting entity, are converted into or exchanged for preference securities of the surviving or resulting entity or its ultimate parent, and (y) such shares remaining outstanding or such preference securities, as the case may be, have such rights, preferences, privileges and voting powers, and limitations and restrictions thereof that are the same as the rights, preferences, privileges and voting powers, and limitations and restrictions thereof, of Designated Preferred Stock immediately prior to such consummation, taken as a whole; provided, that in all cases, the obligations of the Issuer are assumed (by operation of law or by express written assumption) by the resulting entity or its ultimate parent;

 

(iv)                    Certain Asset Sales. Any sale of all, substantially all, or any material portion of, the assets of the Company, if the Designated Preferred Stock will not be redeemed in full contemporaneously with the consummation of such sale; and

 

(v)                       Holding Company Transactions. Any consummation of a Holding Company Transaction, unless as a result of the Holding Company Transaction each share of Designated Preferred Stock shall be converted into or exchanged for one share with an equal liquidation preference of preference securities of the Issuer or the Acquiror (the “Holding Company Preferred Stock”). Any such Holding Company Preferred Stock shall entitle holders thereof to dividends from the date of issuance of such Holding Company Preferred Stock on terms that are equivalent to the terms set forth herein, and shall have such other rights, preferences, privileges and voting powers, and limitations and restrictions thereof that are the same as the rights, preferences, privileges and voting

 

A-15



 

powers, and limitations and restrictions thereof, of Designated Preferred Stock immediately prior to such conversion or exchange, taken as a whole;

 

provided, however, that for all purposes of this Section 7(d), any increase in the amount of the authorized Preferred Stock, including any increase in the authorized amount of Designated Preferred Stock necessary to satisfy preemptive or similar rights granted by the Issuer to other persons prior to the Signing Date, or the creation and issuance, or an increase in the authorized or issued amount, whether pursuant to preemptive or similar rights or otherwise, of any other series of Preferred Stock, or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for any other series of Preferred Stock, ranking equally with and/or junior to Designated Preferred Stock with respect to the payment of dividends (whether such dividends are cumulative or non-cumulative) and the distribution of assets upon liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Issuer will not be deemed to adversely affect the rights, preferences, privileges or voting powers, and shall not require the affirmative vote or consent of, the holders of outstanding shares of the Designated Preferred Stock.

 

(e)                             Changes after Provision for Redemption. No vote or consent of the holders of Designated Preferred Stock shall be required pursuant to Section 7(d) above if, at or prior to the time when any such vote or consent would otherwise be required pursuant to such Section, all outstanding shares of the Designated Preferred Stock shall have been redeemed, or shall have been called for redemption upon proper notice and sufficient funds shall have been deposited in trust for such redemption, in each case pursuant to Section 5 above.

 

(f)                              Procedures for Voting and Consents. The rules and procedures for calling and conducting any meeting of the holders of Designated Preferred Stock (including, without limitation, the fixing of a record date in connection therewith), the solicitation and use of proxies at such a meeting, the obtaining of written consents and any other aspect or matter with regard to such a meeting or such consents shall be governed by any rules of the Board of Directors or any duly authorized committee of the Board of Directors, in its discretion, may adopt from time to time, which rules and procedures shall conform to the requirements of the Charter, the Bylaws, and applicable law and the rules of any national securities exchange or other trading facility on which Designated Preferred Stock is listed or traded at the time.

 

Section 8. Restriction on Redemptions and Repurchases.

 

(a)                            Subject to Sections 8(b) and (c), so long as any share of Designated Preferred Stock remains outstanding, the Issuer may repurchase or redeem any shares of Capital Stock (as defined below), in each case only if (i) after giving effect to such dividend, repurchase or redemption, the Issuer’s Tier 1 capital would be at least equal to the Tier 1 Dividend Threshold and (ii) dividends on all outstanding shares of Designated Preferred Stock for the most recently completed Dividend Period have been or are contemporaneously declared and paid (or have been declared and a sum sufficient for the payment thereof has been set aside for the benefit of the holders of shares of Designated Preferred Stock on the applicable record date).

 

(b)                            If a dividend is not declared and paid on the Designated Preferred Stock in respect of any Dividend Period, then from the last day of such Dividend Period until the last day of the third (3rd) Dividend Period immediately following it, neither the Issuer nor any Issuer

 

A-16



 

Subsidiary shall, redeem, purchase or acquire any shares of Common Stock, Junior Stock, Parity Stock or other capital stock or other equity securities of any kind of the Issuer or any Issuer Subsidiary, or any trust preferred securities issued by the Issuer or any Affiliate of the Issuer (“Capital Stock”), (other than (i) redemptions, purchases, repurchases or other acquisitions of the Designated Preferred Stock and (ii) repurchases of Junior Stock or Common Stock in connection with the administration of any employee benefit plan in the ordinary course of business (including purchases to offset any Share Dilution Amount pursuant to a publicly announced repurchase plan) and consistent with past practice; provided that any purchases to offset the Share Dilution Amount shall in no event exceed the Share Dilution Amount, (iii) the acquisition by the Issuer or any of the Issuer Subsidiaries of record ownership in Junior Stock or Parity Stock for the beneficial ownership of any other persons (other than the Issuer or any other Issuer Subsidiary), including as trustees or custodians, (iv) the exchange or conversion of Junior Stock for or into other Junior Stock or of Parity Stock or trust preferred securities for or into other Parity Stock (with the same or lesser aggregate liquidation amount) or Junior Stock, in each case set forth in this clause (iv), solely to the extent required pursuant to binding contractual agreements entered into prior to the Signing Date or any subsequent agreement for the accelerated exercise, settlement or exchange thereof for Common Stock, (v) redemptions of securities held by the Issuer or any wholly-owned Issuer Subsidiary or (vi) redemptions, purchases or other acquisitions of capital stock or other equity securities of any kind of any Issuer Subsidiary required pursuant to binding contractual agreements entered into prior to (x) if Treasury held Previously Acquired Preferred Shares immediately prior to the Original Issue Date, the original issue date of such Previously Acquired Preferred Shares, or (y) otherwise, the Signing Date).

 

(c)                             If the Issuer is not Publicly-Traded, then after the tenth (10th) anniversary of the Signing Date, so long as any share of Designated Preferred Stock remains outstanding, no Common Stock, Junior Stock or Parity Stock shall be, directly or indirectly, purchased, redeemed or otherwise acquired for consideration by the Issuer or any of its subsidiaries.

 

Section 9. No Preemptive Rights. No share of Designated Preferred Stock shall have any rights of preemption whatsoever as to any securities of the Issuer, or any warrants, rights or options issued or granted with respect thereto, regardless of how such securities, or such warrants, rights or options, may be designated, issued or granted.

 

Section 10. References to Line Items of Supplemental Reports. If Treasury modifies the form of Supplemental Report, pursuant to its rights under the Definitive Agreement, and any such modification includes a change to the caption or number of any line item on the Supplemental Report, then any reference herein to such line item shall thereafter be a reference to such re-captioned or re-numbered line item.

 

Section 11. Record Holders. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, the Issuer and the transfer agent for Designated Preferred Stock may deem and treat the record holder of any share of Designated Preferred Stock as the true and lawful owner thereof for all purposes, and neither the Issuer nor such transfer agent shall be affected by any notice to the contrary.

 

A-17



 

Section 12. Notices. All notices or communications in respect of Designated Preferred Stock shall be sufficiently given if given in writing and delivered in person or by first class mail, postage prepaid, or if given in such other manner as may be permitted in this Statement of Designations, in the Charter or Bylaws or by applicable law. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if shares of Designated Preferred Stock are issued in book-entry form through The Depository Trust Company or any similar facility, such notices may be given to the holders of Designated Preferred Stock in any manner permitted by such facility.

 

Section 13. Replacement Certificates. The Issuer shall replace any mutilated certificate at the holder’s expense upon surrender of that certificate to the Issuer. The Issuer shall replace certificates that become destroyed, stolen or lost at the holder’s expense upon delivery to the Issuer of reasonably satisfactory evidence that the certificate has been destroyed, stolen or lost, together with any indemnity that may be reasonably required by the Issuer.

 

Section 14. Other Rights. The shares of Designated Preferred Stock shall not have any rights, preferences, privileges or voting powers or relative, participating, optional or other special rights, or qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, other than as set forth herein or in the Charter or as provided by applicable law.

 

A-18




Exhibit 10.1

 

Retention and Nonsolicitation Agreement

 

This Retention and Nonsolicitation Agreement (“Agreement”) is made and entered into as of March 23, 2011 (the “Effective Date”), by and between Veritex Community Bank (“Bank”), Veritex Holdings, Inc. (“Veritex”) and William C. Murphy (“Employee”).

 

W i t n e s s e t h:

 

Whereas, it is the intent of the parties hereto, consistent with the provisions subject to and set forth hereinafter, that Employee will be a director, officer and employee of the Bank and a director of Veritex and the parties would not enter into such relationship except for the following covenants and agreements;

 

Now, Therefore, in consideration of the premises and mutual covenants and agreements herein contained, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, Bank and Employee agree as follows:

 

1.                                      Employment. Commencing on March 23, 2011 and ending on March 31, 2015 (“Term”), the Bank agrees to employ Employee and, subject to approval, Employee agrees to act as Director and Vice Chairman of the Board of the Bank and Veritex. Employee hereby accepts such employment on the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement.

 

2.                                      Position and Responsibilities. During the Term, Employee shall have such duties, functions, responsibilities and authority customarily appertaining to the positions set forth above. During the Term, Employee shall devote sufficient business time and efforts to the performance of his duties hereunder. Employee’s duties include assisting in marketing the Bank’s services and products and assisting in the planning and strategizing of the Bank’s development. It is, however, understood and agreed that the preceding sentence shall not prohibit Employee from spending a reasonable amount of time managing his personal investments and discharging his civic responsibilities as long as such activities do not interfere with the discharge of his duties hereunder.

 

3.                                      Compensation. During the Term, the Bank shall pay Employee for all services and agreements of Employee pursuant to this Agreement, an annual base salary of $185,000.00 per year with merit increases, bonus and other incentives, if any, in accordance with the Bank’s salary administration program based upon performance, which shall be payable in accordance with the Bank’s customary payroll practices with respect to time and manner of payment.

 

1



 

4.                                      Benefits. In addition to the compensation described in Paragraph 3. hereof, Employee shall be entitled to the following benefits:

 

a.                                      During the Term, the Bank shall provide Employee such benefits as the Bank makes available to the Bank’s other employees, including participation in Veritex’s and/or the Bank’s 401(k) Plan, health insurance and retirement plans.

 

b.                                      During the Term, the Bank shall reimburse Employee for expenses related to business entertainment expenses and dues for Preston Trail Golf Club and Dallas Country Club.

 

c.                                       Upon receipt of regulatory approval, reasonably satisfactory to Bank and Employee, Employee and Veritex Holdings, Inc. will enter into the Stock Option Agreement pursuant to the Veritex Holdings, Inc. 2010 Equity Incentive Plan, a form of which Agreement is attached hereto as Exhibit A.

 

d.                                      Employee shall be entitled to receive not less than thirty (30) days vacation each calendar year.

 

e.                                       During the Term, Employee shall be included in the officer cellular telephone and data reimbursement plan.

 

5.                                      Involuntary Termination and/or Suspension of Employment. Employee’s employment with the Bank shall only be terminated or, as applicable, suspended upon the occurrence of any one or more of the following events:

 

a.                                      The Bank gives written notice of termination for good cause to Employee. For purposes of this Agreement, “good cause” shall mean Employee’s personal dishonesty, incompetence, breach of fiduciary duty involving personal profit, the commission of a felony, or fails to reasonably perform in accordance with this Agreement.

 

b.                                      Employee’s death;

 

c.                                       Effective as of the date of an order under which Employee is removed and/or permanently prohibited from participating in the conduct of the Bank’s affairs by an order issued under Section 8(e)(4) or (g)(1) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act; provided, however, said termination shall not affect Employee’s vested rights under this Agreement or any other agreement between the Employee and the Bank.

 

d.                                      If Employee is suspended and/or temporarily prohibited from participating in the conduct of the Bank’s affairs by a notice served under Section 8(e)(3) or (g)(1) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, the Bank’s obligations under this Agreement shall be suspended as of the date of service unless stayed by appropriate proceedings. Further, if the charges in the notice are dismissed, the Bank will (i) pay Employee all of the compensation withheld while their

 

2



 

obligations under this Agreement were suspended, and (ii) reinstate their obligations which were suspended.

 

6.                                      Voluntary Termination of Employment. Employee’s employment with the Bank may also be terminated:

 

a.                                      By the resignation of Employee at any time upon not less than sixty (60) days’ prior written notice to the Bank; provided that, upon Employee’s resignation under this Paragraph 6.a., Employee shall only be entitled to compensation for services performed by Employee up to the effective date of termination, as specified in such notice of resignation, and Employee shall not be entitled to other compensation or benefits, save and except for options, or grants that have fully vested as of the date of any such termination under this Agreement; or

 

b.                                      By the Bank’s Board of Directors, at any time; provided that upon Employee’s termination under this Paragraph 6.b., Employee shall be entitled to continue to receive all compensation and benefits due to him under Paragraphs 3. and 4. above as if his employment under this Agreement had not been terminated.

 

7.                                      Non-Solicitation. If Employee’s employment is terminated with the Bank, in accordance with Section 5. or 6.a. above, prior to the expiration of the Initial Term, Employee does hereby agree that for a period of one (1) year thereafter, the Employee shall not, directly or indirectly, for his own account or for the benefit of any other person:

 

a.                                      Directly or indirectly:

 

(1)                                 Employ or solicit for employment, any employee of the Bank; or

 

(2)                                 Solicit or induce, or in any manner attempt to solicit or induce, any client or customer of the Bank to cease being a client of the Bank.

 

b.                                      Provided, however, the provisions set forth in Paragraph 7.a. hereof shall not apply if the termination of employment occurs subsequent to:

 

(1)                                 The sale of all or substantially all of the assets of either Veritex or the Bank; or

 

(2)                                 The occurrence of a merger involving either Veritex or the Bank; or

 

(3)                                 If more than fifty percent (50%) of the issued and outstanding shares of common stock of either Veritex or the Bank is sold within any six (6) month period.

 

3



 

8.                                      Injunctive Relief. In the event of a breach by the Employee of any of the provisions of Paragraph 7., the Bank shall be entitled as a matter of right to obtain a restraining order, an injunction or other equitable relief from Employee. Such right to equitable relief shall not be exclusive but shall be in addition to all other rights and remedies to which the Bank may be entitled at law or in equity.

 

9.                                      Notices. Any notice required or desired to be given under this Agreement shall be deemed given if in writing mailed or delivered as follows:

 

If to Employee:

William C. Murphy

 

3412 Caruth Boulevard

 

Dallas, Texas 75225

 

Telephone No. 214-369-1909

 

Facsimile No. 214-369-2349

 

 

If to the Bank:

Veritex Community Bank

 

10000 North Central Expressway, Suite 1325

 

Dallas, Texas 75231

 

Attention: Malcolm Holland

 

Facsimile No. (214) 890-4089

 

 

With copy to:

D. Woodard Glenn

 

D. Woodard Glenn, P.C.

 

2626 Cole Avenue, Suite 510

 

Dallas, Texas 75204

 

Telephone No. (214) 871-9333

 

Facsimile No. (214) 871-7131

 

10.                               Entire Agreement. This Agreement contains the entire agreement of the parties regarding the employment of Employee by the Bank and supersedes any prior agreement, arrangement or understanding, whether oral or written, between the Bank and Employee concerning Employee’s employment hereunder (including the Employment Agreement).

 

11.                               Choice of Law. This Agreement shall be governed by, and enforced according to, the laws of the State of Texas. The invalidity of any provision shall be automatically reformed to the extent permitted by applicable law and shall not affect the enforceability of the remaining provisions hereof.

 

12.                               Assignment. This Agreement is for the personal service of Employee and may not be assigned by Employee but may be assigned by the Bank to any affiliate or successor-in-interest to the Bank’s business. In the event the Bank makes such an assignment, Employee shall continue to perform, on behalf of such affiliate or successor, the services required of Employee by this Agreement and the provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon, and inure to the benefit of, such successor or affiliate. This Agreement shall be binding upon and ‘inure to the benefit of Employee, his heirs, representatives and estate.

 

4



 

13.                               Modification; Termination. This Agreement may be modified only by a written agreement signed by Employee and by a duly authorized officer of the Bank. The failure to insist upon compliance with any provision hereof shall not be deemed a waiver of such provision or any other provision hereof.

 

14.                               Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in several identical counterparts, and by the parties hereto on separate counterparts, and each counterpart, when so executed and delivered, shall constitute an original instrument, and all such separate counterparts shall constitute but one and the same instrument.

 

15.                               Regulatory Compliance. Any payments made to Employee pursuant to this Agreement, or otherwise, are subject to and conditioned upon their compliance with 12 USC §1828(k) and any regulations promulgated thereunder.

 

16.                               Approval. During the terms of this Agreement, Veritex and the Bank will use their reasonable best efforts to cause Employee to be elected as a Director and as Vice Chairman of each of their Board of Directors.

 

In Witness Whereof, the parties have executed this Agreement to be effective as of March 23, 2011.

 

 

Veritex Community Bank

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ C. Malcolm Holland

 

 

(Signature)

 

 

 

 

 

C. Malcolm Holland  CEO

 

 

(Printed Name & Title)

 

 

 

 

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ C. Malcolm Holland

 

 

(Signature)

 

 

 

 

 

C. Malcolm Holland  Chairman

 

 

(Printed Name & Title)

 

 

 

 

Employee:

 

 

 

/s/ William C. Murphy

 

William C. Murphy

 

5


 

Exhibit “A”

 



 

STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT PURSUANT TO THE
VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. 2010 EQUITY INCENTIVE PLAN

 

This STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”) is made as of the         day of                         , 20      , by Veritex Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”), and                                                (“Holder”).

 

In connection with and pursuant to the Veritex Holdings, Inc. 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (the “Plan”), as amended or modified from time to time, a stock option is granted by the Board to Holder pursuant and subject to, the Plan on the following terms and conditions:

 

SECTION I
DEFINED TERMS

 

Unless otherwise defined herein or, unless the context requires a different definition, capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Plan.

 

SECTION II

OPTIONS, OPTION PRICE AND TIME OF EXERCISE

 

Effective as of                  ,                 , the Company grants to Holder, subject to the terms and provisions set forth hereinafter and in the Plan, the right and option to purchase all or any part of the number of shares set forth in Exhibit A of the presently authorized but unissued common stock (“Common Stock”), of the Company at the purchase price per share set forth as the Option Price in Exhibit A (the option hereby granted being hereinafter referred to as the “Option”).

 

The Option shall not be considered granted (as of the effective date described above) or become exercisable unless and until Holder delivers to the Company a fully executed counterpart hereof. Thereafter, the Option shall be exercisable in accordance with the Exercise Schedule set forth on Exhibit A, subject to any termination, acceleration or change in such Exercise Schedule set forth in this Agreement apart from Exhibit A.

 

Neither the Option nor any other rights granted under this Agreement may be exercised after the Expiration Date set forth on Exhibit A and, before that time, the Option may be terminated as hereinafter provided. If Holder does not purchase the full number of shares to which he is entitled in any one year, he may purchase such shares in the next year specified in the Exercise Schedule hereto, in addition to the shares which he is otherwise entitled to purchase in the next year.

 

1


 

SECTION III
EXERCISE PROCEDURE, WITHHOLDING

 

Holder shall exercise the Option by notifying the Company of the number of shares that he desires to purchase and by delivering with such notice the full payment for the purchase price of the shares being purchased. Such purchase price shall be payable in cash. The Option can be exercised subject to the Repurchase Option and the Right of First Refusal as to all Shares as set forth hereinafter.

 

The Company will, as soon as is reasonably possible, notify the Holder of the amount of withholding tax, if any, that must be paid under federal, state and local law due to exercise of the Option. The Company shall have no obligation to deliver certificates for the shares purchased until Holder pays to the Company the amount of withholding specified in the Company’s notice in cash.

 

SECTION IV
TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT/SERVICE

 

If an Optionee’s employment (or other service) with the Company terminates for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily the Options, to the extent not previously exercised, will terminate on the date of such termination of employment (or service).

 

SECTION V
ACCELERATION OF EXERCISE

 

Upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, the Option (to the extent not previously terminated or forfeited) shall become fully exercisable as to all shares subject to it.

 

SECTION VI
NON-ASSIGNABILITY AND TERM OF OPTION

 

The Option shall not be transferrable or assignable by the Holder, other than by will or the laws of descent and distribution and the Option shall be exercisable, during the Holder’s lifetime, only by him or, during periods of legal disability, by his legal representative. No Option shall be subject to execution, attachment, or similar process.

 

In no event may the Option be exercisable to any extent by anyone after the Expiration Date specified in Exhibit A. It is expressly agreed that, anything contained herein to the contrary notwithstanding, this Agreement shall not constitute, or be evidence of, any agreement or understanding, express or implied, that the Company or a Subsidiary will employ Holder for any period of time or in any position or for any particular compensation.

 

2



 

SECTION VII
COMPANY RIGHT OF REPURCHASE

 

(a)           Exercise the Right. The Company shall have the right (the “Repurchase Right”)to repurchase some or all of the Option Shares which the Optionee has elected to exercise from the Optionee, upon the occurrence of any of the events specified in Section 7(b) below (each, a “Repurchase Event”). The Repurchase Right may be exercised by the Company within 180 days following the date of such Repurchase Event (the “Repurchase Period”). The Repurchase Right shall be exercised by the Company by giving the holder written notice on or before the last day of the Repurchase Period of its intention to exercise the Repurchase Right, and, together with such notice, tendering to the holder an amount equal to the Repurchase Price of the Shares, determined as provided in Section 7(c). The Company may assign the Repurchase Right to one or more persons or legal entities. Upon exercise of the Repurchase Right in the manner provided in this Section 7(a), the Optionee shall deliver to the Company the stock certificate or certificates representing the Option Shares being repurchased, duly endorsed and free and clear of any and all liens, charges, and encumbrances.

 

If Option Shares are not purchased under the Repurchase Right, the Optionee and his or her successor in interest, if any, will hold any such shares in his or her possession subject to all the provisions of this Section 7 and Section 8 hereof.

 

(b)           Company’s Right to Exercise Repurchase Right. The Company shall have the Repurchase Right in the event that any of the following events shall occur:

 

(i)           The termination of the Optionee’s employment with the Company and its Subsidiaries for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily; or

 

(ii)          The (x) filing of a voluntary petition under any bankruptcy or insolvency law, or a petition for the appointment of a receiver or the making of an assignment for the benefit of creditors, with respect to the Optionee, or (y) the Optionee being subjected involuntarily to a petition or assignment or to an attachment or other legal or equitable interest with respect to his or her assets, which involuntary petition or assignment or attachment is not discharged within 60 days after its date, or (z) the Optionee being subject to a transfer of Option Shares by operation of law, except by reason of death.

 

(c)           Determination of Repurchase Price. For purposes of this Section 7, the Repurchase Price of the Option Shares shall be, the lesser of the Option Price or the Fair Market Value of the Option Shares as determined by the Board as of the date of the Repurchase Event. The Fair Market Value, if shares of the Common Stock are not then publicly traded, shall be determined by any reasonable method chosen by the Board including, for example, any valuation method described in Treasury Regulation Sec. 20.2031.2, or as determined pursuant to the applicable Stock Option Agreement or Stock Grant Agreement.

 

3


 

(d)         Expiration of Company’s Repurchase Right. The Repurchase Right shall remain in effect until and shall terminate upon the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

SECTION VIII
COMPANY’S RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL

 

(a)         Exercise of Right. If, at a time other than within the period specified in this Section 8(a) and without limiting any other restrictions on transfer of any Option Shares set forth in any other agreement or otherwise, the Optionee desires to transfer all or any part of the Option Shares to any person other than the Company (an “Offeror”); the Optionee shall: (i) obtain in writing an irrevocable and unconditional bona fide offer (the “Offer”) for the purchase thereof from the Offeror; and (ii) give written notice (the “Option Notice”) to the Company setting forth the Optionee’s desire to transfer such shares, which Option Notice shall be accompanied by a photocopy of the Offer and shall set forth the name and address of the Offeror and the price and terms of the Offer. Upon receipt of the Option Notice, the Company shall have an assignable option to purchase any or all of such Option Shares (the “Company Option Shares”) specified in the Option Notice, such option to be exercisable by giving, within 30 days after receipt of the Option Notice, a written counter notice to the Optionee. If the Company elects to purchase any or all of such Company Option Shares, it shall be obligated to purchase, and the Optionee shall be obligated to sell to the Company, such Company Option Shares at the price and terms indicated in the Offer within 20 days after the date of the delivery by the Company of such counter notice.

 

(b)         Sale of Option Shares to Offeror. The Optionee may, for 30 days after the expiration of the 20-day option period as set forth in Section 8(a), sell to the Offeror, pursuant to the terms of the Offer, any or all of such Company Option Shares not purchased or agreed to be purchased by the Company or its assignee. If any or all of such Company Option Shares are not sold pursuant to an Offer within the time permitted above, the unsold Company Option Shares shall remain subject to the terms of this Section 8.

 

(c)          Adjustment for Changes in Capital Structure. If there shall be any change in the Common Shares of the Company through merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization, stock dividend, stock split, combination or exchange of shares, or the like, the restrictions contained in this Section 8, shall exchange for, or by virtue of his or her ownership of Option Shares.

 

(d)         Failure to Deliver Option Shares. If the Optionee fails or refuses to deliver on a timely basis duly endorsed certificates representing Company Option Shares to be sold to the Company or its assignee pursuant to this Section 8, the Company shall have the right to deposit the purchase price for such Company Option Shares in a special account with any bank or trust company, giving notice of such deposit to the Optionee, whereupon such Company Option Shares shall be deemed to have been purchased by the Company. All such monies shall be held by the bank or trust company for the benefit of the Optionee. All monies deposited with the bank or trust company but remaining unclaimed for two years after the date of deposit shall be repaid by the bank or trust company to the Company on demand, and the Optionee shall thereafter look

 

4



 

only to the Company for payment. The Company may place a legend on any certificate for Option Shares delivered to the Optionee reflecting the restrictions on transfer provided in this Section 8.

 

(e)           Expiration of Company’s Right of First Refusal. The first refusal of rights of the Company set forth above shall remain in effect until the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

SECTION IX
RIGHTS OF HOLDER IN
STOCK

 

Neither Holder, nor his successor in interest, shall have any of the rights of a shareholder of the Company with respect to the shares for which the Option is issued until such shares are issued by the Company.

 

SECTION X
NOTICES

 

Any notice to be given hereunder shall be in writing and shall be addressed to the Company, in care of the                   , and any notice to be given to the Holder shall be addressed to the address designated below the signature appearing hereinafter, or at such other address as either party may hereafter designate in writing to the other. Any such notice shall have been deemed duly given upon three (3) days of sending such notice enclosed in a properly sealed envelope, addressed as aforesaid, registered or certified and deposited (with the proper postage and registration or certificate fee prepaid) in the United States mail.

 

SECTION XI
SUCCESSORS OR ASSIGNS OF THE COMPANY

 

The Option shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of any successor of the Company.

 

SECTION XII
MISCELLANEOUS

 

(a)                                 Designation of Beneficiary. The Holder shall have the right to appoint any individual or legal entity in writing, on Exhibit C hereto, as his beneficiary to receive any Option (to the extent not previously terminated or forfeited) under this Agreement upon the Holder’s death. Such designation under this Agreement may be revoked by the Holder at any time and a new beneficiary may be appointed by the Holder by execution and submission to the Board of a revised Exhibit C to this Agreement. In order to be effective, a designation of beneficiary must be completed by the Holder on Exhibit C and received to the Board, or its designee, prior to the date of the Holder’s death. In the absence of such designation, the Holder’s beneficiary shall be the legal representative of the Holder’s estate.

 

5


 

(b)                                 Incapacity of Holder or Beneficiary. If any person entitled to a distribution under this Agreement is deemed by the Board to be incapable of making an election hereunder or of personally receiving and giving a valid receipt for such distribution hereunder, then, unless and until an election or claim therefore shall have been made by a duly appointed guardian or other legal representative of such person, the Board may provide for such election or distribution or any part thereof to be made to any other person or institution then contributing toward or providing for the care and maintenance of such person. Any such distribution shall be a distribution for the account of such person and a complete discharge of any liability of the Board, the Company and the Plan therefore.

 

(c)                                  Incorporation of the Plan. The terms and provisions of the Plan, as the same may be amended from time to time, are hereby incorporated in this Agreement. Unless otherwise specifically stated herein, such terms and provisions shall control in the event of any inconsistency between the Plan and this Agreement.

 

(d)                                 Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS AND ALL APPLICABLE FEDERAL LAWS. THE SECURITIES ISSUED HEREUNDER SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CORPORATE SECURITIES LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS.

 

(e)                                  Gender. Reference to the masculine herein shall be deemed to include the feminine, wherever appropriate.

 

(f)                                   Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, which shall together constitute a valid and binding agreement.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Agreement has been executed by the Company and the Holder as of the date and year first written above.

 

HOLDER

 

COMPANY

 

 

 

 

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

Name

 

Its:

 

Address

 

 

 

6



 

EXHIBIT A

 

1.  Board Approval Date:

 

2.  Date of Grant:

 

3.  Holder:

 

4.  Number of Shares:

15,000 (Tranche 1) 35,000 (Tranche 2)

 

of shares of Common Stock

 

 

5.  Initial Vesting Date:

 

6.  Option Price per Share:

Ten Dollars ($10.00)

 

 

7.  Vesting Schedule:

Tranche 1:

 

·  20% of Tranche 1 Options vest at the earlier of the date that is one (1) calendar year from the Date of Grant as set forth hereinabove;

 

·  20% of Tranche 1 Options vest at the earlier of the date that is two(2) calendar year from the Date of Grant as set forth hereinabove;

 

·  20% of Tranche 1 Options vest at the earlier of the date that is three (3) calendar year from the Date of Grant as set forth hereinabove;

 

·  20% of Tranche 1 Options vest at the earlier of the date that is four (4) calendar year from the Date of Grant as set forth hereinabove;

 

·  20% of Tranche 1 Options vest at the earlier of the date that is five (5) calendar year from the Date of Grant as set forth hereinabove;

 

 

 

Tranche 2: Tranche 2 options vest as follows:

 

·  35% vest at Change of Control;

 

·  35% vest at Change of Control and Investors receive a 20% IRR or 2.5X their Original Investment;

 

·  30% vest at Change of Control and Investors receive a 30% IRR or 3.5X their Original Investment

 

 

8.  Definitions:

a. Investors

 

 

 

b. IRR

 

 

 

c. Original Investment

 

7




Exhibit 10.2

 

10000 N Central Expressway Suite 1325

Dallas, Texas 75291

(972) 674 - 4400 (972) 674 - 4399 fax

veritexbank.com

 

In connection with the employment of Noreen Skelly to become the CFO of Veritex Community Bank (“bank”) and as part of her compensation package, we agree to the following:

 

At change of control only, if the gross amount of proceeds from Noreen’s option/grant ownership does not meet a minimum of $200,000.00 then the “bank” will supplement the deficiency so that a total gross amount of $200,000.00 is achieved.

 

Agreed to and accepted this 18th day of June, 2012.

 

 

/s/ C Malcolm Holland

 

/s/ Noreen Skelly

C Malcolm Holland, CEO

 

Noreen Skelly, CFO

 




Exhibit 10.3

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

FIRST AMENDED
2010 STOCK OPTION AND EQUITY INCENTIVE PLAN

 



 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

FIRST AMENDED

2010 STOCK OPTION AND EQUITY INCENTIVE PLAN

 

SECTION I. ESTABLISHMENT AND PURPOSE.

 

The purpose of the Plan is to offer (i) selected persons an opportunity to acquire a proprietary interest in the success of the Company, or to increase such interest, by purchasing Shares of the Company’s Stock; (ii) attract and retain persons eligible to participate in the Plan; (iii) motivate Participants by means of appropriate equity-based incentives to achieve long-range goals; and (iv) provide incentive compensation opportunities that are competitive with those of similar companies thereby promote the long-term financial interest of the company and its subsidiaries. The Plan provides both for the direct award or sale of Shares and for the grant of Options to purchase Shares. Options granted under the Plan may include Nonstatutory Options as well as ISOs intended to qualify under Section 422 of the Code.

 

Capitalized terms are defined in Section 12.

 

SECTION 2. ADMINISTRATION.

 

(a)                                 Board of Directors. The Plan will be administered by the Board of Directors. The Board of Directors shall have the power, authority and discretion to: (i) designate participants; (ii) determine the type and number of Awards to be granted to Participants and the number of shares to Stock of which an award will relate; and (iii) determine the terms and conditions of any award, including but not limited to, exercise price, grant price, vesting schedule or purchase price, and any restrictions or limitations.

 

(b)                                 Authority of the Board of Directors. Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Board of Directors shall have full authority and discretion to take any actions it deems necessary or advisable for the administration of the Plan. All decisions, interpretations and other actions of the Board of Directors shall be final and binding on all Purchasers, all Optionees and all persons deriving their rights from a Purchaser or Optionee.

 

SECTION 3. ELIGIBILITY.

 

(a)                                 General Rule. Only Employees, Officers, Outside Directors and Consultants shall be eligible for the grant of Nonstatutory Options or the direct award or sale of Shares. Only Employees and Officers shall be eligible for the grant of ISOs.

 

(b)                                 Ten-Percent Stockholders. A person who owns more than 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of outstanding stock of the Company, its Parent or any of its Subsidiaries shall not be eligible for the grant of an ISO unless (i) the Exercise Price is at least 110% of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant and (ii) such ISO by its terms is not exercisable after the expiration of five years from the date of grant. For purposes of this Subsection (b), in determining stock ownership, the attribution rules of Section

 

1



 

424(d) of the Code shall be applied.

 

SECTION 4. STOCK SUBJECT TO PLAN.

 

(a)                                 Basic Limitation. The Company may make awards or grant options to purchase up to 1,000,000 shares of common stock of the Company. Shares may be issued under the Plan (subject to Subsection (b) below and Section 8). The number of Shares that are subject to Options or other rights outstanding at any time under the Plan shall not exceed the number of Shares that then remain available for issuance under the Plan. The Company, during the term of the Plan, shall at all times reserve and keep available sufficient Shares to satisfy the requirements of the Plan. Shares offered under the Plan may be authorized but unissued Shares or treasury Shares.

 

(b)                                 Additional Shares. In the event that Shares previously issued under the Plan are reacquired by the Company pursuant to a forfeiture provision, right of repurchase or right of first refusal, such Shares shall be added to the number of Shares then available for issuance under the Plan. However, the aggregate number of Shares issued upon the exercise of ISOs (including Shares reacquired by the Company) shall in no event exceed the number specified in Subsection (a) above. In the event that an outstanding Option or other right for any reason expires or is canceled, the Shares allocable to the unexercised portion of such Option or other right shall not reduce the number of Shares available for issuance under the Plan.

 

SECTION 5. TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF AWARDS OR SALES.

 

(a)                                 Stock Grant Agreement. Each grant or sale of Shares under the Plan (other than upon exercise of an Option) shall be evidenced by a Stock Grant Agreement between the Grantee and the Company. Such grant or sale shall be subject to all applicable terms and conditions of the Plan and may be subject to any other terms and conditions which are not inconsistent with the Plan and which the Board of Directors deems appropriate for inclusion in a Stock Grant Agreement. The provisions of the various Stock Grant Agreements entered into under the Plan need not be identical.

 

(b)                                 Duration of Offers and Nontransferability of Rights. Any right to acquire Shares under the Plan (other than an Option) shall automatically expire if not exercised by the Grantee within 30 days after the grant of such right was communicated to the Grantee and becomes exercisable by the Grantor. Such right shall not be transferable and shall be exercisable only by the Grantee to whom such right was granted.

 

(c)                                  Withholding Taxes. As a condition to the grant of Shares, Nonstatutory Options or ISOs the Grantee shall make such arrangements as the Board of Directors may require for the satisfaction of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding tax obligations that may arise in connection with such purchase.

 

(d)                                 Restrictions on Transfer of Shares. Any Shares granted under the Plan shall be subject to such special forfeiture conditions, rights of repurchase, rights of first refusal and other transfer restrictions as the Board of Directors may determine. Such restrictions shall be set forth in the applicable Stock Grant Agreement and shall apply in addition to any restrictions

 

2



 

that may apply to holders of Shares generally. A Stock Grant Agreement may provide for accelerated vesting in the event of the Purchaser’s death, disability or retirement or other events.

 

(e)                                  Termination of Status. If a Participant’s employment or other relationship with the Company is terminated for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation, upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntary, any unvested grant of Shares under the Plan to such Participant shall terminate on the date of such termination.

 

(f)                                   Board Discretion. The terms of each type of award need not be identical, and the Board need not treat participants uniformly.

 

(g)                                 Maintenance of Exemption from Code Section 409A. Awards issued under this Plan are intended to meet the requirements for exemption from coverage under Code Section 409A and all grants shall be construed and administered accordingly.

 

SECTION 6. TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF OPTIONS.

 

(a)                                 Stock Option Agreement. Each grant of an Option under the Plan shall be evidenced by a Stock Option Agreement between the Optionee and the Company. Such Option shall be subject to all applicable terms and conditions of the Plan and may be subject to any other terms and conditions which are not inconsistent with the Plan and which the Board of Directors deems appropriate for inclusion in a Stock Option Agreement. The provisions of the various Stock Option Agreements entered into under the Plan need not be identical.

 

(b)                                 Number of Shares. Each Stock Option Agreement shall specify the number of Shares that are subject to the Option and shall provide for the adjustment of such number in accordance with Section 8. The Stock Option Agreement shall also specify whether the Option is an ISO or a Nonstatutory Option.

 

(c)                                  Exercise Price. Each Stock Option Agreement shall specify the Exercise Price. The Exercise Price of an ISO shall not be less than 100% of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant, and a higher percentage may be required by Section 3(b). The Exercise Price of a Nonstatutory Option to purchase newly issued Shares shall not be less than 100% of the Fair Market Value of a Share on the date of grant. Subject to the preceding two sentences, the Exercise Price under an Option shall be determined by the Board of Directors at its sole discretion. The Exercise Price shall be payable in a form described in Section 7.

 

(d)                                 Exercisability. Each Stock Option Agreement shall specify the date when all or any installment of the Option is to become exercisable. No Option shall be exercisable unless the Optionee has delivered an executed copy of the Stock Option Agreement to the Company. The Board of Directors shall determine the exercisability provisions of any Stock Option Agreement at its sole discretion. After an option becomes exercisable in accordance with the terms of the Stock Option Agreement, it may be exercised by the Optionee by giving

 

3



 

written notice to Company as set forth in the Stock Option Agreement on a form provided by Company and by paying to Company as set forth in the Stock Option Agreement, the Exercise Price as set forth herein.

 

(e)               Accelerated Exercisability. Unless the applicable Stock Option Agreement provides otherwise, all of an Optionee’s Options shall become exercisable in full if the Company is subject to a Change in Control before the Optionee’s Service terminates. A Stock Option Agreement may also provide for accelerated exercisability in the event of the Optionee’s death, disability or retirement or other events.

 

(f)                                   Term. The Stock Option Agreement shall specify the term of the Option. The term shall not exceed 10 years from the date of grant, and in the case of an ISO a shorter term may be required by Section 3(b). Subject to the preceding sentence, the Board of Directors at its sole discretion shall determine when an Option is to expire. A Stock Option Agreement may provide for expiration prior to the end of its term in the event of the termination of the Optionee’s Service or death.

 

(g)                                 Restrictions on Transfer of Shares. Any Shares issued upon exercise of an Option shall be subject to such special forfeiture conditions, rights of repurchase, rights of first refusal and other transfer restrictions as the Board of Directors may determine. Such restrictions shall be set forth in the applicable Stock Option Agreement and shall apply in addition to any restrictions that may apply to holders of Shares generally.

 

(h)                                 Transferability of Options. An Option shall be transferable by the Optionee only by (i) a beneficiary designation, (ii) a will or (iii) the laws of descent and distribution, except as provided in the next sentence. If the applicable Stock Option Agreement so provides, a Nonstatutory Option shall also be transferable by the Optionee by (i) a gift to a member of the Optionee’s Immediate Family or (ii) a gift to an inter vivos or testamentary trust in which members of the Optionee’s Immediate Family have a beneficial interest of more than 50% and which provides that such Nonstatutory Option is to be transferred to the beneficiaries upon the Optionee’s death. An ISO may be exercised during the lifetime of the Optionee only by the Optionee or by the Optionee’s guardian or legal representative.

 

(i)                                    Withholding Taxes. As a condition to the exercise of an Option, the Optionee shall make such arrangements as the Board of Directors may require for the satisfaction of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding tax obligations that may arise in connection with such exercise. The Optionee shall also make such arrangements as the Board of Directors may require for the satisfaction of any federal, state, local or foreign withholding tax obligations that may arise in connection with the disposition of Shares acquired by exercising an Option.

 

(j)                                    No Rights as a Stockholder. An Optionee, or a transferee of an Optionee, shall have no rights as a stockholder with respect to any Shares covered by the Optionee’s Option until such person becomes entitled to receive such Shares by filing a notice of exercise and paying the Exercise Price pursuant to the terms of such Option and such Shares are issued by the Company.

 

4



 

(k)                                 Modification, Extension and Assumption of Options. Within the limitations of the Plan, the Board of Directors may modify, extend or assume outstanding Options or may accept the cancellation of outstanding Options (whether granted by the Company or another issuer) in return for the grant of new Options for the same or a different number of Shares and at the same or a different Exercise Price. The foregoing notwithstanding, no modification of an Option shall, without the consent of the Optionee, impair the Optionee’s rights or increase the Optionee’s obligations under such Option.

 

(l)                                    Termination of Status. If a Participant’s employment or other relationship with the Company is terminated for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation, upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntary, the Options issued to such Participant shall terminate on the date of such termination and shall thereupon not be exercisable to any extent whatsoever.

 

SECTION 7. PAYMENT FOR SHARES.

 

(a)                                 General Rule. The entire Purchase Price or Exercise Price of Shares issued under the Plan shall be payable in cash or cash equivalents at the time when such Shares are purchased, except as otherwise provided in this Section 7.

 

(b)                                 Surrender of Stock. To the extent that a Stock Option Agreement so provides, all or any part of the Exercise Price may be paid by surrendering, or attesting to the ownership of, Shares that are already owned by the Optionee. Such Shares shall be surrendered to the Company in good form for transfer and shall be valued at their Fair Market Value on the date when the Option is exercised. The Optionee shall not surrender, or attest to the ownership of, Shares in payment of the Exercise Price if such action would cause the Company to recognize compensation expense (or additional compensation expense) with respect to the Option for financial reporting purposes.

 

(c)                                  Services Rendered. At the discretion of the Board of Directors, Shares may be awarded under the Plan in consideration of services rendered to the Company, a Parent or a Subsidiary prior to the award.

 

(d)                                 Promissory Note. To the extent that a Stock Option Agreement or Stock Grant Agreement so provides, all or a portion of the Exercise Price or Purchase Price (as the case may be) of Shares issued under the Plan may be paid with a full-recourse promissory note. However, the par value of the Shares, if newly issued, shall be paid in cash or cash equivalents. The Shares shall be pledged as security for payment of the principal amount of the promissory note and interest thereon. The interest rate payable under the terms of the promissory note shall not be less than the minimum rate (if any) required to avoid the imputation of additional interest under the Code. Subject to the foregoing, the Board of Directors (at its sole discretion) shall specify the term, interest rate, amortization requirements (if any) and other provisions of such note.

 

5



 

SECTION 8. COMPANY RIGHT OF REPURCHASE

 

(a)                                 Exercise the Right. The Company shall have the right (the “Repurchase Right”) to repurchase some or all of the Shares (whether acquired by grant or option) which the Participant has received or elected to exercise from the Participant, upon the occurrence of any of the events specified in Section 7(b) below (each, a “Repurchase Event”). The Repurchase Right may be exercised by the Company within 180 days following the date of such Repurchase Event (the “Repurchase Period”). The Repurchase Right shall be exercised by the Company by giving the holder written notice on or before the last day of the Repurchase Period of its intention to exercise the Repurchase Right, and, together with such notice, tendering to the holder an amount equal to the Repurchase Price of the Shares, determined as provided in Section 7(c). The Company may assign the Repurchase Right to one or more persons or legal entities. Upon exercise of the Repurchase Right in the manner provided in this Section 7(a), the Participant shall deliver to the Company the stock certificate or certificates representing the Shares being repurchased, duly endorsed and free and clear of any and all liens, charges, and encumbrances.

 

If Shares are not purchased under the Repurchase Right, the Participant and his or her successor in interest, if any, will hold any such shares in his or her possession subject to all the provisions of this Section 7 and Section 8 hereof.

 

(b)                                 Company’s Right to Exercise Repurchase Right. The Company shall have the Repurchase Right in the event that any of the following events shall occur:

 

(i)                                The termination of the Participant’s employment with the Company and its Subsidiaries for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily; or

(ii)                             The (x) filing of a voluntary petition under any bankruptcy or insolvency law, or a petition for the appointment of a receiver or the making of an assignment for the benefit of creditors, with respect to the Participant, or (y) the Participant being subjected involuntarily to a petition or assignment or to an attachment or other legal or equitable interest with respect to his or her assets, which involuntary petition or assignment or attachment is not discharged within 60 days after its date, or (z) the Participant being subject to a transfer of Shares by operation of law, except by reason of death.

 

(c)                                  Determination of Repurchase Price. For purposes of this Section 7, the Repurchase Price of the Shares shall be, the lesser of the Option Price, the Grant Price, or the Fair Market Value of the Shares as determined by the Board as of the date of the Repurchase Event. The Fair Market Value, if shares of the Common Stock are not then publicly traded, shall be determined by any reasonable method chosen by the Board including, for example, any valuation method described in Treasury Regulation Sec. 20.2031.2, or as determined pursuant to the applicable Stock Option Agreement or Stock Grant Agreement.

 

(d)                                 Expiration of Company’s Repurchase Right. The Repurchase Right shall remain in effect until and shall terminate upon the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

6



 

SECTION 9. ADJUSTMENT OF SHARES.

 

(a)                                 General. In the event of a subdivision of the outstanding Stock, a declaration of a dividend payable in Shares, a declaration of an extraordinary dividend payable in a form other than Shares in an amount that has a material effect on the Fair Market Value of the Stock, a combination or consolidation of the outstanding Stock into a lesser number of Shares, a recapitalization, a spin-off, a reclassification or a similar occurrence, the Board of Directors may make appropriate adjustments in one or more of (i) the number of Shares available for future grants under Section 4, (ii) the number of Shares covered by each outstanding Option or (iii) the Exercise Price under each outstanding Option.

 

(b)                                 Mergers and Consolidations. In the event that the Company is a party to a merger or consolidation, outstanding Options shall be subject to the agreement of merger or consolidation. Such agreement shall provide for:

 

(i)                                     The continuation of such outstanding Options by the Company (if the Company is the surviving corporation);

 

(ii)                                  The assumption of the Plan and such outstanding Options by the surviving corporation or its parent;

 

(iii)                               The substitution by the surviving corporation or its parent of options with substantially the same terms for such outstanding Options;

 

(iv)                              The full exercisability of such outstanding Options and full vesting of the Shares subject to such Options, followed by the cancellation of such Options; or

 

(v)                                 The settlement of the full value of such outstanding Options (whether or not then exercisable) in cash or cash equivalents, followed by the cancellation of such Options.

 

(c)                                  Reservation of Rights. Except as provided in this Section 8, an Optionee or Purchaser shall have no rights by reason of (i) any subdivision or consolidation of shares of stock of any class, (ii) the payment of any dividend or (iii) any other increase or decrease in the number of shares of stock of any class. Any issuance by the Company of shares of stock of any class, or securities convertible into shares of stock of any class, shall not affect, and no adjustment by reason thereof shall be made with respect to, the number or Exercise Price of Shares subject to an Option. The grant of an Option pursuant to the Plan shall not affect in any way the right or power of the Company to make adjustments, reclassifications, reorganizations or changes of its capital or business structure, to merge or consolidate or to dissolve, liquidate, sell or transfer all or any part of its business or assets.

 

SECTION 10. SECURITIES LAW REQUIREMENTS.

 

Shares shall not be issued under the Plan unless the issuance and delivery of such Shares comply with (or are exempt from) all applicable requirements of law, including (without limitation) the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the rules and regulations promulgated

 

7



 

thereunder, state securities laws and regulations, and the regulations of any stock exchange or other securities market on which the Company’s securities may then be traded.

 

SECTION 11. NO RETENTION RIGHTS.

 

Nothing in the Plan or in any right or Option granted under the Plan shall confer upon the Purchaser or Optionee any right to continue in Service for any period of specific duration or interfere with or otherwise restrict in any way the rights of the Company (or any Parent or Subsidiary employing or retaining the Purchaser or Optionee) or of the Purchaser or Optionee, which rights are hereby expressly reserved by each, to terminate his or her Service at any time and for any reason, with or without cause.

 

SECTION 12. DURATION AND AMENDMENTS.

 

(a)                                 Term of the Plan. The Plan, as set forth herein, shall become effective on the date of its adoption by the Board of Directors, subject to the approval of the Company’s stockholders. If the stockholders fail to approve the Plan within 12 months after its adoption by the Board of Directors, then any grants, exercises or sales that have already occurred under the Plan shall be rescinded and no additional grants, exercises or sales shall thereafter be made under the Plan. The Plan shall terminate automatically 10 years after the later of (i) its adoption by the Board of Directors or (ii) the most recent increase in the number of Shares reserved under Section 4 that was approved by the Company’s stockholders. The Plan may be terminated on any earlier date pursuant to Subsection (b) below.

 

(b)                                 Right to Amend or Terminate the Plan. The Board of Directors may amend, suspend or terminate the Plan at any time and for any reason; provided, however, that any amendment of the Plan shall be subject to the approval of the Company’s stockholders if it (i) increases the number of Shares available for issuance under the Plan (except as provided in Section 8) or (ii) materially changes the class of persons who are eligible for the grant of ISOs. Stockholder approval shall not be required for any other amendment of the Plan. If the stockholders fail to approve an increase in the number of Shares reserved under Section 4 within 12 months after its adoption by the Board of Directors, then any grants, exercises or sales that have already occurred in reliance on such increase shall be rescinded and no additional grants, exercises or sales shall thereafter be made in reliance on such increase.

 

(e)                                  Effect of Amendment or Termination. No Shares shall be issued or sold under the Plan after the termination thereof, except upon exercise of an Option granted prior to such termination. The termination of the Plan, or any amendment thereof, shall not affect any Share previously issued or any Option previously granted under the Plan.

 

SECTION 13. DEFINITIONS.

 

(a)                                 “Board of Directors” shall mean the Board of Directors of the Company, as constituted from time to time.

 

(b)                                 “Change in Control” shall mean: (i) the consummation of a merger or consolidation of the Company with or into another entity or any other corporate reorganization,

 

8



 

if persons who were not stockholders of the Company immediately prior to such merger, consolidation or other reorganization own immediately after such merger, consolidation or other reorganization 50% or more of the voting power of the outstanding securities of each of (A) the continuing or surviving entity and (B) any direct or indirect parent corporation of such continuing or surviving entity; or (ii) the sale, transfer or other disposition of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets.

 

(c)                                  “Code” shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

 

(d)                                 “Committee” shall mean a committee of the Board of Directors, as described in Section 2(a).

 

(e)                                  “Company” shall mean Veritex Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation.

 

(f)                                   “Consultant” shall mean a person who performs bona fide services for the Company, a Parent or a Subsidiary as a consultant or advisor, excluding Employees and Outside Directors.

 

(g)                                 “Employee” shall mean any individual who is a common-law employee of the Company, a Parent or a Subsidiary.

 

(h)                                 “Exercise Price” shall mean the amount for which one Share may be purchased upon exercise of an Option, as specified by the Board of Directors in the applicable Stock Option Agreement.

 

(i)                                    “Fair Market Value” shall mean the fair market value of a Share, as determined by the Board of Directors in good faith. Such determination shall be conclusive and binding on all persons.

 

(j)                                    “Immediate Family” shall mean any child, stepchild, grandchild, parent, stepparent, grandparent, spouse, sibling, mother-in-law, father-in-law, son-in-law, daughter-in- law, brother-in-law or sister-in-law and shall include adoptive relationships.

 

(k)                                 “ISO” shall mean an employee incentive stock option described in Section 422(b) of the Code.

 

(l)                                    “Nonstatutory Option” shall mean a stock option not described in Sections 422(b) or 423(b) of the Code.

 

(m)                             “Option” shall mean an ISO or Nonstatutory Option granted under the Plan and entitling the holder to purchase Shares.

 

(n)                                 “Optionee” shall mean a person who holds an Option.

 

(o)                                 “Outside Director” shall mean a member of the Board of Directors who is not an Employee.

 

(p)                                 “Parent” shall mean any corporation (other than the Company) in an unbroken chain of corporations ending with the Company, if each of the corporations other than the

 

9



 

Company owns stock possessing 50% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock in one of the other corporations in such chain. A corporation that attains the status of a Parent on a date after the adoption of the Plan shall be considered a Parent commencing as of such date,

 

(q)                                      “Plan” shall mean this Veritex Holdings, Inc. Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan.

 

(r)                                       “Purchase Price” shall mean the consideration for which one Share may be acquired under the Plan (other than upon exercise of an Option), as specified by the Board of Directors.

 

(s)                                        “Purchaser” shall mean a person to whom the Board of Directors has offered the right to acquire Shares under the Plan (other than upon exercise of an Option).

 

(t)                                         “Service” shall mean service as an Employee, Outside Director or Consultant.

 

(u)                                      “Share” shall mean one share of Stock, as adjusted in accordance with Section 8 (if applicable).

 

(v)                                      “Stock” shall mean the Common Stock of the Company, no par value.

 

(w)                                    “Stock Option Agreement” shall mean the agreement between the Company and an Optionee that contains the terms, conditions and restrictions pertaining to the Optionee’s Option.

 

(x)                                      “Stock Grant Agreement” shall mean the agreement between the Company and a Purchaser who acquires Shares under the Plan that contains the terms, conditions and restrictions pertaining to the acquisition of such Shares.

 

(y)                                      “Subsidiary” shall mean any corporation (other than the Company) in an unbroken chain of corporations beginning with the Company, if each of the corporations other than the last corporation in the unbroken chain owns stock possessing 50% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock in one of the other corporations in such chain. A corporation that attains the status of a Subsidiary on a date after the adoption of the Plan shall be considered a Subsidiary commencing as of such date.

 

10


 

STOCK GRANT AGREEMENT PURSUANT TO THE

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. 2010 EQUITY INCENTIVE PLAN

 

This STOCK GRANT AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”) is made as of the        day of                                       , 20      , by Veritex Holdings, Inc, (the “Company”), and                                                          (“Holder”).

 

In connection with and pursuant to the Veritex Holdings, Inc. 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (the “Plan”), as amended or modified from time to time, a stock award is granted by the Board to Holder pursuant and subject to, the Plan on the following terms and conditions:

 

SECTION I

DEFINED TERMS

 

Unless otherwise defined herein or, unless the context requires a different definition, capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Plan.

 

SECTION II

GRANT AND TIME OF VESTING

 

Effective as of                       ,           , the Company grants to Holder, subject to the terms and provisions set forth hereinafter and in the Plan, the right to receive the number of shares set forth in Exhibit A of the presently authorized but unissued common stock (“Common Stock”), of the Company (the rights hereby granted being hereinafter referred to as the “Grant”).

 

The Grant shall not be considered granted unless and until Holder delivers to the Company a fully executed counterpart hereof. Thereafter, the Grant shall vest in accordance with the Schedule set forth on Exhibit A, subject to any termination, acceleration or change in such Schedule set forth in this Agreement apart from Exhibit A.

 

Neither the Grant nor any other rights granted under this Agreement may be exercised after the Expiration Date set forth on Exhibit A and, before that time, the Grant may be terminated as hereinafter provided.

 

SECTION III

WITHHOLDING

 

The Company will, as soon as is reasonably possible, notify the Holder of the amount of withholding tax, if any, that must be paid under federal, state and local law due to vesting of the Grant. The Company shall have no obligation to deliver certificates for the shares purchased until Holder pays to the Company the amount of withholding specified in the Company’s notice in cash.

 

1



 

SECTION IV

TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT/SERVICE

 

If a Holder’s employment (or other service) with the Company terminates for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily the Grant, to the extent not previously vested, will terminate on the date of such termination of employment (or service).

 

SECTION V

ACCELERATION OF VESTING

 

Upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, the Grant (to the extent not previously terminated or forfeited) shall become fully vested as to all shares subject to it.

 

SECTION VI

NON-ASSIGNABILITY AND TERM OF GRANT

 

The Grant shall not be transferrable or assignable by the Holder, other than by will or the laws of descent and distribution. No invested Grant shall be subject to execution, attachment, or similar process.

 

It is expressly agreed that, anything contained herein to the contrary notwithstanding, this Agreement shall not constitute, or be evidence of, any agreement or understanding, express or implied, that the Company or a Subsidiary will employ Holder for any period of time or in any position or for any particular compensation.

 

SECTION VII

COMPANY RIGHT OF REPURCHASE

 

(a)                                 Exercise the Right.  The Company shall have the right (the “Repurchase Right”) to repurchase some or all of the Shares which the Holder has acquired upon the occurrence of any of the events specified in Section 7(b) below (each, a “Repurchase Event”).  The Repurchase Right may be exercised by the Company within 180 days following the date of such Repurchase Event (the “Repurchase Period”).  The Repurchase Right shall be exercised by the Company by giving the Holder written notice on or before the last day of the Repurchase Period of its intention to exercise the Repurchase Right, and, together with such notice, tendering to the holder an amount equal to the Repurchase Price of the Shares, determined as provided in Section 7(c).  The Company may assign the Repurchase Right to one or more persons or legal entities.  Upon exercise of the Repurchase Right in the manner provided in this Section 7(a), the Holder shall deliver to the Company the stock certificate or certificates representing the Shares being repurchased, duly endorsed and free and clear of any and all liens, charges, and encumbrances.

 

2



 

If Shares are not purchased under the Repurchase Right, the Holder and his or her successor in interest, if any, will hold any such shares in his or her possession subject to all the provisions of this Section 7 and Section 8 hereof.

 

(b)                                 Company’s Right to Exercise Repurchase Right.  The Company shall have the Repurchase Right in the event that any of the following events shall occur:

 

(i)                                     The termination of the Holder’s employment with the Company and its Subsidiaries for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily; or

 

(ii)                                  The (x) filing of a voluntary petition under any bankruptcy or insolvency law, or a petition for the appointment of a receiver or the making of an assignment for the benefit of creditors, with respect to the Holder, or (y) the Holder being subjected involuntarily to a petition or assignment or to an attachment or other legal or equitable interest with respect to his or her assets, which involuntary petition or assignment or attachment is not discharged within 60 days after its date, or (z) the Holder being subject to a transfer of Shares by operation of law, except by reason of death.

 

(c)                                  Determination of Repurchase Price.  For purposes of this Section 7, the Repurchase Price of the Option Shares shall be, the lesser of the Grant Price (as set forth in Exhibit A) or the Fair Market Value of the Shares as determined by the Board as of the date of the Repurchase Event.  The Fair Market Value, if shares of the Common Stock are not then publicly traded, shall be determined by any reasonable method chosen by the Board including, for example, any valuation method described in Treasury Regulation Sec. 20.2031.2, or as determined pursuant to the applicable Stock Option Agreement or Stock Grant Agreement.

 

(d)                                 Expiration of Company’s Repurchase Right.  The Repurchase Right shall remain in effect until and shall terminate upon the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

SECTION VIII

COMPANY’S RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL

 

(a)                                 Exercise of Right.  If, at a time other than within the period specified in this Section 8(a) and without limiting any other restrictions on transfer of any Shares set forth in any other agreement or otherwise, the Holder desires to transfer all or any part of the Shares to any person other than the Company (an “Offeror”); the Holder shall: (i) obtain in writing an irrevocable and unconditional bona fide offer (the “Offer”) for the purchase thereof from the Offeror; and (ii) give written notice (the “Option Notice”) to the Company setting forth the Holder’s desire to transfer such shares, which Option Notice shall be accompanied by a photocopy of the Offer and shall set forth the name and address of the Offeror and the price and terms of the Offer.  Upon receipt of the Option Notice, the Company shall have an assignable option to purchase any or all of such Shares (the “Company Option Shares”) specified in the Option Notice, such option to be exercisable by giving, within 30 days after receipt of the Option

 

3



 

Notice, a written counter notice to the Holder.  If the Company elects to purchase any or all of such Company Option Shares, it shall be obligated to purchase, and the Holder shall be obligated to sell to the Company, such Company Option Shares at the price and terms indicated in the Offer within 20 days after the date of the delivery by the Company of such counter notice.

 

(b)                                 Sale of Option Shares to Offeror.  The Holder may, for 30 days after the expiration of the 20-day option period as set forth in Section 8(a), sell to the Offeror, pursuant to the terms of the Offer, any or all of such Company Option Shares not purchased or agreed to be purchased by the Company or its assignee.  If any or all of such Company Option Shares are not sold pursuant to an Offer within the time permitted above, the unsold Company Option Shares shall remain subject to the terms of this Section 8.

 

(c)                                  Adjustment for Changes in Capital Structure.  If there shall be any change in the Common Shares of the Company through merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization, stock dividend, stock split, combination or exchange of shares, or the like, the restrictions contained in this Section 8, shall exchange for, or by virtue of his or her ownership of Shares.

 

(d)                                 Failure to Deliver Option Shares.  If the Holder fails or refuses to deliver on a timely basis duly endorsed certificates representing Company Option Shares to be sold to the Company or its assignee pursuant to this Section 8, the Company shall have the right to deposit the purchase price for such Company Option Shares in a special account with any bank or trust company, giving notice of such deposit to the Holder, whereupon such Company Option Shares shall be deemed to have been purchased by the Company.  All such monies shall be held by the bank or trust company for the benefit of the Holder.  All monies deposited with the bank or trust company but remaining unclaimed for two years after the date of deposit shall be repaid by the bank or trust company to the Company on demand, and the Holder shall thereafter look only to the Company for payment.  The Company may place a legend on any certificate for Option Shares delivered to the Holder reflecting the restrictions on transfer provided in this Section 8.

 

(e)                                  Expiration of Company’s Right of First Refusal.  The first refusal of rights of the Company set forth above shall remain in effect until the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

SECTION IX

RIGHTS OF HOLDER IN STOCK

 

Neither Holder, nor his successor in interest, shall have any of the rights of a shareholder of the Company with respect to the shares until such shares are issued by the Company.

 

4



 

SECTION X

NOTICES

 

Any notice to be given hereunder shall be in writing and shall be addressed to the Company in care of                                               , and any notice to be given to the Holder shall be addressed to the address designated below the signature appearing hereinafter, or at such other address as either party may hereafter designate in writing to the other.

 

Any such notice shall have been deemed duly given upon three (3) days of sending such notice enclosed in a properly sealed envelope, addressed as aforesaid, registered or certified and deposited (with the proper postage and registration or certificate fee prepaid) in the United States mail.

 

SECTION XI

SUCCESSORS OR ASSIGNS OF THE COMPANY

 

The Grant shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of any successor of the Company.

 

SECTION XII

MISCELLANEOUS

 

(a)                                 Designation of Beneficiary. The Holder shall have the right to appoint any individual or legal entity in writing, on Exhibit C hereto, as his beneficiary to receive any Shares (to the extent not previously terminated or forfeited) under this Agreement upon the Holder’s death. Such designation under this Agreement may be revoked by the Holder at any time and a new beneficiary may be appointed by the Holder by execution and submission to the Board of a revised Exhibit C to this Agreement. In order to be effective, a designation of beneficiary must be completed by the Holder on Exhibit C and received to the Board, or its designee, prior to the date of the Holder’s death. In the absence of such designation, the Holder’s beneficiary shall be the legal representative of the Holder’s estate.

 

(b)                                 Incapacity of Holder or Beneficiary. If any person entitled to a distribution under this Agreement is deemed by the Board to be incapable of making an election hereunder or of personally receiving and giving a valid receipt for such distribution hereunder, then, unless and until an election or claim therefore shall have been made by a duly appointed guardian or other legal representative of such person, the Board may provide for such election or distribution or any part thereof to be made to any other person or institution then contributing toward or providing for the care and maintenance of such person. Any such distribution shall be a distribution for the account of such person and a complete discharge of any liability of the Board, the Company and the Plan therefore.

 

(c)                                  Incorporation of the Plan. The terms and provisions of the Plan, as the same may be amended from time to time, are hereby incorporated in this Agreement. Unless otherwise specifically stated herein, such terms and provisions shall control in the event of any inconsistency between the Plan and this Agreement.

 

5



 

(d)                                 Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS AND ALL APPLICABLE FEDERAL LAWS. THE SECURITIES ISSUED HEREUNDER SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CORPORATE SECURITIES LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS.

 

(e)                                  Gender. Reference to the masculine herein shall be deemed to include the feminine, wherever appropriate.

 

(f)                                   Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, which shall together constitute a valid and binding agreement.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Agreement has been executed by the Company and the Holder as of the date and year first written above.

 

HOLDER 

COMPANY 

 

 

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

Name

Its:

 

Address

 

 

6



 

EXHIBIT A

 

1.  Board Approval Date:

 

 

 

2.  Date of Grant:

                                 , 20        

 

 

3.  Holder:

 

 

 

4.  Number of Shares:

                               (                          )
of shares (voting) of Common Stock

 

 

5.  Initial Vesting Date:

 

6.  Grant Price per Share:

                                                                                                          ($                        )

 

 

7.  Vesting Schedule:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8.  Expiration Date:

                              (not more than ten years from Date of Grant.)

 

7


 

STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT PURSUANT TO THE

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. 2010 EQUITY INCENTIVE PLAN

 

This STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT (this “Agreement”) is made as of the        day of                                       , 20      , by Veritex Holdings, Inc, (the “Company”), and                                                          (“Holder”).

 

In connection with and pursuant to the Veritex Holdings, Inc. 2010 Stock Option and Equity Incentive Plan (the “Plan”), as amended or modified from time to time, a stock option is granted by the Board to Holder pursuant and subject to, the Plan on the following terms and conditions:

 

SECTION I

DEFINED TERMS

 

Unless otherwise defined herein or, unless the context requires a different definition, capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Plan.

 

SECTION II

OPTIONS, OPTION PRICE AND TIME OF EXERCISE

 

Effective as of                       ,               , the Company grants to Holder, subject to the terms and provisions set forth hereinafter and in the Plan, the right and option to purchase all or any part of the number of shares set forth in Exhibit A of the presently authorized but unissued common stock (“Common Stock”), of the Company at the purchase price per share set forth as the Option Price in Exhibit A (the option hereby granted being hereinafter referred to as the “Option”).

 

The Option shall not be considered granted (as of the effective date described above) or become exercisable unless and until Holder delivers to the Company a fully executed counterpart hereof. Thereafter, the Option shall be exercisable in accordance with the Exercise Schedule set forth on Exhibit A, subject to any termination, acceleration or change in such Exercise Schedule set forth in this Agreement apart from Exhibit A.

 

Neither the Option nor any other rights granted under this Agreement may be exercised after the Expiration Date set forth on Exhibit A and, before that time, the Option may be terminated as hereinafter provided. If Holder does not purchase the full number of shares to which he is entitled in any one year, he may purchase such shares in the next year specified in the Exercise Schedule hereto, in addition to the shares which he is otherwise entitled to purchase in the next year.

 

1



 

SECTION III

EXERCISE PROCEDURE, WITHHOLDING

 

Holder shall exercise the Option by notifying the Company of the number of shares that he desires to purchase and by delivering with such notice the full payment for the purchase price of the shares being purchased. Such purchase price shall be payable in cash.  The Option can be exercised subject to the Repurchase Option and the Right of First Refusal as to all Shares as set forth hereinafter.

 

The Company will, as soon as is reasonably possible, notify the Holder of the amount of withholding tax, if any, that must be paid under federal, state and local law due to exercise of the Option. The Company shall have no obligation to deliver certificates for the shares purchased until Holder pays to the Company the amount of withholding specified in the Company’s notice in cash.

 

SECTION IV

TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT/SERVICE

 

If an Optionee’s employment (or other service) with the Company terminates for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily the Options, to the extent not previously exercised, will terminate on the date of such termination of employment (or service).

 

SECTION V

ACCELERATION OF EXERCISE

 

Upon the occurrence of a Change in Control, the Option (to the extent not previously terminated or forfeited) shall become fully exercisable as to all shares subject to it.

 

SECTION VI

NON-ASSIGNABILITY AND TERM OF OPTION

 

The Option shall not be transferrable or assignable by the Holder, other than by will or the laws of descent and distribution and the Option shall be exercisable, during the Holder’s lifetime, only by him or, during periods of legal disability, by his legal representative. No Option shall be subject to execution, attachment, or similar process.

 

In no event may the Option be exercisable to any extent by anyone after the Expiration Date specified in Exhibit A. It is expressly agreed that, anything contained herein to the contrary notwithstanding, this Agreement shall not constitute, or be evidence of, any agreement or understanding, express or implied, that the Company or a Subsidiary will employ Holder for any period of time or in any position or for any particular compensation.

 

2



 

SECTION VII

COMPANY RIGHT OF REPURCHASE

 

(a)                                 Exercise the Right.  The Company shall have the right (the “Repurchase Right”) to repurchase some or all of the Option Shares which the Optionee has elected to exercise from the Optionee, upon the occurrence of any of the events specified in Section 7(b) below (each, a “Repurchase Event”).  The Repurchase Right may be exercised by the Company within 180 days following the date of such Repurchase Event (the “Repurchase Period”).  The Repurchase Right shall be exercised by the Company by giving the holder written notice on or before the last day of the Repurchase Period of its intention to exercise the Repurchase Right, and, together with such notice, tendering to the holder an amount equal to the Repurchase Price of the Shares, determined as provided in Section 7(c).  The Company may assign the Repurchase Right to one or more persons or legal entities.  Upon exercise of the Repurchase Right in the manner provided in this Section 7(a), the Optionee shall deliver to the Company the stock certificate or certificates representing the Option Shares being repurchased, duly endorsed and free and clear of any and all liens, charges, and encumbrances.

 

If Option Shares are not purchased under the Repurchase Right, the Optionee and his or her successor in interest, if any, will hold any such shares in his or her possession subject to all the provisions of this Section 7 and Section 8 hereof.

 

(b)                                 Company’s Right to Exercise Repurchase Right.  The Company shall have the Repurchase Right in the event that any of the following events shall occur:

 

(i)                                     The termination of the Optionee’s employment with the Company and its Subsidiaries for any reason whatsoever, regardless of the circumstances thereof, and including without limitation upon death, disability, retirement, discharge, or resignation for any reason, whether voluntary or involuntarily; or

 

(ii)                                  The (x) filing of a voluntary petition under any bankruptcy or insolvency law, or a petition for the appointment of a receiver or the making of an assignment for the benefit of creditors, with respect to the Optionee, or (y) the Optionee being subjected involuntarily to a petition or assignment or to an attachment or other legal or equitable interest with respect to his or her assets, which involuntary petition or assignment or attachment is not discharged within 60 days after its date, or (z) the Optionee being subject to a transfer of Option Shares by operation of law, except by reason of death.

 

(c)                                  Determination of Repurchase Price.  For purposes of this Section 7, the Repurchase Price of the Option Shares shall be, the lesser of the Option Price or the Fair Market Value of the Option Shares as determined by the Board as of the date of the Repurchase Event.  The Fair Market Value, if shares of the Common Stock are not then publicly traded, shall be determined by any reasonable method chosen by the Board including, for example, any valuation method described in Treasury Regulation Sec. 20.2031.2, or as determined pursuant to the applicable Stock Option Agreement or Stock Grant Agreement.

 

3



 

(d)                                 Expiration of Company’s Repurchase Right.  The Repurchase Right shall remain in effect until and shall terminate upon the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

SECTION VIII

COMPANY’S RIGHT OF FIRST REFUSAL

 

(a)                                 Exercise of Right.  If, at a time other than within the period specified in this Section 8(a) and without limiting any other restrictions on transfer of any Option Shares set forth in any other agreement or otherwise, the Optionee desires to transfer all or any part of the Option Shares to any person other than the Company (an “Offeror”); the Optionee shall: (i) obtain in writing an irrevocable and unconditional bona fide offer (the “Offer”) for the purchase thereof from the Offeror; and (ii) give written notice (the “Option Notice”) to the Company setting forth the Optionee’s desire to transfer such shares, which Option Notice shall be accompanied by a photocopy of the Offer and shall set forth the name and address of the Offeror and the price and terms of the Offer.  Upon receipt of the Option Notice, the Company shall have an assignable option to purchase any or all of such Option Shares (the “Company Option Shares”) specified in the Option Notice, such option to be exercisable by giving, within 30 days after receipt of the Option Notice, a written counter notice to the Optionee.  If the Company elects to purchase any or all of such Company Option Shares, it shall be obligated to purchase, and the Optionee shall be obligated to sell to the Company, such Company Option Shares at the price and terms indicated in the Offer within 20 days after the date of the delivery by the Company of such counter notice.

 

(b)                                 Sale of Option Shares to Offeror.  The Optionee may, for 30 days after the expiration of the 20-day option period as set forth in Section 8(a), sell to the Offeror, pursuant to the terms of the Offer, any or all of such Company Option Shares not purchased or agreed to be purchased by the Company or its assignee.  If any or all of such Company Option Shares are not sold pursuant to an Offer within the time permitted above, the unsold Company Option Shares shall remain subject to the terms of this Section 8.

 

(c)                                  Adjustment for Changes in Capital Structure.  If there shall be any change in the Common Shares of the Company through merger, consolidation, reorganization, recapitalization, stock dividend, stock split, combination or exchange of shares, or the like, the restrictions contained in this Section 8, shall exchange for, or by virtue of his or her ownership of Option Shares.

 

(d)                                 Failure to Deliver Option Shares.  If the Optionee fails or refuses to deliver on a timely basis duly endorsed certificates representing Company Option Shares to be sold to the Company or its assignee pursuant to this Section 8, the Company shall have the right to deposit the purchase price for such Company Option Shares in a special account with any bank or trust company, giving notice of such deposit to the Optionee, whereupon such Company Option Shares shall be deemed to have been purchased by the Company.  All such monies shall be held by the bank or trust company for the benefit of the Optionee.  All monies deposited with the bank or trust company but remaining unclaimed for two years after the date of deposit shall be repaid by the bank or trust company to the Company on demand, and the Optionee shall thereafter look

 

4



 

only to the Company for payment.  The Company may place a legend on any certificate for Option Shares delivered to the Optionee reflecting the restrictions on transfer provided in this Section 8.

 

(e)                                  Expiration of Company’s Right of First Refusal.  The first refusal of rights of the Company set forth above shall remain in effect until the closing of an Initial Public Offering.

 

SECTION IX

RIGHTS OF HOLDER IN STOCK

 

Neither Holder, nor his successor in interest, shall have any of the rights of a shareholder of the Company with respect to the shares for which the Option is issued until such shares are issued by the Company.

 

SECTION X

NOTICES

 

Any notice to be given hereunder shall be in writing and shall be addressed to the Company, in care of the                                       , and any notice to be given to the Holder shall be addressed to the address designated below the signature appearing hereinafter, or at such other address as either party may hereafter designate in writing to the other. Any such notice shall have been deemed duly given upon three (3) days of sending such notice enclosed in a properly sealed envelope, addressed as aforesaid, registered or certified and deposited (with the proper postage and registration or certificate fee prepaid) in the United States mail.

 

SECTION XI

SUCCESSORS OR ASSIGNS OF THE COMPANY

 

The Option shall be binding upon and shall inure to the benefit of any successor of the Company.

 

SECTION XII

MISCELLANEOUS

 

(a)                                 Designation of Beneficiary. The Holder shall have the right to appoint any individual or legal entity in writing, on Exhibit C hereto, as his beneficiary to receive any Option (to the extent not previously terminated or forfeited) under this Agreement upon the Holder’s death. Such designation under this Agreement may be revoked by the Holder at any time and a new beneficiary may be appointed by the Holder by execution and submission to the Board of a revised Exhibit C to this Agreement. In order to be effective, a designation of beneficiary must be completed by the Holder on Exhibit C and received to the Board, or its designee, prior to the date of the Holder’s death. In the absence of such designation, the Holder’s beneficiary shall be the legal representative of the Holder’s estate.

 

5



 

(b)                                 Incapacity of Holder or Beneficiary. If any person entitled to a distribution under this Agreement is deemed by the Board to be incapable of making an election hereunder or of personally receiving and giving a valid receipt for such distribution hereunder, then, unless and until an election or claim therefore shall have been made by a duly appointed guardian or other legal representative of such person, the Board may provide for such election or distribution or any part thereof to be made to any other person or institution then contributing toward or providing for the care and maintenance of such person. Any such distribution shall be a distribution for the account of such person and a complete discharge of any liability of the Board, the Company and the Plan therefore.

 

(c)                                  Incorporation of the Plan. The terms and provisions of the Plan, as the same may be amended from time to time, are hereby incorporated in this Agreement. Unless otherwise specifically stated herein, such terms and provisions shall control in the event of any inconsistency between the Plan and this Agreement.

 

(d)                                 Governing Law. THIS AGREEMENT SHALL BE GOVERNED BY THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS AND ALL APPLICABLE FEDERAL LAWS. THE SECURITIES ISSUED HEREUNDER SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE CORPORATE SECURITIES LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS.

 

(e)                                  Gender. Reference to the masculine herein shall be deemed to include the feminine, wherever appropriate.

 

(f)                                   Counterparts. This Agreement may be executed in one or more counterparts, which shall together constitute a valid and binding agreement.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Agreement has been executed by the Company and the Holder as of the date and year first written above.

 

HOLDER 

COMPANY 

 

 

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

Name

Its:

 

Address

 

 

6



 

EXHIBIT A

 

1.  Board Approval Date:

 

 

 

2.  Date of Grant:

                                 , 20        

 

 

3.  Holder:

 

 

 

4.  Number of Shares:

                               (                          )
of shares (voting) of Common Stock

 

 

5.  Initial Vesting Date:

 

6.  Option Price per Share:

                                                                                                          ($                        )

 

 

7.  Vesting Schedule:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8.  Expiration Date:

                              (not more than ten years from Date of Grant.)

 

7




Exhibit 10.5

 

Veritex Community Bank

EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN
ADOPTION AGREEMENT

 

SECTION 1
EMPLOYER INFORMATION

 

1-1       EMPLOYER INFORMATION:

 

Name: Veritex Community Bank

Address:

 

8214 Westchester Drive

Suite 400

Dallas, Texas 75225 

Telephone: (972) 349-6200

Fax: (972) 349-6155

 

1-2       EMPLOYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (EIN): 76-0752296

 

1-3       FORM OF BUSINESS:

 

x C-Corporation

 

o S-Corporation

 

1-4       EMPLOYER’S TAX YEAR END: The Employer’s tax year ends December 31

 

1-5       RELATED EMPLOYERS: List any Related Employers (as defined in Section 1.118 of the Plan). A Related Employer must complete a Participating Employer Adoption Page for Employees of that Related Employer to participate in this Plan. The failure to cover the Employees of a Related Employer may result in a violation of the minimum coverage rules under Code §410(b).

 

 

[Note: The failure to list all Related Employers will not jeopardize the qualified status of the Plan.]

 

SECTION 2
PLAN INFORMATION

 

2-1       PLAN NAME: Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

 

2-2       PLAN NUMBER: 002

 

2-3       PLAN YEAR:

 

x (a)        Calendar year

o (b)       The 12-consecutive month period ending on       each year.

o (c)        The Plan has a short Plan Year running from         to         .

o (d)       Other:

 

2-4       PLAN ADMINISTRATOR:

 

x (a)        The Employer identified in AA §1-1.

o (b)         Name:

Address:

Telephone:

 

© Copyright 2011

 

ESOP — Cycle A

 

1



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Section 3 — Eligible Employees

 

SECTION 3
ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

 

3-1                              ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES: In addition to the Employees identified in Section 2.02 of the Plan, the following Employees are excluded from participation under the Plan. (See Sections 2.02(d) and (e) of the Plan for rules regarding the effect on Plan participation if an Employee changes between an eligible and ineligible class of employment.)

 

o (a)                  No exclusions.

x (b)                Collectively Bargained Employees.

x (c)                 Non-resident aliens who receive no compensation from the Employer which constitutes U.S. source income.

o (d)                   Leased Employees.

o (e)                    Employees paid on an hourly basis.

o (f)                     Employees paid on a salaried basis.

o (g)                    Other:

 

SECTION 4
MINIMUM AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

 

4-1                              ELIGIBILITY REQUIREMENTS — MINIMUM AGE AND SERVICE: An Eligible Employee (as defined in AA §3-1) who satisfies the minimum age and service conditions under this AA §4-1 will be eligible to participate under the Plan as of his/her Entry Date (as defined in AA §4-2 below).

 

(a)                                 Service Requirement. An Eligible Employee must complete the following minimum service requirements to participate in the Plan.

 

x (1)                There is no minimum service requirement for participation in the Plan.

o (2)                  One Year of Service (as defined in Section 2.03(a)(1) of the Plan and AA §4-3).

o (3)                  The completion of at least      [cannot exceed 1,000] Hours of Service during the first            months of employment or the completion of a Year of Service (as defined in AA §4-3), if earlier. [If no minimum Hours of Service are required, insert one (1) in the second blank line.]

o (4)                  The completion of       [cannot exceed 1,000] Hours of Service during an Eligibility Computation Period. [If this (4) is chosen, an Employee satisfies the service requirement immediately upon completion of the designated Hours of Service.]

o (5)                  Two (2) Years of Service. [Full and immediate vesting must be chosen under AA §8.]

o (6)                  Under the Elapsed Time method. See AA §4-3(c) below.

 

o (7)                  Describe eligibility conditions:

 

[Note: Any conditions provided under (7) must be described in a manner that precludes Employer discretion, must satisfy the nondiscrimination requirements of §1.401(a)(4) of the regulations, and may not cause the Plan to violate the provisions of Code §410(a).]

 

(b)                                 Minimum Age Requirement. An Eligible Employee (as defined in AA §3-1) must have attained the following age to participate under the Plan.

 

x (1)     There is no minimum age for Plan eligibility.

o (2)      Age 21.

o (3)      Age 201/2.

o (4)      Age            (not later than age 21).

 

2



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Section 4 — Minimum Age and Service Requirements

 

4-2                            ENTRY DATE: An Eligible Employee (as defined in AA §3-1) who satisfies the minimum age and service requirements in AA §4-1 shall be eligible to participate in the Plan as of his/her Entry Date. For this purpose, the Entry Date is the following date. [Note: If any of (b)  (g) is completed, also complete one of (h)  (k).]

 

x (a)                Immediate. The date the minimum age and service requirements are satisfied (or date of hire, if no minimum age and service requirements apply).

o (b)                  Semi-annual. The first day of the 1st and 7th month of the Plan Year.

o (c)                   Quarterly. The first day of the 1st, 4th, 7th and 10th month of the Plan Year.

o (d)                  Monthly. The first day of each calendar month.

o (e)                   Payroll period. The first day of the payroll period.

o (f)                    The first day of the Plan Year. [if this (f) is checked, see Section 2.03(b)(2) of the Plan for special rules that apply.]

o (g)                   Describe Entry Date:

 

[Note: Any Entry Date designated in (g) must comply with the requirements of Code §410(a)(4) and must satisfy the nondiscrimination requirements under Treas. Reg. §1.401(a)(4). See Section 2.03(b) of the Plan.]

 

An Eligible Employee’s Entry Date (as defined above) is determined based on when the Employee satisfies the minimum age and service requirements in AA §4-1. For this purpose, an Employee’s Entry Date is the Entry Date:

 

o (h)      next following satisfaction of the minimum age and service requirements.

o (i)       coinciding with or next following satisfaction of the minimum age and service requirements.

o (j)       nearest the satisfaction of the minimum age and service requirements.

o (k)      preceding the satisfaction of the minimum age and service requirements.

 

4-3                              DEFAULT ELIGIBILITY RULES. In applying the minimum age and service requirements under AA §4-1 above, the following default rules apply:

 

·                 Year of Service. An Employee earns a Year of Service for eligibility purposes upon completing 1,000 Hours of Service during an Eligibility Computation Period. Hours of Service are calculated based on actual hours worked during the Eligibility Computation Period. (See Section 1.67 of the Plan for the definition of Hours of Service.)

 

·                 Eligibility Computation Period. If one Year of Service is required for eligibility, the Plan will determine subsequent Eligibility Computation Periods on the basis of Plan Years (see Section 2.03(a)(2)(i) of the Plan). If more than one Year of Service is required for eligibility, the Plan will determine subsequent Eligibility Computation Periods on the basis of Anniversary Years (see Section 2.03(a)(2)(ii) of the Plan).

 

·                 Break in Service Rules. The Nonvested Participant Break in Service rule and the One-Year Break in Service rule do NOT apply. (See Section 2.07 of the Plan.)

 

To override the default eligibility rules, complete the applicable sections of this AA §4-3. If this AA §4-3 is not completed, the default eligibility rules apply.

 

o (a)                  Year of Service. Instead of 1,000 Hours of Service, an Employee earns a Year of Service upon the completion of        [must be less than 1,000] Hours of Service during an Eligibility Computation Period.

 

o (b)                  Eligibility Computation Period (ECP). The Plan will use Anniversary Years, unless more than one Year of Service is required under AA §4-1(a), in which case the Plan will shift to Plan Years.

 

o (c)                   Elapsed Time method. [Check this (c) only if AA §4-1(a)(6) above is also checked.] Eligibility service will be determined under the Elapsed Time method. An Eligible Employee (as defined in AA §3-1) must complete a        [not to exceed 12] month period of service to participate in the Plan. (See Section 2.03(a)(5) of the Plan.)

 

x (d)                Equivalency Method. For purposes of determining an Employee’s Hours of service for eligibility, the plan will use the Equivalency Method (as defined in Section 2.03(a)(4) of the Plan). The Equivalency Method will apply to:

 

o (1)      All Employees.

x (2)     Only Employees for whom the Employer does not maintain hourly records. For Employees for whom the Employer maintains hourly records, eligibility will be determined based on actual hours worked.

 

If this (d) is checked, Hours of Service for eligibility will be determined under the following Equivalency Method.

 

x (3)     Monthly. 190 Hours of Service for each month worked.

o (4)      Daily. 10 Hours of Service for each day worked.

o (5)      Weekly. 45 Hours of Service for each week worked.

o (6)      Semi-monthly. 95 Hours of Service for each semi-monthly period worked.

 

o (e)                   Nonvested Participant Break in Service rule applies. Service earned prior to a Nonvested Participant Break in Service will be disregarded in applying the eligibility rules. (See Section 2.07(b) of the Plan.)

 

3



 

o (f)                    One-Year Break in Service rule applies. The One-Year Break in Service rule (as defined in Section 2.07(d) of the Plan) applies to temporarily disregard an Employee’s service earned prior to a one-year Break in Service.

 

4-4                              EFFECTIVE DATE OF MINIMUM AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS. The minimum age and/or service requirements under AA §4-1 apply to all Employees under the Plan. An Employee will participate as of his/her Entry Date, taking into account all service with the Employer, including service earned prior to the Effective Date.

 

To allow Employees hired on a specified date to enter the Plan without regard to the minimum age and/or service conditions, complete this AA §4-4.

 

x           An Eligible Employee who is employed by the Employer on the following date will become eligible to enter the Plan on such date:

 

o (a)      the Effective Date of this Plan (as designated in subsection (a) or (b) of the Employer Signature Page, as applicable)

x (b)     1-1-2013 [insert date]

 

An Eligible Employee who is employed on the designated date will become eligible to participate in the Plan without regard to the

 

x (c)      minimum service

x (d)     minimum age

requirements under AA §4-1 above.

 

4-5                              SERVICE WITH PREDECESSOR EMPLOYER. If the Employer is maintaining the Plan of a Predecessor Employer, service with such Predecessor Employer is automatically counted for eligibility, vesting and for purposes of applying any allocation conditions under AA §6-5.

 

In addition, service with the following Predecessor Employers also will be counted for purposes of determining eligibility, vesting and allocation conditions under this Plan. (See Sections 2.06, 3.09(d) and 7.06 of the Plan.)

 

o (a)                  Identify Predecessor Employer(s):

o (b)                  The following special rules apply:

 

[Use this (b) to impose limits on the service that will be taken into account with a Predecessor Employer for determining eligibility, vesting and allocation conditions. For example, if service with a Predecessor Employer will not be taken into account in the same manner in applying eligibility, vesting and allocation conditions, the limits applicable to such service may be identified in (b). Any limits imposed under this (b) may not cause the Plan to violate the nondiscrimination requirements under Treas. Reg. §1.401(a)(4).]

 

SECTION 5
COMPENSATION DEFINITIONS

 

5-1                              TOTAL COMPENSATION. Total Compensation is based on the definition set forth under this AA §5-1. See Section 1.123 of the Plan for a specific definition of the various types of Total Compensation.

 

x (a)     W-2 Wages

o (b)      Code §415 Compensation.

o (c)      Wages under Code §3401(a).

 

[For purposes of determining Total Compensation, each definition includes Elective Deferrals, pre-tax contributions to a Code §125 cafeteria plan or a Code §457 plan, and qualified transportation fringes under Code §132(f)(4).]

 

5-2                              PLAN COMPENSATION: Plan Compensation is Total Compensation (as defined in AA §5-1 above) with the following exclusions described below.

 

o (a)      No exclusions.

o (b)      Elective Deferrals (as defined in Section 1.48 of the Plan), pre-tax contributions to a cafeteria plan or a Code §457 plan, and qualified transportation fringes under Code §132(f)(4) are excluded.

o (c)      All fringe benefits, expense reimbursements, deferred compensation, and welfare benefits are excluded.

o (d)      Compensation above $          is excluded.

o (e)      Amounts received as a bonus are excluded.

 

4



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Section 5 — Compensation Definitions

 

o (f)                    Amounts received as commissions are excluded.

o (g)                   Overtime payments are excluded.

o (h)                  Amounts received for services performed for a non-signatory Related Employer are excluded.

o (i)                      “Deemed §125 compensation” as defined in Section 1.123 of the Plan.

o (j)                     Amounts received after termination of employment are excluded (see Section 1.123 of the Plan).

o (k)                  Differential Pay (as defined in Section 15.05(b) of the Plan)

x (l)                    Describe adjustments to Plan Compensation: telephone allowance, car allowance, and taxable amounts attributable to Group Term Life Insurance.

 

5-3                              PERIOD FOR DETERMINING COMPENSATION.

 

(a)              Compensation Period. Plan Compensation will be determined on the basis of the following period(s). [If (2), (3) or (4) is checked, any reference to the Plan Year as it refers to Plan Compensation will be deemed to be a reference to the period designated below.]

 

x (1)            The Plan Year.

o (2)            The calendar year ending in the Plan Year.

o (3)            The Employer’s fiscal tax year ending in the Plan Year.

o (4)            The 12-month period ending on          which ends during the Plan Year.

 

(b)              Compensation while a Participant. In determining Plan Compensation, only compensation earned while an individual is a Participant under the Plan will be taken into account.

 

To count compensation for the entire Plan Year, including compensation earned while an individual is not a Participant, check below.

 

o      All compensation earned during the Plan Year will be taken into account, including compensation earned while an individual is not a Participant.

 

SECTION 6
EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS

 

6-1                              EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS: The Employer will contribute to the Plan each Plan Year the amount determined under the Employer Contribution formula designated in AA §6-2 below.

 

6-2                              EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTION FORMULAS: For the period designated in AA §6-4 below, the Employer will make the following Employer Contributions on behalf of Participants who satisfy the allocation conditions designated in AA §6-5 below. Any Employer Contribution authorized under this AA §6-2 will be allocated in accordance with the allocation formula selected under AA §6-3.

 

x (a)     Discretionary contribution. The Employer will determine in its sole discretion how much, if any, it will make as an Employer Contribution.

 

o (b)      Fixed contribution.

 

o (1)               % of each Participant’s Plan Compensation.

o (2)      $        for each Participant.

 

o (c)     Describe:

 

6-3                              ALLOCATION FORMULA.

 

o (a)      Pro rata allocation. The Employer Contribution under AA §6-2 will be allocated as a uniform percentage of Plan Compensation or as a uniform dollar amount. If a fixed Employer Contribution is selected in AA §6-2(b), the Employer Contribution will be allocated in accordance with the selections made in AA §6-2(b).

 

5



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Section 6 — Employer Contributions

 

x (b)    Describe: The Employer Contribution under AA §6-2 will be allocated as a matching contribution to each Participant’s Account based on the amount each Participant contributes as an Employer Elective Contribution under the Veritex Community Bank 401(k) Plan. Additionally, the Employer will allocate such amount of the Employer Contribution under AA §6-2 as is not allocated as a matching contribution to each Participant’s Account as a uniform percentage of Plan Compensation or a uniform dollar amount.

 

[Note: Any allocation formula described in this subsection (b) must satisfy the definitely determinable allocation requirement under Treas. Reg. §1.401-1 (b)(1)(ii).]

 

6-4                              SPECIAL RULES. No special rules apply with respect to Employer Contributions under the Plan, except to the extent designated under this AA §6-4.

 

o (a)      Period for determining Employer Contributions. In determining the amount of the Employer Contributions to be allocated under this AA §6, the Employer Contribution will be based on Plan Compensation earned during the Plan Year.

 

Alternatively, the Employer may elect to base the Employer Contributions on Plan Compensation earned during the following period.

 

o (1)   Plan Year quarter

o (2)     calendar month

 

 

o (3)   payroll period o (4)

Other:        

 

[Note: Although Employer Contributions are determined on the basis of Plan Compensation earned during the period designated under this subsection (a), this does not require the Employer to actually make contributions or allocate contributions on the basis of such period. Employer Contributions may be contributed and allocated to Participants at any time within the contribution period permitted under Treas. Reg. §1.415-6, regardless of the period selected under this subsection (a).]

 

o (b)     Contribution limits. Employer Contributions will be limited as follows:                                                

 

o (c)     Top Heavy contribution. If this (c) is checked, any Top Heavy minimum contribution required under Section 4 of the Plan will be allocated to all Participants, including Key Employees.

 

6-5       ALLOCATION CONDITIONS. A Participant who has otherwise satisfied all conditions to receive an Employer Contribution, must satisfy any allocation conditions designated under this AA §6-5 to receive an allocation of Employer Contributions under the Plan. [Note: See AA §4-5 for treatment of service with Predecessor Employers for purposes of applying the allocation conditions under this AA §6-5.]

 

o (a)    No allocation conditions apply with respect to Employer Contributions under the Plan.

 

o (b)      Safe harbor allocation condition. An Employee must be employed by the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year OR must complete more than:

 

o (1)              (not to exceed 500) Hours of Service during the Plan Year.

 

o (2)              (not more than 91) consecutive days of employment with the Employer during the Plan Year.

 

x (c)      Employment condition. An Employee must be employed with the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year.

 

x (d)     Minimum service condition. An Employee must be credited with at least:

 

x (1)      1,000 Hours of Service (not to exceed 1,000) during the Plan Year.

 

o (2)              (not more than 182) consecutive days of employment with the Employer during the Plan Year.

 

o (e)      Application to a specified period. The allocation conditions selected under this AA §6-5 apply on the basis of the Plan Year. If the Employer will base its Employer Contributions on a periodic basis (as designated in AA §6-5(a)), this (e) may be checked to allow the allocation conditions under this AA §6-5 to be applied with respect to such period. (See Section 3.09(a) of the Plan.)

 

x (f)    Exceptions.

 

x (1)       The above allocation condition(s) will not apply if the Employee:

 

x (i)       dies during the Plan Year.

 

x (ii)      terminates employment due to becoming Disabled.

 

x (iii)     terminates employment after attainment of Normal Retirement Age in the current Plan Year or any prior Plan Year.

 

o (iv)     terminates employment after attainment of Early Retirement Age in the current Plan Year or any prior Plan Year.

 

6



 

o (2)        The exceptions selected under (f)(1) do not apply to:

 

o (i)       the employment condition under subsection (c) above.

 

o (ii)      the minimum service condition under subsection (d) above.

 

SECTION 7
RETIREMENT AGES

 

7-1        NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE: Normal Retirement Age under the Plan is:

 

x (a)                Age 65 (not to exceed 65).

 

o (b)                  The later of (1) age      (not to exceed 65) or (2) the     (not to exceed 5th) anniversary of the date the Employee commenced participation in the Plan.

 

o (c)                                                                            (may not be later than the maximum age permitted under subsection (b)).

 

7-2        EARLY RETIREMENT AGE:

 

o (a)      There is no Early Retirement Age under the Plan.

 

x (b)     A Participant reaches Early Retirement Age if he/she is still employed after attainment of each of the following:

 

x (1)    Attainment of age 591/2

 

o (2)     The        anniversary of the date the Employee commenced participation in the Plan, and/or

 

o (3)     The completion of        Years of Service, determined as follows:

 

o (i)         Same as for eligibility.

 

o (ii)        Same as for vesting.

 

SECTION 8
VESTING AND FORFEITURES

 

8-1          VESTING OF EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS. The Employer Contributions authorized under AA §6 will vest in accordance with the vesting schedule designated under AA §8-2 and AA §8-3, as applicable.

 

8-2          VESTING SCHEDULE. See Section 7.02(a) of the Plan for a description of the various vesting schedules under this AA §8-2.

 

o (a)    Full and immediate vesting.

 

o (b)    Three-year cliff vesting schedule

 

o (c)     Six-year graded vesting schedule

 

x (d)    Modified vesting schedule

 

20% after 1 Year of Service

40% after 2 Years of Service

60% after 3 Years of Service

80% after 4 Years of Service

100% after 5 Years of Service

100% after 6 Years of Service

 

[Note: If a modified vesting schedule is selected, the vested percentage for every Year of Service must satisfy the vesting requirements under the 6-year graded vesting schedule, unless 100% vesting occurs after no more than 3 Years of Service.]

 

7


 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Section 8 — Vesting and Forfeitures

 

8-3                              TOP HEAVY VESTING SCHEDULE. The schedule elected in AA §8-2 also applies when the Plan is a Top-Heavy Plan.

 

8-4                              VESTING SERVICE. In applying the vesting schedules under this AA §8, the following service with the Employer is excluded.

 

x (a)                None, all service with the Employer counts for vesting purposes.

 

o (b)                  Service before the original Effective Date of this Plan (or a Predecessor Plan) is excluded.

 

o (c)                Service completed before the Employee’s                     (not to exceed 18th) birthday is excluded.

 

[Note: See Section 7.06 of the Plan and AA §4-5 for rules regarding the crediting of service with Predecessor Employers for purposes of vesting under the Plan.]

 

8-5                              VESTING UPON DEATH, DISABILITY OR EARLY RETIREMENT AGE. An Employee’s vesting percentage increases to 100% if, while employed with the Employer, the Employee

 

x (a)                dies

 

x (b)                terminates employment due to becoming Disabled

 

o (c)                   reaches Early Retirement Age

 

8-6                              MODIFICATION OF DEFAULT VESTING RULES. In applying the vesting requirements under this AA §8, the following default rules apply.

 

·                 Year of Service. An Employee earns a Year of Service for vesting purposes upon completing 1,000 Hours of Service during a Vesting Computation Period. Hours of Service are calculated based on actual hours worked during the Vesting Computation Period.

·                 Vesting Computation Period. The Vesting Computation Period is the Plan Year.

·                 Break in Service Rules. The Nonvested Participant Break in Service rule and One-Year Break in Service rules do NOT apply. (See Section 7.07 of the Plan.)

 

To override the default vesting rules, complete the applicable sections of this AA §8-6. If this AA §8-6 is not completed, the default vesting rules apply.

 

o (a)                  Year of Service. Instead of 1,000 Hours of Service, an Employee earns a Year of Service upon the completion of              [must be less than 1,000] Hours of Service during a Vesting Computation Period.

 

o (b)                  Vesting Computation Period (VCP). Instead of the Plan Year, the Vesting Computation Period is:

 

o (1)                  The 12-month period beginning with the anniversary of the Employee’s date of hire.

 

o (2)               Describe:                                                                                                                    

 

[Note: Any Vesting Computation Period described in (2) must be a 12-consecutive month period and must apply uniformly to all Participants.]

 

o (c)                   Elapsed Time Method. Vesting service will be determined under the Elapsed Time Method. (See Section 7.03(b) of the Plan.)

 

o (d)                  Equivalency Method. For purposes of determining an Employee’s Hours of Service for vesting, the Plan will use the Equivalency Method (as defined in Section 7.03(a)(2) of the Plan). The Equivalency Method will apply to:

 

o (1)                  All Employees.

 

o (2)                  Only to Employees for whom the Employer does not maintain hourly records. For Employees for whom the Employer maintains hourly records, vesting will be determined based on actual hours worked.

 

If this (d) is checked, Hours of Service for vesting will be determined under the following Equivalency Method.

 

o (3)                  Monthly. 190 Hours of Service for each month worked.

 

o (4)                  Daily. 10 Hours of Service for each day worked.

 

o (5)                  Weekly. 45 Hours of Service for each week worked.

 

o (6)                  Semi-monthly. 95 Hours of Service for each semi-monthly period.

 

o (e)                   Nonvested Participant Break in Service rule applies. Service earned prior to a Nonvested Participant Break in Service will be disregarded in applying the vesting rules. (See Section 7.07(c) of the Plan).

 

o (f)                    One-Year Break in Service rule applies. The One-Year Break in Service rule (as defined in Section 7.07(b) of the Plan) applies to temporarily disregard an Employee’s service earned prior to a one-year Break in Service.

 

8



 

x (g)                 Special vesting provisions. No special vesting provisions apply unless designated under this subsection (g): In the event the Employer acquires another organization, for purposes of calculating the Years of Service for vesting purposes,  the number of Years of Service shall be counted from the date of the Employer’s acquisition of the other organization.  If a “Change of Control” occurs, each Participant in the Plan shall become 100% vested in their accounts. For this  purpose, “Change of Control” shall mean: (i) the consummation of a merger or consolidation of the Employer with or  into another entity or any other Company reorganization, if persons who were not stockholders of the Company  immediately prior to such merger, consolidation or other reorganization own immediately after such merger,  consolidation or other reorganization 50% or more of the voting power of the outstanding securities of each of (A) the  continuing or surviving entity and (B) any direct or indirect parent corporation of such continuing or surviving entity; or (ii) the sale, transfer or disposition of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets.

 

[Note: Any special vesting provision designated in subsection (g) must satisfy the requirements of Code §411(a) and must satisfy the nondiscrimination requirements under §1.401(a)(4) of the regulations.]

 

8-7                              ALLOCATION OF FORFEITURES. Any forfeitures occurring during a Plan Year will be:

 

o (a)                  Reallocated as additional Employer Contributions.

 

x (b)                Used to reduce Employer Contributions.

 

For purposes of this AA § 8-7, forfeitures will be applied:

 

x (c)                 for the Plan Year in which the forfeiture occurs.

 

o (d)                  for the Plan Year following the Plan Year in which the forfeitures occur.

 

Prior to applying forfeitures under this AA §8-7:

 

x (e)                 Forfeitures will be used to pay Plan expenses.

 

o (f)                    Forfeitures will not be used to pay Plan expenses.

 

8-8                              CASH-OUT RULES. If a terminated Participant receives a complete distribution of his/her vested Account Balance while still entitled to an additional allocation, the Cash-Out Distribution forfeiture provisions do not apply until the Participant receives a distribution of the additional amounts to be allocated. (See Section 7.10(a)(1) of the Plan.)

 

To modify the default Cash-Out Distribution forfeiture rules, complete this AA §8-8.

 

o                                    The Cash-Out Distribution forfeiture provisions will apply if a terminated Participant takes a complete distribution, regardless of any additional allocations during the Plan Year.

 

SECTION 9
DISTRIBUTION PROVISIONS — TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT

 

9-1                              AVAILABLE FORMS OF DISTRIBUTION.

 

Lump sum distribution. A Participant may take a distribution of his/her entire vested Account Balance in a single lump sum. The Plan Administrator may, in its discretion, permit Participants to take distributions of less than their entire vested Account Balance provided, if the Plan Administrator permits multiple distributions, all Participants are allowed to take multiple distributions upon termination of employment. In addition, the Plan Administrator may permit a Participant to take an installment distribution solely to the extent necessary to satisfy the required minimum distribution rules under Section 8 of the Plan. (See Section 8.03 of the Plan for special rules regarding the distribution of Company Stock.)

 

Additional distribution options. To provide for additional distribution options, check the applicable distribution forms under this AA §9-1. If a lump sum distribution will not be provided under the Plan, check (c) below and indicate that no lump sum distribution is available under the Plan.

 

o (a)                  Installment distributions. A Participant may take a distribution over a specified period not to exceed the life or life expectancy of the Participant (and a designated beneficiary).

 

o (b)                  Annuity distributions. A Participant may elect to have the Plan Administrator use the Participant’s vested Account Balance to purchase an annuity as described in Section 8.02 of the Plan.

 

x (c)                 Describe: Partial withdrawals for Required Minimum Distributions.

[Note: Any distribution option described in (c) will apply uniformly to all Participants under the Plan.]

 

9



 

[Name of Plan]

Section 9 – Distribution Provisions

 

9-2               QUALIFIED JOINT AND SURVIVOR ANNUITY RULES. This Plan is not subject to the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity rules, except to the extent required under Section 9.01 of the Plan (e.g., if the Plan is a Transferee Plan). Upon termination of employment, a Participant may receive a distribution from the Plan, in accordance with the provisions of AA §9-3, in any form allowed under AA §9-1. (If any portion of this Plan is subject to the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity rules, the QJSA and QPSA provisions will automatically apply to such portion of the Plan.)

 

To override this default provision, complete the applicable sections of this AA §9-2.

 

o (a)                  Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity rules. Check this (a) to apply the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity rules to the entire Plan. If this (a) is checked, all distributions from the Plan must satisfy the QJSA and QPSA requirements under Section 9 of the Plan, with the following modifications:

 

o (1)                  No modifications.

 

o (2)                  Modified QJSA benefit. Instead of a 50% survivor benefit, the spouse’s survivor benefit is:

 

o (i)                      100%.             o (ii)                   75%.                    o (iii)                66-2/3%.

 

o (3)                  Modified QPSA benefit. Instead of a 50% QPSA benefit, the QPSA benefit is 100% of the Participant’s vested Account Balance.

 

o (b)                  One-year marriage rule. The one-year marriage rule does not apply unless this (b) is checked. See Section
9.04(c)(2) of the Plan.

 

9-3                    TIMING OF DISTRIBUTIONS UPON TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT.

 

(a)         Distribution of vested Account Balances exceeding $5,000. A Participant who terminates employment with a vested Account Balance exceeding $5,000 may receive a distribution of his/her vested Account Balance in any form permitted under AA §9-1 within a reasonable period following:

 

x (1)                the date the Participant terminates employment.

 

o (2)                  the last day of the Plan Year during which the Participant terminates employment.

 

o (3)                  the first Valuation Date following the Participant’s termination of employment.

 

o (4)                  the completion of                        Breaks in Service.

 

o (5)                  the end of the calendar quarter following the date the Participant terminates employment.

 

o (6)                  attainment of Normal Retirement Age, death or becoming Disabled.

 

o(7)                     Describe:                                                                                           
[Note: Any distribution event described in (7) will apply uniformly to all Participants under the Plan.]

 

(b)         Distribution of vested Account Balances not exceeding $5,000. A Participant who terminates employment with a vested Account Balance that does not exceed $5,000 may receive a lump sum distribution of his/her vested Account Balance within a reasonable period following:

 

x (1)                the date the Participant terminates employment.

 

o (2)                  the last day of the Plan Year during which the Participant terminates employment.

 

o (3)                  the first Valuation Date following the Participant’s termination of employment.

 

o (4)                  Describe:                                                                                                     
[Note: Any distribution event described in (4) will apply uniformly to all Participants under the Plan.]

 

9-4                    DISTRIBUTION UPON DISABILITY

 

(a)         Termination of Disabled Employee. A Participant who terminates employment on account of becoming Disabled may receive a distribution of his/her vested Account Balance in the same manner as a regular distribution upon termination, unless provided otherwise under this AA §9-4(a).

 

o (1)                  Distribution will be made as soon as reasonable following the date the Participant terminates on account of becoming Disabled.

 

o (2)                  Distribution will be made as soon as reasonable following the last day of the Plan Year during which the Participant terminates on account of becoming Disabled.

 

o (3)                  Describe:                                                                                                           
[Note: Any distribution event described in (3) will apply uniformly to all Participants under the Plan.]

 

10



 

(b)                                 Definition of Disabled. A Participant is treated as Disabled if such Participant satisfies the conditions in Section 1.38 of the Plan.

 

To override this default definition, check below and insert the definition of Disabled to be used under the Plan.

 

o                      Alternative definition of Disabled:

 

9-5                              SPECIAL RULES.

 

(a)                                 Availability of Involuntary Cash-Out Distributions. A Participant who terminates employment with a vested Account Balance of $5,000 or less will receive an Involuntary Cash-Out Distribution, subject to the Automatic Rollover provisions under Section 8.07 of the Plan.

 

Alternatively, an Involuntary Cash-Out Distribution will be made to the following terminated Participants.

 

o (1)                  No Involuntary Cash-Out Distributions. The Plan does not provide for Involuntary Cash-Out Distributions.A terminated Participant must consent to any distribution from the Plan. (See Section 14.03(b) of the Plan for special rules upon Plan termination.)

 

o (2)                  Lower Involuntary Cash-Out Distribution threshold. A terminated Participant will receive an Involuntary Cash-Out Distribution only if the Participant’s vested Account Balance is less than or equal to:

 

o (i) $1,000

 

o (ii) $            (must be less than $5,000)

 

(b)                                 Application of Automatic Rollover rules. The Automatic Rollover rules described in Section 8.07 of the Plan do not apply to any Involuntary Cash-Out Distribution below $1,000 (to the extent available under the Plan).

 

To override this default provision, check this subsection (b).

 

o                                    Check this (b) to apply the Automatic Rollover provisions under Section 8.07 of the Plan to all Involuntary Cash-Out Distributions (including those below $1,000).

 

(c)                                  Treatment of Rollover Contributions. Unless elected otherwise under this (c), Rollover Contributions will be excluded in determining whether a Participant’s vested Account Balance exceeds the Involuntary Cash-Out threshold for purposes of applying the distribution rules under this AA §9 and Section 8.05(a) of the Plan. To include Rollover Contributions for purposes of applying the Plan’s distribution rules, check below.

 

o                                    In determining whether a Participant’s vested Account Balance exceeds the Involuntary Cash-Out threshold, Rollover Contributions will be included.

 

[Note: This (c) should be checked if a lower Involuntary Cash-Out Distribution is selected in (a)(2) above in order to avoid the Automatic Rollover provisions described in Section 8.07 of the Plan. Failure to check this (c) could cause the Plan to be subject to the Automatic Rollover provisions if a Participant receives a distribution attributable to Rollover Contributions that exceeds $1,000.]

 

(d)                                 Distribution upon attainment of stated age. A Participant must consent to a distribution from the Plan at any time prior to attainment of the Participant’s Required Beginning Date.

 

To allow for involuntary distribution upon attainment of Normal Retirement Age (or age 62, if later), check below.

 

o                                    A distribution from the Plan will be made to a terminated Participant without the Participant’s consent, regardless of the value of such Participant’s vested Account Balance, upon attainment of Normal Retirement Age (or age 62, if later).

 

9-6                              MODIFICATION OF DIVERSIFICATION ELECTION. A Participant’s diversification election under Section 12.06 is modified in the following manner:

 

o (a)                  Distribution in Company Stock. Any distribution made under Section 12.06(a)(2) will be made in whole shares of Company Stock with fractional shares paid in cash. [If this (a) is not checked, any distribution made under Section 12.06(a)(2) will be paid in cash.]

 

o (b)                  Modification of available options. The diversification options in Section 12.06 are modified as follows:

 

 

[This (b) may be used to modify or limit the availability of any of the diversification options listed in Section 12.06 of the BPD. For example, this (b) may be used to restrict the ability of Qualified Participants’ to direct the investment of their Company Stock Account as permitted under Section 1 2.06(a)(1) of the BPD.]

 

11



 

9-7                              DISTRIBUTION OF S CORPORATION STOCK. If the Plan holds S Corporation stock, a Participant may elect to receive a distribution in cash or stock, unless designated otherwise under this AA §9-7.

 

o                 If the Plan holds S Corporation stock, a Participant may only receive a distribution in the form of cash, without regard to any Participant election to the contrary. [Note: This AA §9-7 only applies if the Employer has made an election under Code §1362(a) to be taxed as an S Corporation.]

 

SECTION 10

IN-SERVICE DISTRIBUTIONS AND REQUIRED MINIMUM DISTRIBUTIONS

 

10-1                       AVAILABILITY OF IN-SERVICE DISTRIBUTIONS. A Participant may withdraw all or any portion of his/her vested Account Balance, to the extent designated, upon the occurrence of the event(s) selected under this AA §10-1.

 

x (a)                No in-service distributions are permitted.

 

o (b)                  Attainment of age         .

 

o (c)                   A Hardship (that satisfies the safe harbor rules under Section 8.11(d)(1) of the Plan).

 

o (d)                  A non-safe harbor Hardship described in Section 8.11(d)(2) of the Plan.

 

o (e)                   Attainment of Normal Retirement Age.

 

o (f)                    Attainment of Early Retirement Age.

 

o (g)               The Participant has participated in the Plan for at least                    (cannot be less than 60) months.

 

o (h)                  The amounts being withdrawn have been held in the Trust for at least two years.

 

o (i)                      Describe:

 

10-2                       SPECIAL DISTRIBUTION RULES. No special distribution rules apply, unless specifically provided under this AA §10-2.

 

o (a)                  In-service distributions will only be permitted if the Participant is 100% vested in the amounts being withdrawn.

 

o (b)              A Participant may take no more than               in-service distribution(s) in a Plan Year.

 

o (c)               A Participant may not take an in-service distribution of less than $                     (may not exceed $1,000).

 

o (d)                  If a Hardship distribution is permitted in AA §10-1 above, a Participant may take such a Hardship distribution after termination of employment.

 

o (e)                   If a Hardship distribution is permitted in AA §10-1, the hardship distribution provisions apply with respect to primary beneficiaries as described in Section 8.11(d)(4) of the Plan.

 

o (f)                    Describe:

[Note: Any special rules described in (f) will apply uniformly to all Participants under the Plan.]

 

10-3                       REQUIRED BEGINNING DATE – NON-5% OWNERS. In applying the required minimum distribution rules under Section 8.13 of the Plan, the Required Beginning Date for non-5% owners is:

 

x (a)                the later of attainment of age 701/2 or termination of employment.

 

o (b)                  the date the Employee attains age 701/2, even if the Employee is still employed with the Employer.

 

10-4                       REQUIRED DISTRIBUTIONS AFTER DEATH. If a Participant dies before distributions begin and there is a Designated Beneficiary, the Participant or Beneficiary may elect on an individual basis whether the 5-year rule (as described in Section 8.13(e)(1) of the Plan) or the life expectancy method described under Sections 8.13(a) and (c) of the Plan apply. (See Section 8.13(e)(2) of the Plan for rules regarding the timing of an election authorized under this AA §10-4.)

 

Alternatively, if selected below, any death distributions to a Designated Beneficiary will be made under the 5-year rule (as described in Section 8.13(e)(1) of the Plan.

 

o            The five-year rule under Section 8.13(e)(1) of the Plan applies (instead of the life expectancy method). This election applies to:

 

o (a)                  All distributions.

 

o (b)                  The following distributions:

 

12



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Section 11 — Miscellaneous Provisions

 

SECTION 11

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

 

11-1                       VALUATION DATES. The Plan is valued annually, as of the last day of the Plan Year. In addition, the Plan will be valued on the following dates: (See Section 10.02 of the Plan for valuation rules that apply with respect to the Company Stock Account.)

 

o (a)                  Daily. The Plan is valued at the end of each business day during which the New York Stock Exchange is open.

 

o (b)                  Monthly. The Plan is valued at the end of each month of the Plan Year.

 

o (c)                   Quarterly. The Plan is valued at the end of each Plan Year quarter.

 

o (d)                  Describe:

 

[Note: The Employer may elect operationally to perform interim valuations, provided such valuations do not result in discrimination in favor of Highly Compensated Employees.]

 

11-2                       DEFINITION OF HIGHLY COMPENSATED EMPLOYEE. In determining which Employees are Highly Compensated (as defined in Section 1.65 of the Plan), the following rules apply:

 

x (a)                     The Top-Paid Group Test does not apply.

 

o (b)                       The Top-Paid Group Test applies.

 

o (c)                   The Calendar Year Election applies. [This (c) may be chosen only if the Plan Year is not the calendar year. If this (c) is not selected, the determination of Highly Compensated Employees is based on the Plan Year. See Section 1.65(d) of the Plan.]

 

11-3                       SPECIAL RULES FOR APPLYING THE CODE §415 LIMITATION. The provisions under Section 5.03 of the Plan apply for purposes of determining the Code §415 Limitation.

 

Complete this AA §11-3 to override the default provisions that apply in determining the Code §415 Limitation under Section 5.03 of the Plan.

 

o (a)              Limitation Year. Instead of the Plan Year, the Limitation Year is the 12-month period ending           .

 

[Note: If the Plan has a short Plan Year for the first year of establishment, the Limitation Year is deemed to be the 12-month period ending on the last day of the short Plan Year, unless provided otherwise in (c) below.]

 

o (b)                  Imputed compensation. For purposes of applying the Code §415 Limitation, Total Compensation includes imputed compensation for a Nonhighly Compensated Participant who terminates employment on account of becoming Disabled. (See Section 5.03(c)(7)(iii) of the Plan.)

 

o (c)                   Inclusion of Forfeitures and Interest from Annual Additions. If this subsection (c) is checked, forfeitures of Company Stock that was acquired with the proceeds of a loan described under Code §404(a)(9)(A) and Employer Contributions which are deductible under Code §404(a)(9)(B and charged against the Particpant’s Account are treated as Annual Additions.

 

[Note: If this (c) is not checked, such forfeitures and Employer Contributions are not treated as Annual Additions provided no more than 1/3 of the Employer Contributions for a Limitation Year which are deductible under Code §404(a)(9) are allocated to Highly Compensated Employees. See Section 5.03(c)(1) of the Plan.]

 

o (d)                  Special rules. Instead of the default provisions under Article 5.03 of the Plan, the following rules apply:

 

13



 

11-4                       SPECIAL RULES FOR MORE THAN ONE PLAN.

 

(a)                                 Top Heavy minimum contribution — Defined Contribution Plan. If the Employer maintains this Plan and one or more Defined Contribution Plans, any Top Heavy minimum contributions will be provided under this Plan. (See Section 4.04(e)(1) of the Plan.)

 

To provide the Top Heavy minimum contributions under another Defined Contribution Plan, complete (1) and/or (2) below:

 

x (1)                The Top Heavy minimum contribution will be provided in the following Defined Contribution Plan maintained by the Employer: Veritex Community Bank 401(k) Plan

 

o (2)                  Describe any special rules for providing the Top Heavy minimum contribution:

 

(b)                                 Top Heavy minimum contribution — Defined Benefit Plan. If the Employer maintains this Plan and one or more Defined Benefit Plans, any Top Heavy minimum contributions will be provided under this Plan, but the minimum required contribution is increased from 3% to 5% of Total Compensation for the Plan Year. (See Section 4.04(e)(2) of the Plan.)

 

To provide the Top Heavy minimum benefit under a Defined Benefit Plan, complete (1) and/or (2) below:

 

o (1)                  The Top Heavy minimum benefit will be provided in the following Defined Benefit Plan maintained by the Employer:

 

o (2)                  Describe any special rules for providing the Top Heavy minimum contribution:

 

(c)                                  Code §415 Limitation. If the Employer maintains another Defined Contribution Plan in which any Participant is a participant, the rules set forth under Section 5.03(b)(5) of the Plan apply.

 

To modify the default provisions under Section 5.03(b)(5) of the Plan, designate how such rules will apply.

 

o                                    Instead of applying the default rules under Section 5.03(b)(5) of the Plan, the Employer will limit Annual Additions in the following manner:

 

[Note: Any method designated above must provide for the proper reduction of any Excess Amounts and must preclude Employer discretion.]

 

11-5                       FAIL-SAFE COVERAGE PROVISION. If the Plan fails the minimum coverage test under Code §410(b) due to the application of an allocation condition under AA §6-5, the Employer must amend the Plan in accordance with the provisions of Section 14.02(a) of the Plan to correct the coverage violation.

 

Alternatively, the Employer may elect under subsection (a) or (b) below to apply a Fail-Safe Coverage Provision that will allow the Plan to automatically correct the minimum coverage violation.

 

o (a)                  The Fail-Safe Coverage Provision applies based on service with the Employer. (See Section 14.02(b)(1) of the Plan.)

 

o (b)                  The Fail-Safe Coverage Provision applies based on Plan Compensation. (See Section 14.02(b)(2) of the Plan).

 

[Note: Do not check (a) or (b) if the Fail-Safe Coverage Provision does not apply. If the Fail-Safe Coverage Provision applies, the Plan may not perform the average benefit test to demonstrate compliance with the coverage requirements under Code §410(b), except as provided in Section 14.02 of the Plan.]

 

11-6                       ELECTION NOT TO PARTICIPATE (see Section 2.08 of the Plan). All Participants share in any allocation under this Plan and no Employee may waive out of Plan participation.

 

To allow Employees to make a one-time irrevocable waiver, check below.

 

o            An Employee may make a one-time irrevocable election not to participate under the Plan at any time prior to the time the Employee first becomes eligible to participate under the Plan. [Note: Use of this provision could result in a violation of the minimum coverage rules under Code §410(b).]

 

11-7                       PROTECTED BENEFITS. There are no protected benefits (as described in Code §411(d)(6)) other than those described in the Plan.

 

To designate protected benefits other than those described in the Plan, check the box below and describe the protected benefits in an Addendum to this Agreement.

 

o            Additional protected benefits are provided to Participants in addition to those described in the Plan. See the Addendum attached to this Adoption Agreement for a description of such protected benefits.

 

14



 

11-8                       HEART ACT PROVISIONS — BENEFIT ACCRUALS. The benefit accrual provisions under Section 15.05(a) of the Plan do not apply. To apply the benefit accrual provisions under Section 15.05(a), check the box below.

 

o                                    Eligibility for Plan benefits. Check this box if the Plan will provide the benefits described in Section 15.05(a) of the Plan. If this box is checked, an individual who dies or becomes disabled in qualified military service will be treated as reemployed for purposes of determining entitlement to benefits under the Plan.

 

15


 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Appendix A — Special Effective Dates

 

APPENDIX A
SPECIAL EFFECTIVE DATES

 

o A-1                                Eligible Employees. The definition of Eligible Employee under AA §3 is effective as follows:

 

 

o A-2                                Minimum age and service conditions. The minimum age and service conditions Entry Date provisions specified in AA §4 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-3                                Compensation definitions. The compensation definitions under AA §5 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-4                                Employer Contributions. The Employer Contribution provisions under AA §6 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-5                                Retirement ages. The retirement age provisions under AA §7 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-6                                Vesting and forfeiture rules. The rules regarding vesting and forfeitures under AA §8 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-7                                Distribution provisions. The distribution provisions under AA §9 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-8                                In-service distributions and Required Minimum Distributions. The provisions regarding in-service distribution and Required Minimum Distributions under AA §10 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-9                                Miscellaneous provisions. The provisions under AA §11 are effective as follows:

 

 

o A-10                         Special effective date provisions for merged plans. If any qualified retirement plans have been merged into this Plan, the provisions of Section 14.04 of the Plan apply, except as follows:

 

 

o A-1 1                      Other special effective dates:

 

 

A-1



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Appendix B — Loan Policy

 

APPENDIX B
LOAN POLICY

 

B-1                            Are PARTICIPANT LOANS permitted? (See Section 13 of the Plan.)

o (a)                  Yes.                         x (b)                No.

 

B-2                            LOAN PROCEDURES.

 

o (a)                  Loans will be provided under the default loan procedures set forth in Section 13 of the Plan, unless modified under this Appendix B.

 

o (b)                  Loans will be provided under a separate written loan policy. [If this (b) is checked, do not complete the remainder of this Appendix B.]

 

B-3                            LOAN LIMITS. The default loan policy under Section 13.03 of the Plan allows Participants to take a loan provided all outstanding loans do not exceed 50% of the Participant’s vested Account Balance. To override the default loan policy to allow loans up to $10,000, even if greater than 50% of the Participant’s vested Account Balance, check box below.

 

o                                    A Participant may take a loan equal to the greater of $10,000 or 50% of the Participant’s vested Account Balance. [If this AA §B-3 is checked, the Participant may be required to provide adequate security as required under Section 13.06 of the Plan.]

 

B-4                            NUMBER OF LOANS. The default loan policy under Section 13.04 of the Plan restricts Participants to one loan outstanding at any time. To override the default loan policy and permit Participants to have more than one loan outstanding at any time, complete (a) or (b) below.

 

o (a)                  A Participant may have            loans outstanding at any time.

 

o (b)                  There are no restrictions on the number of loans a Participant may have outstanding at any time.

 

B-5                            INTEREST RATE. The default loan policy under Section 13.05 of the Plan provides for an interest rate commensurate with the interest rates charged by local commercial banks for similar loans. To override the default loan policy and provide a specific interest rate to be charged on Participant loans, complete this AA §B-5.

 

o (a)                  The prime interest rate

 

o (1)                  plus          percentage point(s).

 

o (b)                  Describe:

 

B-6                            MINIMUM LOAN AMOUNT. The default loan policy under Section 13.04 of the Plan provides that a Participant may not receive a loan of less than $1,000. To modify the minimum loan amount, complete (a) or (b) below.

 

o (a)                  There is no minimum loan amount.

 

o (b)                  The minimum loan amount is $          .

 

B-7                            PURPOSE OF LOAN. The default loan policy under Section 13.02 of the Plan provides that a Participant may receive a Participant loan for any purpose. To modify the default loan policy to restrict the availability of Participant loans, complete (a) or (b) below.

 

o (a)                  A Participant may only receive a Participant loan upon the demonstration of a hardship event, as described in Section 8.11(d)(1)(i) of the Plan.

 

o (b)                  A Participant may only receive a Participant loan under the following circumstances:

 

B-1



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Appendix C — Administrative Elections

 

APPENDIX C
ADMINISTRATIVE ELECTIONS

 

Use this Appendix C to identify certain elections dealing with the administration of the Plan. These elections may be changed without reexecuting this Agreement by substituting an updated Appendix C with new elections.

 

C-1                            DIRECTION OF INVESTMENTS. Are Participants permitted to direct investments? (See Section 10.08 of the Plan.)

 

x (a)                No

 

o (b)                  Yes

 

o                                    Check this selection if the Plan is intended to comply with ERISA §404(c). (See Section 10.08(d) of the Plan.)

 

[Note: A Participant must have the right to direct the investment of his/her ESOP Contributions (as designated under AA §2-4) to the extent required under Section 12.06 of the Plan. This AA §C-1 may be completed to permit directed investments of ESOP Contributions prior to the required diversification under Section 12.06 of the Plan or to allow Participants to direct the investment of non-ESOP Contributions.]

 

C-2                            ROLLOVER CONTRIBUTIONS. Does the Plan accept Rollover Contributions? (See Section 3.07 of the Plan.)

 

x (a)                No

 

o (b)                  Yes

 

[Note: The Employer may designate in separate written procedures the extent to which it will accept rollovers from designated plan types. For example, the Employer may decide not to accept rollovers from certain designated plans (e.g., 403(b) plans, §457 plans or IRAs). Any special rollover procedures will apply uniformly to all Participants under the Plan.]

 

C-3                            QDRO PROCEDURES. Do the default QDRO procedures under Section 11.06 of the Plan apply?

 

o (a)                  No

 

x (b)                Yes

 

C-1



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Appendix D — Allocation Conditions

 

APPENDIX D
ALLLOCATION CONDITIONS

 

Special provision with respect to Section 6-5, Allocation Conditions.

 

To the extent Company Stock is purchased with the proceeds of an Exempt Loan (as defined in Section 12.05) and such Company Stock is held in a Suspense Account pending repayment of the Exempt Loan, Malcolm Holland shall not receive an allocation of Employer Contributions under the Plan.

 

D-1



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Employer Signature Page

 

EMPLOYER SIGNATURE PAGE

 

PURPOSE OF EXECUTION. This Signature Page is being executed for Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan to effect:

 

x (a)

 

The adoption of a new plan, effective

01-01-2012

 

[insert Effective Date of Plan].

 

o (b)

 

The restatement of an existing plan, effective

 

 

[insert Effective Date of Plan].

 

(1) Name of Plan(s) being restated:

 

(2) The original effective date of the plan(s) being restated:

 

o (c)                   An amendment of the Plan. If this Plan is being amended, the updated pages of the Adoption Agreement may be substituted for the original pages in the Adoption Agreement. All prior Signature Pages should be retained as part of this Adoption Agreement.

 

(1)                       Identify the Adoption Agreement section(s) being amended:

 

(2)                       Effective Date(s) of such changes:

 

o (d)                  To identify a Successor Employer. Check this selection if a successor to the signatory Employer is continuing this Plan as a Successor Employer. Complete this Signature Page and substitute a new page I under this Adoption Agreement to identify the Successor Employer. All prior Signature Pages should be retained as part of this Adoption Agreement.

 

(1)                     Effective Date of the amendment is:

 

By signing this Adoption Agreement, the Employer intends to adopt the provisions as set forth in this Adoption Agreement and the ESOP Basic Plan Document — Cycle A. It is recommended that the Employer consult with legal counsel before executing this Adoption Agreement.

 

Veritex Community Bank

 

 

(Name of Employer)

 

 

 

 

 

C. Malcolm Holland

 

CEO

(Name of authorized representative)

 

(Title)

 

 

 

/s/ C. Malcolm Holland

 

12-31-12

(Signature)

 

(Date)

 

ER-1



 

Veritex Community Bank Employee Stock Ownership Plan

Trustee Declaration

 

TRUSTEE DECLARATION

 

Effective date of Trustee Declaration:

01-01-2012

 

 

The Trustee’s investment powers are:

 

x (a)                Discretionary. The Trustee has discretion to invest Plan assets, unless specifically directed otherwise by the Plan Administrator, the Employer, an Investment Manager or other Named Fiduciary or, to the extent authorized under the Plan, a Plan Participant.

 

o (b)                  Nondiscretionary. The Trustee may only invest Plan assets as directed by the Plan Administrator, the Employer, an Investment Manager or other Named Fiduciary or, to the extent authorized under the Plan, a Plan Participant.

 

o (c)                   Determined under a separate trust agreement. The Trustee’s investment powers are determined under a separate trust document which replaces (or is adopted in conjunction with) the trust provisions under the Plan.

 

Trustee Signature. By executing this Adoption Agreement, the designated Trustee(s) accept the responsibilities and obligations set forth under the Plan and Adoption Agreement.

 

C. Malcolm Holland

 

 

(Print name of Trustee)

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ C. Malcolm Holland

 

12-31-12

(Signature of Trustee or authorized representative)

 

(Date)

 

TD-1




EXHIBIT 10.6

 

SMALL BUSINESS LENDING FUND — SECURITIES PURCHASE AGREEMENT

 

Veritex Holdings, Inc.

 

0078

Name of Company

 

SBLF No.

 

10000 N. Central Expressway, Suite 1325

 

Corporation

Street Address for Notices

 

Organizational Form (e.g., corporation, national bank)

 

 

 

Dallas

Texas

75231

 

Texas

City

State

Zip Code

 

Jurisdiction of Organization

 

 

 

 

 

Thomas R. Freas

 

Federal Reserve

Name of Contact Person to Receive Notices

 

Appropriate Federal Banking Agency

 

 

 

 

972-674-4399

 

972-674-4378

 

August 25, 2011

Fax Number for Notices

 

Phone Number for Notices

 

Effective Date

 

THIS SECURITIES PURCHASE AGREEMENT (the “Agreement”) is made as of the Effective Date set forth above (the “Signing Date”) between the Secretary of the Treasury (“Treasury”) and the Company named above (the “Company”), an entity existing under the laws of the Jurisdiction of Organization stated above in the Organizational Form stated above.  The Company has elected to participate in Treasury’s Small Business Lending Fund program (“SBLF”).  This Agreement contains the terms and conditions on which the Company intends to issue preferred stock to Treasury, which Treasury will purchase using SBLF funds.

 

This Agreement consists of the following attached parts, all of which together constitute the entire agreement of Treasury and the Company (the “Parties”) with respect to the subject matter hereof, superseding all prior written and oral agreements and understandings between the Parties with respect to such subject matter:

 

Annex A:

Information Specific to the Company and the Investment

Annex B:

Definitions

Annex C:

General Terms and Conditions

Annex D:

Disclosure Schedule

Annex E:

Registration Rights

Annex F:

Form of Statement of Designations

Annex G:

Form of Officer’s Certificate

Annex H:

Form of Supplemental Reports

Annex I:

Form of Annual Certification

Annex J:

Form of Opinion

Annex K:

Form of Repayment Document

 

This Agreement may be executed in any number of counterparts, each being deemed to be an original instrument, and all of which will together constitute the same agreement.  Executed signature pages to this Agreement may be delivered by facsimile or electronic mail attachment.

 



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF , this Agreement has been duly executed and delivered by the duly authorized representatives of the parties hereto as of the Effective Date.

 

THE SECRETARY OF THE TREASURY

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Don Graves

 

By:

/s/ C. Malcolm Holland, III

Name:

Don Graves

 

Name:

C. Malcolm Holland, III

Title:

Deputy Assistant Secretary

 

Title:

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

[Signature Page- SBLF Securities Purchase Agreement – Veritex Holdings, Inc.]

 



 

ANNEX A

INFORMATION SPECIFIC TO THE COMPANY AND THE INVESTMENT

 

Purchase Information

 

Terms of the Purchase:

 

 

 

 

 

Series of Preferred Stock Purchased:

 

Senior Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series C

 

 

 

Per Share Liquidation Preference of Preferred Stock:

 

$1,000.00 per share

 

 

 

Number of Shares of Preferred Stock Purchased:

 

8,000

 

 

 

Dividend Payment Dates on the Preferred Stock:

 

Payable quarterly in arrears on January 1, April 1, July 1 and October 1 of each year.

 

 

 

Purchase Price:

 

$8,000,000.00

 

 

 

Closing:

 

 

 

 

 

Location of Closing:

 

Virtual

 

 

 

Time of Closing:

 

10:00 a.m. (EST)

 

 

 

Date of Closing:

 

August 25, 2011

 

Redemption Information

(Only complete if the Company was a CPP or CDCI participant; leave blank otherwise.)

 

Prior Program:

 

x

CPP

 

 

 

 

 

 

o

CDCI

 

 

 

 

Series of Previously Acquired Preferred Stock:

 

Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A and B

 

 

 

Number of Shares of Previously Acquired Preferred Stock:

 

3,000 shares of Series A and 150 shares of Series B

 

 

 

Repayment Amount:

 

$3,154,541.67

 

 

 

Residual Amount:

 

0

 

1



 

Matching Private Investment Information

 

Treasury investment is contingent on the Company raising Matching Private Investment (check one):

 

o

 

Yes

 

 

x

No

 

 

 

 

If Yes, complete the following (leave blank otherwise):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Aggregate Dollar Amount of Matching Private Investment Required:

 

 

 

 

 

Aggregate Dollar Amount of Matching Private Investment Received:

 

 

 

 

 

Class of securities representing Matching Private Investment:

 

 

 

 

 

Date of issuance of Matching Private Investment:

 

 

 

2


 

ANNEX B

DEFINITIONS

 

1.             Definitions.  Except as otherwise specified herein or as the context may otherwise require, the following terms have the respective meanings set forth below for all purposes of this Agreement.

 

Affiliate” means, with respect to any person, any person directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under common control with, such other person. For purposes of this definition, “control” (including, with correlative meanings, the terms “controlled by” and “under common control with”) when used with respect to any person, means the possession, directly or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, of the power to cause the direction of management and/or policies of such person, whether through the ownership of voting securities by contract or otherwise.

 

Application Date” means the date of the Company’s completed application to participate in SBLF.

 

Appropriate Federal Banking Agency” means the “appropriate Federal banking agency” with respect to the Company or such Company Subsidiaries, as applicable, as defined in Section 3(q) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (12 U.S.C. Section 1813(q)).  The Appropriate Federal Banking Agency is identified on the cover page of this Agreement.

 

Appropriate State Banking Agency” means, if the Company is a State-chartered bank, the Company’s State bank supervisor (as defined in Section 3(r) of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, 12 U.S.C. § 1813(q).

 

Bank Holding Company” means a company registered as such with the Federal Reserve pursuant to 12 U.S.C. §1842 and the regulations of the Federal Reserve promulgated thereunder.

 

Call Report” has the meaning assigned thereto in Section 4102(4) of the SBJA.  If the Company is a Bank Holding Company or a Savings and Loan Holding Company, unless the context clearly indicates otherwise:  (a) the term “Call Report” shall mean the Call Report(s) (as defined in Section 4102(4) of the SBJA) of the IDI Subsidiary(ies); and (b) if there are multiple IDI Subsidiaries, all references herein or in any document executed or delivered in connection herewith (including the Statement of Designations, the Initial Supplemental Report and all Quarterly Supplemental Reports) to any data reported in a Call Report shall refer to the aggregate of such data across the Call Reports for all such IDI Subsidiaries.

 

CDCI” means the Community Development Capital Initiative, as authorized under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.

 

Company Material Adverse Effect” means a material adverse effect on (i) the business, results of operation or condition (financial or otherwise) of the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries taken as a whole; provided, however, that Company Material Adverse Effect shall not be deemed to include the effects of (A) changes after the Signing Date in general

 

1



 

business, economic or market conditions (including changes generally in prevailing interest rates, credit availability and liquidity, currency exchange rates and price levels or trading volumes in the United States or foreign securities or credit markets), or any outbreak or escalation of hostilities, declared or undeclared acts of war or terrorism, in each case generally affecting the industries in which the Company and its subsidiaries operate, (B) changes or proposed changes after the Signing Date in GAAP, or authoritative interpretations thereof, or (C) changes or proposed changes after the Signing Date in securities, banking and other laws of general applicability or related policies or interpretations of Governmental Entities (in the case of each of these clauses (A), (B) and (C), other than changes or occurrences to the extent that such changes or occurrences have or would reasonably be expected to have a materially disproportionate adverse effect on the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries taken as a whole relative to comparable U.S. banking or financial services organizations); or (ii) the ability of the Company to consummate the Purchase and other transactions contemplated by this Agreement and perform its obligations hereunder and under the Statement of Designations on a timely basis and declare and pay dividends on the Dividend Payment Dates set forth in the Statement of Designations.

 

CPP” means the Capital Purchase Program, as authorized under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.

 

Disclosure Schedule” means that certain schedule to this Agreement delivered to Treasury on or prior to the Signing Date, setting forth, among other things, items the disclosure of which is necessary or appropriate in response to an express disclosure requirement contained in a provision hereof.  The Disclosure Schedule is contained in Annex D of this Agreement.

 

Executive Officers” means the Company’s “executive officers” as defined in 12 C.F.R. § 215.2(e)(1) (regardless of whether or not such regulation is applicable to the Company).

 

Federal Reserve” means the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.

 

GAAP” means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States.

 

General Terms and Conditions” and “General T&C” each mean Annex C of this Agreement.

 

IDI Subsidiary” means any Company Subsidiary that is an insured depository institution.

 

Junior Stock” means Common Stock and any other class or series of stock of the Company the terms of which expressly provide that it ranks junior to the Preferred Shares as to dividend and redemption rights and/or as to rights on liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company.

 

knowledge of the Company” or “Company’s knowledge” means the actual knowledge after reasonable and due inquiry of the “officers” (as such term is defined in Rule 3b-2 under the Exchange Act) of the Company.

 

2



 

Matching Private Investment-Supported,” when used to describe the Company (if applicable), means the Company’s eligibility for participation in the SBLF program is conditioned upon the Company or an Affiliate of the Company acceptable to Treasury receiving Matching Private Investment, as contemplated by Section 4103(d)(3)(B) of the SBJA.

 

Original Letter Agreement” means, if applicable, the Letter Agreement (and all terms incorporated therein) pursuant to which Treasury purchased from the Company, and the Company issued to Treasury, the Previously Acquired Preferred Shares (or warrants exercised to acquire the Previously Acquired Preferred Shares or the securities exchanged for the Previously Acquired Preferred Stock).

 

Oversight Officials” means, interchangeably and collectively as context requires, the Special Deputy Inspector General for SBLF Program Oversight, the Inspector General of the Department of the Treasury, and the Comptroller General of the United States.

 

Parity Stock” means any class or series of stock of the Company the terms of which do not expressly provide that such class or series will rank senior or junior to the Preferred Shares as to dividend rights and/or as to rights on liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Company (in each case without regard to whether dividends accrue cumulatively or non-cumulatively).

 

Preferred Shares” means the number of shares of Preferred Stock identified in the “Purchase Information” section of Annex A opposite “Number of Shares of Preferred Stock Purchased.”

 

Preferred Stock” means the series of the Company’s preferred stock identified in the “Purchase Information” section of Annex A opposite “Series of Preferred Stock Purchased.”

 

“Previously Acquired Preferred Shares” means, if the Company participated in CPP or CDCI, the number of shares of Previously Acquired Preferred Stock identified in the “Redemption Information” section of Annex A opposite “Number of Shares of Previously Acquired Preferred Stock.”

 

Previously Acquired Preferred Stock” means, if the Company participated in CPP or CDCI, the series of the Company’s preferred stock identified in the “Redemption Information” section of Annex A opposite “Series of Previously Acquired Preferred Stock.”

 

Previously Disclosed” means information set forth on the Disclosure Schedule or the Disclosure Update, as applicable; provided, however, that disclosure in any section of such Disclosure Schedule or Disclosure Update, as applicable, shall apply only to the indicated section of this Agreement; provided, further, that the existence of Previously Disclosed information, pursuant to a Disclosure Update, shall neither obligate Treasury to consummate the Purchase nor limit or affect any rights of or remedies available to Treasury.

 

Prior Program” means (a) CPP, if the Company is a participant in CPP immediately prior to the Closing, or (b) CDCI, if the Company is a participant in CDCI immediately prior to the Closing.

 

3



 

Publicly-traded” means a company that (i) has a class of securities that is traded on a national securities exchange and (ii) is required to file periodic reports with either the Securities and Exchange Commission or its primary federal bank regulator.

 

Purchase” means the purchase of the Preferred Shares by Treasury from the Company pursuant to this Agreement.

 

“Repayment” has the meaning set forth in the Repayment Document.

 

Repayment Amount” means, if the Company participated in CPP or CDCI, the aggregate amount payable by the Company as of the Closing Date to redeem the Previously Acquired Preferred Stock in accordance with its terms, which amount is set forth in the “Redemption Information” section of Annex A.

 

Savings and Loan Holding Company” means a company registered as such with the Office of Thrift Supervision or any successor thereto pursuant to 12 U.S.C. §1467(a) and the regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision promulgated thereunder.

 

SBJA” means the Small Business Jobs Act of 2010, as it may be amended from time to time.

 

Subsidiary” means any corporation, partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or other entity (A) of which such person or a subsidiary of such person is a general partner or (B) of which a majority of the voting securities or other voting interests, or a majority of the securities or other interests of which having by their terms ordinary voting power to elect a majority of the board of directors or persons performing similar functions with respect to such entity, is directly or indirectly owned by such person and/or one or more subsidiaries thereof.

 

Tax” or “Taxes” means any federal, state, local or foreign income, gross receipts, property, sales, use, license, excise, franchise, employment, payroll, withholding, alternative or add-on minimum, ad valorem, transfer or excise tax, or any other tax, custom, duty, governmental fee or other like assessment or charge of any kind whatsoever, together with any interest, penalty or addition imposed by any Governmental Entity.

 

Total Assets” means, with respect to an insured depository institution, the total assets of such insured depository institution.

 

Total Risk-Weighted Assets” means, with respect to an insured depository institution, the risk-weighted assets of such insured depository institution.

 

Warrant” has the meaning set forth in the Repayment Document.

 

2.             Index of Definitions.  The following table, which is provided solely for convenience of reference and shall not affect the interpretation of this Agreement, identifies the location where capitalized terms are defined in this Agreement:

 

4



 

 

 

Location of

Term

 

Definition

Affiliate

 

Annex B, §1

Agreement

 

Cover Page

Appropriate Federal Banking Agency

 

Annex B, §1

Appropriate State Banking Agency

 

Annex B, §1

Bank Holding Company

 

Annex B, §1

Bankruptcy Exceptions

 

General T&C, §2.5(a)

Board of Directors

 

General T&C, §2.6

Business Combination

 

General T&C, §5.8

business day

 

General T&C, §5.12

Call Report

 

Annex B, §1

Capitalization Date

 

General T&C, §2.2

CDCI

 

Annex B, §1

Charter

 

General T&C, §1.3(d)

Closing

 

General T&C, §1.2(a)

Closing Date

 

General T&C, §1.2(a)

Closing Deadline

 

General T&C, §5.1(a)(i)

Code

 

General T&C, §2.14

Common Stock

 

General T&C, §2.2

Company

 

Cover Page

Company Financial Statements

 

General T&C, §1.3(i)

Company Material Adverse Effect

 

Annex B, §1

Company Reports

 

General T&C, §2.9

Company Subsidiary; Company Subsidiaries

 

General T&C, §2.5(b)

control; controlled by; under common control with

 

Annex B, §1

CPP

 

Annex B, §1

Disclosure Schedule

 

Annex B, §1

Disclosure Update

 

General T&C, §1.3(h)

ERISA

 

General T&C, §2.14

Exchange Act

 

General T&C, §4.3

Federal Reserve

 

Annex B, §1

GAAP

 

Annex B, §1

Governmental Entities

 

General T&C, §1.3(a)

Holders

 

General T&C, §4.4(a)

Indemnitee

 

General T&C, §4.4(b)

Information

 

General T&C, §3.1(c)(iii)

Initial Supplemental Report

 

General T&C, §1.3(j)

Treasury

 

Cover Page

Junior Stock

 

Annex B, §1

knowledge of the Company; Company’s knowledge

 

Annex B, §1

Matching Private Investment

 

General T&C, §1.3(l)

Matching Private Investment-Supported

 

Annex B, § 1

Matching Private Investors

 

General T&C, §1.3(l)

officers

 

Annex B, §1

Parity Stock

 

Annex B, §1

 

5



 

Parties

 

Cover Page

Plan

 

General T&C, §2.14

Preferred Shares

 

Annex B, §1

Preferred Stock

 

Annex B, §1

Previously Acquired Preferred Shares

 

Annex B, §1

Previously Acquired Preferred Stock

 

Annex B, §1

Previously Disclosed

 

Annex B, §1

Prior Program

 

General T&C, §1.2(c)

Proprietary Rights

 

General T&C, §2.21

Purchase

 

Annex B, §1

Purchase Price

 

General T&C, §1.1(a)

Regulatory Agreement

 

General T&C, §2.19

Related Party

 

General T&C, §2.25

Repayment Document

 

General T&C, §1.2(b)(ii)(E)

Residual Amount

 

General T&C, §1.2(b)(ii)(B)

Savings and Loan Holding Company

 

Annex B, §1

SBJA

 

Annex B, §1

SBLF

 

Cover Page

SEC

 

General T&C, §2.11

Securities Act

 

General T&C, §2.1

Signing Date

 

Cover Page

Statement of Designations

 

General T&C, §1.3(d)

Subsidiary

 

Annex B, §1

Quarterly Supplemental Report

 

General T&C, §3.1(d)(i)

Tax; Taxes

 

Annex B, §1

Transfer

 

General T&C, §4.3

 

3.             Defined Terms in Annex K.  Except for defined terms in Annex K that are expressly cross-referenced in another part of this Agreement, terms defined in Annex K are defined therein solely for purposes of Annex K and are not applicable to other parts of this Agreement.

 

6



 

ANNEX C

GENERAL TERMS AND CONDITIONS

 

CONTENTS OF GENERAL TERMS AND CONDITIONS

 

 

 

 

Page

 

 

 

 

ARTICLE I

PURCHASE; CLOSING

 

3

 

 

 

 

 

1.1

Purchase

 

3

 

1.2

Closing

 

3

 

1.3

Closing Conditions

 

4

 

 

 

 

 

ARTICLE II

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

 

6

 

 

 

 

 

2.1

Organization, Authority and Significant Subsidiaries

 

6

 

2.2

Capitalization

 

6

 

2.3

Preferred Shares

 

7

 

2.4

Compliance With Identity Verification Requirements

 

7

 

2.5

Authorization; Enforceability

 

7

 

2.6

Anti-takeover Provisions and Rights Plan

 

8

 

2.7

No Company Material Adverse Effect

 

8

 

2.8

Company Financial Statements

 

9

 

2.9

Reports

 

9

 

2.10

No Undisclosed Liabilities

 

9

 

2.11

Offering of Securities

 

10

 

2.12

Litigation and Other Proceedings

 

10

 

2.13

Compliance with Laws

 

10

 

2.14

Employee Benefit Matters

 

11

 

2.15

Taxes

 

11

 

2.16

Properties and Leases

 

11

 

2.17

Environmental Liability

 

12

 

2.18

Risk Management Instruments

 

12

 

2.19

Agreements with Regulatory Agencies

 

12

 

2.20

Insurance

 

13

 

2.21

Intellectual Property

 

13

 

2.22

Brokers and Finders

 

13

 

2.23

Disclosure Schedule

 

13

 

2.24

Previously Acquired Preferred Shares

 

14

 

2.25

Related Party Transactions

 

14

 

2.26

Ability to Pay Dividends

 

14

 

 

 

 

 

ARTICLE III

COVENANTS

 

14

 

 

 

 

 

3.1

Affirmative Covenants

 

14

 

3.2

Negative Covenants

 

20

 

1



 

ARTICLE IV

ADDITIONAL AGREEMENTS

 

21

 

 

 

 

 

4.1

Purchase for Investment

 

21

 

4.2

Legends

 

21

 

4.3

Transfer of Preferred Shares

 

22

 

4.4

Rule 144; Rule 144A; 4(1½) Transactions

 

22

 

4.5

Depositary Shares

 

24

 

4.6

Expenses and Further Assurances

 

24

 

 

 

 

 

ARTICLE V

MISCELLANEOUS

 

24

 

 

 

 

 

5.1

Termination

 

24

 

5.2

Survival

 

25

 

5.3

Amendment

 

25

 

5.4

Waiver of Conditions

 

25

 

5.5

Governing Law; Submission to Jurisdiction; etc.

 

26

 

5.6

No Relationship to TARP

 

26

 

5.7

Notices

 

26

 

5.8

Assignment

 

27

 

5.9

Severability

 

27

 

5.10

No Third Party Beneficiaries

 

27

 

5.11

Specific Performance

 

27

 

5.12

Interpretation

 

27

 

2


 

ARTICLE I

PURCHASE; CLOSING

 

1.1          Purchase.  On the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement, the Company agrees to sell to Treasury, and Treasury agrees to purchase from the Company, at the Closing, the Preferred Shares for the aggregate price set forth on Annex A (the “Purchase Price”).

 

1.2          Closing.  (a)  On the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement, the closing of the Purchase (the “Closing”) will take place at the location specified in Annex A, at the time and on the date set forth in Annex A or as soon as practicable thereafter, or at such other place, time and date as shall be agreed between the Company and Treasury.  The time and date on which the Closing occurs is referred to in this Agreement as the “Closing Date”.

 

(b)           Subject to the fulfillment or waiver of the conditions to the Closing in Section 1.3, at the Closing:

 

(i)            if Treasury holds Previously Acquired Preferred Shares:

 

(A)          the Purchase Price shall first be applied to pay the Repayment Amount;

 

(B)          if the Purchase Price is less than the Repayment Amount, the Company shall pay the positive difference (if any) between the Repayment Amount and the Purchase Price (a “Residual Amount”) to Treasury’s Office of Financial Stability by wire transfer of immediately available United States funds to an account designated in writing by Treasury; and

 

(C)          upon receipt of the full Repayment Amount (by application of the Purchase Price and, if applicable, the Company’s payment of the Residual Amount), Treasury and the Company will consummate the Repayment;

 

(D)          the Company will deliver to Treasury a statement of adjustment as contemplated by Section 13(J) of the Warrant; and

 

(E)           the Company and Treasury will execute and deliver a properly completed repurchase document in the form attached hereto as Annex K, (the “Repayment Document”).

 

(ii)           the Company will deliver the Preferred Shares as evidenced by one or more certificates dated the Closing Date and bearing appropriate legends as hereinafter provided for, in exchange for payment in full of the Purchase Price by application of the Purchase Price to the Repayment and by wire transfer of immediately available United States funds to a bank account designated by the Company in the Initial Supplemental Report, as applicable.

 

3



 

1.3          Closing Conditions. The obligation of Treasury to consummate the Purchase is subject to the fulfillment (or waiver by Treasury) at or prior to the Closing of each of the following conditions:

 

(a)           (i) any approvals or authorizations of all United States federal, state, local, foreign and other governmental, regulatory or judicial authorities (collectively, “Governmental Entities”) required for the consummation of the Purchase shall have been obtained or made in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to each party and shall be in full force and effect and all waiting periods required by United States and other applicable law, if any, shall have expired and (ii) no provision of any applicable United States or other law and no judgment, injunction, order or decree of any Governmental Entity shall prohibit the purchase and sale of the Preferred Shares as contemplated by this Agreement;

 

(b)           (i) the representations and warranties of the Company set forth in (A) Sections 2.7 and 2.26 shall be true and correct in all respects as though made on and as of the Closing Date; (B) Sections 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.19, 2.22, 2.23, 2.24 and 2.25 shall be true and correct in all material respects as though made on and as of the Closing Date (other than representations and warranties that by their terms speak as of another date, which representations and warranties shall be true and correct in all respects as of such other date); and (C) Sections 2.8 through 2.18 and Sections 2.20 through 2.21 (disregarding all qualifications or limitations set forth in such representations and warranties as to “materiality”, “Company Material Adverse Effect” and words of similar import) shall be true and correct as though made on and as of the Closing Date (other than representations and warranties that by their terms speak as of another date, which representations and warranties shall be true and correct as of such other date), except to the extent that the failure of such representations and warranties referred to in this Section 1.3(b)(i)(C) to be so true and correct, individually or in the aggregate, does not have and would not reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect; and (ii) the Company shall have performed in all respects all obligations required to be performed by it under this Agreement at or prior to the Closing;

 

(c)           the Company shall have delivered to Treasury a certificate signed on behalf of the Company by an Executive Officer certifying to the effect that the conditions set forth in Section 1.3(b) have been satisfied, in substantially the form of Annex G;

 

(d)           the Company shall have duly adopted and filed with the Secretary of State of its jurisdiction of organization or other applicable Governmental Entity an amendment to its certificate or articles of incorporation, articles of association, or similar organizational document (“Charter”) in substantially the form of Annex F (the “Statement of Designations”) and the Company shall have delivered to Treasury a copy of the filed Statement of Designations with appropriate evidence from the Secretary of State or other applicable Governmental Entity that the filing has been accepted, or if a filed copy is unavailable, a certificate signed on behalf of the Company by an Executive Officer certifying to the effect that the filing of the Statement of Designations has been accepted, in substantially the form attached hereto as Annex F;

 

(e)           the Company shall have delivered to Treasury true, complete and correct certified copies of the Charter and bylaws of the Company;

 

4



 

(f)            the Company shall have delivered to Treasury a written opinion from counsel to the Company (which may be internal counsel), addressed to Treasury and dated as of the Closing Date, in substantially the form of Annex J;

 

(g)           the Company shall have delivered certificates in proper form or, with the prior consent of Treasury, evidence of shares in book-entry form, evidencing the Preferred Shares to Treasury or its designee(s);

 

(h)           the Company shall have delivered to Treasury a copy of the Disclosure Schedule on or prior to the Signing Date and, to the extent that any information set forth on the Disclosure Schedule needs to be updated or supplemented to make it true, complete and correct as of the Closing Date, (i) the Company shall have delivered to Treasury an update to the Disclosure Schedule (the “Disclosure Update”), setting forth any information necessary to make the Disclosure Schedule true, correct and complete as of the Closing Date and (ii) Treasury, in its sole discretion, shall have approved the Disclosure Update, provided, however, that the delivery and acceptance of the Disclosure Update shall not limit or affect any rights of or remedies available to Treasury;

 

(i)            the Company shall have delivered to Treasury on or prior to the Signing Date each of the consolidated financial statements of the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries for each of the last three completed fiscal years of the Company (which shall be audited to the extent audited financial statements are available prior to the Signing Date) (together with the Call Reports filed by the Company or the IDI Subsidiary(ies) for each completed quarterly period since the last completed fiscal year, the “Company Financial Statements”);

 

(j)            the Company shall have delivered to Treasury, not later than five (5) business days prior to the Closing Date, a certificate (the “Initial Supplemental Report”) in substantially the form attached hereto as Annex H setting forth a complete and accurate statement of loans held by the Company (or if the Company is a Bank Holding Company or a Savings and Loan Holding Company, by the IDI Subsidiary(ies)) in each of the categories described therein, for the time periods specified therein, (A) including a signed certification of the Chief Executive Officer, the Chief Financial Officer and all directors or trustees of the Company or the IDI Subsidiary(ies) who attested to the Call Reports for the quarters covered by such certificate, that such certificate (x) has been prepared in conformance with the instructions issued by Treasury and (y) is true and correct to the best of their knowledge and belief; and (B) completed for the last full calendar quarter prior to the Closing Date and the four (4) quarters ended September 30, 2009, December 31, 2009, March 31, 2010 and June 30, 2010;

 

(k)           prior to the Signing Date, the Company shall have delivered to Treasury, the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency and, if the Company is a State-chartered bank, the Appropriate State Banking Agency, a small business lending plan describing how the Company’s business strategy and operating goals will allow it to address the needs of small businesses in the area it serves, as well as a plan to provide linguistically and culturally appropriate outreach, where appropriate; and

 

5



 

(l)            if the Company is Matching Private Investment-Supported, on or after September 27, 2010 the Company or an Affiliate of the Company acceptable to Treasury shall (i) have received equity capital (“Matching Private Investment”) from one or more non-governmental investors (“Matching Private Investors”) (A) in an amount equal to or greater than the Aggregate Dollar Amount of Matching Private Investment Required set forth on Annex A (net of all dividends paid with respect to, and all repurchases and redemptions of, the Company’s equity securities), (B) that is subordinate in right of payment of dividends, liquidation preference and redemption rights to the Preferred Shares and (C) that is acceptable in form and substance to Treasury, in its sole discretion and (ii) have satisfied the following requirements reasonably in advance of the Closing Date: (A) delivery of copies of the definitive documentation for the Matching Private Investment to Treasury, (B) delivery of the organizational charts of such non-governmental investors to Treasury, each certified by the applicable non-governmental investor and demonstrating that such non-governmental investor is not an Affiliate of the Company, (C) delivery of any other documents or information as Treasury may reasonably request, in its sole discretion and (D) any other terms and conditions imposed by Treasury or the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency, in their sole discretion.

 

ARTICLE II

REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

 

The Company represents and warrants to Treasury that as of the Signing Date and as of the Closing Date (or such other date specified herein):

 

2.1          Organization, Authority and Significant Subsidiaries.  The Company has been duly incorporated and is validly existing and in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization, with the necessary power and authority to own, operate and lease its properties and conduct its business as it is being currently conducted, and except as has not, individually or in the aggregate, had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, has been duly qualified as a foreign corporation for the transaction of business and is in good standing under the laws of each other jurisdiction in which it owns or leases properties or conducts any business so as to require such qualification; each subsidiary of the Company that would be considered a “significant subsidiary” within the meaning of Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act of 1933 (the “Securities Act”), has been duly organized and is validly existing in good standing under the laws of its jurisdiction of organization.  The Charter and bylaws of the Company, copies of which have been provided to Treasury prior to the Signing Date, are true, complete and correct copies of such documents as in full force and effect as of the Signing Date and as of the Closing Date.

 

2.2          Capitalization.  The outstanding shares of capital stock of the Company have been duly authorized and are validly issued and outstanding, fully paid and nonassessable, and subject to no preemptive or similar rights (and were not issued in violation of any preemptive rights). As of the Signing Date, the Company does not have outstanding any securities or other obligations providing the holder the right to acquire its common stock (“Common Stock”) or other capital stock that is not reserved for issuance as specified in Part 2.2 of the Disclosure Schedule, and the Company has not made any other commitment to authorize, issue or sell any Common Stock or other capital stock.  Since the last day of the fiscal period covered by the last Call Report filed by

 

6



 

the Company or the IDI Subsidiary(ies) prior to the Application Date (the “Capitalization Date”), the Company has not (a) declared, and has no present intention of declaring, any dividends on its Common Stock in a per-share amount greater than the per-share amount of declared dividends that are reflected in such Call Report; (b) declared, and has no present intention of declaring (except as contemplated by the Statement of Designations) any dividends on any of its preferred stock in a per-share amount greater than the per-share amount of declared dividends that are reflected in such Call Report; or (c) issued any shares of Common Stock or other capital stock, other than (i) shares issued upon the exercise of stock options or delivered under other equity-based awards or other convertible securities or warrants which were issued and outstanding on the Capitalization Date and disclosed in Part 2.2 of the Disclosure Schedule, (ii) shares disclosed in Part 2.2 of the Disclosure Schedule, and (iii) if the Company is Matching Private Investment-Supported, shares or other capital stock representing Matching Private Investment disclosed in the “Matching Private Investment” section of Annex A.  Except as disclosed in Part 2.2 of the Disclosure Schedule, the Company has no agreements providing for the accelerated exercise, settlement or exchange of any capital stock of the Company for Common Stock.  Each holder of 5% or more of any class of capital stock of the Company and such holder’s primary address are set forth in Part 2.2 of the Disclosure Schedule.  The Company has received a representation from each Matching Private Investor that such Matching Private Investor has not received or applied for any investment from the SBLF, and the Company has no reason to believe that any such representation is inaccurate.  If the Company is a Bank Holding Company or a Savings and Loan Holding Company, (x) the percentage of each IDI Subsidiary’s issued and outstanding capital stock that is owned by the Company is set forth on Part 2.2 of the Disclosure Schedule; and (y) all shares of issued and outstanding capital stock of the IDI Subsidiary(ies) owned by the Company are free and clear of all liens, security interests, charges or encumbrances.  Since the Application Date, there has been no change in the organizational hierarchy information regarding the Company that was available on the Application Date from the National Information Center of the Federal Reserve System.

 

2.3          Preferred Shares.  The Preferred Shares have been duly and validly authorized, and, when issued and delivered pursuant to this Agreement, such Preferred Shares will be duly and validly issued and fully paid and non-assessable, will not be issued in violation of any preemptive rights, and will rank pari passu with or senior to all other series or classes of preferred stock, whether or not designated, issued or outstanding, with respect to the payment of dividends and the distribution of assets in the event of any dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the Company.

 

2.4          Compliance with Identity Verification Requirements. The Company and the Company Subsidiaries (to the extent such regulations are applicable to the Company Subsidiaries) are in compliance with the requirements of Section 103.121 of title 31, Code of Federal Regulations.

 

2.5          Authorization, Enforceability.

 

(a)           The Company has the corporate power and authority to execute and deliver this Agreement and to carry out its obligations hereunder (which includes the issuance of the Preferred Shares).  The execution, delivery and performance by the Company of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby have been duly

 

7



 

authorized by all necessary corporate action on the part of the Company and its stockholders, and no further approval or authorization is required on the part of the Company.  This Agreement is a valid and binding obligation of the Company enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms, subject to any limitations of applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights generally and general equitable principles, regardless of whether such enforceability is considered in a proceeding at law or in equity (“Bankruptcy Exceptions”).

 

(b)           The execution, delivery and performance by the Company of this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and compliance by the Company with the provisions hereof, will not (i) violate, conflict with, or result in a breach of any provision of, or constitute a default (or an event which, with notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute a default) under, or result in the termination of, or accelerate the performance required by, or result in a right of termination or acceleration of, or result in the creation of, any lien, security interest, charge or encumbrance upon any of the properties or assets of the Company or any subsidiary of the Company (each subsidiary, a “Company Subsidiary” and, collectively, the “Company Subsidiaries”) under any of the terms, conditions or provisions of (A) its organizational documents or (B) any note, bond, mortgage, indenture, deed of trust, license, lease, agreement or other instrument or obligation to which the Company or any Company Subsidiary is a party or by which it or any Company Subsidiary may be bound, or to which the Company or any Company Subsidiary or any of the properties or assets of the Company or any Company Subsidiary may be subject, or (ii) subject to compliance with the statutes and regulations referred to in the next paragraph, violate any statute, rule or regulation or any judgment, ruling, order, writ, injunction or decree applicable to the Company or any Company Subsidiary or any of their respective properties or assets except, in the case of clauses (i)(B) and (ii), for those occurrences that, individually or in the aggregate, have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

(c)           Other than the filing of the Statement of Designations with the Secretary of State of its jurisdiction of organization or other applicable Governmental Entity, such filings and approvals as are required to be made or obtained under any state “blue sky” laws and such as have been made or obtained, no notice to, filing with, exemption or review by, or authorization, consent or approval of, any Governmental Entity is required to be made or obtained by the Company in connection with the consummation by the Company of the Purchase except for any such notices, filings, exemptions, reviews, authorizations, consents and approvals the failure of which to make or obtain would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

2.6          Anti-takeover Provisions and Rights Plan.  The Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board of Directors”) has taken all necessary action to ensure that the transactions contemplated by this Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby will be exempt from any anti-takeover or similar provisions of the Company’s Charter and bylaws, and any other provisions of any applicable “moratorium”, “control share”, “fair price”, “interested stockholder” or other anti-takeover laws and regulations of any jurisdiction.

 

2.7          No Company Material Adverse Effect.  Since the last day of the fiscal period covered by the last Call Report filed by the Company or the IDI Subsidiary(ies) prior to the

 

8



 

Application Date, no fact, circumstance, event, change, occurrence, condition or development has occurred that, individually or in the aggregate, has had or would reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

2.8          Company Financial Statements.  The Company Financial Statements present fairly in all material respects the consolidated financial position of the Company and its consolidated subsidiaries as of the dates indicated therein and the consolidated results of their operations for the periods specified therein; and except as stated therein, such financial statements (a) were prepared in conformity with GAAP applied on a consistent basis (except as may be noted therein) and (b) have been prepared from, and are in accordance with, the books and records of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries.

 

2.9          Reports.

 

(a)           Since December 31, 2007, the Company and each Company Subsidiary has filed all reports, registrations, documents, filings, statements and submissions, together with any amendments thereto, that it was required to file with any Governmental Entity (the foregoing, collectively, the “Company Reports”) and has paid all fees and assessments due and payable in connection therewith, except, in each case, as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.  As of their respective dates of filing, the Company Reports complied in all material respects with all statutes and applicable rules and regulations of the applicable Governmental Entities.

 

(b)           The records, systems, controls, data and information of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries are recorded, stored, maintained and operated under means (including any electronic, mechanical or photographic process, whether computerized or not) that are under the exclusive ownership and direct control of the Company or the Company Subsidiaries or their accountants (including all means of access thereto and therefrom), except for any non-exclusive ownership and non-direct control that would not reasonably be expected to have a material adverse effect on the system of internal accounting controls described below in this Section 2.9(b).  The Company (i) has implemented and maintains adequate disclosure controls and procedures to ensure that material information relating to the Company, including the consolidated Company Subsidiaries, is made known to the chief executive officer and the chief financial officer of the Company by others within those entities, and (ii) has disclosed, based on its most recent evaluation prior to the Signing Date, to the Company’s outside auditors and the audit committee of the Board of Directors (A) any significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal controls that are reasonably likely to adversely affect the Company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information and (B) any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the Company’s internal controls over financial reporting.

 

2.10        No Undisclosed Liabilities.  Neither the Company nor any of the Company Subsidiaries has any liabilities or obligations of any nature (absolute, accrued, contingent or otherwise) which are not properly reflected in the Company Financial Statements to the extent required to be so reflected and, if applicable, reserved against in accordance with GAAP applied on a consistent basis, except for (a) liabilities that have arisen since the last fiscal year end in the ordinary and usual course of business and consistent with past practice and (b) liabilities that,

 

9



 

individually or in the aggregate, have not had and would not reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

2.11        Offering of Securities.  Neither the Company nor any person acting on its behalf has taken any action (including any offering of any securities of the Company under circumstances which would require the integration of such offering with the offering of any of the Preferred Shares under the Securities Act, and the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) promulgated thereunder), which might subject the offering, issuance or sale of any of the Preferred Shares to Treasury pursuant to this Agreement to the registration requirements of the Securities Act.

 

2.12        Litigation and Other Proceedings.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, there is no (a) pending or, to the knowledge of the Company, threatened, claim, action, suit, investigation or proceeding, against the Company or any Company Subsidiary or to which any of their assets are subject nor is the Company or any Company Subsidiary subject to any order, judgment or decree or (b) unresolved violation, criticism or exception by any Governmental Entity with respect to any report or relating to any examinations or inspections of the Company or any Company Subsidiaries.  There is no claim, action, suit, investigation or proceeding pending or, to the Company’s knowledge, threatened against any institution-affiliated party (as defined in 12 U.S.C. §1813(u)) of the Company or any of the IDI Subsidiaries that, if determined or resolved in a manner adverse to such institution-affiliated party, could result in such institution-affiliated party being prohibited from participation in the conduct of the affairs of any financial institution or holding company of any financial institution and, to the Company’s knowledge, there are no facts or circumstances could reasonably be expected to provide a basis for any such claim, action, suit, investigation or proceeding.

 

2.13        Compliance with Laws.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, the Company and the Company Subsidiaries have all permits, licenses, franchises, authorizations, orders and approvals of, and have made all filings, applications and registrations with, Governmental Entities that are required in order to permit them to own or lease their properties and assets and to carry on their business as presently conducted and that are material to the business of the Company or such Company Subsidiary.  Except as set forth in Part 2.13 of the Disclosure Schedule, the Company and the Company Subsidiaries have complied in all respects and are not in default or violation of, and none of them is, to the knowledge of the Company, under investigation with respect to or, to the knowledge of the Company, have been threatened to be charged with or given notice of any violation of, any applicable domestic (federal, state or local) or foreign law, statute, ordinance, license, rule, regulation, policy or guideline, order, demand, writ, injunction, decree or judgment of any Governmental Entity, other than such noncompliance, defaults or violations that would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.  Except for statutory or regulatory restrictions of general application, no Governmental Entity has placed any restriction on the business or properties of the Company or any Company Subsidiary that would, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

10



 

2.14        Employee Benefit Matters.  Except as would not reasonably be expected to have, either individually or in the aggregate, a Company Material Adverse Effect: (a) each “employee benefit plan” (within the meaning of Section 3(3) of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”)) providing benefits to any current or former employee, officer or director of the Company or any member of its “Controlled Group” (defined as any organization which is a member of a controlled group of corporations within the meaning of Section 414 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”)) that is sponsored, maintained or contributed to by the Company or any member of its Controlled Group and for which the Company or any member of its Controlled Group would have any liability, whether actual or contingent (each, a “Plan”) has been maintained in compliance with its terms and with the requirements of all applicable statutes, rules and regulations, including ERISA and the Code; (b) with respect to each Plan subject to Title IV of ERISA (including, for purposes of this clause (b), any plan subject to Title IV of ERISA that the Company or any member of its Controlled Group previously maintained or contributed to in the six years prior to the Signing Date), (1) no “reportable event” (within the meaning of Section 4043(c) of ERISA), other than a reportable event for which the notice period referred to in Section 4043(c) of ERISA has been waived, has occurred in the three years prior to the Signing Date or is reasonably expected to occur, (2) no “accumulated funding deficiency” (within the meaning of Section 302 of ERISA or Section 412 of the Code), whether or not waived, has occurred in the three years prior to the Signing Date or is reasonably expected to occur, (3) the fair market value of the assets under each Plan exceeds the present value of all benefits accrued under such Plan (determined based on the assumptions used to fund such Plan) and (4) neither the Company nor any member of its Controlled Group has incurred in the six years prior to the Signing Date, or reasonably expects to incur, any liability under Title IV of ERISA (other than contributions to the Plan or premiums to the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation in the ordinary course and without default) in respect of a Plan (including any Plan that is a “multiemployer plan”, within the meaning of Section 4001(c)(3) of ERISA); and (c) each Plan that is intended to be qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code has received a favorable determination letter from the Internal Revenue Service with respect to its qualified status that has not been revoked, or such a determination letter has been timely applied for but not received by the Signing Date, and nothing has occurred, whether by action or by failure to act, which could reasonably be expected to cause the loss, revocation or denial of such qualified status or favorable determination letter.

 

2.15        Taxes.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, (a) the Company and the Company Subsidiaries have filed all federal, state, local and foreign income and franchise Tax returns (together with any schedules and attached thereto) required to be filed through the Signing Date, subject to permitted extensions, and have paid all Taxes due thereon, (b) all such Tax returns (together with any schedules and attached thereto) are true, complete and correct in all material respects and were prepared in compliance with all applicable laws and (c) no Tax deficiency has been determined adversely to the Company or any of the Company Subsidiaries, nor does the Company have any knowledge of any Tax deficiencies.

 

2.16        Properties and Leases.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, the Company and the Company Subsidiaries have good and marketable title to all real properties and all other properties and assets owned by them, in each case free from liens (including, without limitation,

 

11



 

liens for Taxes), encumbrances, claims and defects that would affect the value thereof or interfere with the use made or to be made thereof by them.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, the Company and the Company Subsidiaries hold all leased real or personal property under valid and enforceable leases with no exceptions that would interfere with the use made or to be made thereof by them.

 

2.17        Environmental Liability.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect:

 

(a)           there is no legal, administrative, or other proceeding, claim or action of any nature seeking to impose, or that would reasonably be expected to result in the imposition of, on the Company or any Company Subsidiary, any liability relating to the release of hazardous substances as defined under any local, state or federal environmental statute, regulation or ordinance, including the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, pending or, to the Company’s knowledge, threatened against the Company or any Company Subsidiary;

 

(b)           to the Company’s knowledge, there is no reasonable basis for any such proceeding, claim or action; and

 

(c)           neither the Company nor any Company Subsidiary is subject to any agreement, order, judgment or decree by or with any court, Governmental Entity or third party imposing any such environmental liability.

 

2.18        Risk Management Instruments.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, all derivative instruments, including, swaps, caps, floors and option agreements, whether entered into for the Company’s own account, or for the account of one or more of the Company Subsidiaries or its or their customers, were entered into (i) only in the ordinary course of business, (ii) in accordance with prudent practices and in all material respects with all applicable laws, rules, regulations and regulatory policies and (iii) with counterparties believed to be financially responsible at the time; and each of such instruments constitutes the valid and legally binding obligation of the Company or one of the Company Subsidiaries, enforceable in accordance with its terms, except as may be limited by the Bankruptcy Exceptions.  Neither the Company or the Company Subsidiaries, nor, to the knowledge of the Company, any other party thereto, is in breach of any of its obligations under any such agreement or arrangement other than such breaches that would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

2.19        Agreements with Regulatory Agencies.  Except as set forth in Part 2.19 of the Disclosure Schedule, neither the Company nor any Company Subsidiary is subject to any cease-and-desist or other similar order or enforcement action issued by, or is a party to any written agreement, consent agreement or memorandum of understanding with, or is a party to any commitment letter or similar undertaking to, or is subject to any capital directive by, or since December 31, 2007, has adopted any board resolutions at the request of, any Governmental Entity that currently restricts the conduct of its business or that in any material manner relates to its capital adequacy, its liquidity and funding policies and practices, its ability to pay dividends,

 

12



 

its credit, risk management or compliance policies or procedures, its internal controls, its management or its operations or business (each item in this sentence, a “Regulatory Agreement”), nor has the Company or any Company Subsidiary been advised since December 31, 2007, by any such Governmental Entity that it is considering issuing, initiating, ordering, or requesting any such Regulatory Agreement.  The Company and each Company Subsidiary is in compliance with each Regulatory Agreement to which it is party or subject, and neither the Company nor any Company Subsidiary has received any notice from any Governmental Entity indicating that either the Company or any Company Subsidiary is not in compliance with any such Regulatory Agreement.

 

2.20        Insurance.  The Company and the Company Subsidiaries are insured with reputable insurers against such risks and in such amounts as the management of the Company reasonably has determined to be prudent and consistent with industry practice.  The Company and the Company Subsidiaries are in material compliance with their insurance policies and are not in default under any of the material terms thereof, each such policy is outstanding and in full force and effect, all premiums and other payments due under any material policy have been paid, and all claims thereunder have been filed in due and timely fashion, except, in each case, as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect.

 

2.21        Intellectual Property.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, (i) the Company and each Company Subsidiary owns or otherwise has the right to use, all intellectual property rights, including all trademarks, trade dress, trade names, service marks, domain names, patents, inventions, trade secrets, know-how, works of authorship and copyrights therein, that are used in the conduct of their existing businesses and all rights relating to the plans, design and specifications of any of its branch facilities (“Proprietary Rights”) free and clear of all liens and any claims of ownership by current or former employees, contractors, designers or others and (ii) neither the Company nor any of the Company Subsidiaries is materially infringing, diluting, misappropriating or violating, nor has the Company or any of the Company Subsidiaries received any written (or, to the knowledge of the Company, oral) communications alleging that any of them has materially infringed, diluted, misappropriated or violated, any of the Proprietary Rights owned by any other person.  Except as would not, individually or in the aggregate, reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect, to the Company’s knowledge, no other person is infringing, diluting, misappropriating or violating, nor has the Company or any or the Company Subsidiaries sent any written communications since December 31, 2007, alleging that any person has infringed, diluted, misappropriated or violated, any of the Proprietary Rights owned by the Company and the Company Subsidiaries.

 

2.22        Brokers and Finders.  Treasury has no liability for any amounts that any broker, finder or investment banker is entitled to for any financial advisory, brokerage, finder’s or other fee or commission in connection with this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby based upon arrangements made by or on behalf of the Company or any Company Subsidiary.

 

2.23        Disclosure Schedule.  The Company has delivered the Disclosure Schedule and, if applicable, the Disclosure Update to Treasury and the information contained in the Disclosure

 

13


 

Schedule, as modified by the information contained in the Disclosure Update, if applicable, is true, complete and correct.

 

2.24        Previously Acquired Preferred Shares.  If Treasury holds Previously Acquired Preferred Shares:

 

(a)           The Company has not breached any representation, warranty or covenant set forth in the Original Letter Agreement or any of the other documents governing the Previously Acquired Preferred Stock.

 

(b)           The Company has paid to Treasury: (i) if the Previously Acquired Preferred Stock is cumulative, all accrued and unpaid dividends and/or interest then due on the Previously Acquired Preferred Stock; or (ii) if the Previously Acquired Preferred Stock is non-cumulative, all unpaid dividends and/or interest due on the Previously Acquired Preferred Shares for the fiscal quarter prior to the Closing Date plus the accrued and unpaid dividends and/or interest due on the Previously Acquired Preferred Shares as of the Closing Date for the fiscal quarter in which the Closing shall occur.

 

2.25        Related Party Transactions.  Neither the Company nor any Company Subsidiary has made any extension of credit to any director or Executive Officer of the Company or any Company Subsidiary, any holder of 5% or more of the Company’s issued and outstanding capital stock, or any of their respective spouses or children or to any Affiliate of any of the foregoing (each, a “Related Party”), other than in compliance with 12 C.F.R Part 215 (Regulation O).  Except as set forth in Part 2.25 of the Disclosure Schedule, to the Company’s knowledge, no Related Party has any (i) material commercial, industrial, banking, consulting, legal, accounting, charitable or familial relationship with any vendor or material customer of the Company or any Company Subsidiary that is not on arms-length terms, or (ii) direct or indirect ownership interest in any person or entity with which the Company or any Company Subsidiary has a material business relationship that is not on arms-length terms (not including Publicly-traded entities in which such person owns less than two percent (2%) of the outstanding capital stock).

 

2.26        Ability to Pay Dividends.  The Company has all permits, licenses, franchises, authorizations, orders and approvals of, and has made all filings, applications and registrations with, Governmental Entities and third parties that are required in order to permit the Company to declare and pay dividends on the Preferred Shares on the Dividend Payment Dates set forth in the Statement of Designations.

 

ARTICLE III

COVENANTS

 

3.1          Affirmative CovenantsThe Company hereby covenants and agrees with Treasury that:

 

(a)           Commercially Reasonable Efforts.  Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, each of the parties will use its commercially reasonable efforts in good faith to take, or cause to be taken, all actions, and to do, or cause to be done, all things necessary, proper

 

14



 

or desirable, or advisable under applicable laws, so as to permit consummation of the Purchase as promptly as practicable and otherwise to enable consummation of the transactions contemplated hereby and shall use commercially reasonable efforts to cooperate with the other party to that end.

 

(b)           Certain Notifications until Closing.  From the Signing Date until the Closing, the Company shall promptly notify Treasury of (i) any fact, event or circumstance of which it is aware and which would reasonably be expected to cause any representation or warranty of the Company contained in this Agreement to be untrue or inaccurate in any material respect or to cause any covenant or agreement of the Company contained in this Agreement not to be complied with or satisfied in any material respect and (ii) except as Previously Disclosed, any fact, circumstance, event, change, occurrence, condition or development of which the Company is aware and which, individually or in the aggregate, has had or would reasonably be expected to have a Company Material Adverse Effect; provided, however, that delivery of any notice pursuant to this Section 3.1(b) shall not limit or affect any rights of or remedies available to Treasury.

 

(c)           Access, Information and Confidentiality.

 

(i)            From the Signing Date until the date on which all of the Preferred Shares have been redeemed in whole, the Company will permit, and shall cause each of the Company’s Subsidiaries to permit, Treasury, the Oversight Officials and their respective agents, consultants, contractors and advisors to (x) examine any books, papers, records, Tax returns (including all schedules attached thereto), data and other information; (y) make copies thereof; and (z) discuss the affairs, finances and accounts of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries with the personnel of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries, all upon reasonable notice; provided, that:

 

(A)                         any examinations and discussions pursuant to this Section 3.1(c)(i) shall be conducted during normal business hours and in such manner as not to interfere unreasonably with the conduct of the business of the Company;

 

(B)                         neither the Company nor any Company Subsidiary shall be required by this Section 3.1(c)(i) to disclose any information to the extent (x) prohibited by applicable law or regulation, or (y) that such disclosure would reasonably be expected to cause a violation of any agreement to which the Company or any Company Subsidiary is a party or would cause a risk of a loss of privilege to the Company or any Company Subsidiary (provided that the Company shall use commercially reasonable efforts to make appropriate substitute disclosure arrangements under circumstances where the restrictions in this clause (B) apply);

 

(C)                         the obligations of the Company and the Company Subsidiaries to disclose information pursuant to this Section 3.1(c)(i) to any Oversight Official or any agent, consultant, contractor and

 

15



 

advisor thereof, such Oversight Official shall have agreed, with respect to documents obtained under this Section 3.1(c)(i), to follow applicable law and regulation (and the applicable customary policies and procedures) regarding the dissemination of confidential materials, including redacting confidential information from the public version of its reports and soliciting input from the Company as to information that should be afforded confidentiality, as appropriate; and

 

(D)                         for avoidance of doubt, such examinations and discussions may, at Treasury’s option, be conducted on site at any office of the Company or any Company Subsidiary.

 

(ii)           From the Signing Date until the date on which all of the Preferred Shares have been redeemed in whole, the Company will deliver, or will cause to be delivered, to Treasury:

 

(A)                         as soon as available after the end of each fiscal year of the Company, and in any event within 90 days thereafter, a consolidated balance sheet of the Company as of the end of such fiscal year, and consolidated statements of income, retained earnings and cash flows of the Company for such year, in each case prepared in accordance with GAAP applied on a consistent basis and setting forth in each case in comparative form the figures for the previous fiscal year of the Company and which shall be audited to the extent audited financial statements are available;

 

(B)                         as soon as available after the end of the first, second and third quarterly periods in each fiscal year of the Company, a copy of any quarterly reports provided to other stockholders of the Company or Company management by the Company;

 

(C)                         as soon as available after the Company receives any assessment of the Company’s internal controls, a copy of such assessment (other than assessments provided by the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency or the Appropriate State Banking Agency that the Company is prohibited by applicable law or regulation from disclosing to Treasury);

 

(D)                         annually on a date specified by Treasury, a completed survey, in a form specified by Treasury, providing, among other things, a description of how the Company has utilized the funds the Company received hereunder in connection with the sale of the Preferred Shares and the effects of such funds on the operations and status of the Company;

 

16



 

(E)                          as soon as such items become effective, any amendments to the Charter, bylaws or other organizational documents of the Company; and

 

(F)                           at the same time as such items are sent to any stockholders of the Company, copies of any information or documents sent by the Company to its stockholders.

 

(iii)          Treasury will use reasonable best efforts to hold, and will use reasonable best efforts to cause its agents, consultants, contractors and advisors and United States executive branch officials and employees, to hold, in confidence all non-public records, books, contracts, instruments, computer data and other data and information (collectively, “Information”) concerning the Company furnished or made available to it by the Company or its representatives pursuant to this Agreement (except to the extent that such information can be shown to have been (A) previously known by such party on a non-confidential basis, (B) in the public domain through no fault of such party or (C) later lawfully acquired from other sources by the party to which it was furnished (and without violation of any other confidentiality obligation)); provided that nothing herein shall prevent Treasury from disclosing any Information to the extent required by applicable laws or regulations or by any subpoena or similar legal process.  Treasury understands that the Information may contain commercially sensitive confidential information entitled to an exception from a Freedom of Information Act request.

 

(iv)          Treasury’s information rights pursuant to Section 3.1(c)(ii)(A), (B), (C), (E) and (F) and Treasury’s right to receive certifications from the Company pursuant to Section 3.1(d)(i) may be assigned by Treasury to a transferee or assignee of the Preferred Shares with a liquidation preference of no less than an amount equal to 2% of the initial aggregate liquidation preference of the Preferred Shares.

 

(v)           Nothing in this Section shall be construed to limit the authority that any Oversight Official or any other applicable regulatory authority has under law.

 

(vi)          The Company shall provide to Treasury all such information as Treasury may request from time to time for the purpose of carrying out the study required by Section 4112 of the SBJA.

 

(d)          Quarterly Supplemental Reports and Annual Certifications.

 

(i)            Concurrently with the submission of Call Reports by the Company or the IDI Subsidiary(ies) (as the case may be) for each quarter ending after the Closing Date, the Company shall deliver to Treasury a certificate in substantially the form attached hereto as Annex H setting forth a complete and accurate statement of loans held by the Company in each of the categories described therein, for the time periods specified therein, (A) including a signed certification of the Chief Executive Officer, the Chief Financial Officer and all directors or trustees of the Company or the IDI Subsidiary(ies) who attested to the Call Report for the quarter covered by such certificate, that such certificate (x) has been prepared in conformance with the

 

17



 

instructions issued by Treasury and (y) is true and correct to the best of their knowledge and belief; (B) completed for such quarter (each, a “Quarterly Supplemental Report”).

 

(ii)           Within ninety (90) days after the end of each fiscal year of the Company during which the Initial Supplemental Report is submitted pursuant to Section 1.3(j) or the first ten (10) Quarterly Supplemental Reports are submitted pursuant to Section 3.1(d)(i), the Company shall deliver to Treasury a certification from the Company’s independent auditors that the Initial Supplemental Report and/or Quarterly Supplemental Reports during such fiscal year are complete and accurate with respect to accounting matters, including policies and procedures and controls over such.

 

(iii)          Until the date on which the Preferred Shares are redeemed pursuant to Section 5 of the Statement of Designations, within ninety (90) days after the end of each fiscal year of the Company, the Company shall deliver to Treasury a certificate in substantially the form attached hereto as Annex I, signed on behalf of the Company by an Executive Officer.

 

(iv)          If any Initial Supplemental Report or Quarterly Supplemental Report is inaccurate, Treasury shall be entitled to recover from the Company, upon demand, the amount of any difference between (x) the amount of the dividend payment(s) actually made to Treasury based on such inaccurate report and (y) the correct amount of the dividend payment(s) that should have been made, but for such inaccuracy.  The Company shall provide Treasury with a written description of any such inaccuracy within three (3) business days after the Company’s discovery thereof.

 

(v)           Treasury shall have the right from time to time to modify Annex H,  by posting an amended and restated version of Annex H on Treasury’s web site, to conform Annex H to (A) reflect changes in GAAP, (B) reflect changes in the form or content of, or definitions used in, Call Reports, or (C) to make clarifications and/or technical corrections as Treasury determines to be reasonably necessary.  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, upon posting by Treasury on its web site, Annex H shall be deemed to be amended and restated as so posted, without the need for any further act on the part of any person or entity.  If any such modification includes a change to the caption or number of any line item of Annex H, any reference herein to such line item shall thereafter be a reference to such re-captioned or re-numbered line item.

 

(e)           Bank and Thrift Holding Company Status.  If the Company is a Bank Holding Company or a Savings and Loan Holding Company on the Signing Date, then the Company shall maintain its status as a Bank Holding Company or Savings and Loan Holding Company, as the case may be, for as long as Treasury owns any Preferred Shares.  The Company shall redeem all Preferred Shares held by Treasury prior to terminating its status as a Bank Holding Company or Savings and Loan Holding Company, as applicable.

 

(f)            Predominantly Financial.  For as long as Treasury owns any Preferred Shares, the Company, to the extent it is not itself an insured depository institution, agrees to remain predominantly engaged in financial activities.  A company is predominantly engaged in financial activities if the annual gross revenues derived by the company and all subsidiaries of

 

18



 

the company (excluding revenues derived from subsidiary depository institutions), on a consolidated basis, from engaging in activities that are financial in nature or are incidental to a financial activity under subsection (k) of Section 4 of the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (12 U.S.C. 1843(k)) represent at least 85 percent of the consolidated annual gross revenues of the company.

 

(g)           Capital Covenant.  From the Signing Date until the date on which all of the Preferred Shares have been redeemed in whole, the Company and the Company Subsidiaries shall maintain such capital as may be necessary to meet the minimum capital requirements of the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency, as in effect from time to time.

 

(h)           Reporting Requirements.  Prior to the date on which all of the Preferred Shares have been redeemed in whole, the Company covenants and agrees that, at all times on or after the Closing Date, (i) to the extent it is subject to the reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, it shall comply with the terms and conditions set forth in Annex E or (ii) as soon as practicable after the date that the Company becomes subject to the reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, it shall comply with the terms and conditions set forth in Annex E.

 

(i)            Transfer of Proceeds to Depository Institutions.  If the Company is a Bank Holding Company or a Savings and Loan Holding Company, the Company shall immediately transfer to the IDI Subsidiaries, as equity capital contributions (in a manner that will cause such equity capital contributions to qualify for inclusion in the Tier 1 capital of the IDI Subsidiaries), not less than ninety percent (90%) of the proceeds it receives in connection with the sale of Preferred Shares; provided, however, that:

 

(A)          no IDI Subsidiary shall receive any amount pursuant to this Section 3.1(i) in excess of (A) three percent (3%) of the insured depository institution’s Total Risk-Weighted Assets as reported in its Call Report filed immediately prior to the Application Date, if the insured depository institution has Total Assets of more than $1,000,000,000 and less than $10,000,000,000 as of December 31, 2009or (B) five percent (5%) of the IDI Subsidiary’s Total Risk-Weighted Assets as reported in its Call Report filed immediately prior to the Application Date, if the IDI Subsidiary has Total Assets of $1,000,000,000 or less as of December 31, 2009; and

 

(B)          if Treasury held Previously Acquired Preferred Shares immediately prior to the Closing Date, the amount required to be transferred pursuant this Section 3.1(i) shall be the difference obtained by subtracting the Repayment Amount from the Purchase Price (unless the Purchase Price is less than the Repayment Amount, in which case no amount shall be required to be transferred pursuant to this Section 3.1(i)).

 

(j)            Outreach to Minorities, Women and Veterans.  The Company shall comply with Section 4103(d)(8) of the SBJA.

 

(k)           Certification Related to Sex Offender Registration and Notification Act.  The Company shall obtain from any business to which it makes a loan that is funded in whole or

 

19



 

in part using funds from the Purchase Price a written certification that no principal of such business has been convicted of a sex offense against a minor (as such terms are defined in section 111 of the Sex Offender Registration and Notification Act, 42 U.S.C. §16911).  The Company shall retain all such certifications in accordance with standard recordkeeping practices established by the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency.

 

3.2          Negative Covenants.  The Company hereby covenants and agrees with Treasury that:

 

(a)           Certain Transactions.

 

(i)            The Company shall not merge or consolidate with, or sell, transfer or lease all or substantially all of its property or assets to, any other party unless the successor, transferee or lessee party (or its ultimate parent entity), as the case may be (if not the Company), expressly assumes the due and punctual performance and observance of each and every covenant, agreement and condition of this Agreement to be performed and observed by the Company.

 

(ii)           Without the prior written consent of Treasury, until such time as Treasury shall cease to own any Preferred Shares, the Company shall not permit any of its “significant subsidiaries” (as such term is defined in Rule 12b-2 promulgated under the Exchange Act) to (A) engage in any merger, consolidation, statutory share exchange or similar transaction following the consummation of which such significant subsidiary is not wholly-owned by the Company, (B) dissolve or sell all or substantially all of its assets or property other than in connection with an internal reorganization or consolidation involving wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company or (C) issue or sell any shares of its capital stock or any securities convertible or exercisable for any such shares, other than issuances or sales in connection with an internal reorganization or consolidation involving wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Company.

 

(b)           Restriction on Dividends and Repurchases.  The Company covenants and agrees that it shall not violate any of the restrictions on dividends, distributions, redemptions, repurchases, acquisitions and related actions set forth in the Statement of Designations, which are incorporated by reference herein as if set forth in full.

 

(c)           Related Party Transactions.  Until such time as Treasury ceases to own any debt or equity securities of the Company, including the Preferred Shares, the Company and the Company Subsidiaries shall not enter into transactions with Affiliates or related persons (within the meaning of Item 404 under the SEC’s Regulation S-K) unless (A) such transactions are on terms no less favorable to the Company and the Company Subsidiaries than could be obtained from an unaffiliated third party, and (B) have been approved by the audit committee of the Board of Directors or comparable body of independent directors of the Company, or if there are no independent directors, the Board of Directors, provided that the Board of Directors shall maintain written documentation which supports its determination that the transaction meets the requirements of clause (A) of this Section 3.2(c).

 

20



 

ARTICLE IV

ADDITIONAL AGREEMENTS

 

4.1          Purchase for Investment.  Treasury acknowledges that the Preferred Shares have not been registered under the Securities Act or under any state securities laws. Treasury (a) is acquiring the Preferred Shares pursuant to an exemption from registration under the Securities Act solely for investment with no present intention to distribute them to any person in violation of the Securities Act or any applicable U.S. state securities laws, (b) will not sell or otherwise dispose of any of the Preferred Shares, except in compliance with the registration requirements or exemption provisions of the Securities Act and any applicable U.S. state securities laws, and (c) has such knowledge and experience in financial and business matters and in investments of this type that it is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of the Purchase and of making an informed investment decision.

 

4.2          Legends.  (a)  Treasury agrees that all certificates or other instruments representing the Preferred Shares will bear a legend substantially to the following effect:

 

“THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT ARE NOT SAVINGS ACCOUNTS, DEPOSITS OR OTHER OBLIGATIONS OF A BANK AND ARE NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.

 

THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE AND MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED, SOLD OR OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF EXCEPT WHILE A REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING THERETO IS IN EFFECT UNDER SUCH ACT AND APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS OR PURSUANT TO AN EXEMPTION FROM REGISTRATION UNDER SUCH ACT OR SUCH LAWS. EACH PURCHASER OF THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT IS NOTIFIED THAT THE SELLER MAY BE RELYING ON THE EXEMPTION FROM SECTION 5 OF THE SECURITIES ACT PROVIDED BY RULE 144A THEREUNDER (THE “144A EXEMPTION”).  IF ANY TRANSFEREE OF THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT IS ADVISED BY THE TRANSFEROR THAT SUCH TRANSFEROR IS RELYING ON THE 144A EXEMPTION, SUCH TRANSFEREE BY ITS ACCEPTANCE HEREOF (1) REPRESENTS THAT IT IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” (AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT), (2) AGREES THAT IT WILL NOT OFFER, SELL OR OTHERWISE TRANSFER THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT EXCEPT (A) PURSUANT TO A REGISTRATION STATEMENT WHICH IS THEN EFFECTIVE UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT, (B) FOR SO LONG AS THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT ARE ELIGIBLE FOR RESALE PURSUANT TO RULE 144A, TO A PERSON IT REASONABLY BELIEVES IS A “QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER” AS DEFINED IN RULE 144A UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT THAT PURCHASES FOR ITS OWN ACCOUNT OR FOR THE ACCOUNT OF A QUALIFIED INSTITUTIONAL BUYER TO WHOM NOTICE IS GIVEN THAT THE TRANSFER IS BEING MADE IN RELIANCE

 

21



 

ON RULE 144A, (C) TO THE ISSUER OR (D) PURSUANT TO ANY OTHER AVAILABLE EXEMPTION FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF THE SECURITIES ACT AND (3) AGREES THAT IT WILL GIVE TO EACH PERSON TO WHOM THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT ARE TRANSFERRED A NOTICE SUBSTANTIALLY TO THE EFFECT OF THIS LEGEND.

 

THIS INSTRUMENT IS ISSUED SUBJECT TO THE RESTRICTIONS ON TRANSFER AND OTHER PROVISIONS OF A SECURITIES PURCHASE AGREEMENT BETWEEN THE ISSUER OF THESE SECURITIES AND TREASURY, A COPY OF WHICH IS ON FILE WITH THE ISSUER.  THE SECURITIES REPRESENTED BY THIS INSTRUMENT MAY NOT BE SOLD OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE WITH SAID AGREEMENT.  ANY SALE OR OTHER TRANSFER NOT IN COMPLIANCE WITH SAID AGREEMENT WILL BE VOID.”

 

(b)           In the event that any Preferred Shares (i) become registered under the Securities Act or (ii) are eligible to be transferred without restriction in accordance with Rule 144 or another exemption from registration under the Securities Act (other than Rule 144A), the Company shall issue new certificates or other instruments representing such Preferred Shares, which shall not contain the applicable legends in Section 4.2(a) above; provided that Treasury surrenders to the Company the previously issued certificates or other instruments.

 

4.3          Transfer of Preferred Shares.  Subject to compliance with applicable securities laws, Treasury shall be permitted to transfer, sell, assign or otherwise dispose of (“Transfer”) all or a portion of the Preferred Shares at any time, and the Company shall take all steps as may be reasonably requested by Treasury to facilitate the Transfer of the Preferred Shares, including without limitation, as set forth in Section 4.4, provided that Treasury shall not Transfer any Preferred Shares if such transfer would require the Company to be subject to the periodic reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”) and the Company was not already subject to such requirements.  In furtherance of the foregoing, the Company shall provide reasonable cooperation to facilitate any Transfers of the Preferred Shares, including, as is reasonable under the circumstances, by furnishing such information concerning the Company and its business as a proposed transferee may reasonably request and making management of the Company reasonably available to respond to questions of a proposed transferee in accordance with customary practice, subject in all cases to the proposed transferee agreeing to a customary confidentiality agreement.

 

4.4          Rule 144; Rule 144A; 4(1½) Transactions. (a)  At all times after the Signing Date, the Company covenants that (1) it will, upon the request of Treasury or any subsequent holders of the Preferred Shares (“Holders”), use its reasonable best efforts to (x), to the extent any Holder is relying on Rule 144 under the Securities Act to sell any of the Preferred Shares, make “current public information” available, as provided in Section (c)(1) of Rule 144 (if the Company is a “Reporting Issuer” within the meaning of Rule 144) or in Section (c)(2) of Rule 144 (if the Company is a “Non-Reporting Issuer” within the meaning of Rule 144), in either case for such time period as necessary to permit sales pursuant to Rule 144, (y), to the extent any Holder is relying on the so-called “Section 4(1½)” exemption to sell any of its Preferred

 

22



 

Shares, prepare and provide to such Holder such information, including the preparation of private offering memoranda or circulars or financial information, as the Holder may reasonably request to enable the sale of the Preferred Shares pursuant to such exemption, or (z) to the extent any Holder is relying on Rule 144A under the Securities Act to sell any of its Preferred Shares, prepare and provide to such Holder the information required pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4), and (2) it will take such further action as any Holder may reasonably request from time to time to enable such Holder to sell Preferred Shares without registration under the Securities Act within the limitations of the exemptions provided by (i) the provisions of the Securities Act or any interpretations thereof or related thereto by the SEC, including transactions based on the so-called “Section 4(1½)” and other similar transactions, (ii) Rule 144 or 144A under the Securities Act, as such rules may be amended from time to time, or (iii) any similar rule or regulation hereafter adopted by the SEC; provided that the Company shall not be required to take any action described in this Section 4.4(a) that would cause the Company to become subject to the reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act if the Company was not subject to such requirements prior to taking such action.  Upon the request of any Holder, the Company will deliver to such Holder a written statement as to whether it has complied with such requirements and, if not, the specifics thereof.

 

(b)           The Company agrees to indemnify Treasury, Treasury’s officials, officers, employees, agents, representatives and Affiliates, and each person, if any, that controls Treasury within the meaning of the Securities Act (each, an “Indemnitee”), against any and all losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs and expenses (including reasonable fees, expenses and disbursements of attorneys and other professionals incurred in connection with investigating, defending, settling, compromising or paying any such losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs and expenses), joint or several, arising out of or based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of material fact contained in any document or report provided by the Company pursuant to this Section 4.4 or any omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.

 

(c)           If the indemnification provided for in Section 4.4(b) is unavailable to an Indemnitee with respect to any losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs or expenses referred to therein or is insufficient to hold the Indemnitee harmless as contemplated therein, then the Company, in lieu of indemnifying such Indemnitee, shall contribute to the amount paid or payable by such Indemnitee as a result of such losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs or expenses in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative fault of the Indemnitee, on the one hand, and the Company, on the other hand, in connection with the statements or omissions which resulted in such losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs or expenses as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.  The relative fault of the Company, on the one hand, and of the Indemnitee, on the other hand, shall be determined by reference to, among other factors, whether the untrue statement of a material fact or omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the Company or by the Indemnitee and the parties’ relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission; the Company and Treasury agree that it would not be just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 4.4(c) were determined by pro rata allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take account of the equitable considerations referred to in Section 4.4(b).  No Indemnitee guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the

 

23



 

meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from the Company if the Company was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

 

4.5          Depositary Shares.  Upon request by Treasury at any time following the Closing Date, the Company shall promptly enter into a depositary arrangement, pursuant to customary agreements reasonably satisfactory to Treasury and with a depositary reasonably acceptable to Treasury, pursuant to which the Preferred Shares may be deposited and depositary shares, each representing a fraction of a Preferred Share, as specified by Treasury, may be issued. From and after the execution of any such depositary arrangement, and the deposit of any Preferred Shares, as applicable, pursuant thereto, the depositary shares issued pursuant thereto shall be deemed “Preferred Shares” and, as applicable, “Registrable Securities” for purposes of this Agreement.

 

4.6          Expenses and Further Assurances.  (a)  Unless otherwise provided in this Agreement, each of the parties hereto will bear and pay all costs and expenses incurred by it or on its behalf in connection with the transactions contemplated under this Agreement, including fees and expenses of its own financial or other consultants, investment bankers, accountants and counsel.

 

(b)           The Company shall, at the Company’s sole cost and expense, (i) furnish to Treasury all instruments, documents and other agreements required to be furnished by the Company pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, including, without limitation, any documents required to be delivered pursuant to Section 4.4 above, or which are reasonably requested by Treasury in connection therewith; (ii) execute and deliver to Treasury such documents, instruments, certificates, assignments and other writings, and do such other acts necessary or desirable, to evidence, preserve and/or protect the Preferred Shares purchased by Treasury, as Treasury may reasonably require; and (iii) do and execute all and such further lawful and reasonable acts, conveyances and assurances for the better and more effective carrying out of the intents and purposes of this Agreement, as Treasury shall reasonably require from time to time.

 

ARTICLE V

MISCELLANEOUS

 

5.1          Termination.  This Agreement shall terminate upon the earliest to occur of:

 

(a)           termination at any time prior to the Closing:

 

(i)            by either Treasury or the Company if the Closing shall not have occurred on or before the 30th calendar day following the date on which Treasury issued its preliminary approval of the Company’s application to participate in SBLF (the “Closing Deadline”); provided, however, that in the event the Closing has not occurred by the Closing Deadline, the parties will consult in good faith to determine whether to extend the term of this Agreement, it being understood that the parties shall be required to consult only until the fifth calendar day after the Closing Deadline and not be under any obligation to extend the term of this Agreement thereafter; provided, further, that the right to terminate this Agreement under this Section 5.1(a)(i) shall not be available to any party whose breach of any representation or

 

24



 

warranty or failure to perform any obligation under this Agreement shall have caused or resulted in the failure of the Closing to occur on or prior to such date; or

 

(ii)           by either Treasury or the Company in the event that any Governmental Entity shall have issued an order, decree or ruling or taken any other action restraining, enjoining or otherwise prohibiting the transactions contemplated by this Agreement, and such order, decree, ruling or other action shall have become final and nonappealable; or

 

(iii)          by the mutual written consent of Treasury and the Company; or

 

(b)           the date on which all of the Preferred Shares have been redeemed in whole; or

 

(c)           the date on which Treasury has transferred all of the Preferred Shares to third parties which are not Affiliates of Treasury.

 

In the event of termination of this Agreement as provided in this Section 5.1, this Agreement shall forthwith become void and there shall be no liability on the part of either party hereto except that nothing herein shall relieve either party from liability for any breach of this Agreement.

 

5.2          Survival.

 

(a)           This Agreement and all representations, warranties, covenants and agreements made herein shall survive the Closing without limitation.

 

(b)           The covenants set forth in Article III and Annex E and the agreements set forth in Article IV shall, to the extent such covenants do not explicitly terminate at such time as Treasury no longer owns any Preferred Shares, survive the termination of this Agreement pursuant to Section 5.1(c) without limitation until the date on which all of the Preferred Shares have been redeemed in whole.

 

(c)           The rights and remedies of Treasury with respect to the representations, warranties, covenants and obligations of the Company herein shall not be affected by any investigation conducted with respect to, or any knowledge acquired (or capable of being acquired) at any time by Treasury or any of its personnel or agents with respect to the accuracy or inaccuracy of, or compliance with, any such representation, warranty, covenant or obligation.

 

5.3          Amendment.  No amendment of any provision of this Agreement will be effective unless made in writing and signed by an officer or a duly authorized representative of each party, except as set forth in Section 3.1(d)(v).  No failure or delay by any party in exercising any right, power or privilege hereunder shall operate as a waiver thereof nor shall any single or partial exercise thereof preclude any other or further exercise of any other right, power or privilege.  The rights and remedies herein provided shall be cumulative of any rights or remedies provided by law.

 

5.4          Waiver of Conditions.  The conditions to each party’s obligation to consummate the Purchase are for the sole benefit of such party and may be waived by such party in whole or

 

25



 

in part to the extent permitted by applicable law. No waiver will be effective unless it is in a writing signed by a duly authorized officer of the waiving party that makes express reference to the provision or provisions subject to such waiver.

 

5.5          Governing Law; Submission to Jurisdiction, etc.  This Agreement and any claim, controversy or dispute arising under or related to this Agreement, the relationship of the parties, and/or the interpretation and enforcement of the rights and duties of the parties shall be enforced, governed, and construed in all respects (whether in contract or in tort) in accordance with the federal law of the United States if and to the extent such law is applicable, and otherwise in accordance with the laws of the State of New York applicable to contracts made and to be performed entirely within such State. Each of the parties hereto agrees (a) to submit to the exclusive jurisdiction and venue of the United States District Court for the District of Columbia and the United States Court of Federal Claims for any and all civil actions, suits or proceedings arising out of or relating to this Agreement or the Purchase contemplated hereby and (b) that notice may be served upon (i) the Company at the address and in the manner set forth for notices to the Company in Section 5.7 and (ii) Treasury at the address and in the manner set forth for notices to the Company in Section 5.7, but otherwise in accordance with federal law. TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY UNCONDITIONALLY WAIVES TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY CIVIL LEGAL ACTION OR PROCEEDING RELATING TO THIS AGREEMENT OR THE PURCHASE CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.

 

5.6          No Relationship to TARP.  The parties acknowledge and agree that (i) the SBLF program is separate and distinct from the Troubled Asset Relief Program established by the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008; and (ii) the Company shall not, by virtue of the investment contemplated hereby, be considered a recipient under the Troubled Asset Relief Program.

 

5.7          Notices.  Any notice, request, instruction or other document to be given hereunder by any party to the other will be in writing and will be deemed to have been duly given (a) on the date of delivery if delivered personally, or by facsimile, upon confirmation of receipt, or (b) on the second business day following the date of dispatch if delivered by a recognized next day courier service.  All notices to the Company shall be delivered as set forth on the cover page of this Agreement, or pursuant to such other instruction as may be designated in writing by the Company to Treasury.  All notices to Treasury shall be delivered as set forth below, or pursuant to such other instructions as may be designated in writing by Treasury to the Company.

 

If to Treasury:

 

United States Department of the Treasury

1500 Pennsylvania Avenue, NW

Washington, D.C. 20220

Attention:  Small Business Lending Fund, Office of Domestic Finance

 

E-mail: SBLFComplSubmissions@treasury.gov

 

26


 

5.8          Assignment.  Neither this Agreement nor any right, remedy, obligation nor liability arising hereunder or by reason hereof shall be assignable by any party hereto without the prior written consent of the other party, and any attempt to assign any right, remedy, obligation or liability hereunder without such consent shall be void, except (a) an assignment, in the case of a merger, consolidation, statutory share exchange or similar transaction that requires the approval of the Company’s stockholders (a “Business Combination”) where such party is not the surviving entity, or a sale of substantially all of its assets, to the entity which is the survivor of such Business Combination or the purchaser in such sale, (b) an assignment of certain rights as provided in Sections 3.1(c) or 3.1(h) or Annex E or (c) an assignment by Treasury of this Agreement to an Affiliate of Treasury; provided that if Treasury assigns this Agreement to an Affiliate, Treasury shall be relieved of its obligations under this Agreement but (i) all rights, remedies and obligations of Treasury hereunder shall continue and be enforceable by such Affiliate, (ii) the Company’s obligations and liabilities hereunder shall continue to be outstanding and (iii) all references to Treasury herein shall be deemed to be references to such Affiliate.

 

5.9          Severability.  If any provision of this Agreement, or the application thereof to any person or circumstance, is determined by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, void or unenforceable, the remaining provisions hereof, or the application of such provision to persons or circumstances other than those as to which it has been held invalid or unenforceable, will remain in full force and effect and shall in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated thereby, so long as the economic or legal substance of the transactions contemplated hereby is not affected in any manner materially adverse to any party. Upon such determination, the parties shall negotiate in good faith in an effort to agree upon a suitable and equitable substitute provision to effect the original intent of the parties.

 

5.10        No Third Party Beneficiaries.  Other than as expressly provided herein, nothing contained in this Agreement, expressed or implied, is intended to confer upon any person or entity other than the Company and Treasury (and any Indemnitee) any benefit, right or remedies.

 

5.11        Specific Performance.  The parties agree that irreparable damage would occur in the event that any of the provisions of this Agreement were not performed in accordance with their specific terms.  It is accordingly agreed that the parties shall be entitled (without the necessity of posting a bond) to specific performance of the terms hereof, this being in addition to any other remedies to which they are entitled at law or equity.

 

5.12        Interpretation.  When a reference is made in this Agreement to “Articles” or “Sections” such reference shall be to an Article or Section of the Annex of this Agreement in which such reference is contained, unless otherwise indicated.  When a reference is made in this Agreement to an “Annex”, such reference shall be to an Annex to this Agreement, unless otherwise indicated.  The terms defined in the singular have a comparable meaning when used in the plural, and vice versa.  References to “herein”, “hereof”, “hereunder” and the like refer to this Agreement as a whole and not to any particular section or provision, unless the context requires otherwise. The table of contents and headings contained in this Agreement are for reference purposes only and are not part of this Agreement. Whenever the words “include”, “includes” or “including” are used in this Agreement, they shall be deemed to be followed by the words “without limitation”.  No rule of construction against the draftsperson shall be applied in

 

27



 

connection with the interpretation or enforcement of this Agreement, as this Agreement is entered into between sophisticated parties advised by counsel.  All references to “$” or “dollars” mean the lawful currency of the United States of America.  Except as expressly stated in this Agreement, all references to any statute, rule or regulation are to the statute, rule or regulation as amended, modified, supplemented or replaced from time to time (and, in the case of statutes, include any rules and regulations promulgated under the statute) and to any section of any statute, rule or regulation include any successor to the section.  References to a “business day” shall mean any day except Saturday, Sunday and any day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or the District of Columbia generally are authorized or required by law or other governmental actions to close.

 

28



 

ANNEX D

DISCLOSURE SCHEDULE

 

Part 2.2                 Capitalization

 

Capital stock reserved for issuance in connection with securities or obligations giving the holder thereof the right to acquire such capital:

 

700,000 shares

 

 

 

Shares issued since the Capitalization Date upon exercise of options or pursuant to equity-based awards, warrants, or convertible securities:

 

27,000 Option and Grant shares

 

 

 

All other shares issued since the Capitalization Date:

 

1,823,362 shares

 

 

 

Holders of 5% or more of any class of capital stock

 

Primary Address

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury pursuant to their Capital Purchase Program:  Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A and B

 

1500 Pennsylvania Avenue, NW
Washington, D.C.  20220

 

 

 

SunTx Capital Partners

 

Two Lincoln Centre, Suite 1000
Dallas TX  75240

 

 

 

WCM Parkway

 

3412 Caruth
Dallas TX 75225

 

 

 

Greg Allen

 

13455 Noel Rd # 2000
Dallas, TX  75240

 

If the Company is a Bank Holding Company or Savings and Loan Holding Company, complete the following (leave blank otherwise):

 

Name of IDI Subsidiary

 

Percentage of IDI Subsidiary’s capital stock owned by the Company

 

 

 

Veritex Community Bank

 

100%

 

1



 

Part 2.13               Compliance With Laws

 

List any exceptions to the representation and warranty in the second sentence of Section 2.13 of the General Terms and Conditions.  If none, please so indicate by checking the box:  x.

 

List any exceptions to the representation and warranty in the last sentence of Section 2.13 of the General Terms and Conditions.  If none, please so indicate by checking the box:  x.

 

2



 

Part 2.19               Regulatory Agreements

 

List any exceptions to the representation and warranty in Section 2.19 of the General Terms and Conditions.  If none, please so indicate by checking the box: x.

 

3



 

Part 2.25               Related Party Transactions

 

List any exceptions to the representation and warranty in Section 2.25 of the General Terms and Conditions.  If none, please so indicate by checking the box: x.

 

4


 

ANNEX E

REGISTRATION RIGHTS

 

1.         Definitions.  Terms not defined in this Annex shall have the meaning ascribed to such terms in the Agreement. As used in this Annex E, the following terms shall have the following respective meanings:

 

(a)       “Holder” means Treasury and any other holder of Registrable Securities to whom the registration rights conferred by this Agreement have been transferred in compliance with Section 9 of this Annex E.

 

(b)       “Holders’ Counsel” means one counsel for the selling Holders chosen by Holders holding a majority interest in the Registrable Securities being registered.

 

(c)       “Pending Underwritten Offering” means, with respect to any Holder forfeiting its rights pursuant to Section 11 of this Annex E, any underwritten offering of Registrable Securities in which such Holder has advised the Company of its intent to register its Registrable Securities either pursuant to Section 2(b) or 2(d) of this Annex E prior to the date of such Holder’s forfeiture.

 

(d)       “Register”, “registered”, and “registration” shall refer to a registration effected by preparing and (A) filing a registration statement or amendment thereto in compliance with the Securities Act and applicable rules and regulations thereunder, and the declaration or ordering of effectiveness of such registration statement or amendment thereto or (B) filing a prospectus and/or prospectus supplement in respect of an appropriate effective registration statement on Form S-3.

 

(e)       “Registrable Securities” means (A) all Preferred Shares and (B) any equity securities issued or issuable directly or indirectly with respect to the securities referred to in the foregoing clause (A) by way of conversion, exercise or exchange thereof, or share dividend or share split or in connection with a combination of shares, recapitalization, reclassification, merger, amalgamation, arrangement, consolidation or other reorganization, provided that, once issued, such securities will not be Registrable Securities when (1) they are sold pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act, (2) they shall have ceased to be outstanding or (3) they have been sold in any transaction in which the transferor’s rights under this Agreement are not assigned to the transferee of the securities.  No Registrable Securities may be registered under more than one registration statement at any one time.

 

(f)        “Registration Expenses” mean all expenses incurred by the Company in effecting any registration pursuant to this Agreement (whether or not any registration or prospectus becomes effective or final) or otherwise complying with its obligations under this Annex E, including all registration, filing and listing fees, printing expenses, fees and disbursements of counsel for the Company, blue sky fees and expenses, expenses incurred in connection with any “road show”, the reasonable fees and disbursements of Holders’ Counsel, and expenses of the Company’s independent accountants in connection with any regular or

 

1



 

special reviews or audits incident to or required by any such registration, but shall not include Selling Expenses.

 

(g)       “Rule 144”, “Rule 144A”, “Rule 159A”, “Rule 405” and “Rule 415” mean, in each case, such rule promulgated under the Securities Act (or any successor provision), as the same shall be amended from time to time.

 

(h)       “Selling Expenses” mean all discounts, selling commissions and stock transfer taxes applicable to the sale of Registrable Securities and fees and disbursements of counsel for any Holder (other than the fees and disbursements of Holders’ Counsel included in Registration Expenses).

 

(i)        “Special Registration” means the registration of (A) equity securities and/or options or other rights in respect thereof solely registered on Form S-4 or Form S-8 (or successor form) or (B) shares of equity securities and/or options or other rights in respect thereof to be offered to directors, members of management, employees, consultants, customers, lenders or vendors of the Company or Company Subsidiaries or in connection with dividend reinvestment plans.

 

2.         Registration.

 

(a)       The Company covenants and agrees that as promptly as practicable after the date that the Company becomes subject to the reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act (and in any event no later than 30 days thereafter), the Company shall prepare and file with the SEC a Shelf Registration Statement covering all Registrable Securities (or otherwise designate an existing shelf registration on an appropriate form under Rule 415 under the Securities Act (a “Shelf Registration Statement”) filed with the SEC to cover the Registrable Securities), and, to the extent the Shelf Registration Statement has not theretofore been declared effective or is not automatically effective upon such filing, the Company shall use reasonable best efforts to cause such Shelf Registration Statement to be declared or become effective and to keep such Shelf Registration Statement continuously effective and in compliance with the Securities Act and usable for resale of such Registrable Securities for a period from the date of its initial effectiveness until such time as there are no Registrable Securities remaining (including by refiling such Shelf Registration Statement (or a new Shelf Registration Statement) if the initial Shelf Registration Statement expires).  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the Company is not eligible to file a registration statement on Form S-3, then the Company shall not be obligated to file a Shelf Registration Statement unless and until requested to do so in writing by Treasury.

 

(b)       Any registration pursuant to Section 2(a) of this Annex E shall be effected by means of a Shelf Registration Statement on an appropriate form under Rule 415 under the Securities Act (a “Shelf Registration Statement”).  If any Holder intends to distribute any Registrable Securities by means of an underwritten offering it shall promptly so advise the Company and the Company shall take all reasonable steps to facilitate such distribution, including the actions required pursuant to Section 2(d) of this Annex E; provided that the Company shall not be required to facilitate an underwritten offering of Registrable Securities unless (i) the expected gross proceeds from such offering exceed $200,000 or (ii) such underwritten offering includes all of the outstanding Registrable Securities held by such Holder.

 

2



 

The lead underwriters in any such distribution shall be selected by the Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities to be distributed.

 

(c)       The Company shall not be required to effect a registration (including a resale of Registrable Securities from an effective Shelf Registration Statement) or an underwritten offering pursuant to Section 2 of this Annex E:  (A) with respect to securities that are not Registrable Securities; or (B) if the Company has notified all Holders that in the good faith judgment of the Board of Directors, it would be materially detrimental to the Company or its security holders for such registration or underwritten offering to be effected at such time, in which event the Company shall have the right to defer such registration for a period of not more than 45 days after receipt of the request of any Holder; provided that such right to delay a registration or underwritten offering shall be exercised by the Company (1) only if the Company has generally exercised (or is concurrently exercising) similar black-out rights against holders of similar securities that have registration rights and (2) not more than three times in any 12-month period and not more than 90 days in the aggregate in any 12-month period.

 

(d)       If during any period when an effective Shelf Registration Statement is not available, the Company proposes to register any of its equity securities, other than a registration pursuant to Section 2(a) of this Annex E or a Special Registration, and the registration form to be filed may be used for the registration or qualification for distribution of Registrable Securities, the Company will give prompt written notice to all Holders of its intention to effect such a registration (but in no event less than ten days prior to the anticipated filing date) and will include in such registration all Registrable Securities with respect to which the Company has received written requests for inclusion therein within ten business days after the date of the Company’s notice (a “Piggyback Registration”).  Any such person that has made such a written request may withdraw its Registrable Securities from such Piggyback Registration by giving written notice to the Company and the managing underwriter, if any, on or before the fifth business day prior to the planned effective date of such Piggyback Registration.  The Company may terminate or withdraw any registration under this Section 2(d) of this Annex E prior to the effectiveness of such registration, whether or not any Holders have elected to include Registrable Securities in such registration.

 

(e)       If the registration referred to in Section 2(d) of this Annex E is proposed to be underwritten, the Company will so advise all Holders as a part of the written notice given pursuant to Section 2(d) of this Annex E.  In such event, the right of all Holders to registration pursuant to Section 2 of this Annex E will be conditioned upon such persons’ participation in such underwriting and the inclusion of such person’s Registrable Securities in the underwriting if such securities are of the same class of securities as the securities to be offered in the underwritten offering, and each such person will (together with the Company and the other persons distributing their securities through such underwriting) enter into an underwriting agreement in customary form with the underwriter or underwriters selected for such underwriting by the Company; provided that Treasury (as opposed to other Holders) shall not be required to indemnify any person in connection with any registration. If any participating person disapproves of the terms of the underwriting, such person may elect to withdraw therefrom by written notice to the Company, the managing underwriters and Treasury (if Treasury is participating in the underwriting).

 

3



 

(f)        If either (x) the Company grants “piggyback” registration rights to one or more third parties to include their securities in an underwritten offering under the Shelf Registration Statement pursuant to Section 2(b) of this Annex E or (y) a Piggyback Registration under Section 2(d) of this Annex E relates to an underwritten offering on behalf of the Company, and in either case the managing underwriters advise the Company that in their reasonable opinion the number of securities requested to be included in such offering exceeds the number which can be sold without adversely affecting the marketability of such offering (including an adverse effect on the per share offering price), the Company will include in such offering only such number of securities that in the reasonable opinion of such managing underwriters can be sold without adversely affecting the marketability of the offering (including an adverse effect on the per share offering price), which securities will be so included in the following order of priority: (A) first, in the case of a Piggyback Registration under Section 2(d) of this Annex E, the securities the Company proposes to sell, (B) then the Registrable Securities of all Holders who have requested inclusion of Registrable Securities pursuant to Section 2(b) or Section 2(d) of this Annex E, as applicable, pro rata on the basis of the aggregate number of such securities or shares owned by each such Holder and (C) lastly, any other securities of the Company that have been requested to be so included, subject to the terms of this Agreement; provided, however, that if the Company has, prior to the Signing Date, entered into an agreement with respect to its securities that is inconsistent with the order of priority contemplated hereby then it shall apply the order of priority in such conflicting agreement to the extent that it would otherwise result in a breach under such agreement.

 

3.         Expenses of Registration.  All Registration Expenses incurred in connection with any registration, qualification or compliance hereunder shall be borne by the Company.  All Selling Expenses incurred in connection with any registrations hereunder shall be borne by the holders of the securities so registered pro rata on the basis of the aggregate offering or sale price of the securities so registered.

 

4.         Obligations of the Company.  Whenever required to effect the registration of any Registrable Securities or facilitate the distribution of Registrable Securities pursuant to an effective Shelf Registration Statement, the Company shall, as expeditiously as reasonably practicable:

 

(a)       Prepare and file with the SEC a prospectus supplement or post-effective amendment with respect to a proposed offering of Registrable Securities pursuant to an effective registration statement, subject to Section 4 of this Annex E, keep such registration statement effective and keep such prospectus supplement current until the securities described therein are no longer Registrable Securities.

 

(b)       Prepare and file with the SEC such amendments and supplements to the applicable registration statement and the prospectus or prospectus supplement used in connection with such registration statement as may be necessary to comply with the provisions of the Securities Act with respect to the disposition of all securities covered by such registration statement.

 

(c)       Furnish to the Holders and any underwriters such number of copies of the applicable registration statement and each such amendment and supplement thereto (including in

 

4



 

each case all exhibits) and of a prospectus, including a preliminary prospectus, in conformity with the requirements of the Securities Act, and such other documents as they may reasonably request in order to facilitate the disposition of Registrable Securities owned or to be distributed by them.

 

(d)       Use its reasonable best efforts to register and qualify the securities covered by such registration statement under such other securities or Blue Sky laws of such jurisdictions as shall be reasonably requested by the Holders or any managing underwriter(s), to keep such registration or qualification in effect for so long as such registration statement remains in effect, and to take any other action which may be reasonably necessary to enable such seller to consummate the disposition in such jurisdictions of the securities owned by such Holder; provided that the Company shall not be required in connection therewith or as a condition thereto to qualify to do business or to file a general consent to service of process in any such states or jurisdictions.

 

(e)       Notify each Holder of Registrable Securities at any time when a prospectus relating thereto is required to be delivered under the Securities Act of the happening of any event as a result of which the applicable prospectus, as then in effect, includes an untrue statement of a material fact or omits to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading in light of the circumstances then existing.

 

(f)        Give written notice to the Holders:

 

(i)            when any registration statement or any amendment thereto has been filed with the SEC (except for any amendment effected by the filing of a document with the SEC pursuant to the Exchange Act) and when such registration statement or any post-effective amendment thereto has become effective;

 

(ii)           of any request by the SEC for amendments or supplements to any registration statement or the prospectus included therein or for additional information;

 

(iii)          of the issuance by the SEC of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of any registration statement or the initiation of any proceedings for that purpose;

 

(iv)          of the receipt by the Company or its legal counsel of any notification with respect to the suspension of the qualification of the applicable Registrable Securities for sale in any jurisdiction or the initiation or threatening of any proceeding for such purpose;

 

(v)           of the happening of any event that requires the Company to make changes in any effective registration statement or the prospectus related to the registration statement in order to make the statements therein not misleading (which notice shall be accompanied by an instruction to suspend the use of the prospectus until the requisite changes have been made); and

 

(vi)          if at any time the representations and warranties of the Company contained in any underwriting agreement contemplated by Section 4(j) of this Annex E cease to be true and correct.

 

5



 

(g)       Use its reasonable best efforts to prevent the issuance or obtain the withdrawal of any order suspending the effectiveness of any registration statement referred to in Section 4(f)(iii) of this Annex E at the earliest practicable time.

 

(h)       Upon the occurrence of any event contemplated by Section 4(e) or 4(f)(v) of this Annex E, promptly prepare a post-effective amendment to such registration statement or a supplement to the related prospectus or file any other required document so that, as thereafter delivered to the Holders and any underwriters, the prospectus will not contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state any material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.  If the Company notifies the Holders in accordance with Section 4(f)(v) to suspend the use of the prospectus until the requisite changes to the prospectus have been made, then the Holders and any underwriters shall suspend use of such prospectus and use their reasonable best efforts to return to the Company all copies of such prospectus (at the Company’s expense) other than permanent file copies then in such Holders’ or underwriters’ possession.  The total number of days that any such suspension may be in effect in any 12-month period shall not exceed 90 days.

 

(i)        Use reasonable best efforts to procure the cooperation of the Company’s transfer agent in settling any offering or sale of Registrable Securities, including with respect to the transfer of physical stock certificates into book-entry form in accordance with any procedures reasonably requested by the Holders or any managing underwriter(s).

 

(j)        If an underwritten offering is requested pursuant to Section 2(b) of this Annex E, enter into an underwriting agreement in customary form, scope and substance and take all such other actions reasonably requested by the Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities being sold in connection therewith or by the managing underwriter(s), if any, to expedite or facilitate the underwritten disposition of such Registrable Securities, and in connection therewith in any underwritten offering (including making members of management and executives of the Company available to participate in “road shows”, similar sales events and other marketing activities), (A) make such representations and warranties to the Holders that are selling stockholders and the managing underwriter(s), if any, with respect to the business of the Company and its subsidiaries, and the Shelf Registration Statement, prospectus and documents, if any, incorporated or deemed to be incorporated by reference therein, in each case, in customary form, substance and scope, and, if true, confirm the same if and when requested, (B) use its reasonable best efforts to furnish the underwriters with opinions of counsel to the Company, addressed to the managing underwriter(s), if any, covering the matters customarily covered in such opinions requested in underwritten offerings, (C) use its reasonable best efforts to obtain “cold comfort” letters from the independent certified public accountants of the Company (and, if necessary, any other independent certified public accountants of any business acquired by the Company for which financial statements and financial data are included in the Shelf Registration Statement) who have certified the financial statements included in such Shelf Registration Statement, addressed to each of the managing underwriter(s), if any, such letters to be in customary form and covering matters of the type customarily covered in “cold comfort” letters, (D) if an underwriting agreement is entered into, the same shall contain indemnification provisions and procedures customary in underwritten offerings (provided that Treasury shall not be obligated to provide any indemnity), and (E) deliver such documents and certificates as may be reasonably requested by the Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities being sold in

 

6



 

connection therewith, their counsel and the managing underwriter(s), if any, to evidence the continued validity of the representations and warranties made pursuant to clause (A) above and to evidence compliance with any customary conditions contained in the underwriting agreement or other agreement entered into by the Company.

 

(k)       Make available for inspection by a representative of Holders that are selling stockholders, the managing underwriter(s), if any, and any attorneys or accountants retained by such Holders or managing underwriter(s), at the offices where normally kept, during reasonable business hours, financial and other records, pertinent corporate documents and properties of the Company, and cause the officers, directors and employees of the Company to supply all information in each case reasonably requested (and of the type customarily provided in connection with due diligence conducted in connection with a registered public offering of securities) by any such representative, managing underwriter(s), attorney or accountant in connection with such Shelf Registration Statement.

 

(l)        Use reasonable best efforts to cause all such Registrable Securities to be listed on each national securities exchange on which similar securities issued by the Company are then listed or, if no similar securities issued by the Company are then listed on any national securities exchange, use its reasonable best efforts to cause all such Registrable Securities to be listed on such securities exchange as Treasury may designate.

 

(m)      If requested by Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities being registered and/or sold in connection therewith, or the managing underwriter(s), if any, promptly include in a prospectus supplement or amendment such information as the Holders of a majority of the Registrable Securities being registered and/or sold in connection therewith or managing underwriter(s), if any, may reasonably request in order to permit the intended method of distribution of such securities and make all required filings of such prospectus supplement or such amendment as soon as practicable after the Company has received such request.

 

(n)       Timely provide to its security holders earning statements satisfying the provisions of Section 11(a) of the Securities Act and Rule 158 thereunder.

 

7



 

5.         Suspension of Sales.  Upon receipt of written notice from the Company that a registration statement, prospectus or prospectus supplement contains or may contain an untrue statement of a material fact or omits or may omit to state a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading or that circumstances exist that make inadvisable use of such registration statement, prospectus or prospectus supplement, each Holder of Registrable Securities shall forthwith discontinue disposition of Registrable Securities until such Holder has received copies of a supplemented or amended prospectus or prospectus supplement, or until such Holder is advised in writing by the Company that the use of the prospectus and, if applicable, prospectus supplement may be resumed, and, if so directed by the Company, such Holder shall deliver to the Company (at the Company’s expense) all copies, other than permanent file copies then in such Holder’s possession, of the prospectus and, if applicable, prospectus supplement covering such Registrable Securities current at the time of receipt of such notice.  The total number of days that any such suspension may be in effect in any 12-month period shall not exceed 90 days.

 

6.         Termination of Registration Rights.  A Holder’s registration rights as to any securities held by such Holder (and its Affiliates, partners, members and former members) shall not be available unless such securities are Registrable Securities.

 

7.         Furnishing Information.

 

(a)       No Holder shall use any free writing prospectus (as defined in Rule 405) in connection with the sale of Registrable Securities without the prior written consent of the Company.

 

(b)       It shall be a condition precedent to the obligations of the Company to take any action pursuant to Section 4 of this Annex E that the selling Holders and the underwriters, if any, shall furnish to the Company such information regarding themselves, the Registrable Securities held by them and the intended method of disposition of such securities as shall be required to effect the registered offering of their Registrable Securities.

 

8.         Indemnification.

 

(a)       The Company agrees to indemnify each Holder and, if a Holder is a person other than an individual, such Holder’s officers, directors, employees, agents, representatives and Affiliates, and in the case of Treasury, Treasury’s officials, and each person, if any, that controls a Holder within the meaning of the Securities Act (each, an “Indemnitee”), against any and all losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs and expenses (including reasonable fees, expenses and disbursements of attorneys and other professionals incurred in connection with investigating, defending, settling, compromising or paying any such losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs and expenses), joint or several, arising out of or based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement of material fact contained in any registration statement, including any preliminary prospectus or final prospectus contained therein or any amendments or supplements thereto or any documents incorporated therein by reference or contained in any free writing prospectus (as such term is defined in Rule 405) prepared by the Company or authorized by it in writing for use by such Holder (or any amendment or supplement thereto); or any omission to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the

 

8



 

statements therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading; provided, that the Company shall not be liable to such Indemnitee in any such case to the extent that any such loss, claim, damage, liability (or action or proceeding in respect thereof) or expense arises out of or is based upon (A) an untrue statement or omission made in such registration statement, including any such preliminary prospectus or final prospectus contained therein or any such amendments or supplements thereto or contained in any free writing prospectus (as such term is defined in Rule 405) prepared by the Company or authorized by it in writing for use by such Holder (or any amendment or supplement thereto), in reliance upon and in conformity with information regarding such Indemnitee or its plan of distribution or ownership interests which was furnished in writing to the Company by such Indemnitee for use in connection with such registration statement, including any such preliminary prospectus or final prospectus contained therein or any such amendments or supplements thereto, or (B)  offers or sales effected by or on behalf of such Indemnitee “by means of” (as defined in Rule 159A) a “free writing prospectus” (as defined in Rule 405) that was not authorized in writing by the Company.

 

(b)       If the indemnification provided for in Section 8(a) of this Annex E is unavailable to an Indemnitee with respect to any losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs or expenses referred to therein or is insufficient to hold the Indemnitee harmless as contemplated therein, then the Company, in lieu of indemnifying such Indemnitee, shall contribute to the amount paid or payable by such Indemnitee as a result of such losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs or expenses in such proportion as is appropriate to reflect the relative fault of the Indemnitee, on the one hand, and the Company, on the other hand, in connection with the statements or omissions which resulted in such losses, claims, damages, actions, liabilities, costs or expenses as well as any other relevant equitable considerations.  The relative fault of the Company, on the one hand, and of the Indemnitee, on the other hand, shall be determined by reference to, among other factors, whether the untrue statement of a material fact or omission to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the Company or by the Indemnitee and the parties’ relative intent, knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such statement or omission;  the Company and each Holder agree that it would not be just and equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 8(b) of this Annex E were determined by pro rata allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take account of the equitable considerations referred to in Section 8(a) of this Annex E.  No Indemnitee guilty of fraudulent misrepresentation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall be entitled to contribution from the Company if the Company was not guilty of such fraudulent misrepresentation.

 

9.         Assignment of Registration Rights.  The rights of Treasury to registration of Registrable Securities pursuant to Section 2 of this Annex E may be assigned by Treasury to a transferee or assignee of Registrable Securities; provided, however, the transferor shall, within ten days after such transfer, furnish to the Company written notice of the name and address of such transferee or assignee and the number and type of Registrable Securities that are being assigned.

 

10.      Clear Market.  With respect to any underwritten offering of Registrable Securities by Holders pursuant to this Annex E, the Company agrees not to effect (other than pursuant to such registration or pursuant to a Special Registration) any public sale or distribution, or to file any Shelf Registration Statement (other than such registration or a Special Registration) covering

 

9



 

any preferred stock of the Company or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for preferred stock of the Company, during the period not to exceed ten days prior and 60 days following the effective date of such offering or such longer period up to 90 days as may be requested by the managing underwriter for such underwritten offering.  The Company also agrees to cause such of its directors and senior executive officers to execute and deliver customary lock-up agreements in such form and for such time period up to 90 days as may be requested by the managing underwriter.

 

11.      Forfeiture of Rights.  At any time, any holder of Registrable Securities (including any Holder) may elect to forfeit its rights set forth in this Annex E from that date forward; provided, that a Holder forfeiting such rights shall nonetheless be entitled to participate under Section 2(d) — (f) of this Annex E in any Pending Underwritten Offering to the same extent that such Holder would have been entitled to if the Holder had not withdrawn; and provided, further, that no such forfeiture shall terminate a Holder’s rights or obligations under Section 7 of this Annex E with respect to any prior registration or Pending Underwritten Offering.

 

12.      Specific Performance.  The parties hereto acknowledge that there would be no adequate remedy at law if the Company fails to perform any of its obligations under this Annex E and that Holders from time to time may be irreparably harmed by any such failure, and accordingly agree that such Holders, in addition to any other remedy to which they may be entitled at law or in equity, to the fullest extent permitted and enforceable under applicable law shall be entitled to compel specific performance of the obligations of the Company under this Annex E in accordance with the terms and conditions of this Annex E.

 

13.      No Inconsistent Agreements.  The Company shall not, on or after the Signing Date, enter into any agreement with respect to its securities that may impair the rights granted to Holders under this Annex E or that otherwise conflicts with the provisions hereof in any manner that may impair the rights granted to Holders under this Annex E.  In the event the Company has, prior to the Signing Date, entered into any agreement with respect to its securities that is inconsistent with the rights granted to Holders under this Annex E (including agreements that are inconsistent with the order of priority contemplated by Section 2(f) of Annex E) or that may otherwise conflict with the provisions hereof, the Company shall use its reasonable best efforts to amend such agreements to ensure they are consistent with the provisions of this Annex E.

 

14.      Certain Offerings by Treasury.  An “underwritten” offering or other disposition shall include any distribution of such securities on behalf of Treasury by one or more broker-dealers, an “underwriting agreement” shall include any purchase agreement entered into by such broker-dealers, and any “registration statement” or “prospectus” shall include any offering document approved by the Company and used in connection with such distribution.

 

10


 

ANNEX F

FORM OF STATEMENT OF DESIGNATIONS

 

[SEE ATTACHED]

 

1



 

ANNEX G

FORM OF OFFICER’S CERTIFICATE

 

OFFICER’S CERTIFICATE

 

OF

 

[COMPANY]

 

In connection with that certain Securities Purchase Agreement, dated  [                        ], 2011 (the “Agreement”) by and between [COMPANY] (the “Company”) and the Secretary of the Treasury, the undersigned does hereby certify as follows:

 

1.             I am a duly elected/appointed [                        ] of the Company.

 

2.             Attached as Exhibit A hereto is a true, complete and correct copy of the articles of incorporation, articles of association, or similar organizational document of the Company and any amendments thereto as presently on file with the [Secretary of State] of the State of [State].

 

3.             Attached as Exhibit B hereto is a true, complete and correct copy of the by-laws of the Company as presently in effect.

 

4.             Attached as Exhibit C hereto is a true, complete and correct copy of resolutions adopted [at a duly convened meeting at which a quorum was present and acting /by unanimous written consent] of the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”).  Such resolutions are now in full force and effect and have not been modified, amended or revoked and are the only resolutions of the Board relating to the Agreement.

 

5.             Attached as Exhibit D hereto is a true, complete and correct copy of the resolutions adopted [at a duly convened meeting at which a quorum was present and acting /by unanimous written consent] of the [shareholders] of the Company (the “[Shareholders]”).  Such resolutions are now in full force and effect and have not been modified, amended or revoked and are the only resolutions of the [Shareholders] relating to the Agreement. —OR- Shareholder consent is not required in connection with the execution, delivery and performance of the Agreement by the Company.

 

6.             Attached as Exhibit E is a true, complete and correct copy of the Statement of Designations, which has been filed with, and accepted by, the Secretary of State of the State of [                      ].

 

7.             The representations and warranties of the Company set forth in Article II of Annex C of the Agreement are true and correct in all respects as though as of the date hereof (other than representations and warranties that by their terms speak as of another date, which representations and warranties shall be true and correct in all respects as of such other date) and the Company has performed in all material respects all obligations required to be performed by it under the Agreement.

 

1



 

The foregoing certifications are made and delivered as of [                  ] pursuant to Section 1.3 of Annex C of the Agreement.

 

Capitalized terms used and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Agreement.

 

[SIGNATURE PAGE FOLLOWS]

 

2



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Officer’s Certificate has been duly executed and delivered as of the [    ] day of [                    ], 2011.

 

 

[COMPANY]

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

3



 

EXHIBIT A

 

4



 

EXHIBIT B

 

5



 

EXHIBIT C

 

6



 

EXHIBIT D

 

7



 

EXHIBIT E

 

8



 

ANNEX H

FORM OF SUPPLEMENTAL REPORTS

 

[SEE ATTACHED FORM OF INITIAL SUPPLEMENTAL REPORT]

 

1



 

[SEE ATTACHED FORM OF QUARTERLY SUPPLEMENTAL REPORT]

 

2


 

ANNEX I

FORM OF ANNUAL CERTIFICATION

 

ANNUAL CERTIFICATION

 

OF

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

In connection with that certain Securities Purchase Agreement, dated August 25, 2011 (the “Agreement”) by and between Veritex Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) and the Secretary of the Treasury (“Treasury”), the undersigned does hereby certify as follows:

 

1.             I am a duly elected/appointed [                        ] of the Company.

 

2.             For each loan originated by the Company or any of its Affiliates that was funded in whole or in part using funds from the Purchase Price, the Company has obtained from the business to which it made such loan a written certification that no principal of such business has been convicted of a sex offense against a minor (as such terms are defined in section 111 of the Sex Offender Registration and Notification Act, 42 U.S.C. §16911).  The Company shall retain all such certifications in accordance with standard recordkeeping practices established by the Appropriate Federal Banking Agency.

 

3.             The Company is in compliance with the requirements of Section 103.121 of title 31, Code of Federal Regulations.

 

The foregoing certifications are made and delivered as of [                  ] pursuant to Section 3.1(d)(iii) of Annex C of the Agreement.

 

Capitalized terms used and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Agreement.

 

[SIGNATURE PAGE FOLLOWS]

 

1



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Certificate has been duly executed and delivered as of the [    ] day of [                    ], 20[    ].

 

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

2



 

ANNEX J

FORM OF OPINION

 

Secretary of the Treasury
1500 Pennsylvania Avenue, NW
Washington, D.C. 20220

Attention:  Small Business Lending Fund, Office of Domestic Finance

 

Re:

[Institution Name]

 

[SBLF Identification No.]

 

Ladies and/or Gentlemen:

 

We have acted as counsel for [insert Institution Name] (the “Company”) in connection with the sale and issuance of [insert number] shares of [Senior] Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series [      ] (the “Preferred Shares”) to the Secretary of the Treasury (the “Treasury”) pursuant to and in accordance with the terms of that certain Small Business Lending Fund - Securities Purchase Agreement, dated [                        , 2011] (the “Agreement”).  This letter is rendered to you pursuant to Section 1.3(f) of the Agreement and Annex J attached thereto.  Unless otherwise defined herein, capitalized terms used herein shall have the meaning set forth in the Agreement.

 

(a)          The Company has been duly formed and is validly existing as a [TYPE OF ORGANIZATION] and is in good standing under the laws of the jurisdiction of its organization.  The Company has all necessary power and authority to own, operate and lease its properties and to carry on its business as it is being conducted.

 

(b)           The Company has been duly qualified as a foreign entity for the transaction of business and is in good standing under the laws of [                          ], [                          ] and [                          ].

 

(c)           The Preferred Shares have been duly and validly authorized, and, when issued and delivered pursuant to the Agreement, the Preferred Shares will be duly and validly issued and fully paid and non-assessable, will not be issued in violation of any preemptive rights, and will rank pari passu with or senior to all other series or classes of designated preferred stock authorized on the Closing Date with respect to the payment of dividends and the distribution of assets in the event of any dissolution, liquidation or winding up of the Company.

 

(d)           The Company has the corporate power and authority to execute and deliver the Agreement and to carry out its obligations thereunder (which includes the issuance of the Preferred Shares).

 

(e)           The execution, delivery and performance by the Company of the Agreement and the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby have been duly authorized by all necessary corporate action on the part of the Company and its stockholders, and no further approval or authorization is required on the part of the Company, including, without limitation, by any rule or requirement of any national stock exchange.

 

1



 

(f)            The Agreement is a valid and binding obligation of the Company enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms, except as the same may be limited by applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization, moratorium or similar laws affecting the enforcement of creditors’ rights generally and general equitable principles, regardless of whether such enforceability is considered in a proceeding at law or in equity.

 

(g)           The execution and delivery by the Company of this Agreement and the performance by the Company of its obligations thereunder (i) do not require any approval by any Governmental Entity to be obtained on the part of the Company, except those that have been obtained, (ii) do not violate or conflict with any provision of the Charter, (iii) do not violate, conflict with, or result in a breach of any provision of, or constitute a default (or an event which, with notice or lapse of time or both, would constitute a default) under, or result in the termination of, or accelerate the performance required by, or result in a right of termination or acceleration of, or result in the creation of, any lien, security interest, charge or encumbrance upon any of the properties or assets of the Company or any Company Subsidiary under any of the terms, conditions or provisions of its organizational documents or under any agreement, contract, indenture, lease, mortgage, power of attorney, evidence of indebtedness, letter of credit, license, instrument, obligation, purchase or sales order, or other commitment, whether oral or written, to which it is a party or by which it or any of its properties is bound or (iv) do not conflict with, breach or result in a violation of, or default under any judgment, decree or order known to us that is applicable to the Company and, pursuant to any applicable laws, is issued by any Governmental Entity having jurisdiction over the Company.

 

(h)           Other than the filing of the Statement of Designations with the [Secretary of State] of its jurisdiction of organization or other applicable Governmental Entity, such filings and approvals as are required to be made or obtained under any state “blue sky” laws and such consents and approvals that have been made or obtained, no notice to, filing with, exemption or review by, or authorization, consent or approval of, any Governmental Entity is required to be made or obtained by the Company in connection with the consummation by the Company of the Purchase.

 

2



 

ANNEX K

FORM OF REPAYMENT DOCUMENT

 

UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY
1500 PENNSYLVANIA AVENUE, NW
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20220

 

Dear Ladies and Gentlemen:

 

Reference is made to that certain Letter Agreement incorporating the Securities Purchase Agreement — Standard Terms (the “Securities Purchase Agreement”), dated as of the date set forth on Schedule A hereto, between the United States Department of the Treasury (the “Investor”) and the company set forth on Schedule A hereto (the “Company”).  Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Securities Purchase Agreement.  Pursuant to the Securities Purchase Agreement, at the Closing, the Company issued to the Investor the number of shares of the series of its preferred stock set forth on Schedule A hereto (the “Preferred Shares”) and a warrant (the “Warrant”) to purchase the number of shares of [To be included for private issuers:  the series of its preferred stock set forth on Schedule A hereto (such shares, the “Warrant Shares”), which was exercised by the Investor at Closing.] [To be included for public issuers:  its common stock set forth on Schedule A hereto.]

 

In connection with the consummation of the repurchase (the “Repurchase”) by the Company from the Investor, on the date hereof, of the number of Preferred Shares listed on Schedule A hereto (the “Repurchased Preferred Shares”) [To be included for private issuers who are repurchasing some or all of the Warrant Shares:  and the number of Warrant Shares listed on Schedule A hereto (the “Repurchased Warrant Shares”)], as permitted by the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, as amended by the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009:

 

(a)           The Company hereby acknowledges receipt from the Investor of the share certificate(s) set forth on Schedule A hereto representing the Preferred Shares; [and]

 

(b)           The Investor hereby acknowledges receipt from the Company of a wire transfer for the account of the Investor in immediately available funds of the aggregate purchase price set forth on Schedule A hereto, representing payment in full for the Repurchased Preferred Shares at a price per share equal to the Liquidation Amount per share, together with any accrued and unpaid dividends to, but excluding, the date hereof;

 

[Paragraphs (c) and (d) to be included for private issuers who are repurchasing some or all of the Warrant Shares:  (c) The Company hereby acknowledges receipt from the Investor of the share certificate(s) set forth on Schedule A hereto representing the Warrant Shares; [and]

 

(d)           The Investor hereby acknowledges receipt from the Company of a wire transfer for the account of the Investor in immediately available funds of the aggregate purchase price set forth on Schedule A hereto, representing payment in full for the Repurchased Warrant Shares at a price per share equal to the Liquidation Amount per

 

1



 

share, together with any accrued and unpaid dividends to, but excluding, the date hereof [; and]]

 

[Paragraph (e) to be included for private issuers who are repurchasing less than all of the Warrant Shares:  (e) The Investor hereby acknowledges receipt from the Company of a share certificate for the number of Warrant Shares set forth on Schedule A hereto, equal to the difference between the Warrant Shares represented by the certificate referenced in clause (c) above and the Repurchased Warrant Shares.]

 

[To be included for public issuers:  The Investor and the Company hereby agree that, notwithstanding Section 4.4 of the Securities Purchase Agreement, immediately following consummation of the Repurchase, but subject to compliance with applicable securities laws, the Investor shall be permitted to Transfer all or a portion of the Warrant with respect to, and/or exercise the Warrant for, all or a portion of the number of shares of Common Stock issuable thereunder, at any time and without limitation, and Section 4.4 of the Securities Purchase Agreement shall be deemed to be amended in order to permit the foregoing.  The Company shall take all steps as may be reasonably requested by the Investor to facilitate any such Transfer.

 

In addition, the Company agrees that in the event it elects to repurchase the Warrant, it shall deliver to the Investor within 15 calendar days of the date hereof a notice of intent to repurchase the Warrant, which notice shall be in accordance with Section 4.9(b) of the Securities Purchase Agreement (the “Warrant Repurchase Notice”).  In the event the Company does not deliver the Warrant Repurchase Notice to the Investor within 15 calendar days of the date hereof, the Investor hereby provides notice, pursuant to Section 4.5(p) of the Securities Purchase Agreement, of its intention to sell the Warrant, such notice to be effective as of the first day following the end of such 15-day period.

 

In the event that the Company delivers a Warrant Repurchase Notice and the Company and the Investor fail to agree on the Fair Market Value of the Warrant pursuant to the procedures (including the Appraisal Procedure), and in accordance with the time periods, set forth in Section 4.9(c) of the Securities Purchase Agreement or the Company revokes the delivery of such Warrant Repurchase Notice, then the Investor hereby provides notice of its intention to sell the Warrant.]

 

This letter agreement will be governed by and construed in accordance with the federal law of the United States if and to the extent such law is applicable, and otherwise in accordance with the laws of the State of New York applicable to contracts made and to be performed entirely within such State.

 

This letter agreement may be executed in any number of separate counterparts, each such counterpart being deemed to be an original instrument, and all such counterparts will together constitute the same agreement.  Executed signature pages to this letter agreement may be delivered by facsimile and such facsimiles will be deemed sufficient as if actual signature pages had been delivered

 

[Remainder of this page intentionally left blank]

 

2



 

In witness whereof, the parties have duly executed this letter agreement as of the date first written above.

 

 

UNITED STATES DEPARTMENT OF THE TREASURY

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

COMPANY:

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

3



 

SCHEDULE A

 

[Version to be used by public issuers]

 

General Information:

 

 

 

 

 

Date of Letter Agreement incorporating the Securities Purchase Agreement:

 

 

 

 

 

Name of the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Corporate or other organizational form of the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Jurisdiction of organization of the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Number and series of preferred stock issued to the Investor at the Closing:

 

 

 

 

 

Number of Initial Warrant Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Terms of the Repurchase:

 

 

 

 

 

Number of Preferred Shares repurchased by the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Share certificate number (representing the Preferred Shares previously issued to the Investor at the Closing):

 

 

 

 

 

Per share Liquidation Amount of Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued and unpaid dividends on Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Aggregate purchase price for Repurchased Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Investor wire information for payment of purchase price:

 

ABA Number:

 

 

Bank:

 

 

Account Name:

 

 

Account Number:

 

4



 

SCHEDULE A

 

[Version to be used by private issuers]

 

General Information:

 

 

 

 

 

Date of Letter Agreement incorporating the Securities Purchase Agreement:

 

 

 

 

 

Name of the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Corporate or other organizational form of the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Jurisdiction of organization of the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Number and series of preferred stock issued to the Investor at the Closing (Preferred Shares):

 

 

 

 

 

Number and series of preferred stock underlying the Warrant issued to the Investor at the Closing (Warrant Shares):

 

 

 

 

 

Terms of the Repurchase of Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Number of Preferred Shares purchased by the Company:

 

 

 

 

 

Share certificate number (representing the Preferred Shares previously issued to the Investor at the Closing):

 

 

 

 

 

Per share Liquidation Amount of Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued and unpaid dividends on Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Aggregate purchase price for Repurchased Preferred Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

[To be included for private issuers who are repurchasing some or all of the Warrant Shares: Terms of the Repurchase of the Warrant Shares:

 

 

 

Number of Warrant Shares purchased by the Company:

 

 

 

5



 

Share certificate (representing the Warrant Shares previously issued to the Investor at the Closing):

 

 

 

 

 

Per share Liquidation Amount of Warrant Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued and unpaid dividends on Warrant Shares;

 

 

 

 

 

Aggregate purchase price for Repurchased Warrant Shares:

 

 

 

 

 

[To be included for issuers who are repurchasing less than all of the Warrant Shares: Difference between the Warrant Shares and the Repurchased Warrant Shares:] ]

 

 

 

 

 

Investor wire information for payment of purchase price:

 

ABA Number:

 

 

Bank:

 

 

Account Name:

 

 

Account Number:

 

 

Beneficiary:

 

6




EXHIBIT 10.7

 

2013 Subordinated Promissory Note

 

Certificate Number —[·]-

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

a Texas corporation

 

2013 Subordinated Promissory Note

 

$[·]

 

THIS CERTIFIES THAT [·] is a registered holder of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note in the principal sum of $[·], of Veritex Holdings, Inc. (the “Company”) with a maturity date of December 31, 2023, transferable only on the books of the Company by the holder hereof in person or by duly authorized attorney upon surrender of this Certificate.  Interest on this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note shall be payable quarterly, in arrears, to the registered holder hereof at a rate of 6% per annum, as provided on the reverse side of this certificate.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this Certificate to be signed by its duly authorized officers this [·] day of December, 2013.

 

This certificate and the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note represented hereby is issued and shall be subject to all the provisions of the Certificate of Formation of the Company, as now and hereafter amended, and the restrictions listed on the reverse side of this Certificate, to all of which each holder hereof, by acceptance hereof, assents.

 

 

 

 

Name: C. Malcolm Holland

 

Name: William C. Murphy

Title: Chief Executive Officer

 

Title: Vice Chairman

 

BY ACCEPTANCE OF THIS CERTIFICATE, THE HOLDER HEREOF HEREBY ACCEPTS AND AGREES TO THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS SET OUT IN THE DOCUMENT ENTITLED “VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC. 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE TERMS AND CONDITIONS” DATED DECEMBER 20, 2013.

 

THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE IS NOT A DEPOSIT AND IS NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.

 

THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE CONSTITUTES A SPECULATIVE INVESTMENT, INVOLVES A HIGH DEGREE OF RISK AND SHOULD NOT BE PURCHASED BY ANYONE WHO DOES NOT SATISFY THE SUITABILITY STANDARDS SET FORTH IN REGULATION D.  ACCORDINGLY, NO PERSON SHOULD INVEST WHO IS NOT IN A POSITION TO LOSE HIS ENTIRE INVESTMENT.  INVESTORS SHOULD BE AWARE THAT THEY WILL BE REQUIRED TO BEAR THE FINANCIAL RISKS OF THIS INVESTMENT FOR AN INDEFINITE PERIOD OF TIME. THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE HAS NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE.  SUCH 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE IS BEING OFFERED AND SOLD IN RELIANCE ON EXEMPTIONS FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF SAID ACT AND SUCH LAWS.  THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE HAS NEITHER BEEN REGISTERED

 



 

WITH NOR APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR THE SECURITIES AUTHORITIES OF ANY STATE.  ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE. THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED OR RESOLD EXCEPT AS PERMITTED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT AND APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS.  THE COMPANY MAKES NO REPRESENTATION TO ANY PURCHASER OF THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE REGARDING THE LEGALITY OF AN INVESTMENT HEREIN BY SUCH PURCHASER UNDER APPROPRIATE LEGAL INVESTMENT OR SIMILAR LAWS.

 

INTEREST ON THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE SHALL BE CALCULATED ON THE BASIS OF A 360-DAY YEAR OF TWELVE 30-DAY MONTHS.  INTEREST SHALL BE PAYABLE QUARTERLY, IN ARREARS, ON THE 15TH DAY AFTER THE END OF EACH CALENDAR QUARTER (APRIL 15, JULY 15, OCTOBER 15, JANUARY 15) BEGINNING ON THE QUARTER ENDING ON MARCH 31, 2014 UP TO AND INCLUDING THE MATURITY DATE OF DECEMBER 31, 2023, WHEN A FINAL PAYMENT OF ACCRUED INTEREST AND ALL REMAINING PRINCIPAL SHALL BE PAID.  THE HOLDER HEREOF FOR PRINCIPAL AND INTEREST PAYMENTS SHALL BE THE REGISTERED HOLDER HEREOF ON THE FIFTEENTH (15TH) DAY OF THE CALENDAR MONTH PRECEDING THE INTEREST PAYMENT DATE.

 

THIS 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE MAY ONLY BE PRESENTED FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER OR EXCHANGE WHEN PROPERLY ENDORSED OR ACCOMPANIED BY A WRITTEN INSTRUCTION AND TRANSFER FORM SATISFACTORY TO THE COMPANY AND DELIVERED TO THE COMPANY AT ITS OFFICE MAINTAINED AT 8214 WESTCHESTER DR., STE. 400, DALLAS, TEXAS 75225, OR AT SUCH OTHER LOCATION DESIGNATED BY WRITTEN NOTICE FROM THE COMPANY TO THE HOLDER HEREOF.

 

                                                                                       

FOR VALUE RECEIVED                                                                      HEREBY SELLS, ASSIGNS, AND TRANSFERS UNTO                                                                          THE VERITEX HOLDINGS INC. 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE, AND DOES HEREBY IRREVOCABLY CONSTITUTE AND APPOINT                                                                                ATTORNEY TO TRANSFER THE SAID 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE ON THE BOOKS OF THE COMPANY WITH FULL POWER OF SUBSTITUTION IN THE PREMISES.

 

DATED:                                                                                 , 20    

 

 

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

 

IN THE PRESENCE OF

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date:

 

 

 

 

 

2


 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes

 

$5,000,000 IN AGGREGATE PRINCIPAL AMOUNT OF

2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES

 

TERMS AND CONDITIONS

Dated: December 20, 2013

 


 

THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES CONSTITUTE A SPECULATIVE INVESTMENT, INVOLVE A HIGH DEGREE OF RISK AND SHOULD NOT BE PURCHASED BY ANYONE WHO DOES NOT SATISFY THE SUITABILITY STANDARDS SET FORTH REGULATION D.  ACCORDINGLY, NO PERSON SHOULD INVEST WHO IS NOT IN A POSITION TO LOSE HIS ENTIRE INVESTMENT.  INVESTORS SHOULD BE AWARE THAT THEY WILL BE REQUIRED TO BEAR THE FINANCIAL RISKS OF THIS INVESTMENT FOR AN INDEFINITE PERIOD OF TIME. THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES OFFERED HEREBY HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED (THE “SECURITIES ACT”), OR THE SECURITIES LAWS OF ANY STATE.  SUCH 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES ARE BEING OFFERED AND SOLD IN RELIANCE ON EXEMPTIONS FROM THE REGISTRATION REQUIREMENTS OF SAID ACT AND SUCH LAWS.  THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES HAVE NEITHER BEEN REGISTERED WITH NOR APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR THE SECURITIES AUTHORITIES OF ANY STATE, NOR HAVE THE FOREGOING AUTHORITIES PASSED UPON OR ENDORSED THE MERITS OF THIS OFFERING. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE. THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES OFFERED HEREBY MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED OR RESOLD EXCEPT AS PERMITTED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT AND APPLICABLE STATE SECURITIES LAWS.  THE COMPANY MAKES NO REPRESENTATION TO ANY PURCHASER OF THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES OFFERED HEREBY REGARDING THE LEGALITY OF AN INVESTMENT THEREIN BY SUCH PURCHASER UNDER APPROPRIATE LEGAL INVESTMENT OR SIMILAR LAWS.

 

THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES OFFERED HEREBY ARE NOT SAVINGS OR DEPOSIT ACCOUNTS AND ARE NOT INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION OR ANY OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY.  BY ACCEPTANCE OF THE CERTIFICATE REPRESENTING A 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE, EACH HOLDER OF A 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE HEREBY ACCEPTS AND AGREES TO THE TERMS RESPECTING SUCH 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTE CONTAINED IN THIS DOCUMENT.

 

1



 


 

Veritex Holdings, Inc., a Texas corporation (the “Company”), shall pay to the holder of each of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, or registered assigns, the principal sum indicated in the certificate therefor in one installment on December 31, 2023, and to pay to the Note-Holder interest from the date hereof, quarterly, in arrears, on the 15th day after the end of each calendar quarter end (April 15, July 15, October 15, and January 15) of each quarter beginning on March 31, 2014, up to and including the maturity date of December 31, 2023, on said principal sum at a rate per annum of six percent (6.00%); provided, however, that payment of interest will be made by check mailed to the address of the registered holder hereof as such address shall appear in the register for 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes (the “Note Register”) maintained by the Company or by wire transfer to the account of the registered holder hereof as such account shall appear in the Note Register.  Payment of interest shall by considered made by the Company on the date that the check therefor is deposited in the United States Mail, postage paid.  The Note-Holder for quarterly interest payments, shall be the registered holder thereof on the 15th day of the calendar month preceding the interest payment date.  Interest shall be calculated on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months.

 

ARTICLE I.

 

Defined Terms

 

Section 1.01          Defined Terms. Unless the context otherwise requires, capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings ascribed to them in Article VIII.

 

ARTICLE II.

 

General Provisions

 

Section 2.01          Mutilated Destroyed, Lost or Stolen 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note.  In case a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note shall become mutilated or be destroyed, lost or stolen, the Company in its discretion may execute and deliver a new 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, in exchange and substitution for the mutilated 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note or in lieu of and in substitution for the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note destroyed, lost or stolen.  In every case the Note-Holder shall furnish to the Company such security or indemnity as may be required by it to hold the Company harmless, and, in every case of destruction, loss or theft the Note-Holder shall also furnish to the Company evidence to its satisfaction of the destruction, loss or theft of this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note and of the ownership thereof.  Upon issuance of any substituted 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, the Company may require the payment of a sum sufficient to cover any tax or other governmental charge that may be imposed in relation thereto and other expenses connected therewith.

 

Section 2.02          Transfer and Registration of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.  A 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note may be presented for transfer by surrender thereof at the office of the Company maintained in accordance with Section 3.02 hereof, duly endorsed or accompanied by a written instruction of transfer in form satisfactory to the Company, duly executed by the registered holder thereof or his attorney duly authorized in writing. A 2013 Subordinated

 

2



 

Promissory Note may be transferred in whole, but not in part.  The Company will have no obligation to transfer this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note unless its requirements are met and such transfer complies with the legends on the back of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note.  By its acceptance of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, the holder hereof acknowledges the restrictions on transfer of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note set forth herein, and agrees that it will transfer the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note only as provided herein.

 

Section 2.03          Aggregate Principal Amount of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.  Each 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note is one of a duly authorized issue of Promissory Notes of the Company known as its 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes with an aggregate principal amount of Five Million Dollars ($5,000,000).

 

Section 2.04          Amendment of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.  Each of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes may be amended by the Company with the written consent of the holders of at least a majority in outstanding principal amount of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes; provided that without the written consent of the holder of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, no amendment shall (a) reduce the rate or change the time for payment of interest on every 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, (b) reduce the principal of or change the maturity of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, (c) amend Sections 5.01 or 7.01, or (d) make any change in Article VI that adversely affects the rights of the holder of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note.  After an amendment becomes effective, it shall bind the holders and every subsequent holder of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, even if notation of the amendment is not made on any 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note.  However, the Company may place an appropriate notation regarding an amendment on any 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note thereafter executed.

 

Section 2.05          Early Redemption.  The 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes are not convertible.  Subject to the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas or such other regulatory approvals as may be required, the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes may be redeemed at the option of the Company, in whole or in part in any amount, at any time or from time to time subsequent to the date five years after the date the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes were originally issued, upon not less than thirty (30) days’ prior written notice, at a redemption price equal to 100% of any remaining principal amount being redeemed, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the Redemption Date (as defined herein).

 

(a)           Notice to Record Holder.  If the Company elects to redeem the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes pursuant to this Section 2.05, at least thirty (30) days before a Redemption Date, the Company shall provide a written notice of redemption to each holder whose Promissory Note(s) are to be redeemed at such holder’s registered address.

 

(b)           The notice shall identify the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes to be redeemed and shall state:

 

(i)            the redemption date (the “Redemption Date”);

 

3



 

(ii)           the redemption price and the amount accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to be paid;

 

(iii)          if this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note is being redeemed in part, the portion of the principal amount of this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note to be redeemed and that, after the Redemption Date, upon cancellation of this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, a new 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note or Promissory Notes in principal amount equal to the unredeemed portion will be issued in the name of the holder hereof;

 

(iv)          the name and address of the Paying Agent (as defined herein);

 

(v)           that the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes called for redemption must be surrendered to the Company to collect the redemption price plus accrued interest, if any;

 

(vi)          that, unless the Company defaults in making such redemption payment or is prohibited from making such payment pursuant to the terms of this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, by law or otherwise, interest on this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note if called for redemption ceases to accrue on and after the Redemption Date;

 

(vii)         the paragraph of this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note pursuant to which this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note is called for redemption is being redeemed; and

 

(viii)        any other information necessary to enable holder to comply with the notice of redemption.

 

(c)           Selection of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes to be RedeemedIf less than all the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes are to be redeemed, the Company shall select the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes to be redeemed on a pro rata basis, by lot or by such other method as the Company considers fair and appropriate in its sole discretion.  The Company shall make the selection not less than thirty (30) days before the Redemption Date from the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes outstanding and not previously called for redemption.  2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes and portions of them the Company selects shall be in any principal amount.

 

(d)           Effect of Notice of Redemption.  Once notice of redemption is delivered (if this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note is called for redemption), this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note will become due and payable on the Redemption Date set forth in the notice at the price set forth herein plus interest, if any, accrued and unpaid to the Redemption Date; provided that accrued interest which is due and payable on any interest payment date which is on or prior to the Redemption Date shall be payable to the holder of this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, registered as such at the close of business on the 15th day of the calendar month preceding the Redemption Date; and provided, further, that if a Redemption Date is not a business day, payment shall be made on the next succeeding business day and no interest shall accrue for the period from such

 

4



 

Redemption Date to such succeeding business day unless the Company shall default in the payment due on such business day.  Upon surrender to the Company, this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note shall be paid at the redemption price stated in such notice.  Failure to give notice or any defect in the notice to any holder shall not affect the validity of the notice to any other holder.

 

The notice if mailed in the manner provided herein shall be conclusively presumed to have been given.  In any case, failure to give such notice to any holder or any defect in the notice to any holder of any 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note designated for redemption as a whole or in part shall not affect the validity of the proceedings for the redemption of any other 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

(e)           Deposit of Redemption Price.  Prior to 10:00 a.m. (Dallas, Texas time) on the Redemption Date, the Company shall deposit in an account with Veritex Community Bank, Dallas, Texas (“Paying Agent”), in immediately available funds, money sufficient to pay the redemption price of and accrued and unpaid interest, to but not including the Redemption Date on all 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes to be redeemed on that date (subject to the right of holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on an interest payment date).  The Paying Agent shall return to the Company any money not required for that purpose.

 

So long as the Company complies with the preceding paragraph and the other provisions of this Section 2.05 and unless the Paying Agent is prohibited from making such payment pursuant to the terms of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes to be redeemed on the applicable Redemption Date, interest shall cease to accrue from and after such Redemption Date and such 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes or portions thereof shall be deemed not to be entitled to any benefit under this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note except to receive payment on the Redemption Date of the redemption price plus interest, if any, accrued and unpaid to the Redemption Date.  If any 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note called for redemption shall not be so paid upon surrender for redemption, then, from the Redemption Date until such redemption price (including, without limitation, accrued interest) is paid in full, the Company shall pay interest, to the extent permitted by law, on the unpaid principal, and interest, if any, on such 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note at the rate of six percent (6.00%) per annum or the maximum rate permitted by law.

 

(f)            Securities Redeemed in Part.  If this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note is redeemed in part, and upon surrender hereof, the Company shall issue for the holder at the expense of the Company a new 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, equal in principal amount of the unredeemed portion of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note surrendered.

 

Section 2.06          Tax Withholding.  To the extent required by applicable law, the Company shall withhold or cause to be withheld an amount on any payment to be received by a holder of each of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes for or on account of any taxes imposed and pay or cause to be paid the amount withheld to the applicable governmental authority. The holder of each of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall provide the Company with the applicable

 

5



 

and duly completed Internal Revenue Service form as requested by the Company or as required under then current United States law or regulations to avoid or reduce United States withholding taxes on payments in respect of all amounts to be received by such holder.

 

ARTICLE III.

 

Particular Covenants of the Company

 

Section 3.01          Payment of Principal and Interest on 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note. The Company covenants and agrees that it will duly and punctually pay or cause to be paid the principal of and the interest on each 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note at the place, at the respective times and in the manner provided herein.

 

Section 3.02          Board Observation Rights.  The Company covenants and agrees that if, at any time or times, interest on the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note payable to a Note-Holder has not been paid within 30 days of the date when such interest was due or the Company’s classified assets to total tangible capital ratio exceeds 40%, then the Note-Holder that holds the greatest aggregate principal amount of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes may elect one (1) representative of the Note-Holder (the “Note-Holder Representative”), to attend as an invited guest and fully monitor all regular and special meetings of the Board of Directors of the Company until such interest payment has been paid and/or the Company’s classified assets to total tangible capital ratio no longer exceeds 40%.  Notwithstanding the above, the Note-Holder Representative may be excluded from portions of the meetings of the Board of Directors of the Company if, based on advice of counsel to the Company, the presence of such Note-Holder Representative would be reasonably likely to adversely affect the confidential nature of or any privilege relating to any matter to be discussed.

 

Section 3.03          Inspection of Records; Meeting with Officers.  The Company covenants and agrees that as of the date hereof, the Note-Holder’s rights to inspect the books and records of the Company shall rank pari passu with the rights of the holders of common stock of the Company to inspect the books and records of the Company under the laws of the State of Texas, and that the Note-Holder’s shall have the right to have a meeting (which may be conducted telephonically) with the Chief Financial Officer or Chief Executive Officer no more than once per quarter.

 

Section 3.04          Office for Notices and Payments etc.  So long as any 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note remains outstanding, the Company will maintain at 8214 Westchester Dr., Ste. 400, Texas 75225 (or at such other location designated by a written notice to the Note-Holder), an office or agency where this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note may be presented for payment, an office or agency where a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note may be presented for registration of transfer or exchange as herein provided, and an office or agency where notices and demands to or upon the Company in respect of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note may be served.

 

Section 3.05          Closing Fee.  The Company covenants and agrees that it will pay to the Note-Holder on the date the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes are issued a one-time closing fee (“Closing Fee”) equal to one-half of one percent (.50%) multiplied by the aggregate principal

 

6



 

amount of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes that the Note-Holder purchases. For example, if Note-Holder purchased $3,500,000 of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, then the Company will pay a Closing Fee of $17,500 to the Note-Holder on the date the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes are issued.  The Company will only pay a Closing Fee on the original date of issuance of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, and the Company will not be obligated to pay a Closing Fee to any subsequent holder of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

ARTICLE IV.

 

Immunity of Incorporators, Stockholders,

Officers and Directors

 

Section 4.01          2013 Subordinated Promissory Note Solely Corporate Obligations.  No recourse for the payment of the principal of or interest on a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, or for any claim based hereon or otherwise in respect hereof, and no recourse under or upon any obligation, covenant or agreement of the Company related to a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note, or because of the creation of any indebtedness represented hereby, shall be had against any incorporator, stockholder, officer or director, as such, past, present or future, of the Company or of any successor corporation, either directly or through the Company or any successor corporation, whether by virtue of any constitution, statute, or rule of law, or by the enforcement of any assessment or penalty or otherwise; it being expressly understood that all such liability is hereby expressly waived and released as a condition of, and as a consideration for, the execution of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

ARTICLE V.

 

Remedies in Event of Default

 

Section 5.01          Event of Default.  In case one or more of the following Events of Default shall have occurred and be continuing:

 

(a)           without the consent of the Company, a court having jurisdiction shall enter an order for relief with respect to the Company under the Bankruptcy Code or without the consent of the Company a court having jurisdiction shall enter a judgment, order or decree adjudging the Company bankrupt or insolvent, or enter an order for relief for reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition of or in respect of the Company under the Bankruptcy Code or applicable state insolvency law and the continuance of any such judgment, order or decree unstayed and in effect for a period of ninety (90) consecutive days; or

 

(b)           the Company shall institute proceedings for entry of an order for relief with respect to the Company under the Bankruptcy Code or for an adjudication of insolvency, or shall consent to the institution of bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings against it, or shall file a petition seeking, or seek or consent to reorganization, arrangement, composition or relief under the Bankruptcy Code or any applicable state law, or shall consent to the filing of such petition or to the appointment of a receiver, custodian, liquidator, assignee, trustee, sequestrator or similar official of the Company or

 

7



 

substantially all of its property, or the Company shall make a general assignment for the benefit of creditors as recognized under the Bankruptcy Code;

 

then and in each and every such case, unless the principal of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall have already become due and payable, the holders of not less than 51% in outstanding principal amount of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes (“Majority Holders”) by notice in writing to the Company, may declare the principal of all 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes and any accrued interest to the date of declaration to be due and payable immediately, and upon any such declaration the same shall become and shall be immediately due and payable, subject to Article VI.

 

Section 5.02          No Acceleration.  Except as permitted by Section 5.01, the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall not have the right to accelerate the payment of or otherwise declare the principal of all 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes and any accrued interest to the date of declaration to be due and payable prior to the date of maturity of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

Section 5.03          Remedies Cumulative and Continuing.  All powers and remedies given by this Article V to the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall, to the extent permitted by law, be deemed cumulative and not exclusive of any other thereof or of any other powers and remedies available to such holders, by judicial proceedings or otherwise, to enforce the performance or observance of the covenants and agreements contained in the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, and no delay or omission of any holder to exercise any right or power accruing upon any default occurring and continuing as aforesaid, shall impair any such right or power, or shall be construed to be a waiver of any such default or an acquiescence therein; and every power and remedy given by this Article V or by law to the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes may be exercised from time to time, and as often as shall be deemed expedient, by such holders.

 

Section 5.04          Waiver of Presentment, Demand, Etc.  Except as provided herein, the Company hereby waives presentment and demand for payment, protest, notice of protest and nonpayment, notice of the intention to accelerate, notice of acceleration, and agrees that its liability on this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note shall not be affected by any renewal or extension in the time of payment hereof, by any indulgences, and hereby consents to any and all renewals, extensions, indulgences, releases, or changes, regardless of the number of such renewals, extensions, indulgences, releases or changes.

 

ARTICLE VI.

 

Subordination of Promissory Note

 

Section 6.01          Agreement of Subordination.  The Company irrevocably covenants and agrees, and the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, by their acceptance thereof, likewise irrevocably covenant and agree, that the payment of the principal of and interest on the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes is hereby expressly subordinated, to the extent and in the manner hereinafter set forth, to the prior payment in full of all Senior Indebtedness. The 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes are unsecured.  The provisions of this Article VI are made for

 

8



 

the benefit of the holders of Senior Indebtedness, and such holders shall, at any time, be entitled to enforce such provisions against the Company or the holder hereof.  No holder of any Senior Indebtedness shall be deemed to owe any fiduciary duty or any other obligation to any holder of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes now or at any time hereafter.

 

Section 6.02          Payment Over of Proceeds Upon Dissolution, etc.

 

(a)           In the event of (x) any insolvency, bankruptcy, receivership, liquidation, readjustment, composition or other similar proceeding relative to the Company or its creditors or its property, (y) any proceeding for voluntary liquidation, dissolution or other winding up of the Company whether or not involving insolvency or bankruptcy proceedings, or (z) any assignment for the benefit of creditors or any marshaling of the assets of the Company, then and in any such event,

 

(i)            all Senior Indebtedness (including interest accruing on such Senior Indebtedness after the date of filing a petition or other action commencing any such proceeding) shall first be paid in full, or have provision made for payment in full to the reasonable satisfaction of the holder of any Senior Indebtedness, before the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall be entitled to receive any payment on account of the principal of or interest on the indebtedness evidenced by the certificates for the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, and

 

(ii)           any payment or distribution of assets of the Company of any kind or character, whether in cash, property or securities (other than securities of the Company or any other corporation provided for by a plan of reorganization or readjustment, provided that the rights of the holders of Senior Indebtedness are not altered by such reorganization or readjustment, the payment of which is subordinate, at least to the extent provided in this Article VI with respect to the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, to the payment of all Senior Indebtedness at the time outstanding and to the payment of all securities issued in exchange therefor to the holders of Senior Indebtedness at the time outstanding), to which the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes would be entitled except for the provisions of this Article VI, shall be paid by the liquidating trustee or agent or other person making such payment or distribution, whether a trustee in bankruptcy, a receiver or liquidating trustee or other trustee or agent, directly to the holders of Senior Indebtedness or their representative or representatives or to the trustee or trustees under any indenture under which any instruments evidencing any of such Senior Indebtedness may have been issued, ratably according to the aggregate amounts remaining unpaid on account of the principal of and premium, if any, and interest on, the Senior Indebtedness held or represented by each, to the extent necessary to make payment in full of all Senior Indebtedness remaining unpaid and/or outstanding (as the case may be), after giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution, or provision therefor, to the holders of such Senior Indebtedness.

 

(b)           No payments on account of principal of or interest on the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall be made unless full payment of amounts then due for principal of,

 

9



 

premium, if any, and interest on all Senior Indebtedness has been made or otherwise duly provided for to the reasonable satisfaction of each holder of any Senior Indebtedness.

 

(c)           In the event and during the continuation of any default or event of default in respect of any Senior Indebtedness or under any agreement under which any Senior Indebtedness was issued continuing beyond the period of grace, if any, specified in such agreement, then, unless and until such default shall have been cured or waived or shall have ceased to exist, no payment shall be made by the Company and no application of funds shall be made with respect to the principal of or interest on the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

(d)           In the event that, notwithstanding the foregoing, any payment or distribution of assets of the Company of any kind or character, whether in cash, property or securities (other than securities of the Company or any other corporation provided for by a plan of reorganization or readjustment, provided that the rights of the holders of Senior Indebtedness are not altered by such reorganization or readjustment, the payment of which is subordinate, at least to the extent provided in this Article VI with respect to the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, to the payment of all Senior Indebtedness at the time outstanding and to the payment of all securities issued in exchange therefor to the holders of Senior Indebtedness at the time outstanding), shall be received by the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes during the continuance of any event specified in Sections 6.02(a), 6.02(b) or 6.02(c) prohibiting such payment and before all Senior Indebtedness is paid in full or provision made for its payment to the reasonable satisfaction of each holder of any Senior Indebtedness, such payment or distribution (subject to Section 6.04) shall be immediately paid by the holder hereof over to the holders of Senior Indebtedness (or their representative or representatives or to the trustee or trustees under any indenture under which any instruments evidencing any of such Senior Indebtedness may have been issued), upon their written request remaining unpaid or unprovided for as provided in the foregoing subsection (ii) of Section 6.02(a), for application to the payment of such Senior Indebtedness until all such Senior Indebtedness shall have been paid in full, after giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution, or provision therefor, to the holders of such Senior Indebtedness.

 

(e)           Subject to the payment in full of all Senior Indebtedness and the irrevocable and complete termination of all commitments and obligations to issue or fund any Senior Indebtedness (and not before such time), all holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall be subrogated equally and ratably with the other holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes to all rights of the holders of Senior Indebtedness to receive payments or distributions of cash, property or securities of the Company applicable to the Senior Indebtedness until the principal of and interest on this 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note shall be paid in full; and, for purposes of such subrogation, no payments or distributions to the holders of Senior Indebtedness of cash, property or securities distributable or paid over to the holders of Senior Indebtedness under the provisions hereof to which the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes would be entitled except for the provisions of this Article VI shall, as between the Company, its creditors other than the holders of Senior Indebtedness, and the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, be deemed to be a payment by the Company to

 

10


 

or on account of the Senior Indebtedness, it being understood that the provisions of this Article VI are and are intended solely for the purposes of defining the relative rights of the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes and the holders of the Senior Indebtedness.

 

(f)            Nothing contained in this Article VI or elsewhere in this document is intended to or shall impair, as between the Company, its creditors other than the holders of Senior Indebtedness, and the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, the obligation of the Company, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay to the holder hereof the principal of and interest hereon, as and when the same shall become due and payable in accordance with the terms hereof, or is intended to or shall affect the relative rights of the holder hereof and other creditors of the Company other than the holders of the Senior Indebtedness, nor shall anything in this document prevent the holder from exercising all remedies otherwise permitted by applicable law upon the happening of any Event of Default under this document, subject to the rights, if any, under this Article VI of the holders of Senior Indebtedness in respect of cash, property or securities of the Company received upon the exercise of any such remedy.

 

(g)           Without notice to or the consent of the holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, the holders of the Senior Indebtedness or the entities committed or obligated to issue or fund any Senior Indebtedness may at any time and from time to time, without impairing or releasing the subordination herein made, change the manner, place or terms of payment, or change or extend the time of payment of or renew or alter the Senior Indebtedness or the commitment or obligation to issue or fund any Senior Indebtedness, or amend or supplement in any manner any instrument evidencing the Senior Indebtedness or the commitment or obligation to issue or fund any Senior Indebtedness, any agreement pursuant to which the Senior Indebtedness was issued or incurred or any instrument securing or relating to the Senior Indebtedness or the commitment or obligation to issue or fund any Senior Indebtedness; release any person liable in any manner for the payment or collection of the Senior Indebtedness; exercise or refrain from exercising any rights in respect of the Senior Indebtedness against the Company or any other person; apply any money or other property paid by any person or released in any manner to the Senior Indebtedness; accept or release any security for the Senior Indebtedness; sell, exchange, release or otherwise deal with any property pledged, mortgaged or otherwise securing Senior Indebtedness; or exercise or refrain from exercising any rights against the Company or any other person; all without thereby impairing in any respect the rights of such holders of Senior Indebtedness as provided in this Article VI.

 

Section 6.03          No Waiver of Subordination Provision.  No right of any present or future holder of any Senior Indebtedness of the Company to enforce subordination, as herein provided, shall at any time in any way be prejudiced or impaired by any act or failure to act on the part of the Company or by any act or failure to act, in good faith, by any such holder, or by any noncompliance by the Company with the terms, provisions and covenants of this document, regardless of any knowledge thereof any such holder may have or be otherwise charged with.

 

11



 

Section 6.04          Payments to Note-Holder.  Nothing contained in this Article VI or elsewhere in this document, shall, however, affect the obligation of the Company to make, or prevent the Company from making, at any time, except as provided in Section 6.02, payments of principal of or interest on the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

Section 6.05          Authorization of Note-Holder to Company to Effect Subordination.  Each holder of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note by his acceptance hereof irrevocably authorizes and directs the Company on his behalf to take such action as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate the subordination provided in this Article VI and appoints the Company his attorney-in-fact for such purpose.

 

Section 6.06          All Provisions of 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note Qualified by Article VI.  Notwithstanding anything herein contained to the contrary, all the provisions of this document shall, except as otherwise provided herein, be subject to the provisions of this Article VI, so far as the same may be applicable thereto.

 

Section 6.07          No Sinking Fund Payment.  The holders of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, by their acceptance hereof, irrevocably acknowledges and agrees, that the Company will not make any sinking fund deposits with regards to the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

ARTICLE VII.

 

Miscellaneous Provisions

 

Section 7.01          Successors and Assigns of Company Bound.  All the covenants, stipulations, promises and agreements in this document by or in behalf of the Company shall bind its successors and assigns, whether so expressed or not.

 

Section 7.02          Notice to Note-Holder.  When this document provides for notice to the holder of any event, such notice shall be sufficiently given (unless otherwise expressly herein provided) if in writing and mailed, first class, postage prepaid, to the holder at his address as it appears on the Note Register, not later than the latest date, and not earlier than the earliest date, prescribed for the giving of such notice. Any notice which is mailed to the holder in the manner herein provided shall be conclusively presumed to have been duly given. Where this document provides for notice in any manner, such notice may be waived in writing by the person entitled to receive such notice, either before or after the event, and such waiver shall be the equivalent of such notice.

 

Section 7.03          GOVERNING LAW.  THIS DOCUMENT SHALL BE DEEMED TO BE A CONTRACT MADE UNDER THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF TEXAS, AND FOR ALL PURPOSES SHALL BE CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF SAID STATE.  THE EXCLUSIVE VENUE FOR ANY DISPUTES RELATED TO OR ARISING OUT OF THE 2013 SUBORDINATED PROMISSORY NOTES, INCLUDING THESE TERMS AND CONDITIONS, SHALL BE IN DALLAS COUNTY, TEXAS.

 

Section 7.04          Legal Holidays.  In any case where the date of maturity of interest on or principal of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes or the date fixed for redemption of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall not be a Business Day, then payment of interest on or

 

12



 

principal of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes need not be made on such date, but may be made on the next succeeding Business Day with the same force and effect as if made on the date of maturity or the date fixed for redemption, and no interest shall accrue for the period after such prior date.

 

Section 7.05          Severability.  In case any provision of this document shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.

 

ARTICLE VIII.

 

Definitions

 

Section 8.01          Definitions.  The terms defined in this Section 8.01 (except as herein otherwise expressly provided or unless the context otherwise requires) for all purposes of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes shall have the respective meanings specified in this Section 8.01.

 

Bankruptcy Code” shall mean the United States Bankruptcy Code, 11 U.S.C. § 101 et seq. or any successor statute thereto.

 

Business Day” shall mean any day except a Saturday, a Sunday or a day on which banking institutions in Texas are authorized or required by law to close.

 

Indebtedness” shall mean the following, whether outstanding on the date hereof or hereafter created, incurred, assumed or guaranteed, (a) the principal of, premium if any, and interest on (i) indebtedness of the Company for money borrowed, (ii) indebtedness of the Company evidenced by bonds, 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes or similar obligations, (iii) capitalized lease obligations, (iv) indebtedness or obligations incurred, assumed or guaranteed by the Company in connection with the acquisition or improvement of any property or asset or the acquisition by it or by a Subsidiary of any business, (v) indebtedness of others of the kinds described in the preceding clauses (i), (ii), (iii), and (iv), assumed or guaranteed by the Company or in effect guaranteed by the Company through an agreement to purchase or otherwise, (vi) obligations which would be classified as liabilities on the balance sheet of the Company in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, evidencing the purchase price for the acquisition of assets of any kind, tangible or intangible, by the Company or a Subsidiary, except in the ordinary course of business, and (b) any increases, refundings, renewals, rearrangements or extensions of and amendments, modifications and supplements to any indebtedness, liability or obligation described in clause (a) above.

 

Junior Indebtedness” shall mean Indebtedness, which, by the terms of the instrument by which such Indebtedness is created or evidenced, ranks junior and subordinate in right of payment to the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes, including, but not limited to, the Company’s common stock and preferred stock, and any Indebtedness of the Company incurred in connection with the issuance of trust preferred securities.

 

Promissory Note” shall mean any of the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes issued on exchange or transfer hereof.

 

13



 

Note-Holder” “holder of a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note” or other similar terms mean any person in whose name at the time a 2013 Subordinated Promissory Note shall be registered in the Note Register kept for that purpose in accordance with the terms hereof.

 

Senior Indebtedness” shall mean whether outstanding on the date hereof or hereafter created, incurred, assumed or guaranteed, the principal of, premium if any, and interest on Indebtedness for money borrowed by the Company which by law or by its express terms is made senior and preferential in right of payment to the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.  Senior Indebtedness includes the Indebtedness of any general creditors of the Company.  Senior Indebtedness also includes the obligations of Veritex Community Bank, Dallas, Texas (the “Bank”) to its depositors, its obligations under banker’s acceptance and letters of credit, its obligations, if any, to any Federal Reserve Bank, its obligations to the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”), and to claims of its fiduciary beneficiaries as well as any indebtedness of the Bank or a successor bank or corporation, including interest thereon, for borrowed money however incurred or any guarantee of such indebtedness by the Bank outstanding at any time except such indebtedness that by its express terms is not senior in right of payment to the 2013 Subordinated Promissory Notes.

 

Subsidiary” shall mean any corporation of which the Company, or the Company and one or more Subsidiaries, or any one or more Subsidiaries, directly or indirectly own voting securities entitling the holders thereof to elect a majority of the directors, either at all times or so long as there is no default or contingency which permits the holders of any other class or classes of securities to vote for the election of one or more directors.

 

[Signature page follows]

 

14



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this instrument to be executed by a duly authorized officer.

 

 

VERITEX HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

C. Malcolm Holland

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

[Signature Page to Terms and Conditions of Veritex Holdings, Inc.

2013 Subordinated Promissory Note]

 

15




QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.1

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

        We have issued our report dated July 22, 2014, with respect to the consolidated financial statements of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and subsidiary contained in the Registration Statement and Prospectus. We consent to the use of the aforementioned report in the Registration Statement and Prospectus, and to the use of our name as it appears under the caption "Experts."

/s/ Grant Thornton LLP

Dallas, Texas
August 29, 2014




QuickLinks

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.2

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

        We consent to the use in this Registration Statement on Form S-1 of our report dated July 22, 2014 relating to the consolidated financial statements of Veritex Holdings, Inc. and Subsidiary, appearing in the Prospectus, which is a part of the Registration Statement.

/s/ JonesBaggett LLP
Dallas, Texas
August 29, 2014




QuickLinks

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm